| File: | src/gnu/usr.bin/clang/libclangSema/../../../llvm/clang/lib/Sema/SemaType.cpp |
| Warning: | line 5916, column 15 Called C++ object pointer is null |
Press '?' to see keyboard shortcuts
Keyboard shortcuts:
| 1 | //===--- SemaType.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Types -----------------------===// | ||||||||||
| 2 | // | ||||||||||
| 3 | // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. | ||||||||||
| 4 | // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. | ||||||||||
| 5 | // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception | ||||||||||
| 6 | // | ||||||||||
| 7 | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | ||||||||||
| 8 | // | ||||||||||
| 9 | // This file implements type-related semantic analysis. | ||||||||||
| 10 | // | ||||||||||
| 11 | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | ||||||||||
| 12 | |||||||||||
| 13 | #include "TypeLocBuilder.h" | ||||||||||
| 14 | #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" | ||||||||||
| 15 | #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" | ||||||||||
| 16 | #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h" | ||||||||||
| 17 | #include "clang/AST/ASTStructuralEquivalence.h" | ||||||||||
| 18 | #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" | ||||||||||
| 19 | #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" | ||||||||||
| 20 | #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" | ||||||||||
| 21 | #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" | ||||||||||
| 22 | #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h" | ||||||||||
| 23 | #include "clang/AST/TypeLocVisitor.h" | ||||||||||
| 24 | #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" | ||||||||||
| 25 | #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" | ||||||||||
| 26 | #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" | ||||||||||
| 27 | #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" | ||||||||||
| 28 | #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" | ||||||||||
| 29 | #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" | ||||||||||
| 30 | #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" | ||||||||||
| 31 | #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" | ||||||||||
| 32 | #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" | ||||||||||
| 33 | #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" | ||||||||||
| 34 | #include "clang/Sema/TemplateInstCallback.h" | ||||||||||
| 35 | #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" | ||||||||||
| 36 | #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" | ||||||||||
| 37 | #include "llvm/ADT/StringSwitch.h" | ||||||||||
| 38 | #include "llvm/IR/DerivedTypes.h" | ||||||||||
| 39 | #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h" | ||||||||||
| 40 | #include <bitset> | ||||||||||
| 41 | |||||||||||
| 42 | using namespace clang; | ||||||||||
| 43 | |||||||||||
| 44 | enum TypeDiagSelector { | ||||||||||
| 45 | TDS_Function, | ||||||||||
| 46 | TDS_Pointer, | ||||||||||
| 47 | TDS_ObjCObjOrBlock | ||||||||||
| 48 | }; | ||||||||||
| 49 | |||||||||||
| 50 | /// isOmittedBlockReturnType - Return true if this declarator is missing a | ||||||||||
| 51 | /// return type because this is a omitted return type on a block literal. | ||||||||||
| 52 | static bool isOmittedBlockReturnType(const Declarator &D) { | ||||||||||
| 53 | if (D.getContext() != DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteral || | ||||||||||
| 54 | D.getDeclSpec().hasTypeSpecifier()) | ||||||||||
| 55 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 56 | |||||||||||
| 57 | if (D.getNumTypeObjects() == 0) | ||||||||||
| 58 | return true; // ^{ ... } | ||||||||||
| 59 | |||||||||||
| 60 | if (D.getNumTypeObjects() == 1 && | ||||||||||
| 61 | D.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function) | ||||||||||
| 62 | return true; // ^(int X, float Y) { ... } | ||||||||||
| 63 | |||||||||||
| 64 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 65 | } | ||||||||||
| 66 | |||||||||||
| 67 | /// diagnoseBadTypeAttribute - Diagnoses a type attribute which | ||||||||||
| 68 | /// doesn't apply to the given type. | ||||||||||
| 69 | static void diagnoseBadTypeAttribute(Sema &S, const ParsedAttr &attr, | ||||||||||
| 70 | QualType type) { | ||||||||||
| 71 | TypeDiagSelector WhichType; | ||||||||||
| 72 | bool useExpansionLoc = true; | ||||||||||
| 73 | switch (attr.getKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 74 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCGC: | ||||||||||
| 75 | WhichType = TDS_Pointer; | ||||||||||
| 76 | break; | ||||||||||
| 77 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership: | ||||||||||
| 78 | WhichType = TDS_ObjCObjOrBlock; | ||||||||||
| 79 | break; | ||||||||||
| 80 | default: | ||||||||||
| 81 | // Assume everything else was a function attribute. | ||||||||||
| 82 | WhichType = TDS_Function; | ||||||||||
| 83 | useExpansionLoc = false; | ||||||||||
| 84 | break; | ||||||||||
| 85 | } | ||||||||||
| 86 | |||||||||||
| 87 | SourceLocation loc = attr.getLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 88 | StringRef name = attr.getAttrName()->getName(); | ||||||||||
| 89 | |||||||||||
| 90 | // The GC attributes are usually written with macros; special-case them. | ||||||||||
| 91 | IdentifierInfo *II = attr.isArgIdent(0) ? attr.getArgAsIdent(0)->Ident | ||||||||||
| 92 | : nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 93 | if (useExpansionLoc && loc.isMacroID() && II) { | ||||||||||
| 94 | if (II->isStr("strong")) { | ||||||||||
| 95 | if (S.findMacroSpelling(loc, "__strong")) name = "__strong"; | ||||||||||
| 96 | } else if (II->isStr("weak")) { | ||||||||||
| 97 | if (S.findMacroSpelling(loc, "__weak")) name = "__weak"; | ||||||||||
| 98 | } | ||||||||||
| 99 | } | ||||||||||
| 100 | |||||||||||
| 101 | S.Diag(loc, diag::warn_type_attribute_wrong_type) << name << WhichType | ||||||||||
| 102 | << type; | ||||||||||
| 103 | } | ||||||||||
| 104 | |||||||||||
| 105 | // objc_gc applies to Objective-C pointers or, otherwise, to the | ||||||||||
| 106 | // smallest available pointer type (i.e. 'void*' in 'void**'). | ||||||||||
| 107 | #define OBJC_POINTER_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCGC: case ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership \ | ||||||||||
| 108 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCGC: \ | ||||||||||
| 109 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership | ||||||||||
| 110 | |||||||||||
| 111 | // Calling convention attributes. | ||||||||||
| 112 | #define CALLING_CONV_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_CDecl: case ParsedAttr::AT_FastCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_StdCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_ThisCall: case ParsedAttr ::AT_RegCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pascal: case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftAsyncCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_VectorCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_AArch64VectorPcs: case ParsedAttr::AT_MSABI : case ParsedAttr::AT_SysVABI: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pcs: case ParsedAttr ::AT_IntelOclBicc: case ParsedAttr::AT_PreserveMost: case ParsedAttr ::AT_PreserveAll \ | ||||||||||
| 113 | case ParsedAttr::AT_CDecl: \ | ||||||||||
| 114 | case ParsedAttr::AT_FastCall: \ | ||||||||||
| 115 | case ParsedAttr::AT_StdCall: \ | ||||||||||
| 116 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ThisCall: \ | ||||||||||
| 117 | case ParsedAttr::AT_RegCall: \ | ||||||||||
| 118 | case ParsedAttr::AT_Pascal: \ | ||||||||||
| 119 | case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftCall: \ | ||||||||||
| 120 | case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftAsyncCall: \ | ||||||||||
| 121 | case ParsedAttr::AT_VectorCall: \ | ||||||||||
| 122 | case ParsedAttr::AT_AArch64VectorPcs: \ | ||||||||||
| 123 | case ParsedAttr::AT_MSABI: \ | ||||||||||
| 124 | case ParsedAttr::AT_SysVABI: \ | ||||||||||
| 125 | case ParsedAttr::AT_Pcs: \ | ||||||||||
| 126 | case ParsedAttr::AT_IntelOclBicc: \ | ||||||||||
| 127 | case ParsedAttr::AT_PreserveMost: \ | ||||||||||
| 128 | case ParsedAttr::AT_PreserveAll | ||||||||||
| 129 | |||||||||||
| 130 | // Function type attributes. | ||||||||||
| 131 | #define FUNCTION_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_NSReturnsRetained: case ParsedAttr::AT_NoReturn : case ParsedAttr::AT_Regparm: case ParsedAttr::AT_CmseNSCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegisters: case ParsedAttr ::AT_AnyX86NoCfCheck: case ParsedAttr::AT_CDecl: case ParsedAttr ::AT_FastCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_StdCall: case ParsedAttr:: AT_ThisCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_RegCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pascal : case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftAsyncCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_VectorCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_AArch64VectorPcs : case ParsedAttr::AT_MSABI: case ParsedAttr::AT_SysVABI: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pcs: case ParsedAttr::AT_IntelOclBicc: case ParsedAttr ::AT_PreserveMost: case ParsedAttr::AT_PreserveAll \ | ||||||||||
| 132 | case ParsedAttr::AT_NSReturnsRetained: \ | ||||||||||
| 133 | case ParsedAttr::AT_NoReturn: \ | ||||||||||
| 134 | case ParsedAttr::AT_Regparm: \ | ||||||||||
| 135 | case ParsedAttr::AT_CmseNSCall: \ | ||||||||||
| 136 | case ParsedAttr::AT_AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegisters: \ | ||||||||||
| 137 | case ParsedAttr::AT_AnyX86NoCfCheck: \ | ||||||||||
| 138 | CALLING_CONV_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_CDecl: case ParsedAttr::AT_FastCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_StdCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_ThisCall: case ParsedAttr ::AT_RegCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pascal: case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftAsyncCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_VectorCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_AArch64VectorPcs: case ParsedAttr::AT_MSABI : case ParsedAttr::AT_SysVABI: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pcs: case ParsedAttr ::AT_IntelOclBicc: case ParsedAttr::AT_PreserveMost: case ParsedAttr ::AT_PreserveAll | ||||||||||
| 139 | |||||||||||
| 140 | // Microsoft-specific type qualifiers. | ||||||||||
| 141 | #define MS_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_Ptr32: case ParsedAttr::AT_Ptr64: case ParsedAttr ::AT_SPtr: case ParsedAttr::AT_UPtr \ | ||||||||||
| 142 | case ParsedAttr::AT_Ptr32: \ | ||||||||||
| 143 | case ParsedAttr::AT_Ptr64: \ | ||||||||||
| 144 | case ParsedAttr::AT_SPtr: \ | ||||||||||
| 145 | case ParsedAttr::AT_UPtr | ||||||||||
| 146 | |||||||||||
| 147 | // Nullability qualifiers. | ||||||||||
| 148 | #define NULLABILITY_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNonNull: case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullable : case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullableResult: case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullUnspecified \ | ||||||||||
| 149 | case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNonNull: \ | ||||||||||
| 150 | case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullable: \ | ||||||||||
| 151 | case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullableResult: \ | ||||||||||
| 152 | case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullUnspecified | ||||||||||
| 153 | |||||||||||
| 154 | namespace { | ||||||||||
| 155 | /// An object which stores processing state for the entire | ||||||||||
| 156 | /// GetTypeForDeclarator process. | ||||||||||
| 157 | class TypeProcessingState { | ||||||||||
| 158 | Sema &sema; | ||||||||||
| 159 | |||||||||||
| 160 | /// The declarator being processed. | ||||||||||
| 161 | Declarator &declarator; | ||||||||||
| 162 | |||||||||||
| 163 | /// The index of the declarator chunk we're currently processing. | ||||||||||
| 164 | /// May be the total number of valid chunks, indicating the | ||||||||||
| 165 | /// DeclSpec. | ||||||||||
| 166 | unsigned chunkIndex; | ||||||||||
| 167 | |||||||||||
| 168 | /// Whether there are non-trivial modifications to the decl spec. | ||||||||||
| 169 | bool trivial; | ||||||||||
| 170 | |||||||||||
| 171 | /// Whether we saved the attributes in the decl spec. | ||||||||||
| 172 | bool hasSavedAttrs; | ||||||||||
| 173 | |||||||||||
| 174 | /// The original set of attributes on the DeclSpec. | ||||||||||
| 175 | SmallVector<ParsedAttr *, 2> savedAttrs; | ||||||||||
| 176 | |||||||||||
| 177 | /// A list of attributes to diagnose the uselessness of when the | ||||||||||
| 178 | /// processing is complete. | ||||||||||
| 179 | SmallVector<ParsedAttr *, 2> ignoredTypeAttrs; | ||||||||||
| 180 | |||||||||||
| 181 | /// Attributes corresponding to AttributedTypeLocs that we have not yet | ||||||||||
| 182 | /// populated. | ||||||||||
| 183 | // FIXME: The two-phase mechanism by which we construct Types and fill | ||||||||||
| 184 | // their TypeLocs makes it hard to correctly assign these. We keep the | ||||||||||
| 185 | // attributes in creation order as an attempt to make them line up | ||||||||||
| 186 | // properly. | ||||||||||
| 187 | using TypeAttrPair = std::pair<const AttributedType*, const Attr*>; | ||||||||||
| 188 | SmallVector<TypeAttrPair, 8> AttrsForTypes; | ||||||||||
| 189 | bool AttrsForTypesSorted = true; | ||||||||||
| 190 | |||||||||||
| 191 | /// MacroQualifiedTypes mapping to macro expansion locations that will be | ||||||||||
| 192 | /// stored in a MacroQualifiedTypeLoc. | ||||||||||
| 193 | llvm::DenseMap<const MacroQualifiedType *, SourceLocation> LocsForMacros; | ||||||||||
| 194 | |||||||||||
| 195 | /// Flag to indicate we parsed a noderef attribute. This is used for | ||||||||||
| 196 | /// validating that noderef was used on a pointer or array. | ||||||||||
| 197 | bool parsedNoDeref; | ||||||||||
| 198 | |||||||||||
| 199 | public: | ||||||||||
| 200 | TypeProcessingState(Sema &sema, Declarator &declarator) | ||||||||||
| 201 | : sema(sema), declarator(declarator), | ||||||||||
| 202 | chunkIndex(declarator.getNumTypeObjects()), trivial(true), | ||||||||||
| 203 | hasSavedAttrs(false), parsedNoDeref(false) {} | ||||||||||
| 204 | |||||||||||
| 205 | Sema &getSema() const { | ||||||||||
| 206 | return sema; | ||||||||||
| 207 | } | ||||||||||
| 208 | |||||||||||
| 209 | Declarator &getDeclarator() const { | ||||||||||
| 210 | return declarator; | ||||||||||
| 211 | } | ||||||||||
| 212 | |||||||||||
| 213 | bool isProcessingDeclSpec() const { | ||||||||||
| 214 | return chunkIndex == declarator.getNumTypeObjects(); | ||||||||||
| 215 | } | ||||||||||
| 216 | |||||||||||
| 217 | unsigned getCurrentChunkIndex() const { | ||||||||||
| 218 | return chunkIndex; | ||||||||||
| 219 | } | ||||||||||
| 220 | |||||||||||
| 221 | void setCurrentChunkIndex(unsigned idx) { | ||||||||||
| 222 | assert(idx <= declarator.getNumTypeObjects())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 223 | chunkIndex = idx; | ||||||||||
| 224 | } | ||||||||||
| 225 | |||||||||||
| 226 | ParsedAttributesView &getCurrentAttributes() const { | ||||||||||
| 227 | if (isProcessingDeclSpec()) | ||||||||||
| 228 | return getMutableDeclSpec().getAttributes(); | ||||||||||
| 229 | return declarator.getTypeObject(chunkIndex).getAttrs(); | ||||||||||
| 230 | } | ||||||||||
| 231 | |||||||||||
| 232 | /// Save the current set of attributes on the DeclSpec. | ||||||||||
| 233 | void saveDeclSpecAttrs() { | ||||||||||
| 234 | // Don't try to save them multiple times. | ||||||||||
| 235 | if (hasSavedAttrs) return; | ||||||||||
| 236 | |||||||||||
| 237 | DeclSpec &spec = getMutableDeclSpec(); | ||||||||||
| 238 | for (ParsedAttr &AL : spec.getAttributes()) | ||||||||||
| 239 | savedAttrs.push_back(&AL); | ||||||||||
| 240 | trivial &= savedAttrs.empty(); | ||||||||||
| 241 | hasSavedAttrs = true; | ||||||||||
| 242 | } | ||||||||||
| 243 | |||||||||||
| 244 | /// Record that we had nowhere to put the given type attribute. | ||||||||||
| 245 | /// We will diagnose such attributes later. | ||||||||||
| 246 | void addIgnoredTypeAttr(ParsedAttr &attr) { | ||||||||||
| 247 | ignoredTypeAttrs.push_back(&attr); | ||||||||||
| 248 | } | ||||||||||
| 249 | |||||||||||
| 250 | /// Diagnose all the ignored type attributes, given that the | ||||||||||
| 251 | /// declarator worked out to the given type. | ||||||||||
| 252 | void diagnoseIgnoredTypeAttrs(QualType type) const { | ||||||||||
| 253 | for (auto *Attr : ignoredTypeAttrs) | ||||||||||
| 254 | diagnoseBadTypeAttribute(getSema(), *Attr, type); | ||||||||||
| 255 | } | ||||||||||
| 256 | |||||||||||
| 257 | /// Get an attributed type for the given attribute, and remember the Attr | ||||||||||
| 258 | /// object so that we can attach it to the AttributedTypeLoc. | ||||||||||
| 259 | QualType getAttributedType(Attr *A, QualType ModifiedType, | ||||||||||
| 260 | QualType EquivType) { | ||||||||||
| 261 | QualType T = | ||||||||||
| 262 | sema.Context.getAttributedType(A->getKind(), ModifiedType, EquivType); | ||||||||||
| 263 | AttrsForTypes.push_back({cast<AttributedType>(T.getTypePtr()), A}); | ||||||||||
| 264 | AttrsForTypesSorted = false; | ||||||||||
| 265 | return T; | ||||||||||
| 266 | } | ||||||||||
| 267 | |||||||||||
| 268 | /// Completely replace the \c auto in \p TypeWithAuto by | ||||||||||
| 269 | /// \p Replacement. Also replace \p TypeWithAuto in \c TypeAttrPair if | ||||||||||
| 270 | /// necessary. | ||||||||||
| 271 | QualType ReplaceAutoType(QualType TypeWithAuto, QualType Replacement) { | ||||||||||
| 272 | QualType T = sema.ReplaceAutoType(TypeWithAuto, Replacement); | ||||||||||
| 273 | if (auto *AttrTy = TypeWithAuto->getAs<AttributedType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 274 | // Attributed type still should be an attributed type after replacement. | ||||||||||
| 275 | auto *NewAttrTy = cast<AttributedType>(T.getTypePtr()); | ||||||||||
| 276 | for (TypeAttrPair &A : AttrsForTypes) { | ||||||||||
| 277 | if (A.first == AttrTy) | ||||||||||
| 278 | A.first = NewAttrTy; | ||||||||||
| 279 | } | ||||||||||
| 280 | AttrsForTypesSorted = false; | ||||||||||
| 281 | } | ||||||||||
| 282 | return T; | ||||||||||
| 283 | } | ||||||||||
| 284 | |||||||||||
| 285 | /// Extract and remove the Attr* for a given attributed type. | ||||||||||
| 286 | const Attr *takeAttrForAttributedType(const AttributedType *AT) { | ||||||||||
| 287 | if (!AttrsForTypesSorted) { | ||||||||||
| 288 | llvm::stable_sort(AttrsForTypes, llvm::less_first()); | ||||||||||
| 289 | AttrsForTypesSorted = true; | ||||||||||
| 290 | } | ||||||||||
| 291 | |||||||||||
| 292 | // FIXME: This is quadratic if we have lots of reuses of the same | ||||||||||
| 293 | // attributed type. | ||||||||||
| 294 | for (auto It = std::partition_point( | ||||||||||
| 295 | AttrsForTypes.begin(), AttrsForTypes.end(), | ||||||||||
| 296 | [=](const TypeAttrPair &A) { return A.first < AT; }); | ||||||||||
| 297 | It != AttrsForTypes.end() && It->first == AT; ++It) { | ||||||||||
| 298 | if (It->second) { | ||||||||||
| 299 | const Attr *Result = It->second; | ||||||||||
| 300 | It->second = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 301 | return Result; | ||||||||||
| 302 | } | ||||||||||
| 303 | } | ||||||||||
| 304 | |||||||||||
| 305 | llvm_unreachable("no Attr* for AttributedType*")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 306 | } | ||||||||||
| 307 | |||||||||||
| 308 | SourceLocation | ||||||||||
| 309 | getExpansionLocForMacroQualifiedType(const MacroQualifiedType *MQT) const { | ||||||||||
| 310 | auto FoundLoc = LocsForMacros.find(MQT); | ||||||||||
| 311 | assert(FoundLoc != LocsForMacros.end() &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 312 | "Unable to find macro expansion location for MacroQualifedType")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 313 | return FoundLoc->second; | ||||||||||
| 314 | } | ||||||||||
| 315 | |||||||||||
| 316 | void setExpansionLocForMacroQualifiedType(const MacroQualifiedType *MQT, | ||||||||||
| 317 | SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 318 | LocsForMacros[MQT] = Loc; | ||||||||||
| 319 | } | ||||||||||
| 320 | |||||||||||
| 321 | void setParsedNoDeref(bool parsed) { parsedNoDeref = parsed; } | ||||||||||
| 322 | |||||||||||
| 323 | bool didParseNoDeref() const { return parsedNoDeref; } | ||||||||||
| 324 | |||||||||||
| 325 | ~TypeProcessingState() { | ||||||||||
| 326 | if (trivial) return; | ||||||||||
| 327 | |||||||||||
| 328 | restoreDeclSpecAttrs(); | ||||||||||
| 329 | } | ||||||||||
| 330 | |||||||||||
| 331 | private: | ||||||||||
| 332 | DeclSpec &getMutableDeclSpec() const { | ||||||||||
| 333 | return const_cast<DeclSpec&>(declarator.getDeclSpec()); | ||||||||||
| 334 | } | ||||||||||
| 335 | |||||||||||
| 336 | void restoreDeclSpecAttrs() { | ||||||||||
| 337 | assert(hasSavedAttrs)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 338 | |||||||||||
| 339 | getMutableDeclSpec().getAttributes().clearListOnly(); | ||||||||||
| 340 | for (ParsedAttr *AL : savedAttrs) | ||||||||||
| 341 | getMutableDeclSpec().getAttributes().addAtEnd(AL); | ||||||||||
| 342 | } | ||||||||||
| 343 | }; | ||||||||||
| 344 | } // end anonymous namespace | ||||||||||
| 345 | |||||||||||
| 346 | static void moveAttrFromListToList(ParsedAttr &attr, | ||||||||||
| 347 | ParsedAttributesView &fromList, | ||||||||||
| 348 | ParsedAttributesView &toList) { | ||||||||||
| 349 | fromList.remove(&attr); | ||||||||||
| 350 | toList.addAtEnd(&attr); | ||||||||||
| 351 | } | ||||||||||
| 352 | |||||||||||
| 353 | /// The location of a type attribute. | ||||||||||
| 354 | enum TypeAttrLocation { | ||||||||||
| 355 | /// The attribute is in the decl-specifier-seq. | ||||||||||
| 356 | TAL_DeclSpec, | ||||||||||
| 357 | /// The attribute is part of a DeclaratorChunk. | ||||||||||
| 358 | TAL_DeclChunk, | ||||||||||
| 359 | /// The attribute is immediately after the declaration's name. | ||||||||||
| 360 | TAL_DeclName | ||||||||||
| 361 | }; | ||||||||||
| 362 | |||||||||||
| 363 | static void processTypeAttrs(TypeProcessingState &state, QualType &type, | ||||||||||
| 364 | TypeAttrLocation TAL, ParsedAttributesView &attrs); | ||||||||||
| 365 | |||||||||||
| 366 | static bool handleFunctionTypeAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, ParsedAttr &attr, | ||||||||||
| 367 | QualType &type); | ||||||||||
| 368 | |||||||||||
| 369 | static bool handleMSPointerTypeQualifierAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 370 | ParsedAttr &attr, QualType &type); | ||||||||||
| 371 | |||||||||||
| 372 | static bool handleObjCGCTypeAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, ParsedAttr &attr, | ||||||||||
| 373 | QualType &type); | ||||||||||
| 374 | |||||||||||
| 375 | static bool handleObjCOwnershipTypeAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 376 | ParsedAttr &attr, QualType &type); | ||||||||||
| 377 | |||||||||||
| 378 | static bool handleObjCPointerTypeAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 379 | ParsedAttr &attr, QualType &type) { | ||||||||||
| 380 | if (attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCGC) | ||||||||||
| 381 | return handleObjCGCTypeAttr(state, attr, type); | ||||||||||
| 382 | assert(attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 383 | return handleObjCOwnershipTypeAttr(state, attr, type); | ||||||||||
| 384 | } | ||||||||||
| 385 | |||||||||||
| 386 | /// Given the index of a declarator chunk, check whether that chunk | ||||||||||
| 387 | /// directly specifies the return type of a function and, if so, find | ||||||||||
| 388 | /// an appropriate place for it. | ||||||||||
| 389 | /// | ||||||||||
| 390 | /// \param i - a notional index which the search will start | ||||||||||
| 391 | /// immediately inside | ||||||||||
| 392 | /// | ||||||||||
| 393 | /// \param onlyBlockPointers Whether we should only look into block | ||||||||||
| 394 | /// pointer types (vs. all pointer types). | ||||||||||
| 395 | static DeclaratorChunk *maybeMovePastReturnType(Declarator &declarator, | ||||||||||
| 396 | unsigned i, | ||||||||||
| 397 | bool onlyBlockPointers) { | ||||||||||
| 398 | assert(i <= declarator.getNumTypeObjects())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 399 | |||||||||||
| 400 | DeclaratorChunk *result = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 401 | |||||||||||
| 402 | // First, look inwards past parens for a function declarator. | ||||||||||
| 403 | for (; i != 0; --i) { | ||||||||||
| 404 | DeclaratorChunk &fnChunk = declarator.getTypeObject(i-1); | ||||||||||
| 405 | switch (fnChunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 406 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 407 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 408 | |||||||||||
| 409 | // If we find anything except a function, bail out. | ||||||||||
| 410 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 411 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 412 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 413 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 414 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 415 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 416 | return result; | ||||||||||
| 417 | |||||||||||
| 418 | // If we do find a function declarator, scan inwards from that, | ||||||||||
| 419 | // looking for a (block-)pointer declarator. | ||||||||||
| 420 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 421 | for (--i; i != 0; --i) { | ||||||||||
| 422 | DeclaratorChunk &ptrChunk = declarator.getTypeObject(i-1); | ||||||||||
| 423 | switch (ptrChunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 424 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 425 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 426 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 427 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 428 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 429 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 430 | |||||||||||
| 431 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 432 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 433 | if (onlyBlockPointers) | ||||||||||
| 434 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 435 | |||||||||||
| 436 | LLVM_FALLTHROUGH[[gnu::fallthrough]]; | ||||||||||
| 437 | |||||||||||
| 438 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 439 | result = &ptrChunk; | ||||||||||
| 440 | goto continue_outer; | ||||||||||
| 441 | } | ||||||||||
| 442 | llvm_unreachable("bad declarator chunk kind")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 443 | } | ||||||||||
| 444 | |||||||||||
| 445 | // If we run out of declarators doing that, we're done. | ||||||||||
| 446 | return result; | ||||||||||
| 447 | } | ||||||||||
| 448 | llvm_unreachable("bad declarator chunk kind")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 449 | |||||||||||
| 450 | // Okay, reconsider from our new point. | ||||||||||
| 451 | continue_outer: ; | ||||||||||
| 452 | } | ||||||||||
| 453 | |||||||||||
| 454 | // Ran out of chunks, bail out. | ||||||||||
| 455 | return result; | ||||||||||
| 456 | } | ||||||||||
| 457 | |||||||||||
| 458 | /// Given that an objc_gc attribute was written somewhere on a | ||||||||||
| 459 | /// declaration *other* than on the declarator itself (for which, use | ||||||||||
| 460 | /// distributeObjCPointerTypeAttrFromDeclarator), and given that it | ||||||||||
| 461 | /// didn't apply in whatever position it was written in, try to move | ||||||||||
| 462 | /// it to a more appropriate position. | ||||||||||
| 463 | static void distributeObjCPointerTypeAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 464 | ParsedAttr &attr, QualType type) { | ||||||||||
| 465 | Declarator &declarator = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 466 | |||||||||||
| 467 | // Move it to the outermost normal or block pointer declarator. | ||||||||||
| 468 | for (unsigned i = state.getCurrentChunkIndex(); i != 0; --i) { | ||||||||||
| 469 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = declarator.getTypeObject(i-1); | ||||||||||
| 470 | switch (chunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 471 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 472 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: { | ||||||||||
| 473 | // But don't move an ARC ownership attribute to the return type | ||||||||||
| 474 | // of a block. | ||||||||||
| 475 | DeclaratorChunk *destChunk = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 476 | if (state.isProcessingDeclSpec() && | ||||||||||
| 477 | attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership) | ||||||||||
| 478 | destChunk = maybeMovePastReturnType(declarator, i - 1, | ||||||||||
| 479 | /*onlyBlockPointers=*/true); | ||||||||||
| 480 | if (!destChunk) destChunk = &chunk; | ||||||||||
| 481 | |||||||||||
| 482 | moveAttrFromListToList(attr, state.getCurrentAttributes(), | ||||||||||
| 483 | destChunk->getAttrs()); | ||||||||||
| 484 | return; | ||||||||||
| 485 | } | ||||||||||
| 486 | |||||||||||
| 487 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 488 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 489 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 490 | |||||||||||
| 491 | // We may be starting at the return type of a block. | ||||||||||
| 492 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 493 | if (state.isProcessingDeclSpec() && | ||||||||||
| 494 | attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership) { | ||||||||||
| 495 | if (DeclaratorChunk *dest = maybeMovePastReturnType( | ||||||||||
| 496 | declarator, i, | ||||||||||
| 497 | /*onlyBlockPointers=*/true)) { | ||||||||||
| 498 | moveAttrFromListToList(attr, state.getCurrentAttributes(), | ||||||||||
| 499 | dest->getAttrs()); | ||||||||||
| 500 | return; | ||||||||||
| 501 | } | ||||||||||
| 502 | } | ||||||||||
| 503 | goto error; | ||||||||||
| 504 | |||||||||||
| 505 | // Don't walk through these. | ||||||||||
| 506 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 507 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 508 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 509 | goto error; | ||||||||||
| 510 | } | ||||||||||
| 511 | } | ||||||||||
| 512 | error: | ||||||||||
| 513 | |||||||||||
| 514 | diagnoseBadTypeAttribute(state.getSema(), attr, type); | ||||||||||
| 515 | } | ||||||||||
| 516 | |||||||||||
| 517 | /// Distribute an objc_gc type attribute that was written on the | ||||||||||
| 518 | /// declarator. | ||||||||||
| 519 | static void distributeObjCPointerTypeAttrFromDeclarator( | ||||||||||
| 520 | TypeProcessingState &state, ParsedAttr &attr, QualType &declSpecType) { | ||||||||||
| 521 | Declarator &declarator = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 522 | |||||||||||
| 523 | // objc_gc goes on the innermost pointer to something that's not a | ||||||||||
| 524 | // pointer. | ||||||||||
| 525 | unsigned innermost = -1U; | ||||||||||
| 526 | bool considerDeclSpec = true; | ||||||||||
| 527 | for (unsigned i = 0, e = declarator.getNumTypeObjects(); i != e; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 528 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = declarator.getTypeObject(i); | ||||||||||
| 529 | switch (chunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 530 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 531 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 532 | innermost = i; | ||||||||||
| 533 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 534 | |||||||||||
| 535 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 536 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 537 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 538 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 539 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 540 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 541 | |||||||||||
| 542 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 543 | considerDeclSpec = false; | ||||||||||
| 544 | goto done; | ||||||||||
| 545 | } | ||||||||||
| 546 | } | ||||||||||
| 547 | done: | ||||||||||
| 548 | |||||||||||
| 549 | // That might actually be the decl spec if we weren't blocked by | ||||||||||
| 550 | // anything in the declarator. | ||||||||||
| 551 | if (considerDeclSpec) { | ||||||||||
| 552 | if (handleObjCPointerTypeAttr(state, attr, declSpecType)) { | ||||||||||
| 553 | // Splice the attribute into the decl spec. Prevents the | ||||||||||
| 554 | // attribute from being applied multiple times and gives | ||||||||||
| 555 | // the source-location-filler something to work with. | ||||||||||
| 556 | state.saveDeclSpecAttrs(); | ||||||||||
| 557 | declarator.getMutableDeclSpec().getAttributes().takeOneFrom( | ||||||||||
| 558 | declarator.getAttributes(), &attr); | ||||||||||
| 559 | return; | ||||||||||
| 560 | } | ||||||||||
| 561 | } | ||||||||||
| 562 | |||||||||||
| 563 | // Otherwise, if we found an appropriate chunk, splice the attribute | ||||||||||
| 564 | // into it. | ||||||||||
| 565 | if (innermost != -1U) { | ||||||||||
| 566 | moveAttrFromListToList(attr, declarator.getAttributes(), | ||||||||||
| 567 | declarator.getTypeObject(innermost).getAttrs()); | ||||||||||
| 568 | return; | ||||||||||
| 569 | } | ||||||||||
| 570 | |||||||||||
| 571 | // Otherwise, diagnose when we're done building the type. | ||||||||||
| 572 | declarator.getAttributes().remove(&attr); | ||||||||||
| 573 | state.addIgnoredTypeAttr(attr); | ||||||||||
| 574 | } | ||||||||||
| 575 | |||||||||||
| 576 | /// A function type attribute was written somewhere in a declaration | ||||||||||
| 577 | /// *other* than on the declarator itself or in the decl spec. Given | ||||||||||
| 578 | /// that it didn't apply in whatever position it was written in, try | ||||||||||
| 579 | /// to move it to a more appropriate position. | ||||||||||
| 580 | static void distributeFunctionTypeAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 581 | ParsedAttr &attr, QualType type) { | ||||||||||
| 582 | Declarator &declarator = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 583 | |||||||||||
| 584 | // Try to push the attribute from the return type of a function to | ||||||||||
| 585 | // the function itself. | ||||||||||
| 586 | for (unsigned i = state.getCurrentChunkIndex(); i != 0; --i) { | ||||||||||
| 587 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = declarator.getTypeObject(i-1); | ||||||||||
| 588 | switch (chunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 589 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 590 | moveAttrFromListToList(attr, state.getCurrentAttributes(), | ||||||||||
| 591 | chunk.getAttrs()); | ||||||||||
| 592 | return; | ||||||||||
| 593 | |||||||||||
| 594 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 595 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 596 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 597 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 598 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 599 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 600 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 601 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 602 | } | ||||||||||
| 603 | } | ||||||||||
| 604 | |||||||||||
| 605 | diagnoseBadTypeAttribute(state.getSema(), attr, type); | ||||||||||
| 606 | } | ||||||||||
| 607 | |||||||||||
| 608 | /// Try to distribute a function type attribute to the innermost | ||||||||||
| 609 | /// function chunk or type. Returns true if the attribute was | ||||||||||
| 610 | /// distributed, false if no location was found. | ||||||||||
| 611 | static bool distributeFunctionTypeAttrToInnermost( | ||||||||||
| 612 | TypeProcessingState &state, ParsedAttr &attr, | ||||||||||
| 613 | ParsedAttributesView &attrList, QualType &declSpecType) { | ||||||||||
| 614 | Declarator &declarator = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 615 | |||||||||||
| 616 | // Put it on the innermost function chunk, if there is one. | ||||||||||
| 617 | for (unsigned i = 0, e = declarator.getNumTypeObjects(); i != e; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 618 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = declarator.getTypeObject(i); | ||||||||||
| 619 | if (chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) continue; | ||||||||||
| 620 | |||||||||||
| 621 | moveAttrFromListToList(attr, attrList, chunk.getAttrs()); | ||||||||||
| 622 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 623 | } | ||||||||||
| 624 | |||||||||||
| 625 | return handleFunctionTypeAttr(state, attr, declSpecType); | ||||||||||
| 626 | } | ||||||||||
| 627 | |||||||||||
| 628 | /// A function type attribute was written in the decl spec. Try to | ||||||||||
| 629 | /// apply it somewhere. | ||||||||||
| 630 | static void distributeFunctionTypeAttrFromDeclSpec(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 631 | ParsedAttr &attr, | ||||||||||
| 632 | QualType &declSpecType) { | ||||||||||
| 633 | state.saveDeclSpecAttrs(); | ||||||||||
| 634 | |||||||||||
| 635 | // C++11 attributes before the decl specifiers actually appertain to | ||||||||||
| 636 | // the declarators. Move them straight there. We don't support the | ||||||||||
| 637 | // 'put them wherever you like' semantics we allow for GNU attributes. | ||||||||||
| 638 | if (attr.isStandardAttributeSyntax()) { | ||||||||||
| 639 | moveAttrFromListToList(attr, state.getCurrentAttributes(), | ||||||||||
| 640 | state.getDeclarator().getAttributes()); | ||||||||||
| 641 | return; | ||||||||||
| 642 | } | ||||||||||
| 643 | |||||||||||
| 644 | // Try to distribute to the innermost. | ||||||||||
| 645 | if (distributeFunctionTypeAttrToInnermost( | ||||||||||
| 646 | state, attr, state.getCurrentAttributes(), declSpecType)) | ||||||||||
| 647 | return; | ||||||||||
| 648 | |||||||||||
| 649 | // If that failed, diagnose the bad attribute when the declarator is | ||||||||||
| 650 | // fully built. | ||||||||||
| 651 | state.addIgnoredTypeAttr(attr); | ||||||||||
| 652 | } | ||||||||||
| 653 | |||||||||||
| 654 | /// A function type attribute was written on the declarator. Try to | ||||||||||
| 655 | /// apply it somewhere. | ||||||||||
| 656 | static void distributeFunctionTypeAttrFromDeclarator(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 657 | ParsedAttr &attr, | ||||||||||
| 658 | QualType &declSpecType) { | ||||||||||
| 659 | Declarator &declarator = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 660 | |||||||||||
| 661 | // Try to distribute to the innermost. | ||||||||||
| 662 | if (distributeFunctionTypeAttrToInnermost( | ||||||||||
| 663 | state, attr, declarator.getAttributes(), declSpecType)) | ||||||||||
| 664 | return; | ||||||||||
| 665 | |||||||||||
| 666 | // If that failed, diagnose the bad attribute when the declarator is | ||||||||||
| 667 | // fully built. | ||||||||||
| 668 | declarator.getAttributes().remove(&attr); | ||||||||||
| 669 | state.addIgnoredTypeAttr(attr); | ||||||||||
| 670 | } | ||||||||||
| 671 | |||||||||||
| 672 | /// Given that there are attributes written on the declarator | ||||||||||
| 673 | /// itself, try to distribute any type attributes to the appropriate | ||||||||||
| 674 | /// declarator chunk. | ||||||||||
| 675 | /// | ||||||||||
| 676 | /// These are attributes like the following: | ||||||||||
| 677 | /// int f ATTR; | ||||||||||
| 678 | /// int (f ATTR)(); | ||||||||||
| 679 | /// but not necessarily this: | ||||||||||
| 680 | /// int f() ATTR; | ||||||||||
| 681 | static void distributeTypeAttrsFromDeclarator(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 682 | QualType &declSpecType) { | ||||||||||
| 683 | // Collect all the type attributes from the declarator itself. | ||||||||||
| 684 | assert(!state.getDeclarator().getAttributes().empty() &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 685 | "declarator has no attrs!")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 686 | // The called functions in this loop actually remove things from the current | ||||||||||
| 687 | // list, so iterating over the existing list isn't possible. Instead, make a | ||||||||||
| 688 | // non-owning copy and iterate over that. | ||||||||||
| 689 | ParsedAttributesView AttrsCopy{state.getDeclarator().getAttributes()}; | ||||||||||
| 690 | for (ParsedAttr &attr : AttrsCopy) { | ||||||||||
| 691 | // Do not distribute [[]] attributes. They have strict rules for what | ||||||||||
| 692 | // they appertain to. | ||||||||||
| 693 | if (attr.isStandardAttributeSyntax()) | ||||||||||
| 694 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 695 | |||||||||||
| 696 | switch (attr.getKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 697 | OBJC_POINTER_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCGC: case ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership: | ||||||||||
| 698 | distributeObjCPointerTypeAttrFromDeclarator(state, attr, declSpecType); | ||||||||||
| 699 | break; | ||||||||||
| 700 | |||||||||||
| 701 | FUNCTION_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_NSReturnsRetained: case ParsedAttr::AT_NoReturn : case ParsedAttr::AT_Regparm: case ParsedAttr::AT_CmseNSCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegisters: case ParsedAttr ::AT_AnyX86NoCfCheck: case ParsedAttr::AT_CDecl: case ParsedAttr ::AT_FastCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_StdCall: case ParsedAttr:: AT_ThisCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_RegCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pascal : case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftAsyncCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_VectorCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_AArch64VectorPcs : case ParsedAttr::AT_MSABI: case ParsedAttr::AT_SysVABI: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pcs: case ParsedAttr::AT_IntelOclBicc: case ParsedAttr ::AT_PreserveMost: case ParsedAttr::AT_PreserveAll: | ||||||||||
| 702 | distributeFunctionTypeAttrFromDeclarator(state, attr, declSpecType); | ||||||||||
| 703 | break; | ||||||||||
| 704 | |||||||||||
| 705 | MS_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_Ptr32: case ParsedAttr::AT_Ptr64: case ParsedAttr ::AT_SPtr: case ParsedAttr::AT_UPtr: | ||||||||||
| 706 | // Microsoft type attributes cannot go after the declarator-id. | ||||||||||
| 707 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 708 | |||||||||||
| 709 | NULLABILITY_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNonNull: case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullable : case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullableResult: case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullUnspecified: | ||||||||||
| 710 | // Nullability specifiers cannot go after the declarator-id. | ||||||||||
| 711 | |||||||||||
| 712 | // Objective-C __kindof does not get distributed. | ||||||||||
| 713 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCKindOf: | ||||||||||
| 714 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 715 | |||||||||||
| 716 | default: | ||||||||||
| 717 | break; | ||||||||||
| 718 | } | ||||||||||
| 719 | } | ||||||||||
| 720 | } | ||||||||||
| 721 | |||||||||||
| 722 | /// Add a synthetic '()' to a block-literal declarator if it is | ||||||||||
| 723 | /// required, given the return type. | ||||||||||
| 724 | static void maybeSynthesizeBlockSignature(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 725 | QualType declSpecType) { | ||||||||||
| 726 | Declarator &declarator = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 727 | |||||||||||
| 728 | // First, check whether the declarator would produce a function, | ||||||||||
| 729 | // i.e. whether the innermost semantic chunk is a function. | ||||||||||
| 730 | if (declarator.isFunctionDeclarator()) { | ||||||||||
| 731 | // If so, make that declarator a prototyped declarator. | ||||||||||
| 732 | declarator.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype = true; | ||||||||||
| 733 | return; | ||||||||||
| 734 | } | ||||||||||
| 735 | |||||||||||
| 736 | // If there are any type objects, the type as written won't name a | ||||||||||
| 737 | // function, regardless of the decl spec type. This is because a | ||||||||||
| 738 | // block signature declarator is always an abstract-declarator, and | ||||||||||
| 739 | // abstract-declarators can't just be parentheses chunks. Therefore | ||||||||||
| 740 | // we need to build a function chunk unless there are no type | ||||||||||
| 741 | // objects and the decl spec type is a function. | ||||||||||
| 742 | if (!declarator.getNumTypeObjects() && declSpecType->isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 743 | return; | ||||||||||
| 744 | |||||||||||
| 745 | // Note that there *are* cases with invalid declarators where | ||||||||||
| 746 | // declarators consist solely of parentheses. In general, these | ||||||||||
| 747 | // occur only in failed efforts to make function declarators, so | ||||||||||
| 748 | // faking up the function chunk is still the right thing to do. | ||||||||||
| 749 | |||||||||||
| 750 | // Otherwise, we need to fake up a function declarator. | ||||||||||
| 751 | SourceLocation loc = declarator.getBeginLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 752 | |||||||||||
| 753 | // ...and *prepend* it to the declarator. | ||||||||||
| 754 | SourceLocation NoLoc; | ||||||||||
| 755 | declarator.AddInnermostTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction( | ||||||||||
| 756 | /*HasProto=*/true, | ||||||||||
| 757 | /*IsAmbiguous=*/false, | ||||||||||
| 758 | /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc, | ||||||||||
| 759 | /*ArgInfo=*/nullptr, | ||||||||||
| 760 | /*NumParams=*/0, | ||||||||||
| 761 | /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc, | ||||||||||
| 762 | /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc, | ||||||||||
| 763 | /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true, | ||||||||||
| 764 | /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, | ||||||||||
| 765 | /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, EST_None, | ||||||||||
| 766 | /*ESpecRange=*/SourceRange(), | ||||||||||
| 767 | /*Exceptions=*/nullptr, | ||||||||||
| 768 | /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr, | ||||||||||
| 769 | /*NumExceptions=*/0, | ||||||||||
| 770 | /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr, | ||||||||||
| 771 | /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr, | ||||||||||
| 772 | /*DeclsInPrototype=*/None, loc, loc, declarator)); | ||||||||||
| 773 | |||||||||||
| 774 | // For consistency, make sure the state still has us as processing | ||||||||||
| 775 | // the decl spec. | ||||||||||
| 776 | assert(state.getCurrentChunkIndex() == declarator.getNumTypeObjects() - 1)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 777 | state.setCurrentChunkIndex(declarator.getNumTypeObjects()); | ||||||||||
| 778 | } | ||||||||||
| 779 | |||||||||||
| 780 | static void diagnoseAndRemoveTypeQualifiers(Sema &S, const DeclSpec &DS, | ||||||||||
| 781 | unsigned &TypeQuals, | ||||||||||
| 782 | QualType TypeSoFar, | ||||||||||
| 783 | unsigned RemoveTQs, | ||||||||||
| 784 | unsigned DiagID) { | ||||||||||
| 785 | // If this occurs outside a template instantiation, warn the user about | ||||||||||
| 786 | // it; they probably didn't mean to specify a redundant qualifier. | ||||||||||
| 787 | typedef std::pair<DeclSpec::TQ, SourceLocation> QualLoc; | ||||||||||
| 788 | for (QualLoc Qual : {QualLoc(DeclSpec::TQ_const, DS.getConstSpecLoc()), | ||||||||||
| 789 | QualLoc(DeclSpec::TQ_restrict, DS.getRestrictSpecLoc()), | ||||||||||
| 790 | QualLoc(DeclSpec::TQ_volatile, DS.getVolatileSpecLoc()), | ||||||||||
| 791 | QualLoc(DeclSpec::TQ_atomic, DS.getAtomicSpecLoc())}) { | ||||||||||
| 792 | if (!(RemoveTQs & Qual.first)) | ||||||||||
| 793 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 794 | |||||||||||
| 795 | if (!S.inTemplateInstantiation()) { | ||||||||||
| 796 | if (TypeQuals & Qual.first) | ||||||||||
| 797 | S.Diag(Qual.second, DiagID) | ||||||||||
| 798 | << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(Qual.first) << TypeSoFar | ||||||||||
| 799 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(Qual.second); | ||||||||||
| 800 | } | ||||||||||
| 801 | |||||||||||
| 802 | TypeQuals &= ~Qual.first; | ||||||||||
| 803 | } | ||||||||||
| 804 | } | ||||||||||
| 805 | |||||||||||
| 806 | /// Return true if this is omitted block return type. Also check type | ||||||||||
| 807 | /// attributes and type qualifiers when returning true. | ||||||||||
| 808 | static bool checkOmittedBlockReturnType(Sema &S, Declarator &declarator, | ||||||||||
| 809 | QualType Result) { | ||||||||||
| 810 | if (!isOmittedBlockReturnType(declarator)) | ||||||||||
| 811 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 812 | |||||||||||
| 813 | // Warn if we see type attributes for omitted return type on a block literal. | ||||||||||
| 814 | SmallVector<ParsedAttr *, 2> ToBeRemoved; | ||||||||||
| 815 | for (ParsedAttr &AL : declarator.getMutableDeclSpec().getAttributes()) { | ||||||||||
| 816 | if (AL.isInvalid() || !AL.isTypeAttr()) | ||||||||||
| 817 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 818 | S.Diag(AL.getLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 819 | diag::warn_block_literal_attributes_on_omitted_return_type) | ||||||||||
| 820 | << AL; | ||||||||||
| 821 | ToBeRemoved.push_back(&AL); | ||||||||||
| 822 | } | ||||||||||
| 823 | // Remove bad attributes from the list. | ||||||||||
| 824 | for (ParsedAttr *AL : ToBeRemoved) | ||||||||||
| 825 | declarator.getMutableDeclSpec().getAttributes().remove(AL); | ||||||||||
| 826 | |||||||||||
| 827 | // Warn if we see type qualifiers for omitted return type on a block literal. | ||||||||||
| 828 | const DeclSpec &DS = declarator.getDeclSpec(); | ||||||||||
| 829 | unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers(); | ||||||||||
| 830 | diagnoseAndRemoveTypeQualifiers(S, DS, TypeQuals, Result, (unsigned)-1, | ||||||||||
| 831 | diag::warn_block_literal_qualifiers_on_omitted_return_type); | ||||||||||
| 832 | declarator.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearTypeQualifiers(); | ||||||||||
| 833 | |||||||||||
| 834 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 835 | } | ||||||||||
| 836 | |||||||||||
| 837 | /// Apply Objective-C type arguments to the given type. | ||||||||||
| 838 | static QualType applyObjCTypeArgs(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, QualType type, | ||||||||||
| 839 | ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> typeArgs, | ||||||||||
| 840 | SourceRange typeArgsRange, | ||||||||||
| 841 | bool failOnError = false) { | ||||||||||
| 842 | // We can only apply type arguments to an Objective-C class type. | ||||||||||
| 843 | const auto *objcObjectType = type->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); | ||||||||||
| 844 | if (!objcObjectType || !objcObjectType->getInterface()) { | ||||||||||
| 845 | S.Diag(loc, diag::err_objc_type_args_non_class) | ||||||||||
| 846 | << type | ||||||||||
| 847 | << typeArgsRange; | ||||||||||
| 848 | |||||||||||
| 849 | if (failOnError) | ||||||||||
| 850 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 851 | return type; | ||||||||||
| 852 | } | ||||||||||
| 853 | |||||||||||
| 854 | // The class type must be parameterized. | ||||||||||
| 855 | ObjCInterfaceDecl *objcClass = objcObjectType->getInterface(); | ||||||||||
| 856 | ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = objcClass->getTypeParamList(); | ||||||||||
| 857 | if (!typeParams) { | ||||||||||
| 858 | S.Diag(loc, diag::err_objc_type_args_non_parameterized_class) | ||||||||||
| 859 | << objcClass->getDeclName() | ||||||||||
| 860 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(typeArgsRange); | ||||||||||
| 861 | |||||||||||
| 862 | if (failOnError) | ||||||||||
| 863 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 864 | |||||||||||
| 865 | return type; | ||||||||||
| 866 | } | ||||||||||
| 867 | |||||||||||
| 868 | // The type must not already be specialized. | ||||||||||
| 869 | if (objcObjectType->isSpecialized()) { | ||||||||||
| 870 | S.Diag(loc, diag::err_objc_type_args_specialized_class) | ||||||||||
| 871 | << type | ||||||||||
| 872 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(typeArgsRange); | ||||||||||
| 873 | |||||||||||
| 874 | if (failOnError) | ||||||||||
| 875 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 876 | |||||||||||
| 877 | return type; | ||||||||||
| 878 | } | ||||||||||
| 879 | |||||||||||
| 880 | // Check the type arguments. | ||||||||||
| 881 | SmallVector<QualType, 4> finalTypeArgs; | ||||||||||
| 882 | unsigned numTypeParams = typeParams->size(); | ||||||||||
| 883 | bool anyPackExpansions = false; | ||||||||||
| 884 | for (unsigned i = 0, n = typeArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 885 | TypeSourceInfo *typeArgInfo = typeArgs[i]; | ||||||||||
| 886 | QualType typeArg = typeArgInfo->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 887 | |||||||||||
| 888 | // Type arguments cannot have explicit qualifiers or nullability. | ||||||||||
| 889 | // We ignore indirect sources of these, e.g. behind typedefs or | ||||||||||
| 890 | // template arguments. | ||||||||||
| 891 | if (TypeLoc qual = typeArgInfo->getTypeLoc().findExplicitQualifierLoc()) { | ||||||||||
| 892 | bool diagnosed = false; | ||||||||||
| 893 | SourceRange rangeToRemove; | ||||||||||
| 894 | if (auto attr = qual.getAs<AttributedTypeLoc>()) { | ||||||||||
| 895 | rangeToRemove = attr.getLocalSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 896 | if (attr.getTypePtr()->getImmediateNullability()) { | ||||||||||
| 897 | typeArg = attr.getTypePtr()->getModifiedType(); | ||||||||||
| 898 | S.Diag(attr.getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 899 | diag::err_objc_type_arg_explicit_nullability) | ||||||||||
| 900 | << typeArg << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(rangeToRemove); | ||||||||||
| 901 | diagnosed = true; | ||||||||||
| 902 | } | ||||||||||
| 903 | } | ||||||||||
| 904 | |||||||||||
| 905 | if (!diagnosed) { | ||||||||||
| 906 | S.Diag(qual.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_objc_type_arg_qualified) | ||||||||||
| 907 | << typeArg << typeArg.getQualifiers().getAsString() | ||||||||||
| 908 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(rangeToRemove); | ||||||||||
| 909 | } | ||||||||||
| 910 | } | ||||||||||
| 911 | |||||||||||
| 912 | // Remove qualifiers even if they're non-local. | ||||||||||
| 913 | typeArg = typeArg.getUnqualifiedType(); | ||||||||||
| 914 | |||||||||||
| 915 | finalTypeArgs.push_back(typeArg); | ||||||||||
| 916 | |||||||||||
| 917 | if (typeArg->getAs<PackExpansionType>()) | ||||||||||
| 918 | anyPackExpansions = true; | ||||||||||
| 919 | |||||||||||
| 920 | // Find the corresponding type parameter, if there is one. | ||||||||||
| 921 | ObjCTypeParamDecl *typeParam = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 922 | if (!anyPackExpansions) { | ||||||||||
| 923 | if (i < numTypeParams) { | ||||||||||
| 924 | typeParam = typeParams->begin()[i]; | ||||||||||
| 925 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 926 | // Too many arguments. | ||||||||||
| 927 | S.Diag(loc, diag::err_objc_type_args_wrong_arity) | ||||||||||
| 928 | << false | ||||||||||
| 929 | << objcClass->getDeclName() | ||||||||||
| 930 | << (unsigned)typeArgs.size() | ||||||||||
| 931 | << numTypeParams; | ||||||||||
| 932 | S.Diag(objcClass->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) | ||||||||||
| 933 | << objcClass; | ||||||||||
| 934 | |||||||||||
| 935 | if (failOnError) | ||||||||||
| 936 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 937 | |||||||||||
| 938 | return type; | ||||||||||
| 939 | } | ||||||||||
| 940 | } | ||||||||||
| 941 | |||||||||||
| 942 | // Objective-C object pointer types must be substitutable for the bounds. | ||||||||||
| 943 | if (const auto *typeArgObjC = typeArg->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 944 | // If we don't have a type parameter to match against, assume | ||||||||||
| 945 | // everything is fine. There was a prior pack expansion that | ||||||||||
| 946 | // means we won't be able to match anything. | ||||||||||
| 947 | if (!typeParam) { | ||||||||||
| 948 | assert(anyPackExpansions && "Too many arguments?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 949 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 950 | } | ||||||||||
| 951 | |||||||||||
| 952 | // Retrieve the bound. | ||||||||||
| 953 | QualType bound = typeParam->getUnderlyingType(); | ||||||||||
| 954 | const auto *boundObjC = bound->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); | ||||||||||
| 955 | |||||||||||
| 956 | // Determine whether the type argument is substitutable for the bound. | ||||||||||
| 957 | if (typeArgObjC->isObjCIdType()) { | ||||||||||
| 958 | // When the type argument is 'id', the only acceptable type | ||||||||||
| 959 | // parameter bound is 'id'. | ||||||||||
| 960 | if (boundObjC->isObjCIdType()) | ||||||||||
| 961 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 962 | } else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(boundObjC, typeArgObjC)) { | ||||||||||
| 963 | // Otherwise, we follow the assignability rules. | ||||||||||
| 964 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 965 | } | ||||||||||
| 966 | |||||||||||
| 967 | // Diagnose the mismatch. | ||||||||||
| 968 | S.Diag(typeArgInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 969 | diag::err_objc_type_arg_does_not_match_bound) | ||||||||||
| 970 | << typeArg << bound << typeParam->getDeclName(); | ||||||||||
| 971 | S.Diag(typeParam->getLocation(), diag::note_objc_type_param_here) | ||||||||||
| 972 | << typeParam->getDeclName(); | ||||||||||
| 973 | |||||||||||
| 974 | if (failOnError) | ||||||||||
| 975 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 976 | |||||||||||
| 977 | return type; | ||||||||||
| 978 | } | ||||||||||
| 979 | |||||||||||
| 980 | // Block pointer types are permitted for unqualified 'id' bounds. | ||||||||||
| 981 | if (typeArg->isBlockPointerType()) { | ||||||||||
| 982 | // If we don't have a type parameter to match against, assume | ||||||||||
| 983 | // everything is fine. There was a prior pack expansion that | ||||||||||
| 984 | // means we won't be able to match anything. | ||||||||||
| 985 | if (!typeParam) { | ||||||||||
| 986 | assert(anyPackExpansions && "Too many arguments?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 987 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 988 | } | ||||||||||
| 989 | |||||||||||
| 990 | // Retrieve the bound. | ||||||||||
| 991 | QualType bound = typeParam->getUnderlyingType(); | ||||||||||
| 992 | if (bound->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(S.Context)) | ||||||||||
| 993 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 994 | |||||||||||
| 995 | // Diagnose the mismatch. | ||||||||||
| 996 | S.Diag(typeArgInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 997 | diag::err_objc_type_arg_does_not_match_bound) | ||||||||||
| 998 | << typeArg << bound << typeParam->getDeclName(); | ||||||||||
| 999 | S.Diag(typeParam->getLocation(), diag::note_objc_type_param_here) | ||||||||||
| 1000 | << typeParam->getDeclName(); | ||||||||||
| 1001 | |||||||||||
| 1002 | if (failOnError) | ||||||||||
| 1003 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 1004 | |||||||||||
| 1005 | return type; | ||||||||||
| 1006 | } | ||||||||||
| 1007 | |||||||||||
| 1008 | // Dependent types will be checked at instantiation time. | ||||||||||
| 1009 | if (typeArg->isDependentType()) { | ||||||||||
| 1010 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 1011 | } | ||||||||||
| 1012 | |||||||||||
| 1013 | // Diagnose non-id-compatible type arguments. | ||||||||||
| 1014 | S.Diag(typeArgInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 1015 | diag::err_objc_type_arg_not_id_compatible) | ||||||||||
| 1016 | << typeArg << typeArgInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 1017 | |||||||||||
| 1018 | if (failOnError) | ||||||||||
| 1019 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 1020 | |||||||||||
| 1021 | return type; | ||||||||||
| 1022 | } | ||||||||||
| 1023 | |||||||||||
| 1024 | // Make sure we didn't have the wrong number of arguments. | ||||||||||
| 1025 | if (!anyPackExpansions && finalTypeArgs.size() != numTypeParams) { | ||||||||||
| 1026 | S.Diag(loc, diag::err_objc_type_args_wrong_arity) | ||||||||||
| 1027 | << (typeArgs.size() < typeParams->size()) | ||||||||||
| 1028 | << objcClass->getDeclName() | ||||||||||
| 1029 | << (unsigned)finalTypeArgs.size() | ||||||||||
| 1030 | << (unsigned)numTypeParams; | ||||||||||
| 1031 | S.Diag(objcClass->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) | ||||||||||
| 1032 | << objcClass; | ||||||||||
| 1033 | |||||||||||
| 1034 | if (failOnError) | ||||||||||
| 1035 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 1036 | |||||||||||
| 1037 | return type; | ||||||||||
| 1038 | } | ||||||||||
| 1039 | |||||||||||
| 1040 | // Success. Form the specialized type. | ||||||||||
| 1041 | return S.Context.getObjCObjectType(type, finalTypeArgs, { }, false); | ||||||||||
| 1042 | } | ||||||||||
| 1043 | |||||||||||
| 1044 | QualType Sema::BuildObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Decl, | ||||||||||
| 1045 | SourceLocation ProtocolLAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1046 | ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols, | ||||||||||
| 1047 | ArrayRef<SourceLocation> ProtocolLocs, | ||||||||||
| 1048 | SourceLocation ProtocolRAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1049 | bool FailOnError) { | ||||||||||
| 1050 | QualType Result = QualType(Decl->getTypeForDecl(), 0); | ||||||||||
| 1051 | if (!Protocols.empty()) { | ||||||||||
| 1052 | bool HasError; | ||||||||||
| 1053 | Result = Context.applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(Result, Protocols, | ||||||||||
| 1054 | HasError); | ||||||||||
| 1055 | if (HasError) { | ||||||||||
| 1056 | Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::err_invalid_protocol_qualifiers) | ||||||||||
| 1057 | << SourceRange(ProtocolLAngleLoc, ProtocolRAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1058 | if (FailOnError) Result = QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 1059 | } | ||||||||||
| 1060 | if (FailOnError && Result.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 1061 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 1062 | } | ||||||||||
| 1063 | |||||||||||
| 1064 | return Result; | ||||||||||
| 1065 | } | ||||||||||
| 1066 | |||||||||||
| 1067 | QualType Sema::BuildObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType, | ||||||||||
| 1068 | SourceLocation Loc, | ||||||||||
| 1069 | SourceLocation TypeArgsLAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1070 | ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> TypeArgs, | ||||||||||
| 1071 | SourceLocation TypeArgsRAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1072 | SourceLocation ProtocolLAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1073 | ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols, | ||||||||||
| 1074 | ArrayRef<SourceLocation> ProtocolLocs, | ||||||||||
| 1075 | SourceLocation ProtocolRAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1076 | bool FailOnError) { | ||||||||||
| 1077 | QualType Result = BaseType; | ||||||||||
| 1078 | if (!TypeArgs.empty()) { | ||||||||||
| 1079 | Result = applyObjCTypeArgs(*this, Loc, Result, TypeArgs, | ||||||||||
| 1080 | SourceRange(TypeArgsLAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1081 | TypeArgsRAngleLoc), | ||||||||||
| 1082 | FailOnError); | ||||||||||
| 1083 | if (FailOnError && Result.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 1084 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 1085 | } | ||||||||||
| 1086 | |||||||||||
| 1087 | if (!Protocols.empty()) { | ||||||||||
| 1088 | bool HasError; | ||||||||||
| 1089 | Result = Context.applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(Result, Protocols, | ||||||||||
| 1090 | HasError); | ||||||||||
| 1091 | if (HasError) { | ||||||||||
| 1092 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_protocol_qualifiers) | ||||||||||
| 1093 | << SourceRange(ProtocolLAngleLoc, ProtocolRAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1094 | if (FailOnError) Result = QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 1095 | } | ||||||||||
| 1096 | if (FailOnError && Result.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 1097 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 1098 | } | ||||||||||
| 1099 | |||||||||||
| 1100 | return Result; | ||||||||||
| 1101 | } | ||||||||||
| 1102 | |||||||||||
| 1103 | TypeResult Sema::actOnObjCProtocolQualifierType( | ||||||||||
| 1104 | SourceLocation lAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1105 | ArrayRef<Decl *> protocols, | ||||||||||
| 1106 | ArrayRef<SourceLocation> protocolLocs, | ||||||||||
| 1107 | SourceLocation rAngleLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 1108 | // Form id<protocol-list>. | ||||||||||
| 1109 | QualType Result = Context.getObjCObjectType( | ||||||||||
| 1110 | Context.ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, | ||||||||||
| 1111 | llvm::makeArrayRef( | ||||||||||
| 1112 | (ObjCProtocolDecl * const *)protocols.data(), | ||||||||||
| 1113 | protocols.size()), | ||||||||||
| 1114 | false); | ||||||||||
| 1115 | Result = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(Result); | ||||||||||
| 1116 | |||||||||||
| 1117 | TypeSourceInfo *ResultTInfo = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result); | ||||||||||
| 1118 | TypeLoc ResultTL = ResultTInfo->getTypeLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 1119 | |||||||||||
| 1120 | auto ObjCObjectPointerTL = ResultTL.castAs<ObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc>(); | ||||||||||
| 1121 | ObjCObjectPointerTL.setStarLoc(SourceLocation()); // implicit | ||||||||||
| 1122 | |||||||||||
| 1123 | auto ObjCObjectTL = ObjCObjectPointerTL.getPointeeLoc() | ||||||||||
| 1124 | .castAs<ObjCObjectTypeLoc>(); | ||||||||||
| 1125 | ObjCObjectTL.setHasBaseTypeAsWritten(false); | ||||||||||
| 1126 | ObjCObjectTL.getBaseLoc().initialize(Context, SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 1127 | |||||||||||
| 1128 | // No type arguments. | ||||||||||
| 1129 | ObjCObjectTL.setTypeArgsLAngleLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 1130 | ObjCObjectTL.setTypeArgsRAngleLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 1131 | |||||||||||
| 1132 | // Fill in protocol qualifiers. | ||||||||||
| 1133 | ObjCObjectTL.setProtocolLAngleLoc(lAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1134 | ObjCObjectTL.setProtocolRAngleLoc(rAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1135 | for (unsigned i = 0, n = protocols.size(); i != n; ++i) | ||||||||||
| 1136 | ObjCObjectTL.setProtocolLoc(i, protocolLocs[i]); | ||||||||||
| 1137 | |||||||||||
| 1138 | // We're done. Return the completed type to the parser. | ||||||||||
| 1139 | return CreateParsedType(Result, ResultTInfo); | ||||||||||
| 1140 | } | ||||||||||
| 1141 | |||||||||||
| 1142 | TypeResult Sema::actOnObjCTypeArgsAndProtocolQualifiers( | ||||||||||
| 1143 | Scope *S, | ||||||||||
| 1144 | SourceLocation Loc, | ||||||||||
| 1145 | ParsedType BaseType, | ||||||||||
| 1146 | SourceLocation TypeArgsLAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1147 | ArrayRef<ParsedType> TypeArgs, | ||||||||||
| 1148 | SourceLocation TypeArgsRAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1149 | SourceLocation ProtocolLAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1150 | ArrayRef<Decl *> Protocols, | ||||||||||
| 1151 | ArrayRef<SourceLocation> ProtocolLocs, | ||||||||||
| 1152 | SourceLocation ProtocolRAngleLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 1153 | TypeSourceInfo *BaseTypeInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 1154 | QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(BaseType, &BaseTypeInfo); | ||||||||||
| 1155 | if (T.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 1156 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 1157 | |||||||||||
| 1158 | // Handle missing type-source info. | ||||||||||
| 1159 | if (!BaseTypeInfo) | ||||||||||
| 1160 | BaseTypeInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc); | ||||||||||
| 1161 | |||||||||||
| 1162 | // Extract type arguments. | ||||||||||
| 1163 | SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 4> ActualTypeArgInfos; | ||||||||||
| 1164 | for (unsigned i = 0, n = TypeArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 1165 | TypeSourceInfo *TypeArgInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 1166 | QualType TypeArg = GetTypeFromParser(TypeArgs[i], &TypeArgInfo); | ||||||||||
| 1167 | if (TypeArg.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 1168 | ActualTypeArgInfos.clear(); | ||||||||||
| 1169 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1170 | } | ||||||||||
| 1171 | |||||||||||
| 1172 | assert(TypeArgInfo && "No type source info?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1173 | ActualTypeArgInfos.push_back(TypeArgInfo); | ||||||||||
| 1174 | } | ||||||||||
| 1175 | |||||||||||
| 1176 | // Build the object type. | ||||||||||
| 1177 | QualType Result = BuildObjCObjectType( | ||||||||||
| 1178 | T, BaseTypeInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange().getBegin(), | ||||||||||
| 1179 | TypeArgsLAngleLoc, ActualTypeArgInfos, TypeArgsRAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1180 | ProtocolLAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1181 | llvm::makeArrayRef((ObjCProtocolDecl * const *)Protocols.data(), | ||||||||||
| 1182 | Protocols.size()), | ||||||||||
| 1183 | ProtocolLocs, ProtocolRAngleLoc, | ||||||||||
| 1184 | /*FailOnError=*/false); | ||||||||||
| 1185 | |||||||||||
| 1186 | if (Result == T) | ||||||||||
| 1187 | return BaseType; | ||||||||||
| 1188 | |||||||||||
| 1189 | // Create source information for this type. | ||||||||||
| 1190 | TypeSourceInfo *ResultTInfo = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result); | ||||||||||
| 1191 | TypeLoc ResultTL = ResultTInfo->getTypeLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 1192 | |||||||||||
| 1193 | // For id<Proto1, Proto2> or Class<Proto1, Proto2>, we'll have an | ||||||||||
| 1194 | // object pointer type. Fill in source information for it. | ||||||||||
| 1195 | if (auto ObjCObjectPointerTL = ResultTL.getAs<ObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc>()) { | ||||||||||
| 1196 | // The '*' is implicit. | ||||||||||
| 1197 | ObjCObjectPointerTL.setStarLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 1198 | ResultTL = ObjCObjectPointerTL.getPointeeLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 1199 | } | ||||||||||
| 1200 | |||||||||||
| 1201 | if (auto OTPTL = ResultTL.getAs<ObjCTypeParamTypeLoc>()) { | ||||||||||
| 1202 | // Protocol qualifier information. | ||||||||||
| 1203 | if (OTPTL.getNumProtocols() > 0) { | ||||||||||
| 1204 | assert(OTPTL.getNumProtocols() == Protocols.size())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1205 | OTPTL.setProtocolLAngleLoc(ProtocolLAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1206 | OTPTL.setProtocolRAngleLoc(ProtocolRAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1207 | for (unsigned i = 0, n = Protocols.size(); i != n; ++i) | ||||||||||
| 1208 | OTPTL.setProtocolLoc(i, ProtocolLocs[i]); | ||||||||||
| 1209 | } | ||||||||||
| 1210 | |||||||||||
| 1211 | // We're done. Return the completed type to the parser. | ||||||||||
| 1212 | return CreateParsedType(Result, ResultTInfo); | ||||||||||
| 1213 | } | ||||||||||
| 1214 | |||||||||||
| 1215 | auto ObjCObjectTL = ResultTL.castAs<ObjCObjectTypeLoc>(); | ||||||||||
| 1216 | |||||||||||
| 1217 | // Type argument information. | ||||||||||
| 1218 | if (ObjCObjectTL.getNumTypeArgs() > 0) { | ||||||||||
| 1219 | assert(ObjCObjectTL.getNumTypeArgs() == ActualTypeArgInfos.size())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1220 | ObjCObjectTL.setTypeArgsLAngleLoc(TypeArgsLAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1221 | ObjCObjectTL.setTypeArgsRAngleLoc(TypeArgsRAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1222 | for (unsigned i = 0, n = ActualTypeArgInfos.size(); i != n; ++i) | ||||||||||
| 1223 | ObjCObjectTL.setTypeArgTInfo(i, ActualTypeArgInfos[i]); | ||||||||||
| 1224 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 1225 | ObjCObjectTL.setTypeArgsLAngleLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 1226 | ObjCObjectTL.setTypeArgsRAngleLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 1227 | } | ||||||||||
| 1228 | |||||||||||
| 1229 | // Protocol qualifier information. | ||||||||||
| 1230 | if (ObjCObjectTL.getNumProtocols() > 0) { | ||||||||||
| 1231 | assert(ObjCObjectTL.getNumProtocols() == Protocols.size())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1232 | ObjCObjectTL.setProtocolLAngleLoc(ProtocolLAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1233 | ObjCObjectTL.setProtocolRAngleLoc(ProtocolRAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1234 | for (unsigned i = 0, n = Protocols.size(); i != n; ++i) | ||||||||||
| 1235 | ObjCObjectTL.setProtocolLoc(i, ProtocolLocs[i]); | ||||||||||
| 1236 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 1237 | ObjCObjectTL.setProtocolLAngleLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 1238 | ObjCObjectTL.setProtocolRAngleLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 1239 | } | ||||||||||
| 1240 | |||||||||||
| 1241 | // Base type. | ||||||||||
| 1242 | ObjCObjectTL.setHasBaseTypeAsWritten(true); | ||||||||||
| 1243 | if (ObjCObjectTL.getType() == T) | ||||||||||
| 1244 | ObjCObjectTL.getBaseLoc().initializeFullCopy(BaseTypeInfo->getTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 1245 | else | ||||||||||
| 1246 | ObjCObjectTL.getBaseLoc().initialize(Context, Loc); | ||||||||||
| 1247 | |||||||||||
| 1248 | // We're done. Return the completed type to the parser. | ||||||||||
| 1249 | return CreateParsedType(Result, ResultTInfo); | ||||||||||
| 1250 | } | ||||||||||
| 1251 | |||||||||||
| 1252 | static OpenCLAccessAttr::Spelling | ||||||||||
| 1253 | getImageAccess(const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { | ||||||||||
| 1254 | for (const ParsedAttr &AL : Attrs) | ||||||||||
| 1255 | if (AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLAccess) | ||||||||||
| 1256 | return static_cast<OpenCLAccessAttr::Spelling>(AL.getSemanticSpelling()); | ||||||||||
| 1257 | return OpenCLAccessAttr::Keyword_read_only; | ||||||||||
| 1258 | } | ||||||||||
| 1259 | |||||||||||
| 1260 | /// Convert the specified declspec to the appropriate type | ||||||||||
| 1261 | /// object. | ||||||||||
| 1262 | /// \param state Specifies the declarator containing the declaration specifier | ||||||||||
| 1263 | /// to be converted, along with other associated processing state. | ||||||||||
| 1264 | /// \returns The type described by the declaration specifiers. This function | ||||||||||
| 1265 | /// never returns null. | ||||||||||
| 1266 | static QualType ConvertDeclSpecToType(TypeProcessingState &state) { | ||||||||||
| 1267 | // FIXME: Should move the logic from DeclSpec::Finish to here for validity | ||||||||||
| 1268 | // checking. | ||||||||||
| 1269 | |||||||||||
| 1270 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 1271 | Declarator &declarator = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 1272 | DeclSpec &DS = declarator.getMutableDeclSpec(); | ||||||||||
| 1273 | SourceLocation DeclLoc = declarator.getIdentifierLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 1274 | if (DeclLoc.isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 1275 | DeclLoc = DS.getBeginLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 1276 | |||||||||||
| 1277 | ASTContext &Context = S.Context; | ||||||||||
| 1278 | |||||||||||
| 1279 | QualType Result; | ||||||||||
| 1280 | switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) { | ||||||||||
| 1281 | case DeclSpec::TST_void: | ||||||||||
| 1282 | Result = Context.VoidTy; | ||||||||||
| 1283 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1284 | case DeclSpec::TST_char: | ||||||||||
| 1285 | if (DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unspecified) | ||||||||||
| 1286 | Result = Context.CharTy; | ||||||||||
| 1287 | else if (DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Signed) | ||||||||||
| 1288 | Result = Context.SignedCharTy; | ||||||||||
| 1289 | else { | ||||||||||
| 1290 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unsigned &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1291 | "Unknown TSS value")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1292 | Result = Context.UnsignedCharTy; | ||||||||||
| 1293 | } | ||||||||||
| 1294 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1295 | case DeclSpec::TST_wchar: | ||||||||||
| 1296 | if (DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unspecified) | ||||||||||
| 1297 | Result = Context.WCharTy; | ||||||||||
| 1298 | else if (DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Signed) { | ||||||||||
| 1299 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecSignLoc(), diag::ext_wchar_t_sign_spec) | ||||||||||
| 1300 | << DS.getSpecifierName(DS.getTypeSpecType(), | ||||||||||
| 1301 | Context.getPrintingPolicy()); | ||||||||||
| 1302 | Result = Context.getSignedWCharType(); | ||||||||||
| 1303 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 1304 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unsigned &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1305 | "Unknown TSS value")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1306 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecSignLoc(), diag::ext_wchar_t_sign_spec) | ||||||||||
| 1307 | << DS.getSpecifierName(DS.getTypeSpecType(), | ||||||||||
| 1308 | Context.getPrintingPolicy()); | ||||||||||
| 1309 | Result = Context.getUnsignedWCharType(); | ||||||||||
| 1310 | } | ||||||||||
| 1311 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1312 | case DeclSpec::TST_char8: | ||||||||||
| 1313 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unspecified &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1314 | "Unknown TSS value")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1315 | Result = Context.Char8Ty; | ||||||||||
| 1316 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1317 | case DeclSpec::TST_char16: | ||||||||||
| 1318 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unspecified &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1319 | "Unknown TSS value")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1320 | Result = Context.Char16Ty; | ||||||||||
| 1321 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1322 | case DeclSpec::TST_char32: | ||||||||||
| 1323 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unspecified &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1324 | "Unknown TSS value")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1325 | Result = Context.Char32Ty; | ||||||||||
| 1326 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1327 | case DeclSpec::TST_unspecified: | ||||||||||
| 1328 | // If this is a missing declspec in a block literal return context, then it | ||||||||||
| 1329 | // is inferred from the return statements inside the block. | ||||||||||
| 1330 | // The declspec is always missing in a lambda expr context; it is either | ||||||||||
| 1331 | // specified with a trailing return type or inferred. | ||||||||||
| 1332 | if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && | ||||||||||
| 1333 | declarator.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr) { | ||||||||||
| 1334 | // In C++1y, a lambda's implicit return type is 'auto'. | ||||||||||
| 1335 | Result = Context.getAutoDeductType(); | ||||||||||
| 1336 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1337 | } else if (declarator.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr || | ||||||||||
| 1338 | checkOmittedBlockReturnType(S, declarator, | ||||||||||
| 1339 | Context.DependentTy)) { | ||||||||||
| 1340 | Result = Context.DependentTy; | ||||||||||
| 1341 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1342 | } | ||||||||||
| 1343 | |||||||||||
| 1344 | // Unspecified typespec defaults to int in C90. However, the C90 grammar | ||||||||||
| 1345 | // [C90 6.5] only allows a decl-spec if there was *some* type-specifier, | ||||||||||
| 1346 | // type-qualifier, or storage-class-specifier. If not, emit an extwarn. | ||||||||||
| 1347 | // Note that the one exception to this is function definitions, which are | ||||||||||
| 1348 | // allowed to be completely missing a declspec. This is handled in the | ||||||||||
| 1349 | // parser already though by it pretending to have seen an 'int' in this | ||||||||||
| 1350 | // case. | ||||||||||
| 1351 | if (S.getLangOpts().ImplicitInt) { | ||||||||||
| 1352 | // In C89 mode, we only warn if there is a completely missing declspec | ||||||||||
| 1353 | // when one is not allowed. | ||||||||||
| 1354 | if (DS.isEmpty()) { | ||||||||||
| 1355 | S.Diag(DeclLoc, diag::ext_missing_declspec) | ||||||||||
| 1356 | << DS.getSourceRange() | ||||||||||
| 1357 | << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DS.getBeginLoc(), "int"); | ||||||||||
| 1358 | } | ||||||||||
| 1359 | } else if (!DS.hasTypeSpecifier()) { | ||||||||||
| 1360 | // C99 and C++ require a type specifier. For example, C99 6.7.2p2 says: | ||||||||||
| 1361 | // "At least one type specifier shall be given in the declaration | ||||||||||
| 1362 | // specifiers in each declaration, and in the specifier-qualifier list in | ||||||||||
| 1363 | // each struct declaration and type name." | ||||||||||
| 1364 | if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !DS.isTypeSpecPipe()) { | ||||||||||
| 1365 | S.Diag(DeclLoc, diag::err_missing_type_specifier) | ||||||||||
| 1366 | << DS.getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 1367 | |||||||||||
| 1368 | // When this occurs in C++ code, often something is very broken with the | ||||||||||
| 1369 | // value being declared, poison it as invalid so we don't get chains of | ||||||||||
| 1370 | // errors. | ||||||||||
| 1371 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1372 | } else if ((S.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 200 || | ||||||||||
| 1373 | S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) && | ||||||||||
| 1374 | DS.isTypeSpecPipe()) { | ||||||||||
| 1375 | S.Diag(DeclLoc, diag::err_missing_actual_pipe_type) | ||||||||||
| 1376 | << DS.getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 1377 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1378 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 1379 | S.Diag(DeclLoc, diag::ext_missing_type_specifier) | ||||||||||
| 1380 | << DS.getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 1381 | } | ||||||||||
| 1382 | } | ||||||||||
| 1383 | |||||||||||
| 1384 | LLVM_FALLTHROUGH[[gnu::fallthrough]]; | ||||||||||
| 1385 | case DeclSpec::TST_int: { | ||||||||||
| 1386 | if (DS.getTypeSpecSign() != TypeSpecifierSign::Unsigned) { | ||||||||||
| 1387 | switch (DS.getTypeSpecWidth()) { | ||||||||||
| 1388 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Unspecified: | ||||||||||
| 1389 | Result = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 1390 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1391 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Short: | ||||||||||
| 1392 | Result = Context.ShortTy; | ||||||||||
| 1393 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1394 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Long: | ||||||||||
| 1395 | Result = Context.LongTy; | ||||||||||
| 1396 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1397 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::LongLong: | ||||||||||
| 1398 | Result = Context.LongLongTy; | ||||||||||
| 1399 | |||||||||||
| 1400 | // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature. | ||||||||||
| 1401 | if (!S.getLangOpts().C99) { | ||||||||||
| 1402 | if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) | ||||||||||
| 1403 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecWidthLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 1404 | S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? | ||||||||||
| 1405 | diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong); | ||||||||||
| 1406 | else | ||||||||||
| 1407 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecWidthLoc(), diag::ext_c99_longlong); | ||||||||||
| 1408 | } | ||||||||||
| 1409 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1410 | } | ||||||||||
| 1411 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 1412 | switch (DS.getTypeSpecWidth()) { | ||||||||||
| 1413 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Unspecified: | ||||||||||
| 1414 | Result = Context.UnsignedIntTy; | ||||||||||
| 1415 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1416 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Short: | ||||||||||
| 1417 | Result = Context.UnsignedShortTy; | ||||||||||
| 1418 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1419 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Long: | ||||||||||
| 1420 | Result = Context.UnsignedLongTy; | ||||||||||
| 1421 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1422 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::LongLong: | ||||||||||
| 1423 | Result = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; | ||||||||||
| 1424 | |||||||||||
| 1425 | // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature. | ||||||||||
| 1426 | if (!S.getLangOpts().C99) { | ||||||||||
| 1427 | if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) | ||||||||||
| 1428 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecWidthLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 1429 | S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? | ||||||||||
| 1430 | diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong); | ||||||||||
| 1431 | else | ||||||||||
| 1432 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecWidthLoc(), diag::ext_c99_longlong); | ||||||||||
| 1433 | } | ||||||||||
| 1434 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1435 | } | ||||||||||
| 1436 | } | ||||||||||
| 1437 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1438 | } | ||||||||||
| 1439 | case DeclSpec::TST_extint: { | ||||||||||
| 1440 | if (!S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasExtIntType()) | ||||||||||
| 1441 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), diag::err_type_unsupported) | ||||||||||
| 1442 | << "_ExtInt"; | ||||||||||
| 1443 | Result = | ||||||||||
| 1444 | S.BuildExtIntType(DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unsigned, | ||||||||||
| 1445 | DS.getRepAsExpr(), DS.getBeginLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 1446 | if (Result.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 1447 | Result = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 1448 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1449 | } | ||||||||||
| 1450 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1451 | } | ||||||||||
| 1452 | case DeclSpec::TST_accum: { | ||||||||||
| 1453 | switch (DS.getTypeSpecWidth()) { | ||||||||||
| 1454 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Short: | ||||||||||
| 1455 | Result = Context.ShortAccumTy; | ||||||||||
| 1456 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1457 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Unspecified: | ||||||||||
| 1458 | Result = Context.AccumTy; | ||||||||||
| 1459 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1460 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Long: | ||||||||||
| 1461 | Result = Context.LongAccumTy; | ||||||||||
| 1462 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1463 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::LongLong: | ||||||||||
| 1464 | llvm_unreachable("Unable to specify long long as _Accum width")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 1465 | } | ||||||||||
| 1466 | |||||||||||
| 1467 | if (DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unsigned) | ||||||||||
| 1468 | Result = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(Result); | ||||||||||
| 1469 | |||||||||||
| 1470 | if (DS.isTypeSpecSat()) | ||||||||||
| 1471 | Result = Context.getCorrespondingSaturatedType(Result); | ||||||||||
| 1472 | |||||||||||
| 1473 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1474 | } | ||||||||||
| 1475 | case DeclSpec::TST_fract: { | ||||||||||
| 1476 | switch (DS.getTypeSpecWidth()) { | ||||||||||
| 1477 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Short: | ||||||||||
| 1478 | Result = Context.ShortFractTy; | ||||||||||
| 1479 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1480 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Unspecified: | ||||||||||
| 1481 | Result = Context.FractTy; | ||||||||||
| 1482 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1483 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::Long: | ||||||||||
| 1484 | Result = Context.LongFractTy; | ||||||||||
| 1485 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1486 | case TypeSpecifierWidth::LongLong: | ||||||||||
| 1487 | llvm_unreachable("Unable to specify long long as _Fract width")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 1488 | } | ||||||||||
| 1489 | |||||||||||
| 1490 | if (DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unsigned) | ||||||||||
| 1491 | Result = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(Result); | ||||||||||
| 1492 | |||||||||||
| 1493 | if (DS.isTypeSpecSat()) | ||||||||||
| 1494 | Result = Context.getCorrespondingSaturatedType(Result); | ||||||||||
| 1495 | |||||||||||
| 1496 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1497 | } | ||||||||||
| 1498 | case DeclSpec::TST_int128: | ||||||||||
| 1499 | if (!S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() && | ||||||||||
| 1500 | !S.getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice && | ||||||||||
| 1501 | !(S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && S.getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice)) | ||||||||||
| 1502 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), diag::err_type_unsupported) | ||||||||||
| 1503 | << "__int128"; | ||||||||||
| 1504 | if (DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unsigned) | ||||||||||
| 1505 | Result = Context.UnsignedInt128Ty; | ||||||||||
| 1506 | else | ||||||||||
| 1507 | Result = Context.Int128Ty; | ||||||||||
| 1508 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1509 | case DeclSpec::TST_float16: | ||||||||||
| 1510 | // CUDA host and device may have different _Float16 support, therefore | ||||||||||
| 1511 | // do not diagnose _Float16 usage to avoid false alarm. | ||||||||||
| 1512 | // ToDo: more precise diagnostics for CUDA. | ||||||||||
| 1513 | if (!S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat16Type() && !S.getLangOpts().CUDA && | ||||||||||
| 1514 | !(S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && S.getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice)) | ||||||||||
| 1515 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), diag::err_type_unsupported) | ||||||||||
| 1516 | << "_Float16"; | ||||||||||
| 1517 | Result = Context.Float16Ty; | ||||||||||
| 1518 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1519 | case DeclSpec::TST_half: Result = Context.HalfTy; break; | ||||||||||
| 1520 | case DeclSpec::TST_BFloat16: | ||||||||||
| 1521 | if (!S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasBFloat16Type()) | ||||||||||
| 1522 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), diag::err_type_unsupported) | ||||||||||
| 1523 | << "__bf16"; | ||||||||||
| 1524 | Result = Context.BFloat16Ty; | ||||||||||
| 1525 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1526 | case DeclSpec::TST_float: Result = Context.FloatTy; break; | ||||||||||
| 1527 | case DeclSpec::TST_double: | ||||||||||
| 1528 | if (DS.getTypeSpecWidth() == TypeSpecifierWidth::Long) | ||||||||||
| 1529 | Result = Context.LongDoubleTy; | ||||||||||
| 1530 | else | ||||||||||
| 1531 | Result = Context.DoubleTy; | ||||||||||
| 1532 | if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 1533 | if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isSupported("cl_khr_fp64", S.getLangOpts())) | ||||||||||
| 1534 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), diag::err_opencl_requires_extension) | ||||||||||
| 1535 | << 0 << Result | ||||||||||
| 1536 | << (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 300 | ||||||||||
| 1537 | ? "cl_khr_fp64 and __opencl_c_fp64" | ||||||||||
| 1538 | : "cl_khr_fp64"); | ||||||||||
| 1539 | else if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp64", S.getLangOpts())) | ||||||||||
| 1540 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), diag::ext_opencl_double_without_pragma); | ||||||||||
| 1541 | } | ||||||||||
| 1542 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1543 | case DeclSpec::TST_float128: | ||||||||||
| 1544 | if (!S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type() && | ||||||||||
| 1545 | !S.getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice && | ||||||||||
| 1546 | !(S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && S.getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice)) | ||||||||||
| 1547 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), diag::err_type_unsupported) | ||||||||||
| 1548 | << "__float128"; | ||||||||||
| 1549 | Result = Context.Float128Ty; | ||||||||||
| 1550 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1551 | case DeclSpec::TST_bool: | ||||||||||
| 1552 | Result = Context.BoolTy; // _Bool or bool | ||||||||||
| 1553 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1554 | case DeclSpec::TST_decimal32: // _Decimal32 | ||||||||||
| 1555 | case DeclSpec::TST_decimal64: // _Decimal64 | ||||||||||
| 1556 | case DeclSpec::TST_decimal128: // _Decimal128 | ||||||||||
| 1557 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), diag::err_decimal_unsupported); | ||||||||||
| 1558 | Result = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 1559 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1560 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1561 | case DeclSpec::TST_class: | ||||||||||
| 1562 | case DeclSpec::TST_enum: | ||||||||||
| 1563 | case DeclSpec::TST_union: | ||||||||||
| 1564 | case DeclSpec::TST_struct: | ||||||||||
| 1565 | case DeclSpec::TST_interface: { | ||||||||||
| 1566 | TagDecl *D = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl()); | ||||||||||
| 1567 | if (!D) { | ||||||||||
| 1568 | // This can happen in C++ with ambiguous lookups. | ||||||||||
| 1569 | Result = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 1570 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1571 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1572 | } | ||||||||||
| 1573 | |||||||||||
| 1574 | // If the type is deprecated or unavailable, diagnose it. | ||||||||||
| 1575 | S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(D, DS.getTypeSpecTypeNameLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 1576 | |||||||||||
| 1577 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecWidth() == TypeSpecifierWidth::Unspecified &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1578 | DS.getTypeSpecComplex() == 0 &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1579 | DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unspecified &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1580 | "No qualifiers on tag names!")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1581 | |||||||||||
| 1582 | // TypeQuals handled by caller. | ||||||||||
| 1583 | Result = Context.getTypeDeclType(D); | ||||||||||
| 1584 | |||||||||||
| 1585 | // In both C and C++, make an ElaboratedType. | ||||||||||
| 1586 | ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword | ||||||||||
| 1587 | = ElaboratedType::getKeywordForTypeSpec(DS.getTypeSpecType()); | ||||||||||
| 1588 | Result = S.getElaboratedType(Keyword, DS.getTypeSpecScope(), Result, | ||||||||||
| 1589 | DS.isTypeSpecOwned() ? D : nullptr); | ||||||||||
| 1590 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1591 | } | ||||||||||
| 1592 | case DeclSpec::TST_typename: { | ||||||||||
| 1593 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecWidth() == TypeSpecifierWidth::Unspecified &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1594 | DS.getTypeSpecComplex() == 0 &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1595 | DS.getTypeSpecSign() == TypeSpecifierSign::Unspecified &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 1596 | "Can't handle qualifiers on typedef names yet!")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1597 | Result = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType()); | ||||||||||
| 1598 | if (Result.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 1599 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1600 | } | ||||||||||
| 1601 | |||||||||||
| 1602 | // TypeQuals handled by caller. | ||||||||||
| 1603 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1604 | } | ||||||||||
| 1605 | case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType: | ||||||||||
| 1606 | // FIXME: Preserve type source info. | ||||||||||
| 1607 | Result = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType()); | ||||||||||
| 1608 | assert(!Result.isNull() && "Didn't get a type for typeof?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1609 | if (!Result->isDependentType()) | ||||||||||
| 1610 | if (const TagType *TT = Result->getAs<TagType>()) | ||||||||||
| 1611 | S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(TT->getDecl(), DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 1612 | // TypeQuals handled by caller. | ||||||||||
| 1613 | Result = Context.getTypeOfType(Result); | ||||||||||
| 1614 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1615 | case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: { | ||||||||||
| 1616 | Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr(); | ||||||||||
| 1617 | assert(E && "Didn't get an expression for typeof?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1618 | // TypeQuals handled by caller. | ||||||||||
| 1619 | Result = S.BuildTypeofExprType(E, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 1620 | if (Result.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 1621 | Result = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 1622 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1623 | } | ||||||||||
| 1624 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1625 | } | ||||||||||
| 1626 | case DeclSpec::TST_decltype: { | ||||||||||
| 1627 | Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr(); | ||||||||||
| 1628 | assert(E && "Didn't get an expression for decltype?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1629 | // TypeQuals handled by caller. | ||||||||||
| 1630 | Result = S.BuildDecltypeType(E, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 1631 | if (Result.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 1632 | Result = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 1633 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1634 | } | ||||||||||
| 1635 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1636 | } | ||||||||||
| 1637 | case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType: | ||||||||||
| 1638 | Result = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType()); | ||||||||||
| 1639 | assert(!Result.isNull() && "Didn't get a type for __underlying_type?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1640 | Result = S.BuildUnaryTransformType(Result, | ||||||||||
| 1641 | UnaryTransformType::EnumUnderlyingType, | ||||||||||
| 1642 | DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 1643 | if (Result.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 1644 | Result = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 1645 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1646 | } | ||||||||||
| 1647 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1648 | |||||||||||
| 1649 | case DeclSpec::TST_auto: | ||||||||||
| 1650 | case DeclSpec::TST_decltype_auto: { | ||||||||||
| 1651 | auto AutoKW = DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_decltype_auto | ||||||||||
| 1652 | ? AutoTypeKeyword::DecltypeAuto | ||||||||||
| 1653 | : AutoTypeKeyword::Auto; | ||||||||||
| 1654 | |||||||||||
| 1655 | ConceptDecl *TypeConstraintConcept = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 1656 | llvm::SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 8> TemplateArgs; | ||||||||||
| 1657 | if (DS.isConstrainedAuto()) { | ||||||||||
| 1658 | if (TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = DS.getRepAsTemplateId()) { | ||||||||||
| 1659 | TypeConstraintConcept = | ||||||||||
| 1660 | cast<ConceptDecl>(TemplateId->Template.get().getAsTemplateDecl()); | ||||||||||
| 1661 | TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsInfo; | ||||||||||
| 1662 | TemplateArgsInfo.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1663 | TemplateArgsInfo.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 1664 | ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), | ||||||||||
| 1665 | TemplateId->NumArgs); | ||||||||||
| 1666 | S.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, TemplateArgsInfo); | ||||||||||
| 1667 | for (const auto &ArgLoc : TemplateArgsInfo.arguments()) | ||||||||||
| 1668 | TemplateArgs.push_back(ArgLoc.getArgument()); | ||||||||||
| 1669 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 1670 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1671 | } | ||||||||||
| 1672 | } | ||||||||||
| 1673 | Result = S.Context.getAutoType(QualType(), AutoKW, | ||||||||||
| 1674 | /*IsDependent*/ false, /*IsPack=*/false, | ||||||||||
| 1675 | TypeConstraintConcept, TemplateArgs); | ||||||||||
| 1676 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1677 | } | ||||||||||
| 1678 | |||||||||||
| 1679 | case DeclSpec::TST_auto_type: | ||||||||||
| 1680 | Result = Context.getAutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::GNUAutoType, false); | ||||||||||
| 1681 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1682 | |||||||||||
| 1683 | case DeclSpec::TST_unknown_anytype: | ||||||||||
| 1684 | Result = Context.UnknownAnyTy; | ||||||||||
| 1685 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1686 | |||||||||||
| 1687 | case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: | ||||||||||
| 1688 | Result = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType()); | ||||||||||
| 1689 | assert(!Result.isNull() && "Didn't get a type for _Atomic?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1690 | Result = S.BuildAtomicType(Result, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 1691 | if (Result.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 1692 | Result = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 1693 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1694 | } | ||||||||||
| 1695 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1696 | |||||||||||
| 1697 | #define GENERIC_IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id) \ | ||||||||||
| 1698 | case DeclSpec::TST_##ImgType##_t: \ | ||||||||||
| 1699 | switch (getImageAccess(DS.getAttributes())) { \ | ||||||||||
| 1700 | case OpenCLAccessAttr::Keyword_write_only: \ | ||||||||||
| 1701 | Result = Context.Id##WOTy; \ | ||||||||||
| 1702 | break; \ | ||||||||||
| 1703 | case OpenCLAccessAttr::Keyword_read_write: \ | ||||||||||
| 1704 | Result = Context.Id##RWTy; \ | ||||||||||
| 1705 | break; \ | ||||||||||
| 1706 | case OpenCLAccessAttr::Keyword_read_only: \ | ||||||||||
| 1707 | Result = Context.Id##ROTy; \ | ||||||||||
| 1708 | break; \ | ||||||||||
| 1709 | case OpenCLAccessAttr::SpellingNotCalculated: \ | ||||||||||
| 1710 | llvm_unreachable("Spelling not yet calculated")__builtin_unreachable(); \ | ||||||||||
| 1711 | } \ | ||||||||||
| 1712 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1713 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" | ||||||||||
| 1714 | |||||||||||
| 1715 | case DeclSpec::TST_error: | ||||||||||
| 1716 | Result = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 1717 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1718 | break; | ||||||||||
| 1719 | } | ||||||||||
| 1720 | |||||||||||
| 1721 | // FIXME: we want resulting declarations to be marked invalid, but claiming | ||||||||||
| 1722 | // the type is invalid is too strong - e.g. it causes ActOnTypeName to return | ||||||||||
| 1723 | // a null type. | ||||||||||
| 1724 | if (Result->containsErrors()) | ||||||||||
| 1725 | declarator.setInvalidType(); | ||||||||||
| 1726 | |||||||||||
| 1727 | if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 1728 | const auto &OpenCLOptions = S.getOpenCLOptions(); | ||||||||||
| 1729 | bool IsOpenCLC30 = (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 300); | ||||||||||
| 1730 | // OpenCL C v3.0 s6.3.3 - OpenCL image types require __opencl_c_images | ||||||||||
| 1731 | // support. | ||||||||||
| 1732 | // OpenCL C v3.0 s6.2.1 - OpenCL 3d image write types requires support | ||||||||||
| 1733 | // for OpenCL C 2.0, or OpenCL C 3.0 or newer and the | ||||||||||
| 1734 | // __opencl_c_3d_image_writes feature. OpenCL C v3.0 API s4.2 - For devices | ||||||||||
| 1735 | // that support OpenCL 3.0, cl_khr_3d_image_writes must be returned when and | ||||||||||
| 1736 | // only when the optional feature is supported | ||||||||||
| 1737 | if ((Result->isImageType() || Result->isSamplerT()) && | ||||||||||
| 1738 | (IsOpenCLC30 && | ||||||||||
| 1739 | !OpenCLOptions.isSupported("__opencl_c_images", S.getLangOpts()))) { | ||||||||||
| 1740 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), diag::err_opencl_requires_extension) | ||||||||||
| 1741 | << 0 << Result << "__opencl_c_images"; | ||||||||||
| 1742 | declarator.setInvalidType(); | ||||||||||
| 1743 | } else if (Result->isOCLImage3dWOType() && | ||||||||||
| 1744 | !OpenCLOptions.isSupported("cl_khr_3d_image_writes", | ||||||||||
| 1745 | S.getLangOpts())) { | ||||||||||
| 1746 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), diag::err_opencl_requires_extension) | ||||||||||
| 1747 | << 0 << Result | ||||||||||
| 1748 | << (IsOpenCLC30 | ||||||||||
| 1749 | ? "cl_khr_3d_image_writes and __opencl_c_3d_image_writes" | ||||||||||
| 1750 | : "cl_khr_3d_image_writes"); | ||||||||||
| 1751 | declarator.setInvalidType(); | ||||||||||
| 1752 | } | ||||||||||
| 1753 | } | ||||||||||
| 1754 | |||||||||||
| 1755 | bool IsFixedPointType = DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_accum || | ||||||||||
| 1756 | DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_fract; | ||||||||||
| 1757 | |||||||||||
| 1758 | // Only fixed point types can be saturated | ||||||||||
| 1759 | if (DS.isTypeSpecSat() && !IsFixedPointType) | ||||||||||
| 1760 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecSatLoc(), diag::err_invalid_saturation_spec) | ||||||||||
| 1761 | << DS.getSpecifierName(DS.getTypeSpecType(), | ||||||||||
| 1762 | Context.getPrintingPolicy()); | ||||||||||
| 1763 | |||||||||||
| 1764 | // Handle complex types. | ||||||||||
| 1765 | if (DS.getTypeSpecComplex() == DeclSpec::TSC_complex) { | ||||||||||
| 1766 | if (S.getLangOpts().Freestanding) | ||||||||||
| 1767 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecComplexLoc(), diag::ext_freestanding_complex); | ||||||||||
| 1768 | Result = Context.getComplexType(Result); | ||||||||||
| 1769 | } else if (DS.isTypeAltiVecVector()) { | ||||||||||
| 1770 | unsigned typeSize = static_cast<unsigned>(Context.getTypeSize(Result)); | ||||||||||
| 1771 | assert(typeSize > 0 && "type size for vector must be greater than 0 bits")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1772 | VectorType::VectorKind VecKind = VectorType::AltiVecVector; | ||||||||||
| 1773 | if (DS.isTypeAltiVecPixel()) | ||||||||||
| 1774 | VecKind = VectorType::AltiVecPixel; | ||||||||||
| 1775 | else if (DS.isTypeAltiVecBool()) | ||||||||||
| 1776 | VecKind = VectorType::AltiVecBool; | ||||||||||
| 1777 | Result = Context.getVectorType(Result, 128/typeSize, VecKind); | ||||||||||
| 1778 | } | ||||||||||
| 1779 | |||||||||||
| 1780 | // FIXME: Imaginary. | ||||||||||
| 1781 | if (DS.getTypeSpecComplex() == DeclSpec::TSC_imaginary) | ||||||||||
| 1782 | S.Diag(DS.getTypeSpecComplexLoc(), diag::err_imaginary_not_supported); | ||||||||||
| 1783 | |||||||||||
| 1784 | // Before we process any type attributes, synthesize a block literal | ||||||||||
| 1785 | // function declarator if necessary. | ||||||||||
| 1786 | if (declarator.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteral) | ||||||||||
| 1787 | maybeSynthesizeBlockSignature(state, Result); | ||||||||||
| 1788 | |||||||||||
| 1789 | // Apply any type attributes from the decl spec. This may cause the | ||||||||||
| 1790 | // list of type attributes to be temporarily saved while the type | ||||||||||
| 1791 | // attributes are pushed around. | ||||||||||
| 1792 | // pipe attributes will be handled later ( at GetFullTypeForDeclarator ) | ||||||||||
| 1793 | if (!DS.isTypeSpecPipe()) | ||||||||||
| 1794 | processTypeAttrs(state, Result, TAL_DeclSpec, DS.getAttributes()); | ||||||||||
| 1795 | |||||||||||
| 1796 | // Apply const/volatile/restrict qualifiers to T. | ||||||||||
| 1797 | if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { | ||||||||||
| 1798 | // Warn about CV qualifiers on function types. | ||||||||||
| 1799 | // C99 6.7.3p8: | ||||||||||
| 1800 | // If the specification of a function type includes any type qualifiers, | ||||||||||
| 1801 | // the behavior is undefined. | ||||||||||
| 1802 | // C++11 [dcl.fct]p7: | ||||||||||
| 1803 | // The effect of a cv-qualifier-seq in a function declarator is not the | ||||||||||
| 1804 | // same as adding cv-qualification on top of the function type. In the | ||||||||||
| 1805 | // latter case, the cv-qualifiers are ignored. | ||||||||||
| 1806 | if (Result->isFunctionType()) { | ||||||||||
| 1807 | diagnoseAndRemoveTypeQualifiers( | ||||||||||
| 1808 | S, DS, TypeQuals, Result, DeclSpec::TQ_const | DeclSpec::TQ_volatile, | ||||||||||
| 1809 | S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus | ||||||||||
| 1810 | ? diag::warn_typecheck_function_qualifiers_ignored | ||||||||||
| 1811 | : diag::warn_typecheck_function_qualifiers_unspecified); | ||||||||||
| 1812 | // No diagnostic for 'restrict' or '_Atomic' applied to a | ||||||||||
| 1813 | // function type; we'll diagnose those later, in BuildQualifiedType. | ||||||||||
| 1814 | } | ||||||||||
| 1815 | |||||||||||
| 1816 | // C++11 [dcl.ref]p1: | ||||||||||
| 1817 | // Cv-qualified references are ill-formed except when the | ||||||||||
| 1818 | // cv-qualifiers are introduced through the use of a typedef-name | ||||||||||
| 1819 | // or decltype-specifier, in which case the cv-qualifiers are ignored. | ||||||||||
| 1820 | // | ||||||||||
| 1821 | // There don't appear to be any other contexts in which a cv-qualified | ||||||||||
| 1822 | // reference type could be formed, so the 'ill-formed' clause here appears | ||||||||||
| 1823 | // to never happen. | ||||||||||
| 1824 | if (TypeQuals && Result->isReferenceType()) { | ||||||||||
| 1825 | diagnoseAndRemoveTypeQualifiers( | ||||||||||
| 1826 | S, DS, TypeQuals, Result, | ||||||||||
| 1827 | DeclSpec::TQ_const | DeclSpec::TQ_volatile | DeclSpec::TQ_atomic, | ||||||||||
| 1828 | diag::warn_typecheck_reference_qualifiers); | ||||||||||
| 1829 | } | ||||||||||
| 1830 | |||||||||||
| 1831 | // C90 6.5.3 constraints: "The same type qualifier shall not appear more | ||||||||||
| 1832 | // than once in the same specifier-list or qualifier-list, either directly | ||||||||||
| 1833 | // or via one or more typedefs." | ||||||||||
| 1834 | if (!S.getLangOpts().C99 && !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus | ||||||||||
| 1835 | && TypeQuals & Result.getCVRQualifiers()) { | ||||||||||
| 1836 | if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_const && Result.isConstQualified()) { | ||||||||||
| 1837 | S.Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_duplicate_declspec) | ||||||||||
| 1838 | << "const"; | ||||||||||
| 1839 | } | ||||||||||
| 1840 | |||||||||||
| 1841 | if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile && Result.isVolatileQualified()) { | ||||||||||
| 1842 | S.Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(), diag::ext_duplicate_declspec) | ||||||||||
| 1843 | << "volatile"; | ||||||||||
| 1844 | } | ||||||||||
| 1845 | |||||||||||
| 1846 | // C90 doesn't have restrict nor _Atomic, so it doesn't force us to | ||||||||||
| 1847 | // produce a warning in this case. | ||||||||||
| 1848 | } | ||||||||||
| 1849 | |||||||||||
| 1850 | QualType Qualified = S.BuildQualifiedType(Result, DeclLoc, TypeQuals, &DS); | ||||||||||
| 1851 | |||||||||||
| 1852 | // If adding qualifiers fails, just use the unqualified type. | ||||||||||
| 1853 | if (Qualified.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 1854 | declarator.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 1855 | else | ||||||||||
| 1856 | Result = Qualified; | ||||||||||
| 1857 | } | ||||||||||
| 1858 | |||||||||||
| 1859 | assert(!Result.isNull() && "This function should not return a null type")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 1860 | return Result; | ||||||||||
| 1861 | } | ||||||||||
| 1862 | |||||||||||
| 1863 | static std::string getPrintableNameForEntity(DeclarationName Entity) { | ||||||||||
| 1864 | if (Entity) | ||||||||||
| 1865 | return Entity.getAsString(); | ||||||||||
| 1866 | |||||||||||
| 1867 | return "type name"; | ||||||||||
| 1868 | } | ||||||||||
| 1869 | |||||||||||
| 1870 | QualType Sema::BuildQualifiedType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc, | ||||||||||
| 1871 | Qualifiers Qs, const DeclSpec *DS) { | ||||||||||
| 1872 | if (T.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 1873 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 1874 | |||||||||||
| 1875 | // Ignore any attempt to form a cv-qualified reference. | ||||||||||
| 1876 | if (T->isReferenceType()) { | ||||||||||
| 1877 | Qs.removeConst(); | ||||||||||
| 1878 | Qs.removeVolatile(); | ||||||||||
| 1879 | } | ||||||||||
| 1880 | |||||||||||
| 1881 | // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from | ||||||||||
| 1882 | // object or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified." | ||||||||||
| 1883 | if (Qs.hasRestrict()) { | ||||||||||
| 1884 | unsigned DiagID = 0; | ||||||||||
| 1885 | QualType ProblemTy; | ||||||||||
| 1886 | |||||||||||
| 1887 | if (T->isAnyPointerType() || T->isReferenceType() || | ||||||||||
| 1888 | T->isMemberPointerType()) { | ||||||||||
| 1889 | QualType EltTy; | ||||||||||
| 1890 | if (T->isObjCObjectPointerType()) | ||||||||||
| 1891 | EltTy = T; | ||||||||||
| 1892 | else if (const MemberPointerType *PTy = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) | ||||||||||
| 1893 | EltTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); | ||||||||||
| 1894 | else | ||||||||||
| 1895 | EltTy = T->getPointeeType(); | ||||||||||
| 1896 | |||||||||||
| 1897 | // If we have a pointer or reference, the pointee must have an object | ||||||||||
| 1898 | // incomplete type. | ||||||||||
| 1899 | if (!EltTy->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { | ||||||||||
| 1900 | DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_invalid_pointee; | ||||||||||
| 1901 | ProblemTy = EltTy; | ||||||||||
| 1902 | } | ||||||||||
| 1903 | } else if (!T->isDependentType()) { | ||||||||||
| 1904 | DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer; | ||||||||||
| 1905 | ProblemTy = T; | ||||||||||
| 1906 | } | ||||||||||
| 1907 | |||||||||||
| 1908 | if (DiagID) { | ||||||||||
| 1909 | Diag(DS ? DS->getRestrictSpecLoc() : Loc, DiagID) << ProblemTy; | ||||||||||
| 1910 | Qs.removeRestrict(); | ||||||||||
| 1911 | } | ||||||||||
| 1912 | } | ||||||||||
| 1913 | |||||||||||
| 1914 | return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); | ||||||||||
| 1915 | } | ||||||||||
| 1916 | |||||||||||
| 1917 | QualType Sema::BuildQualifiedType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc, | ||||||||||
| 1918 | unsigned CVRAU, const DeclSpec *DS) { | ||||||||||
| 1919 | if (T.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 1920 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 1921 | |||||||||||
| 1922 | // Ignore any attempt to form a cv-qualified reference. | ||||||||||
| 1923 | if (T->isReferenceType()) | ||||||||||
| 1924 | CVRAU &= | ||||||||||
| 1925 | ~(DeclSpec::TQ_const | DeclSpec::TQ_volatile | DeclSpec::TQ_atomic); | ||||||||||
| 1926 | |||||||||||
| 1927 | // Convert from DeclSpec::TQ to Qualifiers::TQ by just dropping TQ_atomic and | ||||||||||
| 1928 | // TQ_unaligned; | ||||||||||
| 1929 | unsigned CVR = CVRAU & ~(DeclSpec::TQ_atomic | DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned); | ||||||||||
| 1930 | |||||||||||
| 1931 | // C11 6.7.3/5: | ||||||||||
| 1932 | // If the same qualifier appears more than once in the same | ||||||||||
| 1933 | // specifier-qualifier-list, either directly or via one or more typedefs, | ||||||||||
| 1934 | // the behavior is the same as if it appeared only once. | ||||||||||
| 1935 | // | ||||||||||
| 1936 | // It's not specified what happens when the _Atomic qualifier is applied to | ||||||||||
| 1937 | // a type specified with the _Atomic specifier, but we assume that this | ||||||||||
| 1938 | // should be treated as if the _Atomic qualifier appeared multiple times. | ||||||||||
| 1939 | if (CVRAU & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic && !T->isAtomicType()) { | ||||||||||
| 1940 | // C11 6.7.3/5: | ||||||||||
| 1941 | // If other qualifiers appear along with the _Atomic qualifier in a | ||||||||||
| 1942 | // specifier-qualifier-list, the resulting type is the so-qualified | ||||||||||
| 1943 | // atomic type. | ||||||||||
| 1944 | // | ||||||||||
| 1945 | // Don't need to worry about array types here, since _Atomic can't be | ||||||||||
| 1946 | // applied to such types. | ||||||||||
| 1947 | SplitQualType Split = T.getSplitUnqualifiedType(); | ||||||||||
| 1948 | T = BuildAtomicType(QualType(Split.Ty, 0), | ||||||||||
| 1949 | DS ? DS->getAtomicSpecLoc() : Loc); | ||||||||||
| 1950 | if (T.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 1951 | return T; | ||||||||||
| 1952 | Split.Quals.addCVRQualifiers(CVR); | ||||||||||
| 1953 | return BuildQualifiedType(T, Loc, Split.Quals); | ||||||||||
| 1954 | } | ||||||||||
| 1955 | |||||||||||
| 1956 | Qualifiers Q = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(CVR); | ||||||||||
| 1957 | Q.setUnaligned(CVRAU & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned); | ||||||||||
| 1958 | return BuildQualifiedType(T, Loc, Q, DS); | ||||||||||
| 1959 | } | ||||||||||
| 1960 | |||||||||||
| 1961 | /// Build a paren type including \p T. | ||||||||||
| 1962 | QualType Sema::BuildParenType(QualType T) { | ||||||||||
| 1963 | return Context.getParenType(T); | ||||||||||
| 1964 | } | ||||||||||
| 1965 | |||||||||||
| 1966 | /// Given that we're building a pointer or reference to the given | ||||||||||
| 1967 | static QualType inferARCLifetimeForPointee(Sema &S, QualType type, | ||||||||||
| 1968 | SourceLocation loc, | ||||||||||
| 1969 | bool isReference) { | ||||||||||
| 1970 | // Bail out if retention is unrequired or already specified. | ||||||||||
| 1971 | if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType() || | ||||||||||
| 1972 | type.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None) | ||||||||||
| 1973 | return type; | ||||||||||
| 1974 | |||||||||||
| 1975 | Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime implicitLifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_None; | ||||||||||
| 1976 | |||||||||||
| 1977 | // If the object type is const-qualified, we can safely use | ||||||||||
| 1978 | // __unsafe_unretained. This is safe (because there are no read | ||||||||||
| 1979 | // barriers), and it'll be safe to coerce anything but __weak* to | ||||||||||
| 1980 | // the resulting type. | ||||||||||
| 1981 | if (type.isConstQualified()) { | ||||||||||
| 1982 | implicitLifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; | ||||||||||
| 1983 | |||||||||||
| 1984 | // Otherwise, check whether the static type does not require | ||||||||||
| 1985 | // retaining. This currently only triggers for Class (possibly | ||||||||||
| 1986 | // protocol-qualifed, and arrays thereof). | ||||||||||
| 1987 | } else if (type->isObjCARCImplicitlyUnretainedType()) { | ||||||||||
| 1988 | implicitLifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; | ||||||||||
| 1989 | |||||||||||
| 1990 | // If we are in an unevaluated context, like sizeof, skip adding a | ||||||||||
| 1991 | // qualification. | ||||||||||
| 1992 | } else if (S.isUnevaluatedContext()) { | ||||||||||
| 1993 | return type; | ||||||||||
| 1994 | |||||||||||
| 1995 | // If that failed, give an error and recover using __strong. __strong | ||||||||||
| 1996 | // is the option most likely to prevent spurious second-order diagnostics, | ||||||||||
| 1997 | // like when binding a reference to a field. | ||||||||||
| 1998 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 1999 | // These types can show up in private ivars in system headers, so | ||||||||||
| 2000 | // we need this to not be an error in those cases. Instead we | ||||||||||
| 2001 | // want to delay. | ||||||||||
| 2002 | if (S.DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics()) { | ||||||||||
| 2003 | S.DelayedDiagnostics.add( | ||||||||||
| 2004 | sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType(loc, | ||||||||||
| 2005 | diag::err_arc_indirect_no_ownership, type, isReference)); | ||||||||||
| 2006 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 2007 | S.Diag(loc, diag::err_arc_indirect_no_ownership) << type << isReference; | ||||||||||
| 2008 | } | ||||||||||
| 2009 | implicitLifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_Strong; | ||||||||||
| 2010 | } | ||||||||||
| 2011 | assert(implicitLifetime && "didn't infer any lifetime!")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 2012 | |||||||||||
| 2013 | Qualifiers qs; | ||||||||||
| 2014 | qs.addObjCLifetime(implicitLifetime); | ||||||||||
| 2015 | return S.Context.getQualifiedType(type, qs); | ||||||||||
| 2016 | } | ||||||||||
| 2017 | |||||||||||
| 2018 | static std::string getFunctionQualifiersAsString(const FunctionProtoType *FnTy){ | ||||||||||
| 2019 | std::string Quals = FnTy->getMethodQuals().getAsString(); | ||||||||||
| 2020 | |||||||||||
| 2021 | switch (FnTy->getRefQualifier()) { | ||||||||||
| 2022 | case RQ_None: | ||||||||||
| 2023 | break; | ||||||||||
| 2024 | |||||||||||
| 2025 | case RQ_LValue: | ||||||||||
| 2026 | if (!Quals.empty()) | ||||||||||
| 2027 | Quals += ' '; | ||||||||||
| 2028 | Quals += '&'; | ||||||||||
| 2029 | break; | ||||||||||
| 2030 | |||||||||||
| 2031 | case RQ_RValue: | ||||||||||
| 2032 | if (!Quals.empty()) | ||||||||||
| 2033 | Quals += ' '; | ||||||||||
| 2034 | Quals += "&&"; | ||||||||||
| 2035 | break; | ||||||||||
| 2036 | } | ||||||||||
| 2037 | |||||||||||
| 2038 | return Quals; | ||||||||||
| 2039 | } | ||||||||||
| 2040 | |||||||||||
| 2041 | namespace { | ||||||||||
| 2042 | /// Kinds of declarator that cannot contain a qualified function type. | ||||||||||
| 2043 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2044 | /// C++98 [dcl.fct]p4 / C++11 [dcl.fct]p6: | ||||||||||
| 2045 | /// a function type with a cv-qualifier or a ref-qualifier can only appear | ||||||||||
| 2046 | /// at the topmost level of a type. | ||||||||||
| 2047 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2048 | /// Parens and member pointers are permitted. We don't diagnose array and | ||||||||||
| 2049 | /// function declarators, because they don't allow function types at all. | ||||||||||
| 2050 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2051 | /// The values of this enum are used in diagnostics. | ||||||||||
| 2052 | enum QualifiedFunctionKind { QFK_BlockPointer, QFK_Pointer, QFK_Reference }; | ||||||||||
| 2053 | } // end anonymous namespace | ||||||||||
| 2054 | |||||||||||
| 2055 | /// Check whether the type T is a qualified function type, and if it is, | ||||||||||
| 2056 | /// diagnose that it cannot be contained within the given kind of declarator. | ||||||||||
| 2057 | static bool checkQualifiedFunction(Sema &S, QualType T, SourceLocation Loc, | ||||||||||
| 2058 | QualifiedFunctionKind QFK) { | ||||||||||
| 2059 | // Does T refer to a function type with a cv-qualifier or a ref-qualifier? | ||||||||||
| 2060 | const FunctionProtoType *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); | ||||||||||
| 2061 | if (!FPT || | ||||||||||
| 2062 | (FPT->getMethodQuals().empty() && FPT->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) | ||||||||||
| 2063 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 2064 | |||||||||||
| 2065 | S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_compound_qualified_function_type) | ||||||||||
| 2066 | << QFK << isa<FunctionType>(T.IgnoreParens()) << T | ||||||||||
| 2067 | << getFunctionQualifiersAsString(FPT); | ||||||||||
| 2068 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 2069 | } | ||||||||||
| 2070 | |||||||||||
| 2071 | bool Sema::CheckQualifiedFunctionForTypeId(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 2072 | const FunctionProtoType *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); | ||||||||||
| 2073 | if (!FPT || | ||||||||||
| 2074 | (FPT->getMethodQuals().empty() && FPT->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) | ||||||||||
| 2075 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 2076 | |||||||||||
| 2077 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_qualified_function_typeid) | ||||||||||
| 2078 | << T << getFunctionQualifiersAsString(FPT); | ||||||||||
| 2079 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 2080 | } | ||||||||||
| 2081 | |||||||||||
| 2082 | // Helper to deduce addr space of a pointee type in OpenCL mode. | ||||||||||
| 2083 | static QualType deduceOpenCLPointeeAddrSpace(Sema &S, QualType PointeeType) { | ||||||||||
| 2084 | if (!PointeeType->isUndeducedAutoType() && !PointeeType->isDependentType() && | ||||||||||
| 2085 | !PointeeType->isSamplerT() && | ||||||||||
| 2086 | !PointeeType.hasAddressSpace()) | ||||||||||
| 2087 | PointeeType = S.getASTContext().getAddrSpaceQualType( | ||||||||||
| 2088 | PointeeType, S.getLangOpts().OpenCLGenericAddressSpace | ||||||||||
| 2089 | ? LangAS::opencl_generic | ||||||||||
| 2090 | : LangAS::opencl_private); | ||||||||||
| 2091 | return PointeeType; | ||||||||||
| 2092 | } | ||||||||||
| 2093 | |||||||||||
| 2094 | /// Build a pointer type. | ||||||||||
| 2095 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2096 | /// \param T The type to which we'll be building a pointer. | ||||||||||
| 2097 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2098 | /// \param Loc The location of the entity whose type involves this | ||||||||||
| 2099 | /// pointer type or, if there is no such entity, the location of the | ||||||||||
| 2100 | /// type that will have pointer type. | ||||||||||
| 2101 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2102 | /// \param Entity The name of the entity that involves the pointer | ||||||||||
| 2103 | /// type, if known. | ||||||||||
| 2104 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2105 | /// \returns A suitable pointer type, if there are no | ||||||||||
| 2106 | /// errors. Otherwise, returns a NULL type. | ||||||||||
| 2107 | QualType Sema::BuildPointerType(QualType T, | ||||||||||
| 2108 | SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity) { | ||||||||||
| 2109 | if (T->isReferenceType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2110 | // C++ 8.3.2p4: There shall be no ... pointers to references ... | ||||||||||
| 2111 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_illegal_decl_pointer_to_reference) | ||||||||||
| 2112 | << getPrintableNameForEntity(Entity) << T; | ||||||||||
| 2113 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2114 | } | ||||||||||
| 2115 | |||||||||||
| 2116 | if (T->isFunctionType() && getLangOpts().OpenCL && | ||||||||||
| 2117 | !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers", | ||||||||||
| 2118 | getLangOpts())) { | ||||||||||
| 2119 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_function_pointer) << /*pointer*/ 0; | ||||||||||
| 2120 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2121 | } | ||||||||||
| 2122 | |||||||||||
| 2123 | if (checkQualifiedFunction(*this, T, Loc, QFK_Pointer)) | ||||||||||
| 2124 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2125 | |||||||||||
| 2126 | assert(!T->isObjCObjectType() && "Should build ObjCObjectPointerType")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 2127 | |||||||||||
| 2128 | // In ARC, it is forbidden to build pointers to unqualified pointers. | ||||||||||
| 2129 | if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) | ||||||||||
| 2130 | T = inferARCLifetimeForPointee(*this, T, Loc, /*reference*/ false); | ||||||||||
| 2131 | |||||||||||
| 2132 | if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) | ||||||||||
| 2133 | T = deduceOpenCLPointeeAddrSpace(*this, T); | ||||||||||
| 2134 | |||||||||||
| 2135 | // Build the pointer type. | ||||||||||
| 2136 | return Context.getPointerType(T); | ||||||||||
| 2137 | } | ||||||||||
| 2138 | |||||||||||
| 2139 | /// Build a reference type. | ||||||||||
| 2140 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2141 | /// \param T The type to which we'll be building a reference. | ||||||||||
| 2142 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2143 | /// \param Loc The location of the entity whose type involves this | ||||||||||
| 2144 | /// reference type or, if there is no such entity, the location of the | ||||||||||
| 2145 | /// type that will have reference type. | ||||||||||
| 2146 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2147 | /// \param Entity The name of the entity that involves the reference | ||||||||||
| 2148 | /// type, if known. | ||||||||||
| 2149 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2150 | /// \returns A suitable reference type, if there are no | ||||||||||
| 2151 | /// errors. Otherwise, returns a NULL type. | ||||||||||
| 2152 | QualType Sema::BuildReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue, | ||||||||||
| 2153 | SourceLocation Loc, | ||||||||||
| 2154 | DeclarationName Entity) { | ||||||||||
| 2155 | assert(Context.getCanonicalType(T) != Context.OverloadTy &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 2156 | "Unresolved overloaded function type")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 2157 | |||||||||||
| 2158 | // C++0x [dcl.ref]p6: | ||||||||||
| 2159 | // If a typedef (7.1.3), a type template-parameter (14.3.1), or a | ||||||||||
| 2160 | // decltype-specifier (7.1.6.2) denotes a type TR that is a reference to a | ||||||||||
| 2161 | // type T, an attempt to create the type "lvalue reference to cv TR" creates | ||||||||||
| 2162 | // the type "lvalue reference to T", while an attempt to create the type | ||||||||||
| 2163 | // "rvalue reference to cv TR" creates the type TR. | ||||||||||
| 2164 | bool LValueRef = SpelledAsLValue || T->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); | ||||||||||
| 2165 | |||||||||||
| 2166 | // C++ [dcl.ref]p4: There shall be no references to references. | ||||||||||
| 2167 | // | ||||||||||
| 2168 | // According to C++ DR 106, references to references are only | ||||||||||
| 2169 | // diagnosed when they are written directly (e.g., "int & &"), | ||||||||||
| 2170 | // but not when they happen via a typedef: | ||||||||||
| 2171 | // | ||||||||||
| 2172 | // typedef int& intref; | ||||||||||
| 2173 | // typedef intref& intref2; | ||||||||||
| 2174 | // | ||||||||||
| 2175 | // Parser::ParseDeclaratorInternal diagnoses the case where | ||||||||||
| 2176 | // references are written directly; here, we handle the | ||||||||||
| 2177 | // collapsing of references-to-references as described in C++0x. | ||||||||||
| 2178 | // DR 106 and 540 introduce reference-collapsing into C++98/03. | ||||||||||
| 2179 | |||||||||||
| 2180 | // C++ [dcl.ref]p1: | ||||||||||
| 2181 | // A declarator that specifies the type "reference to cv void" | ||||||||||
| 2182 | // is ill-formed. | ||||||||||
| 2183 | if (T->isVoidType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2184 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_void); | ||||||||||
| 2185 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2186 | } | ||||||||||
| 2187 | |||||||||||
| 2188 | if (checkQualifiedFunction(*this, T, Loc, QFK_Reference)) | ||||||||||
| 2189 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2190 | |||||||||||
| 2191 | if (T->isFunctionType() && getLangOpts().OpenCL && | ||||||||||
| 2192 | !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers", | ||||||||||
| 2193 | getLangOpts())) { | ||||||||||
| 2194 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_function_pointer) << /*reference*/ 1; | ||||||||||
| 2195 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2196 | } | ||||||||||
| 2197 | |||||||||||
| 2198 | // In ARC, it is forbidden to build references to unqualified pointers. | ||||||||||
| 2199 | if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) | ||||||||||
| 2200 | T = inferARCLifetimeForPointee(*this, T, Loc, /*reference*/ true); | ||||||||||
| 2201 | |||||||||||
| 2202 | if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) | ||||||||||
| 2203 | T = deduceOpenCLPointeeAddrSpace(*this, T); | ||||||||||
| 2204 | |||||||||||
| 2205 | // Handle restrict on references. | ||||||||||
| 2206 | if (LValueRef) | ||||||||||
| 2207 | return Context.getLValueReferenceType(T, SpelledAsLValue); | ||||||||||
| 2208 | return Context.getRValueReferenceType(T); | ||||||||||
| 2209 | } | ||||||||||
| 2210 | |||||||||||
| 2211 | /// Build a Read-only Pipe type. | ||||||||||
| 2212 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2213 | /// \param T The type to which we'll be building a Pipe. | ||||||||||
| 2214 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2215 | /// \param Loc We do not use it for now. | ||||||||||
| 2216 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2217 | /// \returns A suitable pipe type, if there are no errors. Otherwise, returns a | ||||||||||
| 2218 | /// NULL type. | ||||||||||
| 2219 | QualType Sema::BuildReadPipeType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 2220 | return Context.getReadPipeType(T); | ||||||||||
| 2221 | } | ||||||||||
| 2222 | |||||||||||
| 2223 | /// Build a Write-only Pipe type. | ||||||||||
| 2224 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2225 | /// \param T The type to which we'll be building a Pipe. | ||||||||||
| 2226 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2227 | /// \param Loc We do not use it for now. | ||||||||||
| 2228 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2229 | /// \returns A suitable pipe type, if there are no errors. Otherwise, returns a | ||||||||||
| 2230 | /// NULL type. | ||||||||||
| 2231 | QualType Sema::BuildWritePipeType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 2232 | return Context.getWritePipeType(T); | ||||||||||
| 2233 | } | ||||||||||
| 2234 | |||||||||||
| 2235 | /// Build a extended int type. | ||||||||||
| 2236 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2237 | /// \param IsUnsigned Boolean representing the signedness of the type. | ||||||||||
| 2238 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2239 | /// \param BitWidth Size of this int type in bits, or an expression representing | ||||||||||
| 2240 | /// that. | ||||||||||
| 2241 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2242 | /// \param Loc Location of the keyword. | ||||||||||
| 2243 | QualType Sema::BuildExtIntType(bool IsUnsigned, Expr *BitWidth, | ||||||||||
| 2244 | SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 2245 | if (BitWidth->isInstantiationDependent()) | ||||||||||
| 2246 | return Context.getDependentExtIntType(IsUnsigned, BitWidth); | ||||||||||
| 2247 | |||||||||||
| 2248 | llvm::APSInt Bits(32); | ||||||||||
| 2249 | ExprResult ICE = | ||||||||||
| 2250 | VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Bits, /*FIXME*/ AllowFold); | ||||||||||
| 2251 | |||||||||||
| 2252 | if (ICE.isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 2253 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2254 | |||||||||||
| 2255 | int64_t NumBits = Bits.getSExtValue(); | ||||||||||
| 2256 | if (!IsUnsigned && NumBits < 2) { | ||||||||||
| 2257 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_ext_int_bad_size) << 0; | ||||||||||
| 2258 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2259 | } | ||||||||||
| 2260 | |||||||||||
| 2261 | if (IsUnsigned && NumBits < 1) { | ||||||||||
| 2262 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_ext_int_bad_size) << 1; | ||||||||||
| 2263 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2264 | } | ||||||||||
| 2265 | |||||||||||
| 2266 | if (NumBits > llvm::IntegerType::MAX_INT_BITS) { | ||||||||||
| 2267 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_ext_int_max_size) << IsUnsigned | ||||||||||
| 2268 | << llvm::IntegerType::MAX_INT_BITS; | ||||||||||
| 2269 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2270 | } | ||||||||||
| 2271 | |||||||||||
| 2272 | return Context.getExtIntType(IsUnsigned, NumBits); | ||||||||||
| 2273 | } | ||||||||||
| 2274 | |||||||||||
| 2275 | /// Check whether the specified array bound can be evaluated using the relevant | ||||||||||
| 2276 | /// language rules. If so, returns the possibly-converted expression and sets | ||||||||||
| 2277 | /// SizeVal to the size. If not, but the expression might be a VLA bound, | ||||||||||
| 2278 | /// returns ExprResult(). Otherwise, produces a diagnostic and returns | ||||||||||
| 2279 | /// ExprError(). | ||||||||||
| 2280 | static ExprResult checkArraySize(Sema &S, Expr *&ArraySize, | ||||||||||
| 2281 | llvm::APSInt &SizeVal, unsigned VLADiag, | ||||||||||
| 2282 | bool VLAIsError) { | ||||||||||
| 2283 | if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && | ||||||||||
| 2284 | (VLAIsError || | ||||||||||
| 2285 | !ArraySize->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())) { | ||||||||||
| 2286 | // C++14 [dcl.array]p1: | ||||||||||
| 2287 | // The constant-expression shall be a converted constant expression of | ||||||||||
| 2288 | // type std::size_t. | ||||||||||
| 2289 | // | ||||||||||
| 2290 | // Don't apply this rule if we might be forming a VLA: in that case, we | ||||||||||
| 2291 | // allow non-constant expressions and constant-folding. We only need to use | ||||||||||
| 2292 | // the converted constant expression rules (to properly convert the source) | ||||||||||
| 2293 | // when the source expression is of class type. | ||||||||||
| 2294 | return S.CheckConvertedConstantExpression( | ||||||||||
| 2295 | ArraySize, S.Context.getSizeType(), SizeVal, Sema::CCEK_ArrayBound); | ||||||||||
| 2296 | } | ||||||||||
| 2297 | |||||||||||
| 2298 | // If the size is an ICE, it certainly isn't a VLA. If we're in a GNU mode | ||||||||||
| 2299 | // (like gnu99, but not c99) accept any evaluatable value as an extension. | ||||||||||
| 2300 | class VLADiagnoser : public Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser { | ||||||||||
| 2301 | public: | ||||||||||
| 2302 | unsigned VLADiag; | ||||||||||
| 2303 | bool VLAIsError; | ||||||||||
| 2304 | bool IsVLA = false; | ||||||||||
| 2305 | |||||||||||
| 2306 | VLADiagnoser(unsigned VLADiag, bool VLAIsError) | ||||||||||
| 2307 | : VLADiag(VLADiag), VLAIsError(VLAIsError) {} | ||||||||||
| 2308 | |||||||||||
| 2309 | Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotICEType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, | ||||||||||
| 2310 | QualType T) override { | ||||||||||
| 2311 | return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_size_non_int) << T; | ||||||||||
| 2312 | } | ||||||||||
| 2313 | |||||||||||
| 2314 | Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, | ||||||||||
| 2315 | SourceLocation Loc) override { | ||||||||||
| 2316 | IsVLA = !VLAIsError; | ||||||||||
| 2317 | return S.Diag(Loc, VLADiag); | ||||||||||
| 2318 | } | ||||||||||
| 2319 | |||||||||||
| 2320 | Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseFold(Sema &S, | ||||||||||
| 2321 | SourceLocation Loc) override { | ||||||||||
| 2322 | return S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); | ||||||||||
| 2323 | } | ||||||||||
| 2324 | } Diagnoser(VLADiag, VLAIsError); | ||||||||||
| 2325 | |||||||||||
| 2326 | ExprResult R = | ||||||||||
| 2327 | S.VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(ArraySize, &SizeVal, Diagnoser); | ||||||||||
| 2328 | if (Diagnoser.IsVLA) | ||||||||||
| 2329 | return ExprResult(); | ||||||||||
| 2330 | return R; | ||||||||||
| 2331 | } | ||||||||||
| 2332 | |||||||||||
| 2333 | /// Build an array type. | ||||||||||
| 2334 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2335 | /// \param T The type of each element in the array. | ||||||||||
| 2336 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2337 | /// \param ASM C99 array size modifier (e.g., '*', 'static'). | ||||||||||
| 2338 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2339 | /// \param ArraySize Expression describing the size of the array. | ||||||||||
| 2340 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2341 | /// \param Brackets The range from the opening '[' to the closing ']'. | ||||||||||
| 2342 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2343 | /// \param Entity The name of the entity that involves the array | ||||||||||
| 2344 | /// type, if known. | ||||||||||
| 2345 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2346 | /// \returns A suitable array type, if there are no errors. Otherwise, | ||||||||||
| 2347 | /// returns a NULL type. | ||||||||||
| 2348 | QualType Sema::BuildArrayType(QualType T, ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM, | ||||||||||
| 2349 | Expr *ArraySize, unsigned Quals, | ||||||||||
| 2350 | SourceRange Brackets, DeclarationName Entity) { | ||||||||||
| 2351 | |||||||||||
| 2352 | SourceLocation Loc = Brackets.getBegin(); | ||||||||||
| 2353 | if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { | ||||||||||
| 2354 | // C++ [dcl.array]p1: | ||||||||||
| 2355 | // T is called the array element type; this type shall not be a reference | ||||||||||
| 2356 | // type, the (possibly cv-qualified) type void, a function type or an | ||||||||||
| 2357 | // abstract class type. | ||||||||||
| 2358 | // | ||||||||||
| 2359 | // C++ [dcl.array]p3: | ||||||||||
| 2360 | // When several "array of" specifications are adjacent, [...] only the | ||||||||||
| 2361 | // first of the constant expressions that specify the bounds of the arrays | ||||||||||
| 2362 | // may be omitted. | ||||||||||
| 2363 | // | ||||||||||
| 2364 | // Note: function types are handled in the common path with C. | ||||||||||
| 2365 | if (T->isReferenceType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2366 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_illegal_decl_array_of_references) | ||||||||||
| 2367 | << getPrintableNameForEntity(Entity) << T; | ||||||||||
| 2368 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2369 | } | ||||||||||
| 2370 | |||||||||||
| 2371 | if (T->isVoidType() || T->isIncompleteArrayType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2372 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type) << 0 << T; | ||||||||||
| 2373 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2374 | } | ||||||||||
| 2375 | |||||||||||
| 2376 | if (RequireNonAbstractType(Brackets.getBegin(), T, | ||||||||||
| 2377 | diag::err_array_of_abstract_type)) | ||||||||||
| 2378 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2379 | |||||||||||
| 2380 | // Mentioning a member pointer type for an array type causes us to lock in | ||||||||||
| 2381 | // an inheritance model, even if it's inside an unused typedef. | ||||||||||
| 2382 | if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) | ||||||||||
| 2383 | if (const MemberPointerType *MPTy = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) | ||||||||||
| 2384 | if (!MPTy->getClass()->isDependentType()) | ||||||||||
| 2385 | (void)isCompleteType(Loc, T); | ||||||||||
| 2386 | |||||||||||
| 2387 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 2388 | // C99 6.7.5.2p1: If the element type is an incomplete or function type, | ||||||||||
| 2389 | // reject it (e.g. void ary[7], struct foo ary[7], void ary[7]()) | ||||||||||
| 2390 | if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Loc, T, | ||||||||||
| 2391 | diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type)) | ||||||||||
| 2392 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2393 | } | ||||||||||
| 2394 | |||||||||||
| 2395 | if (T->isSizelessType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2396 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type) << 1 << T; | ||||||||||
| 2397 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2398 | } | ||||||||||
| 2399 | |||||||||||
| 2400 | if (T->isFunctionType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2401 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_illegal_decl_array_of_functions) | ||||||||||
| 2402 | << getPrintableNameForEntity(Entity) << T; | ||||||||||
| 2403 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2404 | } | ||||||||||
| 2405 | |||||||||||
| 2406 | if (const RecordType *EltTy = T->getAs<RecordType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 2407 | // If the element type is a struct or union that contains a variadic | ||||||||||
| 2408 | // array, accept it as a GNU extension: C99 6.7.2.1p2. | ||||||||||
| 2409 | if (EltTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) | ||||||||||
| 2410 | Diag(Loc, diag::ext_flexible_array_in_array) << T; | ||||||||||
| 2411 | } else if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2412 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_array_of_interfaces) << T; | ||||||||||
| 2413 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2414 | } | ||||||||||
| 2415 | |||||||||||
| 2416 | // Do placeholder conversions on the array size expression. | ||||||||||
| 2417 | if (ArraySize && ArraySize->hasPlaceholderType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2418 | ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(ArraySize); | ||||||||||
| 2419 | if (Result.isInvalid()) return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2420 | ArraySize = Result.get(); | ||||||||||
| 2421 | } | ||||||||||
| 2422 | |||||||||||
| 2423 | // Do lvalue-to-rvalue conversions on the array size expression. | ||||||||||
| 2424 | if (ArraySize && !ArraySize->isPRValue()) { | ||||||||||
| 2425 | ExprResult Result = DefaultLvalueConversion(ArraySize); | ||||||||||
| 2426 | if (Result.isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 2427 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2428 | |||||||||||
| 2429 | ArraySize = Result.get(); | ||||||||||
| 2430 | } | ||||||||||
| 2431 | |||||||||||
| 2432 | // C99 6.7.5.2p1: The size expression shall have integer type. | ||||||||||
| 2433 | // C++11 allows contextual conversions to such types. | ||||||||||
| 2434 | if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && | ||||||||||
| 2435 | ArraySize && !ArraySize->isTypeDependent() && | ||||||||||
| 2436 | !ArraySize->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2437 | Diag(ArraySize->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_array_size_non_int) | ||||||||||
| 2438 | << ArraySize->getType() << ArraySize->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 2439 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2440 | } | ||||||||||
| 2441 | |||||||||||
| 2442 | // VLAs always produce at least a -Wvla diagnostic, sometimes an error. | ||||||||||
| 2443 | unsigned VLADiag; | ||||||||||
| 2444 | bool VLAIsError; | ||||||||||
| 2445 | if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 2446 | // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.d: variable length arrays are not supported. | ||||||||||
| 2447 | VLADiag = diag::err_opencl_vla; | ||||||||||
| 2448 | VLAIsError = true; | ||||||||||
| 2449 | } else if (getLangOpts().C99) { | ||||||||||
| 2450 | VLADiag = diag::warn_vla_used; | ||||||||||
| 2451 | VLAIsError = false; | ||||||||||
| 2452 | } else if (isSFINAEContext()) { | ||||||||||
| 2453 | VLADiag = diag::err_vla_in_sfinae; | ||||||||||
| 2454 | VLAIsError = true; | ||||||||||
| 2455 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 2456 | VLADiag = diag::ext_vla; | ||||||||||
| 2457 | VLAIsError = false; | ||||||||||
| 2458 | } | ||||||||||
| 2459 | |||||||||||
| 2460 | llvm::APSInt ConstVal(Context.getTypeSize(Context.getSizeType())); | ||||||||||
| 2461 | if (!ArraySize) { | ||||||||||
| 2462 | if (ASM == ArrayType::Star) { | ||||||||||
| 2463 | Diag(Loc, VLADiag); | ||||||||||
| 2464 | if (VLAIsError) | ||||||||||
| 2465 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2466 | |||||||||||
| 2467 | T = Context.getVariableArrayType(T, nullptr, ASM, Quals, Brackets); | ||||||||||
| 2468 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 2469 | T = Context.getIncompleteArrayType(T, ASM, Quals); | ||||||||||
| 2470 | } | ||||||||||
| 2471 | } else if (ArraySize->isTypeDependent() || ArraySize->isValueDependent()) { | ||||||||||
| 2472 | T = Context.getDependentSizedArrayType(T, ArraySize, ASM, Quals, Brackets); | ||||||||||
| 2473 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 2474 | ExprResult R = | ||||||||||
| 2475 | checkArraySize(*this, ArraySize, ConstVal, VLADiag, VLAIsError); | ||||||||||
| 2476 | if (R.isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 2477 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2478 | |||||||||||
| 2479 | if (!R.isUsable()) { | ||||||||||
| 2480 | // C99: an array with a non-ICE size is a VLA. We accept any expression | ||||||||||
| 2481 | // that we can fold to a non-zero positive value as a non-VLA as an | ||||||||||
| 2482 | // extension. | ||||||||||
| 2483 | T = Context.getVariableArrayType(T, ArraySize, ASM, Quals, Brackets); | ||||||||||
| 2484 | } else if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isIncompleteType() && | ||||||||||
| 2485 | !T->isConstantSizeType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2486 | // C99: an array with an element type that has a non-constant-size is a | ||||||||||
| 2487 | // VLA. | ||||||||||
| 2488 | // FIXME: Add a note to explain why this isn't a VLA. | ||||||||||
| 2489 | Diag(Loc, VLADiag); | ||||||||||
| 2490 | if (VLAIsError) | ||||||||||
| 2491 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2492 | T = Context.getVariableArrayType(T, ArraySize, ASM, Quals, Brackets); | ||||||||||
| 2493 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 2494 | // C99 6.7.5.2p1: If the expression is a constant expression, it shall | ||||||||||
| 2495 | // have a value greater than zero. | ||||||||||
| 2496 | // In C++, this follows from narrowing conversions being disallowed. | ||||||||||
| 2497 | if (ConstVal.isSigned() && ConstVal.isNegative()) { | ||||||||||
| 2498 | if (Entity) | ||||||||||
| 2499 | Diag(ArraySize->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_decl_negative_array_size) | ||||||||||
| 2500 | << getPrintableNameForEntity(Entity) | ||||||||||
| 2501 | << ArraySize->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 2502 | else | ||||||||||
| 2503 | Diag(ArraySize->getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 2504 | diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size) | ||||||||||
| 2505 | << ArraySize->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 2506 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2507 | } | ||||||||||
| 2508 | if (ConstVal == 0) { | ||||||||||
| 2509 | // GCC accepts zero sized static arrays. We allow them when | ||||||||||
| 2510 | // we're not in a SFINAE context. | ||||||||||
| 2511 | Diag(ArraySize->getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 2512 | isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_zero_array_size | ||||||||||
| 2513 | : diag::ext_typecheck_zero_array_size) | ||||||||||
| 2514 | << ArraySize->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 2515 | } | ||||||||||
| 2516 | |||||||||||
| 2517 | // Is the array too large? | ||||||||||
| 2518 | unsigned ActiveSizeBits = | ||||||||||
| 2519 | (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isVariablyModifiedType() && | ||||||||||
| 2520 | !T->isIncompleteType() && !T->isUndeducedType()) | ||||||||||
| 2521 | ? ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, T, ConstVal) | ||||||||||
| 2522 | : ConstVal.getActiveBits(); | ||||||||||
| 2523 | if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { | ||||||||||
| 2524 | Diag(ArraySize->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_array_too_large) | ||||||||||
| 2525 | << toString(ConstVal, 10) << ArraySize->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 2526 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2527 | } | ||||||||||
| 2528 | |||||||||||
| 2529 | T = Context.getConstantArrayType(T, ConstVal, ArraySize, ASM, Quals); | ||||||||||
| 2530 | } | ||||||||||
| 2531 | } | ||||||||||
| 2532 | |||||||||||
| 2533 | if (T->isVariableArrayType() && !Context.getTargetInfo().isVLASupported()) { | ||||||||||
| 2534 | // CUDA device code and some other targets don't support VLAs. | ||||||||||
| 2535 | targetDiag(Loc, (getLangOpts().CUDA && getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) | ||||||||||
| 2536 | ? diag::err_cuda_vla | ||||||||||
| 2537 | : diag::err_vla_unsupported) | ||||||||||
| 2538 | << ((getLangOpts().CUDA && getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) | ||||||||||
| 2539 | ? CurrentCUDATarget() | ||||||||||
| 2540 | : CFT_InvalidTarget); | ||||||||||
| 2541 | } | ||||||||||
| 2542 | |||||||||||
| 2543 | // If this is not C99, diagnose array size modifiers on non-VLAs. | ||||||||||
| 2544 | if (!getLangOpts().C99 && !T->isVariableArrayType() && | ||||||||||
| 2545 | (ASM != ArrayType::Normal || Quals != 0)) { | ||||||||||
| 2546 | Diag(Loc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? diag::err_c99_array_usage_cxx | ||||||||||
| 2547 | : diag::ext_c99_array_usage) | ||||||||||
| 2548 | << ASM; | ||||||||||
| 2549 | } | ||||||||||
| 2550 | |||||||||||
| 2551 | // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Arrays of blocks are not supported. | ||||||||||
| 2552 | // OpenCL v2.0 s6.16.13.1 - Arrays of pipe type are not supported. | ||||||||||
| 2553 | // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.b - Arrays of image/sampler type are not supported. | ||||||||||
| 2554 | if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 2555 | const QualType ArrType = Context.getBaseElementType(T); | ||||||||||
| 2556 | if (ArrType->isBlockPointerType() || ArrType->isPipeType() || | ||||||||||
| 2557 | ArrType->isSamplerT() || ArrType->isImageType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2558 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_invalid_type_array) << ArrType; | ||||||||||
| 2559 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2560 | } | ||||||||||
| 2561 | } | ||||||||||
| 2562 | |||||||||||
| 2563 | return T; | ||||||||||
| 2564 | } | ||||||||||
| 2565 | |||||||||||
| 2566 | QualType Sema::BuildVectorType(QualType CurType, Expr *SizeExpr, | ||||||||||
| 2567 | SourceLocation AttrLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 2568 | // The base type must be integer (not Boolean or enumeration) or float, and | ||||||||||
| 2569 | // can't already be a vector. | ||||||||||
| 2570 | if ((!CurType->isDependentType() && | ||||||||||
| 2571 | (!CurType->isBuiltinType() || CurType->isBooleanType() || | ||||||||||
| 2572 | (!CurType->isIntegerType() && !CurType->isRealFloatingType()))) || | ||||||||||
| 2573 | CurType->isArrayType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2574 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_invalid_vector_type) << CurType; | ||||||||||
| 2575 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2576 | } | ||||||||||
| 2577 | |||||||||||
| 2578 | if (SizeExpr->isTypeDependent() || SizeExpr->isValueDependent()) | ||||||||||
| 2579 | return Context.getDependentVectorType(CurType, SizeExpr, AttrLoc, | ||||||||||
| 2580 | VectorType::GenericVector); | ||||||||||
| 2581 | |||||||||||
| 2582 | Optional<llvm::APSInt> VecSize = SizeExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context); | ||||||||||
| 2583 | if (!VecSize) { | ||||||||||
| 2584 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_argument_type) | ||||||||||
| 2585 | << "vector_size" << AANT_ArgumentIntegerConstant | ||||||||||
| 2586 | << SizeExpr->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 2587 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2588 | } | ||||||||||
| 2589 | |||||||||||
| 2590 | if (CurType->isDependentType()) | ||||||||||
| 2591 | return Context.getDependentVectorType(CurType, SizeExpr, AttrLoc, | ||||||||||
| 2592 | VectorType::GenericVector); | ||||||||||
| 2593 | |||||||||||
| 2594 | // vecSize is specified in bytes - convert to bits. | ||||||||||
| 2595 | if (!VecSize->isIntN(61)) { | ||||||||||
| 2596 | // Bit size will overflow uint64. | ||||||||||
| 2597 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_size_too_large) | ||||||||||
| 2598 | << SizeExpr->getSourceRange() << "vector"; | ||||||||||
| 2599 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2600 | } | ||||||||||
| 2601 | uint64_t VectorSizeBits = VecSize->getZExtValue() * 8; | ||||||||||
| 2602 | unsigned TypeSize = static_cast<unsigned>(Context.getTypeSize(CurType)); | ||||||||||
| 2603 | |||||||||||
| 2604 | if (VectorSizeBits == 0) { | ||||||||||
| 2605 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_zero_size) | ||||||||||
| 2606 | << SizeExpr->getSourceRange() << "vector"; | ||||||||||
| 2607 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2608 | } | ||||||||||
| 2609 | |||||||||||
| 2610 | if (VectorSizeBits % TypeSize) { | ||||||||||
| 2611 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_invalid_size) | ||||||||||
| 2612 | << SizeExpr->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 2613 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2614 | } | ||||||||||
| 2615 | |||||||||||
| 2616 | if (VectorSizeBits / TypeSize > std::numeric_limits<uint32_t>::max()) { | ||||||||||
| 2617 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_size_too_large) | ||||||||||
| 2618 | << SizeExpr->getSourceRange() << "vector"; | ||||||||||
| 2619 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2620 | } | ||||||||||
| 2621 | |||||||||||
| 2622 | return Context.getVectorType(CurType, VectorSizeBits / TypeSize, | ||||||||||
| 2623 | VectorType::GenericVector); | ||||||||||
| 2624 | } | ||||||||||
| 2625 | |||||||||||
| 2626 | /// Build an ext-vector type. | ||||||||||
| 2627 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2628 | /// Run the required checks for the extended vector type. | ||||||||||
| 2629 | QualType Sema::BuildExtVectorType(QualType T, Expr *ArraySize, | ||||||||||
| 2630 | SourceLocation AttrLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 2631 | // Unlike gcc's vector_size attribute, we do not allow vectors to be defined | ||||||||||
| 2632 | // in conjunction with complex types (pointers, arrays, functions, etc.). | ||||||||||
| 2633 | // | ||||||||||
| 2634 | // Additionally, OpenCL prohibits vectors of booleans (they're considered a | ||||||||||
| 2635 | // reserved data type under OpenCL v2.0 s6.1.4), we don't support selects | ||||||||||
| 2636 | // on bitvectors, and we have no well-defined ABI for bitvectors, so vectors | ||||||||||
| 2637 | // of bool aren't allowed. | ||||||||||
| 2638 | if ((!T->isDependentType() && !T->isIntegerType() && | ||||||||||
| 2639 | !T->isRealFloatingType()) || | ||||||||||
| 2640 | T->isBooleanType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2641 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_invalid_vector_type) << T; | ||||||||||
| 2642 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2643 | } | ||||||||||
| 2644 | |||||||||||
| 2645 | if (!ArraySize->isTypeDependent() && !ArraySize->isValueDependent()) { | ||||||||||
| 2646 | Optional<llvm::APSInt> vecSize = ArraySize->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context); | ||||||||||
| 2647 | if (!vecSize) { | ||||||||||
| 2648 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_argument_type) | ||||||||||
| 2649 | << "ext_vector_type" << AANT_ArgumentIntegerConstant | ||||||||||
| 2650 | << ArraySize->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 2651 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2652 | } | ||||||||||
| 2653 | |||||||||||
| 2654 | if (!vecSize->isIntN(32)) { | ||||||||||
| 2655 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_size_too_large) | ||||||||||
| 2656 | << ArraySize->getSourceRange() << "vector"; | ||||||||||
| 2657 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2658 | } | ||||||||||
| 2659 | // Unlike gcc's vector_size attribute, the size is specified as the | ||||||||||
| 2660 | // number of elements, not the number of bytes. | ||||||||||
| 2661 | unsigned vectorSize = static_cast<unsigned>(vecSize->getZExtValue()); | ||||||||||
| 2662 | |||||||||||
| 2663 | if (vectorSize == 0) { | ||||||||||
| 2664 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_zero_size) | ||||||||||
| 2665 | << ArraySize->getSourceRange() << "vector"; | ||||||||||
| 2666 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2667 | } | ||||||||||
| 2668 | |||||||||||
| 2669 | return Context.getExtVectorType(T, vectorSize); | ||||||||||
| 2670 | } | ||||||||||
| 2671 | |||||||||||
| 2672 | return Context.getDependentSizedExtVectorType(T, ArraySize, AttrLoc); | ||||||||||
| 2673 | } | ||||||||||
| 2674 | |||||||||||
| 2675 | QualType Sema::BuildMatrixType(QualType ElementTy, Expr *NumRows, Expr *NumCols, | ||||||||||
| 2676 | SourceLocation AttrLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 2677 | assert(Context.getLangOpts().MatrixTypes &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 2678 | "Should never build a matrix type when it is disabled")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 2679 | |||||||||||
| 2680 | // Check element type, if it is not dependent. | ||||||||||
| 2681 | if (!ElementTy->isDependentType() && | ||||||||||
| 2682 | !MatrixType::isValidElementType(ElementTy)) { | ||||||||||
| 2683 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_invalid_matrix_type) << ElementTy; | ||||||||||
| 2684 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2685 | } | ||||||||||
| 2686 | |||||||||||
| 2687 | if (NumRows->isTypeDependent() || NumCols->isTypeDependent() || | ||||||||||
| 2688 | NumRows->isValueDependent() || NumCols->isValueDependent()) | ||||||||||
| 2689 | return Context.getDependentSizedMatrixType(ElementTy, NumRows, NumCols, | ||||||||||
| 2690 | AttrLoc); | ||||||||||
| 2691 | |||||||||||
| 2692 | Optional<llvm::APSInt> ValueRows = NumRows->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context); | ||||||||||
| 2693 | Optional<llvm::APSInt> ValueColumns = | ||||||||||
| 2694 | NumCols->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context); | ||||||||||
| 2695 | |||||||||||
| 2696 | auto const RowRange = NumRows->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 2697 | auto const ColRange = NumCols->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 2698 | |||||||||||
| 2699 | // Both are row and column expressions are invalid. | ||||||||||
| 2700 | if (!ValueRows && !ValueColumns) { | ||||||||||
| 2701 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_argument_type) | ||||||||||
| 2702 | << "matrix_type" << AANT_ArgumentIntegerConstant << RowRange | ||||||||||
| 2703 | << ColRange; | ||||||||||
| 2704 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2705 | } | ||||||||||
| 2706 | |||||||||||
| 2707 | // Only the row expression is invalid. | ||||||||||
| 2708 | if (!ValueRows) { | ||||||||||
| 2709 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_argument_type) | ||||||||||
| 2710 | << "matrix_type" << AANT_ArgumentIntegerConstant << RowRange; | ||||||||||
| 2711 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2712 | } | ||||||||||
| 2713 | |||||||||||
| 2714 | // Only the column expression is invalid. | ||||||||||
| 2715 | if (!ValueColumns) { | ||||||||||
| 2716 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_argument_type) | ||||||||||
| 2717 | << "matrix_type" << AANT_ArgumentIntegerConstant << ColRange; | ||||||||||
| 2718 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2719 | } | ||||||||||
| 2720 | |||||||||||
| 2721 | // Check the matrix dimensions. | ||||||||||
| 2722 | unsigned MatrixRows = static_cast<unsigned>(ValueRows->getZExtValue()); | ||||||||||
| 2723 | unsigned MatrixColumns = static_cast<unsigned>(ValueColumns->getZExtValue()); | ||||||||||
| 2724 | if (MatrixRows == 0 && MatrixColumns == 0) { | ||||||||||
| 2725 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_zero_size) | ||||||||||
| 2726 | << "matrix" << RowRange << ColRange; | ||||||||||
| 2727 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2728 | } | ||||||||||
| 2729 | if (MatrixRows == 0) { | ||||||||||
| 2730 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_zero_size) << "matrix" << RowRange; | ||||||||||
| 2731 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2732 | } | ||||||||||
| 2733 | if (MatrixColumns == 0) { | ||||||||||
| 2734 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_zero_size) << "matrix" << ColRange; | ||||||||||
| 2735 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2736 | } | ||||||||||
| 2737 | if (!ConstantMatrixType::isDimensionValid(MatrixRows)) { | ||||||||||
| 2738 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_size_too_large) | ||||||||||
| 2739 | << RowRange << "matrix row"; | ||||||||||
| 2740 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2741 | } | ||||||||||
| 2742 | if (!ConstantMatrixType::isDimensionValid(MatrixColumns)) { | ||||||||||
| 2743 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_size_too_large) | ||||||||||
| 2744 | << ColRange << "matrix column"; | ||||||||||
| 2745 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2746 | } | ||||||||||
| 2747 | return Context.getConstantMatrixType(ElementTy, MatrixRows, MatrixColumns); | ||||||||||
| 2748 | } | ||||||||||
| 2749 | |||||||||||
| 2750 | bool Sema::CheckFunctionReturnType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 2751 | if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2752 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_func_returning_array_function) | ||||||||||
| 2753 | << T->isFunctionType() << T; | ||||||||||
| 2754 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 2755 | } | ||||||||||
| 2756 | |||||||||||
| 2757 | // Functions cannot return half FP. | ||||||||||
| 2758 | if (T->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().HalfArgsAndReturns) { | ||||||||||
| 2759 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_parameters_retval_cannot_have_fp16_type) << 1 << | ||||||||||
| 2760 | FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "*"); | ||||||||||
| 2761 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 2762 | } | ||||||||||
| 2763 | |||||||||||
| 2764 | // Methods cannot return interface types. All ObjC objects are | ||||||||||
| 2765 | // passed by reference. | ||||||||||
| 2766 | if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2767 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) | ||||||||||
| 2768 | << 0 << T << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "*"); | ||||||||||
| 2769 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 2770 | } | ||||||||||
| 2771 | |||||||||||
| 2772 | if (T.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || | ||||||||||
| 2773 | T.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) | ||||||||||
| 2774 | checkNonTrivialCUnion(T, Loc, NTCUC_FunctionReturn, | ||||||||||
| 2775 | NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); | ||||||||||
| 2776 | |||||||||||
| 2777 | // C++2a [dcl.fct]p12: | ||||||||||
| 2778 | // A volatile-qualified return type is deprecated | ||||||||||
| 2779 | if (T.isVolatileQualified() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) | ||||||||||
| 2780 | Diag(Loc, diag::warn_deprecated_volatile_return) << T; | ||||||||||
| 2781 | |||||||||||
| 2782 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 2783 | } | ||||||||||
| 2784 | |||||||||||
| 2785 | /// Check the extended parameter information. Most of the necessary | ||||||||||
| 2786 | /// checking should occur when applying the parameter attribute; the | ||||||||||
| 2787 | /// only other checks required are positional restrictions. | ||||||||||
| 2788 | static void checkExtParameterInfos(Sema &S, ArrayRef<QualType> paramTypes, | ||||||||||
| 2789 | const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI, | ||||||||||
| 2790 | llvm::function_ref<SourceLocation(unsigned)> getParamLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 2791 | assert(EPI.ExtParameterInfos && "shouldn't get here without param infos")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 2792 | |||||||||||
| 2793 | bool emittedError = false; | ||||||||||
| 2794 | auto actualCC = EPI.ExtInfo.getCC(); | ||||||||||
| 2795 | enum class RequiredCC { OnlySwift, SwiftOrSwiftAsync }; | ||||||||||
| 2796 | auto checkCompatible = [&](unsigned paramIndex, RequiredCC required) { | ||||||||||
| 2797 | bool isCompatible = | ||||||||||
| 2798 | (required == RequiredCC::OnlySwift) | ||||||||||
| 2799 | ? (actualCC == CC_Swift) | ||||||||||
| 2800 | : (actualCC == CC_Swift || actualCC == CC_SwiftAsync); | ||||||||||
| 2801 | if (isCompatible || emittedError) | ||||||||||
| 2802 | return; | ||||||||||
| 2803 | S.Diag(getParamLoc(paramIndex), diag::err_swift_param_attr_not_swiftcall) | ||||||||||
| 2804 | << getParameterABISpelling(EPI.ExtParameterInfos[paramIndex].getABI()) | ||||||||||
| 2805 | << (required == RequiredCC::OnlySwift); | ||||||||||
| 2806 | emittedError = true; | ||||||||||
| 2807 | }; | ||||||||||
| 2808 | for (size_t paramIndex = 0, numParams = paramTypes.size(); | ||||||||||
| 2809 | paramIndex != numParams; ++paramIndex) { | ||||||||||
| 2810 | switch (EPI.ExtParameterInfos[paramIndex].getABI()) { | ||||||||||
| 2811 | // Nothing interesting to check for orindary-ABI parameters. | ||||||||||
| 2812 | case ParameterABI::Ordinary: | ||||||||||
| 2813 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 2814 | |||||||||||
| 2815 | // swift_indirect_result parameters must be a prefix of the function | ||||||||||
| 2816 | // arguments. | ||||||||||
| 2817 | case ParameterABI::SwiftIndirectResult: | ||||||||||
| 2818 | checkCompatible(paramIndex, RequiredCC::SwiftOrSwiftAsync); | ||||||||||
| 2819 | if (paramIndex != 0 && | ||||||||||
| 2820 | EPI.ExtParameterInfos[paramIndex - 1].getABI() | ||||||||||
| 2821 | != ParameterABI::SwiftIndirectResult) { | ||||||||||
| 2822 | S.Diag(getParamLoc(paramIndex), | ||||||||||
| 2823 | diag::err_swift_indirect_result_not_first); | ||||||||||
| 2824 | } | ||||||||||
| 2825 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 2826 | |||||||||||
| 2827 | case ParameterABI::SwiftContext: | ||||||||||
| 2828 | checkCompatible(paramIndex, RequiredCC::SwiftOrSwiftAsync); | ||||||||||
| 2829 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 2830 | |||||||||||
| 2831 | // SwiftAsyncContext is not limited to swiftasynccall functions. | ||||||||||
| 2832 | case ParameterABI::SwiftAsyncContext: | ||||||||||
| 2833 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 2834 | |||||||||||
| 2835 | // swift_error parameters must be preceded by a swift_context parameter. | ||||||||||
| 2836 | case ParameterABI::SwiftErrorResult: | ||||||||||
| 2837 | checkCompatible(paramIndex, RequiredCC::OnlySwift); | ||||||||||
| 2838 | if (paramIndex == 0 || | ||||||||||
| 2839 | EPI.ExtParameterInfos[paramIndex - 1].getABI() != | ||||||||||
| 2840 | ParameterABI::SwiftContext) { | ||||||||||
| 2841 | S.Diag(getParamLoc(paramIndex), | ||||||||||
| 2842 | diag::err_swift_error_result_not_after_swift_context); | ||||||||||
| 2843 | } | ||||||||||
| 2844 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 2845 | } | ||||||||||
| 2846 | llvm_unreachable("bad ABI kind")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 2847 | } | ||||||||||
| 2848 | } | ||||||||||
| 2849 | |||||||||||
| 2850 | QualType Sema::BuildFunctionType(QualType T, | ||||||||||
| 2851 | MutableArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes, | ||||||||||
| 2852 | SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity, | ||||||||||
| 2853 | const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) { | ||||||||||
| 2854 | bool Invalid = false; | ||||||||||
| 2855 | |||||||||||
| 2856 | Invalid |= CheckFunctionReturnType(T, Loc); | ||||||||||
| 2857 | |||||||||||
| 2858 | for (unsigned Idx = 0, Cnt = ParamTypes.size(); Idx < Cnt; ++Idx) { | ||||||||||
| 2859 | // FIXME: Loc is too inprecise here, should use proper locations for args. | ||||||||||
| 2860 | QualType ParamType = Context.getAdjustedParameterType(ParamTypes[Idx]); | ||||||||||
| 2861 | if (ParamType->isVoidType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2862 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_param_with_void_type); | ||||||||||
| 2863 | Invalid = true; | ||||||||||
| 2864 | } else if (ParamType->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().HalfArgsAndReturns) { | ||||||||||
| 2865 | // Disallow half FP arguments. | ||||||||||
| 2866 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_parameters_retval_cannot_have_fp16_type) << 0 << | ||||||||||
| 2867 | FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "*"); | ||||||||||
| 2868 | Invalid = true; | ||||||||||
| 2869 | } | ||||||||||
| 2870 | |||||||||||
| 2871 | // C++2a [dcl.fct]p4: | ||||||||||
| 2872 | // A parameter with volatile-qualified type is deprecated | ||||||||||
| 2873 | if (ParamType.isVolatileQualified() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) | ||||||||||
| 2874 | Diag(Loc, diag::warn_deprecated_volatile_param) << ParamType; | ||||||||||
| 2875 | |||||||||||
| 2876 | ParamTypes[Idx] = ParamType; | ||||||||||
| 2877 | } | ||||||||||
| 2878 | |||||||||||
| 2879 | if (EPI.ExtParameterInfos) { | ||||||||||
| 2880 | checkExtParameterInfos(*this, ParamTypes, EPI, | ||||||||||
| 2881 | [=](unsigned i) { return Loc; }); | ||||||||||
| 2882 | } | ||||||||||
| 2883 | |||||||||||
| 2884 | if (EPI.ExtInfo.getProducesResult()) { | ||||||||||
| 2885 | // This is just a warning, so we can't fail to build if we see it. | ||||||||||
| 2886 | checkNSReturnsRetainedReturnType(Loc, T); | ||||||||||
| 2887 | } | ||||||||||
| 2888 | |||||||||||
| 2889 | if (Invalid) | ||||||||||
| 2890 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2891 | |||||||||||
| 2892 | return Context.getFunctionType(T, ParamTypes, EPI); | ||||||||||
| 2893 | } | ||||||||||
| 2894 | |||||||||||
| 2895 | /// Build a member pointer type \c T Class::*. | ||||||||||
| 2896 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2897 | /// \param T the type to which the member pointer refers. | ||||||||||
| 2898 | /// \param Class the class type into which the member pointer points. | ||||||||||
| 2899 | /// \param Loc the location where this type begins | ||||||||||
| 2900 | /// \param Entity the name of the entity that will have this member pointer type | ||||||||||
| 2901 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2902 | /// \returns a member pointer type, if successful, or a NULL type if there was | ||||||||||
| 2903 | /// an error. | ||||||||||
| 2904 | QualType Sema::BuildMemberPointerType(QualType T, QualType Class, | ||||||||||
| 2905 | SourceLocation Loc, | ||||||||||
| 2906 | DeclarationName Entity) { | ||||||||||
| 2907 | // Verify that we're not building a pointer to pointer to function with | ||||||||||
| 2908 | // exception specification. | ||||||||||
| 2909 | if (CheckDistantExceptionSpec(T)) { | ||||||||||
| 2910 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_distant_exception_spec); | ||||||||||
| 2911 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2912 | } | ||||||||||
| 2913 | |||||||||||
| 2914 | // C++ 8.3.3p3: A pointer to member shall not point to ... a member | ||||||||||
| 2915 | // with reference type, or "cv void." | ||||||||||
| 2916 | if (T->isReferenceType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2917 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_illegal_decl_mempointer_to_reference) | ||||||||||
| 2918 | << getPrintableNameForEntity(Entity) << T; | ||||||||||
| 2919 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2920 | } | ||||||||||
| 2921 | |||||||||||
| 2922 | if (T->isVoidType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2923 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_illegal_decl_mempointer_to_void) | ||||||||||
| 2924 | << getPrintableNameForEntity(Entity); | ||||||||||
| 2925 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2926 | } | ||||||||||
| 2927 | |||||||||||
| 2928 | if (!Class->isDependentType() && !Class->isRecordType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2929 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_mempointer_in_nonclass_type) << Class; | ||||||||||
| 2930 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2931 | } | ||||||||||
| 2932 | |||||||||||
| 2933 | if (T->isFunctionType() && getLangOpts().OpenCL && | ||||||||||
| 2934 | !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers", | ||||||||||
| 2935 | getLangOpts())) { | ||||||||||
| 2936 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_function_pointer) << /*pointer*/ 0; | ||||||||||
| 2937 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2938 | } | ||||||||||
| 2939 | |||||||||||
| 2940 | // Adjust the default free function calling convention to the default method | ||||||||||
| 2941 | // calling convention. | ||||||||||
| 2942 | bool IsCtorOrDtor = | ||||||||||
| 2943 | (Entity.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) || | ||||||||||
| 2944 | (Entity.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName); | ||||||||||
| 2945 | if (T->isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 2946 | adjustMemberFunctionCC(T, /*IsStatic=*/false, IsCtorOrDtor, Loc); | ||||||||||
| 2947 | |||||||||||
| 2948 | return Context.getMemberPointerType(T, Class.getTypePtr()); | ||||||||||
| 2949 | } | ||||||||||
| 2950 | |||||||||||
| 2951 | /// Build a block pointer type. | ||||||||||
| 2952 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2953 | /// \param T The type to which we'll be building a block pointer. | ||||||||||
| 2954 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2955 | /// \param Loc The source location, used for diagnostics. | ||||||||||
| 2956 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2957 | /// \param Entity The name of the entity that involves the block pointer | ||||||||||
| 2958 | /// type, if known. | ||||||||||
| 2959 | /// | ||||||||||
| 2960 | /// \returns A suitable block pointer type, if there are no | ||||||||||
| 2961 | /// errors. Otherwise, returns a NULL type. | ||||||||||
| 2962 | QualType Sema::BuildBlockPointerType(QualType T, | ||||||||||
| 2963 | SourceLocation Loc, | ||||||||||
| 2964 | DeclarationName Entity) { | ||||||||||
| 2965 | if (!T->isFunctionType()) { | ||||||||||
| 2966 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_nonfunction_block_type); | ||||||||||
| 2967 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2968 | } | ||||||||||
| 2969 | |||||||||||
| 2970 | if (checkQualifiedFunction(*this, T, Loc, QFK_BlockPointer)) | ||||||||||
| 2971 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2972 | |||||||||||
| 2973 | if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) | ||||||||||
| 2974 | T = deduceOpenCLPointeeAddrSpace(*this, T); | ||||||||||
| 2975 | |||||||||||
| 2976 | return Context.getBlockPointerType(T); | ||||||||||
| 2977 | } | ||||||||||
| 2978 | |||||||||||
| 2979 | QualType Sema::GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType Ty, TypeSourceInfo **TInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 2980 | QualType QT = Ty.get(); | ||||||||||
| 2981 | if (QT.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 2982 | if (TInfo
| ||||||||||
| 2983 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 2984 | } | ||||||||||
| 2985 | |||||||||||
| 2986 | TypeSourceInfo *DI = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 2987 | if (const LocInfoType *LIT = dyn_cast<LocInfoType>(QT)) { | ||||||||||
| 2988 | QT = LIT->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 2989 | DI = LIT->getTypeSourceInfo(); | ||||||||||
| 2990 | } | ||||||||||
| 2991 | |||||||||||
| 2992 | if (TInfo) *TInfo = DI; | ||||||||||
| 2993 | return QT; | ||||||||||
| 2994 | } | ||||||||||
| 2995 | |||||||||||
| 2996 | static void transferARCOwnershipToDeclaratorChunk(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 2997 | Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ownership, | ||||||||||
| 2998 | unsigned chunkIndex); | ||||||||||
| 2999 | |||||||||||
| 3000 | /// Given that this is the declaration of a parameter under ARC, | ||||||||||
| 3001 | /// attempt to infer attributes and such for pointer-to-whatever | ||||||||||
| 3002 | /// types. | ||||||||||
| 3003 | static void inferARCWriteback(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 3004 | QualType &declSpecType) { | ||||||||||
| 3005 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 3006 | Declarator &declarator = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 3007 | |||||||||||
| 3008 | // TODO: should we care about decl qualifiers? | ||||||||||
| 3009 | |||||||||||
| 3010 | // Check whether the declarator has the expected form. We walk | ||||||||||
| 3011 | // from the inside out in order to make the block logic work. | ||||||||||
| 3012 | unsigned outermostPointerIndex = 0; | ||||||||||
| 3013 | bool isBlockPointer = false; | ||||||||||
| 3014 | unsigned numPointers = 0; | ||||||||||
| 3015 | for (unsigned i = 0, e = declarator.getNumTypeObjects(); i != e; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 3016 | unsigned chunkIndex = i; | ||||||||||
| 3017 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = declarator.getTypeObject(chunkIndex); | ||||||||||
| 3018 | switch (chunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 3019 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 3020 | // Ignore parens. | ||||||||||
| 3021 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3022 | |||||||||||
| 3023 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 3024 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 3025 | // Count the number of pointers. Treat references | ||||||||||
| 3026 | // interchangeably as pointers; if they're mis-ordered, normal | ||||||||||
| 3027 | // type building will discover that. | ||||||||||
| 3028 | outermostPointerIndex = chunkIndex; | ||||||||||
| 3029 | numPointers++; | ||||||||||
| 3030 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3031 | |||||||||||
| 3032 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 3033 | // If we have a pointer to block pointer, that's an acceptable | ||||||||||
| 3034 | // indirect reference; anything else is not an application of | ||||||||||
| 3035 | // the rules. | ||||||||||
| 3036 | if (numPointers != 1) return; | ||||||||||
| 3037 | numPointers++; | ||||||||||
| 3038 | outermostPointerIndex = chunkIndex; | ||||||||||
| 3039 | isBlockPointer = true; | ||||||||||
| 3040 | |||||||||||
| 3041 | // We don't care about pointer structure in return values here. | ||||||||||
| 3042 | goto done; | ||||||||||
| 3043 | |||||||||||
| 3044 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: // suppress if written (id[])? | ||||||||||
| 3045 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 3046 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 3047 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 3048 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3049 | } | ||||||||||
| 3050 | } | ||||||||||
| 3051 | done: | ||||||||||
| 3052 | |||||||||||
| 3053 | // If we have *one* pointer, then we want to throw the qualifier on | ||||||||||
| 3054 | // the declaration-specifiers, which means that it needs to be a | ||||||||||
| 3055 | // retainable object type. | ||||||||||
| 3056 | if (numPointers == 1) { | ||||||||||
| 3057 | // If it's not a retainable object type, the rule doesn't apply. | ||||||||||
| 3058 | if (!declSpecType->isObjCRetainableType()) return; | ||||||||||
| 3059 | |||||||||||
| 3060 | // If it already has lifetime, don't do anything. | ||||||||||
| 3061 | if (declSpecType.getObjCLifetime()) return; | ||||||||||
| 3062 | |||||||||||
| 3063 | // Otherwise, modify the type in-place. | ||||||||||
| 3064 | Qualifiers qs; | ||||||||||
| 3065 | |||||||||||
| 3066 | if (declSpecType->isObjCARCImplicitlyUnretainedType()) | ||||||||||
| 3067 | qs.addObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone); | ||||||||||
| 3068 | else | ||||||||||
| 3069 | qs.addObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); | ||||||||||
| 3070 | declSpecType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(declSpecType, qs); | ||||||||||
| 3071 | |||||||||||
| 3072 | // If we have *two* pointers, then we want to throw the qualifier on | ||||||||||
| 3073 | // the outermost pointer. | ||||||||||
| 3074 | } else if (numPointers == 2) { | ||||||||||
| 3075 | // If we don't have a block pointer, we need to check whether the | ||||||||||
| 3076 | // declaration-specifiers gave us something that will turn into a | ||||||||||
| 3077 | // retainable object pointer after we slap the first pointer on it. | ||||||||||
| 3078 | if (!isBlockPointer && !declSpecType->isObjCObjectType()) | ||||||||||
| 3079 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3080 | |||||||||||
| 3081 | // Look for an explicit lifetime attribute there. | ||||||||||
| 3082 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = declarator.getTypeObject(outermostPointerIndex); | ||||||||||
| 3083 | if (chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Pointer && | ||||||||||
| 3084 | chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer) | ||||||||||
| 3085 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3086 | for (const ParsedAttr &AL : chunk.getAttrs()) | ||||||||||
| 3087 | if (AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership) | ||||||||||
| 3088 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3089 | |||||||||||
| 3090 | transferARCOwnershipToDeclaratorChunk(state, Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing, | ||||||||||
| 3091 | outermostPointerIndex); | ||||||||||
| 3092 | |||||||||||
| 3093 | // Any other number of pointers/references does not trigger the rule. | ||||||||||
| 3094 | } else return; | ||||||||||
| 3095 | |||||||||||
| 3096 | // TODO: mark whether we did this inference? | ||||||||||
| 3097 | } | ||||||||||
| 3098 | |||||||||||
| 3099 | void Sema::diagnoseIgnoredQualifiers(unsigned DiagID, unsigned Quals, | ||||||||||
| 3100 | SourceLocation FallbackLoc, | ||||||||||
| 3101 | SourceLocation ConstQualLoc, | ||||||||||
| 3102 | SourceLocation VolatileQualLoc, | ||||||||||
| 3103 | SourceLocation RestrictQualLoc, | ||||||||||
| 3104 | SourceLocation AtomicQualLoc, | ||||||||||
| 3105 | SourceLocation UnalignedQualLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 3106 | if (!Quals) | ||||||||||
| 3107 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3108 | |||||||||||
| 3109 | struct Qual { | ||||||||||
| 3110 | const char *Name; | ||||||||||
| 3111 | unsigned Mask; | ||||||||||
| 3112 | SourceLocation Loc; | ||||||||||
| 3113 | } const QualKinds[5] = { | ||||||||||
| 3114 | { "const", DeclSpec::TQ_const, ConstQualLoc }, | ||||||||||
| 3115 | { "volatile", DeclSpec::TQ_volatile, VolatileQualLoc }, | ||||||||||
| 3116 | { "restrict", DeclSpec::TQ_restrict, RestrictQualLoc }, | ||||||||||
| 3117 | { "__unaligned", DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned, UnalignedQualLoc }, | ||||||||||
| 3118 | { "_Atomic", DeclSpec::TQ_atomic, AtomicQualLoc } | ||||||||||
| 3119 | }; | ||||||||||
| 3120 | |||||||||||
| 3121 | SmallString<32> QualStr; | ||||||||||
| 3122 | unsigned NumQuals = 0; | ||||||||||
| 3123 | SourceLocation Loc; | ||||||||||
| 3124 | FixItHint FixIts[5]; | ||||||||||
| 3125 | |||||||||||
| 3126 | // Build a string naming the redundant qualifiers. | ||||||||||
| 3127 | for (auto &E : QualKinds) { | ||||||||||
| 3128 | if (Quals & E.Mask) { | ||||||||||
| 3129 | if (!QualStr.empty()) QualStr += ' '; | ||||||||||
| 3130 | QualStr += E.Name; | ||||||||||
| 3131 | |||||||||||
| 3132 | // If we have a location for the qualifier, offer a fixit. | ||||||||||
| 3133 | SourceLocation QualLoc = E.Loc; | ||||||||||
| 3134 | if (QualLoc.isValid()) { | ||||||||||
| 3135 | FixIts[NumQuals] = FixItHint::CreateRemoval(QualLoc); | ||||||||||
| 3136 | if (Loc.isInvalid() || | ||||||||||
| 3137 | getSourceManager().isBeforeInTranslationUnit(QualLoc, Loc)) | ||||||||||
| 3138 | Loc = QualLoc; | ||||||||||
| 3139 | } | ||||||||||
| 3140 | |||||||||||
| 3141 | ++NumQuals; | ||||||||||
| 3142 | } | ||||||||||
| 3143 | } | ||||||||||
| 3144 | |||||||||||
| 3145 | Diag(Loc.isInvalid() ? FallbackLoc : Loc, DiagID) | ||||||||||
| 3146 | << QualStr << NumQuals << FixIts[0] << FixIts[1] << FixIts[2] << FixIts[3]; | ||||||||||
| 3147 | } | ||||||||||
| 3148 | |||||||||||
| 3149 | // Diagnose pointless type qualifiers on the return type of a function. | ||||||||||
| 3150 | static void diagnoseRedundantReturnTypeQualifiers(Sema &S, QualType RetTy, | ||||||||||
| 3151 | Declarator &D, | ||||||||||
| 3152 | unsigned FunctionChunkIndex) { | ||||||||||
| 3153 | const DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = | ||||||||||
| 3154 | D.getTypeObject(FunctionChunkIndex).Fun; | ||||||||||
| 3155 | if (FTI.hasTrailingReturnType()) { | ||||||||||
| 3156 | S.diagnoseIgnoredQualifiers(diag::warn_qual_return_type, | ||||||||||
| 3157 | RetTy.getLocalCVRQualifiers(), | ||||||||||
| 3158 | FTI.getTrailingReturnTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 3159 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3160 | } | ||||||||||
| 3161 | |||||||||||
| 3162 | for (unsigned OuterChunkIndex = FunctionChunkIndex + 1, | ||||||||||
| 3163 | End = D.getNumTypeObjects(); | ||||||||||
| 3164 | OuterChunkIndex != End; ++OuterChunkIndex) { | ||||||||||
| 3165 | DeclaratorChunk &OuterChunk = D.getTypeObject(OuterChunkIndex); | ||||||||||
| 3166 | switch (OuterChunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 3167 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 3168 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 3169 | |||||||||||
| 3170 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: { | ||||||||||
| 3171 | DeclaratorChunk::PointerTypeInfo &PTI = OuterChunk.Ptr; | ||||||||||
| 3172 | S.diagnoseIgnoredQualifiers( | ||||||||||
| 3173 | diag::warn_qual_return_type, | ||||||||||
| 3174 | PTI.TypeQuals, | ||||||||||
| 3175 | SourceLocation(), | ||||||||||
| 3176 | PTI.ConstQualLoc, | ||||||||||
| 3177 | PTI.VolatileQualLoc, | ||||||||||
| 3178 | PTI.RestrictQualLoc, | ||||||||||
| 3179 | PTI.AtomicQualLoc, | ||||||||||
| 3180 | PTI.UnalignedQualLoc); | ||||||||||
| 3181 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3182 | } | ||||||||||
| 3183 | |||||||||||
| 3184 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 3185 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 3186 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 3187 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 3188 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 3189 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 3190 | // FIXME: We can't currently provide an accurate source location and a | ||||||||||
| 3191 | // fix-it hint for these. | ||||||||||
| 3192 | unsigned AtomicQual = RetTy->isAtomicType() ? DeclSpec::TQ_atomic : 0; | ||||||||||
| 3193 | S.diagnoseIgnoredQualifiers(diag::warn_qual_return_type, | ||||||||||
| 3194 | RetTy.getCVRQualifiers() | AtomicQual, | ||||||||||
| 3195 | D.getIdentifierLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 3196 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3197 | } | ||||||||||
| 3198 | |||||||||||
| 3199 | llvm_unreachable("unknown declarator chunk kind")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 3200 | } | ||||||||||
| 3201 | |||||||||||
| 3202 | // If the qualifiers come from a conversion function type, don't diagnose | ||||||||||
| 3203 | // them -- they're not necessarily redundant, since such a conversion | ||||||||||
| 3204 | // operator can be explicitly called as "x.operator const int()". | ||||||||||
| 3205 | if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId) | ||||||||||
| 3206 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3207 | |||||||||||
| 3208 | // Just parens all the way out to the decl specifiers. Diagnose any qualifiers | ||||||||||
| 3209 | // which are present there. | ||||||||||
| 3210 | S.diagnoseIgnoredQualifiers(diag::warn_qual_return_type, | ||||||||||
| 3211 | D.getDeclSpec().getTypeQualifiers(), | ||||||||||
| 3212 | D.getIdentifierLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 3213 | D.getDeclSpec().getConstSpecLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 3214 | D.getDeclSpec().getVolatileSpecLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 3215 | D.getDeclSpec().getRestrictSpecLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 3216 | D.getDeclSpec().getAtomicSpecLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 3217 | D.getDeclSpec().getUnalignedSpecLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 3218 | } | ||||||||||
| 3219 | |||||||||||
| 3220 | static std::pair<QualType, TypeSourceInfo *> | ||||||||||
| 3221 | InventTemplateParameter(TypeProcessingState &state, QualType T, | ||||||||||
| 3222 | TypeSourceInfo *TrailingTSI, AutoType *Auto, | ||||||||||
| 3223 | InventedTemplateParameterInfo &Info) { | ||||||||||
| 3224 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 3225 | Declarator &D = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 3226 | |||||||||||
| 3227 | const unsigned TemplateParameterDepth = Info.AutoTemplateParameterDepth; | ||||||||||
| 3228 | const unsigned AutoParameterPosition = Info.TemplateParams.size(); | ||||||||||
| 3229 | const bool IsParameterPack = D.hasEllipsis(); | ||||||||||
| 3230 | |||||||||||
| 3231 | // If auto is mentioned in a lambda parameter or abbreviated function | ||||||||||
| 3232 | // template context, convert it to a template parameter type. | ||||||||||
| 3233 | |||||||||||
| 3234 | // Create the TemplateTypeParmDecl here to retrieve the corresponding | ||||||||||
| 3235 | // template parameter type. Template parameters are temporarily added | ||||||||||
| 3236 | // to the TU until the associated TemplateDecl is created. | ||||||||||
| 3237 | TemplateTypeParmDecl *InventedTemplateParam = | ||||||||||
| 3238 | TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create( | ||||||||||
| 3239 | S.Context, S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), | ||||||||||
| 3240 | /*KeyLoc=*/D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 3241 | /*NameLoc=*/D.getIdentifierLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 3242 | TemplateParameterDepth, AutoParameterPosition, | ||||||||||
| 3243 | S.InventAbbreviatedTemplateParameterTypeName( | ||||||||||
| 3244 | D.getIdentifier(), AutoParameterPosition), false, | ||||||||||
| 3245 | IsParameterPack, /*HasTypeConstraint=*/Auto->isConstrained()); | ||||||||||
| 3246 | InventedTemplateParam->setImplicit(); | ||||||||||
| 3247 | Info.TemplateParams.push_back(InventedTemplateParam); | ||||||||||
| 3248 | |||||||||||
| 3249 | // Attach type constraints to the new parameter. | ||||||||||
| 3250 | if (Auto->isConstrained()) { | ||||||||||
| 3251 | if (TrailingTSI) { | ||||||||||
| 3252 | // The 'auto' appears in a trailing return type we've already built; | ||||||||||
| 3253 | // extract its type constraints to attach to the template parameter. | ||||||||||
| 3254 | AutoTypeLoc AutoLoc = TrailingTSI->getTypeLoc().getContainedAutoTypeLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 3255 | TemplateArgumentListInfo TAL(AutoLoc.getLAngleLoc(), AutoLoc.getRAngleLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 3256 | bool Invalid = false; | ||||||||||
| 3257 | for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < AutoLoc.getNumArgs(); ++Idx) { | ||||||||||
| 3258 | if (D.getEllipsisLoc().isInvalid() && !Invalid && | ||||||||||
| 3259 | S.DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(AutoLoc.getArgLoc(Idx), | ||||||||||
| 3260 | Sema::UPPC_TypeConstraint)) | ||||||||||
| 3261 | Invalid = true; | ||||||||||
| 3262 | TAL.addArgument(AutoLoc.getArgLoc(Idx)); | ||||||||||
| 3263 | } | ||||||||||
| 3264 | |||||||||||
| 3265 | if (!Invalid) { | ||||||||||
| 3266 | S.AttachTypeConstraint( | ||||||||||
| 3267 | AutoLoc.getNestedNameSpecifierLoc(), AutoLoc.getConceptNameInfo(), | ||||||||||
| 3268 | AutoLoc.getNamedConcept(), | ||||||||||
| 3269 | AutoLoc.hasExplicitTemplateArgs() ? &TAL : nullptr, | ||||||||||
| 3270 | InventedTemplateParam, D.getEllipsisLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 3271 | } | ||||||||||
| 3272 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 3273 | // The 'auto' appears in the decl-specifiers; we've not finished forming | ||||||||||
| 3274 | // TypeSourceInfo for it yet. | ||||||||||
| 3275 | TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsTemplateId(); | ||||||||||
| 3276 | TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsInfo; | ||||||||||
| 3277 | bool Invalid = false; | ||||||||||
| 3278 | if (TemplateId->LAngleLoc.isValid()) { | ||||||||||
| 3279 | ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), | ||||||||||
| 3280 | TemplateId->NumArgs); | ||||||||||
| 3281 | S.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, TemplateArgsInfo); | ||||||||||
| 3282 | |||||||||||
| 3283 | if (D.getEllipsisLoc().isInvalid()) { | ||||||||||
| 3284 | for (TemplateArgumentLoc Arg : TemplateArgsInfo.arguments()) { | ||||||||||
| 3285 | if (S.DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Arg, | ||||||||||
| 3286 | Sema::UPPC_TypeConstraint)) { | ||||||||||
| 3287 | Invalid = true; | ||||||||||
| 3288 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3289 | } | ||||||||||
| 3290 | } | ||||||||||
| 3291 | } | ||||||||||
| 3292 | } | ||||||||||
| 3293 | if (!Invalid) { | ||||||||||
| 3294 | S.AttachTypeConstraint( | ||||||||||
| 3295 | D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecScope().getWithLocInContext(S.Context), | ||||||||||
| 3296 | DeclarationNameInfo(DeclarationName(TemplateId->Name), | ||||||||||
| 3297 | TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc), | ||||||||||
| 3298 | cast<ConceptDecl>(TemplateId->Template.get().getAsTemplateDecl()), | ||||||||||
| 3299 | TemplateId->LAngleLoc.isValid() ? &TemplateArgsInfo : nullptr, | ||||||||||
| 3300 | InventedTemplateParam, D.getEllipsisLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 3301 | } | ||||||||||
| 3302 | } | ||||||||||
| 3303 | } | ||||||||||
| 3304 | |||||||||||
| 3305 | // Replace the 'auto' in the function parameter with this invented | ||||||||||
| 3306 | // template type parameter. | ||||||||||
| 3307 | // FIXME: Retain some type sugar to indicate that this was written | ||||||||||
| 3308 | // as 'auto'? | ||||||||||
| 3309 | QualType Replacement(InventedTemplateParam->getTypeForDecl(), 0); | ||||||||||
| 3310 | QualType NewT = state.ReplaceAutoType(T, Replacement); | ||||||||||
| 3311 | TypeSourceInfo *NewTSI = | ||||||||||
| 3312 | TrailingTSI ? S.ReplaceAutoTypeSourceInfo(TrailingTSI, Replacement) | ||||||||||
| 3313 | : nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 3314 | return {NewT, NewTSI}; | ||||||||||
| 3315 | } | ||||||||||
| 3316 | |||||||||||
| 3317 | static TypeSourceInfo * | ||||||||||
| 3318 | GetTypeSourceInfoForDeclarator(TypeProcessingState &State, | ||||||||||
| 3319 | QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *ReturnTypeInfo); | ||||||||||
| 3320 | |||||||||||
| 3321 | static QualType GetDeclSpecTypeForDeclarator(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 3322 | TypeSourceInfo *&ReturnTypeInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 3323 | Sema &SemaRef = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 3324 | Declarator &D = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 3325 | QualType T; | ||||||||||
| 3326 | ReturnTypeInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 3327 | |||||||||||
| 3328 | // The TagDecl owned by the DeclSpec. | ||||||||||
| 3329 | TagDecl *OwnedTagDecl = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 3330 | |||||||||||
| 3331 | switch (D.getName().getKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 3332 | case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: | ||||||||||
| 3333 | case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: | ||||||||||
| 3334 | case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: | ||||||||||
| 3335 | case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: | ||||||||||
| 3336 | case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: | ||||||||||
| 3337 | T = ConvertDeclSpecToType(state); | ||||||||||
| 3338 | |||||||||||
| 3339 | if (!D.isInvalidType() && D.getDeclSpec().isTypeSpecOwned()) { | ||||||||||
| 3340 | OwnedTagDecl = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl()); | ||||||||||
| 3341 | // Owned declaration is embedded in declarator. | ||||||||||
| 3342 | OwnedTagDecl->setEmbeddedInDeclarator(true); | ||||||||||
| 3343 | } | ||||||||||
| 3344 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3345 | |||||||||||
| 3346 | case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: | ||||||||||
| 3347 | case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: | ||||||||||
| 3348 | case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: | ||||||||||
| 3349 | // Constructors and destructors don't have return types. Use | ||||||||||
| 3350 | // "void" instead. | ||||||||||
| 3351 | T = SemaRef.Context.VoidTy; | ||||||||||
| 3352 | processTypeAttrs(state, T, TAL_DeclSpec, | ||||||||||
| 3353 | D.getMutableDeclSpec().getAttributes()); | ||||||||||
| 3354 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3355 | |||||||||||
| 3356 | case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: | ||||||||||
| 3357 | // Deduction guides have a trailing return type and no type in their | ||||||||||
| 3358 | // decl-specifier sequence. Use a placeholder return type for now. | ||||||||||
| 3359 | T = SemaRef.Context.DependentTy; | ||||||||||
| 3360 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3361 | |||||||||||
| 3362 | case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: | ||||||||||
| 3363 | // The result type of a conversion function is the type that it | ||||||||||
| 3364 | // converts to. | ||||||||||
| 3365 | T = SemaRef.GetTypeFromParser(D.getName().ConversionFunctionId, | ||||||||||
| 3366 | &ReturnTypeInfo); | ||||||||||
| 3367 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3368 | } | ||||||||||
| 3369 | |||||||||||
| 3370 | if (!D.getAttributes().empty()) | ||||||||||
| 3371 | distributeTypeAttrsFromDeclarator(state, T); | ||||||||||
| 3372 | |||||||||||
| 3373 | // Find the deduced type in this type. Look in the trailing return type if we | ||||||||||
| 3374 | // have one, otherwise in the DeclSpec type. | ||||||||||
| 3375 | // FIXME: The standard wording doesn't currently describe this. | ||||||||||
| 3376 | DeducedType *Deduced = T->getContainedDeducedType(); | ||||||||||
| 3377 | bool DeducedIsTrailingReturnType = false; | ||||||||||
| 3378 | if (Deduced && isa<AutoType>(Deduced) && D.hasTrailingReturnType()) { | ||||||||||
| 3379 | QualType T = SemaRef.GetTypeFromParser(D.getTrailingReturnType()); | ||||||||||
| 3380 | Deduced = T.isNull() ? nullptr : T->getContainedDeducedType(); | ||||||||||
| 3381 | DeducedIsTrailingReturnType = true; | ||||||||||
| 3382 | } | ||||||||||
| 3383 | |||||||||||
| 3384 | // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p5: reject 'auto' if it is not in an allowed context. | ||||||||||
| 3385 | if (Deduced) { | ||||||||||
| 3386 | AutoType *Auto = dyn_cast<AutoType>(Deduced); | ||||||||||
| 3387 | int Error = -1; | ||||||||||
| 3388 | |||||||||||
| 3389 | // Is this a 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)' type (as opposed to __auto_type or | ||||||||||
| 3390 | // class template argument deduction)? | ||||||||||
| 3391 | bool IsCXXAutoType = | ||||||||||
| 3392 | (Auto && Auto->getKeyword() != AutoTypeKeyword::GNUAutoType); | ||||||||||
| 3393 | bool IsDeducedReturnType = false; | ||||||||||
| 3394 | |||||||||||
| 3395 | switch (D.getContext()) { | ||||||||||
| 3396 | case DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr: | ||||||||||
| 3397 | // Declared return type of a lambda-declarator is implicit and is always | ||||||||||
| 3398 | // 'auto'. | ||||||||||
| 3399 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3400 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCParameter: | ||||||||||
| 3401 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCResult: | ||||||||||
| 3402 | Error = 0; | ||||||||||
| 3403 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3404 | case DeclaratorContext::RequiresExpr: | ||||||||||
| 3405 | Error = 22; | ||||||||||
| 3406 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3407 | case DeclaratorContext::Prototype: | ||||||||||
| 3408 | case DeclaratorContext::LambdaExprParameter: { | ||||||||||
| 3409 | InventedTemplateParameterInfo *Info = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 3410 | if (D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::Prototype) { | ||||||||||
| 3411 | // With concepts we allow 'auto' in function parameters. | ||||||||||
| 3412 | if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 || !Auto || | ||||||||||
| 3413 | Auto->getKeyword() != AutoTypeKeyword::Auto) { | ||||||||||
| 3414 | Error = 0; | ||||||||||
| 3415 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3416 | } else if (!SemaRef.getCurScope()->isFunctionDeclarationScope()) { | ||||||||||
| 3417 | Error = 21; | ||||||||||
| 3418 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3419 | } | ||||||||||
| 3420 | |||||||||||
| 3421 | Info = &SemaRef.InventedParameterInfos.back(); | ||||||||||
| 3422 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 3423 | // In C++14, generic lambdas allow 'auto' in their parameters. | ||||||||||
| 3424 | if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 || !Auto || | ||||||||||
| 3425 | Auto->getKeyword() != AutoTypeKeyword::Auto) { | ||||||||||
| 3426 | Error = 16; | ||||||||||
| 3427 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3428 | } | ||||||||||
| 3429 | Info = SemaRef.getCurLambda(); | ||||||||||
| 3430 | assert(Info && "No LambdaScopeInfo on the stack!")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 3431 | } | ||||||||||
| 3432 | |||||||||||
| 3433 | // We'll deal with inventing template parameters for 'auto' in trailing | ||||||||||
| 3434 | // return types when we pick up the trailing return type when processing | ||||||||||
| 3435 | // the function chunk. | ||||||||||
| 3436 | if (!DeducedIsTrailingReturnType) | ||||||||||
| 3437 | T = InventTemplateParameter(state, T, nullptr, Auto, *Info).first; | ||||||||||
| 3438 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3439 | } | ||||||||||
| 3440 | case DeclaratorContext::Member: { | ||||||||||
| 3441 | if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_static || | ||||||||||
| 3442 | D.isFunctionDeclarator()) | ||||||||||
| 3443 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3444 | bool Cxx = SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; | ||||||||||
| 3445 | if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) { | ||||||||||
| 3446 | Error = 6; // Interface member. | ||||||||||
| 3447 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 3448 | switch (cast<TagDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->getTagKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 3449 | case TTK_Enum: llvm_unreachable("unhandled tag kind")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 3450 | case TTK_Struct: Error = Cxx ? 1 : 2; /* Struct member */ break; | ||||||||||
| 3451 | case TTK_Union: Error = Cxx ? 3 : 4; /* Union member */ break; | ||||||||||
| 3452 | case TTK_Class: Error = 5; /* Class member */ break; | ||||||||||
| 3453 | case TTK_Interface: Error = 6; /* Interface member */ break; | ||||||||||
| 3454 | } | ||||||||||
| 3455 | } | ||||||||||
| 3456 | if (D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) | ||||||||||
| 3457 | Error = 20; // Friend type | ||||||||||
| 3458 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3459 | } | ||||||||||
| 3460 | case DeclaratorContext::CXXCatch: | ||||||||||
| 3461 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCCatch: | ||||||||||
| 3462 | Error = 7; // Exception declaration | ||||||||||
| 3463 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3464 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateParam: | ||||||||||
| 3465 | if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) && | ||||||||||
| 3466 | !SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) | ||||||||||
| 3467 | Error = 19; // Template parameter (until C++20) | ||||||||||
| 3468 | else if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) | ||||||||||
| 3469 | Error = 8; // Template parameter (until C++17) | ||||||||||
| 3470 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3471 | case DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteral: | ||||||||||
| 3472 | Error = 9; // Block literal | ||||||||||
| 3473 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3474 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateArg: | ||||||||||
| 3475 | // Within a template argument list, a deduced template specialization | ||||||||||
| 3476 | // type will be reinterpreted as a template template argument. | ||||||||||
| 3477 | if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) && | ||||||||||
| 3478 | !D.getNumTypeObjects() && | ||||||||||
| 3479 | D.getDeclSpec().getParsedSpecifiers() == DeclSpec::PQ_TypeSpecifier) | ||||||||||
| 3480 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3481 | LLVM_FALLTHROUGH[[gnu::fallthrough]]; | ||||||||||
| 3482 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateTypeArg: | ||||||||||
| 3483 | Error = 10; // Template type argument | ||||||||||
| 3484 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3485 | case DeclaratorContext::AliasDecl: | ||||||||||
| 3486 | case DeclaratorContext::AliasTemplate: | ||||||||||
| 3487 | Error = 12; // Type alias | ||||||||||
| 3488 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3489 | case DeclaratorContext::TrailingReturn: | ||||||||||
| 3490 | case DeclaratorContext::TrailingReturnVar: | ||||||||||
| 3491 | if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 || !IsCXXAutoType) | ||||||||||
| 3492 | Error = 13; // Function return type | ||||||||||
| 3493 | IsDeducedReturnType = true; | ||||||||||
| 3494 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3495 | case DeclaratorContext::ConversionId: | ||||||||||
| 3496 | if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 || !IsCXXAutoType) | ||||||||||
| 3497 | Error = 14; // conversion-type-id | ||||||||||
| 3498 | IsDeducedReturnType = true; | ||||||||||
| 3499 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3500 | case DeclaratorContext::FunctionalCast: | ||||||||||
| 3501 | if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) | ||||||||||
| 3502 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3503 | LLVM_FALLTHROUGH[[gnu::fallthrough]]; | ||||||||||
| 3504 | case DeclaratorContext::TypeName: | ||||||||||
| 3505 | Error = 15; // Generic | ||||||||||
| 3506 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3507 | case DeclaratorContext::File: | ||||||||||
| 3508 | case DeclaratorContext::Block: | ||||||||||
| 3509 | case DeclaratorContext::ForInit: | ||||||||||
| 3510 | case DeclaratorContext::SelectionInit: | ||||||||||
| 3511 | case DeclaratorContext::Condition: | ||||||||||
| 3512 | // FIXME: P0091R3 (erroneously) does not permit class template argument | ||||||||||
| 3513 | // deduction in conditions, for-init-statements, and other declarations | ||||||||||
| 3514 | // that are not simple-declarations. | ||||||||||
| 3515 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3516 | case DeclaratorContext::CXXNew: | ||||||||||
| 3517 | // FIXME: P0091R3 does not permit class template argument deduction here, | ||||||||||
| 3518 | // but we follow GCC and allow it anyway. | ||||||||||
| 3519 | if (!IsCXXAutoType && !isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) | ||||||||||
| 3520 | Error = 17; // 'new' type | ||||||||||
| 3521 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3522 | case DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList: | ||||||||||
| 3523 | Error = 18; // K&R function parameter | ||||||||||
| 3524 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3525 | } | ||||||||||
| 3526 | |||||||||||
| 3527 | if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) | ||||||||||
| 3528 | Error = 11; | ||||||||||
| 3529 | |||||||||||
| 3530 | // In Objective-C it is an error to use 'auto' on a function declarator | ||||||||||
| 3531 | // (and everywhere for '__auto_type'). | ||||||||||
| 3532 | if (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && | ||||||||||
| 3533 | (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 || !IsCXXAutoType)) | ||||||||||
| 3534 | Error = 13; | ||||||||||
| 3535 | |||||||||||
| 3536 | SourceRange AutoRange = D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 3537 | if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId) | ||||||||||
| 3538 | AutoRange = D.getName().getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 3539 | |||||||||||
| 3540 | if (Error != -1) { | ||||||||||
| 3541 | unsigned Kind; | ||||||||||
| 3542 | if (Auto) { | ||||||||||
| 3543 | switch (Auto->getKeyword()) { | ||||||||||
| 3544 | case AutoTypeKeyword::Auto: Kind = 0; break; | ||||||||||
| 3545 | case AutoTypeKeyword::DecltypeAuto: Kind = 1; break; | ||||||||||
| 3546 | case AutoTypeKeyword::GNUAutoType: Kind = 2; break; | ||||||||||
| 3547 | } | ||||||||||
| 3548 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 3549 | assert(isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 3550 | "unknown auto type")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 3551 | Kind = 3; | ||||||||||
| 3552 | } | ||||||||||
| 3553 | |||||||||||
| 3554 | auto *DTST = dyn_cast<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced); | ||||||||||
| 3555 | TemplateName TN = DTST ? DTST->getTemplateName() : TemplateName(); | ||||||||||
| 3556 | |||||||||||
| 3557 | SemaRef.Diag(AutoRange.getBegin(), diag::err_auto_not_allowed) | ||||||||||
| 3558 | << Kind << Error << (int)SemaRef.getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TN) | ||||||||||
| 3559 | << QualType(Deduced, 0) << AutoRange; | ||||||||||
| 3560 | if (auto *TD = TN.getAsTemplateDecl()) | ||||||||||
| 3561 | SemaRef.Diag(TD->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here); | ||||||||||
| 3562 | |||||||||||
| 3563 | T = SemaRef.Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 3564 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 3565 | } else if (Auto && D.getContext() != DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr) { | ||||||||||
| 3566 | // If there was a trailing return type, we already got | ||||||||||
| 3567 | // warn_cxx98_compat_trailing_return_type in the parser. | ||||||||||
| 3568 | SemaRef.Diag(AutoRange.getBegin(), | ||||||||||
| 3569 | D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::LambdaExprParameter | ||||||||||
| 3570 | ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_generic_lambda | ||||||||||
| 3571 | : IsDeducedReturnType | ||||||||||
| 3572 | ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_deduced_return_type | ||||||||||
| 3573 | : diag::warn_cxx98_compat_auto_type_specifier) | ||||||||||
| 3574 | << AutoRange; | ||||||||||
| 3575 | } | ||||||||||
| 3576 | } | ||||||||||
| 3577 | |||||||||||
| 3578 | if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && | ||||||||||
| 3579 | OwnedTagDecl && OwnedTagDecl->isCompleteDefinition()) { | ||||||||||
| 3580 | // Check the contexts where C++ forbids the declaration of a new class | ||||||||||
| 3581 | // or enumeration in a type-specifier-seq. | ||||||||||
| 3582 | unsigned DiagID = 0; | ||||||||||
| 3583 | switch (D.getContext()) { | ||||||||||
| 3584 | case DeclaratorContext::TrailingReturn: | ||||||||||
| 3585 | case DeclaratorContext::TrailingReturnVar: | ||||||||||
| 3586 | // Class and enumeration definitions are syntactically not allowed in | ||||||||||
| 3587 | // trailing return types. | ||||||||||
| 3588 | llvm_unreachable("parser should not have allowed this")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 3589 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3590 | case DeclaratorContext::File: | ||||||||||
| 3591 | case DeclaratorContext::Member: | ||||||||||
| 3592 | case DeclaratorContext::Block: | ||||||||||
| 3593 | case DeclaratorContext::ForInit: | ||||||||||
| 3594 | case DeclaratorContext::SelectionInit: | ||||||||||
| 3595 | case DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteral: | ||||||||||
| 3596 | case DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr: | ||||||||||
| 3597 | // C++11 [dcl.type]p3: | ||||||||||
| 3598 | // A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration unless | ||||||||||
| 3599 | // it appears in the type-id of an alias-declaration (7.1.3) that is not | ||||||||||
| 3600 | // the declaration of a template-declaration. | ||||||||||
| 3601 | case DeclaratorContext::AliasDecl: | ||||||||||
| 3602 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3603 | case DeclaratorContext::AliasTemplate: | ||||||||||
| 3604 | DiagID = diag::err_type_defined_in_alias_template; | ||||||||||
| 3605 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3606 | case DeclaratorContext::TypeName: | ||||||||||
| 3607 | case DeclaratorContext::FunctionalCast: | ||||||||||
| 3608 | case DeclaratorContext::ConversionId: | ||||||||||
| 3609 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateParam: | ||||||||||
| 3610 | case DeclaratorContext::CXXNew: | ||||||||||
| 3611 | case DeclaratorContext::CXXCatch: | ||||||||||
| 3612 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCCatch: | ||||||||||
| 3613 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateArg: | ||||||||||
| 3614 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateTypeArg: | ||||||||||
| 3615 | DiagID = diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier; | ||||||||||
| 3616 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3617 | case DeclaratorContext::Prototype: | ||||||||||
| 3618 | case DeclaratorContext::LambdaExprParameter: | ||||||||||
| 3619 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCParameter: | ||||||||||
| 3620 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCResult: | ||||||||||
| 3621 | case DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList: | ||||||||||
| 3622 | case DeclaratorContext::RequiresExpr: | ||||||||||
| 3623 | // C++ [dcl.fct]p6: | ||||||||||
| 3624 | // Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types. | ||||||||||
| 3625 | DiagID = diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type; | ||||||||||
| 3626 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3627 | case DeclaratorContext::Condition: | ||||||||||
| 3628 | // C++ 6.4p2: | ||||||||||
| 3629 | // The type-specifier-seq shall not contain typedef and shall not declare | ||||||||||
| 3630 | // a new class or enumeration. | ||||||||||
| 3631 | DiagID = diag::err_type_defined_in_condition; | ||||||||||
| 3632 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3633 | } | ||||||||||
| 3634 | |||||||||||
| 3635 | if (DiagID != 0) { | ||||||||||
| 3636 | SemaRef.Diag(OwnedTagDecl->getLocation(), DiagID) | ||||||||||
| 3637 | << SemaRef.Context.getTypeDeclType(OwnedTagDecl); | ||||||||||
| 3638 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 3639 | } | ||||||||||
| 3640 | } | ||||||||||
| 3641 | |||||||||||
| 3642 | assert(!T.isNull() && "This function should not return a null type")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 3643 | return T; | ||||||||||
| 3644 | } | ||||||||||
| 3645 | |||||||||||
| 3646 | /// Produce an appropriate diagnostic for an ambiguity between a function | ||||||||||
| 3647 | /// declarator and a C++ direct-initializer. | ||||||||||
| 3648 | static void warnAboutAmbiguousFunction(Sema &S, Declarator &D, | ||||||||||
| 3649 | DeclaratorChunk &DeclType, QualType RT) { | ||||||||||
| 3650 | const DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = DeclType.Fun; | ||||||||||
| 3651 | assert(FTI.isAmbiguous && "no direct-initializer / function ambiguity")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 3652 | |||||||||||
| 3653 | // If the return type is void there is no ambiguity. | ||||||||||
| 3654 | if (RT->isVoidType()) | ||||||||||
| 3655 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3656 | |||||||||||
| 3657 | // An initializer for a non-class type can have at most one argument. | ||||||||||
| 3658 | if (!RT->isRecordType() && FTI.NumParams > 1) | ||||||||||
| 3659 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3660 | |||||||||||
| 3661 | // An initializer for a reference must have exactly one argument. | ||||||||||
| 3662 | if (RT->isReferenceType() && FTI.NumParams != 1) | ||||||||||
| 3663 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3664 | |||||||||||
| 3665 | // Only warn if this declarator is declaring a function at block scope, and | ||||||||||
| 3666 | // doesn't have a storage class (such as 'extern') specified. | ||||||||||
| 3667 | if (!D.isFunctionDeclarator() || | ||||||||||
| 3668 | D.getFunctionDefinitionKind() != FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration || | ||||||||||
| 3669 | !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || | ||||||||||
| 3670 | D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) | ||||||||||
| 3671 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3672 | |||||||||||
| 3673 | // Inside a condition, a direct initializer is not permitted. We allow one to | ||||||||||
| 3674 | // be parsed in order to give better diagnostics in condition parsing. | ||||||||||
| 3675 | if (D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::Condition) | ||||||||||
| 3676 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3677 | |||||||||||
| 3678 | SourceRange ParenRange(DeclType.Loc, DeclType.EndLoc); | ||||||||||
| 3679 | |||||||||||
| 3680 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, | ||||||||||
| 3681 | FTI.NumParams ? diag::warn_parens_disambiguated_as_function_declaration | ||||||||||
| 3682 | : diag::warn_empty_parens_are_function_decl) | ||||||||||
| 3683 | << ParenRange; | ||||||||||
| 3684 | |||||||||||
| 3685 | // If the declaration looks like: | ||||||||||
| 3686 | // T var1, | ||||||||||
| 3687 | // f(); | ||||||||||
| 3688 | // and name lookup finds a function named 'f', then the ',' was | ||||||||||
| 3689 | // probably intended to be a ';'. | ||||||||||
| 3690 | if (!D.isFirstDeclarator() && D.getIdentifier()) { | ||||||||||
| 3691 | FullSourceLoc Comma(D.getCommaLoc(), S.SourceMgr); | ||||||||||
| 3692 | FullSourceLoc Name(D.getIdentifierLoc(), S.SourceMgr); | ||||||||||
| 3693 | if (Comma.getFileID() != Name.getFileID() || | ||||||||||
| 3694 | Comma.getSpellingLineNumber() != Name.getSpellingLineNumber()) { | ||||||||||
| 3695 | LookupResult Result(S, D.getIdentifier(), SourceLocation(), | ||||||||||
| 3696 | Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); | ||||||||||
| 3697 | if (S.LookupName(Result, S.getCurScope())) | ||||||||||
| 3698 | S.Diag(D.getCommaLoc(), diag::note_empty_parens_function_call) | ||||||||||
| 3699 | << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(D.getCommaLoc(), ";") | ||||||||||
| 3700 | << D.getIdentifier(); | ||||||||||
| 3701 | Result.suppressDiagnostics(); | ||||||||||
| 3702 | } | ||||||||||
| 3703 | } | ||||||||||
| 3704 | |||||||||||
| 3705 | if (FTI.NumParams > 0) { | ||||||||||
| 3706 | // For a declaration with parameters, eg. "T var(T());", suggest adding | ||||||||||
| 3707 | // parens around the first parameter to turn the declaration into a | ||||||||||
| 3708 | // variable declaration. | ||||||||||
| 3709 | SourceRange Range = FTI.Params[0].Param->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 3710 | SourceLocation B = Range.getBegin(); | ||||||||||
| 3711 | SourceLocation E = S.getLocForEndOfToken(Range.getEnd()); | ||||||||||
| 3712 | // FIXME: Maybe we should suggest adding braces instead of parens | ||||||||||
| 3713 | // in C++11 for classes that don't have an initializer_list constructor. | ||||||||||
| 3714 | S.Diag(B, diag::note_additional_parens_for_variable_declaration) | ||||||||||
| 3715 | << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(B, "(") | ||||||||||
| 3716 | << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(E, ")"); | ||||||||||
| 3717 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 3718 | // For a declaration without parameters, eg. "T var();", suggest replacing | ||||||||||
| 3719 | // the parens with an initializer to turn the declaration into a variable | ||||||||||
| 3720 | // declaration. | ||||||||||
| 3721 | const CXXRecordDecl *RD = RT->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); | ||||||||||
| 3722 | |||||||||||
| 3723 | // Empty parens mean value-initialization, and no parens mean | ||||||||||
| 3724 | // default initialization. These are equivalent if the default | ||||||||||
| 3725 | // constructor is user-provided or if zero-initialization is a | ||||||||||
| 3726 | // no-op. | ||||||||||
| 3727 | if (RD && RD->hasDefinition() && | ||||||||||
| 3728 | (RD->isEmpty() || RD->hasUserProvidedDefaultConstructor())) | ||||||||||
| 3729 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::note_empty_parens_default_ctor) | ||||||||||
| 3730 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenRange); | ||||||||||
| 3731 | else { | ||||||||||
| 3732 | std::string Init = | ||||||||||
| 3733 | S.getFixItZeroInitializerForType(RT, ParenRange.getBegin()); | ||||||||||
| 3734 | if (Init.empty() && S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus11) | ||||||||||
| 3735 | Init = "{}"; | ||||||||||
| 3736 | if (!Init.empty()) | ||||||||||
| 3737 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::note_empty_parens_zero_initialize) | ||||||||||
| 3738 | << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(ParenRange, Init); | ||||||||||
| 3739 | } | ||||||||||
| 3740 | } | ||||||||||
| 3741 | } | ||||||||||
| 3742 | |||||||||||
| 3743 | /// Produce an appropriate diagnostic for a declarator with top-level | ||||||||||
| 3744 | /// parentheses. | ||||||||||
| 3745 | static void warnAboutRedundantParens(Sema &S, Declarator &D, QualType T) { | ||||||||||
| 3746 | DeclaratorChunk &Paren = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1); | ||||||||||
| 3747 | assert(Paren.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Paren &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 3748 | "do not have redundant top-level parentheses")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 3749 | |||||||||||
| 3750 | // This is a syntactic check; we're not interested in cases that arise | ||||||||||
| 3751 | // during template instantiation. | ||||||||||
| 3752 | if (S.inTemplateInstantiation()) | ||||||||||
| 3753 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3754 | |||||||||||
| 3755 | // Check whether this could be intended to be a construction of a temporary | ||||||||||
| 3756 | // object in C++ via a function-style cast. | ||||||||||
| 3757 | bool CouldBeTemporaryObject = | ||||||||||
| 3758 | S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.isExpressionContext() && | ||||||||||
| 3759 | !D.isInvalidType() && D.getIdentifier() && | ||||||||||
| 3760 | D.getDeclSpec().getParsedSpecifiers() == DeclSpec::PQ_TypeSpecifier && | ||||||||||
| 3761 | (T->isRecordType() || T->isDependentType()) && | ||||||||||
| 3762 | D.getDeclSpec().getTypeQualifiers() == 0 && D.isFirstDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 3763 | |||||||||||
| 3764 | bool StartsWithDeclaratorId = true; | ||||||||||
| 3765 | for (auto &C : D.type_objects()) { | ||||||||||
| 3766 | switch (C.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 3767 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 3768 | if (&C == &Paren) | ||||||||||
| 3769 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 3770 | LLVM_FALLTHROUGH[[gnu::fallthrough]]; | ||||||||||
| 3771 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 3772 | StartsWithDeclaratorId = false; | ||||||||||
| 3773 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 3774 | |||||||||||
| 3775 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 3776 | if (!C.Arr.NumElts) | ||||||||||
| 3777 | CouldBeTemporaryObject = false; | ||||||||||
| 3778 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 3779 | |||||||||||
| 3780 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 3781 | // FIXME: Suppress the warning here if there is no initializer; we're | ||||||||||
| 3782 | // going to give an error anyway. | ||||||||||
| 3783 | // We assume that something like 'T (&x) = y;' is highly likely to not | ||||||||||
| 3784 | // be intended to be a temporary object. | ||||||||||
| 3785 | CouldBeTemporaryObject = false; | ||||||||||
| 3786 | StartsWithDeclaratorId = false; | ||||||||||
| 3787 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 3788 | |||||||||||
| 3789 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 3790 | // In a new-type-id, function chunks require parentheses. | ||||||||||
| 3791 | if (D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::CXXNew) | ||||||||||
| 3792 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3793 | // FIXME: "A(f())" deserves a vexing-parse warning, not just a | ||||||||||
| 3794 | // redundant-parens warning, but we don't know whether the function | ||||||||||
| 3795 | // chunk was syntactically valid as an expression here. | ||||||||||
| 3796 | CouldBeTemporaryObject = false; | ||||||||||
| 3797 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 3798 | |||||||||||
| 3799 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 3800 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 3801 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 3802 | // These cannot appear in expressions. | ||||||||||
| 3803 | CouldBeTemporaryObject = false; | ||||||||||
| 3804 | StartsWithDeclaratorId = false; | ||||||||||
| 3805 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 3806 | } | ||||||||||
| 3807 | } | ||||||||||
| 3808 | |||||||||||
| 3809 | // FIXME: If there is an initializer, assume that this is not intended to be | ||||||||||
| 3810 | // a construction of a temporary object. | ||||||||||
| 3811 | |||||||||||
| 3812 | // Check whether the name has already been declared; if not, this is not a | ||||||||||
| 3813 | // function-style cast. | ||||||||||
| 3814 | if (CouldBeTemporaryObject) { | ||||||||||
| 3815 | LookupResult Result(S, D.getIdentifier(), SourceLocation(), | ||||||||||
| 3816 | Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); | ||||||||||
| 3817 | if (!S.LookupName(Result, S.getCurScope())) | ||||||||||
| 3818 | CouldBeTemporaryObject = false; | ||||||||||
| 3819 | Result.suppressDiagnostics(); | ||||||||||
| 3820 | } | ||||||||||
| 3821 | |||||||||||
| 3822 | SourceRange ParenRange(Paren.Loc, Paren.EndLoc); | ||||||||||
| 3823 | |||||||||||
| 3824 | if (!CouldBeTemporaryObject) { | ||||||||||
| 3825 | // If we have A (::B), the parentheses affect the meaning of the program. | ||||||||||
| 3826 | // Suppress the warning in that case. Don't bother looking at the DeclSpec | ||||||||||
| 3827 | // here: even (e.g.) "int ::x" is visually ambiguous even though it's | ||||||||||
| 3828 | // formally unambiguous. | ||||||||||
| 3829 | if (StartsWithDeclaratorId && D.getCXXScopeSpec().isValid()) { | ||||||||||
| 3830 | for (NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep(); NNS; | ||||||||||
| 3831 | NNS = NNS->getPrefix()) { | ||||||||||
| 3832 | if (NNS->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Global) | ||||||||||
| 3833 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3834 | } | ||||||||||
| 3835 | } | ||||||||||
| 3836 | |||||||||||
| 3837 | S.Diag(Paren.Loc, diag::warn_redundant_parens_around_declarator) | ||||||||||
| 3838 | << ParenRange << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(Paren.Loc) | ||||||||||
| 3839 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(Paren.EndLoc); | ||||||||||
| 3840 | return; | ||||||||||
| 3841 | } | ||||||||||
| 3842 | |||||||||||
| 3843 | S.Diag(Paren.Loc, diag::warn_parens_disambiguated_as_variable_declaration) | ||||||||||
| 3844 | << ParenRange << D.getIdentifier(); | ||||||||||
| 3845 | auto *RD = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); | ||||||||||
| 3846 | if (!RD || !RD->hasDefinition() || RD->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) | ||||||||||
| 3847 | S.Diag(Paren.Loc, diag::note_raii_guard_add_name) | ||||||||||
| 3848 | << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Paren.Loc, " varname") << T | ||||||||||
| 3849 | << D.getIdentifier(); | ||||||||||
| 3850 | // FIXME: A cast to void is probably a better suggestion in cases where it's | ||||||||||
| 3851 | // valid (when there is no initializer and we're not in a condition). | ||||||||||
| 3852 | S.Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::note_function_style_cast_add_parentheses) | ||||||||||
| 3853 | << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(D.getBeginLoc(), "(") | ||||||||||
| 3854 | << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(S.getLocForEndOfToken(D.getEndLoc()), ")"); | ||||||||||
| 3855 | S.Diag(Paren.Loc, diag::note_remove_parens_for_variable_declaration) | ||||||||||
| 3856 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(Paren.Loc) | ||||||||||
| 3857 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(Paren.EndLoc); | ||||||||||
| 3858 | } | ||||||||||
| 3859 | |||||||||||
| 3860 | /// Helper for figuring out the default CC for a function declarator type. If | ||||||||||
| 3861 | /// this is the outermost chunk, then we can determine the CC from the | ||||||||||
| 3862 | /// declarator context. If not, then this could be either a member function | ||||||||||
| 3863 | /// type or normal function type. | ||||||||||
| 3864 | static CallingConv getCCForDeclaratorChunk( | ||||||||||
| 3865 | Sema &S, Declarator &D, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList, | ||||||||||
| 3866 | const DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI, unsigned ChunkIndex) { | ||||||||||
| 3867 | assert(D.getTypeObject(ChunkIndex).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 3868 | |||||||||||
| 3869 | // Check for an explicit CC attribute. | ||||||||||
| 3870 | for (const ParsedAttr &AL : AttrList) { | ||||||||||
| 3871 | switch (AL.getKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 3872 | CALLING_CONV_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_CDecl: case ParsedAttr::AT_FastCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_StdCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_ThisCall: case ParsedAttr ::AT_RegCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pascal: case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftAsyncCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_VectorCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_AArch64VectorPcs: case ParsedAttr::AT_MSABI : case ParsedAttr::AT_SysVABI: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pcs: case ParsedAttr ::AT_IntelOclBicc: case ParsedAttr::AT_PreserveMost: case ParsedAttr ::AT_PreserveAll : { | ||||||||||
| 3873 | // Ignore attributes that don't validate or can't apply to the | ||||||||||
| 3874 | // function type. We'll diagnose the failure to apply them in | ||||||||||
| 3875 | // handleFunctionTypeAttr. | ||||||||||
| 3876 | CallingConv CC; | ||||||||||
| 3877 | if (!S.CheckCallingConvAttr(AL, CC) && | ||||||||||
| 3878 | (!FTI.isVariadic || supportsVariadicCall(CC))) { | ||||||||||
| 3879 | return CC; | ||||||||||
| 3880 | } | ||||||||||
| 3881 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3882 | } | ||||||||||
| 3883 | |||||||||||
| 3884 | default: | ||||||||||
| 3885 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3886 | } | ||||||||||
| 3887 | } | ||||||||||
| 3888 | |||||||||||
| 3889 | bool IsCXXInstanceMethod = false; | ||||||||||
| 3890 | |||||||||||
| 3891 | if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { | ||||||||||
| 3892 | // Look inwards through parentheses to see if this chunk will form a | ||||||||||
| 3893 | // member pointer type or if we're the declarator. Any type attributes | ||||||||||
| 3894 | // between here and there will override the CC we choose here. | ||||||||||
| 3895 | unsigned I = ChunkIndex; | ||||||||||
| 3896 | bool FoundNonParen = false; | ||||||||||
| 3897 | while (I && !FoundNonParen) { | ||||||||||
| 3898 | --I; | ||||||||||
| 3899 | if (D.getTypeObject(I).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Paren) | ||||||||||
| 3900 | FoundNonParen = true; | ||||||||||
| 3901 | } | ||||||||||
| 3902 | |||||||||||
| 3903 | if (FoundNonParen) { | ||||||||||
| 3904 | // If we're not the declarator, we're a regular function type unless we're | ||||||||||
| 3905 | // in a member pointer. | ||||||||||
| 3906 | IsCXXInstanceMethod = | ||||||||||
| 3907 | D.getTypeObject(I).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer; | ||||||||||
| 3908 | } else if (D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr) { | ||||||||||
| 3909 | // This can only be a call operator for a lambda, which is an instance | ||||||||||
| 3910 | // method. | ||||||||||
| 3911 | IsCXXInstanceMethod = true; | ||||||||||
| 3912 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 3913 | // We're the innermost decl chunk, so must be a function declarator. | ||||||||||
| 3914 | assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 3915 | |||||||||||
| 3916 | // If we're inside a record, we're declaring a method, but it could be | ||||||||||
| 3917 | // explicitly or implicitly static. | ||||||||||
| 3918 | IsCXXInstanceMethod = | ||||||||||
| 3919 | D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember() && | ||||||||||
| 3920 | D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && | ||||||||||
| 3921 | !D.isStaticMember(); | ||||||||||
| 3922 | } | ||||||||||
| 3923 | } | ||||||||||
| 3924 | |||||||||||
| 3925 | CallingConv CC = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(FTI.isVariadic, | ||||||||||
| 3926 | IsCXXInstanceMethod); | ||||||||||
| 3927 | |||||||||||
| 3928 | // Attribute AT_OpenCLKernel affects the calling convention for SPIR | ||||||||||
| 3929 | // and AMDGPU targets, hence it cannot be treated as a calling | ||||||||||
| 3930 | // convention attribute. This is the simplest place to infer | ||||||||||
| 3931 | // calling convention for OpenCL kernels. | ||||||||||
| 3932 | if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 3933 | for (const ParsedAttr &AL : D.getDeclSpec().getAttributes()) { | ||||||||||
| 3934 | if (AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLKernel) { | ||||||||||
| 3935 | CC = CC_OpenCLKernel; | ||||||||||
| 3936 | break; | ||||||||||
| 3937 | } | ||||||||||
| 3938 | } | ||||||||||
| 3939 | } | ||||||||||
| 3940 | |||||||||||
| 3941 | return CC; | ||||||||||
| 3942 | } | ||||||||||
| 3943 | |||||||||||
| 3944 | namespace { | ||||||||||
| 3945 | /// A simple notion of pointer kinds, which matches up with the various | ||||||||||
| 3946 | /// pointer declarators. | ||||||||||
| 3947 | enum class SimplePointerKind { | ||||||||||
| 3948 | Pointer, | ||||||||||
| 3949 | BlockPointer, | ||||||||||
| 3950 | MemberPointer, | ||||||||||
| 3951 | Array, | ||||||||||
| 3952 | }; | ||||||||||
| 3953 | } // end anonymous namespace | ||||||||||
| 3954 | |||||||||||
| 3955 | IdentifierInfo *Sema::getNullabilityKeyword(NullabilityKind nullability) { | ||||||||||
| 3956 | switch (nullability) { | ||||||||||
| 3957 | case NullabilityKind::NonNull: | ||||||||||
| 3958 | if (!Ident__Nonnull) | ||||||||||
| 3959 | Ident__Nonnull = PP.getIdentifierInfo("_Nonnull"); | ||||||||||
| 3960 | return Ident__Nonnull; | ||||||||||
| 3961 | |||||||||||
| 3962 | case NullabilityKind::Nullable: | ||||||||||
| 3963 | if (!Ident__Nullable) | ||||||||||
| 3964 | Ident__Nullable = PP.getIdentifierInfo("_Nullable"); | ||||||||||
| 3965 | return Ident__Nullable; | ||||||||||
| 3966 | |||||||||||
| 3967 | case NullabilityKind::NullableResult: | ||||||||||
| 3968 | if (!Ident__Nullable_result) | ||||||||||
| 3969 | Ident__Nullable_result = PP.getIdentifierInfo("_Nullable_result"); | ||||||||||
| 3970 | return Ident__Nullable_result; | ||||||||||
| 3971 | |||||||||||
| 3972 | case NullabilityKind::Unspecified: | ||||||||||
| 3973 | if (!Ident__Null_unspecified) | ||||||||||
| 3974 | Ident__Null_unspecified = PP.getIdentifierInfo("_Null_unspecified"); | ||||||||||
| 3975 | return Ident__Null_unspecified; | ||||||||||
| 3976 | } | ||||||||||
| 3977 | llvm_unreachable("Unknown nullability kind.")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 3978 | } | ||||||||||
| 3979 | |||||||||||
| 3980 | /// Retrieve the identifier "NSError". | ||||||||||
| 3981 | IdentifierInfo *Sema::getNSErrorIdent() { | ||||||||||
| 3982 | if (!Ident_NSError) | ||||||||||
| 3983 | Ident_NSError = PP.getIdentifierInfo("NSError"); | ||||||||||
| 3984 | |||||||||||
| 3985 | return Ident_NSError; | ||||||||||
| 3986 | } | ||||||||||
| 3987 | |||||||||||
| 3988 | /// Check whether there is a nullability attribute of any kind in the given | ||||||||||
| 3989 | /// attribute list. | ||||||||||
| 3990 | static bool hasNullabilityAttr(const ParsedAttributesView &attrs) { | ||||||||||
| 3991 | for (const ParsedAttr &AL : attrs) { | ||||||||||
| 3992 | if (AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNonNull || | ||||||||||
| 3993 | AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullable || | ||||||||||
| 3994 | AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullableResult || | ||||||||||
| 3995 | AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullUnspecified) | ||||||||||
| 3996 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 3997 | } | ||||||||||
| 3998 | |||||||||||
| 3999 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 4000 | } | ||||||||||
| 4001 | |||||||||||
| 4002 | namespace { | ||||||||||
| 4003 | /// Describes the kind of a pointer a declarator describes. | ||||||||||
| 4004 | enum class PointerDeclaratorKind { | ||||||||||
| 4005 | // Not a pointer. | ||||||||||
| 4006 | NonPointer, | ||||||||||
| 4007 | // Single-level pointer. | ||||||||||
| 4008 | SingleLevelPointer, | ||||||||||
| 4009 | // Multi-level pointer (of any pointer kind). | ||||||||||
| 4010 | MultiLevelPointer, | ||||||||||
| 4011 | // CFFooRef* | ||||||||||
| 4012 | MaybePointerToCFRef, | ||||||||||
| 4013 | // CFErrorRef* | ||||||||||
| 4014 | CFErrorRefPointer, | ||||||||||
| 4015 | // NSError** | ||||||||||
| 4016 | NSErrorPointerPointer, | ||||||||||
| 4017 | }; | ||||||||||
| 4018 | |||||||||||
| 4019 | /// Describes a declarator chunk wrapping a pointer that marks inference as | ||||||||||
| 4020 | /// unexpected. | ||||||||||
| 4021 | // These values must be kept in sync with diagnostics. | ||||||||||
| 4022 | enum class PointerWrappingDeclaratorKind { | ||||||||||
| 4023 | /// Pointer is top-level. | ||||||||||
| 4024 | None = -1, | ||||||||||
| 4025 | /// Pointer is an array element. | ||||||||||
| 4026 | Array = 0, | ||||||||||
| 4027 | /// Pointer is the referent type of a C++ reference. | ||||||||||
| 4028 | Reference = 1 | ||||||||||
| 4029 | }; | ||||||||||
| 4030 | } // end anonymous namespace | ||||||||||
| 4031 | |||||||||||
| 4032 | /// Classify the given declarator, whose type-specified is \c type, based on | ||||||||||
| 4033 | /// what kind of pointer it refers to. | ||||||||||
| 4034 | /// | ||||||||||
| 4035 | /// This is used to determine the default nullability. | ||||||||||
| 4036 | static PointerDeclaratorKind | ||||||||||
| 4037 | classifyPointerDeclarator(Sema &S, QualType type, Declarator &declarator, | ||||||||||
| 4038 | PointerWrappingDeclaratorKind &wrappingKind) { | ||||||||||
| 4039 | unsigned numNormalPointers = 0; | ||||||||||
| 4040 | |||||||||||
| 4041 | // For any dependent type, we consider it a non-pointer. | ||||||||||
| 4042 | if (type->isDependentType()) | ||||||||||
| 4043 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::NonPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4044 | |||||||||||
| 4045 | // Look through the declarator chunks to identify pointers. | ||||||||||
| 4046 | for (unsigned i = 0, n = declarator.getNumTypeObjects(); i != n; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 4047 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = declarator.getTypeObject(i); | ||||||||||
| 4048 | switch (chunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 4049 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 4050 | if (numNormalPointers == 0) | ||||||||||
| 4051 | wrappingKind = PointerWrappingDeclaratorKind::Array; | ||||||||||
| 4052 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4053 | |||||||||||
| 4054 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 4055 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 4056 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4057 | |||||||||||
| 4058 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4059 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4060 | return numNormalPointers > 0 ? PointerDeclaratorKind::MultiLevelPointer | ||||||||||
| 4061 | : PointerDeclaratorKind::SingleLevelPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4062 | |||||||||||
| 4063 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 4064 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4065 | |||||||||||
| 4066 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 4067 | if (numNormalPointers == 0) | ||||||||||
| 4068 | wrappingKind = PointerWrappingDeclaratorKind::Reference; | ||||||||||
| 4069 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4070 | |||||||||||
| 4071 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 4072 | ++numNormalPointers; | ||||||||||
| 4073 | if (numNormalPointers > 2) | ||||||||||
| 4074 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::MultiLevelPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4075 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4076 | } | ||||||||||
| 4077 | } | ||||||||||
| 4078 | |||||||||||
| 4079 | // Then, dig into the type specifier itself. | ||||||||||
| 4080 | unsigned numTypeSpecifierPointers = 0; | ||||||||||
| 4081 | do { | ||||||||||
| 4082 | // Decompose normal pointers. | ||||||||||
| 4083 | if (auto ptrType = type->getAs<PointerType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 4084 | ++numNormalPointers; | ||||||||||
| 4085 | |||||||||||
| 4086 | if (numNormalPointers > 2) | ||||||||||
| 4087 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::MultiLevelPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4088 | |||||||||||
| 4089 | type = ptrType->getPointeeType(); | ||||||||||
| 4090 | ++numTypeSpecifierPointers; | ||||||||||
| 4091 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 4092 | } | ||||||||||
| 4093 | |||||||||||
| 4094 | // Decompose block pointers. | ||||||||||
| 4095 | if (type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 4096 | return numNormalPointers > 0 ? PointerDeclaratorKind::MultiLevelPointer | ||||||||||
| 4097 | : PointerDeclaratorKind::SingleLevelPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4098 | } | ||||||||||
| 4099 | |||||||||||
| 4100 | // Decompose member pointers. | ||||||||||
| 4101 | if (type->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 4102 | return numNormalPointers > 0 ? PointerDeclaratorKind::MultiLevelPointer | ||||||||||
| 4103 | : PointerDeclaratorKind::SingleLevelPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4104 | } | ||||||||||
| 4105 | |||||||||||
| 4106 | // Look at Objective-C object pointers. | ||||||||||
| 4107 | if (auto objcObjectPtr = type->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 4108 | ++numNormalPointers; | ||||||||||
| 4109 | ++numTypeSpecifierPointers; | ||||||||||
| 4110 | |||||||||||
| 4111 | // If this is NSError**, report that. | ||||||||||
| 4112 | if (auto objcClassDecl = objcObjectPtr->getInterfaceDecl()) { | ||||||||||
| 4113 | if (objcClassDecl->getIdentifier() == S.getNSErrorIdent() && | ||||||||||
| 4114 | numNormalPointers == 2 && numTypeSpecifierPointers < 2) { | ||||||||||
| 4115 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::NSErrorPointerPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4116 | } | ||||||||||
| 4117 | } | ||||||||||
| 4118 | |||||||||||
| 4119 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4120 | } | ||||||||||
| 4121 | |||||||||||
| 4122 | // Look at Objective-C class types. | ||||||||||
| 4123 | if (auto objcClass = type->getAs<ObjCInterfaceType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 4124 | if (objcClass->getInterface()->getIdentifier() == S.getNSErrorIdent()) { | ||||||||||
| 4125 | if (numNormalPointers == 2 && numTypeSpecifierPointers < 2) | ||||||||||
| 4126 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::NSErrorPointerPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4127 | } | ||||||||||
| 4128 | |||||||||||
| 4129 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4130 | } | ||||||||||
| 4131 | |||||||||||
| 4132 | // If at this point we haven't seen a pointer, we won't see one. | ||||||||||
| 4133 | if (numNormalPointers == 0) | ||||||||||
| 4134 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::NonPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4135 | |||||||||||
| 4136 | if (auto recordType = type->getAs<RecordType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 4137 | RecordDecl *recordDecl = recordType->getDecl(); | ||||||||||
| 4138 | |||||||||||
| 4139 | // If this is CFErrorRef*, report it as such. | ||||||||||
| 4140 | if (numNormalPointers == 2 && numTypeSpecifierPointers < 2 && | ||||||||||
| 4141 | S.isCFError(recordDecl)) { | ||||||||||
| 4142 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::CFErrorRefPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4143 | } | ||||||||||
| 4144 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4145 | } | ||||||||||
| 4146 | |||||||||||
| 4147 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4148 | } while (true); | ||||||||||
| 4149 | |||||||||||
| 4150 | switch (numNormalPointers) { | ||||||||||
| 4151 | case 0: | ||||||||||
| 4152 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::NonPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4153 | |||||||||||
| 4154 | case 1: | ||||||||||
| 4155 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::SingleLevelPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4156 | |||||||||||
| 4157 | case 2: | ||||||||||
| 4158 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::MaybePointerToCFRef; | ||||||||||
| 4159 | |||||||||||
| 4160 | default: | ||||||||||
| 4161 | return PointerDeclaratorKind::MultiLevelPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4162 | } | ||||||||||
| 4163 | } | ||||||||||
| 4164 | |||||||||||
| 4165 | bool Sema::isCFError(RecordDecl *RD) { | ||||||||||
| 4166 | // If we already know about CFError, test it directly. | ||||||||||
| 4167 | if (CFError) | ||||||||||
| 4168 | return CFError == RD; | ||||||||||
| 4169 | |||||||||||
| 4170 | // Check whether this is CFError, which we identify based on its bridge to | ||||||||||
| 4171 | // NSError. CFErrorRef used to be declared with "objc_bridge" but is now | ||||||||||
| 4172 | // declared with "objc_bridge_mutable", so look for either one of the two | ||||||||||
| 4173 | // attributes. | ||||||||||
| 4174 | if (RD->getTagKind() == TTK_Struct) { | ||||||||||
| 4175 | IdentifierInfo *bridgedType = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 4176 | if (auto bridgeAttr = RD->getAttr<ObjCBridgeAttr>()) | ||||||||||
| 4177 | bridgedType = bridgeAttr->getBridgedType(); | ||||||||||
| 4178 | else if (auto bridgeAttr = RD->getAttr<ObjCBridgeMutableAttr>()) | ||||||||||
| 4179 | bridgedType = bridgeAttr->getBridgedType(); | ||||||||||
| 4180 | |||||||||||
| 4181 | if (bridgedType == getNSErrorIdent()) { | ||||||||||
| 4182 | CFError = RD; | ||||||||||
| 4183 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 4184 | } | ||||||||||
| 4185 | } | ||||||||||
| 4186 | |||||||||||
| 4187 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 4188 | } | ||||||||||
| 4189 | |||||||||||
| 4190 | static FileID getNullabilityCompletenessCheckFileID(Sema &S, | ||||||||||
| 4191 | SourceLocation loc) { | ||||||||||
| 4192 | // If we're anywhere in a function, method, or closure context, don't perform | ||||||||||
| 4193 | // completeness checks. | ||||||||||
| 4194 | for (DeclContext *ctx = S.CurContext; ctx; ctx = ctx->getParent()) { | ||||||||||
| 4195 | if (ctx->isFunctionOrMethod()) | ||||||||||
| 4196 | return FileID(); | ||||||||||
| 4197 | |||||||||||
| 4198 | if (ctx->isFileContext()) | ||||||||||
| 4199 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4200 | } | ||||||||||
| 4201 | |||||||||||
| 4202 | // We only care about the expansion location. | ||||||||||
| 4203 | loc = S.SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(loc); | ||||||||||
| 4204 | FileID file = S.SourceMgr.getFileID(loc); | ||||||||||
| 4205 | if (file.isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 4206 | return FileID(); | ||||||||||
| 4207 | |||||||||||
| 4208 | // Retrieve file information. | ||||||||||
| 4209 | bool invalid = false; | ||||||||||
| 4210 | const SrcMgr::SLocEntry &sloc = S.SourceMgr.getSLocEntry(file, &invalid); | ||||||||||
| 4211 | if (invalid || !sloc.isFile()) | ||||||||||
| 4212 | return FileID(); | ||||||||||
| 4213 | |||||||||||
| 4214 | // We don't want to perform completeness checks on the main file or in | ||||||||||
| 4215 | // system headers. | ||||||||||
| 4216 | const SrcMgr::FileInfo &fileInfo = sloc.getFile(); | ||||||||||
| 4217 | if (fileInfo.getIncludeLoc().isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 4218 | return FileID(); | ||||||||||
| 4219 | if (fileInfo.getFileCharacteristic() != SrcMgr::C_User && | ||||||||||
| 4220 | S.Diags.getSuppressSystemWarnings()) { | ||||||||||
| 4221 | return FileID(); | ||||||||||
| 4222 | } | ||||||||||
| 4223 | |||||||||||
| 4224 | return file; | ||||||||||
| 4225 | } | ||||||||||
| 4226 | |||||||||||
| 4227 | /// Creates a fix-it to insert a C-style nullability keyword at \p pointerLoc, | ||||||||||
| 4228 | /// taking into account whitespace before and after. | ||||||||||
| 4229 | template <typename DiagBuilderT> | ||||||||||
| 4230 | static void fixItNullability(Sema &S, DiagBuilderT &Diag, | ||||||||||
| 4231 | SourceLocation PointerLoc, | ||||||||||
| 4232 | NullabilityKind Nullability) { | ||||||||||
| 4233 | assert(PointerLoc.isValid())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 4234 | if (PointerLoc.isMacroID()) | ||||||||||
| 4235 | return; | ||||||||||
| 4236 | |||||||||||
| 4237 | SourceLocation FixItLoc = S.getLocForEndOfToken(PointerLoc); | ||||||||||
| 4238 | if (!FixItLoc.isValid() || FixItLoc == PointerLoc) | ||||||||||
| 4239 | return; | ||||||||||
| 4240 | |||||||||||
| 4241 | const char *NextChar = S.SourceMgr.getCharacterData(FixItLoc); | ||||||||||
| 4242 | if (!NextChar) | ||||||||||
| 4243 | return; | ||||||||||
| 4244 | |||||||||||
| 4245 | SmallString<32> InsertionTextBuf{" "}; | ||||||||||
| 4246 | InsertionTextBuf += getNullabilitySpelling(Nullability); | ||||||||||
| 4247 | InsertionTextBuf += " "; | ||||||||||
| 4248 | StringRef InsertionText = InsertionTextBuf.str(); | ||||||||||
| 4249 | |||||||||||
| 4250 | if (isWhitespace(*NextChar)) { | ||||||||||
| 4251 | InsertionText = InsertionText.drop_back(); | ||||||||||
| 4252 | } else if (NextChar[-1] == '[') { | ||||||||||
| 4253 | if (NextChar[0] == ']') | ||||||||||
| 4254 | InsertionText = InsertionText.drop_back().drop_front(); | ||||||||||
| 4255 | else | ||||||||||
| 4256 | InsertionText = InsertionText.drop_front(); | ||||||||||
| 4257 | } else if (!isIdentifierBody(NextChar[0], /*allow dollar*/true) && | ||||||||||
| 4258 | !isIdentifierBody(NextChar[-1], /*allow dollar*/true)) { | ||||||||||
| 4259 | InsertionText = InsertionText.drop_back().drop_front(); | ||||||||||
| 4260 | } | ||||||||||
| 4261 | |||||||||||
| 4262 | Diag << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixItLoc, InsertionText); | ||||||||||
| 4263 | } | ||||||||||
| 4264 | |||||||||||
| 4265 | static void emitNullabilityConsistencyWarning(Sema &S, | ||||||||||
| 4266 | SimplePointerKind PointerKind, | ||||||||||
| 4267 | SourceLocation PointerLoc, | ||||||||||
| 4268 | SourceLocation PointerEndLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 4269 | assert(PointerLoc.isValid())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 4270 | |||||||||||
| 4271 | if (PointerKind == SimplePointerKind::Array) { | ||||||||||
| 4272 | S.Diag(PointerLoc, diag::warn_nullability_missing_array); | ||||||||||
| 4273 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 4274 | S.Diag(PointerLoc, diag::warn_nullability_missing) | ||||||||||
| 4275 | << static_cast<unsigned>(PointerKind); | ||||||||||
| 4276 | } | ||||||||||
| 4277 | |||||||||||
| 4278 | auto FixItLoc = PointerEndLoc.isValid() ? PointerEndLoc : PointerLoc; | ||||||||||
| 4279 | if (FixItLoc.isMacroID()) | ||||||||||
| 4280 | return; | ||||||||||
| 4281 | |||||||||||
| 4282 | auto addFixIt = [&](NullabilityKind Nullability) { | ||||||||||
| 4283 | auto Diag = S.Diag(FixItLoc, diag::note_nullability_fix_it); | ||||||||||
| 4284 | Diag << static_cast<unsigned>(Nullability); | ||||||||||
| 4285 | Diag << static_cast<unsigned>(PointerKind); | ||||||||||
| 4286 | fixItNullability(S, Diag, FixItLoc, Nullability); | ||||||||||
| 4287 | }; | ||||||||||
| 4288 | addFixIt(NullabilityKind::Nullable); | ||||||||||
| 4289 | addFixIt(NullabilityKind::NonNull); | ||||||||||
| 4290 | } | ||||||||||
| 4291 | |||||||||||
| 4292 | /// Complains about missing nullability if the file containing \p pointerLoc | ||||||||||
| 4293 | /// has other uses of nullability (either the keywords or the \c assume_nonnull | ||||||||||
| 4294 | /// pragma). | ||||||||||
| 4295 | /// | ||||||||||
| 4296 | /// If the file has \e not seen other uses of nullability, this particular | ||||||||||
| 4297 | /// pointer is saved for possible later diagnosis. See recordNullabilitySeen(). | ||||||||||
| 4298 | static void | ||||||||||
| 4299 | checkNullabilityConsistency(Sema &S, SimplePointerKind pointerKind, | ||||||||||
| 4300 | SourceLocation pointerLoc, | ||||||||||
| 4301 | SourceLocation pointerEndLoc = SourceLocation()) { | ||||||||||
| 4302 | // Determine which file we're performing consistency checking for. | ||||||||||
| 4303 | FileID file = getNullabilityCompletenessCheckFileID(S, pointerLoc); | ||||||||||
| 4304 | if (file.isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 4305 | return; | ||||||||||
| 4306 | |||||||||||
| 4307 | // If we haven't seen any type nullability in this file, we won't warn now | ||||||||||
| 4308 | // about anything. | ||||||||||
| 4309 | FileNullability &fileNullability = S.NullabilityMap[file]; | ||||||||||
| 4310 | if (!fileNullability.SawTypeNullability) { | ||||||||||
| 4311 | // If this is the first pointer declarator in the file, and the appropriate | ||||||||||
| 4312 | // warning is on, record it in case we need to diagnose it retroactively. | ||||||||||
| 4313 | diag::kind diagKind; | ||||||||||
| 4314 | if (pointerKind == SimplePointerKind::Array) | ||||||||||
| 4315 | diagKind = diag::warn_nullability_missing_array; | ||||||||||
| 4316 | else | ||||||||||
| 4317 | diagKind = diag::warn_nullability_missing; | ||||||||||
| 4318 | |||||||||||
| 4319 | if (fileNullability.PointerLoc.isInvalid() && | ||||||||||
| 4320 | !S.Context.getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diagKind, pointerLoc)) { | ||||||||||
| 4321 | fileNullability.PointerLoc = pointerLoc; | ||||||||||
| 4322 | fileNullability.PointerEndLoc = pointerEndLoc; | ||||||||||
| 4323 | fileNullability.PointerKind = static_cast<unsigned>(pointerKind); | ||||||||||
| 4324 | } | ||||||||||
| 4325 | |||||||||||
| 4326 | return; | ||||||||||
| 4327 | } | ||||||||||
| 4328 | |||||||||||
| 4329 | // Complain about missing nullability. | ||||||||||
| 4330 | emitNullabilityConsistencyWarning(S, pointerKind, pointerLoc, pointerEndLoc); | ||||||||||
| 4331 | } | ||||||||||
| 4332 | |||||||||||
| 4333 | /// Marks that a nullability feature has been used in the file containing | ||||||||||
| 4334 | /// \p loc. | ||||||||||
| 4335 | /// | ||||||||||
| 4336 | /// If this file already had pointer types in it that were missing nullability, | ||||||||||
| 4337 | /// the first such instance is retroactively diagnosed. | ||||||||||
| 4338 | /// | ||||||||||
| 4339 | /// \sa checkNullabilityConsistency | ||||||||||
| 4340 | static void recordNullabilitySeen(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc) { | ||||||||||
| 4341 | FileID file = getNullabilityCompletenessCheckFileID(S, loc); | ||||||||||
| 4342 | if (file.isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 4343 | return; | ||||||||||
| 4344 | |||||||||||
| 4345 | FileNullability &fileNullability = S.NullabilityMap[file]; | ||||||||||
| 4346 | if (fileNullability.SawTypeNullability) | ||||||||||
| 4347 | return; | ||||||||||
| 4348 | fileNullability.SawTypeNullability = true; | ||||||||||
| 4349 | |||||||||||
| 4350 | // If we haven't seen any type nullability before, now we have. Retroactively | ||||||||||
| 4351 | // diagnose the first unannotated pointer, if there was one. | ||||||||||
| 4352 | if (fileNullability.PointerLoc.isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 4353 | return; | ||||||||||
| 4354 | |||||||||||
| 4355 | auto kind = static_cast<SimplePointerKind>(fileNullability.PointerKind); | ||||||||||
| 4356 | emitNullabilityConsistencyWarning(S, kind, fileNullability.PointerLoc, | ||||||||||
| 4357 | fileNullability.PointerEndLoc); | ||||||||||
| 4358 | } | ||||||||||
| 4359 | |||||||||||
| 4360 | /// Returns true if any of the declarator chunks before \p endIndex include a | ||||||||||
| 4361 | /// level of indirection: array, pointer, reference, or pointer-to-member. | ||||||||||
| 4362 | /// | ||||||||||
| 4363 | /// Because declarator chunks are stored in outer-to-inner order, testing | ||||||||||
| 4364 | /// every chunk before \p endIndex is testing all chunks that embed the current | ||||||||||
| 4365 | /// chunk as part of their type. | ||||||||||
| 4366 | /// | ||||||||||
| 4367 | /// It is legal to pass the result of Declarator::getNumTypeObjects() as the | ||||||||||
| 4368 | /// end index, in which case all chunks are tested. | ||||||||||
| 4369 | static bool hasOuterPointerLikeChunk(const Declarator &D, unsigned endIndex) { | ||||||||||
| 4370 | unsigned i = endIndex; | ||||||||||
| 4371 | while (i != 0) { | ||||||||||
| 4372 | // Walk outwards along the declarator chunks. | ||||||||||
| 4373 | --i; | ||||||||||
| 4374 | const DeclaratorChunk &DC = D.getTypeObject(i); | ||||||||||
| 4375 | switch (DC.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 4376 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 4377 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4378 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 4379 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 4380 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 4381 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4382 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 4383 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 4384 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4385 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 4386 | // These are invalid anyway, so just ignore. | ||||||||||
| 4387 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4388 | } | ||||||||||
| 4389 | } | ||||||||||
| 4390 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 4391 | } | ||||||||||
| 4392 | |||||||||||
| 4393 | static bool IsNoDerefableChunk(DeclaratorChunk Chunk) { | ||||||||||
| 4394 | return (Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Pointer || | ||||||||||
| 4395 | Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Array); | ||||||||||
| 4396 | } | ||||||||||
| 4397 | |||||||||||
| 4398 | template<typename AttrT> | ||||||||||
| 4399 | static AttrT *createSimpleAttr(ASTContext &Ctx, ParsedAttr &AL) { | ||||||||||
| 4400 | AL.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 4401 | return ::new (Ctx) AttrT(Ctx, AL); | ||||||||||
| 4402 | } | ||||||||||
| 4403 | |||||||||||
| 4404 | static Attr *createNullabilityAttr(ASTContext &Ctx, ParsedAttr &Attr, | ||||||||||
| 4405 | NullabilityKind NK) { | ||||||||||
| 4406 | switch (NK) { | ||||||||||
| 4407 | case NullabilityKind::NonNull: | ||||||||||
| 4408 | return createSimpleAttr<TypeNonNullAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 4409 | |||||||||||
| 4410 | case NullabilityKind::Nullable: | ||||||||||
| 4411 | return createSimpleAttr<TypeNullableAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 4412 | |||||||||||
| 4413 | case NullabilityKind::NullableResult: | ||||||||||
| 4414 | return createSimpleAttr<TypeNullableResultAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 4415 | |||||||||||
| 4416 | case NullabilityKind::Unspecified: | ||||||||||
| 4417 | return createSimpleAttr<TypeNullUnspecifiedAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 4418 | } | ||||||||||
| 4419 | llvm_unreachable("unknown NullabilityKind")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 4420 | } | ||||||||||
| 4421 | |||||||||||
| 4422 | // Diagnose whether this is a case with the multiple addr spaces. | ||||||||||
| 4423 | // Returns true if this is an invalid case. | ||||||||||
| 4424 | // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.3 (amending C99 6.7.3): "No type shall be qualified | ||||||||||
| 4425 | // by qualifiers for two or more different address spaces." | ||||||||||
| 4426 | static bool DiagnoseMultipleAddrSpaceAttributes(Sema &S, LangAS ASOld, | ||||||||||
| 4427 | LangAS ASNew, | ||||||||||
| 4428 | SourceLocation AttrLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 4429 | if (ASOld != LangAS::Default) { | ||||||||||
| 4430 | if (ASOld != ASNew) { | ||||||||||
| 4431 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_address_multiple_qualifiers); | ||||||||||
| 4432 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 4433 | } | ||||||||||
| 4434 | // Emit a warning if they are identical; it's likely unintended. | ||||||||||
| 4435 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, | ||||||||||
| 4436 | diag::warn_attribute_address_multiple_identical_qualifiers); | ||||||||||
| 4437 | } | ||||||||||
| 4438 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 4439 | } | ||||||||||
| 4440 | |||||||||||
| 4441 | static TypeSourceInfo *GetFullTypeForDeclarator(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 4442 | QualType declSpecType, | ||||||||||
| 4443 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 4444 | // The TypeSourceInfo that this function returns will not be a null type. | ||||||||||
| 4445 | // If there is an error, this function will fill in a dummy type as fallback. | ||||||||||
| 4446 | QualType T = declSpecType; | ||||||||||
| 4447 | Declarator &D = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 4448 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 4449 | ASTContext &Context = S.Context; | ||||||||||
| 4450 | const LangOptions &LangOpts = S.getLangOpts(); | ||||||||||
| 4451 | |||||||||||
| 4452 | // The name we're declaring, if any. | ||||||||||
| 4453 | DeclarationName Name; | ||||||||||
| 4454 | if (D.getIdentifier()) | ||||||||||
| |||||||||||
| 4455 | Name = D.getIdentifier(); | ||||||||||
| 4456 | |||||||||||
| 4457 | // Does this declaration declare a typedef-name? | ||||||||||
| 4458 | bool IsTypedefName = | ||||||||||
| 4459 | D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef || | ||||||||||
| 4460 | D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::AliasDecl || | ||||||||||
| 4461 | D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::AliasTemplate; | ||||||||||
| 4462 | |||||||||||
| 4463 | // Does T refer to a function type with a cv-qualifier or a ref-qualifier? | ||||||||||
| 4464 | bool IsQualifiedFunction = T->isFunctionProtoType() && | ||||||||||
| 4465 | (!T->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getMethodQuals().empty() || | ||||||||||
| 4466 | T->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getRefQualifier() != RQ_None); | ||||||||||
| 4467 | |||||||||||
| 4468 | // If T is 'decltype(auto)', the only declarators we can have are parens | ||||||||||
| 4469 | // and at most one function declarator if this is a function declaration. | ||||||||||
| 4470 | // If T is a deduced class template specialization type, we can have no | ||||||||||
| 4471 | // declarator chunks at all. | ||||||||||
| 4472 | if (auto *DT
| ||||||||||
| 4473 | const AutoType *AT = T->getAs<AutoType>(); | ||||||||||
| 4474 | bool IsClassTemplateDeduction = isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(DT); | ||||||||||
| 4475 | if ((AT && AT->isDecltypeAuto()) || IsClassTemplateDeduction) { | ||||||||||
| 4476 | for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { | ||||||||||
| 4477 | unsigned Index = E - I - 1; | ||||||||||
| 4478 | DeclaratorChunk &DeclChunk = D.getTypeObject(Index); | ||||||||||
| 4479 | unsigned DiagId = IsClassTemplateDeduction | ||||||||||
| 4480 | ? diag::err_deduced_class_template_compound_type | ||||||||||
| 4481 | : diag::err_decltype_auto_compound_type; | ||||||||||
| 4482 | unsigned DiagKind = 0; | ||||||||||
| 4483 | switch (DeclChunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 4484 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 4485 | // FIXME: Rejecting this is a little silly. | ||||||||||
| 4486 | if (IsClassTemplateDeduction) { | ||||||||||
| 4487 | DiagKind = 4; | ||||||||||
| 4488 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4489 | } | ||||||||||
| 4490 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 4491 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: { | ||||||||||
| 4492 | if (IsClassTemplateDeduction) { | ||||||||||
| 4493 | DiagKind = 3; | ||||||||||
| 4494 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4495 | } | ||||||||||
| 4496 | unsigned FnIndex; | ||||||||||
| 4497 | if (D.isFunctionDeclarationContext() && | ||||||||||
| 4498 | D.isFunctionDeclarator(FnIndex) && FnIndex == Index) | ||||||||||
| 4499 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 4500 | DiagId = diag::err_decltype_auto_function_declarator_not_declaration; | ||||||||||
| 4501 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4502 | } | ||||||||||
| 4503 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 4504 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4505 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4506 | DiagKind = 0; | ||||||||||
| 4507 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4508 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 4509 | DiagKind = 1; | ||||||||||
| 4510 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4511 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 4512 | DiagKind = 2; | ||||||||||
| 4513 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4514 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 4515 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4516 | } | ||||||||||
| 4517 | |||||||||||
| 4518 | S.Diag(DeclChunk.Loc, DiagId) << DiagKind; | ||||||||||
| 4519 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 4520 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4521 | } | ||||||||||
| 4522 | } | ||||||||||
| 4523 | } | ||||||||||
| 4524 | |||||||||||
| 4525 | // Determine whether we should infer _Nonnull on pointer types. | ||||||||||
| 4526 | Optional<NullabilityKind> inferNullability; | ||||||||||
| 4527 | bool inferNullabilityCS = false; | ||||||||||
| 4528 | bool inferNullabilityInnerOnly = false; | ||||||||||
| 4529 | bool inferNullabilityInnerOnlyComplete = false; | ||||||||||
| 4530 | |||||||||||
| 4531 | // Are we in an assume-nonnull region? | ||||||||||
| 4532 | bool inAssumeNonNullRegion = false; | ||||||||||
| 4533 | SourceLocation assumeNonNullLoc = S.PP.getPragmaAssumeNonNullLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 4534 | if (assumeNonNullLoc.isValid()) { | ||||||||||
| 4535 | inAssumeNonNullRegion = true; | ||||||||||
| 4536 | recordNullabilitySeen(S, assumeNonNullLoc); | ||||||||||
| 4537 | } | ||||||||||
| 4538 | |||||||||||
| 4539 | // Whether to complain about missing nullability specifiers or not. | ||||||||||
| 4540 | enum { | ||||||||||
| 4541 | /// Never complain. | ||||||||||
| 4542 | CAMN_No, | ||||||||||
| 4543 | /// Complain on the inner pointers (but not the outermost | ||||||||||
| 4544 | /// pointer). | ||||||||||
| 4545 | CAMN_InnerPointers, | ||||||||||
| 4546 | /// Complain about any pointers that don't have nullability | ||||||||||
| 4547 | /// specified or inferred. | ||||||||||
| 4548 | CAMN_Yes | ||||||||||
| 4549 | } complainAboutMissingNullability = CAMN_No; | ||||||||||
| 4550 | unsigned NumPointersRemaining = 0; | ||||||||||
| 4551 | auto complainAboutInferringWithinChunk = PointerWrappingDeclaratorKind::None; | ||||||||||
| 4552 | |||||||||||
| 4553 | if (IsTypedefName
| ||||||||||
| 4554 | // For typedefs, we do not infer any nullability (the default), | ||||||||||
| 4555 | // and we only complain about missing nullability specifiers on | ||||||||||
| 4556 | // inner pointers. | ||||||||||
| 4557 | complainAboutMissingNullability = CAMN_InnerPointers; | ||||||||||
| 4558 | |||||||||||
| 4559 | if (T->canHaveNullability(/*ResultIfUnknown*/false) && | ||||||||||
| 4560 | !T->getNullability(S.Context)) { | ||||||||||
| 4561 | // Note that we allow but don't require nullability on dependent types. | ||||||||||
| 4562 | ++NumPointersRemaining; | ||||||||||
| 4563 | } | ||||||||||
| 4564 | |||||||||||
| 4565 | for (unsigned i = 0, n = D.getNumTypeObjects(); i != n; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 4566 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = D.getTypeObject(i); | ||||||||||
| 4567 | switch (chunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 4568 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 4569 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 4570 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 4571 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4572 | |||||||||||
| 4573 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4574 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4575 | ++NumPointersRemaining; | ||||||||||
| 4576 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4577 | |||||||||||
| 4578 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 4579 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 4580 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 4581 | |||||||||||
| 4582 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 4583 | ++NumPointersRemaining; | ||||||||||
| 4584 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 4585 | } | ||||||||||
| 4586 | } | ||||||||||
| 4587 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 4588 | bool isFunctionOrMethod = false; | ||||||||||
| 4589 | switch (auto context = state.getDeclarator().getContext()) { | ||||||||||
| 4590 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCParameter: | ||||||||||
| 4591 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCResult: | ||||||||||
| 4592 | case DeclaratorContext::Prototype: | ||||||||||
| 4593 | case DeclaratorContext::TrailingReturn: | ||||||||||
| 4594 | case DeclaratorContext::TrailingReturnVar: | ||||||||||
| 4595 | isFunctionOrMethod = true; | ||||||||||
| 4596 | LLVM_FALLTHROUGH[[gnu::fallthrough]]; | ||||||||||
| 4597 | |||||||||||
| 4598 | case DeclaratorContext::Member: | ||||||||||
| 4599 | if (state.getDeclarator().isObjCIvar() && !isFunctionOrMethod) { | ||||||||||
| 4600 | complainAboutMissingNullability = CAMN_No; | ||||||||||
| 4601 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4602 | } | ||||||||||
| 4603 | |||||||||||
| 4604 | // Weak properties are inferred to be nullable. | ||||||||||
| 4605 | if (state.getDeclarator().isObjCWeakProperty() && inAssumeNonNullRegion) { | ||||||||||
| 4606 | inferNullability = NullabilityKind::Nullable; | ||||||||||
| 4607 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4608 | } | ||||||||||
| 4609 | |||||||||||
| 4610 | LLVM_FALLTHROUGH[[gnu::fallthrough]]; | ||||||||||
| 4611 | |||||||||||
| 4612 | case DeclaratorContext::File: | ||||||||||
| 4613 | case DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList: { | ||||||||||
| 4614 | complainAboutMissingNullability = CAMN_Yes; | ||||||||||
| 4615 | |||||||||||
| 4616 | // Nullability inference depends on the type and declarator. | ||||||||||
| 4617 | auto wrappingKind = PointerWrappingDeclaratorKind::None; | ||||||||||
| 4618 | switch (classifyPointerDeclarator(S, T, D, wrappingKind)) { | ||||||||||
| 4619 | case PointerDeclaratorKind::NonPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4620 | case PointerDeclaratorKind::MultiLevelPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4621 | // Cannot infer nullability. | ||||||||||
| 4622 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4623 | |||||||||||
| 4624 | case PointerDeclaratorKind::SingleLevelPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4625 | // Infer _Nonnull if we are in an assumes-nonnull region. | ||||||||||
| 4626 | if (inAssumeNonNullRegion) { | ||||||||||
| 4627 | complainAboutInferringWithinChunk = wrappingKind; | ||||||||||
| 4628 | inferNullability = NullabilityKind::NonNull; | ||||||||||
| 4629 | inferNullabilityCS = (context == DeclaratorContext::ObjCParameter || | ||||||||||
| 4630 | context == DeclaratorContext::ObjCResult); | ||||||||||
| 4631 | } | ||||||||||
| 4632 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4633 | |||||||||||
| 4634 | case PointerDeclaratorKind::CFErrorRefPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4635 | case PointerDeclaratorKind::NSErrorPointerPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4636 | // Within a function or method signature, infer _Nullable at both | ||||||||||
| 4637 | // levels. | ||||||||||
| 4638 | if (isFunctionOrMethod && inAssumeNonNullRegion) | ||||||||||
| 4639 | inferNullability = NullabilityKind::Nullable; | ||||||||||
| 4640 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4641 | |||||||||||
| 4642 | case PointerDeclaratorKind::MaybePointerToCFRef: | ||||||||||
| 4643 | if (isFunctionOrMethod) { | ||||||||||
| 4644 | // On pointer-to-pointer parameters marked cf_returns_retained or | ||||||||||
| 4645 | // cf_returns_not_retained, if the outer pointer is explicit then | ||||||||||
| 4646 | // infer the inner pointer as _Nullable. | ||||||||||
| 4647 | auto hasCFReturnsAttr = | ||||||||||
| 4648 | [](const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList) -> bool { | ||||||||||
| 4649 | return AttrList.hasAttribute(ParsedAttr::AT_CFReturnsRetained) || | ||||||||||
| 4650 | AttrList.hasAttribute(ParsedAttr::AT_CFReturnsNotRetained); | ||||||||||
| 4651 | }; | ||||||||||
| 4652 | if (const auto *InnermostChunk = D.getInnermostNonParenChunk()) { | ||||||||||
| 4653 | if (hasCFReturnsAttr(D.getAttributes()) || | ||||||||||
| 4654 | hasCFReturnsAttr(InnermostChunk->getAttrs()) || | ||||||||||
| 4655 | hasCFReturnsAttr(D.getDeclSpec().getAttributes())) { | ||||||||||
| 4656 | inferNullability = NullabilityKind::Nullable; | ||||||||||
| 4657 | inferNullabilityInnerOnly = true; | ||||||||||
| 4658 | } | ||||||||||
| 4659 | } | ||||||||||
| 4660 | } | ||||||||||
| 4661 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4662 | } | ||||||||||
| 4663 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4664 | } | ||||||||||
| 4665 | |||||||||||
| 4666 | case DeclaratorContext::ConversionId: | ||||||||||
| 4667 | complainAboutMissingNullability = CAMN_Yes; | ||||||||||
| 4668 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4669 | |||||||||||
| 4670 | case DeclaratorContext::AliasDecl: | ||||||||||
| 4671 | case DeclaratorContext::AliasTemplate: | ||||||||||
| 4672 | case DeclaratorContext::Block: | ||||||||||
| 4673 | case DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteral: | ||||||||||
| 4674 | case DeclaratorContext::Condition: | ||||||||||
| 4675 | case DeclaratorContext::CXXCatch: | ||||||||||
| 4676 | case DeclaratorContext::CXXNew: | ||||||||||
| 4677 | case DeclaratorContext::ForInit: | ||||||||||
| 4678 | case DeclaratorContext::SelectionInit: | ||||||||||
| 4679 | case DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr: | ||||||||||
| 4680 | case DeclaratorContext::LambdaExprParameter: | ||||||||||
| 4681 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCCatch: | ||||||||||
| 4682 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateParam: | ||||||||||
| 4683 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateArg: | ||||||||||
| 4684 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateTypeArg: | ||||||||||
| 4685 | case DeclaratorContext::TypeName: | ||||||||||
| 4686 | case DeclaratorContext::FunctionalCast: | ||||||||||
| 4687 | case DeclaratorContext::RequiresExpr: | ||||||||||
| 4688 | // Don't infer in these contexts. | ||||||||||
| 4689 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4690 | } | ||||||||||
| 4691 | } | ||||||||||
| 4692 | |||||||||||
| 4693 | // Local function that returns true if its argument looks like a va_list. | ||||||||||
| 4694 | auto isVaList = [&S](QualType T) -> bool { | ||||||||||
| 4695 | auto *typedefTy = T->getAs<TypedefType>(); | ||||||||||
| 4696 | if (!typedefTy) | ||||||||||
| 4697 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 4698 | TypedefDecl *vaListTypedef = S.Context.getBuiltinVaListDecl(); | ||||||||||
| 4699 | do { | ||||||||||
| 4700 | if (typedefTy->getDecl() == vaListTypedef) | ||||||||||
| 4701 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 4702 | if (auto *name = typedefTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier()) | ||||||||||
| 4703 | if (name->isStr("va_list")) | ||||||||||
| 4704 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 4705 | typedefTy = typedefTy->desugar()->getAs<TypedefType>(); | ||||||||||
| 4706 | } while (typedefTy); | ||||||||||
| 4707 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 4708 | }; | ||||||||||
| 4709 | |||||||||||
| 4710 | // Local function that checks the nullability for a given pointer declarator. | ||||||||||
| 4711 | // Returns true if _Nonnull was inferred. | ||||||||||
| 4712 | auto inferPointerNullability = | ||||||||||
| 4713 | [&](SimplePointerKind pointerKind, SourceLocation pointerLoc, | ||||||||||
| 4714 | SourceLocation pointerEndLoc, | ||||||||||
| 4715 | ParsedAttributesView &attrs, AttributePool &Pool) -> ParsedAttr * { | ||||||||||
| 4716 | // We've seen a pointer. | ||||||||||
| 4717 | if (NumPointersRemaining > 0) | ||||||||||
| 4718 | --NumPointersRemaining; | ||||||||||
| 4719 | |||||||||||
| 4720 | // If a nullability attribute is present, there's nothing to do. | ||||||||||
| 4721 | if (hasNullabilityAttr(attrs)) | ||||||||||
| 4722 | return nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 4723 | |||||||||||
| 4724 | // If we're supposed to infer nullability, do so now. | ||||||||||
| 4725 | if (inferNullability && !inferNullabilityInnerOnlyComplete) { | ||||||||||
| 4726 | ParsedAttr::Syntax syntax = inferNullabilityCS | ||||||||||
| 4727 | ? ParsedAttr::AS_ContextSensitiveKeyword | ||||||||||
| 4728 | : ParsedAttr::AS_Keyword; | ||||||||||
| 4729 | ParsedAttr *nullabilityAttr = Pool.create( | ||||||||||
| 4730 | S.getNullabilityKeyword(*inferNullability), SourceRange(pointerLoc), | ||||||||||
| 4731 | nullptr, SourceLocation(), nullptr, 0, syntax); | ||||||||||
| 4732 | |||||||||||
| 4733 | attrs.addAtEnd(nullabilityAttr); | ||||||||||
| 4734 | |||||||||||
| 4735 | if (inferNullabilityCS) { | ||||||||||
| 4736 | state.getDeclarator().getMutableDeclSpec().getObjCQualifiers() | ||||||||||
| 4737 | ->setObjCDeclQualifier(ObjCDeclSpec::DQ_CSNullability); | ||||||||||
| 4738 | } | ||||||||||
| 4739 | |||||||||||
| 4740 | if (pointerLoc.isValid() && | ||||||||||
| 4741 | complainAboutInferringWithinChunk != | ||||||||||
| 4742 | PointerWrappingDeclaratorKind::None) { | ||||||||||
| 4743 | auto Diag = | ||||||||||
| 4744 | S.Diag(pointerLoc, diag::warn_nullability_inferred_on_nested_type); | ||||||||||
| 4745 | Diag << static_cast<int>(complainAboutInferringWithinChunk); | ||||||||||
| 4746 | fixItNullability(S, Diag, pointerLoc, NullabilityKind::NonNull); | ||||||||||
| 4747 | } | ||||||||||
| 4748 | |||||||||||
| 4749 | if (inferNullabilityInnerOnly) | ||||||||||
| 4750 | inferNullabilityInnerOnlyComplete = true; | ||||||||||
| 4751 | return nullabilityAttr; | ||||||||||
| 4752 | } | ||||||||||
| 4753 | |||||||||||
| 4754 | // If we're supposed to complain about missing nullability, do so | ||||||||||
| 4755 | // now if it's truly missing. | ||||||||||
| 4756 | switch (complainAboutMissingNullability) { | ||||||||||
| 4757 | case CAMN_No: | ||||||||||
| 4758 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4759 | |||||||||||
| 4760 | case CAMN_InnerPointers: | ||||||||||
| 4761 | if (NumPointersRemaining == 0) | ||||||||||
| 4762 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4763 | LLVM_FALLTHROUGH[[gnu::fallthrough]]; | ||||||||||
| 4764 | |||||||||||
| 4765 | case CAMN_Yes: | ||||||||||
| 4766 | checkNullabilityConsistency(S, pointerKind, pointerLoc, pointerEndLoc); | ||||||||||
| 4767 | } | ||||||||||
| 4768 | return nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 4769 | }; | ||||||||||
| 4770 | |||||||||||
| 4771 | // If the type itself could have nullability but does not, infer pointer | ||||||||||
| 4772 | // nullability and perform consistency checking. | ||||||||||
| 4773 | if (S.CodeSynthesisContexts.empty()) { | ||||||||||
| 4774 | if (T->canHaveNullability(/*ResultIfUnknown*/false) && | ||||||||||
| 4775 | !T->getNullability(S.Context)) { | ||||||||||
| 4776 | if (isVaList(T)) { | ||||||||||
| 4777 | // Record that we've seen a pointer, but do nothing else. | ||||||||||
| 4778 | if (NumPointersRemaining > 0) | ||||||||||
| 4779 | --NumPointersRemaining; | ||||||||||
| 4780 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 4781 | SimplePointerKind pointerKind = SimplePointerKind::Pointer; | ||||||||||
| 4782 | if (T->isBlockPointerType()) | ||||||||||
| 4783 | pointerKind = SimplePointerKind::BlockPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4784 | else if (T->isMemberPointerType()) | ||||||||||
| 4785 | pointerKind = SimplePointerKind::MemberPointer; | ||||||||||
| 4786 | |||||||||||
| 4787 | if (auto *attr = inferPointerNullability( | ||||||||||
| 4788 | pointerKind, D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 4789 | D.getDeclSpec().getEndLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 4790 | D.getMutableDeclSpec().getAttributes(), | ||||||||||
| 4791 | D.getMutableDeclSpec().getAttributePool())) { | ||||||||||
| 4792 | T = state.getAttributedType( | ||||||||||
| 4793 | createNullabilityAttr(Context, *attr, *inferNullability), T, T); | ||||||||||
| 4794 | } | ||||||||||
| 4795 | } | ||||||||||
| 4796 | } | ||||||||||
| 4797 | |||||||||||
| 4798 | if (complainAboutMissingNullability == CAMN_Yes && | ||||||||||
| 4799 | T->isArrayType() && !T->getNullability(S.Context) && !isVaList(T) && | ||||||||||
| 4800 | D.isPrototypeContext() && | ||||||||||
| 4801 | !hasOuterPointerLikeChunk(D, D.getNumTypeObjects())) { | ||||||||||
| 4802 | checkNullabilityConsistency(S, SimplePointerKind::Array, | ||||||||||
| 4803 | D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 4804 | } | ||||||||||
| 4805 | } | ||||||||||
| 4806 | |||||||||||
| 4807 | bool ExpectNoDerefChunk = | ||||||||||
| 4808 | state.getCurrentAttributes().hasAttribute(ParsedAttr::AT_NoDeref); | ||||||||||
| 4809 | |||||||||||
| 4810 | // Walk the DeclTypeInfo, building the recursive type as we go. | ||||||||||
| 4811 | // DeclTypeInfos are ordered from the identifier out, which is | ||||||||||
| 4812 | // opposite of what we want :). | ||||||||||
| 4813 | for (unsigned i = 0, e = D.getNumTypeObjects(); i != e; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 4814 | unsigned chunkIndex = e - i - 1; | ||||||||||
| 4815 | state.setCurrentChunkIndex(chunkIndex); | ||||||||||
| 4816 | DeclaratorChunk &DeclType = D.getTypeObject(chunkIndex); | ||||||||||
| 4817 | IsQualifiedFunction &= DeclType.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Paren; | ||||||||||
| 4818 | switch (DeclType.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 4819 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 4820 | if (i == 0) | ||||||||||
| 4821 | warnAboutRedundantParens(S, D, T); | ||||||||||
| 4822 | T = S.BuildParenType(T); | ||||||||||
| 4823 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4824 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 4825 | // If blocks are disabled, emit an error. | ||||||||||
| 4826 | if (!LangOpts.Blocks) | ||||||||||
| 4827 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::err_blocks_disable) << LangOpts.OpenCL; | ||||||||||
| 4828 | |||||||||||
| 4829 | // Handle pointer nullability. | ||||||||||
| 4830 | inferPointerNullability(SimplePointerKind::BlockPointer, DeclType.Loc, | ||||||||||
| 4831 | DeclType.EndLoc, DeclType.getAttrs(), | ||||||||||
| 4832 | state.getDeclarator().getAttributePool()); | ||||||||||
| 4833 | |||||||||||
| 4834 | T = S.BuildBlockPointerType(T, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name); | ||||||||||
| 4835 | if (DeclType.Cls.TypeQuals || LangOpts.OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 4836 | // OpenCL v2.0, s6.12.5 - Block variable declarations are implicitly | ||||||||||
| 4837 | // qualified with const. | ||||||||||
| 4838 | if (LangOpts.OpenCL) | ||||||||||
| 4839 | DeclType.Cls.TypeQuals |= DeclSpec::TQ_const; | ||||||||||
| 4840 | T = S.BuildQualifiedType(T, DeclType.Loc, DeclType.Cls.TypeQuals); | ||||||||||
| 4841 | } | ||||||||||
| 4842 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4843 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 4844 | // Verify that we're not building a pointer to pointer to function with | ||||||||||
| 4845 | // exception specification. | ||||||||||
| 4846 | if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && S.CheckDistantExceptionSpec(T)) { | ||||||||||
| 4847 | S.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_distant_exception_spec); | ||||||||||
| 4848 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 4849 | // Build the type anyway. | ||||||||||
| 4850 | } | ||||||||||
| 4851 | |||||||||||
| 4852 | // Handle pointer nullability | ||||||||||
| 4853 | inferPointerNullability(SimplePointerKind::Pointer, DeclType.Loc, | ||||||||||
| 4854 | DeclType.EndLoc, DeclType.getAttrs(), | ||||||||||
| 4855 | state.getDeclarator().getAttributePool()); | ||||||||||
| 4856 | |||||||||||
| 4857 | if (LangOpts.ObjC && T->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 4858 | T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); | ||||||||||
| 4859 | if (DeclType.Ptr.TypeQuals) | ||||||||||
| 4860 | T = S.BuildQualifiedType(T, DeclType.Loc, DeclType.Ptr.TypeQuals); | ||||||||||
| 4861 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4862 | } | ||||||||||
| 4863 | |||||||||||
| 4864 | // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9b - Pointer to image/sampler cannot be used. | ||||||||||
| 4865 | // OpenCL v2.0 s6.13.16.1 - Pointer to pipe cannot be used. | ||||||||||
| 4866 | // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Pointers to Blocks are not allowed. | ||||||||||
| 4867 | if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 4868 | if (T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() || T->isPipeType() || | ||||||||||
| 4869 | T->isBlockPointerType()) { | ||||||||||
| 4870 | S.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_opencl_pointer_to_type) << T; | ||||||||||
| 4871 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 4872 | } | ||||||||||
| 4873 | } | ||||||||||
| 4874 | |||||||||||
| 4875 | T = S.BuildPointerType(T, DeclType.Loc, Name); | ||||||||||
| 4876 | if (DeclType.Ptr.TypeQuals) | ||||||||||
| 4877 | T = S.BuildQualifiedType(T, DeclType.Loc, DeclType.Ptr.TypeQuals); | ||||||||||
| 4878 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4879 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: { | ||||||||||
| 4880 | // Verify that we're not building a reference to pointer to function with | ||||||||||
| 4881 | // exception specification. | ||||||||||
| 4882 | if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && S.CheckDistantExceptionSpec(T)) { | ||||||||||
| 4883 | S.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_distant_exception_spec); | ||||||||||
| 4884 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 4885 | // Build the type anyway. | ||||||||||
| 4886 | } | ||||||||||
| 4887 | T = S.BuildReferenceType(T, DeclType.Ref.LValueRef, DeclType.Loc, Name); | ||||||||||
| 4888 | |||||||||||
| 4889 | if (DeclType.Ref.HasRestrict) | ||||||||||
| 4890 | T = S.BuildQualifiedType(T, DeclType.Loc, Qualifiers::Restrict); | ||||||||||
| 4891 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4892 | } | ||||||||||
| 4893 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: { | ||||||||||
| 4894 | // Verify that we're not building an array of pointers to function with | ||||||||||
| 4895 | // exception specification. | ||||||||||
| 4896 | if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && S.CheckDistantExceptionSpec(T)) { | ||||||||||
| 4897 | S.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_distant_exception_spec); | ||||||||||
| 4898 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 4899 | // Build the type anyway. | ||||||||||
| 4900 | } | ||||||||||
| 4901 | DeclaratorChunk::ArrayTypeInfo &ATI = DeclType.Arr; | ||||||||||
| 4902 | Expr *ArraySize = static_cast<Expr*>(ATI.NumElts); | ||||||||||
| 4903 | ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM; | ||||||||||
| 4904 | if (ATI.isStar) | ||||||||||
| 4905 | ASM = ArrayType::Star; | ||||||||||
| 4906 | else if (ATI.hasStatic) | ||||||||||
| 4907 | ASM = ArrayType::Static; | ||||||||||
| 4908 | else | ||||||||||
| 4909 | ASM = ArrayType::Normal; | ||||||||||
| 4910 | if (ASM == ArrayType::Star && !D.isPrototypeContext()) { | ||||||||||
| 4911 | // FIXME: This check isn't quite right: it allows star in prototypes | ||||||||||
| 4912 | // for function definitions, and disallows some edge cases detailed | ||||||||||
| 4913 | // in http://gcc.gnu.org/ml/gcc-patches/2009-02/msg00133.html | ||||||||||
| 4914 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::err_array_star_outside_prototype); | ||||||||||
| 4915 | ASM = ArrayType::Normal; | ||||||||||
| 4916 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 4917 | } | ||||||||||
| 4918 | |||||||||||
| 4919 | // C99 6.7.5.2p1: The optional type qualifiers and the keyword static | ||||||||||
| 4920 | // shall appear only in a declaration of a function parameter with an | ||||||||||
| 4921 | // array type, ... | ||||||||||
| 4922 | if (ASM == ArrayType::Static || ATI.TypeQuals) { | ||||||||||
| 4923 | if (!(D.isPrototypeContext() || | ||||||||||
| 4924 | D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList)) { | ||||||||||
| 4925 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::err_array_static_outside_prototype) << | ||||||||||
| 4926 | (ASM == ArrayType::Static ? "'static'" : "type qualifier"); | ||||||||||
| 4927 | // Remove the 'static' and the type qualifiers. | ||||||||||
| 4928 | if (ASM == ArrayType::Static) | ||||||||||
| 4929 | ASM = ArrayType::Normal; | ||||||||||
| 4930 | ATI.TypeQuals = 0; | ||||||||||
| 4931 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 4932 | } | ||||||||||
| 4933 | |||||||||||
| 4934 | // C99 6.7.5.2p1: ... and then only in the outermost array type | ||||||||||
| 4935 | // derivation. | ||||||||||
| 4936 | if (hasOuterPointerLikeChunk(D, chunkIndex)) { | ||||||||||
| 4937 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::err_array_static_not_outermost) << | ||||||||||
| 4938 | (ASM == ArrayType::Static ? "'static'" : "type qualifier"); | ||||||||||
| 4939 | if (ASM == ArrayType::Static) | ||||||||||
| 4940 | ASM = ArrayType::Normal; | ||||||||||
| 4941 | ATI.TypeQuals = 0; | ||||||||||
| 4942 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 4943 | } | ||||||||||
| 4944 | } | ||||||||||
| 4945 | const AutoType *AT = T->getContainedAutoType(); | ||||||||||
| 4946 | // Allow arrays of auto if we are a generic lambda parameter. | ||||||||||
| 4947 | // i.e. [](auto (&array)[5]) { return array[0]; }; OK | ||||||||||
| 4948 | if (AT && D.getContext() != DeclaratorContext::LambdaExprParameter) { | ||||||||||
| 4949 | // We've already diagnosed this for decltype(auto). | ||||||||||
| 4950 | if (!AT->isDecltypeAuto()) | ||||||||||
| 4951 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::err_illegal_decl_array_of_auto) | ||||||||||
| 4952 | << getPrintableNameForEntity(Name) << T; | ||||||||||
| 4953 | T = QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 4954 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4955 | } | ||||||||||
| 4956 | |||||||||||
| 4957 | // Array parameters can be marked nullable as well, although it's not | ||||||||||
| 4958 | // necessary if they're marked 'static'. | ||||||||||
| 4959 | if (complainAboutMissingNullability == CAMN_Yes && | ||||||||||
| 4960 | !hasNullabilityAttr(DeclType.getAttrs()) && | ||||||||||
| 4961 | ASM != ArrayType::Static && | ||||||||||
| 4962 | D.isPrototypeContext() && | ||||||||||
| 4963 | !hasOuterPointerLikeChunk(D, chunkIndex)) { | ||||||||||
| 4964 | checkNullabilityConsistency(S, SimplePointerKind::Array, DeclType.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 4965 | } | ||||||||||
| 4966 | |||||||||||
| 4967 | T = S.BuildArrayType(T, ASM, ArraySize, ATI.TypeQuals, | ||||||||||
| 4968 | SourceRange(DeclType.Loc, DeclType.EndLoc), Name); | ||||||||||
| 4969 | break; | ||||||||||
| 4970 | } | ||||||||||
| 4971 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: { | ||||||||||
| 4972 | // If the function declarator has a prototype (i.e. it is not () and | ||||||||||
| 4973 | // does not have a K&R-style identifier list), then the arguments are part | ||||||||||
| 4974 | // of the type, otherwise the argument list is (). | ||||||||||
| 4975 | DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = DeclType.Fun; | ||||||||||
| 4976 | IsQualifiedFunction = | ||||||||||
| 4977 | FTI.hasMethodTypeQualifiers() || FTI.hasRefQualifier(); | ||||||||||
| 4978 | |||||||||||
| 4979 | // Check for auto functions and trailing return type and adjust the | ||||||||||
| 4980 | // return type accordingly. | ||||||||||
| 4981 | if (!D.isInvalidType()) { | ||||||||||
| 4982 | // trailing-return-type is only required if we're declaring a function, | ||||||||||
| 4983 | // and not, for instance, a pointer to a function. | ||||||||||
| 4984 | if (D.getDeclSpec().hasAutoTypeSpec() && | ||||||||||
| 4985 | !FTI.hasTrailingReturnType() && chunkIndex == 0) { | ||||||||||
| 4986 | if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { | ||||||||||
| 4987 | S.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 4988 | D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_auto | ||||||||||
| 4989 | ? diag::err_auto_missing_trailing_return | ||||||||||
| 4990 | : diag::err_deduced_return_type); | ||||||||||
| 4991 | T = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 4992 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 4993 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 4994 | S.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 4995 | diag::warn_cxx11_compat_deduced_return_type); | ||||||||||
| 4996 | } | ||||||||||
| 4997 | } else if (FTI.hasTrailingReturnType()) { | ||||||||||
| 4998 | // T must be exactly 'auto' at this point. See CWG issue 681. | ||||||||||
| 4999 | if (isa<ParenType>(T)) { | ||||||||||
| 5000 | S.Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_trailing_return_in_parens) | ||||||||||
| 5001 | << T << D.getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 5002 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5003 | } else if (D.getName().getKind() == | ||||||||||
| 5004 | UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName) { | ||||||||||
| 5005 | if (T != Context.DependentTy) { | ||||||||||
| 5006 | S.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 5007 | diag::err_deduction_guide_with_complex_decl) | ||||||||||
| 5008 | << D.getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 5009 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5010 | } | ||||||||||
| 5011 | } else if (D.getContext() != DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr && | ||||||||||
| 5012 | (T.hasQualifiers() || !isa<AutoType>(T) || | ||||||||||
| 5013 | cast<AutoType>(T)->getKeyword() != | ||||||||||
| 5014 | AutoTypeKeyword::Auto || | ||||||||||
| 5015 | cast<AutoType>(T)->isConstrained())) { | ||||||||||
| 5016 | S.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 5017 | diag::err_trailing_return_without_auto) | ||||||||||
| 5018 | << T << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 5019 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5020 | } | ||||||||||
| 5021 | T = S.GetTypeFromParser(FTI.getTrailingReturnType(), &TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5022 | if (T.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 5023 | // An error occurred parsing the trailing return type. | ||||||||||
| 5024 | T = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 5025 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5026 | } else if (AutoType *Auto = T->getContainedAutoType()) { | ||||||||||
| 5027 | // If the trailing return type contains an `auto`, we may need to | ||||||||||
| 5028 | // invent a template parameter for it, for cases like | ||||||||||
| 5029 | // `auto f() -> C auto` or `[](auto (*p) -> auto) {}`. | ||||||||||
| 5030 | InventedTemplateParameterInfo *InventedParamInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5031 | if (D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::Prototype) | ||||||||||
| 5032 | InventedParamInfo = &S.InventedParameterInfos.back(); | ||||||||||
| 5033 | else if (D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::LambdaExprParameter) | ||||||||||
| 5034 | InventedParamInfo = S.getCurLambda(); | ||||||||||
| 5035 | if (InventedParamInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 5036 | std::tie(T, TInfo) = InventTemplateParameter( | ||||||||||
| 5037 | state, T, TInfo, Auto, *InventedParamInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5038 | } | ||||||||||
| 5039 | } | ||||||||||
| 5040 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 5041 | // This function type is not the type of the entity being declared, | ||||||||||
| 5042 | // so checking the 'auto' is not the responsibility of this chunk. | ||||||||||
| 5043 | } | ||||||||||
| 5044 | } | ||||||||||
| 5045 | |||||||||||
| 5046 | // C99 6.7.5.3p1: The return type may not be a function or array type. | ||||||||||
| 5047 | // For conversion functions, we'll diagnose this particular error later. | ||||||||||
| 5048 | if (!D.isInvalidType() && (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && | ||||||||||
| 5049 | (D.getName().getKind() != | ||||||||||
| 5050 | UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId)) { | ||||||||||
| 5051 | unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function; | ||||||||||
| 5052 | // Last processing chunk in block context means this function chunk | ||||||||||
| 5053 | // represents the block. | ||||||||||
| 5054 | if (chunkIndex == 0 && | ||||||||||
| 5055 | D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteral) | ||||||||||
| 5056 | diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function; | ||||||||||
| 5057 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diagID) << T->isFunctionType() << T; | ||||||||||
| 5058 | T = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 5059 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5060 | } | ||||||||||
| 5061 | |||||||||||
| 5062 | // Do not allow returning half FP value. | ||||||||||
| 5063 | // FIXME: This really should be in BuildFunctionType. | ||||||||||
| 5064 | if (T->isHalfType()) { | ||||||||||
| 5065 | if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 5066 | if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", | ||||||||||
| 5067 | S.getLangOpts())) { | ||||||||||
| 5068 | S.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_return) | ||||||||||
| 5069 | << T << 0 /*pointer hint*/; | ||||||||||
| 5070 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5071 | } | ||||||||||
| 5072 | } else if (!S.getLangOpts().HalfArgsAndReturns) { | ||||||||||
| 5073 | S.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 5074 | diag::err_parameters_retval_cannot_have_fp16_type) << 1; | ||||||||||
| 5075 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5076 | } | ||||||||||
| 5077 | } | ||||||||||
| 5078 | |||||||||||
| 5079 | if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 5080 | // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - A block cannot be the return value of a | ||||||||||
| 5081 | // function. | ||||||||||
| 5082 | if (T->isBlockPointerType() || T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() || | ||||||||||
| 5083 | T->isPipeType()) { | ||||||||||
| 5084 | S.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_return) | ||||||||||
| 5085 | << T << 1 /*hint off*/; | ||||||||||
| 5086 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5087 | } | ||||||||||
| 5088 | // OpenCL doesn't support variadic functions and blocks | ||||||||||
| 5089 | // (s6.9.e and s6.12.5 OpenCL v2.0) except for printf. | ||||||||||
| 5090 | // We also allow here any toolchain reserved identifiers. | ||||||||||
| 5091 | if (FTI.isVariadic && | ||||||||||
| 5092 | !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption( | ||||||||||
| 5093 | "__cl_clang_variadic_functions", S.getLangOpts()) && | ||||||||||
| 5094 | !(D.getIdentifier() && | ||||||||||
| 5095 | ((D.getIdentifier()->getName() == "printf" && | ||||||||||
| 5096 | (LangOpts.OpenCLCPlusPlus || LangOpts.OpenCLVersion >= 120)) || | ||||||||||
| 5097 | D.getIdentifier()->getName().startswith("__")))) { | ||||||||||
| 5098 | S.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_opencl_variadic_function); | ||||||||||
| 5099 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5100 | } | ||||||||||
| 5101 | } | ||||||||||
| 5102 | |||||||||||
| 5103 | // Methods cannot return interface types. All ObjC objects are | ||||||||||
| 5104 | // passed by reference. | ||||||||||
| 5105 | if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { | ||||||||||
| 5106 | SourceLocation DiagLoc, FixitLoc; | ||||||||||
| 5107 | if (TInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 5108 | DiagLoc = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 5109 | FixitLoc = S.getLocForEndOfToken(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getEndLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5110 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 5111 | DiagLoc = D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 5112 | FixitLoc = S.getLocForEndOfToken(D.getDeclSpec().getEndLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5113 | } | ||||||||||
| 5114 | S.Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) | ||||||||||
| 5115 | << 0 << T | ||||||||||
| 5116 | << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixitLoc, "*"); | ||||||||||
| 5117 | |||||||||||
| 5118 | T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); | ||||||||||
| 5119 | if (TInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 5120 | TypeLocBuilder TLB; | ||||||||||
| 5121 | TLB.pushFullCopy(TInfo->getTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5122 | ObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc TLoc = TLB.push<ObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc>(T); | ||||||||||
| 5123 | TLoc.setStarLoc(FixitLoc); | ||||||||||
| 5124 | TInfo = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T); | ||||||||||
| 5125 | } | ||||||||||
| 5126 | |||||||||||
| 5127 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5128 | } | ||||||||||
| 5129 | |||||||||||
| 5130 | // cv-qualifiers on return types are pointless except when the type is a | ||||||||||
| 5131 | // class type in C++. | ||||||||||
| 5132 | if ((T.getCVRQualifiers() || T->isAtomicType()) && | ||||||||||
| 5133 | !(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && | ||||||||||
| 5134 | (T->isDependentType() || T->isRecordType()))) { | ||||||||||
| 5135 | if (T->isVoidType() && !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && | ||||||||||
| 5136 | D.getFunctionDefinitionKind() == | ||||||||||
| 5137 | FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition) { | ||||||||||
| 5138 | // [6.9.1/3] qualified void return is invalid on a C | ||||||||||
| 5139 | // function definition. Apparently ok on declarations and | ||||||||||
| 5140 | // in C++ though (!) | ||||||||||
| 5141 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::err_func_returning_qualified_void) << T; | ||||||||||
| 5142 | } else | ||||||||||
| 5143 | diagnoseRedundantReturnTypeQualifiers(S, T, D, chunkIndex); | ||||||||||
| 5144 | |||||||||||
| 5145 | // C++2a [dcl.fct]p12: | ||||||||||
| 5146 | // A volatile-qualified return type is deprecated | ||||||||||
| 5147 | if (T.isVolatileQualified() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) | ||||||||||
| 5148 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::warn_deprecated_volatile_return) << T; | ||||||||||
| 5149 | } | ||||||||||
| 5150 | |||||||||||
| 5151 | // Objective-C ARC ownership qualifiers are ignored on the function | ||||||||||
| 5152 | // return type (by type canonicalization). Complain if this attribute | ||||||||||
| 5153 | // was written here. | ||||||||||
| 5154 | if (T.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) { | ||||||||||
| 5155 | SourceLocation AttrLoc; | ||||||||||
| 5156 | if (chunkIndex + 1 < D.getNumTypeObjects()) { | ||||||||||
| 5157 | DeclaratorChunk ReturnTypeChunk = D.getTypeObject(chunkIndex + 1); | ||||||||||
| 5158 | for (const ParsedAttr &AL : ReturnTypeChunk.getAttrs()) { | ||||||||||
| 5159 | if (AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership) { | ||||||||||
| 5160 | AttrLoc = AL.getLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 5161 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5162 | } | ||||||||||
| 5163 | } | ||||||||||
| 5164 | } | ||||||||||
| 5165 | if (AttrLoc.isInvalid()) { | ||||||||||
| 5166 | for (const ParsedAttr &AL : D.getDeclSpec().getAttributes()) { | ||||||||||
| 5167 | if (AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership) { | ||||||||||
| 5168 | AttrLoc = AL.getLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 5169 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5170 | } | ||||||||||
| 5171 | } | ||||||||||
| 5172 | } | ||||||||||
| 5173 | |||||||||||
| 5174 | if (AttrLoc.isValid()) { | ||||||||||
| 5175 | // The ownership attributes are almost always written via | ||||||||||
| 5176 | // the predefined | ||||||||||
| 5177 | // __strong/__weak/__autoreleasing/__unsafe_unretained. | ||||||||||
| 5178 | if (AttrLoc.isMacroID()) | ||||||||||
| 5179 | AttrLoc = | ||||||||||
| 5180 | S.SourceMgr.getImmediateExpansionRange(AttrLoc).getBegin(); | ||||||||||
| 5181 | |||||||||||
| 5182 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, diag::warn_arc_lifetime_result_type) | ||||||||||
| 5183 | << T.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime(); | ||||||||||
| 5184 | } | ||||||||||
| 5185 | } | ||||||||||
| 5186 | |||||||||||
| 5187 | if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().hasTagDefinition()) { | ||||||||||
| 5188 | // C++ [dcl.fct]p6: | ||||||||||
| 5189 | // Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types. | ||||||||||
| 5190 | TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl()); | ||||||||||
| 5191 | S.Diag(Tag->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_result_type) | ||||||||||
| 5192 | << Context.getTypeDeclType(Tag); | ||||||||||
| 5193 | } | ||||||||||
| 5194 | |||||||||||
| 5195 | // Exception specs are not allowed in typedefs. Complain, but add it | ||||||||||
| 5196 | // anyway. | ||||||||||
| 5197 | if (IsTypedefName && FTI.getExceptionSpecType() && !LangOpts.CPlusPlus17) | ||||||||||
| 5198 | S.Diag(FTI.getExceptionSpecLocBeg(), | ||||||||||
| 5199 | diag::err_exception_spec_in_typedef) | ||||||||||
| 5200 | << (D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::AliasDecl || | ||||||||||
| 5201 | D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::AliasTemplate); | ||||||||||
| 5202 | |||||||||||
| 5203 | // If we see "T var();" or "T var(T());" at block scope, it is probably | ||||||||||
| 5204 | // an attempt to initialize a variable, not a function declaration. | ||||||||||
| 5205 | if (FTI.isAmbiguous) | ||||||||||
| 5206 | warnAboutAmbiguousFunction(S, D, DeclType, T); | ||||||||||
| 5207 | |||||||||||
| 5208 | FunctionType::ExtInfo EI( | ||||||||||
| 5209 | getCCForDeclaratorChunk(S, D, DeclType.getAttrs(), FTI, chunkIndex)); | ||||||||||
| 5210 | |||||||||||
| 5211 | if (!FTI.NumParams && !FTI.isVariadic && !LangOpts.CPlusPlus | ||||||||||
| 5212 | && !LangOpts.OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 5213 | // Simple void foo(), where the incoming T is the result type. | ||||||||||
| 5214 | T = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(T, EI); | ||||||||||
| 5215 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 5216 | // We allow a zero-parameter variadic function in C if the | ||||||||||
| 5217 | // function is marked with the "overloadable" attribute. Scan | ||||||||||
| 5218 | // for this attribute now. | ||||||||||
| 5219 | if (!FTI.NumParams && FTI.isVariadic && !LangOpts.CPlusPlus) | ||||||||||
| 5220 | if (!D.getAttributes().hasAttribute(ParsedAttr::AT_Overloadable)) | ||||||||||
| 5221 | S.Diag(FTI.getEllipsisLoc(), diag::err_ellipsis_first_param); | ||||||||||
| 5222 | |||||||||||
| 5223 | if (FTI.NumParams && FTI.Params[0].Param == nullptr) { | ||||||||||
| 5224 | // C99 6.7.5.3p3: Reject int(x,y,z) when it's not a function | ||||||||||
| 5225 | // definition. | ||||||||||
| 5226 | S.Diag(FTI.Params[0].IdentLoc, | ||||||||||
| 5227 | diag::err_ident_list_in_fn_declaration); | ||||||||||
| 5228 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5229 | // Recover by creating a K&R-style function type. | ||||||||||
| 5230 | T = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(T, EI); | ||||||||||
| 5231 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5232 | } | ||||||||||
| 5233 | |||||||||||
| 5234 | FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; | ||||||||||
| 5235 | EPI.ExtInfo = EI; | ||||||||||
| 5236 | EPI.Variadic = FTI.isVariadic; | ||||||||||
| 5237 | EPI.EllipsisLoc = FTI.getEllipsisLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 5238 | EPI.HasTrailingReturn = FTI.hasTrailingReturnType(); | ||||||||||
| 5239 | EPI.TypeQuals.addCVRUQualifiers( | ||||||||||
| 5240 | FTI.MethodQualifiers ? FTI.MethodQualifiers->getTypeQualifiers() | ||||||||||
| 5241 | : 0); | ||||||||||
| 5242 | EPI.RefQualifier = !FTI.hasRefQualifier()? RQ_None | ||||||||||
| 5243 | : FTI.RefQualifierIsLValueRef? RQ_LValue | ||||||||||
| 5244 | : RQ_RValue; | ||||||||||
| 5245 | |||||||||||
| 5246 | // Otherwise, we have a function with a parameter list that is | ||||||||||
| 5247 | // potentially variadic. | ||||||||||
| 5248 | SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTys; | ||||||||||
| 5249 | ParamTys.reserve(FTI.NumParams); | ||||||||||
| 5250 | |||||||||||
| 5251 | SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 16> | ||||||||||
| 5252 | ExtParameterInfos(FTI.NumParams); | ||||||||||
| 5253 | bool HasAnyInterestingExtParameterInfos = false; | ||||||||||
| 5254 | |||||||||||
| 5255 | for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 5256 | ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param); | ||||||||||
| 5257 | QualType ParamTy = Param->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 5258 | assert(!ParamTy.isNull() && "Couldn't parse type?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5259 | |||||||||||
| 5260 | // Look for 'void'. void is allowed only as a single parameter to a | ||||||||||
| 5261 | // function with no other parameters (C99 6.7.5.3p10). We record | ||||||||||
| 5262 | // int(void) as a FunctionProtoType with an empty parameter list. | ||||||||||
| 5263 | if (ParamTy->isVoidType()) { | ||||||||||
| 5264 | // If this is something like 'float(int, void)', reject it. 'void' | ||||||||||
| 5265 | // is an incomplete type (C99 6.2.5p19) and function decls cannot | ||||||||||
| 5266 | // have parameters of incomplete type. | ||||||||||
| 5267 | if (FTI.NumParams != 1 || FTI.isVariadic) { | ||||||||||
| 5268 | S.Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::err_void_only_param); | ||||||||||
| 5269 | ParamTy = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 5270 | Param->setType(ParamTy); | ||||||||||
| 5271 | } else if (FTI.Params[i].Ident) { | ||||||||||
| 5272 | // Reject, but continue to parse 'int(void abc)'. | ||||||||||
| 5273 | S.Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::err_param_with_void_type); | ||||||||||
| 5274 | ParamTy = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 5275 | Param->setType(ParamTy); | ||||||||||
| 5276 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 5277 | // Reject, but continue to parse 'float(const void)'. | ||||||||||
| 5278 | if (ParamTy.hasQualifiers()) | ||||||||||
| 5279 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::err_void_param_qualified); | ||||||||||
| 5280 | |||||||||||
| 5281 | // Do not add 'void' to the list. | ||||||||||
| 5282 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5283 | } | ||||||||||
| 5284 | } else if (ParamTy->isHalfType()) { | ||||||||||
| 5285 | // Disallow half FP parameters. | ||||||||||
| 5286 | // FIXME: This really should be in BuildFunctionType. | ||||||||||
| 5287 | if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { | ||||||||||
| 5288 | if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", | ||||||||||
| 5289 | S.getLangOpts())) { | ||||||||||
| 5290 | S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_param) | ||||||||||
| 5291 | << ParamTy << 0; | ||||||||||
| 5292 | D.setInvalidType(); | ||||||||||
| 5293 | Param->setInvalidDecl(); | ||||||||||
| 5294 | } | ||||||||||
| 5295 | } else if (!S.getLangOpts().HalfArgsAndReturns) { | ||||||||||
| 5296 | S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), | ||||||||||
| 5297 | diag::err_parameters_retval_cannot_have_fp16_type) << 0; | ||||||||||
| 5298 | D.setInvalidType(); | ||||||||||
| 5299 | } | ||||||||||
| 5300 | } else if (!FTI.hasPrototype) { | ||||||||||
| 5301 | if (ParamTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) { | ||||||||||
| 5302 | ParamTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(ParamTy); | ||||||||||
| 5303 | Param->setKNRPromoted(true); | ||||||||||
| 5304 | } else if (const BuiltinType* BTy = ParamTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 5305 | if (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) { | ||||||||||
| 5306 | ParamTy = Context.DoubleTy; | ||||||||||
| 5307 | Param->setKNRPromoted(true); | ||||||||||
| 5308 | } | ||||||||||
| 5309 | } | ||||||||||
| 5310 | } else if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ParamTy->isBlockPointerType()) { | ||||||||||
| 5311 | // OpenCL 2.0 s6.12.5: A block cannot be a parameter of a function. | ||||||||||
| 5312 | S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_param) | ||||||||||
| 5313 | << ParamTy << 1 /*hint off*/; | ||||||||||
| 5314 | D.setInvalidType(); | ||||||||||
| 5315 | } | ||||||||||
| 5316 | |||||||||||
| 5317 | if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount && Param->hasAttr<NSConsumedAttr>()) { | ||||||||||
| 5318 | ExtParameterInfos[i] = ExtParameterInfos[i].withIsConsumed(true); | ||||||||||
| 5319 | HasAnyInterestingExtParameterInfos = true; | ||||||||||
| 5320 | } | ||||||||||
| 5321 | |||||||||||
| 5322 | if (auto attr = Param->getAttr<ParameterABIAttr>()) { | ||||||||||
| 5323 | ExtParameterInfos[i] = | ||||||||||
| 5324 | ExtParameterInfos[i].withABI(attr->getABI()); | ||||||||||
| 5325 | HasAnyInterestingExtParameterInfos = true; | ||||||||||
| 5326 | } | ||||||||||
| 5327 | |||||||||||
| 5328 | if (Param->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>()) { | ||||||||||
| 5329 | ExtParameterInfos[i] = ExtParameterInfos[i].withHasPassObjectSize(); | ||||||||||
| 5330 | HasAnyInterestingExtParameterInfos = true; | ||||||||||
| 5331 | } | ||||||||||
| 5332 | |||||||||||
| 5333 | if (Param->hasAttr<NoEscapeAttr>()) { | ||||||||||
| 5334 | ExtParameterInfos[i] = ExtParameterInfos[i].withIsNoEscape(true); | ||||||||||
| 5335 | HasAnyInterestingExtParameterInfos = true; | ||||||||||
| 5336 | } | ||||||||||
| 5337 | |||||||||||
| 5338 | ParamTys.push_back(ParamTy); | ||||||||||
| 5339 | } | ||||||||||
| 5340 | |||||||||||
| 5341 | if (HasAnyInterestingExtParameterInfos) { | ||||||||||
| 5342 | EPI.ExtParameterInfos = ExtParameterInfos.data(); | ||||||||||
| 5343 | checkExtParameterInfos(S, ParamTys, EPI, | ||||||||||
| 5344 | [&](unsigned i) { return FTI.Params[i].Param->getLocation(); }); | ||||||||||
| 5345 | } | ||||||||||
| 5346 | |||||||||||
| 5347 | SmallVector<QualType, 4> Exceptions; | ||||||||||
| 5348 | SmallVector<ParsedType, 2> DynamicExceptions; | ||||||||||
| 5349 | SmallVector<SourceRange, 2> DynamicExceptionRanges; | ||||||||||
| 5350 | Expr *NoexceptExpr = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5351 | |||||||||||
| 5352 | if (FTI.getExceptionSpecType() == EST_Dynamic) { | ||||||||||
| 5353 | // FIXME: It's rather inefficient to have to split into two vectors | ||||||||||
| 5354 | // here. | ||||||||||
| 5355 | unsigned N = FTI.getNumExceptions(); | ||||||||||
| 5356 | DynamicExceptions.reserve(N); | ||||||||||
| 5357 | DynamicExceptionRanges.reserve(N); | ||||||||||
| 5358 | for (unsigned I = 0; I != N; ++I) { | ||||||||||
| 5359 | DynamicExceptions.push_back(FTI.Exceptions[I].Ty); | ||||||||||
| 5360 | DynamicExceptionRanges.push_back(FTI.Exceptions[I].Range); | ||||||||||
| 5361 | } | ||||||||||
| 5362 | } else if (isComputedNoexcept(FTI.getExceptionSpecType())) { | ||||||||||
| 5363 | NoexceptExpr = FTI.NoexceptExpr; | ||||||||||
| 5364 | } | ||||||||||
| 5365 | |||||||||||
| 5366 | S.checkExceptionSpecification(D.isFunctionDeclarationContext(), | ||||||||||
| 5367 | FTI.getExceptionSpecType(), | ||||||||||
| 5368 | DynamicExceptions, | ||||||||||
| 5369 | DynamicExceptionRanges, | ||||||||||
| 5370 | NoexceptExpr, | ||||||||||
| 5371 | Exceptions, | ||||||||||
| 5372 | EPI.ExceptionSpec); | ||||||||||
| 5373 | |||||||||||
| 5374 | // FIXME: Set address space from attrs for C++ mode here. | ||||||||||
| 5375 | // OpenCLCPlusPlus: A class member function has an address space. | ||||||||||
| 5376 | auto IsClassMember = [&]() { | ||||||||||
| 5377 | return (!state.getDeclarator().getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty() && | ||||||||||
| 5378 | state.getDeclarator() | ||||||||||
| 5379 | .getCXXScopeSpec() | ||||||||||
| 5380 | .getScopeRep() | ||||||||||
| 5381 | ->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec) || | ||||||||||
| 5382 | state.getDeclarator().getContext() == | ||||||||||
| 5383 | DeclaratorContext::Member || | ||||||||||
| 5384 | state.getDeclarator().getContext() == | ||||||||||
| 5385 | DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr; | ||||||||||
| 5386 | }; | ||||||||||
| 5387 | |||||||||||
| 5388 | if (state.getSema().getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && IsClassMember()) { | ||||||||||
| 5389 | LangAS ASIdx = LangAS::Default; | ||||||||||
| 5390 | // Take address space attr if any and mark as invalid to avoid adding | ||||||||||
| 5391 | // them later while creating QualType. | ||||||||||
| 5392 | if (FTI.MethodQualifiers) | ||||||||||
| 5393 | for (ParsedAttr &attr : FTI.MethodQualifiers->getAttributes()) { | ||||||||||
| 5394 | LangAS ASIdxNew = attr.asOpenCLLangAS(); | ||||||||||
| 5395 | if (DiagnoseMultipleAddrSpaceAttributes(S, ASIdx, ASIdxNew, | ||||||||||
| 5396 | attr.getLoc())) | ||||||||||
| 5397 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5398 | else | ||||||||||
| 5399 | ASIdx = ASIdxNew; | ||||||||||
| 5400 | } | ||||||||||
| 5401 | // If a class member function's address space is not set, set it to | ||||||||||
| 5402 | // __generic. | ||||||||||
| 5403 | LangAS AS = | ||||||||||
| 5404 | (ASIdx == LangAS::Default ? S.getDefaultCXXMethodAddrSpace() | ||||||||||
| 5405 | : ASIdx); | ||||||||||
| 5406 | EPI.TypeQuals.addAddressSpace(AS); | ||||||||||
| 5407 | } | ||||||||||
| 5408 | T = Context.getFunctionType(T, ParamTys, EPI); | ||||||||||
| 5409 | } | ||||||||||
| 5410 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5411 | } | ||||||||||
| 5412 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: { | ||||||||||
| 5413 | // The scope spec must refer to a class, or be dependent. | ||||||||||
| 5414 | CXXScopeSpec &SS = DeclType.Mem.Scope(); | ||||||||||
| 5415 | QualType ClsType; | ||||||||||
| 5416 | |||||||||||
| 5417 | // Handle pointer nullability. | ||||||||||
| 5418 | inferPointerNullability(SimplePointerKind::MemberPointer, DeclType.Loc, | ||||||||||
| 5419 | DeclType.EndLoc, DeclType.getAttrs(), | ||||||||||
| 5420 | state.getDeclarator().getAttributePool()); | ||||||||||
| 5421 | |||||||||||
| 5422 | if (SS.isInvalid()) { | ||||||||||
| 5423 | // Avoid emitting extra errors if we already errored on the scope. | ||||||||||
| 5424 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5425 | } else if (S.isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS) || | ||||||||||
| 5426 | dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(S.computeDeclContext(SS))) { | ||||||||||
| 5427 | NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = SS.getScopeRep(); | ||||||||||
| 5428 | NestedNameSpecifier *NNSPrefix = NNS->getPrefix(); | ||||||||||
| 5429 | switch (NNS->getKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 5430 | case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier: | ||||||||||
| 5431 | ClsType = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNSPrefix, | ||||||||||
| 5432 | NNS->getAsIdentifier()); | ||||||||||
| 5433 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5434 | |||||||||||
| 5435 | case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace: | ||||||||||
| 5436 | case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias: | ||||||||||
| 5437 | case NestedNameSpecifier::Global: | ||||||||||
| 5438 | case NestedNameSpecifier::Super: | ||||||||||
| 5439 | llvm_unreachable("Nested-name-specifier must name a type")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 5440 | |||||||||||
| 5441 | case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec: | ||||||||||
| 5442 | case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: | ||||||||||
| 5443 | ClsType = QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0); | ||||||||||
| 5444 | // Note: if the NNS has a prefix and ClsType is a nondependent | ||||||||||
| 5445 | // TemplateSpecializationType, then the NNS prefix is NOT included | ||||||||||
| 5446 | // in ClsType; hence we wrap ClsType into an ElaboratedType. | ||||||||||
| 5447 | // NOTE: in particular, no wrap occurs if ClsType already is an | ||||||||||
| 5448 | // Elaborated, DependentName, or DependentTemplateSpecialization. | ||||||||||
| 5449 | if (NNSPrefix && isa<TemplateSpecializationType>(NNS->getAsType())) | ||||||||||
| 5450 | ClsType = Context.getElaboratedType(ETK_None, NNSPrefix, ClsType); | ||||||||||
| 5451 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5452 | } | ||||||||||
| 5453 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 5454 | S.Diag(DeclType.Mem.Scope().getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 5455 | diag::err_illegal_decl_mempointer_in_nonclass) | ||||||||||
| 5456 | << (D.getIdentifier() ? D.getIdentifier()->getName() : "type name") | ||||||||||
| 5457 | << DeclType.Mem.Scope().getRange(); | ||||||||||
| 5458 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5459 | } | ||||||||||
| 5460 | |||||||||||
| 5461 | if (!ClsType.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 5462 | T = S.BuildMemberPointerType(T, ClsType, DeclType.Loc, | ||||||||||
| 5463 | D.getIdentifier()); | ||||||||||
| 5464 | if (T.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 5465 | T = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 5466 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5467 | } else if (DeclType.Mem.TypeQuals) { | ||||||||||
| 5468 | T = S.BuildQualifiedType(T, DeclType.Loc, DeclType.Mem.TypeQuals); | ||||||||||
| 5469 | } | ||||||||||
| 5470 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5471 | } | ||||||||||
| 5472 | |||||||||||
| 5473 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: { | ||||||||||
| 5474 | T = S.BuildReadPipeType(T, DeclType.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 5475 | processTypeAttrs(state, T, TAL_DeclSpec, | ||||||||||
| 5476 | D.getMutableDeclSpec().getAttributes()); | ||||||||||
| 5477 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5478 | } | ||||||||||
| 5479 | } | ||||||||||
| 5480 | |||||||||||
| 5481 | if (T.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 5482 | D.setInvalidType(true); | ||||||||||
| 5483 | T = Context.IntTy; | ||||||||||
| 5484 | } | ||||||||||
| 5485 | |||||||||||
| 5486 | // See if there are any attributes on this declarator chunk. | ||||||||||
| 5487 | processTypeAttrs(state, T, TAL_DeclChunk, DeclType.getAttrs()); | ||||||||||
| 5488 | |||||||||||
| 5489 | if (DeclType.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Paren) { | ||||||||||
| 5490 | if (ExpectNoDerefChunk && !IsNoDerefableChunk(DeclType)) | ||||||||||
| 5491 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::warn_noderef_on_non_pointer_or_array); | ||||||||||
| 5492 | |||||||||||
| 5493 | ExpectNoDerefChunk = state.didParseNoDeref(); | ||||||||||
| 5494 | } | ||||||||||
| 5495 | } | ||||||||||
| 5496 | |||||||||||
| 5497 | if (ExpectNoDerefChunk) | ||||||||||
| 5498 | S.Diag(state.getDeclarator().getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 5499 | diag::warn_noderef_on_non_pointer_or_array); | ||||||||||
| 5500 | |||||||||||
| 5501 | // GNU warning -Wstrict-prototypes | ||||||||||
| 5502 | // Warn if a function declaration is without a prototype. | ||||||||||
| 5503 | // This warning is issued for all kinds of unprototyped function | ||||||||||
| 5504 | // declarations (i.e. function type typedef, function pointer etc.) | ||||||||||
| 5505 | // C99 6.7.5.3p14: | ||||||||||
| 5506 | // The empty list in a function declarator that is not part of a definition | ||||||||||
| 5507 | // of that function specifies that no information about the number or types | ||||||||||
| 5508 | // of the parameters is supplied. | ||||||||||
| 5509 | if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus && | ||||||||||
| 5510 | D.getFunctionDefinitionKind() == FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration) { | ||||||||||
| 5511 | bool IsBlock = false; | ||||||||||
| 5512 | for (const DeclaratorChunk &DeclType : D.type_objects()) { | ||||||||||
| 5513 | switch (DeclType.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 5514 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 5515 | IsBlock = true; | ||||||||||
| 5516 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5517 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: { | ||||||||||
| 5518 | const DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = DeclType.Fun; | ||||||||||
| 5519 | // We supress the warning when there's no LParen location, as this | ||||||||||
| 5520 | // indicates the declaration was an implicit declaration, which gets | ||||||||||
| 5521 | // warned about separately via -Wimplicit-function-declaration. | ||||||||||
| 5522 | if (FTI.NumParams == 0 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.getLParenLoc().isValid()) | ||||||||||
| 5523 | S.Diag(DeclType.Loc, diag::warn_strict_prototypes) | ||||||||||
| 5524 | << IsBlock | ||||||||||
| 5525 | << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FTI.getRParenLoc(), "void"); | ||||||||||
| 5526 | IsBlock = false; | ||||||||||
| 5527 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5528 | } | ||||||||||
| 5529 | default: | ||||||||||
| 5530 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5531 | } | ||||||||||
| 5532 | } | ||||||||||
| 5533 | } | ||||||||||
| 5534 | |||||||||||
| 5535 | assert(!T.isNull() && "T must not be null after this point")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5536 | |||||||||||
| 5537 | if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus
| ||||||||||
| 5538 | const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); | ||||||||||
| 5539 | assert(FnTy && "Why oh why is there not a FunctionProtoType here?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5540 | |||||||||||
| 5541 | // C++ 8.3.5p4: | ||||||||||
| 5542 | // A cv-qualifier-seq shall only be part of the function type | ||||||||||
| 5543 | // for a nonstatic member function, the function type to which a pointer | ||||||||||
| 5544 | // to member refers, or the top-level function type of a function typedef | ||||||||||
| 5545 | // declaration. | ||||||||||
| 5546 | // | ||||||||||
| 5547 | // Core issue 547 also allows cv-qualifiers on function types that are | ||||||||||
| 5548 | // top-level template type arguments. | ||||||||||
| 5549 | enum { NonMember, Member, DeductionGuide } Kind = NonMember; | ||||||||||
| 5550 | if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName) | ||||||||||
| 5551 | Kind = DeductionGuide; | ||||||||||
| 5552 | else if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { | ||||||||||
| 5553 | if ((D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::Member || | ||||||||||
| 5554 | D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr) && | ||||||||||
| 5555 | !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) | ||||||||||
| 5556 | Kind = Member; | ||||||||||
| 5557 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 5558 | DeclContext *DC = S.computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec()); | ||||||||||
| 5559 | if (!DC || DC->isRecord()) | ||||||||||
| 5560 | Kind = Member; | ||||||||||
| 5561 | } | ||||||||||
| 5562 | |||||||||||
| 5563 | // C++11 [dcl.fct]p6 (w/DR1417): | ||||||||||
| 5564 | // An attempt to specify a function type with a cv-qualifier-seq or a | ||||||||||
| 5565 | // ref-qualifier (including by typedef-name) is ill-formed unless it is: | ||||||||||
| 5566 | // - the function type for a non-static member function, | ||||||||||
| 5567 | // - the function type to which a pointer to member refers, | ||||||||||
| 5568 | // - the top-level function type of a function typedef declaration or | ||||||||||
| 5569 | // alias-declaration, | ||||||||||
| 5570 | // - the type-id in the default argument of a type-parameter, or | ||||||||||
| 5571 | // - the type-id of a template-argument for a type-parameter | ||||||||||
| 5572 | // | ||||||||||
| 5573 | // FIXME: Checking this here is insufficient. We accept-invalid on: | ||||||||||
| 5574 | // | ||||||||||
| 5575 | // template<typename T> struct S { void f(T); }; | ||||||||||
| 5576 | // S<int() const> s; | ||||||||||
| 5577 | // | ||||||||||
| 5578 | // ... for instance. | ||||||||||
| 5579 | if (IsQualifiedFunction && | ||||||||||
| 5580 | !(Kind == Member && | ||||||||||
| 5581 | D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static) && | ||||||||||
| 5582 | !IsTypedefName && D.getContext() != DeclaratorContext::TemplateArg && | ||||||||||
| 5583 | D.getContext() != DeclaratorContext::TemplateTypeArg) { | ||||||||||
| 5584 | SourceLocation Loc = D.getBeginLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 5585 | SourceRange RemovalRange; | ||||||||||
| 5586 | unsigned I; | ||||||||||
| 5587 | if (D.isFunctionDeclarator(I)) { | ||||||||||
| 5588 | SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> RemovalLocs; | ||||||||||
| 5589 | const DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I); | ||||||||||
| 5590 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5591 | |||||||||||
| 5592 | if (Chunk.Fun.hasRefQualifier()) | ||||||||||
| 5593 | RemovalLocs.push_back(Chunk.Fun.getRefQualifierLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5594 | |||||||||||
| 5595 | if (Chunk.Fun.hasMethodTypeQualifiers()) | ||||||||||
| 5596 | Chunk.Fun.MethodQualifiers->forEachQualifier( | ||||||||||
| 5597 | [&](DeclSpec::TQ TypeQual, StringRef QualName, | ||||||||||
| 5598 | SourceLocation SL) { RemovalLocs.push_back(SL); }); | ||||||||||
| 5599 | |||||||||||
| 5600 | if (!RemovalLocs.empty()) { | ||||||||||
| 5601 | llvm::sort(RemovalLocs, | ||||||||||
| 5602 | BeforeThanCompare<SourceLocation>(S.getSourceManager())); | ||||||||||
| 5603 | RemovalRange = SourceRange(RemovalLocs.front(), RemovalLocs.back()); | ||||||||||
| 5604 | Loc = RemovalLocs.front(); | ||||||||||
| 5605 | } | ||||||||||
| 5606 | } | ||||||||||
| 5607 | |||||||||||
| 5608 | S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_qualified_function_type) | ||||||||||
| 5609 | << Kind << D.isFunctionDeclarator() << T | ||||||||||
| 5610 | << getFunctionQualifiersAsString(FnTy) | ||||||||||
| 5611 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemovalRange); | ||||||||||
| 5612 | |||||||||||
| 5613 | // Strip the cv-qualifiers and ref-qualifiers from the type. | ||||||||||
| 5614 | FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FnTy->getExtProtoInfo(); | ||||||||||
| 5615 | EPI.TypeQuals.removeCVRQualifiers(); | ||||||||||
| 5616 | EPI.RefQualifier = RQ_None; | ||||||||||
| 5617 | |||||||||||
| 5618 | T = Context.getFunctionType(FnTy->getReturnType(), FnTy->getParamTypes(), | ||||||||||
| 5619 | EPI); | ||||||||||
| 5620 | // Rebuild any parens around the identifier in the function type. | ||||||||||
| 5621 | for (unsigned i = 0, e = D.getNumTypeObjects(); i != e; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 5622 | if (D.getTypeObject(i).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Paren) | ||||||||||
| 5623 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5624 | T = S.BuildParenType(T); | ||||||||||
| 5625 | } | ||||||||||
| 5626 | } | ||||||||||
| 5627 | } | ||||||||||
| 5628 | |||||||||||
| 5629 | // Apply any undistributed attributes from the declarator. | ||||||||||
| 5630 | processTypeAttrs(state, T, TAL_DeclName, D.getAttributes()); | ||||||||||
| 5631 | |||||||||||
| 5632 | // Diagnose any ignored type attributes. | ||||||||||
| 5633 | state.diagnoseIgnoredTypeAttrs(T); | ||||||||||
| 5634 | |||||||||||
| 5635 | // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p9: | ||||||||||
| 5636 | // A constexpr specifier used in an object declaration declares the object | ||||||||||
| 5637 | // as const. | ||||||||||
| 5638 | if (D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier() == ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr && | ||||||||||
| 5639 | T->isObjectType()) | ||||||||||
| 5640 | T.addConst(); | ||||||||||
| 5641 | |||||||||||
| 5642 | // C++2a [dcl.fct]p4: | ||||||||||
| 5643 | // A parameter with volatile-qualified type is deprecated | ||||||||||
| 5644 | if (T.isVolatileQualified() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && | ||||||||||
| 5645 | (D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::Prototype || | ||||||||||
| 5646 | D.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::LambdaExprParameter)) | ||||||||||
| 5647 | S.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::warn_deprecated_volatile_param) << T; | ||||||||||
| 5648 | |||||||||||
| 5649 | // If there was an ellipsis in the declarator, the declaration declares a | ||||||||||
| 5650 | // parameter pack whose type may be a pack expansion type. | ||||||||||
| 5651 | if (D.hasEllipsis()) { | ||||||||||
| 5652 | // C++0x [dcl.fct]p13: | ||||||||||
| 5653 | // A declarator-id or abstract-declarator containing an ellipsis shall | ||||||||||
| 5654 | // only be used in a parameter-declaration. Such a parameter-declaration | ||||||||||
| 5655 | // is a parameter pack (14.5.3). [...] | ||||||||||
| 5656 | switch (D.getContext()) { | ||||||||||
| 5657 | case DeclaratorContext::Prototype: | ||||||||||
| 5658 | case DeclaratorContext::LambdaExprParameter: | ||||||||||
| 5659 | case DeclaratorContext::RequiresExpr: | ||||||||||
| 5660 | // C++0x [dcl.fct]p13: | ||||||||||
| 5661 | // [...] When it is part of a parameter-declaration-clause, the | ||||||||||
| 5662 | // parameter pack is a function parameter pack (14.5.3). The type T | ||||||||||
| 5663 | // of the declarator-id of the function parameter pack shall contain | ||||||||||
| 5664 | // a template parameter pack; each template parameter pack in T is | ||||||||||
| 5665 | // expanded by the function parameter pack. | ||||||||||
| 5666 | // | ||||||||||
| 5667 | // We represent function parameter packs as function parameters whose | ||||||||||
| 5668 | // type is a pack expansion. | ||||||||||
| 5669 | if (!T->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() && | ||||||||||
| 5670 | (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus20 || !T->getContainedAutoType())) { | ||||||||||
| 5671 | S.Diag(D.getEllipsisLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 5672 | diag::err_function_parameter_pack_without_parameter_packs) | ||||||||||
| 5673 | << T << D.getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 5674 | D.setEllipsisLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 5675 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 5676 | T = Context.getPackExpansionType(T, None, /*ExpectPackInType=*/false); | ||||||||||
| 5677 | } | ||||||||||
| 5678 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5679 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateParam: | ||||||||||
| 5680 | // C++0x [temp.param]p15: | ||||||||||
| 5681 | // If a template-parameter is a [...] is a parameter-declaration that | ||||||||||
| 5682 | // declares a parameter pack (8.3.5), then the template-parameter is a | ||||||||||
| 5683 | // template parameter pack (14.5.3). | ||||||||||
| 5684 | // | ||||||||||
| 5685 | // Note: core issue 778 clarifies that, if there are any unexpanded | ||||||||||
| 5686 | // parameter packs in the type of the non-type template parameter, then | ||||||||||
| 5687 | // it expands those parameter packs. | ||||||||||
| 5688 | if (T->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) | ||||||||||
| 5689 | T = Context.getPackExpansionType(T, None); | ||||||||||
| 5690 | else | ||||||||||
| 5691 | S.Diag(D.getEllipsisLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 5692 | LangOpts.CPlusPlus11 | ||||||||||
| 5693 | ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_variadic_templates | ||||||||||
| 5694 | : diag::ext_variadic_templates); | ||||||||||
| 5695 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5696 | |||||||||||
| 5697 | case DeclaratorContext::File: | ||||||||||
| 5698 | case DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList: | ||||||||||
| 5699 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCParameter: // FIXME: special diagnostic here? | ||||||||||
| 5700 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCResult: // FIXME: special diagnostic here? | ||||||||||
| 5701 | case DeclaratorContext::TypeName: | ||||||||||
| 5702 | case DeclaratorContext::FunctionalCast: | ||||||||||
| 5703 | case DeclaratorContext::CXXNew: | ||||||||||
| 5704 | case DeclaratorContext::AliasDecl: | ||||||||||
| 5705 | case DeclaratorContext::AliasTemplate: | ||||||||||
| 5706 | case DeclaratorContext::Member: | ||||||||||
| 5707 | case DeclaratorContext::Block: | ||||||||||
| 5708 | case DeclaratorContext::ForInit: | ||||||||||
| 5709 | case DeclaratorContext::SelectionInit: | ||||||||||
| 5710 | case DeclaratorContext::Condition: | ||||||||||
| 5711 | case DeclaratorContext::CXXCatch: | ||||||||||
| 5712 | case DeclaratorContext::ObjCCatch: | ||||||||||
| 5713 | case DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteral: | ||||||||||
| 5714 | case DeclaratorContext::LambdaExpr: | ||||||||||
| 5715 | case DeclaratorContext::ConversionId: | ||||||||||
| 5716 | case DeclaratorContext::TrailingReturn: | ||||||||||
| 5717 | case DeclaratorContext::TrailingReturnVar: | ||||||||||
| 5718 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateArg: | ||||||||||
| 5719 | case DeclaratorContext::TemplateTypeArg: | ||||||||||
| 5720 | // FIXME: We may want to allow parameter packs in block-literal contexts | ||||||||||
| 5721 | // in the future. | ||||||||||
| 5722 | S.Diag(D.getEllipsisLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 5723 | diag::err_ellipsis_in_declarator_not_parameter); | ||||||||||
| 5724 | D.setEllipsisLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 5725 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5726 | } | ||||||||||
| 5727 | } | ||||||||||
| 5728 | |||||||||||
| 5729 | assert(!T.isNull() && "T must not be null at the end of this function")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5730 | if (D.isInvalidType()) | ||||||||||
| 5731 | return Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); | ||||||||||
| 5732 | |||||||||||
| 5733 | return GetTypeSourceInfoForDeclarator(state, T, TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5734 | } | ||||||||||
| 5735 | |||||||||||
| 5736 | /// GetTypeForDeclarator - Convert the type for the specified | ||||||||||
| 5737 | /// declarator to Type instances. | ||||||||||
| 5738 | /// | ||||||||||
| 5739 | /// The result of this call will never be null, but the associated | ||||||||||
| 5740 | /// type may be a null type if there's an unrecoverable error. | ||||||||||
| 5741 | TypeSourceInfo *Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator(Declarator &D, Scope *S) { | ||||||||||
| 5742 | // Determine the type of the declarator. Not all forms of declarator | ||||||||||
| 5743 | // have a type. | ||||||||||
| 5744 | |||||||||||
| 5745 | TypeProcessingState state(*this, D); | ||||||||||
| 5746 | |||||||||||
| 5747 | TypeSourceInfo *ReturnTypeInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5748 | QualType T = GetDeclSpecTypeForDeclarator(state, ReturnTypeInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5749 | if (D.isPrototypeContext() && getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) | ||||||||||
| 5750 | inferARCWriteback(state, T); | ||||||||||
| 5751 | |||||||||||
| 5752 | return GetFullTypeForDeclarator(state, T, ReturnTypeInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5753 | } | ||||||||||
| 5754 | |||||||||||
| 5755 | static void transferARCOwnershipToDeclSpec(Sema &S, | ||||||||||
| 5756 | QualType &declSpecTy, | ||||||||||
| 5757 | Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ownership) { | ||||||||||
| 5758 | if (declSpecTy->isObjCRetainableType() && | ||||||||||
| 5759 | declSpecTy.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None) { | ||||||||||
| 5760 | Qualifiers qs; | ||||||||||
| 5761 | qs.addObjCLifetime(ownership); | ||||||||||
| 5762 | declSpecTy = S.Context.getQualifiedType(declSpecTy, qs); | ||||||||||
| 5763 | } | ||||||||||
| 5764 | } | ||||||||||
| 5765 | |||||||||||
| 5766 | static void transferARCOwnershipToDeclaratorChunk(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 5767 | Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ownership, | ||||||||||
| 5768 | unsigned chunkIndex) { | ||||||||||
| 5769 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 5770 | Declarator &D = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 5771 | |||||||||||
| 5772 | // Look for an explicit lifetime attribute. | ||||||||||
| 5773 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = D.getTypeObject(chunkIndex); | ||||||||||
| 5774 | if (chunk.getAttrs().hasAttribute(ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership)) | ||||||||||
| 5775 | return; | ||||||||||
| 5776 | |||||||||||
| 5777 | const char *attrStr = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5778 | switch (ownership) { | ||||||||||
| 5779 | case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("no ownership!")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 5780 | case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: attrStr = "none"; break; | ||||||||||
| 5781 | case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: attrStr = "strong"; break; | ||||||||||
| 5782 | case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: attrStr = "weak"; break; | ||||||||||
| 5783 | case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: attrStr = "autoreleasing"; break; | ||||||||||
| 5784 | } | ||||||||||
| 5785 | |||||||||||
| 5786 | IdentifierLoc *Arg = new (S.Context) IdentifierLoc; | ||||||||||
| 5787 | Arg->Ident = &S.Context.Idents.get(attrStr); | ||||||||||
| 5788 | Arg->Loc = SourceLocation(); | ||||||||||
| 5789 | |||||||||||
| 5790 | ArgsUnion Args(Arg); | ||||||||||
| 5791 | |||||||||||
| 5792 | // If there wasn't one, add one (with an invalid source location | ||||||||||
| 5793 | // so that we don't make an AttributedType for it). | ||||||||||
| 5794 | ParsedAttr *attr = D.getAttributePool().create( | ||||||||||
| 5795 | &S.Context.Idents.get("objc_ownership"), SourceLocation(), | ||||||||||
| 5796 | /*scope*/ nullptr, SourceLocation(), | ||||||||||
| 5797 | /*args*/ &Args, 1, ParsedAttr::AS_GNU); | ||||||||||
| 5798 | chunk.getAttrs().addAtEnd(attr); | ||||||||||
| 5799 | // TODO: mark whether we did this inference? | ||||||||||
| 5800 | } | ||||||||||
| 5801 | |||||||||||
| 5802 | /// Used for transferring ownership in casts resulting in l-values. | ||||||||||
| 5803 | static void transferARCOwnership(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 5804 | QualType &declSpecTy, | ||||||||||
| 5805 | Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ownership) { | ||||||||||
| 5806 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 5807 | Declarator &D = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 5808 | |||||||||||
| 5809 | int inner = -1; | ||||||||||
| 5810 | bool hasIndirection = false; | ||||||||||
| 5811 | for (unsigned i = 0, e = D.getNumTypeObjects(); i != e; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 5812 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = D.getTypeObject(i); | ||||||||||
| 5813 | switch (chunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 5814 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 5815 | // Ignore parens. | ||||||||||
| 5816 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5817 | |||||||||||
| 5818 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 5819 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 5820 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 5821 | if (inner != -1) | ||||||||||
| 5822 | hasIndirection = true; | ||||||||||
| 5823 | inner = i; | ||||||||||
| 5824 | break; | ||||||||||
| 5825 | |||||||||||
| 5826 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 5827 | if (inner != -1) | ||||||||||
| 5828 | transferARCOwnershipToDeclaratorChunk(state, ownership, i); | ||||||||||
| 5829 | return; | ||||||||||
| 5830 | |||||||||||
| 5831 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 5832 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 5833 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 5834 | return; | ||||||||||
| 5835 | } | ||||||||||
| 5836 | } | ||||||||||
| 5837 | |||||||||||
| 5838 | if (inner == -1) | ||||||||||
| 5839 | return; | ||||||||||
| 5840 | |||||||||||
| 5841 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = D.getTypeObject(inner); | ||||||||||
| 5842 | if (chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Pointer) { | ||||||||||
| 5843 | if (declSpecTy->isObjCRetainableType()) | ||||||||||
| 5844 | return transferARCOwnershipToDeclSpec(S, declSpecTy, ownership); | ||||||||||
| 5845 | if (declSpecTy->isObjCObjectType() && hasIndirection) | ||||||||||
| 5846 | return transferARCOwnershipToDeclaratorChunk(state, ownership, inner); | ||||||||||
| 5847 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 5848 | assert(chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Array ||((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 5849 | chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Reference)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5850 | return transferARCOwnershipToDeclSpec(S, declSpecTy, ownership); | ||||||||||
| 5851 | } | ||||||||||
| 5852 | } | ||||||||||
| 5853 | |||||||||||
| 5854 | TypeSourceInfo *Sema::GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(Declarator &D, QualType FromTy) { | ||||||||||
| 5855 | TypeProcessingState state(*this, D); | ||||||||||
| 5856 | |||||||||||
| 5857 | TypeSourceInfo *ReturnTypeInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5858 | QualType declSpecTy = GetDeclSpecTypeForDeclarator(state, ReturnTypeInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5859 | |||||||||||
| 5860 | if (getLangOpts().ObjC) { | ||||||||||
| 5861 | Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ownership = Context.getInnerObjCOwnership(FromTy); | ||||||||||
| 5862 | if (ownership != Qualifiers::OCL_None) | ||||||||||
| 5863 | transferARCOwnership(state, declSpecTy, ownership); | ||||||||||
| 5864 | } | ||||||||||
| 5865 | |||||||||||
| 5866 | return GetFullTypeForDeclarator(state, declSpecTy, ReturnTypeInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5867 | } | ||||||||||
| 5868 | |||||||||||
| 5869 | static void fillAttributedTypeLoc(AttributedTypeLoc TL, | ||||||||||
| 5870 | TypeProcessingState &State) { | ||||||||||
| 5871 | TL.setAttr(State.takeAttrForAttributedType(TL.getTypePtr())); | ||||||||||
| 5872 | } | ||||||||||
| 5873 | |||||||||||
| 5874 | namespace { | ||||||||||
| 5875 | class TypeSpecLocFiller : public TypeLocVisitor<TypeSpecLocFiller> { | ||||||||||
| 5876 | Sema &SemaRef; | ||||||||||
| 5877 | ASTContext &Context; | ||||||||||
| 5878 | TypeProcessingState &State; | ||||||||||
| 5879 | const DeclSpec &DS; | ||||||||||
| 5880 | |||||||||||
| 5881 | public: | ||||||||||
| 5882 | TypeSpecLocFiller(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context, TypeProcessingState &State, | ||||||||||
| 5883 | const DeclSpec &DS) | ||||||||||
| 5884 | : SemaRef(S), Context(Context), State(State), DS(DS) {} | ||||||||||
| 5885 | |||||||||||
| 5886 | void VisitAttributedTypeLoc(AttributedTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5887 | Visit(TL.getModifiedLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5888 | fillAttributedTypeLoc(TL, State); | ||||||||||
| 5889 | } | ||||||||||
| 5890 | void VisitMacroQualifiedTypeLoc(MacroQualifiedTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5891 | Visit(TL.getInnerLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5892 | TL.setExpansionLoc( | ||||||||||
| 5893 | State.getExpansionLocForMacroQualifiedType(TL.getTypePtr())); | ||||||||||
| 5894 | } | ||||||||||
| 5895 | void VisitQualifiedTypeLoc(QualifiedTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5896 | Visit(TL.getUnqualifiedLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5897 | } | ||||||||||
| 5898 | void VisitTypedefTypeLoc(TypedefTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5899 | TL.setNameLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5900 | } | ||||||||||
| 5901 | void VisitObjCInterfaceTypeLoc(ObjCInterfaceTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5902 | TL.setNameLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5903 | // FIXME. We should have DS.getTypeSpecTypeEndLoc(). But, it requires | ||||||||||
| 5904 | // addition field. What we have is good enough for dispay of location | ||||||||||
| 5905 | // of 'fixit' on interface name. | ||||||||||
| 5906 | TL.setNameEndLoc(DS.getEndLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5907 | } | ||||||||||
| 5908 | void VisitObjCObjectTypeLoc(ObjCObjectTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5909 | TypeSourceInfo *RepTInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5910 | Sema::GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &RepTInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5911 | TL.copy(RepTInfo->getTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5912 | } | ||||||||||
| 5913 | void VisitObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc(ObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5914 | TypeSourceInfo *RepTInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5915 | Sema::GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &RepTInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5916 | TL.copy(RepTInfo->getTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| |||||||||||
| 5917 | } | ||||||||||
| 5918 | void VisitTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc(TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5919 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5920 | Sema::GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5921 | |||||||||||
| 5922 | // If we got no declarator info from previous Sema routines, | ||||||||||
| 5923 | // just fill with the typespec loc. | ||||||||||
| 5924 | if (!TInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 5925 | TL.initialize(Context, DS.getTypeSpecTypeNameLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5926 | return; | ||||||||||
| 5927 | } | ||||||||||
| 5928 | |||||||||||
| 5929 | TypeLoc OldTL = TInfo->getTypeLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 5930 | if (TInfo->getType()->getAs<ElaboratedType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 5931 | ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = OldTL.castAs<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(); | ||||||||||
| 5932 | TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc NamedTL = ElabTL.getNamedTypeLoc() | ||||||||||
| 5933 | .castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>(); | ||||||||||
| 5934 | TL.copy(NamedTL); | ||||||||||
| 5935 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 5936 | TL.copy(OldTL.castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>()); | ||||||||||
| 5937 | assert(TL.getRAngleLoc() == OldTL.castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>().getRAngleLoc())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5938 | } | ||||||||||
| 5939 | |||||||||||
| 5940 | } | ||||||||||
| 5941 | void VisitTypeOfExprTypeLoc(TypeOfExprTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5942 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5943 | TL.setTypeofLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5944 | TL.setParensRange(DS.getTypeofParensRange()); | ||||||||||
| 5945 | } | ||||||||||
| 5946 | void VisitTypeOfTypeLoc(TypeOfTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5947 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typeofType)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5948 | TL.setTypeofLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5949 | TL.setParensRange(DS.getTypeofParensRange()); | ||||||||||
| 5950 | assert(DS.getRepAsType())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5951 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5952 | Sema::GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5953 | TL.setUnderlyingTInfo(TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5954 | } | ||||||||||
| 5955 | void VisitUnaryTransformTypeLoc(UnaryTransformTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5956 | // FIXME: This holds only because we only have one unary transform. | ||||||||||
| 5957 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5958 | TL.setKWLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5959 | TL.setParensRange(DS.getTypeofParensRange()); | ||||||||||
| 5960 | assert(DS.getRepAsType())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5961 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5962 | Sema::GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5963 | TL.setUnderlyingTInfo(TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5964 | } | ||||||||||
| 5965 | void VisitBuiltinTypeLoc(BuiltinTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5966 | // By default, use the source location of the type specifier. | ||||||||||
| 5967 | TL.setBuiltinLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5968 | if (TL.needsExtraLocalData()) { | ||||||||||
| 5969 | // Set info for the written builtin specifiers. | ||||||||||
| 5970 | TL.getWrittenBuiltinSpecs() = DS.getWrittenBuiltinSpecs(); | ||||||||||
| 5971 | // Try to have a meaningful source location. | ||||||||||
| 5972 | if (TL.getWrittenSignSpec() != TypeSpecifierSign::Unspecified) | ||||||||||
| 5973 | TL.expandBuiltinRange(DS.getTypeSpecSignLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5974 | if (TL.getWrittenWidthSpec() != TypeSpecifierWidth::Unspecified) | ||||||||||
| 5975 | TL.expandBuiltinRange(DS.getTypeSpecWidthRange()); | ||||||||||
| 5976 | } | ||||||||||
| 5977 | } | ||||||||||
| 5978 | void VisitElaboratedTypeLoc(ElaboratedTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5979 | ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword | ||||||||||
| 5980 | = TypeWithKeyword::getKeywordForTypeSpec(DS.getTypeSpecType()); | ||||||||||
| 5981 | if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == TST_typename) { | ||||||||||
| 5982 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5983 | Sema::GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 5984 | if (TInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 5985 | TL.copy(TInfo->getTypeLoc().castAs<ElaboratedTypeLoc>()); | ||||||||||
| 5986 | return; | ||||||||||
| 5987 | } | ||||||||||
| 5988 | } | ||||||||||
| 5989 | TL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(Keyword != ETK_None | ||||||||||
| 5990 | ? DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc() | ||||||||||
| 5991 | : SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 5992 | const CXXScopeSpec& SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope(); | ||||||||||
| 5993 | TL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); | ||||||||||
| 5994 | Visit(TL.getNextTypeLoc().getUnqualifiedLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 5995 | } | ||||||||||
| 5996 | void VisitDependentNameTypeLoc(DependentNameTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 5997 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecType() == TST_typename)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 5998 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 5999 | Sema::GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 6000 | assert(TInfo)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6001 | TL.copy(TInfo->getTypeLoc().castAs<DependentNameTypeLoc>()); | ||||||||||
| 6002 | } | ||||||||||
| 6003 | void VisitDependentTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc( | ||||||||||
| 6004 | DependentTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6005 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecType() == TST_typename)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6006 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 6007 | Sema::GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 6008 | assert(TInfo)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6009 | TL.copy( | ||||||||||
| 6010 | TInfo->getTypeLoc().castAs<DependentTemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>()); | ||||||||||
| 6011 | } | ||||||||||
| 6012 | void VisitAutoTypeLoc(AutoTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6013 | assert(DS.getTypeSpecType() == TST_auto ||((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 6014 | DS.getTypeSpecType() == TST_decltype_auto ||((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 6015 | DS.getTypeSpecType() == TST_auto_type ||((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 6016 | DS.getTypeSpecType() == TST_unspecified)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6017 | TL.setNameLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6018 | if (!DS.isConstrainedAuto()) | ||||||||||
| 6019 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6020 | TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = DS.getRepAsTemplateId(); | ||||||||||
| 6021 | if (!TemplateId) | ||||||||||
| 6022 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6023 | if (DS.getTypeSpecScope().isNotEmpty()) | ||||||||||
| 6024 | TL.setNestedNameSpecifierLoc( | ||||||||||
| 6025 | DS.getTypeSpecScope().getWithLocInContext(Context)); | ||||||||||
| 6026 | else | ||||||||||
| 6027 | TL.setNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6028 | TL.setTemplateKWLoc(TemplateId->TemplateKWLoc); | ||||||||||
| 6029 | TL.setConceptNameLoc(TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc); | ||||||||||
| 6030 | TL.setFoundDecl(nullptr); | ||||||||||
| 6031 | TL.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 6032 | TL.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc); | ||||||||||
| 6033 | if (TemplateId->NumArgs == 0) | ||||||||||
| 6034 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6035 | TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsInfo; | ||||||||||
| 6036 | ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), | ||||||||||
| 6037 | TemplateId->NumArgs); | ||||||||||
| 6038 | SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, TemplateArgsInfo); | ||||||||||
| 6039 | for (unsigned I = 0; I < TemplateId->NumArgs; ++I) | ||||||||||
| 6040 | TL.setArgLocInfo(I, TemplateArgsInfo.arguments()[I].getLocInfo()); | ||||||||||
| 6041 | } | ||||||||||
| 6042 | void VisitTagTypeLoc(TagTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6043 | TL.setNameLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeNameLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6044 | } | ||||||||||
| 6045 | void VisitAtomicTypeLoc(AtomicTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6046 | // An AtomicTypeLoc can come from either an _Atomic(...) type specifier | ||||||||||
| 6047 | // or an _Atomic qualifier. | ||||||||||
| 6048 | if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_atomic) { | ||||||||||
| 6049 | TL.setKWLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6050 | TL.setParensRange(DS.getTypeofParensRange()); | ||||||||||
| 6051 | |||||||||||
| 6052 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 6053 | Sema::GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 6054 | assert(TInfo)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6055 | TL.getValueLoc().initializeFullCopy(TInfo->getTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6056 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 6057 | TL.setKWLoc(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6058 | // No parens, to indicate this was spelled as an _Atomic qualifier. | ||||||||||
| 6059 | TL.setParensRange(SourceRange()); | ||||||||||
| 6060 | Visit(TL.getValueLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6061 | } | ||||||||||
| 6062 | } | ||||||||||
| 6063 | |||||||||||
| 6064 | void VisitPipeTypeLoc(PipeTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6065 | TL.setKWLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6066 | |||||||||||
| 6067 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 6068 | Sema::GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 6069 | TL.getValueLoc().initializeFullCopy(TInfo->getTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6070 | } | ||||||||||
| 6071 | |||||||||||
| 6072 | void VisitExtIntTypeLoc(ExtIntTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6073 | TL.setNameLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6074 | } | ||||||||||
| 6075 | |||||||||||
| 6076 | void VisitDependentExtIntTypeLoc(DependentExtIntTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6077 | TL.setNameLoc(DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6078 | } | ||||||||||
| 6079 | |||||||||||
| 6080 | void VisitTypeLoc(TypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6081 | // FIXME: add other typespec types and change this to an assert. | ||||||||||
| 6082 | TL.initialize(Context, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6083 | } | ||||||||||
| 6084 | }; | ||||||||||
| 6085 | |||||||||||
| 6086 | class DeclaratorLocFiller : public TypeLocVisitor<DeclaratorLocFiller> { | ||||||||||
| 6087 | ASTContext &Context; | ||||||||||
| 6088 | TypeProcessingState &State; | ||||||||||
| 6089 | const DeclaratorChunk &Chunk; | ||||||||||
| 6090 | |||||||||||
| 6091 | public: | ||||||||||
| 6092 | DeclaratorLocFiller(ASTContext &Context, TypeProcessingState &State, | ||||||||||
| 6093 | const DeclaratorChunk &Chunk) | ||||||||||
| 6094 | : Context(Context), State(State), Chunk(Chunk) {} | ||||||||||
| 6095 | |||||||||||
| 6096 | void VisitQualifiedTypeLoc(QualifiedTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6097 | llvm_unreachable("qualified type locs not expected here!")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 6098 | } | ||||||||||
| 6099 | void VisitDecayedTypeLoc(DecayedTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6100 | llvm_unreachable("decayed type locs not expected here!")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 6101 | } | ||||||||||
| 6102 | |||||||||||
| 6103 | void VisitAttributedTypeLoc(AttributedTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6104 | fillAttributedTypeLoc(TL, State); | ||||||||||
| 6105 | } | ||||||||||
| 6106 | void VisitAdjustedTypeLoc(AdjustedTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6107 | // nothing | ||||||||||
| 6108 | } | ||||||||||
| 6109 | void VisitBlockPointerTypeLoc(BlockPointerTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6110 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6111 | TL.setCaretLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6112 | } | ||||||||||
| 6113 | void VisitPointerTypeLoc(PointerTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6114 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Pointer)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6115 | TL.setStarLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6116 | } | ||||||||||
| 6117 | void VisitObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc(ObjCObjectPointerTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6118 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Pointer)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6119 | TL.setStarLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6120 | } | ||||||||||
| 6121 | void VisitMemberPointerTypeLoc(MemberPointerTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6122 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6123 | const CXXScopeSpec& SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope(); | ||||||||||
| 6124 | NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLoc = SS.getWithLocInContext(Context); | ||||||||||
| 6125 | |||||||||||
| 6126 | const Type* ClsTy = TL.getClass(); | ||||||||||
| 6127 | QualType ClsQT = QualType(ClsTy, 0); | ||||||||||
| 6128 | TypeSourceInfo *ClsTInfo = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(ClsQT, 0); | ||||||||||
| 6129 | // Now copy source location info into the type loc component. | ||||||||||
| 6130 | TypeLoc ClsTL = ClsTInfo->getTypeLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6131 | switch (NNSLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 6132 | case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier: | ||||||||||
| 6133 | assert(isa<DependentNameType>(ClsTy) && "Unexpected TypeLoc")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6134 | { | ||||||||||
| 6135 | DependentNameTypeLoc DNTLoc = ClsTL.castAs<DependentNameTypeLoc>(); | ||||||||||
| 6136 | DNTLoc.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 6137 | DNTLoc.setQualifierLoc(NNSLoc.getPrefix()); | ||||||||||
| 6138 | DNTLoc.setNameLoc(NNSLoc.getLocalBeginLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6139 | } | ||||||||||
| 6140 | break; | ||||||||||
| 6141 | |||||||||||
| 6142 | case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec: | ||||||||||
| 6143 | case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: | ||||||||||
| 6144 | if (isa<ElaboratedType>(ClsTy)) { | ||||||||||
| 6145 | ElaboratedTypeLoc ETLoc = ClsTL.castAs<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(); | ||||||||||
| 6146 | ETLoc.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 6147 | ETLoc.setQualifierLoc(NNSLoc.getPrefix()); | ||||||||||
| 6148 | TypeLoc NamedTL = ETLoc.getNamedTypeLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6149 | NamedTL.initializeFullCopy(NNSLoc.getTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6150 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 6151 | ClsTL.initializeFullCopy(NNSLoc.getTypeLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6152 | } | ||||||||||
| 6153 | break; | ||||||||||
| 6154 | |||||||||||
| 6155 | case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace: | ||||||||||
| 6156 | case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias: | ||||||||||
| 6157 | case NestedNameSpecifier::Global: | ||||||||||
| 6158 | case NestedNameSpecifier::Super: | ||||||||||
| 6159 | llvm_unreachable("Nested-name-specifier must name a type")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 6160 | } | ||||||||||
| 6161 | |||||||||||
| 6162 | // Finally fill in MemberPointerLocInfo fields. | ||||||||||
| 6163 | TL.setStarLoc(Chunk.Mem.StarLoc); | ||||||||||
| 6164 | TL.setClassTInfo(ClsTInfo); | ||||||||||
| 6165 | } | ||||||||||
| 6166 | void VisitLValueReferenceTypeLoc(LValueReferenceTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6167 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Reference)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6168 | // 'Amp' is misleading: this might have been originally | ||||||||||
| 6169 | /// spelled with AmpAmp. | ||||||||||
| 6170 | TL.setAmpLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6171 | } | ||||||||||
| 6172 | void VisitRValueReferenceTypeLoc(RValueReferenceTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6173 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Reference)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6174 | assert(!Chunk.Ref.LValueRef)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6175 | TL.setAmpAmpLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6176 | } | ||||||||||
| 6177 | void VisitArrayTypeLoc(ArrayTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6178 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Array)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6179 | TL.setLBracketLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6180 | TL.setRBracketLoc(Chunk.EndLoc); | ||||||||||
| 6181 | TL.setSizeExpr(static_cast<Expr*>(Chunk.Arr.NumElts)); | ||||||||||
| 6182 | } | ||||||||||
| 6183 | void VisitFunctionTypeLoc(FunctionTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6184 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6185 | TL.setLocalRangeBegin(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6186 | TL.setLocalRangeEnd(Chunk.EndLoc); | ||||||||||
| 6187 | |||||||||||
| 6188 | const DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = Chunk.Fun; | ||||||||||
| 6189 | TL.setLParenLoc(FTI.getLParenLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6190 | TL.setRParenLoc(FTI.getRParenLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6191 | for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumParams(), tpi = 0; i != e; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 6192 | ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param); | ||||||||||
| 6193 | TL.setParam(tpi++, Param); | ||||||||||
| 6194 | } | ||||||||||
| 6195 | TL.setExceptionSpecRange(FTI.getExceptionSpecRange()); | ||||||||||
| 6196 | } | ||||||||||
| 6197 | void VisitParenTypeLoc(ParenTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6198 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Paren)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6199 | TL.setLParenLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6200 | TL.setRParenLoc(Chunk.EndLoc); | ||||||||||
| 6201 | } | ||||||||||
| 6202 | void VisitPipeTypeLoc(PipeTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6203 | assert(Chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Pipe)((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6204 | TL.setKWLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6205 | } | ||||||||||
| 6206 | void VisitExtIntTypeLoc(ExtIntTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6207 | TL.setNameLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6208 | } | ||||||||||
| 6209 | void VisitMacroQualifiedTypeLoc(MacroQualifiedTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6210 | TL.setExpansionLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6211 | } | ||||||||||
| 6212 | void VisitVectorTypeLoc(VectorTypeLoc TL) { TL.setNameLoc(Chunk.Loc); } | ||||||||||
| 6213 | void VisitDependentVectorTypeLoc(DependentVectorTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6214 | TL.setNameLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6215 | } | ||||||||||
| 6216 | void VisitExtVectorTypeLoc(ExtVectorTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6217 | TL.setNameLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6218 | } | ||||||||||
| 6219 | void | ||||||||||
| 6220 | VisitDependentSizedExtVectorTypeLoc(DependentSizedExtVectorTypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6221 | TL.setNameLoc(Chunk.Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6222 | } | ||||||||||
| 6223 | |||||||||||
| 6224 | void VisitTypeLoc(TypeLoc TL) { | ||||||||||
| 6225 | llvm_unreachable("unsupported TypeLoc kind in declarator!")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 6226 | } | ||||||||||
| 6227 | }; | ||||||||||
| 6228 | } // end anonymous namespace | ||||||||||
| 6229 | |||||||||||
| 6230 | static void fillAtomicQualLoc(AtomicTypeLoc ATL, const DeclaratorChunk &Chunk) { | ||||||||||
| 6231 | SourceLocation Loc; | ||||||||||
| 6232 | switch (Chunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 6233 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 6234 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 6235 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 6236 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 6237 | llvm_unreachable("cannot be _Atomic qualified")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 6238 | |||||||||||
| 6239 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 6240 | Loc = Chunk.Ptr.AtomicQualLoc; | ||||||||||
| 6241 | break; | ||||||||||
| 6242 | |||||||||||
| 6243 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 6244 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 6245 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 6246 | // FIXME: Provide a source location for the _Atomic keyword. | ||||||||||
| 6247 | break; | ||||||||||
| 6248 | } | ||||||||||
| 6249 | |||||||||||
| 6250 | ATL.setKWLoc(Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6251 | ATL.setParensRange(SourceRange()); | ||||||||||
| 6252 | } | ||||||||||
| 6253 | |||||||||||
| 6254 | static void | ||||||||||
| 6255 | fillDependentAddressSpaceTypeLoc(DependentAddressSpaceTypeLoc DASTL, | ||||||||||
| 6256 | const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { | ||||||||||
| 6257 | for (const ParsedAttr &AL : Attrs) { | ||||||||||
| 6258 | if (AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_AddressSpace) { | ||||||||||
| 6259 | DASTL.setAttrNameLoc(AL.getLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6260 | DASTL.setAttrExprOperand(AL.getArgAsExpr(0)); | ||||||||||
| 6261 | DASTL.setAttrOperandParensRange(SourceRange()); | ||||||||||
| 6262 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6263 | } | ||||||||||
| 6264 | } | ||||||||||
| 6265 | |||||||||||
| 6266 | llvm_unreachable(__builtin_unreachable() | ||||||||||
| 6267 | "no address_space attribute found at the expected location!")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 6268 | } | ||||||||||
| 6269 | |||||||||||
| 6270 | static void fillMatrixTypeLoc(MatrixTypeLoc MTL, | ||||||||||
| 6271 | const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { | ||||||||||
| 6272 | for (const ParsedAttr &AL : Attrs) { | ||||||||||
| 6273 | if (AL.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_MatrixType) { | ||||||||||
| 6274 | MTL.setAttrNameLoc(AL.getLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6275 | MTL.setAttrRowOperand(AL.getArgAsExpr(0)); | ||||||||||
| 6276 | MTL.setAttrColumnOperand(AL.getArgAsExpr(1)); | ||||||||||
| 6277 | MTL.setAttrOperandParensRange(SourceRange()); | ||||||||||
| 6278 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6279 | } | ||||||||||
| 6280 | } | ||||||||||
| 6281 | |||||||||||
| 6282 | llvm_unreachable("no matrix_type attribute found at the expected location!")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 6283 | } | ||||||||||
| 6284 | |||||||||||
| 6285 | /// Create and instantiate a TypeSourceInfo with type source information. | ||||||||||
| 6286 | /// | ||||||||||
| 6287 | /// \param T QualType referring to the type as written in source code. | ||||||||||
| 6288 | /// | ||||||||||
| 6289 | /// \param ReturnTypeInfo For declarators whose return type does not show | ||||||||||
| 6290 | /// up in the normal place in the declaration specifiers (such as a C++ | ||||||||||
| 6291 | /// conversion function), this pointer will refer to a type source information | ||||||||||
| 6292 | /// for that return type. | ||||||||||
| 6293 | static TypeSourceInfo * | ||||||||||
| 6294 | GetTypeSourceInfoForDeclarator(TypeProcessingState &State, | ||||||||||
| 6295 | QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *ReturnTypeInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 6296 | Sema &S = State.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 6297 | Declarator &D = State.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 6298 | |||||||||||
| 6299 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = S.Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(T); | ||||||||||
| 6300 | UnqualTypeLoc CurrTL = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getUnqualifiedLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6301 | |||||||||||
| 6302 | // Handle parameter packs whose type is a pack expansion. | ||||||||||
| 6303 | if (isa<PackExpansionType>(T)) { | ||||||||||
| 6304 | CurrTL.castAs<PackExpansionTypeLoc>().setEllipsisLoc(D.getEllipsisLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6305 | CurrTL = CurrTL.getNextTypeLoc().getUnqualifiedLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6306 | } | ||||||||||
| 6307 | |||||||||||
| 6308 | for (unsigned i = 0, e = D.getNumTypeObjects(); i != e; ++i) { | ||||||||||
| 6309 | // An AtomicTypeLoc might be produced by an atomic qualifier in this | ||||||||||
| 6310 | // declarator chunk. | ||||||||||
| 6311 | if (AtomicTypeLoc ATL = CurrTL.getAs<AtomicTypeLoc>()) { | ||||||||||
| 6312 | fillAtomicQualLoc(ATL, D.getTypeObject(i)); | ||||||||||
| 6313 | CurrTL = ATL.getValueLoc().getUnqualifiedLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6314 | } | ||||||||||
| 6315 | |||||||||||
| 6316 | while (MacroQualifiedTypeLoc TL = CurrTL.getAs<MacroQualifiedTypeLoc>()) { | ||||||||||
| 6317 | TL.setExpansionLoc( | ||||||||||
| 6318 | State.getExpansionLocForMacroQualifiedType(TL.getTypePtr())); | ||||||||||
| 6319 | CurrTL = TL.getNextTypeLoc().getUnqualifiedLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6320 | } | ||||||||||
| 6321 | |||||||||||
| 6322 | while (AttributedTypeLoc TL = CurrTL.getAs<AttributedTypeLoc>()) { | ||||||||||
| 6323 | fillAttributedTypeLoc(TL, State); | ||||||||||
| 6324 | CurrTL = TL.getNextTypeLoc().getUnqualifiedLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6325 | } | ||||||||||
| 6326 | |||||||||||
| 6327 | while (DependentAddressSpaceTypeLoc TL = | ||||||||||
| 6328 | CurrTL.getAs<DependentAddressSpaceTypeLoc>()) { | ||||||||||
| 6329 | fillDependentAddressSpaceTypeLoc(TL, D.getTypeObject(i).getAttrs()); | ||||||||||
| 6330 | CurrTL = TL.getPointeeTypeLoc().getUnqualifiedLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6331 | } | ||||||||||
| 6332 | |||||||||||
| 6333 | if (MatrixTypeLoc TL = CurrTL.getAs<MatrixTypeLoc>()) | ||||||||||
| 6334 | fillMatrixTypeLoc(TL, D.getTypeObject(i).getAttrs()); | ||||||||||
| 6335 | |||||||||||
| 6336 | // FIXME: Ordering here? | ||||||||||
| 6337 | while (AdjustedTypeLoc TL = CurrTL.getAs<AdjustedTypeLoc>()) | ||||||||||
| 6338 | CurrTL = TL.getNextTypeLoc().getUnqualifiedLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6339 | |||||||||||
| 6340 | DeclaratorLocFiller(S.Context, State, D.getTypeObject(i)).Visit(CurrTL); | ||||||||||
| 6341 | CurrTL = CurrTL.getNextTypeLoc().getUnqualifiedLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6342 | } | ||||||||||
| 6343 | |||||||||||
| 6344 | // If we have different source information for the return type, use | ||||||||||
| 6345 | // that. This really only applies to C++ conversion functions. | ||||||||||
| 6346 | if (ReturnTypeInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 6347 | TypeLoc TL = ReturnTypeInfo->getTypeLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6348 | assert(TL.getFullDataSize() == CurrTL.getFullDataSize())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6349 | memcpy(CurrTL.getOpaqueData(), TL.getOpaqueData(), TL.getFullDataSize()); | ||||||||||
| 6350 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 6351 | TypeSpecLocFiller(S, S.Context, State, D.getDeclSpec()).Visit(CurrTL); | ||||||||||
| 6352 | } | ||||||||||
| 6353 | |||||||||||
| 6354 | return TInfo; | ||||||||||
| 6355 | } | ||||||||||
| 6356 | |||||||||||
| 6357 | /// Create a LocInfoType to hold the given QualType and TypeSourceInfo. | ||||||||||
| 6358 | ParsedType Sema::CreateParsedType(QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { | ||||||||||
| 6359 | // FIXME: LocInfoTypes are "transient", only needed for passing to/from Parser | ||||||||||
| 6360 | // and Sema during declaration parsing. Try deallocating/caching them when | ||||||||||
| 6361 | // it's appropriate, instead of allocating them and keeping them around. | ||||||||||
| 6362 | LocInfoType *LocT = (LocInfoType*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(LocInfoType), | ||||||||||
| 6363 | TypeAlignment); | ||||||||||
| 6364 | new (LocT) LocInfoType(T, TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 6365 | assert(LocT->getTypeClass() != T->getTypeClass() &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 6366 | "LocInfoType's TypeClass conflicts with an existing Type class")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6367 | return ParsedType::make(QualType(LocT, 0)); | ||||||||||
| 6368 | } | ||||||||||
| 6369 | |||||||||||
| 6370 | void LocInfoType::getAsStringInternal(std::string &Str, | ||||||||||
| 6371 | const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const { | ||||||||||
| 6372 | llvm_unreachable("LocInfoType leaked into the type system; an opaque TypeTy*"__builtin_unreachable() | ||||||||||
| 6373 | " was used directly instead of getting the QualType through"__builtin_unreachable() | ||||||||||
| 6374 | " GetTypeFromParser")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 6375 | } | ||||||||||
| 6376 | |||||||||||
| 6377 | TypeResult Sema::ActOnTypeName(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { | ||||||||||
| 6378 | // C99 6.7.6: Type names have no identifier. This is already validated by | ||||||||||
| 6379 | // the parser. | ||||||||||
| 6380 | assert(D.getIdentifier() == nullptr &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 6381 | "Type name should have no identifier!")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 6382 | |||||||||||
| 6383 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); | ||||||||||
| 6384 | QualType T = TInfo->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 6385 | if (D.isInvalidType()) | ||||||||||
| 6386 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6387 | |||||||||||
| 6388 | // Make sure there are no unused decl attributes on the declarator. | ||||||||||
| 6389 | // We don't want to do this for ObjC parameters because we're going | ||||||||||
| 6390 | // to apply them to the actual parameter declaration. | ||||||||||
| 6391 | // Likewise, we don't want to do this for alias declarations, because | ||||||||||
| 6392 | // we are actually going to build a declaration from this eventually. | ||||||||||
| 6393 | if (D.getContext() != DeclaratorContext::ObjCParameter && | ||||||||||
| 6394 | D.getContext() != DeclaratorContext::AliasDecl && | ||||||||||
| 6395 | D.getContext() != DeclaratorContext::AliasTemplate) | ||||||||||
| 6396 | checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D); | ||||||||||
| 6397 | |||||||||||
| 6398 | if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { | ||||||||||
| 6399 | // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only). | ||||||||||
| 6400 | CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); | ||||||||||
| 6401 | } | ||||||||||
| 6402 | |||||||||||
| 6403 | return CreateParsedType(T, TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 6404 | } | ||||||||||
| 6405 | |||||||||||
| 6406 | ParsedType Sema::ActOnObjCInstanceType(SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 6407 | QualType T = Context.getObjCInstanceType(); | ||||||||||
| 6408 | TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc); | ||||||||||
| 6409 | return CreateParsedType(T, TInfo); | ||||||||||
| 6410 | } | ||||||||||
| 6411 | |||||||||||
| 6412 | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | ||||||||||
| 6413 | // Type Attribute Processing | ||||||||||
| 6414 | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// | ||||||||||
| 6415 | |||||||||||
| 6416 | /// Build an AddressSpace index from a constant expression and diagnose any | ||||||||||
| 6417 | /// errors related to invalid address_spaces. Returns true on successfully | ||||||||||
| 6418 | /// building an AddressSpace index. | ||||||||||
| 6419 | static bool BuildAddressSpaceIndex(Sema &S, LangAS &ASIdx, | ||||||||||
| 6420 | const Expr *AddrSpace, | ||||||||||
| 6421 | SourceLocation AttrLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 6422 | if (!AddrSpace->isValueDependent()) { | ||||||||||
| 6423 | Optional<llvm::APSInt> OptAddrSpace = | ||||||||||
| 6424 | AddrSpace->getIntegerConstantExpr(S.Context); | ||||||||||
| 6425 | if (!OptAddrSpace) { | ||||||||||
| 6426 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_argument_type) | ||||||||||
| 6427 | << "'address_space'" << AANT_ArgumentIntegerConstant | ||||||||||
| 6428 | << AddrSpace->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 6429 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 6430 | } | ||||||||||
| 6431 | llvm::APSInt &addrSpace = *OptAddrSpace; | ||||||||||
| 6432 | |||||||||||
| 6433 | // Bounds checking. | ||||||||||
| 6434 | if (addrSpace.isSigned()) { | ||||||||||
| 6435 | if (addrSpace.isNegative()) { | ||||||||||
| 6436 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_address_space_negative) | ||||||||||
| 6437 | << AddrSpace->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 6438 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 6439 | } | ||||||||||
| 6440 | addrSpace.setIsSigned(false); | ||||||||||
| 6441 | } | ||||||||||
| 6442 | |||||||||||
| 6443 | llvm::APSInt max(addrSpace.getBitWidth()); | ||||||||||
| 6444 | max = | ||||||||||
| 6445 | Qualifiers::MaxAddressSpace - (unsigned)LangAS::FirstTargetAddressSpace; | ||||||||||
| 6446 | |||||||||||
| 6447 | if (addrSpace > max) { | ||||||||||
| 6448 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_address_space_too_high) | ||||||||||
| 6449 | << (unsigned)max.getZExtValue() << AddrSpace->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 6450 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 6451 | } | ||||||||||
| 6452 | |||||||||||
| 6453 | ASIdx = | ||||||||||
| 6454 | getLangASFromTargetAS(static_cast<unsigned>(addrSpace.getZExtValue())); | ||||||||||
| 6455 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6456 | } | ||||||||||
| 6457 | |||||||||||
| 6458 | // Default value for DependentAddressSpaceTypes | ||||||||||
| 6459 | ASIdx = LangAS::Default; | ||||||||||
| 6460 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6461 | } | ||||||||||
| 6462 | |||||||||||
| 6463 | /// BuildAddressSpaceAttr - Builds a DependentAddressSpaceType if an expression | ||||||||||
| 6464 | /// is uninstantiated. If instantiated it will apply the appropriate address | ||||||||||
| 6465 | /// space to the type. This function allows dependent template variables to be | ||||||||||
| 6466 | /// used in conjunction with the address_space attribute | ||||||||||
| 6467 | QualType Sema::BuildAddressSpaceAttr(QualType &T, LangAS ASIdx, Expr *AddrSpace, | ||||||||||
| 6468 | SourceLocation AttrLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 6469 | if (!AddrSpace->isValueDependent()) { | ||||||||||
| 6470 | if (DiagnoseMultipleAddrSpaceAttributes(*this, T.getAddressSpace(), ASIdx, | ||||||||||
| 6471 | AttrLoc)) | ||||||||||
| 6472 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 6473 | |||||||||||
| 6474 | return Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(T, ASIdx); | ||||||||||
| 6475 | } | ||||||||||
| 6476 | |||||||||||
| 6477 | // A check with similar intentions as checking if a type already has an | ||||||||||
| 6478 | // address space except for on a dependent types, basically if the | ||||||||||
| 6479 | // current type is already a DependentAddressSpaceType then its already | ||||||||||
| 6480 | // lined up to have another address space on it and we can't have | ||||||||||
| 6481 | // multiple address spaces on the one pointer indirection | ||||||||||
| 6482 | if (T->getAs<DependentAddressSpaceType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 6483 | Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_address_multiple_qualifiers); | ||||||||||
| 6484 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 6485 | } | ||||||||||
| 6486 | |||||||||||
| 6487 | return Context.getDependentAddressSpaceType(T, AddrSpace, AttrLoc); | ||||||||||
| 6488 | } | ||||||||||
| 6489 | |||||||||||
| 6490 | QualType Sema::BuildAddressSpaceAttr(QualType &T, Expr *AddrSpace, | ||||||||||
| 6491 | SourceLocation AttrLoc) { | ||||||||||
| 6492 | LangAS ASIdx; | ||||||||||
| 6493 | if (!BuildAddressSpaceIndex(*this, ASIdx, AddrSpace, AttrLoc)) | ||||||||||
| 6494 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 6495 | return BuildAddressSpaceAttr(T, ASIdx, AddrSpace, AttrLoc); | ||||||||||
| 6496 | } | ||||||||||
| 6497 | |||||||||||
| 6498 | /// HandleAddressSpaceTypeAttribute - Process an address_space attribute on the | ||||||||||
| 6499 | /// specified type. The attribute contains 1 argument, the id of the address | ||||||||||
| 6500 | /// space for the type. | ||||||||||
| 6501 | static void HandleAddressSpaceTypeAttribute(QualType &Type, | ||||||||||
| 6502 | const ParsedAttr &Attr, | ||||||||||
| 6503 | TypeProcessingState &State) { | ||||||||||
| 6504 | Sema &S = State.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 6505 | |||||||||||
| 6506 | // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.3 (amending C99 6.7.3): "A function type shall not be | ||||||||||
| 6507 | // qualified by an address-space qualifier." | ||||||||||
| 6508 | if (Type->isFunctionType()) { | ||||||||||
| 6509 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_address_function_type); | ||||||||||
| 6510 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6511 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6512 | } | ||||||||||
| 6513 | |||||||||||
| 6514 | LangAS ASIdx; | ||||||||||
| 6515 | if (Attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_AddressSpace) { | ||||||||||
| 6516 | |||||||||||
| 6517 | // Check the attribute arguments. | ||||||||||
| 6518 | if (Attr.getNumArgs() != 1) { | ||||||||||
| 6519 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_wrong_number_arguments) << Attr | ||||||||||
| 6520 | << 1; | ||||||||||
| 6521 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6522 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6523 | } | ||||||||||
| 6524 | |||||||||||
| 6525 | Expr *ASArgExpr = static_cast<Expr *>(Attr.getArgAsExpr(0)); | ||||||||||
| 6526 | LangAS ASIdx; | ||||||||||
| 6527 | if (!BuildAddressSpaceIndex(S, ASIdx, ASArgExpr, Attr.getLoc())) { | ||||||||||
| 6528 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6529 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6530 | } | ||||||||||
| 6531 | |||||||||||
| 6532 | ASTContext &Ctx = S.Context; | ||||||||||
| 6533 | auto *ASAttr = | ||||||||||
| 6534 | ::new (Ctx) AddressSpaceAttr(Ctx, Attr, static_cast<unsigned>(ASIdx)); | ||||||||||
| 6535 | |||||||||||
| 6536 | // If the expression is not value dependent (not templated), then we can | ||||||||||
| 6537 | // apply the address space qualifiers just to the equivalent type. | ||||||||||
| 6538 | // Otherwise, we make an AttributedType with the modified and equivalent | ||||||||||
| 6539 | // type the same, and wrap it in a DependentAddressSpaceType. When this | ||||||||||
| 6540 | // dependent type is resolved, the qualifier is added to the equivalent type | ||||||||||
| 6541 | // later. | ||||||||||
| 6542 | QualType T; | ||||||||||
| 6543 | if (!ASArgExpr->isValueDependent()) { | ||||||||||
| 6544 | QualType EquivType = | ||||||||||
| 6545 | S.BuildAddressSpaceAttr(Type, ASIdx, ASArgExpr, Attr.getLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6546 | if (EquivType.isNull()) { | ||||||||||
| 6547 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6548 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6549 | } | ||||||||||
| 6550 | T = State.getAttributedType(ASAttr, Type, EquivType); | ||||||||||
| 6551 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 6552 | T = State.getAttributedType(ASAttr, Type, Type); | ||||||||||
| 6553 | T = S.BuildAddressSpaceAttr(T, ASIdx, ASArgExpr, Attr.getLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 6554 | } | ||||||||||
| 6555 | |||||||||||
| 6556 | if (!T.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 6557 | Type = T; | ||||||||||
| 6558 | else | ||||||||||
| 6559 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6560 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 6561 | // The keyword-based type attributes imply which address space to use. | ||||||||||
| 6562 | ASIdx = S.getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice ? Attr.asSYCLLangAS() | ||||||||||
| 6563 | : Attr.asOpenCLLangAS(); | ||||||||||
| 6564 | |||||||||||
| 6565 | if (ASIdx == LangAS::Default) | ||||||||||
| 6566 | llvm_unreachable("Invalid address space")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 6567 | |||||||||||
| 6568 | if (DiagnoseMultipleAddrSpaceAttributes(S, Type.getAddressSpace(), ASIdx, | ||||||||||
| 6569 | Attr.getLoc())) { | ||||||||||
| 6570 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6571 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6572 | } | ||||||||||
| 6573 | |||||||||||
| 6574 | Type = S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, ASIdx); | ||||||||||
| 6575 | } | ||||||||||
| 6576 | } | ||||||||||
| 6577 | |||||||||||
| 6578 | /// handleObjCOwnershipTypeAttr - Process an objc_ownership | ||||||||||
| 6579 | /// attribute on the specified type. | ||||||||||
| 6580 | /// | ||||||||||
| 6581 | /// Returns 'true' if the attribute was handled. | ||||||||||
| 6582 | static bool handleObjCOwnershipTypeAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 6583 | ParsedAttr &attr, QualType &type) { | ||||||||||
| 6584 | bool NonObjCPointer = false; | ||||||||||
| 6585 | |||||||||||
| 6586 | if (!type->isDependentType() && !type->isUndeducedType()) { | ||||||||||
| 6587 | if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 6588 | QualType pointee = ptr->getPointeeType(); | ||||||||||
| 6589 | if (pointee->isObjCRetainableType() || pointee->isPointerType()) | ||||||||||
| 6590 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 6591 | // It is important not to lose the source info that there was an attribute | ||||||||||
| 6592 | // applied to non-objc pointer. We will create an attributed type but | ||||||||||
| 6593 | // its type will be the same as the original type. | ||||||||||
| 6594 | NonObjCPointer = true; | ||||||||||
| 6595 | } else if (!type->isObjCRetainableType()) { | ||||||||||
| 6596 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 6597 | } | ||||||||||
| 6598 | |||||||||||
| 6599 | // Don't accept an ownership attribute in the declspec if it would | ||||||||||
| 6600 | // just be the return type of a block pointer. | ||||||||||
| 6601 | if (state.isProcessingDeclSpec()) { | ||||||||||
| 6602 | Declarator &D = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 6603 | if (maybeMovePastReturnType(D, D.getNumTypeObjects(), | ||||||||||
| 6604 | /*onlyBlockPointers=*/true)) | ||||||||||
| 6605 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 6606 | } | ||||||||||
| 6607 | } | ||||||||||
| 6608 | |||||||||||
| 6609 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 6610 | SourceLocation AttrLoc = attr.getLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 6611 | if (AttrLoc.isMacroID()) | ||||||||||
| 6612 | AttrLoc = | ||||||||||
| 6613 | S.getSourceManager().getImmediateExpansionRange(AttrLoc).getBegin(); | ||||||||||
| 6614 | |||||||||||
| 6615 | if (!attr.isArgIdent(0)) { | ||||||||||
| 6616 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attribute_argument_type) << attr | ||||||||||
| 6617 | << AANT_ArgumentString; | ||||||||||
| 6618 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6619 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6620 | } | ||||||||||
| 6621 | |||||||||||
| 6622 | IdentifierInfo *II = attr.getArgAsIdent(0)->Ident; | ||||||||||
| 6623 | Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime; | ||||||||||
| 6624 | if (II->isStr("none")) | ||||||||||
| 6625 | lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; | ||||||||||
| 6626 | else if (II->isStr("strong")) | ||||||||||
| 6627 | lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_Strong; | ||||||||||
| 6628 | else if (II->isStr("weak")) | ||||||||||
| 6629 | lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_Weak; | ||||||||||
| 6630 | else if (II->isStr("autoreleasing")) | ||||||||||
| 6631 | lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing; | ||||||||||
| 6632 | else { | ||||||||||
| 6633 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, diag::warn_attribute_type_not_supported) << attr << II; | ||||||||||
| 6634 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6635 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6636 | } | ||||||||||
| 6637 | |||||||||||
| 6638 | // Just ignore lifetime attributes other than __weak and __unsafe_unretained | ||||||||||
| 6639 | // outside of ARC mode. | ||||||||||
| 6640 | if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && | ||||||||||
| 6641 | lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak && | ||||||||||
| 6642 | lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) { | ||||||||||
| 6643 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6644 | } | ||||||||||
| 6645 | |||||||||||
| 6646 | SplitQualType underlyingType = type.split(); | ||||||||||
| 6647 | |||||||||||
| 6648 | // Check for redundant/conflicting ownership qualifiers. | ||||||||||
| 6649 | if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime previousLifetime | ||||||||||
| 6650 | = type.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime()) { | ||||||||||
| 6651 | // If it's written directly, that's an error. | ||||||||||
| 6652 | if (S.Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(type)) { | ||||||||||
| 6653 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_attr_objc_ownership_redundant) | ||||||||||
| 6654 | << type; | ||||||||||
| 6655 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6656 | } | ||||||||||
| 6657 | |||||||||||
| 6658 | // Otherwise, if the qualifiers actually conflict, pull sugar off | ||||||||||
| 6659 | // and remove the ObjCLifetime qualifiers. | ||||||||||
| 6660 | if (previousLifetime != lifetime) { | ||||||||||
| 6661 | // It's possible to have multiple local ObjCLifetime qualifiers. We | ||||||||||
| 6662 | // can't stop after we reach a type that is directly qualified. | ||||||||||
| 6663 | const Type *prevTy = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 6664 | while (!prevTy || prevTy != underlyingType.Ty) { | ||||||||||
| 6665 | prevTy = underlyingType.Ty; | ||||||||||
| 6666 | underlyingType = underlyingType.getSingleStepDesugaredType(); | ||||||||||
| 6667 | } | ||||||||||
| 6668 | underlyingType.Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); | ||||||||||
| 6669 | } | ||||||||||
| 6670 | } | ||||||||||
| 6671 | |||||||||||
| 6672 | underlyingType.Quals.addObjCLifetime(lifetime); | ||||||||||
| 6673 | |||||||||||
| 6674 | if (NonObjCPointer) { | ||||||||||
| 6675 | StringRef name = attr.getAttrName()->getName(); | ||||||||||
| 6676 | switch (lifetime) { | ||||||||||
| 6677 | case Qualifiers::OCL_None: | ||||||||||
| 6678 | case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: | ||||||||||
| 6679 | break; | ||||||||||
| 6680 | case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: name = "__strong"; break; | ||||||||||
| 6681 | case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: name = "__weak"; break; | ||||||||||
| 6682 | case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: name = "__autoreleasing"; break; | ||||||||||
| 6683 | } | ||||||||||
| 6684 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, diag::warn_type_attribute_wrong_type) << name | ||||||||||
| 6685 | << TDS_ObjCObjOrBlock << type; | ||||||||||
| 6686 | } | ||||||||||
| 6687 | |||||||||||
| 6688 | // Don't actually add the __unsafe_unretained qualifier in non-ARC files, | ||||||||||
| 6689 | // because having both 'T' and '__unsafe_unretained T' exist in the type | ||||||||||
| 6690 | // system causes unfortunate widespread consistency problems. (For example, | ||||||||||
| 6691 | // they're not considered compatible types, and we mangle them identicially | ||||||||||
| 6692 | // as template arguments.) These problems are all individually fixable, | ||||||||||
| 6693 | // but it's easier to just not add the qualifier and instead sniff it out | ||||||||||
| 6694 | // in specific places using isObjCInertUnsafeUnretainedType(). | ||||||||||
| 6695 | // | ||||||||||
| 6696 | // Doing this does means we miss some trivial consistency checks that | ||||||||||
| 6697 | // would've triggered in ARC, but that's better than trying to solve all | ||||||||||
| 6698 | // the coexistence problems with __unsafe_unretained. | ||||||||||
| 6699 | if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && | ||||||||||
| 6700 | lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) { | ||||||||||
| 6701 | type = state.getAttributedType( | ||||||||||
| 6702 | createSimpleAttr<ObjCInertUnsafeUnretainedAttr>(S.Context, attr), | ||||||||||
| 6703 | type, type); | ||||||||||
| 6704 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6705 | } | ||||||||||
| 6706 | |||||||||||
| 6707 | QualType origType = type; | ||||||||||
| 6708 | if (!NonObjCPointer) | ||||||||||
| 6709 | type = S.Context.getQualifiedType(underlyingType); | ||||||||||
| 6710 | |||||||||||
| 6711 | // If we have a valid source location for the attribute, use an | ||||||||||
| 6712 | // AttributedType instead. | ||||||||||
| 6713 | if (AttrLoc.isValid()) { | ||||||||||
| 6714 | type = state.getAttributedType(::new (S.Context) | ||||||||||
| 6715 | ObjCOwnershipAttr(S.Context, attr, II), | ||||||||||
| 6716 | origType, type); | ||||||||||
| 6717 | } | ||||||||||
| 6718 | |||||||||||
| 6719 | auto diagnoseOrDelay = [](Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, | ||||||||||
| 6720 | unsigned diagnostic, QualType type) { | ||||||||||
| 6721 | if (S.DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics()) { | ||||||||||
| 6722 | S.DelayedDiagnostics.add( | ||||||||||
| 6723 | sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType( | ||||||||||
| 6724 | S.getSourceManager().getExpansionLoc(loc), | ||||||||||
| 6725 | diagnostic, type, /*ignored*/ 0)); | ||||||||||
| 6726 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 6727 | S.Diag(loc, diagnostic); | ||||||||||
| 6728 | } | ||||||||||
| 6729 | }; | ||||||||||
| 6730 | |||||||||||
| 6731 | // Sometimes, __weak isn't allowed. | ||||||||||
| 6732 | if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak && | ||||||||||
| 6733 | !S.getLangOpts().ObjCWeak && !NonObjCPointer) { | ||||||||||
| 6734 | |||||||||||
| 6735 | // Use a specialized diagnostic if the runtime just doesn't support them. | ||||||||||
| 6736 | unsigned diagnostic = | ||||||||||
| 6737 | (S.getLangOpts().ObjCWeakRuntime ? diag::err_arc_weak_disabled | ||||||||||
| 6738 | : diag::err_arc_weak_no_runtime); | ||||||||||
| 6739 | |||||||||||
| 6740 | // In any case, delay the diagnostic until we know what we're parsing. | ||||||||||
| 6741 | diagnoseOrDelay(S, AttrLoc, diagnostic, type); | ||||||||||
| 6742 | |||||||||||
| 6743 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6744 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6745 | } | ||||||||||
| 6746 | |||||||||||
| 6747 | // Forbid __weak for class objects marked as | ||||||||||
| 6748 | // objc_arc_weak_reference_unavailable | ||||||||||
| 6749 | if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) { | ||||||||||
| 6750 | if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ObjT = | ||||||||||
| 6751 | type->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 6752 | if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = ObjT->getInterfaceDecl()) { | ||||||||||
| 6753 | if (Class->isArcWeakrefUnavailable()) { | ||||||||||
| 6754 | S.Diag(AttrLoc, diag::err_arc_unsupported_weak_class); | ||||||||||
| 6755 | S.Diag(ObjT->getInterfaceDecl()->getLocation(), | ||||||||||
| 6756 | diag::note_class_declared); | ||||||||||
| 6757 | } | ||||||||||
| 6758 | } | ||||||||||
| 6759 | } | ||||||||||
| 6760 | } | ||||||||||
| 6761 | |||||||||||
| 6762 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6763 | } | ||||||||||
| 6764 | |||||||||||
| 6765 | /// handleObjCGCTypeAttr - Process the __attribute__((objc_gc)) type | ||||||||||
| 6766 | /// attribute on the specified type. Returns true to indicate that | ||||||||||
| 6767 | /// the attribute was handled, false to indicate that the type does | ||||||||||
| 6768 | /// not permit the attribute. | ||||||||||
| 6769 | static bool handleObjCGCTypeAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, ParsedAttr &attr, | ||||||||||
| 6770 | QualType &type) { | ||||||||||
| 6771 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 6772 | |||||||||||
| 6773 | // Delay if this isn't some kind of pointer. | ||||||||||
| 6774 | if (!type->isPointerType() && | ||||||||||
| 6775 | !type->isObjCObjectPointerType() && | ||||||||||
| 6776 | !type->isBlockPointerType()) | ||||||||||
| 6777 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 6778 | |||||||||||
| 6779 | if (type.getObjCGCAttr() != Qualifiers::GCNone) { | ||||||||||
| 6780 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_multiple_objc_gc); | ||||||||||
| 6781 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6782 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6783 | } | ||||||||||
| 6784 | |||||||||||
| 6785 | // Check the attribute arguments. | ||||||||||
| 6786 | if (!attr.isArgIdent(0)) { | ||||||||||
| 6787 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_argument_type) | ||||||||||
| 6788 | << attr << AANT_ArgumentString; | ||||||||||
| 6789 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6790 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6791 | } | ||||||||||
| 6792 | Qualifiers::GC GCAttr; | ||||||||||
| 6793 | if (attr.getNumArgs() > 1) { | ||||||||||
| 6794 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_wrong_number_arguments) << attr | ||||||||||
| 6795 | << 1; | ||||||||||
| 6796 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6797 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6798 | } | ||||||||||
| 6799 | |||||||||||
| 6800 | IdentifierInfo *II = attr.getArgAsIdent(0)->Ident; | ||||||||||
| 6801 | if (II->isStr("weak")) | ||||||||||
| 6802 | GCAttr = Qualifiers::Weak; | ||||||||||
| 6803 | else if (II->isStr("strong")) | ||||||||||
| 6804 | GCAttr = Qualifiers::Strong; | ||||||||||
| 6805 | else { | ||||||||||
| 6806 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::warn_attribute_type_not_supported) | ||||||||||
| 6807 | << attr << II; | ||||||||||
| 6808 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 6809 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6810 | } | ||||||||||
| 6811 | |||||||||||
| 6812 | QualType origType = type; | ||||||||||
| 6813 | type = S.Context.getObjCGCQualType(origType, GCAttr); | ||||||||||
| 6814 | |||||||||||
| 6815 | // Make an attributed type to preserve the source information. | ||||||||||
| 6816 | if (attr.getLoc().isValid()) | ||||||||||
| 6817 | type = state.getAttributedType( | ||||||||||
| 6818 | ::new (S.Context) ObjCGCAttr(S.Context, attr, II), origType, type); | ||||||||||
| 6819 | |||||||||||
| 6820 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 6821 | } | ||||||||||
| 6822 | |||||||||||
| 6823 | namespace { | ||||||||||
| 6824 | /// A helper class to unwrap a type down to a function for the | ||||||||||
| 6825 | /// purposes of applying attributes there. | ||||||||||
| 6826 | /// | ||||||||||
| 6827 | /// Use: | ||||||||||
| 6828 | /// FunctionTypeUnwrapper unwrapped(SemaRef, T); | ||||||||||
| 6829 | /// if (unwrapped.isFunctionType()) { | ||||||||||
| 6830 | /// const FunctionType *fn = unwrapped.get(); | ||||||||||
| 6831 | /// // change fn somehow | ||||||||||
| 6832 | /// T = unwrapped.wrap(fn); | ||||||||||
| 6833 | /// } | ||||||||||
| 6834 | struct FunctionTypeUnwrapper { | ||||||||||
| 6835 | enum WrapKind { | ||||||||||
| 6836 | Desugar, | ||||||||||
| 6837 | Attributed, | ||||||||||
| 6838 | Parens, | ||||||||||
| 6839 | Array, | ||||||||||
| 6840 | Pointer, | ||||||||||
| 6841 | BlockPointer, | ||||||||||
| 6842 | Reference, | ||||||||||
| 6843 | MemberPointer, | ||||||||||
| 6844 | MacroQualified, | ||||||||||
| 6845 | }; | ||||||||||
| 6846 | |||||||||||
| 6847 | QualType Original; | ||||||||||
| 6848 | const FunctionType *Fn; | ||||||||||
| 6849 | SmallVector<unsigned char /*WrapKind*/, 8> Stack; | ||||||||||
| 6850 | |||||||||||
| 6851 | FunctionTypeUnwrapper(Sema &S, QualType T) : Original(T) { | ||||||||||
| 6852 | while (true) { | ||||||||||
| 6853 | const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr(); | ||||||||||
| 6854 | if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) { | ||||||||||
| 6855 | Fn = cast<FunctionType>(Ty); | ||||||||||
| 6856 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6857 | } else if (isa<ParenType>(Ty)) { | ||||||||||
| 6858 | T = cast<ParenType>(Ty)->getInnerType(); | ||||||||||
| 6859 | Stack.push_back(Parens); | ||||||||||
| 6860 | } else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(Ty) || isa<VariableArrayType>(Ty) || | ||||||||||
| 6861 | isa<IncompleteArrayType>(Ty)) { | ||||||||||
| 6862 | T = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType(); | ||||||||||
| 6863 | Stack.push_back(Array); | ||||||||||
| 6864 | } else if (isa<PointerType>(Ty)) { | ||||||||||
| 6865 | T = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); | ||||||||||
| 6866 | Stack.push_back(Pointer); | ||||||||||
| 6867 | } else if (isa<BlockPointerType>(Ty)) { | ||||||||||
| 6868 | T = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); | ||||||||||
| 6869 | Stack.push_back(BlockPointer); | ||||||||||
| 6870 | } else if (isa<MemberPointerType>(Ty)) { | ||||||||||
| 6871 | T = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); | ||||||||||
| 6872 | Stack.push_back(MemberPointer); | ||||||||||
| 6873 | } else if (isa<ReferenceType>(Ty)) { | ||||||||||
| 6874 | T = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); | ||||||||||
| 6875 | Stack.push_back(Reference); | ||||||||||
| 6876 | } else if (isa<AttributedType>(Ty)) { | ||||||||||
| 6877 | T = cast<AttributedType>(Ty)->getEquivalentType(); | ||||||||||
| 6878 | Stack.push_back(Attributed); | ||||||||||
| 6879 | } else if (isa<MacroQualifiedType>(Ty)) { | ||||||||||
| 6880 | T = cast<MacroQualifiedType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingType(); | ||||||||||
| 6881 | Stack.push_back(MacroQualified); | ||||||||||
| 6882 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 6883 | const Type *DTy = Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(); | ||||||||||
| 6884 | if (Ty == DTy) { | ||||||||||
| 6885 | Fn = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 6886 | return; | ||||||||||
| 6887 | } | ||||||||||
| 6888 | |||||||||||
| 6889 | T = QualType(DTy, 0); | ||||||||||
| 6890 | Stack.push_back(Desugar); | ||||||||||
| 6891 | } | ||||||||||
| 6892 | } | ||||||||||
| 6893 | } | ||||||||||
| 6894 | |||||||||||
| 6895 | bool isFunctionType() const { return (Fn != nullptr); } | ||||||||||
| 6896 | const FunctionType *get() const { return Fn; } | ||||||||||
| 6897 | |||||||||||
| 6898 | QualType wrap(Sema &S, const FunctionType *New) { | ||||||||||
| 6899 | // If T wasn't modified from the unwrapped type, do nothing. | ||||||||||
| 6900 | if (New == get()) return Original; | ||||||||||
| 6901 | |||||||||||
| 6902 | Fn = New; | ||||||||||
| 6903 | return wrap(S.Context, Original, 0); | ||||||||||
| 6904 | } | ||||||||||
| 6905 | |||||||||||
| 6906 | private: | ||||||||||
| 6907 | QualType wrap(ASTContext &C, QualType Old, unsigned I) { | ||||||||||
| 6908 | if (I == Stack.size()) | ||||||||||
| 6909 | return C.getQualifiedType(Fn, Old.getQualifiers()); | ||||||||||
| 6910 | |||||||||||
| 6911 | // Build up the inner type, applying the qualifiers from the old | ||||||||||
| 6912 | // type to the new type. | ||||||||||
| 6913 | SplitQualType SplitOld = Old.split(); | ||||||||||
| 6914 | |||||||||||
| 6915 | // As a special case, tail-recurse if there are no qualifiers. | ||||||||||
| 6916 | if (SplitOld.Quals.empty()) | ||||||||||
| 6917 | return wrap(C, SplitOld.Ty, I); | ||||||||||
| 6918 | return C.getQualifiedType(wrap(C, SplitOld.Ty, I), SplitOld.Quals); | ||||||||||
| 6919 | } | ||||||||||
| 6920 | |||||||||||
| 6921 | QualType wrap(ASTContext &C, const Type *Old, unsigned I) { | ||||||||||
| 6922 | if (I == Stack.size()) return QualType(Fn, 0); | ||||||||||
| 6923 | |||||||||||
| 6924 | switch (static_cast<WrapKind>(Stack[I++])) { | ||||||||||
| 6925 | case Desugar: | ||||||||||
| 6926 | // This is the point at which we potentially lose source | ||||||||||
| 6927 | // information. | ||||||||||
| 6928 | return wrap(C, Old->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), I); | ||||||||||
| 6929 | |||||||||||
| 6930 | case Attributed: | ||||||||||
| 6931 | return wrap(C, cast<AttributedType>(Old)->getEquivalentType(), I); | ||||||||||
| 6932 | |||||||||||
| 6933 | case Parens: { | ||||||||||
| 6934 | QualType New = wrap(C, cast<ParenType>(Old)->getInnerType(), I); | ||||||||||
| 6935 | return C.getParenType(New); | ||||||||||
| 6936 | } | ||||||||||
| 6937 | |||||||||||
| 6938 | case MacroQualified: | ||||||||||
| 6939 | return wrap(C, cast<MacroQualifiedType>(Old)->getUnderlyingType(), I); | ||||||||||
| 6940 | |||||||||||
| 6941 | case Array: { | ||||||||||
| 6942 | if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(Old)) { | ||||||||||
| 6943 | QualType New = wrap(C, CAT->getElementType(), I); | ||||||||||
| 6944 | return C.getConstantArrayType(New, CAT->getSize(), CAT->getSizeExpr(), | ||||||||||
| 6945 | CAT->getSizeModifier(), | ||||||||||
| 6946 | CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()); | ||||||||||
| 6947 | } | ||||||||||
| 6948 | |||||||||||
| 6949 | if (const auto *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(Old)) { | ||||||||||
| 6950 | QualType New = wrap(C, VAT->getElementType(), I); | ||||||||||
| 6951 | return C.getVariableArrayType( | ||||||||||
| 6952 | New, VAT->getSizeExpr(), VAT->getSizeModifier(), | ||||||||||
| 6953 | VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), VAT->getBracketsRange()); | ||||||||||
| 6954 | } | ||||||||||
| 6955 | |||||||||||
| 6956 | const auto *IAT = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(Old); | ||||||||||
| 6957 | QualType New = wrap(C, IAT->getElementType(), I); | ||||||||||
| 6958 | return C.getIncompleteArrayType(New, IAT->getSizeModifier(), | ||||||||||
| 6959 | IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()); | ||||||||||
| 6960 | } | ||||||||||
| 6961 | |||||||||||
| 6962 | case Pointer: { | ||||||||||
| 6963 | QualType New = wrap(C, cast<PointerType>(Old)->getPointeeType(), I); | ||||||||||
| 6964 | return C.getPointerType(New); | ||||||||||
| 6965 | } | ||||||||||
| 6966 | |||||||||||
| 6967 | case BlockPointer: { | ||||||||||
| 6968 | QualType New = wrap(C, cast<BlockPointerType>(Old)->getPointeeType(),I); | ||||||||||
| 6969 | return C.getBlockPointerType(New); | ||||||||||
| 6970 | } | ||||||||||
| 6971 | |||||||||||
| 6972 | case MemberPointer: { | ||||||||||
| 6973 | const MemberPointerType *OldMPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(Old); | ||||||||||
| 6974 | QualType New = wrap(C, OldMPT->getPointeeType(), I); | ||||||||||
| 6975 | return C.getMemberPointerType(New, OldMPT->getClass()); | ||||||||||
| 6976 | } | ||||||||||
| 6977 | |||||||||||
| 6978 | case Reference: { | ||||||||||
| 6979 | const ReferenceType *OldRef = cast<ReferenceType>(Old); | ||||||||||
| 6980 | QualType New = wrap(C, OldRef->getPointeeType(), I); | ||||||||||
| 6981 | if (isa<LValueReferenceType>(OldRef)) | ||||||||||
| 6982 | return C.getLValueReferenceType(New, OldRef->isSpelledAsLValue()); | ||||||||||
| 6983 | else | ||||||||||
| 6984 | return C.getRValueReferenceType(New); | ||||||||||
| 6985 | } | ||||||||||
| 6986 | } | ||||||||||
| 6987 | |||||||||||
| 6988 | llvm_unreachable("unknown wrapping kind")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 6989 | } | ||||||||||
| 6990 | }; | ||||||||||
| 6991 | } // end anonymous namespace | ||||||||||
| 6992 | |||||||||||
| 6993 | static bool handleMSPointerTypeQualifierAttr(TypeProcessingState &State, | ||||||||||
| 6994 | ParsedAttr &PAttr, QualType &Type) { | ||||||||||
| 6995 | Sema &S = State.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 6996 | |||||||||||
| 6997 | Attr *A; | ||||||||||
| 6998 | switch (PAttr.getKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 6999 | default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown attribute kind")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 7000 | case ParsedAttr::AT_Ptr32: | ||||||||||
| 7001 | A = createSimpleAttr<Ptr32Attr>(S.Context, PAttr); | ||||||||||
| 7002 | break; | ||||||||||
| 7003 | case ParsedAttr::AT_Ptr64: | ||||||||||
| 7004 | A = createSimpleAttr<Ptr64Attr>(S.Context, PAttr); | ||||||||||
| 7005 | break; | ||||||||||
| 7006 | case ParsedAttr::AT_SPtr: | ||||||||||
| 7007 | A = createSimpleAttr<SPtrAttr>(S.Context, PAttr); | ||||||||||
| 7008 | break; | ||||||||||
| 7009 | case ParsedAttr::AT_UPtr: | ||||||||||
| 7010 | A = createSimpleAttr<UPtrAttr>(S.Context, PAttr); | ||||||||||
| 7011 | break; | ||||||||||
| 7012 | } | ||||||||||
| 7013 | |||||||||||
| 7014 | std::bitset<attr::LastAttr> Attrs; | ||||||||||
| 7015 | attr::Kind NewAttrKind = A->getKind(); | ||||||||||
| 7016 | QualType Desugared = Type; | ||||||||||
| 7017 | const AttributedType *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Type); | ||||||||||
| 7018 | while (AT) { | ||||||||||
| 7019 | Attrs[AT->getAttrKind()] = true; | ||||||||||
| 7020 | Desugared = AT->getModifiedType(); | ||||||||||
| 7021 | AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Desugared); | ||||||||||
| 7022 | } | ||||||||||
| 7023 | |||||||||||
| 7024 | // You cannot specify duplicate type attributes, so if the attribute has | ||||||||||
| 7025 | // already been applied, flag it. | ||||||||||
| 7026 | if (Attrs[NewAttrKind]) { | ||||||||||
| 7027 | S.Diag(PAttr.getLoc(), diag::warn_duplicate_attribute_exact) << PAttr; | ||||||||||
| 7028 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7029 | } | ||||||||||
| 7030 | Attrs[NewAttrKind] = true; | ||||||||||
| 7031 | |||||||||||
| 7032 | // You cannot have both __sptr and __uptr on the same type, nor can you | ||||||||||
| 7033 | // have __ptr32 and __ptr64. | ||||||||||
| 7034 | if (Attrs[attr::Ptr32] && Attrs[attr::Ptr64]) { | ||||||||||
| 7035 | S.Diag(PAttr.getLoc(), diag::err_attributes_are_not_compatible) | ||||||||||
| 7036 | << "'__ptr32'" | ||||||||||
| 7037 | << "'__ptr64'"; | ||||||||||
| 7038 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7039 | } else if (Attrs[attr::SPtr] && Attrs[attr::UPtr]) { | ||||||||||
| 7040 | S.Diag(PAttr.getLoc(), diag::err_attributes_are_not_compatible) | ||||||||||
| 7041 | << "'__sptr'" | ||||||||||
| 7042 | << "'__uptr'"; | ||||||||||
| 7043 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7044 | } | ||||||||||
| 7045 | |||||||||||
| 7046 | // Pointer type qualifiers can only operate on pointer types, but not | ||||||||||
| 7047 | // pointer-to-member types. | ||||||||||
| 7048 | // | ||||||||||
| 7049 | // FIXME: Should we really be disallowing this attribute if there is any | ||||||||||
| 7050 | // type sugar between it and the pointer (other than attributes)? Eg, this | ||||||||||
| 7051 | // disallows the attribute on a parenthesized pointer. | ||||||||||
| 7052 | // And if so, should we really allow *any* type attribute? | ||||||||||
| 7053 | if (!isa<PointerType>(Desugared)) { | ||||||||||
| 7054 | if (Type->isMemberPointerType()) | ||||||||||
| 7055 | S.Diag(PAttr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_no_member_pointers) << PAttr; | ||||||||||
| 7056 | else | ||||||||||
| 7057 | S.Diag(PAttr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_pointers_only) << PAttr << 0; | ||||||||||
| 7058 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7059 | } | ||||||||||
| 7060 | |||||||||||
| 7061 | // Add address space to type based on its attributes. | ||||||||||
| 7062 | LangAS ASIdx = LangAS::Default; | ||||||||||
| 7063 | uint64_t PtrWidth = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0); | ||||||||||
| 7064 | if (PtrWidth == 32) { | ||||||||||
| 7065 | if (Attrs[attr::Ptr64]) | ||||||||||
| 7066 | ASIdx = LangAS::ptr64; | ||||||||||
| 7067 | else if (Attrs[attr::UPtr]) | ||||||||||
| 7068 | ASIdx = LangAS::ptr32_uptr; | ||||||||||
| 7069 | } else if (PtrWidth == 64 && Attrs[attr::Ptr32]) { | ||||||||||
| 7070 | if (Attrs[attr::UPtr]) | ||||||||||
| 7071 | ASIdx = LangAS::ptr32_uptr; | ||||||||||
| 7072 | else | ||||||||||
| 7073 | ASIdx = LangAS::ptr32_sptr; | ||||||||||
| 7074 | } | ||||||||||
| 7075 | |||||||||||
| 7076 | QualType Pointee = Type->getPointeeType(); | ||||||||||
| 7077 | if (ASIdx != LangAS::Default) | ||||||||||
| 7078 | Pointee = S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType( | ||||||||||
| 7079 | S.Context.removeAddrSpaceQualType(Pointee), ASIdx); | ||||||||||
| 7080 | Type = State.getAttributedType(A, Type, S.Context.getPointerType(Pointee)); | ||||||||||
| 7081 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7082 | } | ||||||||||
| 7083 | |||||||||||
| 7084 | /// Map a nullability attribute kind to a nullability kind. | ||||||||||
| 7085 | static NullabilityKind mapNullabilityAttrKind(ParsedAttr::Kind kind) { | ||||||||||
| 7086 | switch (kind) { | ||||||||||
| 7087 | case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNonNull: | ||||||||||
| 7088 | return NullabilityKind::NonNull; | ||||||||||
| 7089 | |||||||||||
| 7090 | case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullable: | ||||||||||
| 7091 | return NullabilityKind::Nullable; | ||||||||||
| 7092 | |||||||||||
| 7093 | case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullableResult: | ||||||||||
| 7094 | return NullabilityKind::NullableResult; | ||||||||||
| 7095 | |||||||||||
| 7096 | case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullUnspecified: | ||||||||||
| 7097 | return NullabilityKind::Unspecified; | ||||||||||
| 7098 | |||||||||||
| 7099 | default: | ||||||||||
| 7100 | llvm_unreachable("not a nullability attribute kind")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 7101 | } | ||||||||||
| 7102 | } | ||||||||||
| 7103 | |||||||||||
| 7104 | /// Applies a nullability type specifier to the given type, if possible. | ||||||||||
| 7105 | /// | ||||||||||
| 7106 | /// \param state The type processing state. | ||||||||||
| 7107 | /// | ||||||||||
| 7108 | /// \param type The type to which the nullability specifier will be | ||||||||||
| 7109 | /// added. On success, this type will be updated appropriately. | ||||||||||
| 7110 | /// | ||||||||||
| 7111 | /// \param attr The attribute as written on the type. | ||||||||||
| 7112 | /// | ||||||||||
| 7113 | /// \param allowOnArrayType Whether to accept nullability specifiers on an | ||||||||||
| 7114 | /// array type (e.g., because it will decay to a pointer). | ||||||||||
| 7115 | /// | ||||||||||
| 7116 | /// \returns true if a problem has been diagnosed, false on success. | ||||||||||
| 7117 | static bool checkNullabilityTypeSpecifier(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 7118 | QualType &type, | ||||||||||
| 7119 | ParsedAttr &attr, | ||||||||||
| 7120 | bool allowOnArrayType) { | ||||||||||
| 7121 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 7122 | |||||||||||
| 7123 | NullabilityKind nullability = mapNullabilityAttrKind(attr.getKind()); | ||||||||||
| 7124 | SourceLocation nullabilityLoc = attr.getLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 7125 | bool isContextSensitive = attr.isContextSensitiveKeywordAttribute(); | ||||||||||
| 7126 | |||||||||||
| 7127 | recordNullabilitySeen(S, nullabilityLoc); | ||||||||||
| 7128 | |||||||||||
| 7129 | // Check for existing nullability attributes on the type. | ||||||||||
| 7130 | QualType desugared = type; | ||||||||||
| 7131 | while (auto attributed = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(desugared.getTypePtr())) { | ||||||||||
| 7132 | // Check whether there is already a null | ||||||||||
| 7133 | if (auto existingNullability = attributed->getImmediateNullability()) { | ||||||||||
| 7134 | // Duplicated nullability. | ||||||||||
| 7135 | if (nullability == *existingNullability) { | ||||||||||
| 7136 | S.Diag(nullabilityLoc, diag::warn_nullability_duplicate) | ||||||||||
| 7137 | << DiagNullabilityKind(nullability, isContextSensitive) | ||||||||||
| 7138 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(nullabilityLoc); | ||||||||||
| 7139 | |||||||||||
| 7140 | break; | ||||||||||
| 7141 | } | ||||||||||
| 7142 | |||||||||||
| 7143 | // Conflicting nullability. | ||||||||||
| 7144 | S.Diag(nullabilityLoc, diag::err_nullability_conflicting) | ||||||||||
| 7145 | << DiagNullabilityKind(nullability, isContextSensitive) | ||||||||||
| 7146 | << DiagNullabilityKind(*existingNullability, false); | ||||||||||
| 7147 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7148 | } | ||||||||||
| 7149 | |||||||||||
| 7150 | desugared = attributed->getModifiedType(); | ||||||||||
| 7151 | } | ||||||||||
| 7152 | |||||||||||
| 7153 | // If there is already a different nullability specifier, complain. | ||||||||||
| 7154 | // This (unlike the code above) looks through typedefs that might | ||||||||||
| 7155 | // have nullability specifiers on them, which means we cannot | ||||||||||
| 7156 | // provide a useful Fix-It. | ||||||||||
| 7157 | if (auto existingNullability = desugared->getNullability(S.Context)) { | ||||||||||
| 7158 | if (nullability != *existingNullability) { | ||||||||||
| 7159 | S.Diag(nullabilityLoc, diag::err_nullability_conflicting) | ||||||||||
| 7160 | << DiagNullabilityKind(nullability, isContextSensitive) | ||||||||||
| 7161 | << DiagNullabilityKind(*existingNullability, false); | ||||||||||
| 7162 | |||||||||||
| 7163 | // Try to find the typedef with the existing nullability specifier. | ||||||||||
| 7164 | if (auto typedefType = desugared->getAs<TypedefType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 7165 | TypedefNameDecl *typedefDecl = typedefType->getDecl(); | ||||||||||
| 7166 | QualType underlyingType = typedefDecl->getUnderlyingType(); | ||||||||||
| 7167 | if (auto typedefNullability | ||||||||||
| 7168 | = AttributedType::stripOuterNullability(underlyingType)) { | ||||||||||
| 7169 | if (*typedefNullability == *existingNullability) { | ||||||||||
| 7170 | S.Diag(typedefDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_nullability_here) | ||||||||||
| 7171 | << DiagNullabilityKind(*existingNullability, false); | ||||||||||
| 7172 | } | ||||||||||
| 7173 | } | ||||||||||
| 7174 | } | ||||||||||
| 7175 | |||||||||||
| 7176 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7177 | } | ||||||||||
| 7178 | } | ||||||||||
| 7179 | |||||||||||
| 7180 | // If this definitely isn't a pointer type, reject the specifier. | ||||||||||
| 7181 | if (!desugared->canHaveNullability() && | ||||||||||
| 7182 | !(allowOnArrayType && desugared->isArrayType())) { | ||||||||||
| 7183 | S.Diag(nullabilityLoc, diag::err_nullability_nonpointer) | ||||||||||
| 7184 | << DiagNullabilityKind(nullability, isContextSensitive) << type; | ||||||||||
| 7185 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7186 | } | ||||||||||
| 7187 | |||||||||||
| 7188 | // For the context-sensitive keywords/Objective-C property | ||||||||||
| 7189 | // attributes, require that the type be a single-level pointer. | ||||||||||
| 7190 | if (isContextSensitive) { | ||||||||||
| 7191 | // Make sure that the pointee isn't itself a pointer type. | ||||||||||
| 7192 | const Type *pointeeType = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 7193 | if (desugared->isArrayType()) | ||||||||||
| 7194 | pointeeType = desugared->getArrayElementTypeNoTypeQual(); | ||||||||||
| 7195 | else if (desugared->isAnyPointerType()) | ||||||||||
| 7196 | pointeeType = desugared->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(); | ||||||||||
| 7197 | |||||||||||
| 7198 | if (pointeeType && (pointeeType->isAnyPointerType() || | ||||||||||
| 7199 | pointeeType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || | ||||||||||
| 7200 | pointeeType->isMemberPointerType())) { | ||||||||||
| 7201 | S.Diag(nullabilityLoc, diag::err_nullability_cs_multilevel) | ||||||||||
| 7202 | << DiagNullabilityKind(nullability, true) | ||||||||||
| 7203 | << type; | ||||||||||
| 7204 | S.Diag(nullabilityLoc, diag::note_nullability_type_specifier) | ||||||||||
| 7205 | << DiagNullabilityKind(nullability, false) | ||||||||||
| 7206 | << type | ||||||||||
| 7207 | << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(nullabilityLoc, | ||||||||||
| 7208 | getNullabilitySpelling(nullability)); | ||||||||||
| 7209 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7210 | } | ||||||||||
| 7211 | } | ||||||||||
| 7212 | |||||||||||
| 7213 | // Form the attributed type. | ||||||||||
| 7214 | type = state.getAttributedType( | ||||||||||
| 7215 | createNullabilityAttr(S.Context, attr, nullability), type, type); | ||||||||||
| 7216 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7217 | } | ||||||||||
| 7218 | |||||||||||
| 7219 | /// Check the application of the Objective-C '__kindof' qualifier to | ||||||||||
| 7220 | /// the given type. | ||||||||||
| 7221 | static bool checkObjCKindOfType(TypeProcessingState &state, QualType &type, | ||||||||||
| 7222 | ParsedAttr &attr) { | ||||||||||
| 7223 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 7224 | |||||||||||
| 7225 | if (isa<ObjCTypeParamType>(type)) { | ||||||||||
| 7226 | // Build the attributed type to record where __kindof occurred. | ||||||||||
| 7227 | type = state.getAttributedType( | ||||||||||
| 7228 | createSimpleAttr<ObjCKindOfAttr>(S.Context, attr), type, type); | ||||||||||
| 7229 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7230 | } | ||||||||||
| 7231 | |||||||||||
| 7232 | // Find out if it's an Objective-C object or object pointer type; | ||||||||||
| 7233 | const ObjCObjectPointerType *ptrType = type->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); | ||||||||||
| 7234 | const ObjCObjectType *objType = ptrType ? ptrType->getObjectType() | ||||||||||
| 7235 | : type->getAs<ObjCObjectType>(); | ||||||||||
| 7236 | |||||||||||
| 7237 | // If not, we can't apply __kindof. | ||||||||||
| 7238 | if (!objType) { | ||||||||||
| 7239 | // FIXME: Handle dependent types that aren't yet object types. | ||||||||||
| 7240 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::err_objc_kindof_nonobject) | ||||||||||
| 7241 | << type; | ||||||||||
| 7242 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7243 | } | ||||||||||
| 7244 | |||||||||||
| 7245 | // Rebuild the "equivalent" type, which pushes __kindof down into | ||||||||||
| 7246 | // the object type. | ||||||||||
| 7247 | // There is no need to apply kindof on an unqualified id type. | ||||||||||
| 7248 | QualType equivType = S.Context.getObjCObjectType( | ||||||||||
| 7249 | objType->getBaseType(), objType->getTypeArgsAsWritten(), | ||||||||||
| 7250 | objType->getProtocols(), | ||||||||||
| 7251 | /*isKindOf=*/objType->isObjCUnqualifiedId() ? false : true); | ||||||||||
| 7252 | |||||||||||
| 7253 | // If we started with an object pointer type, rebuild it. | ||||||||||
| 7254 | if (ptrType) { | ||||||||||
| 7255 | equivType = S.Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(equivType); | ||||||||||
| 7256 | if (auto nullability = type->getNullability(S.Context)) { | ||||||||||
| 7257 | // We create a nullability attribute from the __kindof attribute. | ||||||||||
| 7258 | // Make sure that will make sense. | ||||||||||
| 7259 | assert(attr.getAttributeSpellingListIndex() == 0 &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 7260 | "multiple spellings for __kindof?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 7261 | Attr *A = createNullabilityAttr(S.Context, attr, *nullability); | ||||||||||
| 7262 | A->setImplicit(true); | ||||||||||
| 7263 | equivType = state.getAttributedType(A, equivType, equivType); | ||||||||||
| 7264 | } | ||||||||||
| 7265 | } | ||||||||||
| 7266 | |||||||||||
| 7267 | // Build the attributed type to record where __kindof occurred. | ||||||||||
| 7268 | type = state.getAttributedType( | ||||||||||
| 7269 | createSimpleAttr<ObjCKindOfAttr>(S.Context, attr), type, equivType); | ||||||||||
| 7270 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7271 | } | ||||||||||
| 7272 | |||||||||||
| 7273 | /// Distribute a nullability type attribute that cannot be applied to | ||||||||||
| 7274 | /// the type specifier to a pointer, block pointer, or member pointer | ||||||||||
| 7275 | /// declarator, complaining if necessary. | ||||||||||
| 7276 | /// | ||||||||||
| 7277 | /// \returns true if the nullability annotation was distributed, false | ||||||||||
| 7278 | /// otherwise. | ||||||||||
| 7279 | static bool distributeNullabilityTypeAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, | ||||||||||
| 7280 | QualType type, ParsedAttr &attr) { | ||||||||||
| 7281 | Declarator &declarator = state.getDeclarator(); | ||||||||||
| 7282 | |||||||||||
| 7283 | /// Attempt to move the attribute to the specified chunk. | ||||||||||
| 7284 | auto moveToChunk = [&](DeclaratorChunk &chunk, bool inFunction) -> bool { | ||||||||||
| 7285 | // If there is already a nullability attribute there, don't add | ||||||||||
| 7286 | // one. | ||||||||||
| 7287 | if (hasNullabilityAttr(chunk.getAttrs())) | ||||||||||
| 7288 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7289 | |||||||||||
| 7290 | // Complain about the nullability qualifier being in the wrong | ||||||||||
| 7291 | // place. | ||||||||||
| 7292 | enum { | ||||||||||
| 7293 | PK_Pointer, | ||||||||||
| 7294 | PK_BlockPointer, | ||||||||||
| 7295 | PK_MemberPointer, | ||||||||||
| 7296 | PK_FunctionPointer, | ||||||||||
| 7297 | PK_MemberFunctionPointer, | ||||||||||
| 7298 | } pointerKind | ||||||||||
| 7299 | = chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Pointer ? (inFunction ? PK_FunctionPointer | ||||||||||
| 7300 | : PK_Pointer) | ||||||||||
| 7301 | : chunk.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer ? PK_BlockPointer | ||||||||||
| 7302 | : inFunction? PK_MemberFunctionPointer : PK_MemberPointer; | ||||||||||
| 7303 | |||||||||||
| 7304 | auto diag = state.getSema().Diag(attr.getLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 7305 | diag::warn_nullability_declspec) | ||||||||||
| 7306 | << DiagNullabilityKind(mapNullabilityAttrKind(attr.getKind()), | ||||||||||
| 7307 | attr.isContextSensitiveKeywordAttribute()) | ||||||||||
| 7308 | << type | ||||||||||
| 7309 | << static_cast<unsigned>(pointerKind); | ||||||||||
| 7310 | |||||||||||
| 7311 | // FIXME: MemberPointer chunks don't carry the location of the *. | ||||||||||
| 7312 | if (chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer) { | ||||||||||
| 7313 | diag << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(attr.getLoc()) | ||||||||||
| 7314 | << FixItHint::CreateInsertion( | ||||||||||
| 7315 | state.getSema().getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken( | ||||||||||
| 7316 | chunk.Loc), | ||||||||||
| 7317 | " " + attr.getAttrName()->getName().str() + " "); | ||||||||||
| 7318 | } | ||||||||||
| 7319 | |||||||||||
| 7320 | moveAttrFromListToList(attr, state.getCurrentAttributes(), | ||||||||||
| 7321 | chunk.getAttrs()); | ||||||||||
| 7322 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7323 | }; | ||||||||||
| 7324 | |||||||||||
| 7325 | // Move it to the outermost pointer, member pointer, or block | ||||||||||
| 7326 | // pointer declarator. | ||||||||||
| 7327 | for (unsigned i = state.getCurrentChunkIndex(); i != 0; --i) { | ||||||||||
| 7328 | DeclaratorChunk &chunk = declarator.getTypeObject(i-1); | ||||||||||
| 7329 | switch (chunk.Kind) { | ||||||||||
| 7330 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pointer: | ||||||||||
| 7331 | case DeclaratorChunk::BlockPointer: | ||||||||||
| 7332 | case DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer: | ||||||||||
| 7333 | return moveToChunk(chunk, false); | ||||||||||
| 7334 | |||||||||||
| 7335 | case DeclaratorChunk::Paren: | ||||||||||
| 7336 | case DeclaratorChunk::Array: | ||||||||||
| 7337 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 7338 | |||||||||||
| 7339 | case DeclaratorChunk::Function: | ||||||||||
| 7340 | // Try to move past the return type to a function/block/member | ||||||||||
| 7341 | // function pointer. | ||||||||||
| 7342 | if (DeclaratorChunk *dest = maybeMovePastReturnType( | ||||||||||
| 7343 | declarator, i, | ||||||||||
| 7344 | /*onlyBlockPointers=*/false)) { | ||||||||||
| 7345 | return moveToChunk(*dest, true); | ||||||||||
| 7346 | } | ||||||||||
| 7347 | |||||||||||
| 7348 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7349 | |||||||||||
| 7350 | // Don't walk through these. | ||||||||||
| 7351 | case DeclaratorChunk::Reference: | ||||||||||
| 7352 | case DeclaratorChunk::Pipe: | ||||||||||
| 7353 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7354 | } | ||||||||||
| 7355 | } | ||||||||||
| 7356 | |||||||||||
| 7357 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7358 | } | ||||||||||
| 7359 | |||||||||||
| 7360 | static Attr *getCCTypeAttr(ASTContext &Ctx, ParsedAttr &Attr) { | ||||||||||
| 7361 | assert(!Attr.isInvalid())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 7362 | switch (Attr.getKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 7363 | default: | ||||||||||
| 7364 | llvm_unreachable("not a calling convention attribute")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 7365 | case ParsedAttr::AT_CDecl: | ||||||||||
| 7366 | return createSimpleAttr<CDeclAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7367 | case ParsedAttr::AT_FastCall: | ||||||||||
| 7368 | return createSimpleAttr<FastCallAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7369 | case ParsedAttr::AT_StdCall: | ||||||||||
| 7370 | return createSimpleAttr<StdCallAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7371 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ThisCall: | ||||||||||
| 7372 | return createSimpleAttr<ThisCallAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7373 | case ParsedAttr::AT_RegCall: | ||||||||||
| 7374 | return createSimpleAttr<RegCallAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7375 | case ParsedAttr::AT_Pascal: | ||||||||||
| 7376 | return createSimpleAttr<PascalAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7377 | case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftCall: | ||||||||||
| 7378 | return createSimpleAttr<SwiftCallAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7379 | case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftAsyncCall: | ||||||||||
| 7380 | return createSimpleAttr<SwiftAsyncCallAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7381 | case ParsedAttr::AT_VectorCall: | ||||||||||
| 7382 | return createSimpleAttr<VectorCallAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7383 | case ParsedAttr::AT_AArch64VectorPcs: | ||||||||||
| 7384 | return createSimpleAttr<AArch64VectorPcsAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7385 | case ParsedAttr::AT_Pcs: { | ||||||||||
| 7386 | // The attribute may have had a fixit applied where we treated an | ||||||||||
| 7387 | // identifier as a string literal. The contents of the string are valid, | ||||||||||
| 7388 | // but the form may not be. | ||||||||||
| 7389 | StringRef Str; | ||||||||||
| 7390 | if (Attr.isArgExpr(0)) | ||||||||||
| 7391 | Str = cast<StringLiteral>(Attr.getArgAsExpr(0))->getString(); | ||||||||||
| 7392 | else | ||||||||||
| 7393 | Str = Attr.getArgAsIdent(0)->Ident->getName(); | ||||||||||
| 7394 | PcsAttr::PCSType Type; | ||||||||||
| 7395 | if (!PcsAttr::ConvertStrToPCSType(Str, Type)) | ||||||||||
| 7396 | llvm_unreachable("already validated the attribute")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 7397 | return ::new (Ctx) PcsAttr(Ctx, Attr, Type); | ||||||||||
| 7398 | } | ||||||||||
| 7399 | case ParsedAttr::AT_IntelOclBicc: | ||||||||||
| 7400 | return createSimpleAttr<IntelOclBiccAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7401 | case ParsedAttr::AT_MSABI: | ||||||||||
| 7402 | return createSimpleAttr<MSABIAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7403 | case ParsedAttr::AT_SysVABI: | ||||||||||
| 7404 | return createSimpleAttr<SysVABIAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7405 | case ParsedAttr::AT_PreserveMost: | ||||||||||
| 7406 | return createSimpleAttr<PreserveMostAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7407 | case ParsedAttr::AT_PreserveAll: | ||||||||||
| 7408 | return createSimpleAttr<PreserveAllAttr>(Ctx, Attr); | ||||||||||
| 7409 | } | ||||||||||
| 7410 | llvm_unreachable("unexpected attribute kind!")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 7411 | } | ||||||||||
| 7412 | |||||||||||
| 7413 | /// Process an individual function attribute. Returns true to | ||||||||||
| 7414 | /// indicate that the attribute was handled, false if it wasn't. | ||||||||||
| 7415 | static bool handleFunctionTypeAttr(TypeProcessingState &state, ParsedAttr &attr, | ||||||||||
| 7416 | QualType &type) { | ||||||||||
| 7417 | Sema &S = state.getSema(); | ||||||||||
| 7418 | |||||||||||
| 7419 | FunctionTypeUnwrapper unwrapped(S, type); | ||||||||||
| 7420 | |||||||||||
| 7421 | if (attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_NoReturn) { | ||||||||||
| 7422 | if (S.CheckAttrNoArgs(attr)) | ||||||||||
| 7423 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7424 | |||||||||||
| 7425 | // Delay if this is not a function type. | ||||||||||
| 7426 | if (!unwrapped.isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 7427 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7428 | |||||||||||
| 7429 | // Otherwise we can process right away. | ||||||||||
| 7430 | FunctionType::ExtInfo EI = unwrapped.get()->getExtInfo().withNoReturn(true); | ||||||||||
| 7431 | type = unwrapped.wrap(S, S.Context.adjustFunctionType(unwrapped.get(), EI)); | ||||||||||
| 7432 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7433 | } | ||||||||||
| 7434 | |||||||||||
| 7435 | if (attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_CmseNSCall) { | ||||||||||
| 7436 | // Delay if this is not a function type. | ||||||||||
| 7437 | if (!unwrapped.isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 7438 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7439 | |||||||||||
| 7440 | // Ignore if we don't have CMSE enabled. | ||||||||||
| 7441 | if (!S.getLangOpts().Cmse) { | ||||||||||
| 7442 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored) << attr; | ||||||||||
| 7443 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7444 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7445 | } | ||||||||||
| 7446 | |||||||||||
| 7447 | // Otherwise we can process right away. | ||||||||||
| 7448 | FunctionType::ExtInfo EI = | ||||||||||
| 7449 | unwrapped.get()->getExtInfo().withCmseNSCall(true); | ||||||||||
| 7450 | type = unwrapped.wrap(S, S.Context.adjustFunctionType(unwrapped.get(), EI)); | ||||||||||
| 7451 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7452 | } | ||||||||||
| 7453 | |||||||||||
| 7454 | // ns_returns_retained is not always a type attribute, but if we got | ||||||||||
| 7455 | // here, we're treating it as one right now. | ||||||||||
| 7456 | if (attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_NSReturnsRetained) { | ||||||||||
| 7457 | if (attr.getNumArgs()) return true; | ||||||||||
| 7458 | |||||||||||
| 7459 | // Delay if this is not a function type. | ||||||||||
| 7460 | if (!unwrapped.isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 7461 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7462 | |||||||||||
| 7463 | // Check whether the return type is reasonable. | ||||||||||
| 7464 | if (S.checkNSReturnsRetainedReturnType(attr.getLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 7465 | unwrapped.get()->getReturnType())) | ||||||||||
| 7466 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7467 | |||||||||||
| 7468 | // Only actually change the underlying type in ARC builds. | ||||||||||
| 7469 | QualType origType = type; | ||||||||||
| 7470 | if (state.getSema().getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { | ||||||||||
| 7471 | FunctionType::ExtInfo EI | ||||||||||
| 7472 | = unwrapped.get()->getExtInfo().withProducesResult(true); | ||||||||||
| 7473 | type = unwrapped.wrap(S, S.Context.adjustFunctionType(unwrapped.get(), EI)); | ||||||||||
| 7474 | } | ||||||||||
| 7475 | type = state.getAttributedType( | ||||||||||
| 7476 | createSimpleAttr<NSReturnsRetainedAttr>(S.Context, attr), | ||||||||||
| 7477 | origType, type); | ||||||||||
| 7478 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7479 | } | ||||||||||
| 7480 | |||||||||||
| 7481 | if (attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegisters) { | ||||||||||
| 7482 | if (S.CheckAttrTarget(attr) || S.CheckAttrNoArgs(attr)) | ||||||||||
| 7483 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7484 | |||||||||||
| 7485 | // Delay if this is not a function type. | ||||||||||
| 7486 | if (!unwrapped.isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 7487 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7488 | |||||||||||
| 7489 | FunctionType::ExtInfo EI = | ||||||||||
| 7490 | unwrapped.get()->getExtInfo().withNoCallerSavedRegs(true); | ||||||||||
| 7491 | type = unwrapped.wrap(S, S.Context.adjustFunctionType(unwrapped.get(), EI)); | ||||||||||
| 7492 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7493 | } | ||||||||||
| 7494 | |||||||||||
| 7495 | if (attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_AnyX86NoCfCheck) { | ||||||||||
| 7496 | if (!S.getLangOpts().CFProtectionBranch) { | ||||||||||
| 7497 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::warn_nocf_check_attribute_ignored); | ||||||||||
| 7498 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7499 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7500 | } | ||||||||||
| 7501 | |||||||||||
| 7502 | if (S.CheckAttrTarget(attr) || S.CheckAttrNoArgs(attr)) | ||||||||||
| 7503 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7504 | |||||||||||
| 7505 | // If this is not a function type, warning will be asserted by subject | ||||||||||
| 7506 | // check. | ||||||||||
| 7507 | if (!unwrapped.isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 7508 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7509 | |||||||||||
| 7510 | FunctionType::ExtInfo EI = | ||||||||||
| 7511 | unwrapped.get()->getExtInfo().withNoCfCheck(true); | ||||||||||
| 7512 | type = unwrapped.wrap(S, S.Context.adjustFunctionType(unwrapped.get(), EI)); | ||||||||||
| 7513 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7514 | } | ||||||||||
| 7515 | |||||||||||
| 7516 | if (attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_Regparm) { | ||||||||||
| 7517 | unsigned value; | ||||||||||
| 7518 | if (S.CheckRegparmAttr(attr, value)) | ||||||||||
| 7519 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7520 | |||||||||||
| 7521 | // Delay if this is not a function type. | ||||||||||
| 7522 | if (!unwrapped.isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 7523 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7524 | |||||||||||
| 7525 | // Diagnose regparm with fastcall. | ||||||||||
| 7526 | const FunctionType *fn = unwrapped.get(); | ||||||||||
| 7527 | CallingConv CC = fn->getCallConv(); | ||||||||||
| 7528 | if (CC == CC_X86FastCall) { | ||||||||||
| 7529 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attributes_are_not_compatible) | ||||||||||
| 7530 | << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC) | ||||||||||
| 7531 | << "regparm"; | ||||||||||
| 7532 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7533 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7534 | } | ||||||||||
| 7535 | |||||||||||
| 7536 | FunctionType::ExtInfo EI = | ||||||||||
| 7537 | unwrapped.get()->getExtInfo().withRegParm(value); | ||||||||||
| 7538 | type = unwrapped.wrap(S, S.Context.adjustFunctionType(unwrapped.get(), EI)); | ||||||||||
| 7539 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7540 | } | ||||||||||
| 7541 | |||||||||||
| 7542 | if (attr.getKind() == ParsedAttr::AT_NoThrow) { | ||||||||||
| 7543 | // Delay if this is not a function type. | ||||||||||
| 7544 | if (!unwrapped.isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 7545 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7546 | |||||||||||
| 7547 | if (S.CheckAttrNoArgs(attr)) { | ||||||||||
| 7548 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7549 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7550 | } | ||||||||||
| 7551 | |||||||||||
| 7552 | // Otherwise we can process right away. | ||||||||||
| 7553 | auto *Proto = unwrapped.get()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); | ||||||||||
| 7554 | |||||||||||
| 7555 | // MSVC ignores nothrow if it is in conflict with an explicit exception | ||||||||||
| 7556 | // specification. | ||||||||||
| 7557 | if (Proto->hasExceptionSpec()) { | ||||||||||
| 7558 | switch (Proto->getExceptionSpecType()) { | ||||||||||
| 7559 | case EST_None: | ||||||||||
| 7560 | llvm_unreachable("This doesn't have an exception spec!")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 7561 | |||||||||||
| 7562 | case EST_DynamicNone: | ||||||||||
| 7563 | case EST_BasicNoexcept: | ||||||||||
| 7564 | case EST_NoexceptTrue: | ||||||||||
| 7565 | case EST_NoThrow: | ||||||||||
| 7566 | // Exception spec doesn't conflict with nothrow, so don't warn. | ||||||||||
| 7567 | LLVM_FALLTHROUGH[[gnu::fallthrough]]; | ||||||||||
| 7568 | case EST_Unparsed: | ||||||||||
| 7569 | case EST_Uninstantiated: | ||||||||||
| 7570 | case EST_DependentNoexcept: | ||||||||||
| 7571 | case EST_Unevaluated: | ||||||||||
| 7572 | // We don't have enough information to properly determine if there is a | ||||||||||
| 7573 | // conflict, so suppress the warning. | ||||||||||
| 7574 | break; | ||||||||||
| 7575 | case EST_Dynamic: | ||||||||||
| 7576 | case EST_MSAny: | ||||||||||
| 7577 | case EST_NoexceptFalse: | ||||||||||
| 7578 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::warn_nothrow_attribute_ignored); | ||||||||||
| 7579 | break; | ||||||||||
| 7580 | } | ||||||||||
| 7581 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7582 | } | ||||||||||
| 7583 | |||||||||||
| 7584 | type = unwrapped.wrap( | ||||||||||
| 7585 | S, S.Context | ||||||||||
| 7586 | .getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec( | ||||||||||
| 7587 | QualType{Proto, 0}, | ||||||||||
| 7588 | FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo{EST_NoThrow}) | ||||||||||
| 7589 | ->getAs<FunctionType>()); | ||||||||||
| 7590 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7591 | } | ||||||||||
| 7592 | |||||||||||
| 7593 | // Delay if the type didn't work out to a function. | ||||||||||
| 7594 | if (!unwrapped.isFunctionType()) return false; | ||||||||||
| 7595 | |||||||||||
| 7596 | // Otherwise, a calling convention. | ||||||||||
| 7597 | CallingConv CC; | ||||||||||
| 7598 | if (S.CheckCallingConvAttr(attr, CC)) | ||||||||||
| 7599 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7600 | |||||||||||
| 7601 | const FunctionType *fn = unwrapped.get(); | ||||||||||
| 7602 | CallingConv CCOld = fn->getCallConv(); | ||||||||||
| 7603 | Attr *CCAttr = getCCTypeAttr(S.Context, attr); | ||||||||||
| 7604 | |||||||||||
| 7605 | if (CCOld != CC) { | ||||||||||
| 7606 | // Error out on when there's already an attribute on the type | ||||||||||
| 7607 | // and the CCs don't match. | ||||||||||
| 7608 | if (S.getCallingConvAttributedType(type)) { | ||||||||||
| 7609 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attributes_are_not_compatible) | ||||||||||
| 7610 | << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC) | ||||||||||
| 7611 | << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CCOld); | ||||||||||
| 7612 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7613 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7614 | } | ||||||||||
| 7615 | } | ||||||||||
| 7616 | |||||||||||
| 7617 | // Diagnose use of variadic functions with calling conventions that | ||||||||||
| 7618 | // don't support them (e.g. because they're callee-cleanup). | ||||||||||
| 7619 | // We delay warning about this on unprototyped function declarations | ||||||||||
| 7620 | // until after redeclaration checking, just in case we pick up a | ||||||||||
| 7621 | // prototype that way. And apparently we also "delay" warning about | ||||||||||
| 7622 | // unprototyped function types in general, despite not necessarily having | ||||||||||
| 7623 | // much ability to diagnose it later. | ||||||||||
| 7624 | if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) { | ||||||||||
| 7625 | const FunctionProtoType *FnP = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn); | ||||||||||
| 7626 | if (FnP && FnP->isVariadic()) { | ||||||||||
| 7627 | // stdcall and fastcall are ignored with a warning for GCC and MS | ||||||||||
| 7628 | // compatibility. | ||||||||||
| 7629 | if (CC == CC_X86StdCall || CC == CC_X86FastCall) | ||||||||||
| 7630 | return S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::warn_cconv_unsupported) | ||||||||||
| 7631 | << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC) | ||||||||||
| 7632 | << (int)Sema::CallingConventionIgnoredReason::VariadicFunction; | ||||||||||
| 7633 | |||||||||||
| 7634 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7635 | return S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::err_cconv_varargs) | ||||||||||
| 7636 | << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC); | ||||||||||
| 7637 | } | ||||||||||
| 7638 | } | ||||||||||
| 7639 | |||||||||||
| 7640 | // Also diagnose fastcall with regparm. | ||||||||||
| 7641 | if (CC == CC_X86FastCall && fn->getHasRegParm()) { | ||||||||||
| 7642 | S.Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attributes_are_not_compatible) | ||||||||||
| 7643 | << "regparm" << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC_X86FastCall); | ||||||||||
| 7644 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7645 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7646 | } | ||||||||||
| 7647 | |||||||||||
| 7648 | // Modify the CC from the wrapped function type, wrap it all back, and then | ||||||||||
| 7649 | // wrap the whole thing in an AttributedType as written. The modified type | ||||||||||
| 7650 | // might have a different CC if we ignored the attribute. | ||||||||||
| 7651 | QualType Equivalent; | ||||||||||
| 7652 | if (CCOld == CC) { | ||||||||||
| 7653 | Equivalent = type; | ||||||||||
| 7654 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 7655 | auto EI = unwrapped.get()->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC); | ||||||||||
| 7656 | Equivalent = | ||||||||||
| 7657 | unwrapped.wrap(S, S.Context.adjustFunctionType(unwrapped.get(), EI)); | ||||||||||
| 7658 | } | ||||||||||
| 7659 | type = state.getAttributedType(CCAttr, type, Equivalent); | ||||||||||
| 7660 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7661 | } | ||||||||||
| 7662 | |||||||||||
| 7663 | bool Sema::hasExplicitCallingConv(QualType T) { | ||||||||||
| 7664 | const AttributedType *AT; | ||||||||||
| 7665 | |||||||||||
| 7666 | // Stop if we'd be stripping off a typedef sugar node to reach the | ||||||||||
| 7667 | // AttributedType. | ||||||||||
| 7668 | while ((AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>()) && | ||||||||||
| 7669 | AT->getAs<TypedefType>() == T->getAs<TypedefType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 7670 | if (AT->isCallingConv()) | ||||||||||
| 7671 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7672 | T = AT->getModifiedType(); | ||||||||||
| 7673 | } | ||||||||||
| 7674 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7675 | } | ||||||||||
| 7676 | |||||||||||
| 7677 | void Sema::adjustMemberFunctionCC(QualType &T, bool IsStatic, bool IsCtorOrDtor, | ||||||||||
| 7678 | SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 7679 | FunctionTypeUnwrapper Unwrapped(*this, T); | ||||||||||
| 7680 | const FunctionType *FT = Unwrapped.get(); | ||||||||||
| 7681 | bool IsVariadic = (isa<FunctionProtoType>(FT) && | ||||||||||
| 7682 | cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)->isVariadic()); | ||||||||||
| 7683 | CallingConv CurCC = FT->getCallConv(); | ||||||||||
| 7684 | CallingConv ToCC = Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(IsVariadic, !IsStatic); | ||||||||||
| 7685 | |||||||||||
| 7686 | if (CurCC == ToCC) | ||||||||||
| 7687 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7688 | |||||||||||
| 7689 | // MS compiler ignores explicit calling convention attributes on structors. We | ||||||||||
| 7690 | // should do the same. | ||||||||||
| 7691 | if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() && IsCtorOrDtor) { | ||||||||||
| 7692 | // Issue a warning on ignored calling convention -- except of __stdcall. | ||||||||||
| 7693 | // Again, this is what MS compiler does. | ||||||||||
| 7694 | if (CurCC != CC_X86StdCall) | ||||||||||
| 7695 | Diag(Loc, diag::warn_cconv_unsupported) | ||||||||||
| 7696 | << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CurCC) | ||||||||||
| 7697 | << (int)Sema::CallingConventionIgnoredReason::ConstructorDestructor; | ||||||||||
| 7698 | // Default adjustment. | ||||||||||
| 7699 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 7700 | // Only adjust types with the default convention. For example, on Windows | ||||||||||
| 7701 | // we should adjust a __cdecl type to __thiscall for instance methods, and a | ||||||||||
| 7702 | // __thiscall type to __cdecl for static methods. | ||||||||||
| 7703 | CallingConv DefaultCC = | ||||||||||
| 7704 | Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(IsVariadic, IsStatic); | ||||||||||
| 7705 | |||||||||||
| 7706 | if (CurCC != DefaultCC || DefaultCC == ToCC) | ||||||||||
| 7707 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7708 | |||||||||||
| 7709 | if (hasExplicitCallingConv(T)) | ||||||||||
| 7710 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7711 | } | ||||||||||
| 7712 | |||||||||||
| 7713 | FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(ToCC)); | ||||||||||
| 7714 | QualType Wrapped = Unwrapped.wrap(*this, FT); | ||||||||||
| 7715 | T = Context.getAdjustedType(T, Wrapped); | ||||||||||
| 7716 | } | ||||||||||
| 7717 | |||||||||||
| 7718 | /// HandleVectorSizeAttribute - this attribute is only applicable to integral | ||||||||||
| 7719 | /// and float scalars, although arrays, pointers, and function return values are | ||||||||||
| 7720 | /// allowed in conjunction with this construct. Aggregates with this attribute | ||||||||||
| 7721 | /// are invalid, even if they are of the same size as a corresponding scalar. | ||||||||||
| 7722 | /// The raw attribute should contain precisely 1 argument, the vector size for | ||||||||||
| 7723 | /// the variable, measured in bytes. If curType and rawAttr are well formed, | ||||||||||
| 7724 | /// this routine will return a new vector type. | ||||||||||
| 7725 | static void HandleVectorSizeAttr(QualType &CurType, const ParsedAttr &Attr, | ||||||||||
| 7726 | Sema &S) { | ||||||||||
| 7727 | // Check the attribute arguments. | ||||||||||
| 7728 | if (Attr.getNumArgs() != 1) { | ||||||||||
| 7729 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_wrong_number_arguments) << Attr | ||||||||||
| 7730 | << 1; | ||||||||||
| 7731 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7732 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7733 | } | ||||||||||
| 7734 | |||||||||||
| 7735 | Expr *SizeExpr = Attr.getArgAsExpr(0); | ||||||||||
| 7736 | QualType T = S.BuildVectorType(CurType, SizeExpr, Attr.getLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 7737 | if (!T.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 7738 | CurType = T; | ||||||||||
| 7739 | else | ||||||||||
| 7740 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7741 | } | ||||||||||
| 7742 | |||||||||||
| 7743 | /// Process the OpenCL-like ext_vector_type attribute when it occurs on | ||||||||||
| 7744 | /// a type. | ||||||||||
| 7745 | static void HandleExtVectorTypeAttr(QualType &CurType, const ParsedAttr &Attr, | ||||||||||
| 7746 | Sema &S) { | ||||||||||
| 7747 | // check the attribute arguments. | ||||||||||
| 7748 | if (Attr.getNumArgs() != 1) { | ||||||||||
| 7749 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_wrong_number_arguments) << Attr | ||||||||||
| 7750 | << 1; | ||||||||||
| 7751 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7752 | } | ||||||||||
| 7753 | |||||||||||
| 7754 | Expr *SizeExpr = Attr.getArgAsExpr(0); | ||||||||||
| 7755 | QualType T = S.BuildExtVectorType(CurType, SizeExpr, Attr.getLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 7756 | if (!T.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 7757 | CurType = T; | ||||||||||
| 7758 | } | ||||||||||
| 7759 | |||||||||||
| 7760 | static bool isPermittedNeonBaseType(QualType &Ty, | ||||||||||
| 7761 | VectorType::VectorKind VecKind, Sema &S) { | ||||||||||
| 7762 | const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); | ||||||||||
| 7763 | if (!BTy) | ||||||||||
| 7764 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7765 | |||||||||||
| 7766 | llvm::Triple Triple = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); | ||||||||||
| 7767 | |||||||||||
| 7768 | // Signed poly is mathematically wrong, but has been baked into some ABIs by | ||||||||||
| 7769 | // now. | ||||||||||
| 7770 | bool IsPolyUnsigned = Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::aarch64 || | ||||||||||
| 7771 | Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::aarch64_32 || | ||||||||||
| 7772 | Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::aarch64_be; | ||||||||||
| 7773 | if (VecKind == VectorType::NeonPolyVector) { | ||||||||||
| 7774 | if (IsPolyUnsigned) { | ||||||||||
| 7775 | // AArch64 polynomial vectors are unsigned. | ||||||||||
| 7776 | return BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UChar || | ||||||||||
| 7777 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UShort || | ||||||||||
| 7778 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong || | ||||||||||
| 7779 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULongLong; | ||||||||||
| 7780 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 7781 | // AArch32 polynomial vectors are signed. | ||||||||||
| 7782 | return BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::SChar || | ||||||||||
| 7783 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Short || | ||||||||||
| 7784 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongLong; | ||||||||||
| 7785 | } | ||||||||||
| 7786 | } | ||||||||||
| 7787 | |||||||||||
| 7788 | // Non-polynomial vector types: the usual suspects are allowed, as well as | ||||||||||
| 7789 | // float64_t on AArch64. | ||||||||||
| 7790 | if ((Triple.isArch64Bit() || Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::aarch64_32) && | ||||||||||
| 7791 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) | ||||||||||
| 7792 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7793 | |||||||||||
| 7794 | return BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::SChar || | ||||||||||
| 7795 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UChar || | ||||||||||
| 7796 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Short || | ||||||||||
| 7797 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UShort || | ||||||||||
| 7798 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int || | ||||||||||
| 7799 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt || | ||||||||||
| 7800 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long || | ||||||||||
| 7801 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong || | ||||||||||
| 7802 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongLong || | ||||||||||
| 7803 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULongLong || | ||||||||||
| 7804 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || | ||||||||||
| 7805 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half || | ||||||||||
| 7806 | BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BFloat16; | ||||||||||
| 7807 | } | ||||||||||
| 7808 | |||||||||||
| 7809 | static bool verifyValidIntegerConstantExpr(Sema &S, const ParsedAttr &Attr, | ||||||||||
| 7810 | llvm::APSInt &Result) { | ||||||||||
| 7811 | const auto *AttrExpr = Attr.getArgAsExpr(0); | ||||||||||
| 7812 | if (!AttrExpr->isTypeDependent() && !AttrExpr->isValueDependent()) { | ||||||||||
| 7813 | if (Optional<llvm::APSInt> Res = | ||||||||||
| 7814 | AttrExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(S.Context)) { | ||||||||||
| 7815 | Result = *Res; | ||||||||||
| 7816 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 7817 | } | ||||||||||
| 7818 | } | ||||||||||
| 7819 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_argument_type) | ||||||||||
| 7820 | << Attr << AANT_ArgumentIntegerConstant << AttrExpr->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 7821 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7822 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 7823 | } | ||||||||||
| 7824 | |||||||||||
| 7825 | /// HandleNeonVectorTypeAttr - The "neon_vector_type" and | ||||||||||
| 7826 | /// "neon_polyvector_type" attributes are used to create vector types that | ||||||||||
| 7827 | /// are mangled according to ARM's ABI. Otherwise, these types are identical | ||||||||||
| 7828 | /// to those created with the "vector_size" attribute. Unlike "vector_size" | ||||||||||
| 7829 | /// the argument to these Neon attributes is the number of vector elements, | ||||||||||
| 7830 | /// not the vector size in bytes. The vector width and element type must | ||||||||||
| 7831 | /// match one of the standard Neon vector types. | ||||||||||
| 7832 | static void HandleNeonVectorTypeAttr(QualType &CurType, const ParsedAttr &Attr, | ||||||||||
| 7833 | Sema &S, VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) { | ||||||||||
| 7834 | // Target must have NEON (or MVE, whose vectors are similar enough | ||||||||||
| 7835 | // not to need a separate attribute) | ||||||||||
| 7836 | if (!S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFeature("neon") && | ||||||||||
| 7837 | !S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFeature("mve")) { | ||||||||||
| 7838 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_unsupported) | ||||||||||
| 7839 | << Attr << "'neon' or 'mve'"; | ||||||||||
| 7840 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7841 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7842 | } | ||||||||||
| 7843 | // Check the attribute arguments. | ||||||||||
| 7844 | if (Attr.getNumArgs() != 1) { | ||||||||||
| 7845 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_wrong_number_arguments) << Attr | ||||||||||
| 7846 | << 1; | ||||||||||
| 7847 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7848 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7849 | } | ||||||||||
| 7850 | // The number of elements must be an ICE. | ||||||||||
| 7851 | llvm::APSInt numEltsInt(32); | ||||||||||
| 7852 | if (!verifyValidIntegerConstantExpr(S, Attr, numEltsInt)) | ||||||||||
| 7853 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7854 | |||||||||||
| 7855 | // Only certain element types are supported for Neon vectors. | ||||||||||
| 7856 | if (!isPermittedNeonBaseType(CurType, VecKind, S)) { | ||||||||||
| 7857 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_invalid_vector_type) << CurType; | ||||||||||
| 7858 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7859 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7860 | } | ||||||||||
| 7861 | |||||||||||
| 7862 | // The total size of the vector must be 64 or 128 bits. | ||||||||||
| 7863 | unsigned typeSize = static_cast<unsigned>(S.Context.getTypeSize(CurType)); | ||||||||||
| 7864 | unsigned numElts = static_cast<unsigned>(numEltsInt.getZExtValue()); | ||||||||||
| 7865 | unsigned vecSize = typeSize * numElts; | ||||||||||
| 7866 | if (vecSize != 64 && vecSize != 128) { | ||||||||||
| 7867 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_bad_neon_vector_size) << CurType; | ||||||||||
| 7868 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7869 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7870 | } | ||||||||||
| 7871 | |||||||||||
| 7872 | CurType = S.Context.getVectorType(CurType, numElts, VecKind); | ||||||||||
| 7873 | } | ||||||||||
| 7874 | |||||||||||
| 7875 | /// HandleArmSveVectorBitsTypeAttr - The "arm_sve_vector_bits" attribute is | ||||||||||
| 7876 | /// used to create fixed-length versions of sizeless SVE types defined by | ||||||||||
| 7877 | /// the ACLE, such as svint32_t and svbool_t. | ||||||||||
| 7878 | static void HandleArmSveVectorBitsTypeAttr(QualType &CurType, ParsedAttr &Attr, | ||||||||||
| 7879 | Sema &S) { | ||||||||||
| 7880 | // Target must have SVE. | ||||||||||
| 7881 | if (!S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFeature("sve")) { | ||||||||||
| 7882 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_unsupported) << Attr << "'sve'"; | ||||||||||
| 7883 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7884 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7885 | } | ||||||||||
| 7886 | |||||||||||
| 7887 | // Attribute is unsupported if '-msve-vector-bits=<bits>' isn't specified. | ||||||||||
| 7888 | if (!S.getLangOpts().ArmSveVectorBits) { | ||||||||||
| 7889 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_arm_feature_sve_bits_unsupported) | ||||||||||
| 7890 | << Attr; | ||||||||||
| 7891 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7892 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7893 | } | ||||||||||
| 7894 | |||||||||||
| 7895 | // Check the attribute arguments. | ||||||||||
| 7896 | if (Attr.getNumArgs() != 1) { | ||||||||||
| 7897 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_wrong_number_arguments) | ||||||||||
| 7898 | << Attr << 1; | ||||||||||
| 7899 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7900 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7901 | } | ||||||||||
| 7902 | |||||||||||
| 7903 | // The vector size must be an integer constant expression. | ||||||||||
| 7904 | llvm::APSInt SveVectorSizeInBits(32); | ||||||||||
| 7905 | if (!verifyValidIntegerConstantExpr(S, Attr, SveVectorSizeInBits)) | ||||||||||
| 7906 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7907 | |||||||||||
| 7908 | unsigned VecSize = static_cast<unsigned>(SveVectorSizeInBits.getZExtValue()); | ||||||||||
| 7909 | |||||||||||
| 7910 | // The attribute vector size must match -msve-vector-bits. | ||||||||||
| 7911 | if (VecSize != S.getLangOpts().ArmSveVectorBits) { | ||||||||||
| 7912 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_bad_sve_vector_size) | ||||||||||
| 7913 | << VecSize << S.getLangOpts().ArmSveVectorBits; | ||||||||||
| 7914 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7915 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7916 | } | ||||||||||
| 7917 | |||||||||||
| 7918 | // Attribute can only be attached to a single SVE vector or predicate type. | ||||||||||
| 7919 | if (!CurType->isVLSTBuiltinType()) { | ||||||||||
| 7920 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_invalid_sve_type) | ||||||||||
| 7921 | << Attr << CurType; | ||||||||||
| 7922 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7923 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7924 | } | ||||||||||
| 7925 | |||||||||||
| 7926 | const auto *BT = CurType->castAs<BuiltinType>(); | ||||||||||
| 7927 | |||||||||||
| 7928 | QualType EltType = CurType->getSveEltType(S.Context); | ||||||||||
| 7929 | unsigned TypeSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(EltType); | ||||||||||
| 7930 | VectorType::VectorKind VecKind = VectorType::SveFixedLengthDataVector; | ||||||||||
| 7931 | if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::SveBool) { | ||||||||||
| 7932 | // Predicates are represented as i8. | ||||||||||
| 7933 | VecSize /= S.Context.getCharWidth() * S.Context.getCharWidth(); | ||||||||||
| 7934 | VecKind = VectorType::SveFixedLengthPredicateVector; | ||||||||||
| 7935 | } else | ||||||||||
| 7936 | VecSize /= TypeSize; | ||||||||||
| 7937 | CurType = S.Context.getVectorType(EltType, VecSize, VecKind); | ||||||||||
| 7938 | } | ||||||||||
| 7939 | |||||||||||
| 7940 | static void HandleArmMveStrictPolymorphismAttr(TypeProcessingState &State, | ||||||||||
| 7941 | QualType &CurType, | ||||||||||
| 7942 | ParsedAttr &Attr) { | ||||||||||
| 7943 | const VectorType *VT = dyn_cast<VectorType>(CurType); | ||||||||||
| 7944 | if (!VT || VT->getVectorKind() != VectorType::NeonVector) { | ||||||||||
| 7945 | State.getSema().Diag(Attr.getLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 7946 | diag::err_attribute_arm_mve_polymorphism); | ||||||||||
| 7947 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7948 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7949 | } | ||||||||||
| 7950 | |||||||||||
| 7951 | CurType = | ||||||||||
| 7952 | State.getAttributedType(createSimpleAttr<ArmMveStrictPolymorphismAttr>( | ||||||||||
| 7953 | State.getSema().Context, Attr), | ||||||||||
| 7954 | CurType, CurType); | ||||||||||
| 7955 | } | ||||||||||
| 7956 | |||||||||||
| 7957 | /// Handle OpenCL Access Qualifier Attribute. | ||||||||||
| 7958 | static void HandleOpenCLAccessAttr(QualType &CurType, const ParsedAttr &Attr, | ||||||||||
| 7959 | Sema &S) { | ||||||||||
| 7960 | // OpenCL v2.0 s6.6 - Access qualifier can be used only for image and pipe type. | ||||||||||
| 7961 | if (!(CurType->isImageType() || CurType->isPipeType())) { | ||||||||||
| 7962 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_access_qualifier); | ||||||||||
| 7963 | Attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 7964 | return; | ||||||||||
| 7965 | } | ||||||||||
| 7966 | |||||||||||
| 7967 | if (const TypedefType* TypedefTy = CurType->getAs<TypedefType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 7968 | QualType BaseTy = TypedefTy->desugar(); | ||||||||||
| 7969 | |||||||||||
| 7970 | std::string PrevAccessQual; | ||||||||||
| 7971 | if (BaseTy->isPipeType()) { | ||||||||||
| 7972 | if (TypedefTy->getDecl()->hasAttr<OpenCLAccessAttr>()) { | ||||||||||
| 7973 | OpenCLAccessAttr *Attr = | ||||||||||
| 7974 | TypedefTy->getDecl()->getAttr<OpenCLAccessAttr>(); | ||||||||||
| 7975 | PrevAccessQual = Attr->getSpelling(); | ||||||||||
| 7976 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 7977 | PrevAccessQual = "read_only"; | ||||||||||
| 7978 | } | ||||||||||
| 7979 | } else if (const BuiltinType* ImgType = BaseTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 7980 | |||||||||||
| 7981 | switch (ImgType->getKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 7982 | #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ | ||||||||||
| 7983 | case BuiltinType::Id: \ | ||||||||||
| 7984 | PrevAccessQual = #Access; \ | ||||||||||
| 7985 | break; | ||||||||||
| 7986 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" | ||||||||||
| 7987 | default: | ||||||||||
| 7988 | llvm_unreachable("Unable to find corresponding image type.")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 7989 | } | ||||||||||
| 7990 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 7991 | llvm_unreachable("unexpected type")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 7992 | } | ||||||||||
| 7993 | StringRef AttrName = Attr.getAttrName()->getName(); | ||||||||||
| 7994 | if (PrevAccessQual == AttrName.ltrim("_")) { | ||||||||||
| 7995 | // Duplicated qualifiers | ||||||||||
| 7996 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::warn_duplicate_declspec) | ||||||||||
| 7997 | << AttrName << Attr.getRange(); | ||||||||||
| 7998 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 7999 | // Contradicting qualifiers | ||||||||||
| 8000 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_opencl_multiple_access_qualifiers); | ||||||||||
| 8001 | } | ||||||||||
| 8002 | |||||||||||
| 8003 | S.Diag(TypedefTy->getDecl()->getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 8004 | diag::note_opencl_typedef_access_qualifier) << PrevAccessQual; | ||||||||||
| 8005 | } else if (CurType->isPipeType()) { | ||||||||||
| 8006 | if (Attr.getSemanticSpelling() == OpenCLAccessAttr::Keyword_write_only) { | ||||||||||
| 8007 | QualType ElemType = CurType->castAs<PipeType>()->getElementType(); | ||||||||||
| 8008 | CurType = S.Context.getWritePipeType(ElemType); | ||||||||||
| 8009 | } | ||||||||||
| 8010 | } | ||||||||||
| 8011 | } | ||||||||||
| 8012 | |||||||||||
| 8013 | /// HandleMatrixTypeAttr - "matrix_type" attribute, like ext_vector_type | ||||||||||
| 8014 | static void HandleMatrixTypeAttr(QualType &CurType, const ParsedAttr &Attr, | ||||||||||
| 8015 | Sema &S) { | ||||||||||
| 8016 | if (!S.getLangOpts().MatrixTypes) { | ||||||||||
| 8017 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_builtin_matrix_disabled); | ||||||||||
| 8018 | return; | ||||||||||
| 8019 | } | ||||||||||
| 8020 | |||||||||||
| 8021 | if (Attr.getNumArgs() != 2) { | ||||||||||
| 8022 | S.Diag(Attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_wrong_number_arguments) | ||||||||||
| 8023 | << Attr << 2; | ||||||||||
| 8024 | return; | ||||||||||
| 8025 | } | ||||||||||
| 8026 | |||||||||||
| 8027 | Expr *RowsExpr = Attr.getArgAsExpr(0); | ||||||||||
| 8028 | Expr *ColsExpr = Attr.getArgAsExpr(1); | ||||||||||
| 8029 | QualType T = S.BuildMatrixType(CurType, RowsExpr, ColsExpr, Attr.getLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 8030 | if (!T.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 8031 | CurType = T; | ||||||||||
| 8032 | } | ||||||||||
| 8033 | |||||||||||
| 8034 | static void HandleLifetimeBoundAttr(TypeProcessingState &State, | ||||||||||
| 8035 | QualType &CurType, | ||||||||||
| 8036 | ParsedAttr &Attr) { | ||||||||||
| 8037 | if (State.getDeclarator().isDeclarationOfFunction()) { | ||||||||||
| 8038 | CurType = State.getAttributedType( | ||||||||||
| 8039 | createSimpleAttr<LifetimeBoundAttr>(State.getSema().Context, Attr), | ||||||||||
| 8040 | CurType, CurType); | ||||||||||
| 8041 | } | ||||||||||
| 8042 | } | ||||||||||
| 8043 | |||||||||||
| 8044 | static bool isAddressSpaceKind(const ParsedAttr &attr) { | ||||||||||
| 8045 | auto attrKind = attr.getKind(); | ||||||||||
| 8046 | |||||||||||
| 8047 | return attrKind == ParsedAttr::AT_AddressSpace || | ||||||||||
| 8048 | attrKind == ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLPrivateAddressSpace || | ||||||||||
| 8049 | attrKind == ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLGlobalAddressSpace || | ||||||||||
| 8050 | attrKind == ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLGlobalDeviceAddressSpace || | ||||||||||
| 8051 | attrKind == ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLGlobalHostAddressSpace || | ||||||||||
| 8052 | attrKind == ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLLocalAddressSpace || | ||||||||||
| 8053 | attrKind == ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLConstantAddressSpace || | ||||||||||
| 8054 | attrKind == ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLGenericAddressSpace; | ||||||||||
| 8055 | } | ||||||||||
| 8056 | |||||||||||
| 8057 | static void processTypeAttrs(TypeProcessingState &state, QualType &type, | ||||||||||
| 8058 | TypeAttrLocation TAL, | ||||||||||
| 8059 | ParsedAttributesView &attrs) { | ||||||||||
| 8060 | // Scan through and apply attributes to this type where it makes sense. Some | ||||||||||
| 8061 | // attributes (such as __address_space__, __vector_size__, etc) apply to the | ||||||||||
| 8062 | // type, but others can be present in the type specifiers even though they | ||||||||||
| 8063 | // apply to the decl. Here we apply type attributes and ignore the rest. | ||||||||||
| 8064 | |||||||||||
| 8065 | // This loop modifies the list pretty frequently, but we still need to make | ||||||||||
| 8066 | // sure we visit every element once. Copy the attributes list, and iterate | ||||||||||
| 8067 | // over that. | ||||||||||
| 8068 | ParsedAttributesView AttrsCopy{attrs}; | ||||||||||
| 8069 | |||||||||||
| 8070 | state.setParsedNoDeref(false); | ||||||||||
| 8071 | |||||||||||
| 8072 | for (ParsedAttr &attr : AttrsCopy) { | ||||||||||
| 8073 | |||||||||||
| 8074 | // Skip attributes that were marked to be invalid. | ||||||||||
| 8075 | if (attr.isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 8076 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 8077 | |||||||||||
| 8078 | if (attr.isStandardAttributeSyntax()) { | ||||||||||
| 8079 | // [[gnu::...]] attributes are treated as declaration attributes, so may | ||||||||||
| 8080 | // not appertain to a DeclaratorChunk. If we handle them as type | ||||||||||
| 8081 | // attributes, accept them in that position and diagnose the GCC | ||||||||||
| 8082 | // incompatibility. | ||||||||||
| 8083 | if (attr.isGNUScope()) { | ||||||||||
| 8084 | bool IsTypeAttr = attr.isTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8085 | if (TAL == TAL_DeclChunk) { | ||||||||||
| 8086 | state.getSema().Diag(attr.getLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 8087 | IsTypeAttr | ||||||||||
| 8088 | ? diag::warn_gcc_ignores_type_attr | ||||||||||
| 8089 | : diag::warn_cxx11_gnu_attribute_on_type) | ||||||||||
| 8090 | << attr; | ||||||||||
| 8091 | if (!IsTypeAttr) | ||||||||||
| 8092 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 8093 | } | ||||||||||
| 8094 | } else if (TAL != TAL_DeclChunk && !isAddressSpaceKind(attr)) { | ||||||||||
| 8095 | // Otherwise, only consider type processing for a C++11 attribute if | ||||||||||
| 8096 | // it's actually been applied to a type. | ||||||||||
| 8097 | // We also allow C++11 address_space and | ||||||||||
| 8098 | // OpenCL language address space attributes to pass through. | ||||||||||
| 8099 | continue; | ||||||||||
| 8100 | } | ||||||||||
| 8101 | } | ||||||||||
| 8102 | |||||||||||
| 8103 | // If this is an attribute we can handle, do so now, | ||||||||||
| 8104 | // otherwise, add it to the FnAttrs list for rechaining. | ||||||||||
| 8105 | switch (attr.getKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 8106 | default: | ||||||||||
| 8107 | // A [[]] attribute on a declarator chunk must appertain to a type. | ||||||||||
| 8108 | if (attr.isStandardAttributeSyntax() && TAL == TAL_DeclChunk) { | ||||||||||
| 8109 | state.getSema().Diag(attr.getLoc(), diag::err_attribute_not_type_attr) | ||||||||||
| 8110 | << attr; | ||||||||||
| 8111 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8112 | } | ||||||||||
| 8113 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8114 | |||||||||||
| 8115 | case ParsedAttr::UnknownAttribute: | ||||||||||
| 8116 | if (attr.isStandardAttributeSyntax() && TAL == TAL_DeclChunk) | ||||||||||
| 8117 | state.getSema().Diag(attr.getLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 8118 | diag::warn_unknown_attribute_ignored) | ||||||||||
| 8119 | << attr << attr.getRange(); | ||||||||||
| 8120 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8121 | |||||||||||
| 8122 | case ParsedAttr::IgnoredAttribute: | ||||||||||
| 8123 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8124 | |||||||||||
| 8125 | case ParsedAttr::AT_MayAlias: | ||||||||||
| 8126 | // FIXME: This attribute needs to actually be handled, but if we ignore | ||||||||||
| 8127 | // it it breaks large amounts of Linux software. | ||||||||||
| 8128 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8129 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8130 | case ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLPrivateAddressSpace: | ||||||||||
| 8131 | case ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLGlobalAddressSpace: | ||||||||||
| 8132 | case ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLGlobalDeviceAddressSpace: | ||||||||||
| 8133 | case ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLGlobalHostAddressSpace: | ||||||||||
| 8134 | case ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLLocalAddressSpace: | ||||||||||
| 8135 | case ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLConstantAddressSpace: | ||||||||||
| 8136 | case ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLGenericAddressSpace: | ||||||||||
| 8137 | case ParsedAttr::AT_AddressSpace: | ||||||||||
| 8138 | HandleAddressSpaceTypeAttribute(type, attr, state); | ||||||||||
| 8139 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8140 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8141 | OBJC_POINTER_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCGC: case ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership: | ||||||||||
| 8142 | if (!handleObjCPointerTypeAttr(state, attr, type)) | ||||||||||
| 8143 | distributeObjCPointerTypeAttr(state, attr, type); | ||||||||||
| 8144 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8145 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8146 | case ParsedAttr::AT_VectorSize: | ||||||||||
| 8147 | HandleVectorSizeAttr(type, attr, state.getSema()); | ||||||||||
| 8148 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8149 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8150 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ExtVectorType: | ||||||||||
| 8151 | HandleExtVectorTypeAttr(type, attr, state.getSema()); | ||||||||||
| 8152 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8153 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8154 | case ParsedAttr::AT_NeonVectorType: | ||||||||||
| 8155 | HandleNeonVectorTypeAttr(type, attr, state.getSema(), | ||||||||||
| 8156 | VectorType::NeonVector); | ||||||||||
| 8157 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8158 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8159 | case ParsedAttr::AT_NeonPolyVectorType: | ||||||||||
| 8160 | HandleNeonVectorTypeAttr(type, attr, state.getSema(), | ||||||||||
| 8161 | VectorType::NeonPolyVector); | ||||||||||
| 8162 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8163 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8164 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ArmSveVectorBits: | ||||||||||
| 8165 | HandleArmSveVectorBitsTypeAttr(type, attr, state.getSema()); | ||||||||||
| 8166 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8167 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8168 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ArmMveStrictPolymorphism: { | ||||||||||
| 8169 | HandleArmMveStrictPolymorphismAttr(state, type, attr); | ||||||||||
| 8170 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8171 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8172 | } | ||||||||||
| 8173 | case ParsedAttr::AT_OpenCLAccess: | ||||||||||
| 8174 | HandleOpenCLAccessAttr(type, attr, state.getSema()); | ||||||||||
| 8175 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8176 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8177 | case ParsedAttr::AT_LifetimeBound: | ||||||||||
| 8178 | if (TAL == TAL_DeclChunk) | ||||||||||
| 8179 | HandleLifetimeBoundAttr(state, type, attr); | ||||||||||
| 8180 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8181 | |||||||||||
| 8182 | case ParsedAttr::AT_NoDeref: { | ||||||||||
| 8183 | ASTContext &Ctx = state.getSema().Context; | ||||||||||
| 8184 | type = state.getAttributedType(createSimpleAttr<NoDerefAttr>(Ctx, attr), | ||||||||||
| 8185 | type, type); | ||||||||||
| 8186 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8187 | state.setParsedNoDeref(true); | ||||||||||
| 8188 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8189 | } | ||||||||||
| 8190 | |||||||||||
| 8191 | case ParsedAttr::AT_MatrixType: | ||||||||||
| 8192 | HandleMatrixTypeAttr(type, attr, state.getSema()); | ||||||||||
| 8193 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8194 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8195 | |||||||||||
| 8196 | MS_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_Ptr32: case ParsedAttr::AT_Ptr64: case ParsedAttr ::AT_SPtr: case ParsedAttr::AT_UPtr: | ||||||||||
| 8197 | if (!handleMSPointerTypeQualifierAttr(state, attr, type)) | ||||||||||
| 8198 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8199 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8200 | |||||||||||
| 8201 | |||||||||||
| 8202 | NULLABILITY_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNonNull: case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullable : case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullableResult: case ParsedAttr::AT_TypeNullUnspecified: | ||||||||||
| 8203 | // Either add nullability here or try to distribute it. We | ||||||||||
| 8204 | // don't want to distribute the nullability specifier past any | ||||||||||
| 8205 | // dependent type, because that complicates the user model. | ||||||||||
| 8206 | if (type->canHaveNullability() || type->isDependentType() || | ||||||||||
| 8207 | type->isArrayType() || | ||||||||||
| 8208 | !distributeNullabilityTypeAttr(state, type, attr)) { | ||||||||||
| 8209 | unsigned endIndex; | ||||||||||
| 8210 | if (TAL == TAL_DeclChunk) | ||||||||||
| 8211 | endIndex = state.getCurrentChunkIndex(); | ||||||||||
| 8212 | else | ||||||||||
| 8213 | endIndex = state.getDeclarator().getNumTypeObjects(); | ||||||||||
| 8214 | bool allowOnArrayType = | ||||||||||
| 8215 | state.getDeclarator().isPrototypeContext() && | ||||||||||
| 8216 | !hasOuterPointerLikeChunk(state.getDeclarator(), endIndex); | ||||||||||
| 8217 | if (checkNullabilityTypeSpecifier( | ||||||||||
| 8218 | state, | ||||||||||
| 8219 | type, | ||||||||||
| 8220 | attr, | ||||||||||
| 8221 | allowOnArrayType)) { | ||||||||||
| 8222 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 8223 | } | ||||||||||
| 8224 | |||||||||||
| 8225 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8226 | } | ||||||||||
| 8227 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8228 | |||||||||||
| 8229 | case ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCKindOf: | ||||||||||
| 8230 | // '__kindof' must be part of the decl-specifiers. | ||||||||||
| 8231 | switch (TAL) { | ||||||||||
| 8232 | case TAL_DeclSpec: | ||||||||||
| 8233 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8234 | |||||||||||
| 8235 | case TAL_DeclChunk: | ||||||||||
| 8236 | case TAL_DeclName: | ||||||||||
| 8237 | state.getSema().Diag(attr.getLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 8238 | diag::err_objc_kindof_wrong_position) | ||||||||||
| 8239 | << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(attr.getLoc()) | ||||||||||
| 8240 | << FixItHint::CreateInsertion( | ||||||||||
| 8241 | state.getDeclarator().getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 8242 | "__kindof "); | ||||||||||
| 8243 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8244 | } | ||||||||||
| 8245 | |||||||||||
| 8246 | // Apply it regardless. | ||||||||||
| 8247 | if (checkObjCKindOfType(state, type, attr)) | ||||||||||
| 8248 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 8249 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8250 | |||||||||||
| 8251 | case ParsedAttr::AT_NoThrow: | ||||||||||
| 8252 | // Exception Specifications aren't generally supported in C mode throughout | ||||||||||
| 8253 | // clang, so revert to attribute-based handling for C. | ||||||||||
| 8254 | if (!state.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) | ||||||||||
| 8255 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8256 | LLVM_FALLTHROUGH[[gnu::fallthrough]]; | ||||||||||
| 8257 | FUNCTION_TYPE_ATTRS_CASELISTcase ParsedAttr::AT_NSReturnsRetained: case ParsedAttr::AT_NoReturn : case ParsedAttr::AT_Regparm: case ParsedAttr::AT_CmseNSCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegisters: case ParsedAttr ::AT_AnyX86NoCfCheck: case ParsedAttr::AT_CDecl: case ParsedAttr ::AT_FastCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_StdCall: case ParsedAttr:: AT_ThisCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_RegCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pascal : case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_SwiftAsyncCall : case ParsedAttr::AT_VectorCall: case ParsedAttr::AT_AArch64VectorPcs : case ParsedAttr::AT_MSABI: case ParsedAttr::AT_SysVABI: case ParsedAttr::AT_Pcs: case ParsedAttr::AT_IntelOclBicc: case ParsedAttr ::AT_PreserveMost: case ParsedAttr::AT_PreserveAll: | ||||||||||
| 8258 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8259 | |||||||||||
| 8260 | // Never process function type attributes as part of the | ||||||||||
| 8261 | // declaration-specifiers. | ||||||||||
| 8262 | if (TAL == TAL_DeclSpec) | ||||||||||
| 8263 | distributeFunctionTypeAttrFromDeclSpec(state, attr, type); | ||||||||||
| 8264 | |||||||||||
| 8265 | // Otherwise, handle the possible delays. | ||||||||||
| 8266 | else if (!handleFunctionTypeAttr(state, attr, type)) | ||||||||||
| 8267 | distributeFunctionTypeAttr(state, attr, type); | ||||||||||
| 8268 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8269 | case ParsedAttr::AT_AcquireHandle: { | ||||||||||
| 8270 | if (!type->isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 8271 | return; | ||||||||||
| 8272 | |||||||||||
| 8273 | if (attr.getNumArgs() != 1) { | ||||||||||
| 8274 | state.getSema().Diag(attr.getLoc(), | ||||||||||
| 8275 | diag::err_attribute_wrong_number_arguments) | ||||||||||
| 8276 | << attr << 1; | ||||||||||
| 8277 | attr.setInvalid(); | ||||||||||
| 8278 | return; | ||||||||||
| 8279 | } | ||||||||||
| 8280 | |||||||||||
| 8281 | StringRef HandleType; | ||||||||||
| 8282 | if (!state.getSema().checkStringLiteralArgumentAttr(attr, 0, HandleType)) | ||||||||||
| 8283 | return; | ||||||||||
| 8284 | type = state.getAttributedType( | ||||||||||
| 8285 | AcquireHandleAttr::Create(state.getSema().Context, HandleType, attr), | ||||||||||
| 8286 | type, type); | ||||||||||
| 8287 | attr.setUsedAsTypeAttr(); | ||||||||||
| 8288 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8289 | } | ||||||||||
| 8290 | } | ||||||||||
| 8291 | |||||||||||
| 8292 | // Handle attributes that are defined in a macro. We do not want this to be | ||||||||||
| 8293 | // applied to ObjC builtin attributes. | ||||||||||
| 8294 | if (isa<AttributedType>(type) && attr.hasMacroIdentifier() && | ||||||||||
| 8295 | !type.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime() && | ||||||||||
| 8296 | !type.getQualifiers().hasObjCGCAttr() && | ||||||||||
| 8297 | attr.getKind() != ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCGC && | ||||||||||
| 8298 | attr.getKind() != ParsedAttr::AT_ObjCOwnership) { | ||||||||||
| 8299 | const IdentifierInfo *MacroII = attr.getMacroIdentifier(); | ||||||||||
| 8300 | type = state.getSema().Context.getMacroQualifiedType(type, MacroII); | ||||||||||
| 8301 | state.setExpansionLocForMacroQualifiedType( | ||||||||||
| 8302 | cast<MacroQualifiedType>(type.getTypePtr()), | ||||||||||
| 8303 | attr.getMacroExpansionLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 8304 | } | ||||||||||
| 8305 | } | ||||||||||
| 8306 | |||||||||||
| 8307 | if (!state.getSema().getLangOpts().OpenCL || | ||||||||||
| 8308 | type.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) | ||||||||||
| 8309 | return; | ||||||||||
| 8310 | } | ||||||||||
| 8311 | |||||||||||
| 8312 | void Sema::completeExprArrayBound(Expr *E) { | ||||||||||
| 8313 | if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) { | ||||||||||
| 8314 | if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) { | ||||||||||
| 8315 | if (isTemplateInstantiation(Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind())) { | ||||||||||
| 8316 | auto *Def = Var->getDefinition(); | ||||||||||
| 8317 | if (!Def) { | ||||||||||
| 8318 | SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = E->getExprLoc(); | ||||||||||
| 8319 | runWithSufficientStackSpace(PointOfInstantiation, [&] { | ||||||||||
| 8320 | InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var); | ||||||||||
| 8321 | }); | ||||||||||
| 8322 | Def = Var->getDefinition(); | ||||||||||
| 8323 | |||||||||||
| 8324 | // If we don't already have a point of instantiation, and we managed | ||||||||||
| 8325 | // to instantiate a definition, this is the point of instantiation. | ||||||||||
| 8326 | // Otherwise, we don't request an end-of-TU instantiation, so this is | ||||||||||
| 8327 | // not a point of instantiation. | ||||||||||
| 8328 | // FIXME: Is this really the right behavior? | ||||||||||
| 8329 | if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() && Def) { | ||||||||||
| 8330 | assert(Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind() ==((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 8331 | TSK_ImplicitInstantiation &&((void)0) | ||||||||||
| 8332 | "explicit instantiation with no point of instantiation")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 8333 | Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind( | ||||||||||
| 8334 | Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind(), PointOfInstantiation); | ||||||||||
| 8335 | } | ||||||||||
| 8336 | } | ||||||||||
| 8337 | |||||||||||
| 8338 | // Update the type to the definition's type both here and within the | ||||||||||
| 8339 | // expression. | ||||||||||
| 8340 | if (Def) { | ||||||||||
| 8341 | DRE->setDecl(Def); | ||||||||||
| 8342 | QualType T = Def->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 8343 | DRE->setType(T); | ||||||||||
| 8344 | // FIXME: Update the type on all intervening expressions. | ||||||||||
| 8345 | E->setType(T); | ||||||||||
| 8346 | } | ||||||||||
| 8347 | |||||||||||
| 8348 | // We still go on to try to complete the type independently, as it | ||||||||||
| 8349 | // may also require instantiations or diagnostics if it remains | ||||||||||
| 8350 | // incomplete. | ||||||||||
| 8351 | } | ||||||||||
| 8352 | } | ||||||||||
| 8353 | } | ||||||||||
| 8354 | } | ||||||||||
| 8355 | |||||||||||
| 8356 | QualType Sema::getCompletedType(Expr *E) { | ||||||||||
| 8357 | // Incomplete array types may be completed by the initializer attached to | ||||||||||
| 8358 | // their definitions. For static data members of class templates and for | ||||||||||
| 8359 | // variable templates, we need to instantiate the definition to get this | ||||||||||
| 8360 | // initializer and complete the type. | ||||||||||
| 8361 | if (E->getType()->isIncompleteArrayType()) | ||||||||||
| 8362 | completeExprArrayBound(E); | ||||||||||
| 8363 | |||||||||||
| 8364 | // FIXME: Are there other cases which require instantiating something other | ||||||||||
| 8365 | // than the type to complete the type of an expression? | ||||||||||
| 8366 | |||||||||||
| 8367 | return E->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 8368 | } | ||||||||||
| 8369 | |||||||||||
| 8370 | /// Ensure that the type of the given expression is complete. | ||||||||||
| 8371 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8372 | /// This routine checks whether the expression \p E has a complete type. If the | ||||||||||
| 8373 | /// expression refers to an instantiable construct, that instantiation is | ||||||||||
| 8374 | /// performed as needed to complete its type. Furthermore | ||||||||||
| 8375 | /// Sema::RequireCompleteType is called for the expression's type (or in the | ||||||||||
| 8376 | /// case of a reference type, the referred-to type). | ||||||||||
| 8377 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8378 | /// \param E The expression whose type is required to be complete. | ||||||||||
| 8379 | /// \param Kind Selects which completeness rules should be applied. | ||||||||||
| 8380 | /// \param Diagnoser The object that will emit a diagnostic if the type is | ||||||||||
| 8381 | /// incomplete. | ||||||||||
| 8382 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8383 | /// \returns \c true if the type of \p E is incomplete and diagnosed, \c false | ||||||||||
| 8384 | /// otherwise. | ||||||||||
| 8385 | bool Sema::RequireCompleteExprType(Expr *E, CompleteTypeKind Kind, | ||||||||||
| 8386 | TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser) { | ||||||||||
| 8387 | return RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), getCompletedType(E), Kind, | ||||||||||
| 8388 | Diagnoser); | ||||||||||
| 8389 | } | ||||||||||
| 8390 | |||||||||||
| 8391 | bool Sema::RequireCompleteExprType(Expr *E, unsigned DiagID) { | ||||||||||
| 8392 | BoundTypeDiagnoser<> Diagnoser(DiagID); | ||||||||||
| 8393 | return RequireCompleteExprType(E, CompleteTypeKind::Default, Diagnoser); | ||||||||||
| 8394 | } | ||||||||||
| 8395 | |||||||||||
| 8396 | /// Ensure that the type T is a complete type. | ||||||||||
| 8397 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8398 | /// This routine checks whether the type @p T is complete in any | ||||||||||
| 8399 | /// context where a complete type is required. If @p T is a complete | ||||||||||
| 8400 | /// type, returns false. If @p T is a class template specialization, | ||||||||||
| 8401 | /// this routine then attempts to perform class template | ||||||||||
| 8402 | /// instantiation. If instantiation fails, or if @p T is incomplete | ||||||||||
| 8403 | /// and cannot be completed, issues the diagnostic @p diag (giving it | ||||||||||
| 8404 | /// the type @p T) and returns true. | ||||||||||
| 8405 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8406 | /// @param Loc The location in the source that the incomplete type | ||||||||||
| 8407 | /// diagnostic should refer to. | ||||||||||
| 8408 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8409 | /// @param T The type that this routine is examining for completeness. | ||||||||||
| 8410 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8411 | /// @param Kind Selects which completeness rules should be applied. | ||||||||||
| 8412 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8413 | /// @returns @c true if @p T is incomplete and a diagnostic was emitted, | ||||||||||
| 8414 | /// @c false otherwise. | ||||||||||
| 8415 | bool Sema::RequireCompleteType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, | ||||||||||
| 8416 | CompleteTypeKind Kind, | ||||||||||
| 8417 | TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser) { | ||||||||||
| 8418 | if (RequireCompleteTypeImpl(Loc, T, Kind, &Diagnoser)) | ||||||||||
| 8419 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8420 | if (const TagType *Tag = T->getAs<TagType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 8421 | if (!Tag->getDecl()->isCompleteDefinitionRequired()) { | ||||||||||
| 8422 | Tag->getDecl()->setCompleteDefinitionRequired(); | ||||||||||
| 8423 | Consumer.HandleTagDeclRequiredDefinition(Tag->getDecl()); | ||||||||||
| 8424 | } | ||||||||||
| 8425 | } | ||||||||||
| 8426 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 8427 | } | ||||||||||
| 8428 | |||||||||||
| 8429 | bool Sema::hasStructuralCompatLayout(Decl *D, Decl *Suggested) { | ||||||||||
| 8430 | llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<Decl *, Decl *>> NonEquivalentDecls; | ||||||||||
| 8431 | if (!Suggested) | ||||||||||
| 8432 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 8433 | |||||||||||
| 8434 | // FIXME: Add a specific mode for C11 6.2.7/1 in StructuralEquivalenceContext | ||||||||||
| 8435 | // and isolate from other C++ specific checks. | ||||||||||
| 8436 | StructuralEquivalenceContext Ctx( | ||||||||||
| 8437 | D->getASTContext(), Suggested->getASTContext(), NonEquivalentDecls, | ||||||||||
| 8438 | StructuralEquivalenceKind::Default, | ||||||||||
| 8439 | false /*StrictTypeSpelling*/, true /*Complain*/, | ||||||||||
| 8440 | true /*ErrorOnTagTypeMismatch*/); | ||||||||||
| 8441 | return Ctx.IsEquivalent(D, Suggested); | ||||||||||
| 8442 | } | ||||||||||
| 8443 | |||||||||||
| 8444 | /// Determine whether there is any declaration of \p D that was ever a | ||||||||||
| 8445 | /// definition (perhaps before module merging) and is currently visible. | ||||||||||
| 8446 | /// \param D The definition of the entity. | ||||||||||
| 8447 | /// \param Suggested Filled in with the declaration that should be made visible | ||||||||||
| 8448 | /// in order to provide a definition of this entity. | ||||||||||
| 8449 | /// \param OnlyNeedComplete If \c true, we only need the type to be complete, | ||||||||||
| 8450 | /// not defined. This only matters for enums with a fixed underlying | ||||||||||
| 8451 | /// type, since in all other cases, a type is complete if and only if it | ||||||||||
| 8452 | /// is defined. | ||||||||||
| 8453 | bool Sema::hasVisibleDefinition(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl **Suggested, | ||||||||||
| 8454 | bool OnlyNeedComplete) { | ||||||||||
| 8455 | // Easy case: if we don't have modules, all declarations are visible. | ||||||||||
| 8456 | if (!getLangOpts().Modules && !getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) | ||||||||||
| 8457 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8458 | |||||||||||
| 8459 | // If this definition was instantiated from a template, map back to the | ||||||||||
| 8460 | // pattern from which it was instantiated. | ||||||||||
| 8461 | if (isa<TagDecl>(D) && cast<TagDecl>(D)->isBeingDefined()) { | ||||||||||
| 8462 | // We're in the middle of defining it; this definition should be treated | ||||||||||
| 8463 | // as visible. | ||||||||||
| 8464 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8465 | } else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) { | ||||||||||
| 8466 | if (auto *Pattern = RD->getTemplateInstantiationPattern()) | ||||||||||
| 8467 | RD = Pattern; | ||||||||||
| 8468 | D = RD->getDefinition(); | ||||||||||
| 8469 | } else if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) { | ||||||||||
| 8470 | if (auto *Pattern = ED->getTemplateInstantiationPattern()) | ||||||||||
| 8471 | ED = Pattern; | ||||||||||
| 8472 | if (OnlyNeedComplete && (ED->isFixed() || getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)) { | ||||||||||
| 8473 | // If the enum has a fixed underlying type, it may have been forward | ||||||||||
| 8474 | // declared. In -fms-compatibility, `enum Foo;` will also forward declare | ||||||||||
| 8475 | // the enum and assign it the underlying type of `int`. Since we're only | ||||||||||
| 8476 | // looking for a complete type (not a definition), any visible declaration | ||||||||||
| 8477 | // of it will do. | ||||||||||
| 8478 | *Suggested = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 8479 | for (auto *Redecl : ED->redecls()) { | ||||||||||
| 8480 | if (isVisible(Redecl)) | ||||||||||
| 8481 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8482 | if (Redecl->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || | ||||||||||
| 8483 | (Redecl->isCanonicalDecl() && !*Suggested)) | ||||||||||
| 8484 | *Suggested = Redecl; | ||||||||||
| 8485 | } | ||||||||||
| 8486 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 8487 | } | ||||||||||
| 8488 | D = ED->getDefinition(); | ||||||||||
| 8489 | } else if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { | ||||||||||
| 8490 | if (auto *Pattern = FD->getTemplateInstantiationPattern()) | ||||||||||
| 8491 | FD = Pattern; | ||||||||||
| 8492 | D = FD->getDefinition(); | ||||||||||
| 8493 | } else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { | ||||||||||
| 8494 | if (auto *Pattern = VD->getTemplateInstantiationPattern()) | ||||||||||
| 8495 | VD = Pattern; | ||||||||||
| 8496 | D = VD->getDefinition(); | ||||||||||
| 8497 | } | ||||||||||
| 8498 | assert(D && "missing definition for pattern of instantiated definition")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 8499 | |||||||||||
| 8500 | *Suggested = D; | ||||||||||
| 8501 | |||||||||||
| 8502 | auto DefinitionIsVisible = [&] { | ||||||||||
| 8503 | // The (primary) definition might be in a visible module. | ||||||||||
| 8504 | if (isVisible(D)) | ||||||||||
| 8505 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8506 | |||||||||||
| 8507 | // A visible module might have a merged definition instead. | ||||||||||
| 8508 | if (D->isModulePrivate() ? hasMergedDefinitionInCurrentModule(D) | ||||||||||
| 8509 | : hasVisibleMergedDefinition(D)) { | ||||||||||
| 8510 | if (CodeSynthesisContexts.empty() && | ||||||||||
| 8511 | !getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) { | ||||||||||
| 8512 | // Cache the fact that this definition is implicitly visible because | ||||||||||
| 8513 | // there is a visible merged definition. | ||||||||||
| 8514 | D->setVisibleDespiteOwningModule(); | ||||||||||
| 8515 | } | ||||||||||
| 8516 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8517 | } | ||||||||||
| 8518 | |||||||||||
| 8519 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 8520 | }; | ||||||||||
| 8521 | |||||||||||
| 8522 | if (DefinitionIsVisible()) | ||||||||||
| 8523 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8524 | |||||||||||
| 8525 | // The external source may have additional definitions of this entity that are | ||||||||||
| 8526 | // visible, so complete the redeclaration chain now and ask again. | ||||||||||
| 8527 | if (auto *Source = Context.getExternalSource()) { | ||||||||||
| 8528 | Source->CompleteRedeclChain(D); | ||||||||||
| 8529 | return DefinitionIsVisible(); | ||||||||||
| 8530 | } | ||||||||||
| 8531 | |||||||||||
| 8532 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 8533 | } | ||||||||||
| 8534 | |||||||||||
| 8535 | /// Locks in the inheritance model for the given class and all of its bases. | ||||||||||
| 8536 | static void assignInheritanceModel(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *RD) { | ||||||||||
| 8537 | RD = RD->getMostRecentNonInjectedDecl(); | ||||||||||
| 8538 | if (!RD->hasAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>()) { | ||||||||||
| 8539 | MSInheritanceModel IM; | ||||||||||
| 8540 | bool BestCase = false; | ||||||||||
| 8541 | switch (S.MSPointerToMemberRepresentationMethod) { | ||||||||||
| 8542 | case LangOptions::PPTMK_BestCase: | ||||||||||
| 8543 | BestCase = true; | ||||||||||
| 8544 | IM = RD->calculateInheritanceModel(); | ||||||||||
| 8545 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8546 | case LangOptions::PPTMK_FullGeneralitySingleInheritance: | ||||||||||
| 8547 | IM = MSInheritanceModel::Single; | ||||||||||
| 8548 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8549 | case LangOptions::PPTMK_FullGeneralityMultipleInheritance: | ||||||||||
| 8550 | IM = MSInheritanceModel::Multiple; | ||||||||||
| 8551 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8552 | case LangOptions::PPTMK_FullGeneralityVirtualInheritance: | ||||||||||
| 8553 | IM = MSInheritanceModel::Unspecified; | ||||||||||
| 8554 | break; | ||||||||||
| 8555 | } | ||||||||||
| 8556 | |||||||||||
| 8557 | SourceRange Loc = S.ImplicitMSInheritanceAttrLoc.isValid() | ||||||||||
| 8558 | ? S.ImplicitMSInheritanceAttrLoc | ||||||||||
| 8559 | : RD->getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 8560 | RD->addAttr(MSInheritanceAttr::CreateImplicit( | ||||||||||
| 8561 | S.getASTContext(), BestCase, Loc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Microsoft, | ||||||||||
| 8562 | MSInheritanceAttr::Spelling(IM))); | ||||||||||
| 8563 | S.Consumer.AssignInheritanceModel(RD); | ||||||||||
| 8564 | } | ||||||||||
| 8565 | } | ||||||||||
| 8566 | |||||||||||
| 8567 | /// The implementation of RequireCompleteType | ||||||||||
| 8568 | bool Sema::RequireCompleteTypeImpl(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, | ||||||||||
| 8569 | CompleteTypeKind Kind, | ||||||||||
| 8570 | TypeDiagnoser *Diagnoser) { | ||||||||||
| 8571 | // FIXME: Add this assertion to make sure we always get instantiation points. | ||||||||||
| 8572 | // assert(!Loc.isInvalid() && "Invalid location in RequireCompleteType"); | ||||||||||
| 8573 | // FIXME: Add this assertion to help us flush out problems with | ||||||||||
| 8574 | // checking for dependent types and type-dependent expressions. | ||||||||||
| 8575 | // | ||||||||||
| 8576 | // assert(!T->isDependentType() && | ||||||||||
| 8577 | // "Can't ask whether a dependent type is complete"); | ||||||||||
| 8578 | |||||||||||
| 8579 | if (const MemberPointerType *MPTy = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) { | ||||||||||
| 8580 | if (!MPTy->getClass()->isDependentType()) { | ||||||||||
| 8581 | if (getLangOpts().CompleteMemberPointers && | ||||||||||
| 8582 | !MPTy->getClass()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()->isBeingDefined() && | ||||||||||
| 8583 | RequireCompleteType(Loc, QualType(MPTy->getClass(), 0), Kind, | ||||||||||
| 8584 | diag::err_memptr_incomplete)) | ||||||||||
| 8585 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8586 | |||||||||||
| 8587 | // We lock in the inheritance model once somebody has asked us to ensure | ||||||||||
| 8588 | // that a pointer-to-member type is complete. | ||||||||||
| 8589 | if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { | ||||||||||
| 8590 | (void)isCompleteType(Loc, QualType(MPTy->getClass(), 0)); | ||||||||||
| 8591 | assignInheritanceModel(*this, MPTy->getMostRecentCXXRecordDecl()); | ||||||||||
| 8592 | } | ||||||||||
| 8593 | } | ||||||||||
| 8594 | } | ||||||||||
| 8595 | |||||||||||
| 8596 | NamedDecl *Def = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 8597 | bool AcceptSizeless = (Kind == CompleteTypeKind::AcceptSizeless); | ||||||||||
| 8598 | bool Incomplete = (T->isIncompleteType(&Def) || | ||||||||||
| 8599 | (!AcceptSizeless && T->isSizelessBuiltinType())); | ||||||||||
| 8600 | |||||||||||
| 8601 | // Check that any necessary explicit specializations are visible. For an | ||||||||||
| 8602 | // enum, we just need the declaration, so don't check this. | ||||||||||
| 8603 | if (Def && !isa<EnumDecl>(Def)) | ||||||||||
| 8604 | checkSpecializationVisibility(Loc, Def); | ||||||||||
| 8605 | |||||||||||
| 8606 | // If we have a complete type, we're done. | ||||||||||
| 8607 | if (!Incomplete) { | ||||||||||
| 8608 | // If we know about the definition but it is not visible, complain. | ||||||||||
| 8609 | NamedDecl *SuggestedDef = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 8610 | if (Def && | ||||||||||
| 8611 | !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &SuggestedDef, /*OnlyNeedComplete*/true)) { | ||||||||||
| 8612 | // If the user is going to see an error here, recover by making the | ||||||||||
| 8613 | // definition visible. | ||||||||||
| 8614 | bool TreatAsComplete = Diagnoser && !isSFINAEContext(); | ||||||||||
| 8615 | if (Diagnoser && SuggestedDef) | ||||||||||
| 8616 | diagnoseMissingImport(Loc, SuggestedDef, MissingImportKind::Definition, | ||||||||||
| 8617 | /*Recover*/TreatAsComplete); | ||||||||||
| 8618 | return !TreatAsComplete; | ||||||||||
| 8619 | } else if (Def && !TemplateInstCallbacks.empty()) { | ||||||||||
| 8620 | CodeSynthesisContext TempInst; | ||||||||||
| 8621 | TempInst.Kind = CodeSynthesisContext::Memoization; | ||||||||||
| 8622 | TempInst.Template = Def; | ||||||||||
| 8623 | TempInst.Entity = Def; | ||||||||||
| 8624 | TempInst.PointOfInstantiation = Loc; | ||||||||||
| 8625 | atTemplateBegin(TemplateInstCallbacks, *this, TempInst); | ||||||||||
| 8626 | atTemplateEnd(TemplateInstCallbacks, *this, TempInst); | ||||||||||
| 8627 | } | ||||||||||
| 8628 | |||||||||||
| 8629 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 8630 | } | ||||||||||
| 8631 | |||||||||||
| 8632 | TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(Def); | ||||||||||
| 8633 | ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(Def); | ||||||||||
| 8634 | |||||||||||
| 8635 | // Give the external source a chance to provide a definition of the type. | ||||||||||
| 8636 | // This is kept separate from completing the redeclaration chain so that | ||||||||||
| 8637 | // external sources such as LLDB can avoid synthesizing a type definition | ||||||||||
| 8638 | // unless it's actually needed. | ||||||||||
| 8639 | if (Tag || IFace) { | ||||||||||
| 8640 | // Avoid diagnosing invalid decls as incomplete. | ||||||||||
| 8641 | if (Def->isInvalidDecl()) | ||||||||||
| 8642 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8643 | |||||||||||
| 8644 | // Give the external AST source a chance to complete the type. | ||||||||||
| 8645 | if (auto *Source = Context.getExternalSource()) { | ||||||||||
| 8646 | if (Tag && Tag->hasExternalLexicalStorage()) | ||||||||||
| 8647 | Source->CompleteType(Tag); | ||||||||||
| 8648 | if (IFace && IFace->hasExternalLexicalStorage()) | ||||||||||
| 8649 | Source->CompleteType(IFace); | ||||||||||
| 8650 | // If the external source completed the type, go through the motions | ||||||||||
| 8651 | // again to ensure we're allowed to use the completed type. | ||||||||||
| 8652 | if (!T->isIncompleteType()) | ||||||||||
| 8653 | return RequireCompleteTypeImpl(Loc, T, Kind, Diagnoser); | ||||||||||
| 8654 | } | ||||||||||
| 8655 | } | ||||||||||
| 8656 | |||||||||||
| 8657 | // If we have a class template specialization or a class member of a | ||||||||||
| 8658 | // class template specialization, or an array with known size of such, | ||||||||||
| 8659 | // try to instantiate it. | ||||||||||
| 8660 | if (auto *RD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { | ||||||||||
| 8661 | bool Instantiated = false; | ||||||||||
| 8662 | bool Diagnosed = false; | ||||||||||
| 8663 | if (RD->isDependentContext()) { | ||||||||||
| 8664 | // Don't try to instantiate a dependent class (eg, a member template of | ||||||||||
| 8665 | // an instantiated class template specialization). | ||||||||||
| 8666 | // FIXME: Can this ever happen? | ||||||||||
| 8667 | } else if (auto *ClassTemplateSpec = | ||||||||||
| 8668 | dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD)) { | ||||||||||
| 8669 | if (ClassTemplateSpec->getSpecializationKind() == TSK_Undeclared) { | ||||||||||
| 8670 | runWithSufficientStackSpace(Loc, [&] { | ||||||||||
| 8671 | Diagnosed = InstantiateClassTemplateSpecialization( | ||||||||||
| 8672 | Loc, ClassTemplateSpec, TSK_ImplicitInstantiation, | ||||||||||
| 8673 | /*Complain=*/Diagnoser); | ||||||||||
| 8674 | }); | ||||||||||
| 8675 | Instantiated = true; | ||||||||||
| 8676 | } | ||||||||||
| 8677 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 8678 | CXXRecordDecl *Pattern = RD->getInstantiatedFromMemberClass(); | ||||||||||
| 8679 | if (!RD->isBeingDefined() && Pattern) { | ||||||||||
| 8680 | MemberSpecializationInfo *MSI = RD->getMemberSpecializationInfo(); | ||||||||||
| 8681 | assert(MSI && "Missing member specialization information?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 8682 | // This record was instantiated from a class within a template. | ||||||||||
| 8683 | if (MSI->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != | ||||||||||
| 8684 | TSK_ExplicitSpecialization) { | ||||||||||
| 8685 | runWithSufficientStackSpace(Loc, [&] { | ||||||||||
| 8686 | Diagnosed = InstantiateClass(Loc, RD, Pattern, | ||||||||||
| 8687 | getTemplateInstantiationArgs(RD), | ||||||||||
| 8688 | TSK_ImplicitInstantiation, | ||||||||||
| 8689 | /*Complain=*/Diagnoser); | ||||||||||
| 8690 | }); | ||||||||||
| 8691 | Instantiated = true; | ||||||||||
| 8692 | } | ||||||||||
| 8693 | } | ||||||||||
| 8694 | } | ||||||||||
| 8695 | |||||||||||
| 8696 | if (Instantiated) { | ||||||||||
| 8697 | // Instantiate* might have already complained that the template is not | ||||||||||
| 8698 | // defined, if we asked it to. | ||||||||||
| 8699 | if (Diagnoser && Diagnosed) | ||||||||||
| 8700 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8701 | // If we instantiated a definition, check that it's usable, even if | ||||||||||
| 8702 | // instantiation produced an error, so that repeated calls to this | ||||||||||
| 8703 | // function give consistent answers. | ||||||||||
| 8704 | if (!T->isIncompleteType()) | ||||||||||
| 8705 | return RequireCompleteTypeImpl(Loc, T, Kind, Diagnoser); | ||||||||||
| 8706 | } | ||||||||||
| 8707 | } | ||||||||||
| 8708 | |||||||||||
| 8709 | // FIXME: If we didn't instantiate a definition because of an explicit | ||||||||||
| 8710 | // specialization declaration, check that it's visible. | ||||||||||
| 8711 | |||||||||||
| 8712 | if (!Diagnoser) | ||||||||||
| 8713 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8714 | |||||||||||
| 8715 | Diagnoser->diagnose(*this, Loc, T); | ||||||||||
| 8716 | |||||||||||
| 8717 | // If the type was a forward declaration of a class/struct/union | ||||||||||
| 8718 | // type, produce a note. | ||||||||||
| 8719 | if (Tag && !Tag->isInvalidDecl() && !Tag->getLocation().isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 8720 | Diag(Tag->getLocation(), | ||||||||||
| 8721 | Tag->isBeingDefined() ? diag::note_type_being_defined | ||||||||||
| 8722 | : diag::note_forward_declaration) | ||||||||||
| 8723 | << Context.getTagDeclType(Tag); | ||||||||||
| 8724 | |||||||||||
| 8725 | // If the Objective-C class was a forward declaration, produce a note. | ||||||||||
| 8726 | if (IFace && !IFace->isInvalidDecl() && !IFace->getLocation().isInvalid()) | ||||||||||
| 8727 | Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::note_forward_class); | ||||||||||
| 8728 | |||||||||||
| 8729 | // If we have external information that we can use to suggest a fix, | ||||||||||
| 8730 | // produce a note. | ||||||||||
| 8731 | if (ExternalSource) | ||||||||||
| 8732 | ExternalSource->MaybeDiagnoseMissingCompleteType(Loc, T); | ||||||||||
| 8733 | |||||||||||
| 8734 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8735 | } | ||||||||||
| 8736 | |||||||||||
| 8737 | bool Sema::RequireCompleteType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, | ||||||||||
| 8738 | CompleteTypeKind Kind, unsigned DiagID) { | ||||||||||
| 8739 | BoundTypeDiagnoser<> Diagnoser(DiagID); | ||||||||||
| 8740 | return RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, Kind, Diagnoser); | ||||||||||
| 8741 | } | ||||||||||
| 8742 | |||||||||||
| 8743 | /// Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for | ||||||||||
| 8744 | /// literal type diagnostic message. | ||||||||||
| 8745 | /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only! | ||||||||||
| 8746 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8747 | /// \returns diagnostic %select index. | ||||||||||
| 8748 | static unsigned getLiteralDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) { | ||||||||||
| 8749 | switch (Tag) { | ||||||||||
| 8750 | case TTK_Struct: return 0; | ||||||||||
| 8751 | case TTK_Interface: return 1; | ||||||||||
| 8752 | case TTK_Class: return 2; | ||||||||||
| 8753 | default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for literal type diagnostic!")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 8754 | } | ||||||||||
| 8755 | } | ||||||||||
| 8756 | |||||||||||
| 8757 | /// Ensure that the type T is a literal type. | ||||||||||
| 8758 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8759 | /// This routine checks whether the type @p T is a literal type. If @p T is an | ||||||||||
| 8760 | /// incomplete type, an attempt is made to complete it. If @p T is a literal | ||||||||||
| 8761 | /// type, or @p AllowIncompleteType is true and @p T is an incomplete type, | ||||||||||
| 8762 | /// returns false. Otherwise, this routine issues the diagnostic @p PD (giving | ||||||||||
| 8763 | /// it the type @p T), along with notes explaining why the type is not a | ||||||||||
| 8764 | /// literal type, and returns true. | ||||||||||
| 8765 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8766 | /// @param Loc The location in the source that the non-literal type | ||||||||||
| 8767 | /// diagnostic should refer to. | ||||||||||
| 8768 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8769 | /// @param T The type that this routine is examining for literalness. | ||||||||||
| 8770 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8771 | /// @param Diagnoser Emits a diagnostic if T is not a literal type. | ||||||||||
| 8772 | /// | ||||||||||
| 8773 | /// @returns @c true if @p T is not a literal type and a diagnostic was emitted, | ||||||||||
| 8774 | /// @c false otherwise. | ||||||||||
| 8775 | bool Sema::RequireLiteralType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, | ||||||||||
| 8776 | TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser) { | ||||||||||
| 8777 | assert(!T->isDependentType() && "type should not be dependent")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 8778 | |||||||||||
| 8779 | QualType ElemType = Context.getBaseElementType(T); | ||||||||||
| 8780 | if ((isCompleteType(Loc, ElemType) || ElemType->isVoidType()) && | ||||||||||
| 8781 | T->isLiteralType(Context)) | ||||||||||
| 8782 | return false; | ||||||||||
| 8783 | |||||||||||
| 8784 | Diagnoser.diagnose(*this, Loc, T); | ||||||||||
| 8785 | |||||||||||
| 8786 | if (T->isVariableArrayType()) | ||||||||||
| 8787 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8788 | |||||||||||
| 8789 | const RecordType *RT = ElemType->getAs<RecordType>(); | ||||||||||
| 8790 | if (!RT) | ||||||||||
| 8791 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8792 | |||||||||||
| 8793 | const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); | ||||||||||
| 8794 | |||||||||||
| 8795 | // A partially-defined class type can't be a literal type, because a literal | ||||||||||
| 8796 | // class type must have a trivial destructor (which can't be checked until | ||||||||||
| 8797 | // the class definition is complete). | ||||||||||
| 8798 | if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ElemType, diag::note_non_literal_incomplete, T)) | ||||||||||
| 8799 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8800 | |||||||||||
| 8801 | // [expr.prim.lambda]p3: | ||||||||||
| 8802 | // This class type is [not] a literal type. | ||||||||||
| 8803 | if (RD->isLambda() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) { | ||||||||||
| 8804 | Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_literal_lambda); | ||||||||||
| 8805 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8806 | } | ||||||||||
| 8807 | |||||||||||
| 8808 | // If the class has virtual base classes, then it's not an aggregate, and | ||||||||||
| 8809 | // cannot have any constexpr constructors or a trivial default constructor, | ||||||||||
| 8810 | // so is non-literal. This is better to diagnose than the resulting absence | ||||||||||
| 8811 | // of constexpr constructors. | ||||||||||
| 8812 | if (RD->getNumVBases()) { | ||||||||||
| 8813 | Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_literal_virtual_base) | ||||||||||
| 8814 | << getLiteralDiagFromTagKind(RD->getTagKind()) << RD->getNumVBases(); | ||||||||||
| 8815 | for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) | ||||||||||
| 8816 | Diag(I.getBeginLoc(), diag::note_constexpr_virtual_base_here) | ||||||||||
| 8817 | << I.getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 8818 | } else if (!RD->isAggregate() && !RD->hasConstexprNonCopyMoveConstructor() && | ||||||||||
| 8819 | !RD->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) { | ||||||||||
| 8820 | Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_literal_no_constexpr_ctors) << RD; | ||||||||||
| 8821 | } else if (RD->hasNonLiteralTypeFieldsOrBases()) { | ||||||||||
| 8822 | for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) { | ||||||||||
| 8823 | if (!I.getType()->isLiteralType(Context)) { | ||||||||||
| 8824 | Diag(I.getBeginLoc(), diag::note_non_literal_base_class) | ||||||||||
| 8825 | << RD << I.getType() << I.getSourceRange(); | ||||||||||
| 8826 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8827 | } | ||||||||||
| 8828 | } | ||||||||||
| 8829 | for (const auto *I : RD->fields()) { | ||||||||||
| 8830 | if (!I->getType()->isLiteralType(Context) || | ||||||||||
| 8831 | I->getType().isVolatileQualified()) { | ||||||||||
| 8832 | Diag(I->getLocation(), diag::note_non_literal_field) | ||||||||||
| 8833 | << RD << I << I->getType() | ||||||||||
| 8834 | << I->getType().isVolatileQualified(); | ||||||||||
| 8835 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8836 | } | ||||||||||
| 8837 | } | ||||||||||
| 8838 | } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 ? !RD->hasConstexprDestructor() | ||||||||||
| 8839 | : !RD->hasTrivialDestructor()) { | ||||||||||
| 8840 | // All fields and bases are of literal types, so have trivial or constexpr | ||||||||||
| 8841 | // destructors. If this class's destructor is non-trivial / non-constexpr, | ||||||||||
| 8842 | // it must be user-declared. | ||||||||||
| 8843 | CXXDestructorDecl *Dtor = RD->getDestructor(); | ||||||||||
| 8844 | assert(Dtor && "class has literal fields and bases but no dtor?")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 8845 | if (!Dtor) | ||||||||||
| 8846 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8847 | |||||||||||
| 8848 | if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) { | ||||||||||
| 8849 | Diag(Dtor->getLocation(), diag::note_non_literal_non_constexpr_dtor) | ||||||||||
| 8850 | << RD; | ||||||||||
| 8851 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 8852 | Diag(Dtor->getLocation(), Dtor->isUserProvided() | ||||||||||
| 8853 | ? diag::note_non_literal_user_provided_dtor | ||||||||||
| 8854 | : diag::note_non_literal_nontrivial_dtor) | ||||||||||
| 8855 | << RD; | ||||||||||
| 8856 | if (!Dtor->isUserProvided()) | ||||||||||
| 8857 | SpecialMemberIsTrivial(Dtor, CXXDestructor, TAH_IgnoreTrivialABI, | ||||||||||
| 8858 | /*Diagnose*/ true); | ||||||||||
| 8859 | } | ||||||||||
| 8860 | } | ||||||||||
| 8861 | |||||||||||
| 8862 | return true; | ||||||||||
| 8863 | } | ||||||||||
| 8864 | |||||||||||
| 8865 | bool Sema::RequireLiteralType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, unsigned DiagID) { | ||||||||||
| 8866 | BoundTypeDiagnoser<> Diagnoser(DiagID); | ||||||||||
| 8867 | return RequireLiteralType(Loc, T, Diagnoser); | ||||||||||
| 8868 | } | ||||||||||
| 8869 | |||||||||||
| 8870 | /// Retrieve a version of the type 'T' that is elaborated by Keyword, qualified | ||||||||||
| 8871 | /// by the nested-name-specifier contained in SS, and that is (re)declared by | ||||||||||
| 8872 | /// OwnedTagDecl, which is nullptr if this is not a (re)declaration. | ||||||||||
| 8873 | QualType Sema::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, | ||||||||||
| 8874 | const CXXScopeSpec &SS, QualType T, | ||||||||||
| 8875 | TagDecl *OwnedTagDecl) { | ||||||||||
| 8876 | if (T.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 8877 | return T; | ||||||||||
| 8878 | NestedNameSpecifier *NNS; | ||||||||||
| 8879 | if (SS.isValid()) | ||||||||||
| 8880 | NNS = SS.getScopeRep(); | ||||||||||
| 8881 | else { | ||||||||||
| 8882 | if (Keyword == ETK_None) | ||||||||||
| 8883 | return T; | ||||||||||
| 8884 | NNS = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 8885 | } | ||||||||||
| 8886 | return Context.getElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, T, OwnedTagDecl); | ||||||||||
| 8887 | } | ||||||||||
| 8888 | |||||||||||
| 8889 | QualType Sema::BuildTypeofExprType(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 8890 | assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType() && "unexpected placeholder")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 8891 | |||||||||||
| 8892 | if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->refersToBitField()) | ||||||||||
| 8893 | Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield) << 2; | ||||||||||
| 8894 | |||||||||||
| 8895 | if (!E->isTypeDependent()) { | ||||||||||
| 8896 | QualType T = E->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 8897 | if (const TagType *TT = T->getAs<TagType>()) | ||||||||||
| 8898 | DiagnoseUseOfDecl(TT->getDecl(), E->getExprLoc()); | ||||||||||
| 8899 | } | ||||||||||
| 8900 | return Context.getTypeOfExprType(E); | ||||||||||
| 8901 | } | ||||||||||
| 8902 | |||||||||||
| 8903 | /// getDecltypeForParenthesizedExpr - Given an expr, will return the type for | ||||||||||
| 8904 | /// that expression, as in [dcl.type.simple]p4 but without taking id-expressions | ||||||||||
| 8905 | /// and class member access into account. | ||||||||||
| 8906 | QualType Sema::getDecltypeForParenthesizedExpr(Expr *E) { | ||||||||||
| 8907 | // C++11 [dcl.type.simple]p4: | ||||||||||
| 8908 | // [...] | ||||||||||
| 8909 | QualType T = E->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 8910 | switch (E->getValueKind()) { | ||||||||||
| 8911 | // - otherwise, if e is an xvalue, decltype(e) is T&&, where T is the | ||||||||||
| 8912 | // type of e; | ||||||||||
| 8913 | case VK_XValue: | ||||||||||
| 8914 | return Context.getRValueReferenceType(T); | ||||||||||
| 8915 | // - otherwise, if e is an lvalue, decltype(e) is T&, where T is the | ||||||||||
| 8916 | // type of e; | ||||||||||
| 8917 | case VK_LValue: | ||||||||||
| 8918 | return Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); | ||||||||||
| 8919 | // - otherwise, decltype(e) is the type of e. | ||||||||||
| 8920 | case VK_PRValue: | ||||||||||
| 8921 | return T; | ||||||||||
| 8922 | } | ||||||||||
| 8923 | llvm_unreachable("Unknown value kind")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 8924 | } | ||||||||||
| 8925 | |||||||||||
| 8926 | /// getDecltypeForExpr - Given an expr, will return the decltype for | ||||||||||
| 8927 | /// that expression, according to the rules in C++11 | ||||||||||
| 8928 | /// [dcl.type.simple]p4 and C++11 [expr.lambda.prim]p18. | ||||||||||
| 8929 | static QualType getDecltypeForExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { | ||||||||||
| 8930 | if (E->isTypeDependent()) | ||||||||||
| 8931 | return S.Context.DependentTy; | ||||||||||
| 8932 | |||||||||||
| 8933 | Expr *IDExpr = E; | ||||||||||
| 8934 | if (auto *ImplCastExpr = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) | ||||||||||
| 8935 | IDExpr = ImplCastExpr->getSubExpr(); | ||||||||||
| 8936 | |||||||||||
| 8937 | // C++11 [dcl.type.simple]p4: | ||||||||||
| 8938 | // The type denoted by decltype(e) is defined as follows: | ||||||||||
| 8939 | |||||||||||
| 8940 | // C++20: | ||||||||||
| 8941 | // - if E is an unparenthesized id-expression naming a non-type | ||||||||||
| 8942 | // template-parameter (13.2), decltype(E) is the type of the | ||||||||||
| 8943 | // template-parameter after performing any necessary type deduction | ||||||||||
| 8944 | // Note that this does not pick up the implicit 'const' for a template | ||||||||||
| 8945 | // parameter object. This rule makes no difference before C++20 so we apply | ||||||||||
| 8946 | // it unconditionally. | ||||||||||
| 8947 | if (const auto *SNTTPE = dyn_cast<SubstNonTypeTemplateParmExpr>(IDExpr)) | ||||||||||
| 8948 | return SNTTPE->getParameterType(S.Context); | ||||||||||
| 8949 | |||||||||||
| 8950 | // - if e is an unparenthesized id-expression or an unparenthesized class | ||||||||||
| 8951 | // member access (5.2.5), decltype(e) is the type of the entity named | ||||||||||
| 8952 | // by e. If there is no such entity, or if e names a set of overloaded | ||||||||||
| 8953 | // functions, the program is ill-formed; | ||||||||||
| 8954 | // | ||||||||||
| 8955 | // We apply the same rules for Objective-C ivar and property references. | ||||||||||
| 8956 | if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(IDExpr)) { | ||||||||||
| 8957 | const ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl(); | ||||||||||
| 8958 | if (auto *TPO = dyn_cast<TemplateParamObjectDecl>(VD)) | ||||||||||
| 8959 | return TPO->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); | ||||||||||
| 8960 | return VD->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 8961 | } else if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(IDExpr)) { | ||||||||||
| 8962 | if (const ValueDecl *VD = ME->getMemberDecl()) | ||||||||||
| 8963 | if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<VarDecl>(VD)) | ||||||||||
| 8964 | return VD->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 8965 | } else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *IR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(IDExpr)) { | ||||||||||
| 8966 | return IR->getDecl()->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 8967 | } else if (const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PR = | ||||||||||
| 8968 | dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(IDExpr)) { | ||||||||||
| 8969 | if (PR->isExplicitProperty()) | ||||||||||
| 8970 | return PR->getExplicitProperty()->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 8971 | } else if (auto *PE = dyn_cast<PredefinedExpr>(IDExpr)) { | ||||||||||
| 8972 | return PE->getType(); | ||||||||||
| 8973 | } | ||||||||||
| 8974 | |||||||||||
| 8975 | // C++11 [expr.lambda.prim]p18: | ||||||||||
| 8976 | // Every occurrence of decltype((x)) where x is a possibly | ||||||||||
| 8977 | // parenthesized id-expression that names an entity of automatic | ||||||||||
| 8978 | // storage duration is treated as if x were transformed into an | ||||||||||
| 8979 | // access to a corresponding data member of the closure type that | ||||||||||
| 8980 | // would have been declared if x were an odr-use of the denoted | ||||||||||
| 8981 | // entity. | ||||||||||
| 8982 | using namespace sema; | ||||||||||
| 8983 | if (S.getCurLambda()) { | ||||||||||
| 8984 | if (isa<ParenExpr>(IDExpr)) { | ||||||||||
| 8985 | if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(IDExpr->IgnoreParens())) { | ||||||||||
| 8986 | if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) { | ||||||||||
| 8987 | QualType T = S.getCapturedDeclRefType(Var, DRE->getLocation()); | ||||||||||
| 8988 | if (!T.isNull()) | ||||||||||
| 8989 | return S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); | ||||||||||
| 8990 | } | ||||||||||
| 8991 | } | ||||||||||
| 8992 | } | ||||||||||
| 8993 | } | ||||||||||
| 8994 | |||||||||||
| 8995 | return S.getDecltypeForParenthesizedExpr(E); | ||||||||||
| 8996 | } | ||||||||||
| 8997 | |||||||||||
| 8998 | QualType Sema::BuildDecltypeType(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, | ||||||||||
| 8999 | bool AsUnevaluated) { | ||||||||||
| 9000 | assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType() && "unexpected placeholder")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 9001 | |||||||||||
| 9002 | if (AsUnevaluated && CodeSynthesisContexts.empty() && | ||||||||||
| 9003 | !E->isInstantiationDependent() && E->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) { | ||||||||||
| 9004 | // The expression operand for decltype is in an unevaluated expression | ||||||||||
| 9005 | // context, so side effects could result in unintended consequences. | ||||||||||
| 9006 | // Exclude instantiation-dependent expressions, because 'decltype' is often | ||||||||||
| 9007 | // used to build SFINAE gadgets. | ||||||||||
| 9008 | Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); | ||||||||||
| 9009 | } | ||||||||||
| 9010 | |||||||||||
| 9011 | return Context.getDecltypeType(E, getDecltypeForExpr(*this, E)); | ||||||||||
| 9012 | } | ||||||||||
| 9013 | |||||||||||
| 9014 | QualType Sema::BuildUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType, | ||||||||||
| 9015 | UnaryTransformType::UTTKind UKind, | ||||||||||
| 9016 | SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 9017 | switch (UKind) { | ||||||||||
| 9018 | case UnaryTransformType::EnumUnderlyingType: | ||||||||||
| 9019 | if (!BaseType->isDependentType() && !BaseType->isEnumeralType()) { | ||||||||||
| 9020 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_only_enums_have_underlying_types); | ||||||||||
| 9021 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 9022 | } else { | ||||||||||
| 9023 | QualType Underlying = BaseType; | ||||||||||
| 9024 | if (!BaseType->isDependentType()) { | ||||||||||
| 9025 | // The enum could be incomplete if we're parsing its definition or | ||||||||||
| 9026 | // recovering from an error. | ||||||||||
| 9027 | NamedDecl *FwdDecl = nullptr; | ||||||||||
| 9028 | if (BaseType->isIncompleteType(&FwdDecl)) { | ||||||||||
| 9029 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_underlying_type_of_incomplete_enum) << BaseType; | ||||||||||
| 9030 | Diag(FwdDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_forward_declaration) << FwdDecl; | ||||||||||
| 9031 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 9032 | } | ||||||||||
| 9033 | |||||||||||
| 9034 | EnumDecl *ED = BaseType->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl(); | ||||||||||
| 9035 | assert(ED && "EnumType has no EnumDecl")((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 9036 | |||||||||||
| 9037 | DiagnoseUseOfDecl(ED, Loc); | ||||||||||
| 9038 | |||||||||||
| 9039 | Underlying = ED->getIntegerType(); | ||||||||||
| 9040 | assert(!Underlying.isNull())((void)0); | ||||||||||
| 9041 | } | ||||||||||
| 9042 | return Context.getUnaryTransformType(BaseType, Underlying, | ||||||||||
| 9043 | UnaryTransformType::EnumUnderlyingType); | ||||||||||
| 9044 | } | ||||||||||
| 9045 | } | ||||||||||
| 9046 | llvm_unreachable("unknown unary transform type")__builtin_unreachable(); | ||||||||||
| 9047 | } | ||||||||||
| 9048 | |||||||||||
| 9049 | QualType Sema::BuildAtomicType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc) { | ||||||||||
| 9050 | if (!T->isDependentType()) { | ||||||||||
| 9051 | // FIXME: It isn't entirely clear whether incomplete atomic types | ||||||||||
| 9052 | // are allowed or not; for simplicity, ban them for the moment. | ||||||||||
| 9053 | if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, diag::err_atomic_specifier_bad_type, 0)) | ||||||||||
| 9054 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 9055 | |||||||||||
| 9056 | int DisallowedKind = -1; | ||||||||||
| 9057 | if (T->isArrayType()) | ||||||||||
| 9058 | DisallowedKind = 1; | ||||||||||
| 9059 | else if (T->isFunctionType()) | ||||||||||
| 9060 | DisallowedKind = 2; | ||||||||||
| 9061 | else if (T->isReferenceType()) | ||||||||||
| 9062 | DisallowedKind = 3; | ||||||||||
| 9063 | else if (T->isAtomicType()) | ||||||||||
| 9064 | DisallowedKind = 4; | ||||||||||
| 9065 | else if (T.hasQualifiers()) | ||||||||||
| 9066 | DisallowedKind = 5; | ||||||||||
| 9067 | else if (T->isSizelessType()) | ||||||||||
| 9068 | DisallowedKind = 6; | ||||||||||
| 9069 | else if (!T.isTriviallyCopyableType(Context)) | ||||||||||
| 9070 | // Some other non-trivially-copyable type (probably a C++ class) | ||||||||||
| 9071 | DisallowedKind = 7; | ||||||||||
| 9072 | else if (T->isExtIntType()) { | ||||||||||
| 9073 | DisallowedKind = 8; | ||||||||||
| 9074 | } | ||||||||||
| 9075 | |||||||||||
| 9076 | if (DisallowedKind != -1) { | ||||||||||
| 9077 | Diag(Loc, diag::err_atomic_specifier_bad_type) << DisallowedKind << T; | ||||||||||
| 9078 | return QualType(); | ||||||||||
| 9079 | } | ||||||||||
| 9080 | |||||||||||
| 9081 | // FIXME: Do we need any handling for ARC here? | ||||||||||
| 9082 | } | ||||||||||
| 9083 | |||||||||||
| 9084 | // Build the pointer type. | ||||||||||
| 9085 | return Context.getAtomicType(T); | ||||||||||
| 9086 | } |
| 1 | //===--- TypeLocVisitor.h - Visitor for TypeLoc subclasses ------*- C++ -*-===// |
| 2 | // |
| 3 | // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. |
| 4 | // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. |
| 5 | // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception |
| 6 | // |
| 7 | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// |
| 8 | // |
| 9 | // This file defines the TypeLocVisitor interface. |
| 10 | // |
| 11 | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// |
| 12 | #ifndef LLVM_CLANG_AST_TYPELOCVISITOR_H |
| 13 | #define LLVM_CLANG_AST_TYPELOCVISITOR_H |
| 14 | |
| 15 | #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h" |
| 16 | #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h" |
| 17 | |
| 18 | namespace clang { |
| 19 | |
| 20 | #define DISPATCH(CLASSNAME) \ |
| 21 | return static_cast<ImplClass*>(this)-> \ |
| 22 | Visit##CLASSNAME(TyLoc.castAs<CLASSNAME>()) |
| 23 | |
| 24 | template<typename ImplClass, typename RetTy=void> |
| 25 | class TypeLocVisitor { |
| 26 | public: |
| 27 | RetTy Visit(TypeLoc TyLoc) { |
| 28 | switch (TyLoc.getTypeLocClass()) { |
| 29 | #define ABSTRACT_TYPELOC(CLASS, PARENT) |
| 30 | #define TYPELOC(CLASS, PARENT) \ |
| 31 | case TypeLoc::CLASS: DISPATCH(CLASS##TypeLoc); |
| 32 | #include "clang/AST/TypeLocNodes.def" |
| 33 | } |
| 34 | llvm_unreachable("unexpected type loc class!")__builtin_unreachable(); |
| 35 | } |
| 36 | |
| 37 | RetTy Visit(UnqualTypeLoc TyLoc) { |
| 38 | switch (TyLoc.getTypeLocClass()) { |
| 39 | #define ABSTRACT_TYPELOC(CLASS, PARENT) |
| 40 | #define TYPELOC(CLASS, PARENT) \ |
| 41 | case TypeLoc::CLASS: DISPATCH(CLASS##TypeLoc); |
| 42 | #include "clang/AST/TypeLocNodes.def" |
| 43 | } |
| 44 | llvm_unreachable("unexpected type loc class!")__builtin_unreachable(); |
| 45 | } |
| 46 | |
| 47 | #define TYPELOC(CLASS, PARENT) \ |
| 48 | RetTy Visit##CLASS##TypeLoc(CLASS##TypeLoc TyLoc) { \ |
| 49 | DISPATCH(PARENT); \ |
| 50 | } |
| 51 | #include "clang/AST/TypeLocNodes.def" |
| 52 | |
| 53 | RetTy VisitTypeLoc(TypeLoc TyLoc) { return RetTy(); } |
| 54 | }; |
| 55 | |
| 56 | #undef DISPATCH |
| 57 | |
| 58 | } // end namespace clang |
| 59 | |
| 60 | #endif // LLVM_CLANG_AST_TYPELOCVISITOR_H |
| 1 | /*===- TableGen'erated file -------------------------------------*- C++ -*-===*\ |
| 2 | |* *| |
| 3 | |* An x-macro database of Clang type nodes *| |
| 4 | |* *| |
| 5 | |* Automatically generated file, do not edit! *| |
| 6 | |* *| |
| 7 | \*===----------------------------------------------------------------------===*/ |
| 8 | |
| 9 | #ifndef ABSTRACT_TYPE |
| 10 | # define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) TYPE(Class, Base) |
| 11 | #endif |
| 12 | #ifndef NON_CANONICAL_TYPE |
| 13 | # define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) TYPE(Class, Base) |
| 14 | #endif |
| 15 | #ifndef DEPENDENT_TYPE |
| 16 | # define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) TYPE(Class, Base) |
| 17 | #endif |
| 18 | #ifndef NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE |
| 19 | # define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) TYPE(Class, Base) |
| 20 | #endif |
| 21 | NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Adjusted, Type) |
| 22 | NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Decayed, AdjustedType) |
| 23 | ABSTRACT_TYPE(Array, Type) |
| 24 | TYPE(ConstantArray, ArrayType) |
| 25 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(DependentSizedArray, ArrayType) |
| 26 | TYPE(IncompleteArray, ArrayType) |
| 27 | TYPE(VariableArray, ArrayType) |
| 28 | TYPE(Atomic, Type) |
| 29 | NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Attributed, Type) |
| 30 | TYPE(BlockPointer, Type) |
| 31 | TYPE(Builtin, Type) |
| 32 | TYPE(Complex, Type) |
| 33 | NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Decltype, Type) |
| 34 | ABSTRACT_TYPE(Deduced, Type) |
| 35 | TYPE(Auto, DeducedType) |
| 36 | TYPE(DeducedTemplateSpecialization, DeducedType) |
| 37 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(DependentAddressSpace, Type) |
| 38 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(DependentExtInt, Type) |
| 39 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(DependentName, Type) |
| 40 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(DependentSizedExtVector, Type) |
| 41 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(DependentTemplateSpecialization, Type) |
| 42 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(DependentVector, Type) |
| 43 | NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Elaborated, Type) |
| 44 | TYPE(ExtInt, Type) |
| 45 | ABSTRACT_TYPE(Function, Type) |
| 46 | TYPE(FunctionNoProto, FunctionType) |
| 47 | TYPE(FunctionProto, FunctionType) |
| 48 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(InjectedClassName, Type) |
| 49 | NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(MacroQualified, Type) |
| 50 | ABSTRACT_TYPE(Matrix, Type) |
| 51 | TYPE(ConstantMatrix, MatrixType) |
| 52 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(DependentSizedMatrix, MatrixType) |
| 53 | TYPE(MemberPointer, Type) |
| 54 | TYPE(ObjCObjectPointer, Type) |
| 55 | TYPE(ObjCObject, Type) |
| 56 | TYPE(ObjCInterface, ObjCObjectType) |
| 57 | NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(ObjCTypeParam, Type) |
| 58 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(PackExpansion, Type) |
| 59 | NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Paren, Type) |
| 60 | TYPE(Pipe, Type) |
| 61 | TYPE(Pointer, Type) |
| 62 | ABSTRACT_TYPE(Reference, Type) |
| 63 | TYPE(LValueReference, ReferenceType) |
| 64 | TYPE(RValueReference, ReferenceType) |
| 65 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(SubstTemplateTypeParmPack, Type) |
| 66 | NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(SubstTemplateTypeParm, Type) |
| 67 | ABSTRACT_TYPE(Tag, Type) |
| 68 | TYPE(Enum, TagType) |
| 69 | TYPE(Record, TagType) |
| 70 | NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(TemplateSpecialization, Type) |
| 71 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(TemplateTypeParm, Type) |
| 72 | NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(TypeOfExpr, Type) |
| 73 | NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(TypeOf, Type) |
| 74 | NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Typedef, Type) |
| 75 | NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(UnaryTransform, Type) |
| 76 | DEPENDENT_TYPE(UnresolvedUsing, Type) |
| 77 | TYPE(Vector, Type) |
| 78 | TYPE(ExtVector, VectorType) |
| 79 | #ifdef LAST_TYPE |
| 80 | LAST_TYPE(ExtVector) |
| 81 | #undef LAST_TYPE |
| 82 | #endif |
| 83 | #ifdef LEAF_TYPE |
| 84 | LEAF_TYPE(Builtin) |
| 85 | LEAF_TYPE(Enum) |
| 86 | LEAF_TYPE(InjectedClassName) |
| 87 | LEAF_TYPE(ObjCInterface) |
| 88 | LEAF_TYPE(Record) |
| 89 | LEAF_TYPE(TemplateTypeParm) |
| 90 | #undef LEAF_TYPE |
| 91 | #endif |
| 92 | #undef TYPE |
| 93 | #undef ABSTRACT_TYPE |
| 94 | #undef ABSTRACT_TYPE |
| 95 | #undef NON_CANONICAL_TYPE |
| 96 | #undef DEPENDENT_TYPE |
| 97 | #undef NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE |
| 1 | //===- Type.h - C Language Family Type Representation -----------*- C++ -*-===// |
| 2 | // |
| 3 | // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. |
| 4 | // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. |
| 5 | // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception |
| 6 | // |
| 7 | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// |
| 8 | // |
| 9 | /// \file |
| 10 | /// C Language Family Type Representation |
| 11 | /// |
| 12 | /// This file defines the clang::Type interface and subclasses, used to |
| 13 | /// represent types for languages in the C family. |
| 14 | // |
| 15 | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// |
| 16 | |
| 17 | #ifndef LLVM_CLANG_AST_TYPE_H |
| 18 | #define LLVM_CLANG_AST_TYPE_H |
| 19 | |
| 20 | #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h" |
| 21 | #include "clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h" |
| 22 | #include "clang/AST/TemplateName.h" |
| 23 | #include "clang/Basic/AddressSpaces.h" |
| 24 | #include "clang/Basic/AttrKinds.h" |
| 25 | #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" |
| 26 | #include "clang/Basic/ExceptionSpecificationType.h" |
| 27 | #include "clang/Basic/LLVM.h" |
| 28 | #include "clang/Basic/Linkage.h" |
| 29 | #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" |
| 30 | #include "clang/Basic/SourceLocation.h" |
| 31 | #include "clang/Basic/Specifiers.h" |
| 32 | #include "clang/Basic/Visibility.h" |
| 33 | #include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h" |
| 34 | #include "llvm/ADT/APSInt.h" |
| 35 | #include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h" |
| 36 | #include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h" |
| 37 | #include "llvm/ADT/None.h" |
| 38 | #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" |
| 39 | #include "llvm/ADT/PointerIntPair.h" |
| 40 | #include "llvm/ADT/PointerUnion.h" |
| 41 | #include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h" |
| 42 | #include "llvm/ADT/Twine.h" |
| 43 | #include "llvm/ADT/iterator_range.h" |
| 44 | #include "llvm/Support/Casting.h" |
| 45 | #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h" |
| 46 | #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h" |
| 47 | #include "llvm/Support/PointerLikeTypeTraits.h" |
| 48 | #include "llvm/Support/TrailingObjects.h" |
| 49 | #include "llvm/Support/type_traits.h" |
| 50 | #include <cassert> |
| 51 | #include <cstddef> |
| 52 | #include <cstdint> |
| 53 | #include <cstring> |
| 54 | #include <string> |
| 55 | #include <type_traits> |
| 56 | #include <utility> |
| 57 | |
| 58 | namespace clang { |
| 59 | |
| 60 | class ExtQuals; |
| 61 | class QualType; |
| 62 | class ConceptDecl; |
| 63 | class TagDecl; |
| 64 | class TemplateParameterList; |
| 65 | class Type; |
| 66 | |
| 67 | enum { |
| 68 | TypeAlignmentInBits = 4, |
| 69 | TypeAlignment = 1 << TypeAlignmentInBits |
| 70 | }; |
| 71 | |
| 72 | namespace serialization { |
| 73 | template <class T> class AbstractTypeReader; |
| 74 | template <class T> class AbstractTypeWriter; |
| 75 | } |
| 76 | |
| 77 | } // namespace clang |
| 78 | |
| 79 | namespace llvm { |
| 80 | |
| 81 | template <typename T> |
| 82 | struct PointerLikeTypeTraits; |
| 83 | template<> |
| 84 | struct PointerLikeTypeTraits< ::clang::Type*> { |
| 85 | static inline void *getAsVoidPointer(::clang::Type *P) { return P; } |
| 86 | |
| 87 | static inline ::clang::Type *getFromVoidPointer(void *P) { |
| 88 | return static_cast< ::clang::Type*>(P); |
| 89 | } |
| 90 | |
| 91 | static constexpr int NumLowBitsAvailable = clang::TypeAlignmentInBits; |
| 92 | }; |
| 93 | |
| 94 | template<> |
| 95 | struct PointerLikeTypeTraits< ::clang::ExtQuals*> { |
| 96 | static inline void *getAsVoidPointer(::clang::ExtQuals *P) { return P; } |
| 97 | |
| 98 | static inline ::clang::ExtQuals *getFromVoidPointer(void *P) { |
| 99 | return static_cast< ::clang::ExtQuals*>(P); |
| 100 | } |
| 101 | |
| 102 | static constexpr int NumLowBitsAvailable = clang::TypeAlignmentInBits; |
| 103 | }; |
| 104 | |
| 105 | } // namespace llvm |
| 106 | |
| 107 | namespace clang { |
| 108 | |
| 109 | class ASTContext; |
| 110 | template <typename> class CanQual; |
| 111 | class CXXRecordDecl; |
| 112 | class DeclContext; |
| 113 | class EnumDecl; |
| 114 | class Expr; |
| 115 | class ExtQualsTypeCommonBase; |
| 116 | class FunctionDecl; |
| 117 | class IdentifierInfo; |
| 118 | class NamedDecl; |
| 119 | class ObjCInterfaceDecl; |
| 120 | class ObjCProtocolDecl; |
| 121 | class ObjCTypeParamDecl; |
| 122 | struct PrintingPolicy; |
| 123 | class RecordDecl; |
| 124 | class Stmt; |
| 125 | class TagDecl; |
| 126 | class TemplateArgument; |
| 127 | class TemplateArgumentListInfo; |
| 128 | class TemplateArgumentLoc; |
| 129 | class TemplateTypeParmDecl; |
| 130 | class TypedefNameDecl; |
| 131 | class UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl; |
| 132 | |
| 133 | using CanQualType = CanQual<Type>; |
| 134 | |
| 135 | // Provide forward declarations for all of the *Type classes. |
| 136 | #define TYPE(Class, Base) class Class##Type; |
| 137 | #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc" |
| 138 | |
| 139 | /// The collection of all-type qualifiers we support. |
| 140 | /// Clang supports five independent qualifiers: |
| 141 | /// * C99: const, volatile, and restrict |
| 142 | /// * MS: __unaligned |
| 143 | /// * Embedded C (TR18037): address spaces |
| 144 | /// * Objective C: the GC attributes (none, weak, or strong) |
| 145 | class Qualifiers { |
| 146 | public: |
| 147 | enum TQ { // NOTE: These flags must be kept in sync with DeclSpec::TQ. |
| 148 | Const = 0x1, |
| 149 | Restrict = 0x2, |
| 150 | Volatile = 0x4, |
| 151 | CVRMask = Const | Volatile | Restrict |
| 152 | }; |
| 153 | |
| 154 | enum GC { |
| 155 | GCNone = 0, |
| 156 | Weak, |
| 157 | Strong |
| 158 | }; |
| 159 | |
| 160 | enum ObjCLifetime { |
| 161 | /// There is no lifetime qualification on this type. |
| 162 | OCL_None, |
| 163 | |
| 164 | /// This object can be modified without requiring retains or |
| 165 | /// releases. |
| 166 | OCL_ExplicitNone, |
| 167 | |
| 168 | /// Assigning into this object requires the old value to be |
| 169 | /// released and the new value to be retained. The timing of the |
| 170 | /// release of the old value is inexact: it may be moved to |
| 171 | /// immediately after the last known point where the value is |
| 172 | /// live. |
| 173 | OCL_Strong, |
| 174 | |
| 175 | /// Reading or writing from this object requires a barrier call. |
| 176 | OCL_Weak, |
| 177 | |
| 178 | /// Assigning into this object requires a lifetime extension. |
| 179 | OCL_Autoreleasing |
| 180 | }; |
| 181 | |
| 182 | enum { |
| 183 | /// The maximum supported address space number. |
| 184 | /// 23 bits should be enough for anyone. |
| 185 | MaxAddressSpace = 0x7fffffu, |
| 186 | |
| 187 | /// The width of the "fast" qualifier mask. |
| 188 | FastWidth = 3, |
| 189 | |
| 190 | /// The fast qualifier mask. |
| 191 | FastMask = (1 << FastWidth) - 1 |
| 192 | }; |
| 193 | |
| 194 | /// Returns the common set of qualifiers while removing them from |
| 195 | /// the given sets. |
| 196 | static Qualifiers removeCommonQualifiers(Qualifiers &L, Qualifiers &R) { |
| 197 | // If both are only CVR-qualified, bit operations are sufficient. |
| 198 | if (!(L.Mask & ~CVRMask) && !(R.Mask & ~CVRMask)) { |
| 199 | Qualifiers Q; |
| 200 | Q.Mask = L.Mask & R.Mask; |
| 201 | L.Mask &= ~Q.Mask; |
| 202 | R.Mask &= ~Q.Mask; |
| 203 | return Q; |
| 204 | } |
| 205 | |
| 206 | Qualifiers Q; |
| 207 | unsigned CommonCRV = L.getCVRQualifiers() & R.getCVRQualifiers(); |
| 208 | Q.addCVRQualifiers(CommonCRV); |
| 209 | L.removeCVRQualifiers(CommonCRV); |
| 210 | R.removeCVRQualifiers(CommonCRV); |
| 211 | |
| 212 | if (L.getObjCGCAttr() == R.getObjCGCAttr()) { |
| 213 | Q.setObjCGCAttr(L.getObjCGCAttr()); |
| 214 | L.removeObjCGCAttr(); |
| 215 | R.removeObjCGCAttr(); |
| 216 | } |
| 217 | |
| 218 | if (L.getObjCLifetime() == R.getObjCLifetime()) { |
| 219 | Q.setObjCLifetime(L.getObjCLifetime()); |
| 220 | L.removeObjCLifetime(); |
| 221 | R.removeObjCLifetime(); |
| 222 | } |
| 223 | |
| 224 | if (L.getAddressSpace() == R.getAddressSpace()) { |
| 225 | Q.setAddressSpace(L.getAddressSpace()); |
| 226 | L.removeAddressSpace(); |
| 227 | R.removeAddressSpace(); |
| 228 | } |
| 229 | return Q; |
| 230 | } |
| 231 | |
| 232 | static Qualifiers fromFastMask(unsigned Mask) { |
| 233 | Qualifiers Qs; |
| 234 | Qs.addFastQualifiers(Mask); |
| 235 | return Qs; |
| 236 | } |
| 237 | |
| 238 | static Qualifiers fromCVRMask(unsigned CVR) { |
| 239 | Qualifiers Qs; |
| 240 | Qs.addCVRQualifiers(CVR); |
| 241 | return Qs; |
| 242 | } |
| 243 | |
| 244 | static Qualifiers fromCVRUMask(unsigned CVRU) { |
| 245 | Qualifiers Qs; |
| 246 | Qs.addCVRUQualifiers(CVRU); |
| 247 | return Qs; |
| 248 | } |
| 249 | |
| 250 | // Deserialize qualifiers from an opaque representation. |
| 251 | static Qualifiers fromOpaqueValue(unsigned opaque) { |
| 252 | Qualifiers Qs; |
| 253 | Qs.Mask = opaque; |
| 254 | return Qs; |
| 255 | } |
| 256 | |
| 257 | // Serialize these qualifiers into an opaque representation. |
| 258 | unsigned getAsOpaqueValue() const { |
| 259 | return Mask; |
| 260 | } |
| 261 | |
| 262 | bool hasConst() const { return Mask & Const; } |
| 263 | bool hasOnlyConst() const { return Mask == Const; } |
| 264 | void removeConst() { Mask &= ~Const; } |
| 265 | void addConst() { Mask |= Const; } |
| 266 | |
| 267 | bool hasVolatile() const { return Mask & Volatile; } |
| 268 | bool hasOnlyVolatile() const { return Mask == Volatile; } |
| 269 | void removeVolatile() { Mask &= ~Volatile; } |
| 270 | void addVolatile() { Mask |= Volatile; } |
| 271 | |
| 272 | bool hasRestrict() const { return Mask & Restrict; } |
| 273 | bool hasOnlyRestrict() const { return Mask == Restrict; } |
| 274 | void removeRestrict() { Mask &= ~Restrict; } |
| 275 | void addRestrict() { Mask |= Restrict; } |
| 276 | |
| 277 | bool hasCVRQualifiers() const { return getCVRQualifiers(); } |
| 278 | unsigned getCVRQualifiers() const { return Mask & CVRMask; } |
| 279 | unsigned getCVRUQualifiers() const { return Mask & (CVRMask | UMask); } |
| 280 | |
| 281 | void setCVRQualifiers(unsigned mask) { |
| 282 | assert(!(mask & ~CVRMask) && "bitmask contains non-CVR bits")((void)0); |
| 283 | Mask = (Mask & ~CVRMask) | mask; |
| 284 | } |
| 285 | void removeCVRQualifiers(unsigned mask) { |
| 286 | assert(!(mask & ~CVRMask) && "bitmask contains non-CVR bits")((void)0); |
| 287 | Mask &= ~mask; |
| 288 | } |
| 289 | void removeCVRQualifiers() { |
| 290 | removeCVRQualifiers(CVRMask); |
| 291 | } |
| 292 | void addCVRQualifiers(unsigned mask) { |
| 293 | assert(!(mask & ~CVRMask) && "bitmask contains non-CVR bits")((void)0); |
| 294 | Mask |= mask; |
| 295 | } |
| 296 | void addCVRUQualifiers(unsigned mask) { |
| 297 | assert(!(mask & ~CVRMask & ~UMask) && "bitmask contains non-CVRU bits")((void)0); |
| 298 | Mask |= mask; |
| 299 | } |
| 300 | |
| 301 | bool hasUnaligned() const { return Mask & UMask; } |
| 302 | void setUnaligned(bool flag) { |
| 303 | Mask = (Mask & ~UMask) | (flag ? UMask : 0); |
| 304 | } |
| 305 | void removeUnaligned() { Mask &= ~UMask; } |
| 306 | void addUnaligned() { Mask |= UMask; } |
| 307 | |
| 308 | bool hasObjCGCAttr() const { return Mask & GCAttrMask; } |
| 309 | GC getObjCGCAttr() const { return GC((Mask & GCAttrMask) >> GCAttrShift); } |
| 310 | void setObjCGCAttr(GC type) { |
| 311 | Mask = (Mask & ~GCAttrMask) | (type << GCAttrShift); |
| 312 | } |
| 313 | void removeObjCGCAttr() { setObjCGCAttr(GCNone); } |
| 314 | void addObjCGCAttr(GC type) { |
| 315 | assert(type)((void)0); |
| 316 | setObjCGCAttr(type); |
| 317 | } |
| 318 | Qualifiers withoutObjCGCAttr() const { |
| 319 | Qualifiers qs = *this; |
| 320 | qs.removeObjCGCAttr(); |
| 321 | return qs; |
| 322 | } |
| 323 | Qualifiers withoutObjCLifetime() const { |
| 324 | Qualifiers qs = *this; |
| 325 | qs.removeObjCLifetime(); |
| 326 | return qs; |
| 327 | } |
| 328 | Qualifiers withoutAddressSpace() const { |
| 329 | Qualifiers qs = *this; |
| 330 | qs.removeAddressSpace(); |
| 331 | return qs; |
| 332 | } |
| 333 | |
| 334 | bool hasObjCLifetime() const { return Mask & LifetimeMask; } |
| 335 | ObjCLifetime getObjCLifetime() const { |
| 336 | return ObjCLifetime((Mask & LifetimeMask) >> LifetimeShift); |
| 337 | } |
| 338 | void setObjCLifetime(ObjCLifetime type) { |
| 339 | Mask = (Mask & ~LifetimeMask) | (type << LifetimeShift); |
| 340 | } |
| 341 | void removeObjCLifetime() { setObjCLifetime(OCL_None); } |
| 342 | void addObjCLifetime(ObjCLifetime type) { |
| 343 | assert(type)((void)0); |
| 344 | assert(!hasObjCLifetime())((void)0); |
| 345 | Mask |= (type << LifetimeShift); |
| 346 | } |
| 347 | |
| 348 | /// True if the lifetime is neither None or ExplicitNone. |
| 349 | bool hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() const { |
| 350 | ObjCLifetime lifetime = getObjCLifetime(); |
| 351 | return (lifetime > OCL_ExplicitNone); |
| 352 | } |
| 353 | |
| 354 | /// True if the lifetime is either strong or weak. |
| 355 | bool hasStrongOrWeakObjCLifetime() const { |
| 356 | ObjCLifetime lifetime = getObjCLifetime(); |
| 357 | return (lifetime == OCL_Strong || lifetime == OCL_Weak); |
| 358 | } |
| 359 | |
| 360 | bool hasAddressSpace() const { return Mask & AddressSpaceMask; } |
| 361 | LangAS getAddressSpace() const { |
| 362 | return static_cast<LangAS>(Mask >> AddressSpaceShift); |
| 363 | } |
| 364 | bool hasTargetSpecificAddressSpace() const { |
| 365 | return isTargetAddressSpace(getAddressSpace()); |
| 366 | } |
| 367 | /// Get the address space attribute value to be printed by diagnostics. |
| 368 | unsigned getAddressSpaceAttributePrintValue() const { |
| 369 | auto Addr = getAddressSpace(); |
| 370 | // This function is not supposed to be used with language specific |
| 371 | // address spaces. If that happens, the diagnostic message should consider |
| 372 | // printing the QualType instead of the address space value. |
| 373 | assert(Addr == LangAS::Default || hasTargetSpecificAddressSpace())((void)0); |
| 374 | if (Addr != LangAS::Default) |
| 375 | return toTargetAddressSpace(Addr); |
| 376 | // TODO: The diagnostic messages where Addr may be 0 should be fixed |
| 377 | // since it cannot differentiate the situation where 0 denotes the default |
| 378 | // address space or user specified __attribute__((address_space(0))). |
| 379 | return 0; |
| 380 | } |
| 381 | void setAddressSpace(LangAS space) { |
| 382 | assert((unsigned)space <= MaxAddressSpace)((void)0); |
| 383 | Mask = (Mask & ~AddressSpaceMask) |
| 384 | | (((uint32_t) space) << AddressSpaceShift); |
| 385 | } |
| 386 | void removeAddressSpace() { setAddressSpace(LangAS::Default); } |
| 387 | void addAddressSpace(LangAS space) { |
| 388 | assert(space != LangAS::Default)((void)0); |
| 389 | setAddressSpace(space); |
| 390 | } |
| 391 | |
| 392 | // Fast qualifiers are those that can be allocated directly |
| 393 | // on a QualType object. |
| 394 | bool hasFastQualifiers() const { return getFastQualifiers(); } |
| 395 | unsigned getFastQualifiers() const { return Mask & FastMask; } |
| 396 | void setFastQualifiers(unsigned mask) { |
| 397 | assert(!(mask & ~FastMask) && "bitmask contains non-fast qualifier bits")((void)0); |
| 398 | Mask = (Mask & ~FastMask) | mask; |
| 399 | } |
| 400 | void removeFastQualifiers(unsigned mask) { |
| 401 | assert(!(mask & ~FastMask) && "bitmask contains non-fast qualifier bits")((void)0); |
| 402 | Mask &= ~mask; |
| 403 | } |
| 404 | void removeFastQualifiers() { |
| 405 | removeFastQualifiers(FastMask); |
| 406 | } |
| 407 | void addFastQualifiers(unsigned mask) { |
| 408 | assert(!(mask & ~FastMask) && "bitmask contains non-fast qualifier bits")((void)0); |
| 409 | Mask |= mask; |
| 410 | } |
| 411 | |
| 412 | /// Return true if the set contains any qualifiers which require an ExtQuals |
| 413 | /// node to be allocated. |
| 414 | bool hasNonFastQualifiers() const { return Mask & ~FastMask; } |
| 415 | Qualifiers getNonFastQualifiers() const { |
| 416 | Qualifiers Quals = *this; |
| 417 | Quals.setFastQualifiers(0); |
| 418 | return Quals; |
| 419 | } |
| 420 | |
| 421 | /// Return true if the set contains any qualifiers. |
| 422 | bool hasQualifiers() const { return Mask; } |
| 423 | bool empty() const { return !Mask; } |
| 424 | |
| 425 | /// Add the qualifiers from the given set to this set. |
| 426 | void addQualifiers(Qualifiers Q) { |
| 427 | // If the other set doesn't have any non-boolean qualifiers, just |
| 428 | // bit-or it in. |
| 429 | if (!(Q.Mask & ~CVRMask)) |
| 430 | Mask |= Q.Mask; |
| 431 | else { |
| 432 | Mask |= (Q.Mask & CVRMask); |
| 433 | if (Q.hasAddressSpace()) |
| 434 | addAddressSpace(Q.getAddressSpace()); |
| 435 | if (Q.hasObjCGCAttr()) |
| 436 | addObjCGCAttr(Q.getObjCGCAttr()); |
| 437 | if (Q.hasObjCLifetime()) |
| 438 | addObjCLifetime(Q.getObjCLifetime()); |
| 439 | } |
| 440 | } |
| 441 | |
| 442 | /// Remove the qualifiers from the given set from this set. |
| 443 | void removeQualifiers(Qualifiers Q) { |
| 444 | // If the other set doesn't have any non-boolean qualifiers, just |
| 445 | // bit-and the inverse in. |
| 446 | if (!(Q.Mask & ~CVRMask)) |
| 447 | Mask &= ~Q.Mask; |
| 448 | else { |
| 449 | Mask &= ~(Q.Mask & CVRMask); |
| 450 | if (getObjCGCAttr() == Q.getObjCGCAttr()) |
| 451 | removeObjCGCAttr(); |
| 452 | if (getObjCLifetime() == Q.getObjCLifetime()) |
| 453 | removeObjCLifetime(); |
| 454 | if (getAddressSpace() == Q.getAddressSpace()) |
| 455 | removeAddressSpace(); |
| 456 | } |
| 457 | } |
| 458 | |
| 459 | /// Add the qualifiers from the given set to this set, given that |
| 460 | /// they don't conflict. |
| 461 | void addConsistentQualifiers(Qualifiers qs) { |
| 462 | assert(getAddressSpace() == qs.getAddressSpace() ||((void)0) |
| 463 | !hasAddressSpace() || !qs.hasAddressSpace())((void)0); |
| 464 | assert(getObjCGCAttr() == qs.getObjCGCAttr() ||((void)0) |
| 465 | !hasObjCGCAttr() || !qs.hasObjCGCAttr())((void)0); |
| 466 | assert(getObjCLifetime() == qs.getObjCLifetime() ||((void)0) |
| 467 | !hasObjCLifetime() || !qs.hasObjCLifetime())((void)0); |
| 468 | Mask |= qs.Mask; |
| 469 | } |
| 470 | |
| 471 | /// Returns true if address space A is equal to or a superset of B. |
| 472 | /// OpenCL v2.0 defines conversion rules (OpenCLC v2.0 s6.5.5) and notion of |
| 473 | /// overlapping address spaces. |
| 474 | /// CL1.1 or CL1.2: |
| 475 | /// every address space is a superset of itself. |
| 476 | /// CL2.0 adds: |
| 477 | /// __generic is a superset of any address space except for __constant. |
| 478 | static bool isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(LangAS A, LangAS B) { |
| 479 | // Address spaces must match exactly. |
| 480 | return A == B || |
| 481 | // Otherwise in OpenCLC v2.0 s6.5.5: every address space except |
| 482 | // for __constant can be used as __generic. |
| 483 | (A == LangAS::opencl_generic && B != LangAS::opencl_constant) || |
| 484 | // We also define global_device and global_host address spaces, |
| 485 | // to distinguish global pointers allocated on host from pointers |
| 486 | // allocated on device, which are a subset of __global. |
| 487 | (A == LangAS::opencl_global && (B == LangAS::opencl_global_device || |
| 488 | B == LangAS::opencl_global_host)) || |
| 489 | (A == LangAS::sycl_global && (B == LangAS::sycl_global_device || |
| 490 | B == LangAS::sycl_global_host)) || |
| 491 | // Consider pointer size address spaces to be equivalent to default. |
| 492 | ((isPtrSizeAddressSpace(A) || A == LangAS::Default) && |
| 493 | (isPtrSizeAddressSpace(B) || B == LangAS::Default)) || |
| 494 | // Default is a superset of SYCL address spaces. |
| 495 | (A == LangAS::Default && |
| 496 | (B == LangAS::sycl_private || B == LangAS::sycl_local || |
| 497 | B == LangAS::sycl_global || B == LangAS::sycl_global_device || |
| 498 | B == LangAS::sycl_global_host)); |
| 499 | } |
| 500 | |
| 501 | /// Returns true if the address space in these qualifiers is equal to or |
| 502 | /// a superset of the address space in the argument qualifiers. |
| 503 | bool isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(Qualifiers other) const { |
| 504 | return isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(getAddressSpace(), other.getAddressSpace()); |
| 505 | } |
| 506 | |
| 507 | /// Determines if these qualifiers compatibly include another set. |
| 508 | /// Generally this answers the question of whether an object with the other |
| 509 | /// qualifiers can be safely used as an object with these qualifiers. |
| 510 | bool compatiblyIncludes(Qualifiers other) const { |
| 511 | return isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(other) && |
| 512 | // ObjC GC qualifiers can match, be added, or be removed, but can't |
| 513 | // be changed. |
| 514 | (getObjCGCAttr() == other.getObjCGCAttr() || !hasObjCGCAttr() || |
| 515 | !other.hasObjCGCAttr()) && |
| 516 | // ObjC lifetime qualifiers must match exactly. |
| 517 | getObjCLifetime() == other.getObjCLifetime() && |
| 518 | // CVR qualifiers may subset. |
| 519 | (((Mask & CVRMask) | (other.Mask & CVRMask)) == (Mask & CVRMask)) && |
| 520 | // U qualifier may superset. |
| 521 | (!other.hasUnaligned() || hasUnaligned()); |
| 522 | } |
| 523 | |
| 524 | /// Determines if these qualifiers compatibly include another set of |
| 525 | /// qualifiers from the narrow perspective of Objective-C ARC lifetime. |
| 526 | /// |
| 527 | /// One set of Objective-C lifetime qualifiers compatibly includes the other |
| 528 | /// if the lifetime qualifiers match, or if both are non-__weak and the |
| 529 | /// including set also contains the 'const' qualifier, or both are non-__weak |
| 530 | /// and one is None (which can only happen in non-ARC modes). |
| 531 | bool compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(Qualifiers other) const { |
| 532 | if (getObjCLifetime() == other.getObjCLifetime()) |
| 533 | return true; |
| 534 | |
| 535 | if (getObjCLifetime() == OCL_Weak || other.getObjCLifetime() == OCL_Weak) |
| 536 | return false; |
| 537 | |
| 538 | if (getObjCLifetime() == OCL_None || other.getObjCLifetime() == OCL_None) |
| 539 | return true; |
| 540 | |
| 541 | return hasConst(); |
| 542 | } |
| 543 | |
| 544 | /// Determine whether this set of qualifiers is a strict superset of |
| 545 | /// another set of qualifiers, not considering qualifier compatibility. |
| 546 | bool isStrictSupersetOf(Qualifiers Other) const; |
| 547 | |
| 548 | bool operator==(Qualifiers Other) const { return Mask == Other.Mask; } |
| 549 | bool operator!=(Qualifiers Other) const { return Mask != Other.Mask; } |
| 550 | |
| 551 | explicit operator bool() const { return hasQualifiers(); } |
| 552 | |
| 553 | Qualifiers &operator+=(Qualifiers R) { |
| 554 | addQualifiers(R); |
| 555 | return *this; |
| 556 | } |
| 557 | |
| 558 | // Union two qualifier sets. If an enumerated qualifier appears |
| 559 | // in both sets, use the one from the right. |
| 560 | friend Qualifiers operator+(Qualifiers L, Qualifiers R) { |
| 561 | L += R; |
| 562 | return L; |
| 563 | } |
| 564 | |
| 565 | Qualifiers &operator-=(Qualifiers R) { |
| 566 | removeQualifiers(R); |
| 567 | return *this; |
| 568 | } |
| 569 | |
| 570 | /// Compute the difference between two qualifier sets. |
| 571 | friend Qualifiers operator-(Qualifiers L, Qualifiers R) { |
| 572 | L -= R; |
| 573 | return L; |
| 574 | } |
| 575 | |
| 576 | std::string getAsString() const; |
| 577 | std::string getAsString(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const; |
| 578 | |
| 579 | static std::string getAddrSpaceAsString(LangAS AS); |
| 580 | |
| 581 | bool isEmptyWhenPrinted(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const; |
| 582 | void print(raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &Policy, |
| 583 | bool appendSpaceIfNonEmpty = false) const; |
| 584 | |
| 585 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const { |
| 586 | ID.AddInteger(Mask); |
| 587 | } |
| 588 | |
| 589 | private: |
| 590 | // bits: |0 1 2|3|4 .. 5|6 .. 8|9 ... 31| |
| 591 | // |C R V|U|GCAttr|Lifetime|AddressSpace| |
| 592 | uint32_t Mask = 0; |
| 593 | |
| 594 | static const uint32_t UMask = 0x8; |
| 595 | static const uint32_t UShift = 3; |
| 596 | static const uint32_t GCAttrMask = 0x30; |
| 597 | static const uint32_t GCAttrShift = 4; |
| 598 | static const uint32_t LifetimeMask = 0x1C0; |
| 599 | static const uint32_t LifetimeShift = 6; |
| 600 | static const uint32_t AddressSpaceMask = |
| 601 | ~(CVRMask | UMask | GCAttrMask | LifetimeMask); |
| 602 | static const uint32_t AddressSpaceShift = 9; |
| 603 | }; |
| 604 | |
| 605 | /// A std::pair-like structure for storing a qualified type split |
| 606 | /// into its local qualifiers and its locally-unqualified type. |
| 607 | struct SplitQualType { |
| 608 | /// The locally-unqualified type. |
| 609 | const Type *Ty = nullptr; |
| 610 | |
| 611 | /// The local qualifiers. |
| 612 | Qualifiers Quals; |
| 613 | |
| 614 | SplitQualType() = default; |
| 615 | SplitQualType(const Type *ty, Qualifiers qs) : Ty(ty), Quals(qs) {} |
| 616 | |
| 617 | SplitQualType getSingleStepDesugaredType() const; // end of this file |
| 618 | |
| 619 | // Make std::tie work. |
| 620 | std::pair<const Type *,Qualifiers> asPair() const { |
| 621 | return std::pair<const Type *, Qualifiers>(Ty, Quals); |
| 622 | } |
| 623 | |
| 624 | friend bool operator==(SplitQualType a, SplitQualType b) { |
| 625 | return a.Ty == b.Ty && a.Quals == b.Quals; |
| 626 | } |
| 627 | friend bool operator!=(SplitQualType a, SplitQualType b) { |
| 628 | return a.Ty != b.Ty || a.Quals != b.Quals; |
| 629 | } |
| 630 | }; |
| 631 | |
| 632 | /// The kind of type we are substituting Objective-C type arguments into. |
| 633 | /// |
| 634 | /// The kind of substitution affects the replacement of type parameters when |
| 635 | /// no concrete type information is provided, e.g., when dealing with an |
| 636 | /// unspecialized type. |
| 637 | enum class ObjCSubstitutionContext { |
| 638 | /// An ordinary type. |
| 639 | Ordinary, |
| 640 | |
| 641 | /// The result type of a method or function. |
| 642 | Result, |
| 643 | |
| 644 | /// The parameter type of a method or function. |
| 645 | Parameter, |
| 646 | |
| 647 | /// The type of a property. |
| 648 | Property, |
| 649 | |
| 650 | /// The superclass of a type. |
| 651 | Superclass, |
| 652 | }; |
| 653 | |
| 654 | /// A (possibly-)qualified type. |
| 655 | /// |
| 656 | /// For efficiency, we don't store CV-qualified types as nodes on their |
| 657 | /// own: instead each reference to a type stores the qualifiers. This |
| 658 | /// greatly reduces the number of nodes we need to allocate for types (for |
| 659 | /// example we only need one for 'int', 'const int', 'volatile int', |
| 660 | /// 'const volatile int', etc). |
| 661 | /// |
| 662 | /// As an added efficiency bonus, instead of making this a pair, we |
| 663 | /// just store the two bits we care about in the low bits of the |
| 664 | /// pointer. To handle the packing/unpacking, we make QualType be a |
| 665 | /// simple wrapper class that acts like a smart pointer. A third bit |
| 666 | /// indicates whether there are extended qualifiers present, in which |
| 667 | /// case the pointer points to a special structure. |
| 668 | class QualType { |
| 669 | friend class QualifierCollector; |
| 670 | |
| 671 | // Thankfully, these are efficiently composable. |
| 672 | llvm::PointerIntPair<llvm::PointerUnion<const Type *, const ExtQuals *>, |
| 673 | Qualifiers::FastWidth> Value; |
| 674 | |
| 675 | const ExtQuals *getExtQualsUnsafe() const { |
| 676 | return Value.getPointer().get<const ExtQuals*>(); |
| 677 | } |
| 678 | |
| 679 | const Type *getTypePtrUnsafe() const { |
| 680 | return Value.getPointer().get<const Type*>(); |
| 681 | } |
| 682 | |
| 683 | const ExtQualsTypeCommonBase *getCommonPtr() const { |
| 684 | assert(!isNull() && "Cannot retrieve a NULL type pointer")((void)0); |
| 685 | auto CommonPtrVal = reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(Value.getOpaqueValue()); |
| 686 | CommonPtrVal &= ~(uintptr_t)((1 << TypeAlignmentInBits) - 1); |
| 687 | return reinterpret_cast<ExtQualsTypeCommonBase*>(CommonPtrVal); |
| 688 | } |
| 689 | |
| 690 | public: |
| 691 | QualType() = default; |
| 692 | QualType(const Type *Ptr, unsigned Quals) : Value(Ptr, Quals) {} |
| 693 | QualType(const ExtQuals *Ptr, unsigned Quals) : Value(Ptr, Quals) {} |
| 694 | |
| 695 | unsigned getLocalFastQualifiers() const { return Value.getInt(); } |
| 696 | void setLocalFastQualifiers(unsigned Quals) { Value.setInt(Quals); } |
| 697 | |
| 698 | /// Retrieves a pointer to the underlying (unqualified) type. |
| 699 | /// |
| 700 | /// This function requires that the type not be NULL. If the type might be |
| 701 | /// NULL, use the (slightly less efficient) \c getTypePtrOrNull(). |
| 702 | const Type *getTypePtr() const; |
| 703 | |
| 704 | const Type *getTypePtrOrNull() const; |
| 705 | |
| 706 | /// Retrieves a pointer to the name of the base type. |
| 707 | const IdentifierInfo *getBaseTypeIdentifier() const; |
| 708 | |
| 709 | /// Divides a QualType into its unqualified type and a set of local |
| 710 | /// qualifiers. |
| 711 | SplitQualType split() const; |
| 712 | |
| 713 | void *getAsOpaquePtr() const { return Value.getOpaqueValue(); } |
| 714 | |
| 715 | static QualType getFromOpaquePtr(const void *Ptr) { |
| 716 | QualType T; |
| 717 | T.Value.setFromOpaqueValue(const_cast<void*>(Ptr)); |
| 718 | return T; |
| 719 | } |
| 720 | |
| 721 | const Type &operator*() const { |
| 722 | return *getTypePtr(); |
| 723 | } |
| 724 | |
| 725 | const Type *operator->() const { |
| 726 | return getTypePtr(); |
| 727 | } |
| 728 | |
| 729 | bool isCanonical() const; |
| 730 | bool isCanonicalAsParam() const; |
| 731 | |
| 732 | /// Return true if this QualType doesn't point to a type yet. |
| 733 | bool isNull() const { |
| 734 | return Value.getPointer().isNull(); |
| 735 | } |
| 736 | |
| 737 | /// Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the |
| 738 | /// "const" qualifier set, without looking through typedefs that may have |
| 739 | /// added "const" at a different level. |
| 740 | bool isLocalConstQualified() const { |
| 741 | return (getLocalFastQualifiers() & Qualifiers::Const); |
| 742 | } |
| 743 | |
| 744 | /// Determine whether this type is const-qualified. |
| 745 | bool isConstQualified() const; |
| 746 | |
| 747 | /// Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the |
| 748 | /// "restrict" qualifier set, without looking through typedefs that may have |
| 749 | /// added "restrict" at a different level. |
| 750 | bool isLocalRestrictQualified() const { |
| 751 | return (getLocalFastQualifiers() & Qualifiers::Restrict); |
| 752 | } |
| 753 | |
| 754 | /// Determine whether this type is restrict-qualified. |
| 755 | bool isRestrictQualified() const; |
| 756 | |
| 757 | /// Determine whether this particular QualType instance has the |
| 758 | /// "volatile" qualifier set, without looking through typedefs that may have |
| 759 | /// added "volatile" at a different level. |
| 760 | bool isLocalVolatileQualified() const { |
| 761 | return (getLocalFastQualifiers() & Qualifiers::Volatile); |
| 762 | } |
| 763 | |
| 764 | /// Determine whether this type is volatile-qualified. |
| 765 | bool isVolatileQualified() const; |
| 766 | |
| 767 | /// Determine whether this particular QualType instance has any |
| 768 | /// qualifiers, without looking through any typedefs that might add |
| 769 | /// qualifiers at a different level. |
| 770 | bool hasLocalQualifiers() const { |
| 771 | return getLocalFastQualifiers() || hasLocalNonFastQualifiers(); |
| 772 | } |
| 773 | |
| 774 | /// Determine whether this type has any qualifiers. |
| 775 | bool hasQualifiers() const; |
| 776 | |
| 777 | /// Determine whether this particular QualType instance has any |
| 778 | /// "non-fast" qualifiers, e.g., those that are stored in an ExtQualType |
| 779 | /// instance. |
| 780 | bool hasLocalNonFastQualifiers() const { |
| 781 | return Value.getPointer().is<const ExtQuals*>(); |
| 782 | } |
| 783 | |
| 784 | /// Retrieve the set of qualifiers local to this particular QualType |
| 785 | /// instance, not including any qualifiers acquired through typedefs or |
| 786 | /// other sugar. |
| 787 | Qualifiers getLocalQualifiers() const; |
| 788 | |
| 789 | /// Retrieve the set of qualifiers applied to this type. |
| 790 | Qualifiers getQualifiers() const; |
| 791 | |
| 792 | /// Retrieve the set of CVR (const-volatile-restrict) qualifiers |
| 793 | /// local to this particular QualType instance, not including any qualifiers |
| 794 | /// acquired through typedefs or other sugar. |
| 795 | unsigned getLocalCVRQualifiers() const { |
| 796 | return getLocalFastQualifiers(); |
| 797 | } |
| 798 | |
| 799 | /// Retrieve the set of CVR (const-volatile-restrict) qualifiers |
| 800 | /// applied to this type. |
| 801 | unsigned getCVRQualifiers() const; |
| 802 | |
| 803 | bool isConstant(const ASTContext& Ctx) const { |
| 804 | return QualType::isConstant(*this, Ctx); |
| 805 | } |
| 806 | |
| 807 | /// Determine whether this is a Plain Old Data (POD) type (C++ 3.9p10). |
| 808 | bool isPODType(const ASTContext &Context) const; |
| 809 | |
| 810 | /// Return true if this is a POD type according to the rules of the C++98 |
| 811 | /// standard, regardless of the current compilation's language. |
| 812 | bool isCXX98PODType(const ASTContext &Context) const; |
| 813 | |
| 814 | /// Return true if this is a POD type according to the more relaxed rules |
| 815 | /// of the C++11 standard, regardless of the current compilation's language. |
| 816 | /// (C++0x [basic.types]p9). Note that, unlike |
| 817 | /// CXXRecordDecl::isCXX11StandardLayout, this takes DRs into account. |
| 818 | bool isCXX11PODType(const ASTContext &Context) const; |
| 819 | |
| 820 | /// Return true if this is a trivial type per (C++0x [basic.types]p9) |
| 821 | bool isTrivialType(const ASTContext &Context) const; |
| 822 | |
| 823 | /// Return true if this is a trivially copyable type (C++0x [basic.types]p9) |
| 824 | bool isTriviallyCopyableType(const ASTContext &Context) const; |
| 825 | |
| 826 | |
| 827 | /// Returns true if it is a class and it might be dynamic. |
| 828 | bool mayBeDynamicClass() const; |
| 829 | |
| 830 | /// Returns true if it is not a class or if the class might not be dynamic. |
| 831 | bool mayBeNotDynamicClass() const; |
| 832 | |
| 833 | // Don't promise in the API that anything besides 'const' can be |
| 834 | // easily added. |
| 835 | |
| 836 | /// Add the `const` type qualifier to this QualType. |
| 837 | void addConst() { |
| 838 | addFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Const); |
| 839 | } |
| 840 | QualType withConst() const { |
| 841 | return withFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Const); |
| 842 | } |
| 843 | |
| 844 | /// Add the `volatile` type qualifier to this QualType. |
| 845 | void addVolatile() { |
| 846 | addFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Volatile); |
| 847 | } |
| 848 | QualType withVolatile() const { |
| 849 | return withFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Volatile); |
| 850 | } |
| 851 | |
| 852 | /// Add the `restrict` qualifier to this QualType. |
| 853 | void addRestrict() { |
| 854 | addFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Restrict); |
| 855 | } |
| 856 | QualType withRestrict() const { |
| 857 | return withFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Restrict); |
| 858 | } |
| 859 | |
| 860 | QualType withCVRQualifiers(unsigned CVR) const { |
| 861 | return withFastQualifiers(CVR); |
| 862 | } |
| 863 | |
| 864 | void addFastQualifiers(unsigned TQs) { |
| 865 | assert(!(TQs & ~Qualifiers::FastMask)((void)0) |
| 866 | && "non-fast qualifier bits set in mask!")((void)0); |
| 867 | Value.setInt(Value.getInt() | TQs); |
| 868 | } |
| 869 | |
| 870 | void removeLocalConst(); |
| 871 | void removeLocalVolatile(); |
| 872 | void removeLocalRestrict(); |
| 873 | void removeLocalCVRQualifiers(unsigned Mask); |
| 874 | |
| 875 | void removeLocalFastQualifiers() { Value.setInt(0); } |
| 876 | void removeLocalFastQualifiers(unsigned Mask) { |
| 877 | assert(!(Mask & ~Qualifiers::FastMask) && "mask has non-fast qualifiers")((void)0); |
| 878 | Value.setInt(Value.getInt() & ~Mask); |
| 879 | } |
| 880 | |
| 881 | // Creates a type with the given qualifiers in addition to any |
| 882 | // qualifiers already on this type. |
| 883 | QualType withFastQualifiers(unsigned TQs) const { |
| 884 | QualType T = *this; |
| 885 | T.addFastQualifiers(TQs); |
| 886 | return T; |
| 887 | } |
| 888 | |
| 889 | // Creates a type with exactly the given fast qualifiers, removing |
| 890 | // any existing fast qualifiers. |
| 891 | QualType withExactLocalFastQualifiers(unsigned TQs) const { |
| 892 | return withoutLocalFastQualifiers().withFastQualifiers(TQs); |
| 893 | } |
| 894 | |
| 895 | // Removes fast qualifiers, but leaves any extended qualifiers in place. |
| 896 | QualType withoutLocalFastQualifiers() const { |
| 897 | QualType T = *this; |
| 898 | T.removeLocalFastQualifiers(); |
| 899 | return T; |
| 900 | } |
| 901 | |
| 902 | QualType getCanonicalType() const; |
| 903 | |
| 904 | /// Return this type with all of the instance-specific qualifiers |
| 905 | /// removed, but without removing any qualifiers that may have been applied |
| 906 | /// through typedefs. |
| 907 | QualType getLocalUnqualifiedType() const { return QualType(getTypePtr(), 0); } |
| 908 | |
| 909 | /// Retrieve the unqualified variant of the given type, |
| 910 | /// removing as little sugar as possible. |
| 911 | /// |
| 912 | /// This routine looks through various kinds of sugar to find the |
| 913 | /// least-desugared type that is unqualified. For example, given: |
| 914 | /// |
| 915 | /// \code |
| 916 | /// typedef int Integer; |
| 917 | /// typedef const Integer CInteger; |
| 918 | /// typedef CInteger DifferenceType; |
| 919 | /// \endcode |
| 920 | /// |
| 921 | /// Executing \c getUnqualifiedType() on the type \c DifferenceType will |
| 922 | /// desugar until we hit the type \c Integer, which has no qualifiers on it. |
| 923 | /// |
| 924 | /// The resulting type might still be qualified if it's sugar for an array |
| 925 | /// type. To strip qualifiers even from within a sugared array type, use |
| 926 | /// ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType. |
| 927 | inline QualType getUnqualifiedType() const; |
| 928 | |
| 929 | /// Retrieve the unqualified variant of the given type, removing as little |
| 930 | /// sugar as possible. |
| 931 | /// |
| 932 | /// Like getUnqualifiedType(), but also returns the set of |
| 933 | /// qualifiers that were built up. |
| 934 | /// |
| 935 | /// The resulting type might still be qualified if it's sugar for an array |
| 936 | /// type. To strip qualifiers even from within a sugared array type, use |
| 937 | /// ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType. |
| 938 | inline SplitQualType getSplitUnqualifiedType() const; |
| 939 | |
| 940 | /// Determine whether this type is more qualified than the other |
| 941 | /// given type, requiring exact equality for non-CVR qualifiers. |
| 942 | bool isMoreQualifiedThan(QualType Other) const; |
| 943 | |
| 944 | /// Determine whether this type is at least as qualified as the other |
| 945 | /// given type, requiring exact equality for non-CVR qualifiers. |
| 946 | bool isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(QualType Other) const; |
| 947 | |
| 948 | QualType getNonReferenceType() const; |
| 949 | |
| 950 | /// Determine the type of a (typically non-lvalue) expression with the |
| 951 | /// specified result type. |
| 952 | /// |
| 953 | /// This routine should be used for expressions for which the return type is |
| 954 | /// explicitly specified (e.g., in a cast or call) and isn't necessarily |
| 955 | /// an lvalue. It removes a top-level reference (since there are no |
| 956 | /// expressions of reference type) and deletes top-level cvr-qualifiers |
| 957 | /// from non-class types (in C++) or all types (in C). |
| 958 | QualType getNonLValueExprType(const ASTContext &Context) const; |
| 959 | |
| 960 | /// Remove an outer pack expansion type (if any) from this type. Used as part |
| 961 | /// of converting the type of a declaration to the type of an expression that |
| 962 | /// references that expression. It's meaningless for an expression to have a |
| 963 | /// pack expansion type. |
| 964 | QualType getNonPackExpansionType() const; |
| 965 | |
| 966 | /// Return the specified type with any "sugar" removed from |
| 967 | /// the type. This takes off typedefs, typeof's etc. If the outer level of |
| 968 | /// the type is already concrete, it returns it unmodified. This is similar |
| 969 | /// to getting the canonical type, but it doesn't remove *all* typedefs. For |
| 970 | /// example, it returns "T*" as "T*", (not as "int*"), because the pointer is |
| 971 | /// concrete. |
| 972 | /// |
| 973 | /// Qualifiers are left in place. |
| 974 | QualType getDesugaredType(const ASTContext &Context) const { |
| 975 | return getDesugaredType(*this, Context); |
| 976 | } |
| 977 | |
| 978 | SplitQualType getSplitDesugaredType() const { |
| 979 | return getSplitDesugaredType(*this); |
| 980 | } |
| 981 | |
| 982 | /// Return the specified type with one level of "sugar" removed from |
| 983 | /// the type. |
| 984 | /// |
| 985 | /// This routine takes off the first typedef, typeof, etc. If the outer level |
| 986 | /// of the type is already concrete, it returns it unmodified. |
| 987 | QualType getSingleStepDesugaredType(const ASTContext &Context) const { |
| 988 | return getSingleStepDesugaredTypeImpl(*this, Context); |
| 989 | } |
| 990 | |
| 991 | /// Returns the specified type after dropping any |
| 992 | /// outer-level parentheses. |
| 993 | QualType IgnoreParens() const { |
| 994 | if (isa<ParenType>(*this)) |
| 995 | return QualType::IgnoreParens(*this); |
| 996 | return *this; |
| 997 | } |
| 998 | |
| 999 | /// Indicate whether the specified types and qualifiers are identical. |
| 1000 | friend bool operator==(const QualType &LHS, const QualType &RHS) { |
| 1001 | return LHS.Value == RHS.Value; |
| 1002 | } |
| 1003 | friend bool operator!=(const QualType &LHS, const QualType &RHS) { |
| 1004 | return LHS.Value != RHS.Value; |
| 1005 | } |
| 1006 | friend bool operator<(const QualType &LHS, const QualType &RHS) { |
| 1007 | return LHS.Value < RHS.Value; |
| 1008 | } |
| 1009 | |
| 1010 | static std::string getAsString(SplitQualType split, |
| 1011 | const PrintingPolicy &Policy) { |
| 1012 | return getAsString(split.Ty, split.Quals, Policy); |
| 1013 | } |
| 1014 | static std::string getAsString(const Type *ty, Qualifiers qs, |
| 1015 | const PrintingPolicy &Policy); |
| 1016 | |
| 1017 | std::string getAsString() const; |
| 1018 | std::string getAsString(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const; |
| 1019 | |
| 1020 | void print(raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &Policy, |
| 1021 | const Twine &PlaceHolder = Twine(), |
| 1022 | unsigned Indentation = 0) const; |
| 1023 | |
| 1024 | static void print(SplitQualType split, raw_ostream &OS, |
| 1025 | const PrintingPolicy &policy, const Twine &PlaceHolder, |
| 1026 | unsigned Indentation = 0) { |
| 1027 | return print(split.Ty, split.Quals, OS, policy, PlaceHolder, Indentation); |
| 1028 | } |
| 1029 | |
| 1030 | static void print(const Type *ty, Qualifiers qs, |
| 1031 | raw_ostream &OS, const PrintingPolicy &policy, |
| 1032 | const Twine &PlaceHolder, |
| 1033 | unsigned Indentation = 0); |
| 1034 | |
| 1035 | void getAsStringInternal(std::string &Str, |
| 1036 | const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const; |
| 1037 | |
| 1038 | static void getAsStringInternal(SplitQualType split, std::string &out, |
| 1039 | const PrintingPolicy &policy) { |
| 1040 | return getAsStringInternal(split.Ty, split.Quals, out, policy); |
| 1041 | } |
| 1042 | |
| 1043 | static void getAsStringInternal(const Type *ty, Qualifiers qs, |
| 1044 | std::string &out, |
| 1045 | const PrintingPolicy &policy); |
| 1046 | |
| 1047 | class StreamedQualTypeHelper { |
| 1048 | const QualType &T; |
| 1049 | const PrintingPolicy &Policy; |
| 1050 | const Twine &PlaceHolder; |
| 1051 | unsigned Indentation; |
| 1052 | |
| 1053 | public: |
| 1054 | StreamedQualTypeHelper(const QualType &T, const PrintingPolicy &Policy, |
| 1055 | const Twine &PlaceHolder, unsigned Indentation) |
| 1056 | : T(T), Policy(Policy), PlaceHolder(PlaceHolder), |
| 1057 | Indentation(Indentation) {} |
| 1058 | |
| 1059 | friend raw_ostream &operator<<(raw_ostream &OS, |
| 1060 | const StreamedQualTypeHelper &SQT) { |
| 1061 | SQT.T.print(OS, SQT.Policy, SQT.PlaceHolder, SQT.Indentation); |
| 1062 | return OS; |
| 1063 | } |
| 1064 | }; |
| 1065 | |
| 1066 | StreamedQualTypeHelper stream(const PrintingPolicy &Policy, |
| 1067 | const Twine &PlaceHolder = Twine(), |
| 1068 | unsigned Indentation = 0) const { |
| 1069 | return StreamedQualTypeHelper(*this, Policy, PlaceHolder, Indentation); |
| 1070 | } |
| 1071 | |
| 1072 | void dump(const char *s) const; |
| 1073 | void dump() const; |
| 1074 | void dump(llvm::raw_ostream &OS, const ASTContext &Context) const; |
| 1075 | |
| 1076 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const { |
| 1077 | ID.AddPointer(getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 1078 | } |
| 1079 | |
| 1080 | /// Check if this type has any address space qualifier. |
| 1081 | inline bool hasAddressSpace() const; |
| 1082 | |
| 1083 | /// Return the address space of this type. |
| 1084 | inline LangAS getAddressSpace() const; |
| 1085 | |
| 1086 | /// Returns true if address space qualifiers overlap with T address space |
| 1087 | /// qualifiers. |
| 1088 | /// OpenCL C defines conversion rules for pointers to different address spaces |
| 1089 | /// and notion of overlapping address spaces. |
| 1090 | /// CL1.1 or CL1.2: |
| 1091 | /// address spaces overlap iff they are they same. |
| 1092 | /// OpenCL C v2.0 s6.5.5 adds: |
| 1093 | /// __generic overlaps with any address space except for __constant. |
| 1094 | bool isAddressSpaceOverlapping(QualType T) const { |
| 1095 | Qualifiers Q = getQualifiers(); |
| 1096 | Qualifiers TQ = T.getQualifiers(); |
| 1097 | // Address spaces overlap if at least one of them is a superset of another |
| 1098 | return Q.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(TQ) || TQ.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(Q); |
| 1099 | } |
| 1100 | |
| 1101 | /// Returns gc attribute of this type. |
| 1102 | inline Qualifiers::GC getObjCGCAttr() const; |
| 1103 | |
| 1104 | /// true when Type is objc's weak. |
| 1105 | bool isObjCGCWeak() const { |
| 1106 | return getObjCGCAttr() == Qualifiers::Weak; |
| 1107 | } |
| 1108 | |
| 1109 | /// true when Type is objc's strong. |
| 1110 | bool isObjCGCStrong() const { |
| 1111 | return getObjCGCAttr() == Qualifiers::Strong; |
| 1112 | } |
| 1113 | |
| 1114 | /// Returns lifetime attribute of this type. |
| 1115 | Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime getObjCLifetime() const { |
| 1116 | return getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime(); |
| 1117 | } |
| 1118 | |
| 1119 | bool hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() const { |
| 1120 | return getQualifiers().hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime(); |
| 1121 | } |
| 1122 | |
| 1123 | bool hasStrongOrWeakObjCLifetime() const { |
| 1124 | return getQualifiers().hasStrongOrWeakObjCLifetime(); |
| 1125 | } |
| 1126 | |
| 1127 | // true when Type is objc's weak and weak is enabled but ARC isn't. |
| 1128 | bool isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(const ASTContext &Context) const; |
| 1129 | |
| 1130 | enum PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind { |
| 1131 | /// The type does not fall into any of the following categories. Note that |
| 1132 | /// this case is zero-valued so that values of this enum can be used as a |
| 1133 | /// boolean condition for non-triviality. |
| 1134 | PDIK_Trivial, |
| 1135 | |
| 1136 | /// The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified |
| 1137 | /// with the ARC __strong qualifier. |
| 1138 | PDIK_ARCStrong, |
| 1139 | |
| 1140 | /// The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified |
| 1141 | /// with the ARC __weak qualifier. |
| 1142 | PDIK_ARCWeak, |
| 1143 | |
| 1144 | /// The type is a struct containing a field whose type is not PCK_Trivial. |
| 1145 | PDIK_Struct |
| 1146 | }; |
| 1147 | |
| 1148 | /// Functions to query basic properties of non-trivial C struct types. |
| 1149 | |
| 1150 | /// Check if this is a non-trivial type that would cause a C struct |
| 1151 | /// transitively containing this type to be non-trivial to default initialize |
| 1152 | /// and return the kind. |
| 1153 | PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind |
| 1154 | isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize() const; |
| 1155 | |
| 1156 | enum PrimitiveCopyKind { |
| 1157 | /// The type does not fall into any of the following categories. Note that |
| 1158 | /// this case is zero-valued so that values of this enum can be used as a |
| 1159 | /// boolean condition for non-triviality. |
| 1160 | PCK_Trivial, |
| 1161 | |
| 1162 | /// The type would be trivial except that it is volatile-qualified. Types |
| 1163 | /// that fall into one of the other non-trivial cases may additionally be |
| 1164 | /// volatile-qualified. |
| 1165 | PCK_VolatileTrivial, |
| 1166 | |
| 1167 | /// The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified |
| 1168 | /// with the ARC __strong qualifier. |
| 1169 | PCK_ARCStrong, |
| 1170 | |
| 1171 | /// The type is an Objective-C retainable pointer type that is qualified |
| 1172 | /// with the ARC __weak qualifier. |
| 1173 | PCK_ARCWeak, |
| 1174 | |
| 1175 | /// The type is a struct containing a field whose type is neither |
| 1176 | /// PCK_Trivial nor PCK_VolatileTrivial. |
| 1177 | /// Note that a C++ struct type does not necessarily match this; C++ copying |
| 1178 | /// semantics are too complex to express here, in part because they depend |
| 1179 | /// on the exact constructor or assignment operator that is chosen by |
| 1180 | /// overload resolution to do the copy. |
| 1181 | PCK_Struct |
| 1182 | }; |
| 1183 | |
| 1184 | /// Check if this is a non-trivial type that would cause a C struct |
| 1185 | /// transitively containing this type to be non-trivial to copy and return the |
| 1186 | /// kind. |
| 1187 | PrimitiveCopyKind isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy() const; |
| 1188 | |
| 1189 | /// Check if this is a non-trivial type that would cause a C struct |
| 1190 | /// transitively containing this type to be non-trivial to destructively |
| 1191 | /// move and return the kind. Destructive move in this context is a C++-style |
| 1192 | /// move in which the source object is placed in a valid but unspecified state |
| 1193 | /// after it is moved, as opposed to a truly destructive move in which the |
| 1194 | /// source object is placed in an uninitialized state. |
| 1195 | PrimitiveCopyKind isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructiveMove() const; |
| 1196 | |
| 1197 | enum DestructionKind { |
| 1198 | DK_none, |
| 1199 | DK_cxx_destructor, |
| 1200 | DK_objc_strong_lifetime, |
| 1201 | DK_objc_weak_lifetime, |
| 1202 | DK_nontrivial_c_struct |
| 1203 | }; |
| 1204 | |
| 1205 | /// Returns a nonzero value if objects of this type require |
| 1206 | /// non-trivial work to clean up after. Non-zero because it's |
| 1207 | /// conceivable that qualifiers (objc_gc(weak)?) could make |
| 1208 | /// something require destruction. |
| 1209 | DestructionKind isDestructedType() const { |
| 1210 | return isDestructedTypeImpl(*this); |
| 1211 | } |
| 1212 | |
| 1213 | /// Check if this is or contains a C union that is non-trivial to |
| 1214 | /// default-initialize, which is a union that has a member that is non-trivial |
| 1215 | /// to default-initialize. If this returns true, |
| 1216 | /// isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize returns PDIK_Struct. |
| 1217 | bool hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() const; |
| 1218 | |
| 1219 | /// Check if this is or contains a C union that is non-trivial to destruct, |
| 1220 | /// which is a union that has a member that is non-trivial to destruct. If |
| 1221 | /// this returns true, isDestructedType returns DK_nontrivial_c_struct. |
| 1222 | bool hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() const; |
| 1223 | |
| 1224 | /// Check if this is or contains a C union that is non-trivial to copy, which |
| 1225 | /// is a union that has a member that is non-trivial to copy. If this returns |
| 1226 | /// true, isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy returns PCK_Struct. |
| 1227 | bool hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() const; |
| 1228 | |
| 1229 | /// Determine whether expressions of the given type are forbidden |
| 1230 | /// from being lvalues in C. |
| 1231 | /// |
| 1232 | /// The expression types that are forbidden to be lvalues are: |
| 1233 | /// - 'void', but not qualified void |
| 1234 | /// - function types |
| 1235 | /// |
| 1236 | /// The exact rule here is C99 6.3.2.1: |
| 1237 | /// An lvalue is an expression with an object type or an incomplete |
| 1238 | /// type other than void. |
| 1239 | bool isCForbiddenLValueType() const; |
| 1240 | |
| 1241 | /// Substitute type arguments for the Objective-C type parameters used in the |
| 1242 | /// subject type. |
| 1243 | /// |
| 1244 | /// \param ctx ASTContext in which the type exists. |
| 1245 | /// |
| 1246 | /// \param typeArgs The type arguments that will be substituted for the |
| 1247 | /// Objective-C type parameters in the subject type, which are generally |
| 1248 | /// computed via \c Type::getObjCSubstitutions. If empty, the type |
| 1249 | /// parameters will be replaced with their bounds or id/Class, as appropriate |
| 1250 | /// for the context. |
| 1251 | /// |
| 1252 | /// \param context The context in which the subject type was written. |
| 1253 | /// |
| 1254 | /// \returns the resulting type. |
| 1255 | QualType substObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx, |
| 1256 | ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs, |
| 1257 | ObjCSubstitutionContext context) const; |
| 1258 | |
| 1259 | /// Substitute type arguments from an object type for the Objective-C type |
| 1260 | /// parameters used in the subject type. |
| 1261 | /// |
| 1262 | /// This operation combines the computation of type arguments for |
| 1263 | /// substitution (\c Type::getObjCSubstitutions) with the actual process of |
| 1264 | /// substitution (\c QualType::substObjCTypeArgs) for the convenience of |
| 1265 | /// callers that need to perform a single substitution in isolation. |
| 1266 | /// |
| 1267 | /// \param objectType The type of the object whose member type we're |
| 1268 | /// substituting into. For example, this might be the receiver of a message |
| 1269 | /// or the base of a property access. |
| 1270 | /// |
| 1271 | /// \param dc The declaration context from which the subject type was |
| 1272 | /// retrieved, which indicates (for example) which type parameters should |
| 1273 | /// be substituted. |
| 1274 | /// |
| 1275 | /// \param context The context in which the subject type was written. |
| 1276 | /// |
| 1277 | /// \returns the subject type after replacing all of the Objective-C type |
| 1278 | /// parameters with their corresponding arguments. |
| 1279 | QualType substObjCMemberType(QualType objectType, |
| 1280 | const DeclContext *dc, |
| 1281 | ObjCSubstitutionContext context) const; |
| 1282 | |
| 1283 | /// Strip Objective-C "__kindof" types from the given type. |
| 1284 | QualType stripObjCKindOfType(const ASTContext &ctx) const; |
| 1285 | |
| 1286 | /// Remove all qualifiers including _Atomic. |
| 1287 | QualType getAtomicUnqualifiedType() const; |
| 1288 | |
| 1289 | private: |
| 1290 | // These methods are implemented in a separate translation unit; |
| 1291 | // "static"-ize them to avoid creating temporary QualTypes in the |
| 1292 | // caller. |
| 1293 | static bool isConstant(QualType T, const ASTContext& Ctx); |
| 1294 | static QualType getDesugaredType(QualType T, const ASTContext &Context); |
| 1295 | static SplitQualType getSplitDesugaredType(QualType T); |
| 1296 | static SplitQualType getSplitUnqualifiedTypeImpl(QualType type); |
| 1297 | static QualType getSingleStepDesugaredTypeImpl(QualType type, |
| 1298 | const ASTContext &C); |
| 1299 | static QualType IgnoreParens(QualType T); |
| 1300 | static DestructionKind isDestructedTypeImpl(QualType type); |
| 1301 | |
| 1302 | /// Check if \param RD is or contains a non-trivial C union. |
| 1303 | static bool hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(const RecordDecl *RD); |
| 1304 | static bool hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(const RecordDecl *RD); |
| 1305 | static bool hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(const RecordDecl *RD); |
| 1306 | }; |
| 1307 | |
| 1308 | } // namespace clang |
| 1309 | |
| 1310 | namespace llvm { |
| 1311 | |
| 1312 | /// Implement simplify_type for QualType, so that we can dyn_cast from QualType |
| 1313 | /// to a specific Type class. |
| 1314 | template<> struct simplify_type< ::clang::QualType> { |
| 1315 | using SimpleType = const ::clang::Type *; |
| 1316 | |
| 1317 | static SimpleType getSimplifiedValue(::clang::QualType Val) { |
| 1318 | return Val.getTypePtr(); |
| 1319 | } |
| 1320 | }; |
| 1321 | |
| 1322 | // Teach SmallPtrSet that QualType is "basically a pointer". |
| 1323 | template<> |
| 1324 | struct PointerLikeTypeTraits<clang::QualType> { |
| 1325 | static inline void *getAsVoidPointer(clang::QualType P) { |
| 1326 | return P.getAsOpaquePtr(); |
| 1327 | } |
| 1328 | |
| 1329 | static inline clang::QualType getFromVoidPointer(void *P) { |
| 1330 | return clang::QualType::getFromOpaquePtr(P); |
| 1331 | } |
| 1332 | |
| 1333 | // Various qualifiers go in low bits. |
| 1334 | static constexpr int NumLowBitsAvailable = 0; |
| 1335 | }; |
| 1336 | |
| 1337 | } // namespace llvm |
| 1338 | |
| 1339 | namespace clang { |
| 1340 | |
| 1341 | /// Base class that is common to both the \c ExtQuals and \c Type |
| 1342 | /// classes, which allows \c QualType to access the common fields between the |
| 1343 | /// two. |
| 1344 | class ExtQualsTypeCommonBase { |
| 1345 | friend class ExtQuals; |
| 1346 | friend class QualType; |
| 1347 | friend class Type; |
| 1348 | |
| 1349 | /// The "base" type of an extended qualifiers type (\c ExtQuals) or |
| 1350 | /// a self-referential pointer (for \c Type). |
| 1351 | /// |
| 1352 | /// This pointer allows an efficient mapping from a QualType to its |
| 1353 | /// underlying type pointer. |
| 1354 | const Type *const BaseType; |
| 1355 | |
| 1356 | /// The canonical type of this type. A QualType. |
| 1357 | QualType CanonicalType; |
| 1358 | |
| 1359 | ExtQualsTypeCommonBase(const Type *baseType, QualType canon) |
| 1360 | : BaseType(baseType), CanonicalType(canon) {} |
| 1361 | }; |
| 1362 | |
| 1363 | /// We can encode up to four bits in the low bits of a |
| 1364 | /// type pointer, but there are many more type qualifiers that we want |
| 1365 | /// to be able to apply to an arbitrary type. Therefore we have this |
| 1366 | /// struct, intended to be heap-allocated and used by QualType to |
| 1367 | /// store qualifiers. |
| 1368 | /// |
| 1369 | /// The current design tags the 'const', 'restrict', and 'volatile' qualifiers |
| 1370 | /// in three low bits on the QualType pointer; a fourth bit records whether |
| 1371 | /// the pointer is an ExtQuals node. The extended qualifiers (address spaces, |
| 1372 | /// Objective-C GC attributes) are much more rare. |
| 1373 | class ExtQuals : public ExtQualsTypeCommonBase, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 1374 | // NOTE: changing the fast qualifiers should be straightforward as |
| 1375 | // long as you don't make 'const' non-fast. |
| 1376 | // 1. Qualifiers: |
| 1377 | // a) Modify the bitmasks (Qualifiers::TQ and DeclSpec::TQ). |
| 1378 | // Fast qualifiers must occupy the low-order bits. |
| 1379 | // b) Update Qualifiers::FastWidth and FastMask. |
| 1380 | // 2. QualType: |
| 1381 | // a) Update is{Volatile,Restrict}Qualified(), defined inline. |
| 1382 | // b) Update remove{Volatile,Restrict}, defined near the end of |
| 1383 | // this header. |
| 1384 | // 3. ASTContext: |
| 1385 | // a) Update get{Volatile,Restrict}Type. |
| 1386 | |
| 1387 | /// The immutable set of qualifiers applied by this node. Always contains |
| 1388 | /// extended qualifiers. |
| 1389 | Qualifiers Quals; |
| 1390 | |
| 1391 | ExtQuals *this_() { return this; } |
| 1392 | |
| 1393 | public: |
| 1394 | ExtQuals(const Type *baseType, QualType canon, Qualifiers quals) |
| 1395 | : ExtQualsTypeCommonBase(baseType, |
| 1396 | canon.isNull() ? QualType(this_(), 0) : canon), |
| 1397 | Quals(quals) { |
| 1398 | assert(Quals.hasNonFastQualifiers()((void)0) |
| 1399 | && "ExtQuals created with no fast qualifiers")((void)0); |
| 1400 | assert(!Quals.hasFastQualifiers()((void)0) |
| 1401 | && "ExtQuals created with fast qualifiers")((void)0); |
| 1402 | } |
| 1403 | |
| 1404 | Qualifiers getQualifiers() const { return Quals; } |
| 1405 | |
| 1406 | bool hasObjCGCAttr() const { return Quals.hasObjCGCAttr(); } |
| 1407 | Qualifiers::GC getObjCGCAttr() const { return Quals.getObjCGCAttr(); } |
| 1408 | |
| 1409 | bool hasObjCLifetime() const { return Quals.hasObjCLifetime(); } |
| 1410 | Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime getObjCLifetime() const { |
| 1411 | return Quals.getObjCLifetime(); |
| 1412 | } |
| 1413 | |
| 1414 | bool hasAddressSpace() const { return Quals.hasAddressSpace(); } |
| 1415 | LangAS getAddressSpace() const { return Quals.getAddressSpace(); } |
| 1416 | |
| 1417 | const Type *getBaseType() const { return BaseType; } |
| 1418 | |
| 1419 | public: |
| 1420 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const { |
| 1421 | Profile(ID, getBaseType(), Quals); |
| 1422 | } |
| 1423 | |
| 1424 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, |
| 1425 | const Type *BaseType, |
| 1426 | Qualifiers Quals) { |
| 1427 | assert(!Quals.hasFastQualifiers() && "fast qualifiers in ExtQuals hash!")((void)0); |
| 1428 | ID.AddPointer(BaseType); |
| 1429 | Quals.Profile(ID); |
| 1430 | } |
| 1431 | }; |
| 1432 | |
| 1433 | /// The kind of C++11 ref-qualifier associated with a function type. |
| 1434 | /// This determines whether a member function's "this" object can be an |
| 1435 | /// lvalue, rvalue, or neither. |
| 1436 | enum RefQualifierKind { |
| 1437 | /// No ref-qualifier was provided. |
| 1438 | RQ_None = 0, |
| 1439 | |
| 1440 | /// An lvalue ref-qualifier was provided (\c &). |
| 1441 | RQ_LValue, |
| 1442 | |
| 1443 | /// An rvalue ref-qualifier was provided (\c &&). |
| 1444 | RQ_RValue |
| 1445 | }; |
| 1446 | |
| 1447 | /// Which keyword(s) were used to create an AutoType. |
| 1448 | enum class AutoTypeKeyword { |
| 1449 | /// auto |
| 1450 | Auto, |
| 1451 | |
| 1452 | /// decltype(auto) |
| 1453 | DecltypeAuto, |
| 1454 | |
| 1455 | /// __auto_type (GNU extension) |
| 1456 | GNUAutoType |
| 1457 | }; |
| 1458 | |
| 1459 | /// The base class of the type hierarchy. |
| 1460 | /// |
| 1461 | /// A central concept with types is that each type always has a canonical |
| 1462 | /// type. A canonical type is the type with any typedef names stripped out |
| 1463 | /// of it or the types it references. For example, consider: |
| 1464 | /// |
| 1465 | /// typedef int foo; |
| 1466 | /// typedef foo* bar; |
| 1467 | /// 'int *' 'foo *' 'bar' |
| 1468 | /// |
| 1469 | /// There will be a Type object created for 'int'. Since int is canonical, its |
| 1470 | /// CanonicalType pointer points to itself. There is also a Type for 'foo' (a |
| 1471 | /// TypedefType). Its CanonicalType pointer points to the 'int' Type. Next |
| 1472 | /// there is a PointerType that represents 'int*', which, like 'int', is |
| 1473 | /// canonical. Finally, there is a PointerType type for 'foo*' whose canonical |
| 1474 | /// type is 'int*', and there is a TypedefType for 'bar', whose canonical type |
| 1475 | /// is also 'int*'. |
| 1476 | /// |
| 1477 | /// Non-canonical types are useful for emitting diagnostics, without losing |
| 1478 | /// information about typedefs being used. Canonical types are useful for type |
| 1479 | /// comparisons (they allow by-pointer equality tests) and useful for reasoning |
| 1480 | /// about whether something has a particular form (e.g. is a function type), |
| 1481 | /// because they implicitly, recursively, strip all typedefs out of a type. |
| 1482 | /// |
| 1483 | /// Types, once created, are immutable. |
| 1484 | /// |
| 1485 | class alignas(8) Type : public ExtQualsTypeCommonBase { |
| 1486 | public: |
| 1487 | enum TypeClass { |
| 1488 | #define TYPE(Class, Base) Class, |
| 1489 | #define LAST_TYPE(Class) TypeLast = Class |
| 1490 | #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) |
| 1491 | #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc" |
| 1492 | }; |
| 1493 | |
| 1494 | private: |
| 1495 | /// Bitfields required by the Type class. |
| 1496 | class TypeBitfields { |
| 1497 | friend class Type; |
| 1498 | template <class T> friend class TypePropertyCache; |
| 1499 | |
| 1500 | /// TypeClass bitfield - Enum that specifies what subclass this belongs to. |
| 1501 | unsigned TC : 8; |
| 1502 | |
| 1503 | /// Store information on the type dependency. |
| 1504 | unsigned Dependence : llvm::BitWidth<TypeDependence>; |
| 1505 | |
| 1506 | /// True if the cache (i.e. the bitfields here starting with |
| 1507 | /// 'Cache') is valid. |
| 1508 | mutable unsigned CacheValid : 1; |
| 1509 | |
| 1510 | /// Linkage of this type. |
| 1511 | mutable unsigned CachedLinkage : 3; |
| 1512 | |
| 1513 | /// Whether this type involves and local or unnamed types. |
| 1514 | mutable unsigned CachedLocalOrUnnamed : 1; |
| 1515 | |
| 1516 | /// Whether this type comes from an AST file. |
| 1517 | mutable unsigned FromAST : 1; |
| 1518 | |
| 1519 | bool isCacheValid() const { |
| 1520 | return CacheValid; |
| 1521 | } |
| 1522 | |
| 1523 | Linkage getLinkage() const { |
| 1524 | assert(isCacheValid() && "getting linkage from invalid cache")((void)0); |
| 1525 | return static_cast<Linkage>(CachedLinkage); |
| 1526 | } |
| 1527 | |
| 1528 | bool hasLocalOrUnnamedType() const { |
| 1529 | assert(isCacheValid() && "getting linkage from invalid cache")((void)0); |
| 1530 | return CachedLocalOrUnnamed; |
| 1531 | } |
| 1532 | }; |
| 1533 | enum { NumTypeBits = 8 + llvm::BitWidth<TypeDependence> + 6 }; |
| 1534 | |
| 1535 | protected: |
| 1536 | // These classes allow subclasses to somewhat cleanly pack bitfields |
| 1537 | // into Type. |
| 1538 | |
| 1539 | class ArrayTypeBitfields { |
| 1540 | friend class ArrayType; |
| 1541 | |
| 1542 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1543 | |
| 1544 | /// CVR qualifiers from declarations like |
| 1545 | /// 'int X[static restrict 4]'. For function parameters only. |
| 1546 | unsigned IndexTypeQuals : 3; |
| 1547 | |
| 1548 | /// Storage class qualifiers from declarations like |
| 1549 | /// 'int X[static restrict 4]'. For function parameters only. |
| 1550 | /// Actually an ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier. |
| 1551 | unsigned SizeModifier : 3; |
| 1552 | }; |
| 1553 | |
| 1554 | class ConstantArrayTypeBitfields { |
| 1555 | friend class ConstantArrayType; |
| 1556 | |
| 1557 | unsigned : NumTypeBits + 3 + 3; |
| 1558 | |
| 1559 | /// Whether we have a stored size expression. |
| 1560 | unsigned HasStoredSizeExpr : 1; |
| 1561 | }; |
| 1562 | |
| 1563 | class BuiltinTypeBitfields { |
| 1564 | friend class BuiltinType; |
| 1565 | |
| 1566 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1567 | |
| 1568 | /// The kind (BuiltinType::Kind) of builtin type this is. |
| 1569 | unsigned Kind : 8; |
| 1570 | }; |
| 1571 | |
| 1572 | /// FunctionTypeBitfields store various bits belonging to FunctionProtoType. |
| 1573 | /// Only common bits are stored here. Additional uncommon bits are stored |
| 1574 | /// in a trailing object after FunctionProtoType. |
| 1575 | class FunctionTypeBitfields { |
| 1576 | friend class FunctionProtoType; |
| 1577 | friend class FunctionType; |
| 1578 | |
| 1579 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1580 | |
| 1581 | /// Extra information which affects how the function is called, like |
| 1582 | /// regparm and the calling convention. |
| 1583 | unsigned ExtInfo : 13; |
| 1584 | |
| 1585 | /// The ref-qualifier associated with a \c FunctionProtoType. |
| 1586 | /// |
| 1587 | /// This is a value of type \c RefQualifierKind. |
| 1588 | unsigned RefQualifier : 2; |
| 1589 | |
| 1590 | /// Used only by FunctionProtoType, put here to pack with the |
| 1591 | /// other bitfields. |
| 1592 | /// The qualifiers are part of FunctionProtoType because... |
| 1593 | /// |
| 1594 | /// C++ 8.3.5p4: The return type, the parameter type list and the |
| 1595 | /// cv-qualifier-seq, [...], are part of the function type. |
| 1596 | unsigned FastTypeQuals : Qualifiers::FastWidth; |
| 1597 | /// Whether this function has extended Qualifiers. |
| 1598 | unsigned HasExtQuals : 1; |
| 1599 | |
| 1600 | /// The number of parameters this function has, not counting '...'. |
| 1601 | /// According to [implimits] 8 bits should be enough here but this is |
| 1602 | /// somewhat easy to exceed with metaprogramming and so we would like to |
| 1603 | /// keep NumParams as wide as reasonably possible. |
| 1604 | unsigned NumParams : 16; |
| 1605 | |
| 1606 | /// The type of exception specification this function has. |
| 1607 | unsigned ExceptionSpecType : 4; |
| 1608 | |
| 1609 | /// Whether this function has extended parameter information. |
| 1610 | unsigned HasExtParameterInfos : 1; |
| 1611 | |
| 1612 | /// Whether the function is variadic. |
| 1613 | unsigned Variadic : 1; |
| 1614 | |
| 1615 | /// Whether this function has a trailing return type. |
| 1616 | unsigned HasTrailingReturn : 1; |
| 1617 | }; |
| 1618 | |
| 1619 | class ObjCObjectTypeBitfields { |
| 1620 | friend class ObjCObjectType; |
| 1621 | |
| 1622 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1623 | |
| 1624 | /// The number of type arguments stored directly on this object type. |
| 1625 | unsigned NumTypeArgs : 7; |
| 1626 | |
| 1627 | /// The number of protocols stored directly on this object type. |
| 1628 | unsigned NumProtocols : 6; |
| 1629 | |
| 1630 | /// Whether this is a "kindof" type. |
| 1631 | unsigned IsKindOf : 1; |
| 1632 | }; |
| 1633 | |
| 1634 | class ReferenceTypeBitfields { |
| 1635 | friend class ReferenceType; |
| 1636 | |
| 1637 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1638 | |
| 1639 | /// True if the type was originally spelled with an lvalue sigil. |
| 1640 | /// This is never true of rvalue references but can also be false |
| 1641 | /// on lvalue references because of C++0x [dcl.typedef]p9, |
| 1642 | /// as follows: |
| 1643 | /// |
| 1644 | /// typedef int &ref; // lvalue, spelled lvalue |
| 1645 | /// typedef int &&rvref; // rvalue |
| 1646 | /// ref &a; // lvalue, inner ref, spelled lvalue |
| 1647 | /// ref &&a; // lvalue, inner ref |
| 1648 | /// rvref &a; // lvalue, inner ref, spelled lvalue |
| 1649 | /// rvref &&a; // rvalue, inner ref |
| 1650 | unsigned SpelledAsLValue : 1; |
| 1651 | |
| 1652 | /// True if the inner type is a reference type. This only happens |
| 1653 | /// in non-canonical forms. |
| 1654 | unsigned InnerRef : 1; |
| 1655 | }; |
| 1656 | |
| 1657 | class TypeWithKeywordBitfields { |
| 1658 | friend class TypeWithKeyword; |
| 1659 | |
| 1660 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1661 | |
| 1662 | /// An ElaboratedTypeKeyword. 8 bits for efficient access. |
| 1663 | unsigned Keyword : 8; |
| 1664 | }; |
| 1665 | |
| 1666 | enum { NumTypeWithKeywordBits = 8 }; |
| 1667 | |
| 1668 | class ElaboratedTypeBitfields { |
| 1669 | friend class ElaboratedType; |
| 1670 | |
| 1671 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1672 | unsigned : NumTypeWithKeywordBits; |
| 1673 | |
| 1674 | /// Whether the ElaboratedType has a trailing OwnedTagDecl. |
| 1675 | unsigned HasOwnedTagDecl : 1; |
| 1676 | }; |
| 1677 | |
| 1678 | class VectorTypeBitfields { |
| 1679 | friend class VectorType; |
| 1680 | friend class DependentVectorType; |
| 1681 | |
| 1682 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1683 | |
| 1684 | /// The kind of vector, either a generic vector type or some |
| 1685 | /// target-specific vector type such as for AltiVec or Neon. |
| 1686 | unsigned VecKind : 3; |
| 1687 | /// The number of elements in the vector. |
| 1688 | uint32_t NumElements; |
| 1689 | }; |
| 1690 | |
| 1691 | class AttributedTypeBitfields { |
| 1692 | friend class AttributedType; |
| 1693 | |
| 1694 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1695 | |
| 1696 | /// An AttributedType::Kind |
| 1697 | unsigned AttrKind : 32 - NumTypeBits; |
| 1698 | }; |
| 1699 | |
| 1700 | class AutoTypeBitfields { |
| 1701 | friend class AutoType; |
| 1702 | |
| 1703 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1704 | |
| 1705 | /// Was this placeholder type spelled as 'auto', 'decltype(auto)', |
| 1706 | /// or '__auto_type'? AutoTypeKeyword value. |
| 1707 | unsigned Keyword : 2; |
| 1708 | |
| 1709 | /// The number of template arguments in the type-constraints, which is |
| 1710 | /// expected to be able to hold at least 1024 according to [implimits]. |
| 1711 | /// However as this limit is somewhat easy to hit with template |
| 1712 | /// metaprogramming we'd prefer to keep it as large as possible. |
| 1713 | /// At the moment it has been left as a non-bitfield since this type |
| 1714 | /// safely fits in 64 bits as an unsigned, so there is no reason to |
| 1715 | /// introduce the performance impact of a bitfield. |
| 1716 | unsigned NumArgs; |
| 1717 | }; |
| 1718 | |
| 1719 | class SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypeBitfields { |
| 1720 | friend class SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType; |
| 1721 | |
| 1722 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1723 | |
| 1724 | /// The number of template arguments in \c Arguments, which is |
| 1725 | /// expected to be able to hold at least 1024 according to [implimits]. |
| 1726 | /// However as this limit is somewhat easy to hit with template |
| 1727 | /// metaprogramming we'd prefer to keep it as large as possible. |
| 1728 | /// At the moment it has been left as a non-bitfield since this type |
| 1729 | /// safely fits in 64 bits as an unsigned, so there is no reason to |
| 1730 | /// introduce the performance impact of a bitfield. |
| 1731 | unsigned NumArgs; |
| 1732 | }; |
| 1733 | |
| 1734 | class TemplateSpecializationTypeBitfields { |
| 1735 | friend class TemplateSpecializationType; |
| 1736 | |
| 1737 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1738 | |
| 1739 | /// Whether this template specialization type is a substituted type alias. |
| 1740 | unsigned TypeAlias : 1; |
| 1741 | |
| 1742 | /// The number of template arguments named in this class template |
| 1743 | /// specialization, which is expected to be able to hold at least 1024 |
| 1744 | /// according to [implimits]. However, as this limit is somewhat easy to |
| 1745 | /// hit with template metaprogramming we'd prefer to keep it as large |
| 1746 | /// as possible. At the moment it has been left as a non-bitfield since |
| 1747 | /// this type safely fits in 64 bits as an unsigned, so there is no reason |
| 1748 | /// to introduce the performance impact of a bitfield. |
| 1749 | unsigned NumArgs; |
| 1750 | }; |
| 1751 | |
| 1752 | class DependentTemplateSpecializationTypeBitfields { |
| 1753 | friend class DependentTemplateSpecializationType; |
| 1754 | |
| 1755 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1756 | unsigned : NumTypeWithKeywordBits; |
| 1757 | |
| 1758 | /// The number of template arguments named in this class template |
| 1759 | /// specialization, which is expected to be able to hold at least 1024 |
| 1760 | /// according to [implimits]. However, as this limit is somewhat easy to |
| 1761 | /// hit with template metaprogramming we'd prefer to keep it as large |
| 1762 | /// as possible. At the moment it has been left as a non-bitfield since |
| 1763 | /// this type safely fits in 64 bits as an unsigned, so there is no reason |
| 1764 | /// to introduce the performance impact of a bitfield. |
| 1765 | unsigned NumArgs; |
| 1766 | }; |
| 1767 | |
| 1768 | class PackExpansionTypeBitfields { |
| 1769 | friend class PackExpansionType; |
| 1770 | |
| 1771 | unsigned : NumTypeBits; |
| 1772 | |
| 1773 | /// The number of expansions that this pack expansion will |
| 1774 | /// generate when substituted (+1), which is expected to be able to |
| 1775 | /// hold at least 1024 according to [implimits]. However, as this limit |
| 1776 | /// is somewhat easy to hit with template metaprogramming we'd prefer to |
| 1777 | /// keep it as large as possible. At the moment it has been left as a |
| 1778 | /// non-bitfield since this type safely fits in 64 bits as an unsigned, so |
| 1779 | /// there is no reason to introduce the performance impact of a bitfield. |
| 1780 | /// |
| 1781 | /// This field will only have a non-zero value when some of the parameter |
| 1782 | /// packs that occur within the pattern have been substituted but others |
| 1783 | /// have not. |
| 1784 | unsigned NumExpansions; |
| 1785 | }; |
| 1786 | |
| 1787 | union { |
| 1788 | TypeBitfields TypeBits; |
| 1789 | ArrayTypeBitfields ArrayTypeBits; |
| 1790 | ConstantArrayTypeBitfields ConstantArrayTypeBits; |
| 1791 | AttributedTypeBitfields AttributedTypeBits; |
| 1792 | AutoTypeBitfields AutoTypeBits; |
| 1793 | BuiltinTypeBitfields BuiltinTypeBits; |
| 1794 | FunctionTypeBitfields FunctionTypeBits; |
| 1795 | ObjCObjectTypeBitfields ObjCObjectTypeBits; |
| 1796 | ReferenceTypeBitfields ReferenceTypeBits; |
| 1797 | TypeWithKeywordBitfields TypeWithKeywordBits; |
| 1798 | ElaboratedTypeBitfields ElaboratedTypeBits; |
| 1799 | VectorTypeBitfields VectorTypeBits; |
| 1800 | SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypeBitfields SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypeBits; |
| 1801 | TemplateSpecializationTypeBitfields TemplateSpecializationTypeBits; |
| 1802 | DependentTemplateSpecializationTypeBitfields |
| 1803 | DependentTemplateSpecializationTypeBits; |
| 1804 | PackExpansionTypeBitfields PackExpansionTypeBits; |
| 1805 | }; |
| 1806 | |
| 1807 | private: |
| 1808 | template <class T> friend class TypePropertyCache; |
| 1809 | |
| 1810 | /// Set whether this type comes from an AST file. |
| 1811 | void setFromAST(bool V = true) const { |
| 1812 | TypeBits.FromAST = V; |
| 1813 | } |
| 1814 | |
| 1815 | protected: |
| 1816 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 1817 | |
| 1818 | Type(TypeClass tc, QualType canon, TypeDependence Dependence) |
| 1819 | : ExtQualsTypeCommonBase(this, |
| 1820 | canon.isNull() ? QualType(this_(), 0) : canon) { |
| 1821 | static_assert(sizeof(*this) <= 8 + sizeof(ExtQualsTypeCommonBase), |
| 1822 | "changing bitfields changed sizeof(Type)!"); |
| 1823 | static_assert(alignof(decltype(*this)) % sizeof(void *) == 0, |
| 1824 | "Insufficient alignment!"); |
| 1825 | TypeBits.TC = tc; |
| 1826 | TypeBits.Dependence = static_cast<unsigned>(Dependence); |
| 1827 | TypeBits.CacheValid = false; |
| 1828 | TypeBits.CachedLocalOrUnnamed = false; |
| 1829 | TypeBits.CachedLinkage = NoLinkage; |
| 1830 | TypeBits.FromAST = false; |
| 1831 | } |
| 1832 | |
| 1833 | // silence VC++ warning C4355: 'this' : used in base member initializer list |
| 1834 | Type *this_() { return this; } |
| 1835 | |
| 1836 | void setDependence(TypeDependence D) { |
| 1837 | TypeBits.Dependence = static_cast<unsigned>(D); |
| 1838 | } |
| 1839 | |
| 1840 | void addDependence(TypeDependence D) { setDependence(getDependence() | D); } |
| 1841 | |
| 1842 | public: |
| 1843 | friend class ASTReader; |
| 1844 | friend class ASTWriter; |
| 1845 | template <class T> friend class serialization::AbstractTypeReader; |
| 1846 | template <class T> friend class serialization::AbstractTypeWriter; |
| 1847 | |
| 1848 | Type(const Type &) = delete; |
| 1849 | Type(Type &&) = delete; |
| 1850 | Type &operator=(const Type &) = delete; |
| 1851 | Type &operator=(Type &&) = delete; |
| 1852 | |
| 1853 | TypeClass getTypeClass() const { return static_cast<TypeClass>(TypeBits.TC); } |
| 1854 | |
| 1855 | /// Whether this type comes from an AST file. |
| 1856 | bool isFromAST() const { return TypeBits.FromAST; } |
| 1857 | |
| 1858 | /// Whether this type is or contains an unexpanded parameter |
| 1859 | /// pack, used to support C++0x variadic templates. |
| 1860 | /// |
| 1861 | /// A type that contains a parameter pack shall be expanded by the |
| 1862 | /// ellipsis operator at some point. For example, the typedef in the |
| 1863 | /// following example contains an unexpanded parameter pack 'T': |
| 1864 | /// |
| 1865 | /// \code |
| 1866 | /// template<typename ...T> |
| 1867 | /// struct X { |
| 1868 | /// typedef T* pointer_types; // ill-formed; T is a parameter pack. |
| 1869 | /// }; |
| 1870 | /// \endcode |
| 1871 | /// |
| 1872 | /// Note that this routine does not specify which |
| 1873 | bool containsUnexpandedParameterPack() const { |
| 1874 | return getDependence() & TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack; |
| 1875 | } |
| 1876 | |
| 1877 | /// Determines if this type would be canonical if it had no further |
| 1878 | /// qualification. |
| 1879 | bool isCanonicalUnqualified() const { |
| 1880 | return CanonicalType == QualType(this, 0); |
| 1881 | } |
| 1882 | |
| 1883 | /// Pull a single level of sugar off of this locally-unqualified type. |
| 1884 | /// Users should generally prefer SplitQualType::getSingleStepDesugaredType() |
| 1885 | /// or QualType::getSingleStepDesugaredType(const ASTContext&). |
| 1886 | QualType getLocallyUnqualifiedSingleStepDesugaredType() const; |
| 1887 | |
| 1888 | /// As an extension, we classify types as one of "sized" or "sizeless"; |
| 1889 | /// every type is one or the other. Standard types are all sized; |
| 1890 | /// sizeless types are purely an extension. |
| 1891 | /// |
| 1892 | /// Sizeless types contain data with no specified size, alignment, |
| 1893 | /// or layout. |
| 1894 | bool isSizelessType() const; |
| 1895 | bool isSizelessBuiltinType() const; |
| 1896 | |
| 1897 | /// Determines if this is a sizeless type supported by the |
| 1898 | /// 'arm_sve_vector_bits' type attribute, which can be applied to a single |
| 1899 | /// SVE vector or predicate, excluding tuple types such as svint32x4_t. |
| 1900 | bool isVLSTBuiltinType() const; |
| 1901 | |
| 1902 | /// Returns the representative type for the element of an SVE builtin type. |
| 1903 | /// This is used to represent fixed-length SVE vectors created with the |
| 1904 | /// 'arm_sve_vector_bits' type attribute as VectorType. |
| 1905 | QualType getSveEltType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const; |
| 1906 | |
| 1907 | /// Types are partitioned into 3 broad categories (C99 6.2.5p1): |
| 1908 | /// object types, function types, and incomplete types. |
| 1909 | |
| 1910 | /// Return true if this is an incomplete type. |
| 1911 | /// A type that can describe objects, but which lacks information needed to |
| 1912 | /// determine its size (e.g. void, or a fwd declared struct). Clients of this |
| 1913 | /// routine will need to determine if the size is actually required. |
| 1914 | /// |
| 1915 | /// Def If non-null, and the type refers to some kind of declaration |
| 1916 | /// that can be completed (such as a C struct, C++ class, or Objective-C |
| 1917 | /// class), will be set to the declaration. |
| 1918 | bool isIncompleteType(NamedDecl **Def = nullptr) const; |
| 1919 | |
| 1920 | /// Return true if this is an incomplete or object |
| 1921 | /// type, in other words, not a function type. |
| 1922 | bool isIncompleteOrObjectType() const { |
| 1923 | return !isFunctionType(); |
| 1924 | } |
| 1925 | |
| 1926 | /// Determine whether this type is an object type. |
| 1927 | bool isObjectType() const { |
| 1928 | // C++ [basic.types]p8: |
| 1929 | // An object type is a (possibly cv-qualified) type that is not a |
| 1930 | // function type, not a reference type, and not a void type. |
| 1931 | return !isReferenceType() && !isFunctionType() && !isVoidType(); |
| 1932 | } |
| 1933 | |
| 1934 | /// Return true if this is a literal type |
| 1935 | /// (C++11 [basic.types]p10) |
| 1936 | bool isLiteralType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const; |
| 1937 | |
| 1938 | /// Determine if this type is a structural type, per C++20 [temp.param]p7. |
| 1939 | bool isStructuralType() const; |
| 1940 | |
| 1941 | /// Test if this type is a standard-layout type. |
| 1942 | /// (C++0x [basic.type]p9) |
| 1943 | bool isStandardLayoutType() const; |
| 1944 | |
| 1945 | /// Helper methods to distinguish type categories. All type predicates |
| 1946 | /// operate on the canonical type, ignoring typedefs and qualifiers. |
| 1947 | |
| 1948 | /// Returns true if the type is a builtin type. |
| 1949 | bool isBuiltinType() const; |
| 1950 | |
| 1951 | /// Test for a particular builtin type. |
| 1952 | bool isSpecificBuiltinType(unsigned K) const; |
| 1953 | |
| 1954 | /// Test for a type which does not represent an actual type-system type but |
| 1955 | /// is instead used as a placeholder for various convenient purposes within |
| 1956 | /// Clang. All such types are BuiltinTypes. |
| 1957 | bool isPlaceholderType() const; |
| 1958 | const BuiltinType *getAsPlaceholderType() const; |
| 1959 | |
| 1960 | /// Test for a specific placeholder type. |
| 1961 | bool isSpecificPlaceholderType(unsigned K) const; |
| 1962 | |
| 1963 | /// Test for a placeholder type other than Overload; see |
| 1964 | /// BuiltinType::isNonOverloadPlaceholderType. |
| 1965 | bool isNonOverloadPlaceholderType() const; |
| 1966 | |
| 1967 | /// isIntegerType() does *not* include complex integers (a GCC extension). |
| 1968 | /// isComplexIntegerType() can be used to test for complex integers. |
| 1969 | bool isIntegerType() const; // C99 6.2.5p17 (int, char, bool, enum) |
| 1970 | bool isEnumeralType() const; |
| 1971 | |
| 1972 | /// Determine whether this type is a scoped enumeration type. |
| 1973 | bool isScopedEnumeralType() const; |
| 1974 | bool isBooleanType() const; |
| 1975 | bool isCharType() const; |
| 1976 | bool isWideCharType() const; |
| 1977 | bool isChar8Type() const; |
| 1978 | bool isChar16Type() const; |
| 1979 | bool isChar32Type() const; |
| 1980 | bool isAnyCharacterType() const; |
| 1981 | bool isIntegralType(const ASTContext &Ctx) const; |
| 1982 | |
| 1983 | /// Determine whether this type is an integral or enumeration type. |
| 1984 | bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType() const; |
| 1985 | |
| 1986 | /// Determine whether this type is an integral or unscoped enumeration type. |
| 1987 | bool isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() const; |
| 1988 | bool isUnscopedEnumerationType() const; |
| 1989 | |
| 1990 | /// Floating point categories. |
| 1991 | bool isRealFloatingType() const; // C99 6.2.5p10 (float, double, long double) |
| 1992 | /// isComplexType() does *not* include complex integers (a GCC extension). |
| 1993 | /// isComplexIntegerType() can be used to test for complex integers. |
| 1994 | bool isComplexType() const; // C99 6.2.5p11 (complex) |
| 1995 | bool isAnyComplexType() const; // C99 6.2.5p11 (complex) + Complex Int. |
| 1996 | bool isFloatingType() const; // C99 6.2.5p11 (real floating + complex) |
| 1997 | bool isHalfType() const; // OpenCL 6.1.1.1, NEON (IEEE 754-2008 half) |
| 1998 | bool isFloat16Type() const; // C11 extension ISO/IEC TS 18661 |
| 1999 | bool isBFloat16Type() const; |
| 2000 | bool isFloat128Type() const; |
| 2001 | bool isRealType() const; // C99 6.2.5p17 (real floating + integer) |
| 2002 | bool isArithmeticType() const; // C99 6.2.5p18 (integer + floating) |
| 2003 | bool isVoidType() const; // C99 6.2.5p19 |
| 2004 | bool isScalarType() const; // C99 6.2.5p21 (arithmetic + pointers) |
| 2005 | bool isAggregateType() const; |
| 2006 | bool isFundamentalType() const; |
| 2007 | bool isCompoundType() const; |
| 2008 | |
| 2009 | // Type Predicates: Check to see if this type is structurally the specified |
| 2010 | // type, ignoring typedefs and qualifiers. |
| 2011 | bool isFunctionType() const; |
| 2012 | bool isFunctionNoProtoType() const { return getAs<FunctionNoProtoType>(); } |
| 2013 | bool isFunctionProtoType() const { return getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); } |
| 2014 | bool isPointerType() const; |
| 2015 | bool isAnyPointerType() const; // Any C pointer or ObjC object pointer |
| 2016 | bool isBlockPointerType() const; |
| 2017 | bool isVoidPointerType() const; |
| 2018 | bool isReferenceType() const; |
| 2019 | bool isLValueReferenceType() const; |
| 2020 | bool isRValueReferenceType() const; |
| 2021 | bool isObjectPointerType() const; |
| 2022 | bool isFunctionPointerType() const; |
| 2023 | bool isFunctionReferenceType() const; |
| 2024 | bool isMemberPointerType() const; |
| 2025 | bool isMemberFunctionPointerType() const; |
| 2026 | bool isMemberDataPointerType() const; |
| 2027 | bool isArrayType() const; |
| 2028 | bool isConstantArrayType() const; |
| 2029 | bool isIncompleteArrayType() const; |
| 2030 | bool isVariableArrayType() const; |
| 2031 | bool isDependentSizedArrayType() const; |
| 2032 | bool isRecordType() const; |
| 2033 | bool isClassType() const; |
| 2034 | bool isStructureType() const; |
| 2035 | bool isObjCBoxableRecordType() const; |
| 2036 | bool isInterfaceType() const; |
| 2037 | bool isStructureOrClassType() const; |
| 2038 | bool isUnionType() const; |
| 2039 | bool isComplexIntegerType() const; // GCC _Complex integer type. |
| 2040 | bool isVectorType() const; // GCC vector type. |
| 2041 | bool isExtVectorType() const; // Extended vector type. |
| 2042 | bool isMatrixType() const; // Matrix type. |
| 2043 | bool isConstantMatrixType() const; // Constant matrix type. |
| 2044 | bool isDependentAddressSpaceType() const; // value-dependent address space qualifier |
| 2045 | bool isObjCObjectPointerType() const; // pointer to ObjC object |
| 2046 | bool isObjCRetainableType() const; // ObjC object or block pointer |
| 2047 | bool isObjCLifetimeType() const; // (array of)* retainable type |
| 2048 | bool isObjCIndirectLifetimeType() const; // (pointer to)* lifetime type |
| 2049 | bool isObjCNSObjectType() const; // __attribute__((NSObject)) |
| 2050 | bool isObjCIndependentClassType() const; // __attribute__((objc_independent_class)) |
| 2051 | // FIXME: change this to 'raw' interface type, so we can used 'interface' type |
| 2052 | // for the common case. |
| 2053 | bool isObjCObjectType() const; // NSString or typeof(*(id)0) |
| 2054 | bool isObjCQualifiedInterfaceType() const; // NSString<foo> |
| 2055 | bool isObjCQualifiedIdType() const; // id<foo> |
| 2056 | bool isObjCQualifiedClassType() const; // Class<foo> |
| 2057 | bool isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() const; |
| 2058 | bool isObjCIdType() const; // id |
| 2059 | bool isDecltypeType() const; |
| 2060 | /// Was this type written with the special inert-in-ARC __unsafe_unretained |
| 2061 | /// qualifier? |
| 2062 | /// |
| 2063 | /// This approximates the answer to the following question: if this |
| 2064 | /// translation unit were compiled in ARC, would this type be qualified |
| 2065 | /// with __unsafe_unretained? |
| 2066 | bool isObjCInertUnsafeUnretainedType() const { |
| 2067 | return hasAttr(attr::ObjCInertUnsafeUnretained); |
| 2068 | } |
| 2069 | |
| 2070 | /// Whether the type is Objective-C 'id' or a __kindof type of an |
| 2071 | /// object type, e.g., __kindof NSView * or __kindof id |
| 2072 | /// <NSCopying>. |
| 2073 | /// |
| 2074 | /// \param bound Will be set to the bound on non-id subtype types, |
| 2075 | /// which will be (possibly specialized) Objective-C class type, or |
| 2076 | /// null for 'id. |
| 2077 | bool isObjCIdOrObjectKindOfType(const ASTContext &ctx, |
| 2078 | const ObjCObjectType *&bound) const; |
| 2079 | |
| 2080 | bool isObjCClassType() const; // Class |
| 2081 | |
| 2082 | /// Whether the type is Objective-C 'Class' or a __kindof type of an |
| 2083 | /// Class type, e.g., __kindof Class <NSCopying>. |
| 2084 | /// |
| 2085 | /// Unlike \c isObjCIdOrObjectKindOfType, there is no relevant bound |
| 2086 | /// here because Objective-C's type system cannot express "a class |
| 2087 | /// object for a subclass of NSFoo". |
| 2088 | bool isObjCClassOrClassKindOfType() const; |
| 2089 | |
| 2090 | bool isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(ASTContext &ctx) const; |
| 2091 | bool isObjCSelType() const; // Class |
| 2092 | bool isObjCBuiltinType() const; // 'id' or 'Class' |
| 2093 | bool isObjCARCBridgableType() const; |
| 2094 | bool isCARCBridgableType() const; |
| 2095 | bool isTemplateTypeParmType() const; // C++ template type parameter |
| 2096 | bool isNullPtrType() const; // C++11 std::nullptr_t |
| 2097 | bool isNothrowT() const; // C++ std::nothrow_t |
| 2098 | bool isAlignValT() const; // C++17 std::align_val_t |
| 2099 | bool isStdByteType() const; // C++17 std::byte |
| 2100 | bool isAtomicType() const; // C11 _Atomic() |
| 2101 | bool isUndeducedAutoType() const; // C++11 auto or |
| 2102 | // C++14 decltype(auto) |
| 2103 | bool isTypedefNameType() const; // typedef or alias template |
| 2104 | |
| 2105 | #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ |
| 2106 | bool is##Id##Type() const; |
| 2107 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" |
| 2108 | |
| 2109 | bool isImageType() const; // Any OpenCL image type |
| 2110 | |
| 2111 | bool isSamplerT() const; // OpenCL sampler_t |
| 2112 | bool isEventT() const; // OpenCL event_t |
| 2113 | bool isClkEventT() const; // OpenCL clk_event_t |
| 2114 | bool isQueueT() const; // OpenCL queue_t |
| 2115 | bool isReserveIDT() const; // OpenCL reserve_id_t |
| 2116 | |
| 2117 | #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \ |
| 2118 | bool is##Id##Type() const; |
| 2119 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" |
| 2120 | // Type defined in cl_intel_device_side_avc_motion_estimation OpenCL extension |
| 2121 | bool isOCLIntelSubgroupAVCType() const; |
| 2122 | bool isOCLExtOpaqueType() const; // Any OpenCL extension type |
| 2123 | |
| 2124 | bool isPipeType() const; // OpenCL pipe type |
| 2125 | bool isExtIntType() const; // Extended Int Type |
| 2126 | bool isOpenCLSpecificType() const; // Any OpenCL specific type |
| 2127 | |
| 2128 | /// Determines if this type, which must satisfy |
| 2129 | /// isObjCLifetimeType(), is implicitly __unsafe_unretained rather |
| 2130 | /// than implicitly __strong. |
| 2131 | bool isObjCARCImplicitlyUnretainedType() const; |
| 2132 | |
| 2133 | /// Check if the type is the CUDA device builtin surface type. |
| 2134 | bool isCUDADeviceBuiltinSurfaceType() const; |
| 2135 | /// Check if the type is the CUDA device builtin texture type. |
| 2136 | bool isCUDADeviceBuiltinTextureType() const; |
| 2137 | |
| 2138 | /// Return the implicit lifetime for this type, which must not be dependent. |
| 2139 | Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime getObjCARCImplicitLifetime() const; |
| 2140 | |
| 2141 | enum ScalarTypeKind { |
| 2142 | STK_CPointer, |
| 2143 | STK_BlockPointer, |
| 2144 | STK_ObjCObjectPointer, |
| 2145 | STK_MemberPointer, |
| 2146 | STK_Bool, |
| 2147 | STK_Integral, |
| 2148 | STK_Floating, |
| 2149 | STK_IntegralComplex, |
| 2150 | STK_FloatingComplex, |
| 2151 | STK_FixedPoint |
| 2152 | }; |
| 2153 | |
| 2154 | /// Given that this is a scalar type, classify it. |
| 2155 | ScalarTypeKind getScalarTypeKind() const; |
| 2156 | |
| 2157 | TypeDependence getDependence() const { |
| 2158 | return static_cast<TypeDependence>(TypeBits.Dependence); |
| 2159 | } |
| 2160 | |
| 2161 | /// Whether this type is an error type. |
| 2162 | bool containsErrors() const { |
| 2163 | return getDependence() & TypeDependence::Error; |
| 2164 | } |
| 2165 | |
| 2166 | /// Whether this type is a dependent type, meaning that its definition |
| 2167 | /// somehow depends on a template parameter (C++ [temp.dep.type]). |
| 2168 | bool isDependentType() const { |
| 2169 | return getDependence() & TypeDependence::Dependent; |
| 2170 | } |
| 2171 | |
| 2172 | /// Determine whether this type is an instantiation-dependent type, |
| 2173 | /// meaning that the type involves a template parameter (even if the |
| 2174 | /// definition does not actually depend on the type substituted for that |
| 2175 | /// template parameter). |
| 2176 | bool isInstantiationDependentType() const { |
| 2177 | return getDependence() & TypeDependence::Instantiation; |
| 2178 | } |
| 2179 | |
| 2180 | /// Determine whether this type is an undeduced type, meaning that |
| 2181 | /// it somehow involves a C++11 'auto' type or similar which has not yet been |
| 2182 | /// deduced. |
| 2183 | bool isUndeducedType() const; |
| 2184 | |
| 2185 | /// Whether this type is a variably-modified type (C99 6.7.5). |
| 2186 | bool isVariablyModifiedType() const { |
| 2187 | return getDependence() & TypeDependence::VariablyModified; |
| 2188 | } |
| 2189 | |
| 2190 | /// Whether this type involves a variable-length array type |
| 2191 | /// with a definite size. |
| 2192 | bool hasSizedVLAType() const; |
| 2193 | |
| 2194 | /// Whether this type is or contains a local or unnamed type. |
| 2195 | bool hasUnnamedOrLocalType() const; |
| 2196 | |
| 2197 | bool isOverloadableType() const; |
| 2198 | |
| 2199 | /// Determine wither this type is a C++ elaborated-type-specifier. |
| 2200 | bool isElaboratedTypeSpecifier() const; |
| 2201 | |
| 2202 | bool canDecayToPointerType() const; |
| 2203 | |
| 2204 | /// Whether this type is represented natively as a pointer. This includes |
| 2205 | /// pointers, references, block pointers, and Objective-C interface, |
| 2206 | /// qualified id, and qualified interface types, as well as nullptr_t. |
| 2207 | bool hasPointerRepresentation() const; |
| 2208 | |
| 2209 | /// Whether this type can represent an objective pointer type for the |
| 2210 | /// purpose of GC'ability |
| 2211 | bool hasObjCPointerRepresentation() const; |
| 2212 | |
| 2213 | /// Determine whether this type has an integer representation |
| 2214 | /// of some sort, e.g., it is an integer type or a vector. |
| 2215 | bool hasIntegerRepresentation() const; |
| 2216 | |
| 2217 | /// Determine whether this type has an signed integer representation |
| 2218 | /// of some sort, e.g., it is an signed integer type or a vector. |
| 2219 | bool hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() const; |
| 2220 | |
| 2221 | /// Determine whether this type has an unsigned integer representation |
| 2222 | /// of some sort, e.g., it is an unsigned integer type or a vector. |
| 2223 | bool hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation() const; |
| 2224 | |
| 2225 | /// Determine whether this type has a floating-point representation |
| 2226 | /// of some sort, e.g., it is a floating-point type or a vector thereof. |
| 2227 | bool hasFloatingRepresentation() const; |
| 2228 | |
| 2229 | // Type Checking Functions: Check to see if this type is structurally the |
| 2230 | // specified type, ignoring typedefs and qualifiers, and return a pointer to |
| 2231 | // the best type we can. |
| 2232 | const RecordType *getAsStructureType() const; |
| 2233 | /// NOTE: getAs*ArrayType are methods on ASTContext. |
| 2234 | const RecordType *getAsUnionType() const; |
| 2235 | const ComplexType *getAsComplexIntegerType() const; // GCC complex int type. |
| 2236 | const ObjCObjectType *getAsObjCInterfaceType() const; |
| 2237 | |
| 2238 | // The following is a convenience method that returns an ObjCObjectPointerType |
| 2239 | // for object declared using an interface. |
| 2240 | const ObjCObjectPointerType *getAsObjCInterfacePointerType() const; |
| 2241 | const ObjCObjectPointerType *getAsObjCQualifiedIdType() const; |
| 2242 | const ObjCObjectPointerType *getAsObjCQualifiedClassType() const; |
| 2243 | const ObjCObjectType *getAsObjCQualifiedInterfaceType() const; |
| 2244 | |
| 2245 | /// Retrieves the CXXRecordDecl that this type refers to, either |
| 2246 | /// because the type is a RecordType or because it is the injected-class-name |
| 2247 | /// type of a class template or class template partial specialization. |
| 2248 | CXXRecordDecl *getAsCXXRecordDecl() const; |
| 2249 | |
| 2250 | /// Retrieves the RecordDecl this type refers to. |
| 2251 | RecordDecl *getAsRecordDecl() const; |
| 2252 | |
| 2253 | /// Retrieves the TagDecl that this type refers to, either |
| 2254 | /// because the type is a TagType or because it is the injected-class-name |
| 2255 | /// type of a class template or class template partial specialization. |
| 2256 | TagDecl *getAsTagDecl() const; |
| 2257 | |
| 2258 | /// If this is a pointer or reference to a RecordType, return the |
| 2259 | /// CXXRecordDecl that the type refers to. |
| 2260 | /// |
| 2261 | /// If this is not a pointer or reference, or the type being pointed to does |
| 2262 | /// not refer to a CXXRecordDecl, returns NULL. |
| 2263 | const CXXRecordDecl *getPointeeCXXRecordDecl() const; |
| 2264 | |
| 2265 | /// Get the DeducedType whose type will be deduced for a variable with |
| 2266 | /// an initializer of this type. This looks through declarators like pointer |
| 2267 | /// types, but not through decltype or typedefs. |
| 2268 | DeducedType *getContainedDeducedType() const; |
| 2269 | |
| 2270 | /// Get the AutoType whose type will be deduced for a variable with |
| 2271 | /// an initializer of this type. This looks through declarators like pointer |
| 2272 | /// types, but not through decltype or typedefs. |
| 2273 | AutoType *getContainedAutoType() const { |
| 2274 | return dyn_cast_or_null<AutoType>(getContainedDeducedType()); |
| 2275 | } |
| 2276 | |
| 2277 | /// Determine whether this type was written with a leading 'auto' |
| 2278 | /// corresponding to a trailing return type (possibly for a nested |
| 2279 | /// function type within a pointer to function type or similar). |
| 2280 | bool hasAutoForTrailingReturnType() const; |
| 2281 | |
| 2282 | /// Member-template getAs<specific type>'. Look through sugar for |
| 2283 | /// an instance of \<specific type>. This scheme will eventually |
| 2284 | /// replace the specific getAsXXXX methods above. |
| 2285 | /// |
| 2286 | /// There are some specializations of this member template listed |
| 2287 | /// immediately following this class. |
| 2288 | template <typename T> const T *getAs() const; |
| 2289 | |
| 2290 | /// Member-template getAsAdjusted<specific type>. Look through specific kinds |
| 2291 | /// of sugar (parens, attributes, etc) for an instance of \<specific type>. |
| 2292 | /// This is used when you need to walk over sugar nodes that represent some |
| 2293 | /// kind of type adjustment from a type that was written as a \<specific type> |
| 2294 | /// to another type that is still canonically a \<specific type>. |
| 2295 | template <typename T> const T *getAsAdjusted() const; |
| 2296 | |
| 2297 | /// A variant of getAs<> for array types which silently discards |
| 2298 | /// qualifiers from the outermost type. |
| 2299 | const ArrayType *getAsArrayTypeUnsafe() const; |
| 2300 | |
| 2301 | /// Member-template castAs<specific type>. Look through sugar for |
| 2302 | /// the underlying instance of \<specific type>. |
| 2303 | /// |
| 2304 | /// This method has the same relationship to getAs<T> as cast<T> has |
| 2305 | /// to dyn_cast<T>; which is to say, the underlying type *must* |
| 2306 | /// have the intended type, and this method will never return null. |
| 2307 | template <typename T> const T *castAs() const; |
| 2308 | |
| 2309 | /// A variant of castAs<> for array type which silently discards |
| 2310 | /// qualifiers from the outermost type. |
| 2311 | const ArrayType *castAsArrayTypeUnsafe() const; |
| 2312 | |
| 2313 | /// Determine whether this type had the specified attribute applied to it |
| 2314 | /// (looking through top-level type sugar). |
| 2315 | bool hasAttr(attr::Kind AK) const; |
| 2316 | |
| 2317 | /// Get the base element type of this type, potentially discarding type |
| 2318 | /// qualifiers. This should never be used when type qualifiers |
| 2319 | /// are meaningful. |
| 2320 | const Type *getBaseElementTypeUnsafe() const; |
| 2321 | |
| 2322 | /// If this is an array type, return the element type of the array, |
| 2323 | /// potentially with type qualifiers missing. |
| 2324 | /// This should never be used when type qualifiers are meaningful. |
| 2325 | const Type *getArrayElementTypeNoTypeQual() const; |
| 2326 | |
| 2327 | /// If this is a pointer type, return the pointee type. |
| 2328 | /// If this is an array type, return the array element type. |
| 2329 | /// This should never be used when type qualifiers are meaningful. |
| 2330 | const Type *getPointeeOrArrayElementType() const; |
| 2331 | |
| 2332 | /// If this is a pointer, ObjC object pointer, or block |
| 2333 | /// pointer, this returns the respective pointee. |
| 2334 | QualType getPointeeType() const; |
| 2335 | |
| 2336 | /// Return the specified type with any "sugar" removed from the type, |
| 2337 | /// removing any typedefs, typeofs, etc., as well as any qualifiers. |
| 2338 | const Type *getUnqualifiedDesugaredType() const; |
| 2339 | |
| 2340 | /// More type predicates useful for type checking/promotion |
| 2341 | bool isPromotableIntegerType() const; // C99 6.3.1.1p2 |
| 2342 | |
| 2343 | /// Return true if this is an integer type that is |
| 2344 | /// signed, according to C99 6.2.5p4 [char, signed char, short, int, long..], |
| 2345 | /// or an enum decl which has a signed representation. |
| 2346 | bool isSignedIntegerType() const; |
| 2347 | |
| 2348 | /// Return true if this is an integer type that is |
| 2349 | /// unsigned, according to C99 6.2.5p6 [which returns true for _Bool], |
| 2350 | /// or an enum decl which has an unsigned representation. |
| 2351 | bool isUnsignedIntegerType() const; |
| 2352 | |
| 2353 | /// Determines whether this is an integer type that is signed or an |
| 2354 | /// enumeration types whose underlying type is a signed integer type. |
| 2355 | bool isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() const; |
| 2356 | |
| 2357 | /// Determines whether this is an integer type that is unsigned or an |
| 2358 | /// enumeration types whose underlying type is a unsigned integer type. |
| 2359 | bool isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() const; |
| 2360 | |
| 2361 | /// Return true if this is a fixed point type according to |
| 2362 | /// ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169. |
| 2363 | bool isFixedPointType() const; |
| 2364 | |
| 2365 | /// Return true if this is a fixed point or integer type. |
| 2366 | bool isFixedPointOrIntegerType() const; |
| 2367 | |
| 2368 | /// Return true if this is a saturated fixed point type according to |
| 2369 | /// ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169. This type can be signed or unsigned. |
| 2370 | bool isSaturatedFixedPointType() const; |
| 2371 | |
| 2372 | /// Return true if this is a saturated fixed point type according to |
| 2373 | /// ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169. This type can be signed or unsigned. |
| 2374 | bool isUnsaturatedFixedPointType() const; |
| 2375 | |
| 2376 | /// Return true if this is a fixed point type that is signed according |
| 2377 | /// to ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169. This type can also be saturated. |
| 2378 | bool isSignedFixedPointType() const; |
| 2379 | |
| 2380 | /// Return true if this is a fixed point type that is unsigned according |
| 2381 | /// to ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169. This type can also be saturated. |
| 2382 | bool isUnsignedFixedPointType() const; |
| 2383 | |
| 2384 | /// Return true if this is not a variable sized type, |
| 2385 | /// according to the rules of C99 6.7.5p3. It is not legal to call this on |
| 2386 | /// incomplete types. |
| 2387 | bool isConstantSizeType() const; |
| 2388 | |
| 2389 | /// Returns true if this type can be represented by some |
| 2390 | /// set of type specifiers. |
| 2391 | bool isSpecifierType() const; |
| 2392 | |
| 2393 | /// Determine the linkage of this type. |
| 2394 | Linkage getLinkage() const; |
| 2395 | |
| 2396 | /// Determine the visibility of this type. |
| 2397 | Visibility getVisibility() const { |
| 2398 | return getLinkageAndVisibility().getVisibility(); |
| 2399 | } |
| 2400 | |
| 2401 | /// Return true if the visibility was explicitly set is the code. |
| 2402 | bool isVisibilityExplicit() const { |
| 2403 | return getLinkageAndVisibility().isVisibilityExplicit(); |
| 2404 | } |
| 2405 | |
| 2406 | /// Determine the linkage and visibility of this type. |
| 2407 | LinkageInfo getLinkageAndVisibility() const; |
| 2408 | |
| 2409 | /// True if the computed linkage is valid. Used for consistency |
| 2410 | /// checking. Should always return true. |
| 2411 | bool isLinkageValid() const; |
| 2412 | |
| 2413 | /// Determine the nullability of the given type. |
| 2414 | /// |
| 2415 | /// Note that nullability is only captured as sugar within the type |
| 2416 | /// system, not as part of the canonical type, so nullability will |
| 2417 | /// be lost by canonicalization and desugaring. |
| 2418 | Optional<NullabilityKind> getNullability(const ASTContext &context) const; |
| 2419 | |
| 2420 | /// Determine whether the given type can have a nullability |
| 2421 | /// specifier applied to it, i.e., if it is any kind of pointer type. |
| 2422 | /// |
| 2423 | /// \param ResultIfUnknown The value to return if we don't yet know whether |
| 2424 | /// this type can have nullability because it is dependent. |
| 2425 | bool canHaveNullability(bool ResultIfUnknown = true) const; |
| 2426 | |
| 2427 | /// Retrieve the set of substitutions required when accessing a member |
| 2428 | /// of the Objective-C receiver type that is declared in the given context. |
| 2429 | /// |
| 2430 | /// \c *this is the type of the object we're operating on, e.g., the |
| 2431 | /// receiver for a message send or the base of a property access, and is |
| 2432 | /// expected to be of some object or object pointer type. |
| 2433 | /// |
| 2434 | /// \param dc The declaration context for which we are building up a |
| 2435 | /// substitution mapping, which should be an Objective-C class, extension, |
| 2436 | /// category, or method within. |
| 2437 | /// |
| 2438 | /// \returns an array of type arguments that can be substituted for |
| 2439 | /// the type parameters of the given declaration context in any type described |
| 2440 | /// within that context, or an empty optional to indicate that no |
| 2441 | /// substitution is required. |
| 2442 | Optional<ArrayRef<QualType>> |
| 2443 | getObjCSubstitutions(const DeclContext *dc) const; |
| 2444 | |
| 2445 | /// Determines if this is an ObjC interface type that may accept type |
| 2446 | /// parameters. |
| 2447 | bool acceptsObjCTypeParams() const; |
| 2448 | |
| 2449 | const char *getTypeClassName() const; |
| 2450 | |
| 2451 | QualType getCanonicalTypeInternal() const { |
| 2452 | return CanonicalType; |
| 2453 | } |
| 2454 | |
| 2455 | CanQualType getCanonicalTypeUnqualified() const; // in CanonicalType.h |
| 2456 | void dump() const; |
| 2457 | void dump(llvm::raw_ostream &OS, const ASTContext &Context) const; |
| 2458 | }; |
| 2459 | |
| 2460 | /// This will check for a TypedefType by removing any existing sugar |
| 2461 | /// until it reaches a TypedefType or a non-sugared type. |
| 2462 | template <> const TypedefType *Type::getAs() const; |
| 2463 | |
| 2464 | /// This will check for a TemplateSpecializationType by removing any |
| 2465 | /// existing sugar until it reaches a TemplateSpecializationType or a |
| 2466 | /// non-sugared type. |
| 2467 | template <> const TemplateSpecializationType *Type::getAs() const; |
| 2468 | |
| 2469 | /// This will check for an AttributedType by removing any existing sugar |
| 2470 | /// until it reaches an AttributedType or a non-sugared type. |
| 2471 | template <> const AttributedType *Type::getAs() const; |
| 2472 | |
| 2473 | // We can do canonical leaf types faster, because we don't have to |
| 2474 | // worry about preserving child type decoration. |
| 2475 | #define TYPE(Class, Base) |
| 2476 | #define LEAF_TYPE(Class) \ |
| 2477 | template <> inline const Class##Type *Type::getAs() const { \ |
| 2478 | return dyn_cast<Class##Type>(CanonicalType); \ |
| 2479 | } \ |
| 2480 | template <> inline const Class##Type *Type::castAs() const { \ |
| 2481 | return cast<Class##Type>(CanonicalType); \ |
| 2482 | } |
| 2483 | #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc" |
| 2484 | |
| 2485 | /// This class is used for builtin types like 'int'. Builtin |
| 2486 | /// types are always canonical and have a literal name field. |
| 2487 | class BuiltinType : public Type { |
| 2488 | public: |
| 2489 | enum Kind { |
| 2490 | // OpenCL image types |
| 2491 | #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) Id, |
| 2492 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" |
| 2493 | // OpenCL extension types |
| 2494 | #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) Id, |
| 2495 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" |
| 2496 | // SVE Types |
| 2497 | #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) Id, |
| 2498 | #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def" |
| 2499 | // PPC MMA Types |
| 2500 | #define PPC_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) Id, |
| 2501 | #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def" |
| 2502 | // RVV Types |
| 2503 | #define RVV_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) Id, |
| 2504 | #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def" |
| 2505 | // All other builtin types |
| 2506 | #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) Id, |
| 2507 | #define LAST_BUILTIN_TYPE(Id) LastKind = Id |
| 2508 | #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" |
| 2509 | }; |
| 2510 | |
| 2511 | private: |
| 2512 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2513 | |
| 2514 | BuiltinType(Kind K) |
| 2515 | : Type(Builtin, QualType(), |
| 2516 | K == Dependent ? TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation |
| 2517 | : TypeDependence::None) { |
| 2518 | BuiltinTypeBits.Kind = K; |
| 2519 | } |
| 2520 | |
| 2521 | public: |
| 2522 | Kind getKind() const { return static_cast<Kind>(BuiltinTypeBits.Kind); } |
| 2523 | StringRef getName(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const; |
| 2524 | |
| 2525 | const char *getNameAsCString(const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const { |
| 2526 | // The StringRef is null-terminated. |
| 2527 | StringRef str = getName(Policy); |
| 2528 | assert(!str.empty() && str.data()[str.size()] == '\0')((void)0); |
| 2529 | return str.data(); |
| 2530 | } |
| 2531 | |
| 2532 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 2533 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 2534 | |
| 2535 | bool isInteger() const { |
| 2536 | return getKind() >= Bool && getKind() <= Int128; |
| 2537 | } |
| 2538 | |
| 2539 | bool isSignedInteger() const { |
| 2540 | return getKind() >= Char_S && getKind() <= Int128; |
| 2541 | } |
| 2542 | |
| 2543 | bool isUnsignedInteger() const { |
| 2544 | return getKind() >= Bool && getKind() <= UInt128; |
| 2545 | } |
| 2546 | |
| 2547 | bool isFloatingPoint() const { |
| 2548 | return getKind() >= Half && getKind() <= Float128; |
| 2549 | } |
| 2550 | |
| 2551 | /// Determines whether the given kind corresponds to a placeholder type. |
| 2552 | static bool isPlaceholderTypeKind(Kind K) { |
| 2553 | return K >= Overload; |
| 2554 | } |
| 2555 | |
| 2556 | /// Determines whether this type is a placeholder type, i.e. a type |
| 2557 | /// which cannot appear in arbitrary positions in a fully-formed |
| 2558 | /// expression. |
| 2559 | bool isPlaceholderType() const { |
| 2560 | return isPlaceholderTypeKind(getKind()); |
| 2561 | } |
| 2562 | |
| 2563 | /// Determines whether this type is a placeholder type other than |
| 2564 | /// Overload. Most placeholder types require only syntactic |
| 2565 | /// information about their context in order to be resolved (e.g. |
| 2566 | /// whether it is a call expression), which means they can (and |
| 2567 | /// should) be resolved in an earlier "phase" of analysis. |
| 2568 | /// Overload expressions sometimes pick up further information |
| 2569 | /// from their context, like whether the context expects a |
| 2570 | /// specific function-pointer type, and so frequently need |
| 2571 | /// special treatment. |
| 2572 | bool isNonOverloadPlaceholderType() const { |
| 2573 | return getKind() > Overload; |
| 2574 | } |
| 2575 | |
| 2576 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Builtin; } |
| 2577 | }; |
| 2578 | |
| 2579 | /// Complex values, per C99 6.2.5p11. This supports the C99 complex |
| 2580 | /// types (_Complex float etc) as well as the GCC integer complex extensions. |
| 2581 | class ComplexType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 2582 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2583 | |
| 2584 | QualType ElementType; |
| 2585 | |
| 2586 | ComplexType(QualType Element, QualType CanonicalPtr) |
| 2587 | : Type(Complex, CanonicalPtr, Element->getDependence()), |
| 2588 | ElementType(Element) {} |
| 2589 | |
| 2590 | public: |
| 2591 | QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; } |
| 2592 | |
| 2593 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 2594 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 2595 | |
| 2596 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 2597 | Profile(ID, getElementType()); |
| 2598 | } |
| 2599 | |
| 2600 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Element) { |
| 2601 | ID.AddPointer(Element.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 2602 | } |
| 2603 | |
| 2604 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Complex; } |
| 2605 | }; |
| 2606 | |
| 2607 | /// Sugar for parentheses used when specifying types. |
| 2608 | class ParenType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 2609 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2610 | |
| 2611 | QualType Inner; |
| 2612 | |
| 2613 | ParenType(QualType InnerType, QualType CanonType) |
| 2614 | : Type(Paren, CanonType, InnerType->getDependence()), Inner(InnerType) {} |
| 2615 | |
| 2616 | public: |
| 2617 | QualType getInnerType() const { return Inner; } |
| 2618 | |
| 2619 | bool isSugared() const { return true; } |
| 2620 | QualType desugar() const { return getInnerType(); } |
| 2621 | |
| 2622 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 2623 | Profile(ID, getInnerType()); |
| 2624 | } |
| 2625 | |
| 2626 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Inner) { |
| 2627 | Inner.Profile(ID); |
| 2628 | } |
| 2629 | |
| 2630 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Paren; } |
| 2631 | }; |
| 2632 | |
| 2633 | /// PointerType - C99 6.7.5.1 - Pointer Declarators. |
| 2634 | class PointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 2635 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2636 | |
| 2637 | QualType PointeeType; |
| 2638 | |
| 2639 | PointerType(QualType Pointee, QualType CanonicalPtr) |
| 2640 | : Type(Pointer, CanonicalPtr, Pointee->getDependence()), |
| 2641 | PointeeType(Pointee) {} |
| 2642 | |
| 2643 | public: |
| 2644 | QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; } |
| 2645 | |
| 2646 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 2647 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 2648 | |
| 2649 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 2650 | Profile(ID, getPointeeType()); |
| 2651 | } |
| 2652 | |
| 2653 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Pointee) { |
| 2654 | ID.AddPointer(Pointee.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 2655 | } |
| 2656 | |
| 2657 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Pointer; } |
| 2658 | }; |
| 2659 | |
| 2660 | /// Represents a type which was implicitly adjusted by the semantic |
| 2661 | /// engine for arbitrary reasons. For example, array and function types can |
| 2662 | /// decay, and function types can have their calling conventions adjusted. |
| 2663 | class AdjustedType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 2664 | QualType OriginalTy; |
| 2665 | QualType AdjustedTy; |
| 2666 | |
| 2667 | protected: |
| 2668 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2669 | |
| 2670 | AdjustedType(TypeClass TC, QualType OriginalTy, QualType AdjustedTy, |
| 2671 | QualType CanonicalPtr) |
| 2672 | : Type(TC, CanonicalPtr, OriginalTy->getDependence()), |
| 2673 | OriginalTy(OriginalTy), AdjustedTy(AdjustedTy) {} |
| 2674 | |
| 2675 | public: |
| 2676 | QualType getOriginalType() const { return OriginalTy; } |
| 2677 | QualType getAdjustedType() const { return AdjustedTy; } |
| 2678 | |
| 2679 | bool isSugared() const { return true; } |
| 2680 | QualType desugar() const { return AdjustedTy; } |
| 2681 | |
| 2682 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 2683 | Profile(ID, OriginalTy, AdjustedTy); |
| 2684 | } |
| 2685 | |
| 2686 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Orig, QualType New) { |
| 2687 | ID.AddPointer(Orig.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 2688 | ID.AddPointer(New.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 2689 | } |
| 2690 | |
| 2691 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 2692 | return T->getTypeClass() == Adjusted || T->getTypeClass() == Decayed; |
| 2693 | } |
| 2694 | }; |
| 2695 | |
| 2696 | /// Represents a pointer type decayed from an array or function type. |
| 2697 | class DecayedType : public AdjustedType { |
| 2698 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2699 | |
| 2700 | inline |
| 2701 | DecayedType(QualType OriginalType, QualType Decayed, QualType Canonical); |
| 2702 | |
| 2703 | public: |
| 2704 | QualType getDecayedType() const { return getAdjustedType(); } |
| 2705 | |
| 2706 | inline QualType getPointeeType() const; |
| 2707 | |
| 2708 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Decayed; } |
| 2709 | }; |
| 2710 | |
| 2711 | /// Pointer to a block type. |
| 2712 | /// This type is to represent types syntactically represented as |
| 2713 | /// "void (^)(int)", etc. Pointee is required to always be a function type. |
| 2714 | class BlockPointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 2715 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2716 | |
| 2717 | // Block is some kind of pointer type |
| 2718 | QualType PointeeType; |
| 2719 | |
| 2720 | BlockPointerType(QualType Pointee, QualType CanonicalCls) |
| 2721 | : Type(BlockPointer, CanonicalCls, Pointee->getDependence()), |
| 2722 | PointeeType(Pointee) {} |
| 2723 | |
| 2724 | public: |
| 2725 | // Get the pointee type. Pointee is required to always be a function type. |
| 2726 | QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; } |
| 2727 | |
| 2728 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 2729 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 2730 | |
| 2731 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 2732 | Profile(ID, getPointeeType()); |
| 2733 | } |
| 2734 | |
| 2735 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Pointee) { |
| 2736 | ID.AddPointer(Pointee.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 2737 | } |
| 2738 | |
| 2739 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 2740 | return T->getTypeClass() == BlockPointer; |
| 2741 | } |
| 2742 | }; |
| 2743 | |
| 2744 | /// Base for LValueReferenceType and RValueReferenceType |
| 2745 | class ReferenceType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 2746 | QualType PointeeType; |
| 2747 | |
| 2748 | protected: |
| 2749 | ReferenceType(TypeClass tc, QualType Referencee, QualType CanonicalRef, |
| 2750 | bool SpelledAsLValue) |
| 2751 | : Type(tc, CanonicalRef, Referencee->getDependence()), |
| 2752 | PointeeType(Referencee) { |
| 2753 | ReferenceTypeBits.SpelledAsLValue = SpelledAsLValue; |
| 2754 | ReferenceTypeBits.InnerRef = Referencee->isReferenceType(); |
| 2755 | } |
| 2756 | |
| 2757 | public: |
| 2758 | bool isSpelledAsLValue() const { return ReferenceTypeBits.SpelledAsLValue; } |
| 2759 | bool isInnerRef() const { return ReferenceTypeBits.InnerRef; } |
| 2760 | |
| 2761 | QualType getPointeeTypeAsWritten() const { return PointeeType; } |
| 2762 | |
| 2763 | QualType getPointeeType() const { |
| 2764 | // FIXME: this might strip inner qualifiers; okay? |
| 2765 | const ReferenceType *T = this; |
| 2766 | while (T->isInnerRef()) |
| 2767 | T = T->PointeeType->castAs<ReferenceType>(); |
| 2768 | return T->PointeeType; |
| 2769 | } |
| 2770 | |
| 2771 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 2772 | Profile(ID, PointeeType, isSpelledAsLValue()); |
| 2773 | } |
| 2774 | |
| 2775 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, |
| 2776 | QualType Referencee, |
| 2777 | bool SpelledAsLValue) { |
| 2778 | ID.AddPointer(Referencee.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 2779 | ID.AddBoolean(SpelledAsLValue); |
| 2780 | } |
| 2781 | |
| 2782 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 2783 | return T->getTypeClass() == LValueReference || |
| 2784 | T->getTypeClass() == RValueReference; |
| 2785 | } |
| 2786 | }; |
| 2787 | |
| 2788 | /// An lvalue reference type, per C++11 [dcl.ref]. |
| 2789 | class LValueReferenceType : public ReferenceType { |
| 2790 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 2791 | |
| 2792 | LValueReferenceType(QualType Referencee, QualType CanonicalRef, |
| 2793 | bool SpelledAsLValue) |
| 2794 | : ReferenceType(LValueReference, Referencee, CanonicalRef, |
| 2795 | SpelledAsLValue) {} |
| 2796 | |
| 2797 | public: |
| 2798 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 2799 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 2800 | |
| 2801 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 2802 | return T->getTypeClass() == LValueReference; |
| 2803 | } |
| 2804 | }; |
| 2805 | |
| 2806 | /// An rvalue reference type, per C++11 [dcl.ref]. |
| 2807 | class RValueReferenceType : public ReferenceType { |
| 2808 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 2809 | |
| 2810 | RValueReferenceType(QualType Referencee, QualType CanonicalRef) |
| 2811 | : ReferenceType(RValueReference, Referencee, CanonicalRef, false) {} |
| 2812 | |
| 2813 | public: |
| 2814 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 2815 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 2816 | |
| 2817 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 2818 | return T->getTypeClass() == RValueReference; |
| 2819 | } |
| 2820 | }; |
| 2821 | |
| 2822 | /// A pointer to member type per C++ 8.3.3 - Pointers to members. |
| 2823 | /// |
| 2824 | /// This includes both pointers to data members and pointer to member functions. |
| 2825 | class MemberPointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 2826 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2827 | |
| 2828 | QualType PointeeType; |
| 2829 | |
| 2830 | /// The class of which the pointee is a member. Must ultimately be a |
| 2831 | /// RecordType, but could be a typedef or a template parameter too. |
| 2832 | const Type *Class; |
| 2833 | |
| 2834 | MemberPointerType(QualType Pointee, const Type *Cls, QualType CanonicalPtr) |
| 2835 | : Type(MemberPointer, CanonicalPtr, |
| 2836 | (Cls->getDependence() & ~TypeDependence::VariablyModified) | |
| 2837 | Pointee->getDependence()), |
| 2838 | PointeeType(Pointee), Class(Cls) {} |
| 2839 | |
| 2840 | public: |
| 2841 | QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; } |
| 2842 | |
| 2843 | /// Returns true if the member type (i.e. the pointee type) is a |
| 2844 | /// function type rather than a data-member type. |
| 2845 | bool isMemberFunctionPointer() const { |
| 2846 | return PointeeType->isFunctionProtoType(); |
| 2847 | } |
| 2848 | |
| 2849 | /// Returns true if the member type (i.e. the pointee type) is a |
| 2850 | /// data type rather than a function type. |
| 2851 | bool isMemberDataPointer() const { |
| 2852 | return !PointeeType->isFunctionProtoType(); |
| 2853 | } |
| 2854 | |
| 2855 | const Type *getClass() const { return Class; } |
| 2856 | CXXRecordDecl *getMostRecentCXXRecordDecl() const; |
| 2857 | |
| 2858 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 2859 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 2860 | |
| 2861 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 2862 | Profile(ID, getPointeeType(), getClass()); |
| 2863 | } |
| 2864 | |
| 2865 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Pointee, |
| 2866 | const Type *Class) { |
| 2867 | ID.AddPointer(Pointee.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 2868 | ID.AddPointer(Class); |
| 2869 | } |
| 2870 | |
| 2871 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 2872 | return T->getTypeClass() == MemberPointer; |
| 2873 | } |
| 2874 | }; |
| 2875 | |
| 2876 | /// Represents an array type, per C99 6.7.5.2 - Array Declarators. |
| 2877 | class ArrayType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 2878 | public: |
| 2879 | /// Capture whether this is a normal array (e.g. int X[4]) |
| 2880 | /// an array with a static size (e.g. int X[static 4]), or an array |
| 2881 | /// with a star size (e.g. int X[*]). |
| 2882 | /// 'static' is only allowed on function parameters. |
| 2883 | enum ArraySizeModifier { |
| 2884 | Normal, Static, Star |
| 2885 | }; |
| 2886 | |
| 2887 | private: |
| 2888 | /// The element type of the array. |
| 2889 | QualType ElementType; |
| 2890 | |
| 2891 | protected: |
| 2892 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2893 | |
| 2894 | ArrayType(TypeClass tc, QualType et, QualType can, ArraySizeModifier sm, |
| 2895 | unsigned tq, const Expr *sz = nullptr); |
| 2896 | |
| 2897 | public: |
| 2898 | QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; } |
| 2899 | |
| 2900 | ArraySizeModifier getSizeModifier() const { |
| 2901 | return ArraySizeModifier(ArrayTypeBits.SizeModifier); |
| 2902 | } |
| 2903 | |
| 2904 | Qualifiers getIndexTypeQualifiers() const { |
| 2905 | return Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()); |
| 2906 | } |
| 2907 | |
| 2908 | unsigned getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers() const { |
| 2909 | return ArrayTypeBits.IndexTypeQuals; |
| 2910 | } |
| 2911 | |
| 2912 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 2913 | return T->getTypeClass() == ConstantArray || |
| 2914 | T->getTypeClass() == VariableArray || |
| 2915 | T->getTypeClass() == IncompleteArray || |
| 2916 | T->getTypeClass() == DependentSizedArray; |
| 2917 | } |
| 2918 | }; |
| 2919 | |
| 2920 | /// Represents the canonical version of C arrays with a specified constant size. |
| 2921 | /// For example, the canonical type for 'int A[4 + 4*100]' is a |
| 2922 | /// ConstantArrayType where the element type is 'int' and the size is 404. |
| 2923 | class ConstantArrayType final |
| 2924 | : public ArrayType, |
| 2925 | private llvm::TrailingObjects<ConstantArrayType, const Expr *> { |
| 2926 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2927 | friend TrailingObjects; |
| 2928 | |
| 2929 | llvm::APInt Size; // Allows us to unique the type. |
| 2930 | |
| 2931 | ConstantArrayType(QualType et, QualType can, const llvm::APInt &size, |
| 2932 | const Expr *sz, ArraySizeModifier sm, unsigned tq) |
| 2933 | : ArrayType(ConstantArray, et, can, sm, tq, sz), Size(size) { |
| 2934 | ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasStoredSizeExpr = sz != nullptr; |
| 2935 | if (ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasStoredSizeExpr) { |
| 2936 | assert(!can.isNull() && "canonical constant array should not have size")((void)0); |
| 2937 | *getTrailingObjects<const Expr*>() = sz; |
| 2938 | } |
| 2939 | } |
| 2940 | |
| 2941 | unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<const Expr*>) const { |
| 2942 | return ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasStoredSizeExpr; |
| 2943 | } |
| 2944 | |
| 2945 | public: |
| 2946 | const llvm::APInt &getSize() const { return Size; } |
| 2947 | const Expr *getSizeExpr() const { |
| 2948 | return ConstantArrayTypeBits.HasStoredSizeExpr |
| 2949 | ? *getTrailingObjects<const Expr *>() |
| 2950 | : nullptr; |
| 2951 | } |
| 2952 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 2953 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 2954 | |
| 2955 | /// Determine the number of bits required to address a member of |
| 2956 | // an array with the given element type and number of elements. |
| 2957 | static unsigned getNumAddressingBits(const ASTContext &Context, |
| 2958 | QualType ElementType, |
| 2959 | const llvm::APInt &NumElements); |
| 2960 | |
| 2961 | /// Determine the maximum number of active bits that an array's size |
| 2962 | /// can require, which limits the maximum size of the array. |
| 2963 | static unsigned getMaxSizeBits(const ASTContext &Context); |
| 2964 | |
| 2965 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Ctx) { |
| 2966 | Profile(ID, Ctx, getElementType(), getSize(), getSizeExpr(), |
| 2967 | getSizeModifier(), getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()); |
| 2968 | } |
| 2969 | |
| 2970 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Ctx, |
| 2971 | QualType ET, const llvm::APInt &ArraySize, |
| 2972 | const Expr *SizeExpr, ArraySizeModifier SizeMod, |
| 2973 | unsigned TypeQuals); |
| 2974 | |
| 2975 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 2976 | return T->getTypeClass() == ConstantArray; |
| 2977 | } |
| 2978 | }; |
| 2979 | |
| 2980 | /// Represents a C array with an unspecified size. For example 'int A[]' has |
| 2981 | /// an IncompleteArrayType where the element type is 'int' and the size is |
| 2982 | /// unspecified. |
| 2983 | class IncompleteArrayType : public ArrayType { |
| 2984 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 2985 | |
| 2986 | IncompleteArrayType(QualType et, QualType can, |
| 2987 | ArraySizeModifier sm, unsigned tq) |
| 2988 | : ArrayType(IncompleteArray, et, can, sm, tq) {} |
| 2989 | |
| 2990 | public: |
| 2991 | friend class StmtIteratorBase; |
| 2992 | |
| 2993 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 2994 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 2995 | |
| 2996 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 2997 | return T->getTypeClass() == IncompleteArray; |
| 2998 | } |
| 2999 | |
| 3000 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 3001 | Profile(ID, getElementType(), getSizeModifier(), |
| 3002 | getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()); |
| 3003 | } |
| 3004 | |
| 3005 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ET, |
| 3006 | ArraySizeModifier SizeMod, unsigned TypeQuals) { |
| 3007 | ID.AddPointer(ET.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 3008 | ID.AddInteger(SizeMod); |
| 3009 | ID.AddInteger(TypeQuals); |
| 3010 | } |
| 3011 | }; |
| 3012 | |
| 3013 | /// Represents a C array with a specified size that is not an |
| 3014 | /// integer-constant-expression. For example, 'int s[x+foo()]'. |
| 3015 | /// Since the size expression is an arbitrary expression, we store it as such. |
| 3016 | /// |
| 3017 | /// Note: VariableArrayType's aren't uniqued (since the expressions aren't) and |
| 3018 | /// should not be: two lexically equivalent variable array types could mean |
| 3019 | /// different things, for example, these variables do not have the same type |
| 3020 | /// dynamically: |
| 3021 | /// |
| 3022 | /// void foo(int x) { |
| 3023 | /// int Y[x]; |
| 3024 | /// ++x; |
| 3025 | /// int Z[x]; |
| 3026 | /// } |
| 3027 | class VariableArrayType : public ArrayType { |
| 3028 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 3029 | |
| 3030 | /// An assignment-expression. VLA's are only permitted within |
| 3031 | /// a function block. |
| 3032 | Stmt *SizeExpr; |
| 3033 | |
| 3034 | /// The range spanned by the left and right array brackets. |
| 3035 | SourceRange Brackets; |
| 3036 | |
| 3037 | VariableArrayType(QualType et, QualType can, Expr *e, |
| 3038 | ArraySizeModifier sm, unsigned tq, |
| 3039 | SourceRange brackets) |
| 3040 | : ArrayType(VariableArray, et, can, sm, tq, e), |
| 3041 | SizeExpr((Stmt*) e), Brackets(brackets) {} |
| 3042 | |
| 3043 | public: |
| 3044 | friend class StmtIteratorBase; |
| 3045 | |
| 3046 | Expr *getSizeExpr() const { |
| 3047 | // We use C-style casts instead of cast<> here because we do not wish |
| 3048 | // to have a dependency of Type.h on Stmt.h/Expr.h. |
| 3049 | return (Expr*) SizeExpr; |
| 3050 | } |
| 3051 | |
| 3052 | SourceRange getBracketsRange() const { return Brackets; } |
| 3053 | SourceLocation getLBracketLoc() const { return Brackets.getBegin(); } |
| 3054 | SourceLocation getRBracketLoc() const { return Brackets.getEnd(); } |
| 3055 | |
| 3056 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 3057 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 3058 | |
| 3059 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3060 | return T->getTypeClass() == VariableArray; |
| 3061 | } |
| 3062 | |
| 3063 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 3064 | llvm_unreachable("Cannot unique VariableArrayTypes.")__builtin_unreachable(); |
| 3065 | } |
| 3066 | }; |
| 3067 | |
| 3068 | /// Represents an array type in C++ whose size is a value-dependent expression. |
| 3069 | /// |
| 3070 | /// For example: |
| 3071 | /// \code |
| 3072 | /// template<typename T, int Size> |
| 3073 | /// class array { |
| 3074 | /// T data[Size]; |
| 3075 | /// }; |
| 3076 | /// \endcode |
| 3077 | /// |
| 3078 | /// For these types, we won't actually know what the array bound is |
| 3079 | /// until template instantiation occurs, at which point this will |
| 3080 | /// become either a ConstantArrayType or a VariableArrayType. |
| 3081 | class DependentSizedArrayType : public ArrayType { |
| 3082 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 3083 | |
| 3084 | const ASTContext &Context; |
| 3085 | |
| 3086 | /// An assignment expression that will instantiate to the |
| 3087 | /// size of the array. |
| 3088 | /// |
| 3089 | /// The expression itself might be null, in which case the array |
| 3090 | /// type will have its size deduced from an initializer. |
| 3091 | Stmt *SizeExpr; |
| 3092 | |
| 3093 | /// The range spanned by the left and right array brackets. |
| 3094 | SourceRange Brackets; |
| 3095 | |
| 3096 | DependentSizedArrayType(const ASTContext &Context, QualType et, QualType can, |
| 3097 | Expr *e, ArraySizeModifier sm, unsigned tq, |
| 3098 | SourceRange brackets); |
| 3099 | |
| 3100 | public: |
| 3101 | friend class StmtIteratorBase; |
| 3102 | |
| 3103 | Expr *getSizeExpr() const { |
| 3104 | // We use C-style casts instead of cast<> here because we do not wish |
| 3105 | // to have a dependency of Type.h on Stmt.h/Expr.h. |
| 3106 | return (Expr*) SizeExpr; |
| 3107 | } |
| 3108 | |
| 3109 | SourceRange getBracketsRange() const { return Brackets; } |
| 3110 | SourceLocation getLBracketLoc() const { return Brackets.getBegin(); } |
| 3111 | SourceLocation getRBracketLoc() const { return Brackets.getEnd(); } |
| 3112 | |
| 3113 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 3114 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 3115 | |
| 3116 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3117 | return T->getTypeClass() == DependentSizedArray; |
| 3118 | } |
| 3119 | |
| 3120 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 3121 | Profile(ID, Context, getElementType(), |
| 3122 | getSizeModifier(), getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(), getSizeExpr()); |
| 3123 | } |
| 3124 | |
| 3125 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context, |
| 3126 | QualType ET, ArraySizeModifier SizeMod, |
| 3127 | unsigned TypeQuals, Expr *E); |
| 3128 | }; |
| 3129 | |
| 3130 | /// Represents an extended address space qualifier where the input address space |
| 3131 | /// value is dependent. Non-dependent address spaces are not represented with a |
| 3132 | /// special Type subclass; they are stored on an ExtQuals node as part of a QualType. |
| 3133 | /// |
| 3134 | /// For example: |
| 3135 | /// \code |
| 3136 | /// template<typename T, int AddrSpace> |
| 3137 | /// class AddressSpace { |
| 3138 | /// typedef T __attribute__((address_space(AddrSpace))) type; |
| 3139 | /// } |
| 3140 | /// \endcode |
| 3141 | class DependentAddressSpaceType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 3142 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 3143 | |
| 3144 | const ASTContext &Context; |
| 3145 | Expr *AddrSpaceExpr; |
| 3146 | QualType PointeeType; |
| 3147 | SourceLocation loc; |
| 3148 | |
| 3149 | DependentAddressSpaceType(const ASTContext &Context, QualType PointeeType, |
| 3150 | QualType can, Expr *AddrSpaceExpr, |
| 3151 | SourceLocation loc); |
| 3152 | |
| 3153 | public: |
| 3154 | Expr *getAddrSpaceExpr() const { return AddrSpaceExpr; } |
| 3155 | QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; } |
| 3156 | SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const { return loc; } |
| 3157 | |
| 3158 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 3159 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 3160 | |
| 3161 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3162 | return T->getTypeClass() == DependentAddressSpace; |
| 3163 | } |
| 3164 | |
| 3165 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 3166 | Profile(ID, Context, getPointeeType(), getAddrSpaceExpr()); |
| 3167 | } |
| 3168 | |
| 3169 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context, |
| 3170 | QualType PointeeType, Expr *AddrSpaceExpr); |
| 3171 | }; |
| 3172 | |
| 3173 | /// Represents an extended vector type where either the type or size is |
| 3174 | /// dependent. |
| 3175 | /// |
| 3176 | /// For example: |
| 3177 | /// \code |
| 3178 | /// template<typename T, int Size> |
| 3179 | /// class vector { |
| 3180 | /// typedef T __attribute__((ext_vector_type(Size))) type; |
| 3181 | /// } |
| 3182 | /// \endcode |
| 3183 | class DependentSizedExtVectorType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 3184 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 3185 | |
| 3186 | const ASTContext &Context; |
| 3187 | Expr *SizeExpr; |
| 3188 | |
| 3189 | /// The element type of the array. |
| 3190 | QualType ElementType; |
| 3191 | |
| 3192 | SourceLocation loc; |
| 3193 | |
| 3194 | DependentSizedExtVectorType(const ASTContext &Context, QualType ElementType, |
| 3195 | QualType can, Expr *SizeExpr, SourceLocation loc); |
| 3196 | |
| 3197 | public: |
| 3198 | Expr *getSizeExpr() const { return SizeExpr; } |
| 3199 | QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; } |
| 3200 | SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const { return loc; } |
| 3201 | |
| 3202 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 3203 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 3204 | |
| 3205 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3206 | return T->getTypeClass() == DependentSizedExtVector; |
| 3207 | } |
| 3208 | |
| 3209 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 3210 | Profile(ID, Context, getElementType(), getSizeExpr()); |
| 3211 | } |
| 3212 | |
| 3213 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context, |
| 3214 | QualType ElementType, Expr *SizeExpr); |
| 3215 | }; |
| 3216 | |
| 3217 | |
| 3218 | /// Represents a GCC generic vector type. This type is created using |
| 3219 | /// __attribute__((vector_size(n)), where "n" specifies the vector size in |
| 3220 | /// bytes; or from an Altivec __vector or vector declaration. |
| 3221 | /// Since the constructor takes the number of vector elements, the |
| 3222 | /// client is responsible for converting the size into the number of elements. |
| 3223 | class VectorType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 3224 | public: |
| 3225 | enum VectorKind { |
| 3226 | /// not a target-specific vector type |
| 3227 | GenericVector, |
| 3228 | |
| 3229 | /// is AltiVec vector |
| 3230 | AltiVecVector, |
| 3231 | |
| 3232 | /// is AltiVec 'vector Pixel' |
| 3233 | AltiVecPixel, |
| 3234 | |
| 3235 | /// is AltiVec 'vector bool ...' |
| 3236 | AltiVecBool, |
| 3237 | |
| 3238 | /// is ARM Neon vector |
| 3239 | NeonVector, |
| 3240 | |
| 3241 | /// is ARM Neon polynomial vector |
| 3242 | NeonPolyVector, |
| 3243 | |
| 3244 | /// is AArch64 SVE fixed-length data vector |
| 3245 | SveFixedLengthDataVector, |
| 3246 | |
| 3247 | /// is AArch64 SVE fixed-length predicate vector |
| 3248 | SveFixedLengthPredicateVector |
| 3249 | }; |
| 3250 | |
| 3251 | protected: |
| 3252 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 3253 | |
| 3254 | /// The element type of the vector. |
| 3255 | QualType ElementType; |
| 3256 | |
| 3257 | VectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned nElements, QualType canonType, |
| 3258 | VectorKind vecKind); |
| 3259 | |
| 3260 | VectorType(TypeClass tc, QualType vecType, unsigned nElements, |
| 3261 | QualType canonType, VectorKind vecKind); |
| 3262 | |
| 3263 | public: |
| 3264 | QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; } |
| 3265 | unsigned getNumElements() const { return VectorTypeBits.NumElements; } |
| 3266 | |
| 3267 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 3268 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 3269 | |
| 3270 | VectorKind getVectorKind() const { |
| 3271 | return VectorKind(VectorTypeBits.VecKind); |
| 3272 | } |
| 3273 | |
| 3274 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 3275 | Profile(ID, getElementType(), getNumElements(), |
| 3276 | getTypeClass(), getVectorKind()); |
| 3277 | } |
| 3278 | |
| 3279 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ElementType, |
| 3280 | unsigned NumElements, TypeClass TypeClass, |
| 3281 | VectorKind VecKind) { |
| 3282 | ID.AddPointer(ElementType.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 3283 | ID.AddInteger(NumElements); |
| 3284 | ID.AddInteger(TypeClass); |
| 3285 | ID.AddInteger(VecKind); |
| 3286 | } |
| 3287 | |
| 3288 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3289 | return T->getTypeClass() == Vector || T->getTypeClass() == ExtVector; |
| 3290 | } |
| 3291 | }; |
| 3292 | |
| 3293 | /// Represents a vector type where either the type or size is dependent. |
| 3294 | //// |
| 3295 | /// For example: |
| 3296 | /// \code |
| 3297 | /// template<typename T, int Size> |
| 3298 | /// class vector { |
| 3299 | /// typedef T __attribute__((vector_size(Size))) type; |
| 3300 | /// } |
| 3301 | /// \endcode |
| 3302 | class DependentVectorType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 3303 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 3304 | |
| 3305 | const ASTContext &Context; |
| 3306 | QualType ElementType; |
| 3307 | Expr *SizeExpr; |
| 3308 | SourceLocation Loc; |
| 3309 | |
| 3310 | DependentVectorType(const ASTContext &Context, QualType ElementType, |
| 3311 | QualType CanonType, Expr *SizeExpr, |
| 3312 | SourceLocation Loc, VectorType::VectorKind vecKind); |
| 3313 | |
| 3314 | public: |
| 3315 | Expr *getSizeExpr() const { return SizeExpr; } |
| 3316 | QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; } |
| 3317 | SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const { return Loc; } |
| 3318 | VectorType::VectorKind getVectorKind() const { |
| 3319 | return VectorType::VectorKind(VectorTypeBits.VecKind); |
| 3320 | } |
| 3321 | |
| 3322 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 3323 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 3324 | |
| 3325 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3326 | return T->getTypeClass() == DependentVector; |
| 3327 | } |
| 3328 | |
| 3329 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 3330 | Profile(ID, Context, getElementType(), getSizeExpr(), getVectorKind()); |
| 3331 | } |
| 3332 | |
| 3333 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context, |
| 3334 | QualType ElementType, const Expr *SizeExpr, |
| 3335 | VectorType::VectorKind VecKind); |
| 3336 | }; |
| 3337 | |
| 3338 | /// ExtVectorType - Extended vector type. This type is created using |
| 3339 | /// __attribute__((ext_vector_type(n)), where "n" is the number of elements. |
| 3340 | /// Unlike vector_size, ext_vector_type is only allowed on typedef's. This |
| 3341 | /// class enables syntactic extensions, like Vector Components for accessing |
| 3342 | /// points (as .xyzw), colors (as .rgba), and textures (modeled after OpenGL |
| 3343 | /// Shading Language). |
| 3344 | class ExtVectorType : public VectorType { |
| 3345 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 3346 | |
| 3347 | ExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned nElements, QualType canonType) |
| 3348 | : VectorType(ExtVector, vecType, nElements, canonType, GenericVector) {} |
| 3349 | |
| 3350 | public: |
| 3351 | static int getPointAccessorIdx(char c) { |
| 3352 | switch (c) { |
| 3353 | default: return -1; |
| 3354 | case 'x': case 'r': return 0; |
| 3355 | case 'y': case 'g': return 1; |
| 3356 | case 'z': case 'b': return 2; |
| 3357 | case 'w': case 'a': return 3; |
| 3358 | } |
| 3359 | } |
| 3360 | |
| 3361 | static int getNumericAccessorIdx(char c) { |
| 3362 | switch (c) { |
| 3363 | default: return -1; |
| 3364 | case '0': return 0; |
| 3365 | case '1': return 1; |
| 3366 | case '2': return 2; |
| 3367 | case '3': return 3; |
| 3368 | case '4': return 4; |
| 3369 | case '5': return 5; |
| 3370 | case '6': return 6; |
| 3371 | case '7': return 7; |
| 3372 | case '8': return 8; |
| 3373 | case '9': return 9; |
| 3374 | case 'A': |
| 3375 | case 'a': return 10; |
| 3376 | case 'B': |
| 3377 | case 'b': return 11; |
| 3378 | case 'C': |
| 3379 | case 'c': return 12; |
| 3380 | case 'D': |
| 3381 | case 'd': return 13; |
| 3382 | case 'E': |
| 3383 | case 'e': return 14; |
| 3384 | case 'F': |
| 3385 | case 'f': return 15; |
| 3386 | } |
| 3387 | } |
| 3388 | |
| 3389 | static int getAccessorIdx(char c, bool isNumericAccessor) { |
| 3390 | if (isNumericAccessor) |
| 3391 | return getNumericAccessorIdx(c); |
| 3392 | else |
| 3393 | return getPointAccessorIdx(c); |
| 3394 | } |
| 3395 | |
| 3396 | bool isAccessorWithinNumElements(char c, bool isNumericAccessor) const { |
| 3397 | if (int idx = getAccessorIdx(c, isNumericAccessor)+1) |
| 3398 | return unsigned(idx-1) < getNumElements(); |
| 3399 | return false; |
| 3400 | } |
| 3401 | |
| 3402 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 3403 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 3404 | |
| 3405 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3406 | return T->getTypeClass() == ExtVector; |
| 3407 | } |
| 3408 | }; |
| 3409 | |
| 3410 | /// Represents a matrix type, as defined in the Matrix Types clang extensions. |
| 3411 | /// __attribute__((matrix_type(rows, columns))), where "rows" specifies |
| 3412 | /// number of rows and "columns" specifies the number of columns. |
| 3413 | class MatrixType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 3414 | protected: |
| 3415 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 3416 | |
| 3417 | /// The element type of the matrix. |
| 3418 | QualType ElementType; |
| 3419 | |
| 3420 | MatrixType(QualType ElementTy, QualType CanonElementTy); |
| 3421 | |
| 3422 | MatrixType(TypeClass TypeClass, QualType ElementTy, QualType CanonElementTy, |
| 3423 | const Expr *RowExpr = nullptr, const Expr *ColumnExpr = nullptr); |
| 3424 | |
| 3425 | public: |
| 3426 | /// Returns type of the elements being stored in the matrix |
| 3427 | QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; } |
| 3428 | |
| 3429 | /// Valid elements types are the following: |
| 3430 | /// * an integer type (as in C2x 6.2.5p19), but excluding enumerated types |
| 3431 | /// and _Bool |
| 3432 | /// * the standard floating types float or double |
| 3433 | /// * a half-precision floating point type, if one is supported on the target |
| 3434 | static bool isValidElementType(QualType T) { |
| 3435 | return T->isDependentType() || |
| 3436 | (T->isRealType() && !T->isBooleanType() && !T->isEnumeralType()); |
| 3437 | } |
| 3438 | |
| 3439 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 3440 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 3441 | |
| 3442 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3443 | return T->getTypeClass() == ConstantMatrix || |
| 3444 | T->getTypeClass() == DependentSizedMatrix; |
| 3445 | } |
| 3446 | }; |
| 3447 | |
| 3448 | /// Represents a concrete matrix type with constant number of rows and columns |
| 3449 | class ConstantMatrixType final : public MatrixType { |
| 3450 | protected: |
| 3451 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 3452 | |
| 3453 | /// The element type of the matrix. |
| 3454 | // FIXME: Appears to be unused? There is also MatrixType::ElementType... |
| 3455 | QualType ElementType; |
| 3456 | |
| 3457 | /// Number of rows and columns. |
| 3458 | unsigned NumRows; |
| 3459 | unsigned NumColumns; |
| 3460 | |
| 3461 | static constexpr unsigned MaxElementsPerDimension = (1 << 20) - 1; |
| 3462 | |
| 3463 | ConstantMatrixType(QualType MatrixElementType, unsigned NRows, |
| 3464 | unsigned NColumns, QualType CanonElementType); |
| 3465 | |
| 3466 | ConstantMatrixType(TypeClass typeClass, QualType MatrixType, unsigned NRows, |
| 3467 | unsigned NColumns, QualType CanonElementType); |
| 3468 | |
| 3469 | public: |
| 3470 | /// Returns the number of rows in the matrix. |
| 3471 | unsigned getNumRows() const { return NumRows; } |
| 3472 | |
| 3473 | /// Returns the number of columns in the matrix. |
| 3474 | unsigned getNumColumns() const { return NumColumns; } |
| 3475 | |
| 3476 | /// Returns the number of elements required to embed the matrix into a vector. |
| 3477 | unsigned getNumElementsFlattened() const { |
| 3478 | return getNumRows() * getNumColumns(); |
| 3479 | } |
| 3480 | |
| 3481 | /// Returns true if \p NumElements is a valid matrix dimension. |
| 3482 | static constexpr bool isDimensionValid(size_t NumElements) { |
| 3483 | return NumElements > 0 && NumElements <= MaxElementsPerDimension; |
| 3484 | } |
| 3485 | |
| 3486 | /// Returns the maximum number of elements per dimension. |
| 3487 | static constexpr unsigned getMaxElementsPerDimension() { |
| 3488 | return MaxElementsPerDimension; |
| 3489 | } |
| 3490 | |
| 3491 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 3492 | Profile(ID, getElementType(), getNumRows(), getNumColumns(), |
| 3493 | getTypeClass()); |
| 3494 | } |
| 3495 | |
| 3496 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ElementType, |
| 3497 | unsigned NumRows, unsigned NumColumns, |
| 3498 | TypeClass TypeClass) { |
| 3499 | ID.AddPointer(ElementType.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 3500 | ID.AddInteger(NumRows); |
| 3501 | ID.AddInteger(NumColumns); |
| 3502 | ID.AddInteger(TypeClass); |
| 3503 | } |
| 3504 | |
| 3505 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3506 | return T->getTypeClass() == ConstantMatrix; |
| 3507 | } |
| 3508 | }; |
| 3509 | |
| 3510 | /// Represents a matrix type where the type and the number of rows and columns |
| 3511 | /// is dependent on a template. |
| 3512 | class DependentSizedMatrixType final : public MatrixType { |
| 3513 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 3514 | |
| 3515 | const ASTContext &Context; |
| 3516 | Expr *RowExpr; |
| 3517 | Expr *ColumnExpr; |
| 3518 | |
| 3519 | SourceLocation loc; |
| 3520 | |
| 3521 | DependentSizedMatrixType(const ASTContext &Context, QualType ElementType, |
| 3522 | QualType CanonicalType, Expr *RowExpr, |
| 3523 | Expr *ColumnExpr, SourceLocation loc); |
| 3524 | |
| 3525 | public: |
| 3526 | QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; } |
| 3527 | Expr *getRowExpr() const { return RowExpr; } |
| 3528 | Expr *getColumnExpr() const { return ColumnExpr; } |
| 3529 | SourceLocation getAttributeLoc() const { return loc; } |
| 3530 | |
| 3531 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 3532 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 3533 | |
| 3534 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3535 | return T->getTypeClass() == DependentSizedMatrix; |
| 3536 | } |
| 3537 | |
| 3538 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 3539 | Profile(ID, Context, getElementType(), getRowExpr(), getColumnExpr()); |
| 3540 | } |
| 3541 | |
| 3542 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context, |
| 3543 | QualType ElementType, Expr *RowExpr, Expr *ColumnExpr); |
| 3544 | }; |
| 3545 | |
| 3546 | /// FunctionType - C99 6.7.5.3 - Function Declarators. This is the common base |
| 3547 | /// class of FunctionNoProtoType and FunctionProtoType. |
| 3548 | class FunctionType : public Type { |
| 3549 | // The type returned by the function. |
| 3550 | QualType ResultType; |
| 3551 | |
| 3552 | public: |
| 3553 | /// Interesting information about a specific parameter that can't simply |
| 3554 | /// be reflected in parameter's type. This is only used by FunctionProtoType |
| 3555 | /// but is in FunctionType to make this class available during the |
| 3556 | /// specification of the bases of FunctionProtoType. |
| 3557 | /// |
| 3558 | /// It makes sense to model language features this way when there's some |
| 3559 | /// sort of parameter-specific override (such as an attribute) that |
| 3560 | /// affects how the function is called. For example, the ARC ns_consumed |
| 3561 | /// attribute changes whether a parameter is passed at +0 (the default) |
| 3562 | /// or +1 (ns_consumed). This must be reflected in the function type, |
| 3563 | /// but isn't really a change to the parameter type. |
| 3564 | /// |
| 3565 | /// One serious disadvantage of modelling language features this way is |
| 3566 | /// that they generally do not work with language features that attempt |
| 3567 | /// to destructure types. For example, template argument deduction will |
| 3568 | /// not be able to match a parameter declared as |
| 3569 | /// T (*)(U) |
| 3570 | /// against an argument of type |
| 3571 | /// void (*)(__attribute__((ns_consumed)) id) |
| 3572 | /// because the substitution of T=void, U=id into the former will |
| 3573 | /// not produce the latter. |
| 3574 | class ExtParameterInfo { |
| 3575 | enum { |
| 3576 | ABIMask = 0x0F, |
| 3577 | IsConsumed = 0x10, |
| 3578 | HasPassObjSize = 0x20, |
| 3579 | IsNoEscape = 0x40, |
| 3580 | }; |
| 3581 | unsigned char Data = 0; |
| 3582 | |
| 3583 | public: |
| 3584 | ExtParameterInfo() = default; |
| 3585 | |
| 3586 | /// Return the ABI treatment of this parameter. |
| 3587 | ParameterABI getABI() const { return ParameterABI(Data & ABIMask); } |
| 3588 | ExtParameterInfo withABI(ParameterABI kind) const { |
| 3589 | ExtParameterInfo copy = *this; |
| 3590 | copy.Data = (copy.Data & ~ABIMask) | unsigned(kind); |
| 3591 | return copy; |
| 3592 | } |
| 3593 | |
| 3594 | /// Is this parameter considered "consumed" by Objective-C ARC? |
| 3595 | /// Consumed parameters must have retainable object type. |
| 3596 | bool isConsumed() const { return (Data & IsConsumed); } |
| 3597 | ExtParameterInfo withIsConsumed(bool consumed) const { |
| 3598 | ExtParameterInfo copy = *this; |
| 3599 | if (consumed) |
| 3600 | copy.Data |= IsConsumed; |
| 3601 | else |
| 3602 | copy.Data &= ~IsConsumed; |
| 3603 | return copy; |
| 3604 | } |
| 3605 | |
| 3606 | bool hasPassObjectSize() const { return Data & HasPassObjSize; } |
| 3607 | ExtParameterInfo withHasPassObjectSize() const { |
| 3608 | ExtParameterInfo Copy = *this; |
| 3609 | Copy.Data |= HasPassObjSize; |
| 3610 | return Copy; |
| 3611 | } |
| 3612 | |
| 3613 | bool isNoEscape() const { return Data & IsNoEscape; } |
| 3614 | ExtParameterInfo withIsNoEscape(bool NoEscape) const { |
| 3615 | ExtParameterInfo Copy = *this; |
| 3616 | if (NoEscape) |
| 3617 | Copy.Data |= IsNoEscape; |
| 3618 | else |
| 3619 | Copy.Data &= ~IsNoEscape; |
| 3620 | return Copy; |
| 3621 | } |
| 3622 | |
| 3623 | unsigned char getOpaqueValue() const { return Data; } |
| 3624 | static ExtParameterInfo getFromOpaqueValue(unsigned char data) { |
| 3625 | ExtParameterInfo result; |
| 3626 | result.Data = data; |
| 3627 | return result; |
| 3628 | } |
| 3629 | |
| 3630 | friend bool operator==(ExtParameterInfo lhs, ExtParameterInfo rhs) { |
| 3631 | return lhs.Data == rhs.Data; |
| 3632 | } |
| 3633 | |
| 3634 | friend bool operator!=(ExtParameterInfo lhs, ExtParameterInfo rhs) { |
| 3635 | return lhs.Data != rhs.Data; |
| 3636 | } |
| 3637 | }; |
| 3638 | |
| 3639 | /// A class which abstracts out some details necessary for |
| 3640 | /// making a call. |
| 3641 | /// |
| 3642 | /// It is not actually used directly for storing this information in |
| 3643 | /// a FunctionType, although FunctionType does currently use the |
| 3644 | /// same bit-pattern. |
| 3645 | /// |
| 3646 | // If you add a field (say Foo), other than the obvious places (both, |
| 3647 | // constructors, compile failures), what you need to update is |
| 3648 | // * Operator== |
| 3649 | // * getFoo |
| 3650 | // * withFoo |
| 3651 | // * functionType. Add Foo, getFoo. |
| 3652 | // * ASTContext::getFooType |
| 3653 | // * ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes |
| 3654 | // * FunctionNoProtoType::Profile |
| 3655 | // * FunctionProtoType::Profile |
| 3656 | // * TypePrinter::PrintFunctionProto |
| 3657 | // * AST read and write |
| 3658 | // * Codegen |
| 3659 | class ExtInfo { |
| 3660 | friend class FunctionType; |
| 3661 | |
| 3662 | // Feel free to rearrange or add bits, but if you go over 16, you'll need to |
| 3663 | // adjust the Bits field below, and if you add bits, you'll need to adjust |
| 3664 | // Type::FunctionTypeBitfields::ExtInfo as well. |
| 3665 | |
| 3666 | // | CC |noreturn|produces|nocallersavedregs|regparm|nocfcheck|cmsenscall| |
| 3667 | // |0 .. 4| 5 | 6 | 7 |8 .. 10| 11 | 12 | |
| 3668 | // |
| 3669 | // regparm is either 0 (no regparm attribute) or the regparm value+1. |
| 3670 | enum { CallConvMask = 0x1F }; |
| 3671 | enum { NoReturnMask = 0x20 }; |
| 3672 | enum { ProducesResultMask = 0x40 }; |
| 3673 | enum { NoCallerSavedRegsMask = 0x80 }; |
| 3674 | enum { |
| 3675 | RegParmMask = 0x700, |
| 3676 | RegParmOffset = 8 |
| 3677 | }; |
| 3678 | enum { NoCfCheckMask = 0x800 }; |
| 3679 | enum { CmseNSCallMask = 0x1000 }; |
| 3680 | uint16_t Bits = CC_C; |
| 3681 | |
| 3682 | ExtInfo(unsigned Bits) : Bits(static_cast<uint16_t>(Bits)) {} |
| 3683 | |
| 3684 | public: |
| 3685 | // Constructor with no defaults. Use this when you know that you |
| 3686 | // have all the elements (when reading an AST file for example). |
| 3687 | ExtInfo(bool noReturn, bool hasRegParm, unsigned regParm, CallingConv cc, |
| 3688 | bool producesResult, bool noCallerSavedRegs, bool NoCfCheck, |
| 3689 | bool cmseNSCall) { |
| 3690 | assert((!hasRegParm || regParm < 7) && "Invalid regparm value")((void)0); |
| 3691 | Bits = ((unsigned)cc) | (noReturn ? NoReturnMask : 0) | |
| 3692 | (producesResult ? ProducesResultMask : 0) | |
| 3693 | (noCallerSavedRegs ? NoCallerSavedRegsMask : 0) | |
| 3694 | (hasRegParm ? ((regParm + 1) << RegParmOffset) : 0) | |
| 3695 | (NoCfCheck ? NoCfCheckMask : 0) | |
| 3696 | (cmseNSCall ? CmseNSCallMask : 0); |
| 3697 | } |
| 3698 | |
| 3699 | // Constructor with all defaults. Use when for example creating a |
| 3700 | // function known to use defaults. |
| 3701 | ExtInfo() = default; |
| 3702 | |
| 3703 | // Constructor with just the calling convention, which is an important part |
| 3704 | // of the canonical type. |
| 3705 | ExtInfo(CallingConv CC) : Bits(CC) {} |
| 3706 | |
| 3707 | bool getNoReturn() const { return Bits & NoReturnMask; } |
| 3708 | bool getProducesResult() const { return Bits & ProducesResultMask; } |
| 3709 | bool getCmseNSCall() const { return Bits & CmseNSCallMask; } |
| 3710 | bool getNoCallerSavedRegs() const { return Bits & NoCallerSavedRegsMask; } |
| 3711 | bool getNoCfCheck() const { return Bits & NoCfCheckMask; } |
| 3712 | bool getHasRegParm() const { return ((Bits & RegParmMask) >> RegParmOffset) != 0; } |
| 3713 | |
| 3714 | unsigned getRegParm() const { |
| 3715 | unsigned RegParm = (Bits & RegParmMask) >> RegParmOffset; |
| 3716 | if (RegParm > 0) |
| 3717 | --RegParm; |
| 3718 | return RegParm; |
| 3719 | } |
| 3720 | |
| 3721 | CallingConv getCC() const { return CallingConv(Bits & CallConvMask); } |
| 3722 | |
| 3723 | bool operator==(ExtInfo Other) const { |
| 3724 | return Bits == Other.Bits; |
| 3725 | } |
| 3726 | bool operator!=(ExtInfo Other) const { |
| 3727 | return Bits != Other.Bits; |
| 3728 | } |
| 3729 | |
| 3730 | // Note that we don't have setters. That is by design, use |
| 3731 | // the following with methods instead of mutating these objects. |
| 3732 | |
| 3733 | ExtInfo withNoReturn(bool noReturn) const { |
| 3734 | if (noReturn) |
| 3735 | return ExtInfo(Bits | NoReturnMask); |
| 3736 | else |
| 3737 | return ExtInfo(Bits & ~NoReturnMask); |
| 3738 | } |
| 3739 | |
| 3740 | ExtInfo withProducesResult(bool producesResult) const { |
| 3741 | if (producesResult) |
| 3742 | return ExtInfo(Bits | ProducesResultMask); |
| 3743 | else |
| 3744 | return ExtInfo(Bits & ~ProducesResultMask); |
| 3745 | } |
| 3746 | |
| 3747 | ExtInfo withCmseNSCall(bool cmseNSCall) const { |
| 3748 | if (cmseNSCall) |
| 3749 | return ExtInfo(Bits | CmseNSCallMask); |
| 3750 | else |
| 3751 | return ExtInfo(Bits & ~CmseNSCallMask); |
| 3752 | } |
| 3753 | |
| 3754 | ExtInfo withNoCallerSavedRegs(bool noCallerSavedRegs) const { |
| 3755 | if (noCallerSavedRegs) |
| 3756 | return ExtInfo(Bits | NoCallerSavedRegsMask); |
| 3757 | else |
| 3758 | return ExtInfo(Bits & ~NoCallerSavedRegsMask); |
| 3759 | } |
| 3760 | |
| 3761 | ExtInfo withNoCfCheck(bool noCfCheck) const { |
| 3762 | if (noCfCheck) |
| 3763 | return ExtInfo(Bits | NoCfCheckMask); |
| 3764 | else |
| 3765 | return ExtInfo(Bits & ~NoCfCheckMask); |
| 3766 | } |
| 3767 | |
| 3768 | ExtInfo withRegParm(unsigned RegParm) const { |
| 3769 | assert(RegParm < 7 && "Invalid regparm value")((void)0); |
| 3770 | return ExtInfo((Bits & ~RegParmMask) | |
| 3771 | ((RegParm + 1) << RegParmOffset)); |
| 3772 | } |
| 3773 | |
| 3774 | ExtInfo withCallingConv(CallingConv cc) const { |
| 3775 | return ExtInfo((Bits & ~CallConvMask) | (unsigned) cc); |
| 3776 | } |
| 3777 | |
| 3778 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const { |
| 3779 | ID.AddInteger(Bits); |
| 3780 | } |
| 3781 | }; |
| 3782 | |
| 3783 | /// A simple holder for a QualType representing a type in an |
| 3784 | /// exception specification. Unfortunately needed by FunctionProtoType |
| 3785 | /// because TrailingObjects cannot handle repeated types. |
| 3786 | struct ExceptionType { QualType Type; }; |
| 3787 | |
| 3788 | /// A simple holder for various uncommon bits which do not fit in |
| 3789 | /// FunctionTypeBitfields. Aligned to alignof(void *) to maintain the |
| 3790 | /// alignment of subsequent objects in TrailingObjects. You must update |
| 3791 | /// hasExtraBitfields in FunctionProtoType after adding extra data here. |
| 3792 | struct alignas(void *) FunctionTypeExtraBitfields { |
| 3793 | /// The number of types in the exception specification. |
| 3794 | /// A whole unsigned is not needed here and according to |
| 3795 | /// [implimits] 8 bits would be enough here. |
| 3796 | unsigned NumExceptionType; |
| 3797 | }; |
| 3798 | |
| 3799 | protected: |
| 3800 | FunctionType(TypeClass tc, QualType res, QualType Canonical, |
| 3801 | TypeDependence Dependence, ExtInfo Info) |
| 3802 | : Type(tc, Canonical, Dependence), ResultType(res) { |
| 3803 | FunctionTypeBits.ExtInfo = Info.Bits; |
| 3804 | } |
| 3805 | |
| 3806 | Qualifiers getFastTypeQuals() const { |
| 3807 | return Qualifiers::fromFastMask(FunctionTypeBits.FastTypeQuals); |
| 3808 | } |
| 3809 | |
| 3810 | public: |
| 3811 | QualType getReturnType() const { return ResultType; } |
| 3812 | |
| 3813 | bool getHasRegParm() const { return getExtInfo().getHasRegParm(); } |
| 3814 | unsigned getRegParmType() const { return getExtInfo().getRegParm(); } |
| 3815 | |
| 3816 | /// Determine whether this function type includes the GNU noreturn |
| 3817 | /// attribute. The C++11 [[noreturn]] attribute does not affect the function |
| 3818 | /// type. |
| 3819 | bool getNoReturnAttr() const { return getExtInfo().getNoReturn(); } |
| 3820 | |
| 3821 | bool getCmseNSCallAttr() const { return getExtInfo().getCmseNSCall(); } |
| 3822 | CallingConv getCallConv() const { return getExtInfo().getCC(); } |
| 3823 | ExtInfo getExtInfo() const { return ExtInfo(FunctionTypeBits.ExtInfo); } |
| 3824 | |
| 3825 | static_assert((~Qualifiers::FastMask & Qualifiers::CVRMask) == 0, |
| 3826 | "Const, volatile and restrict are assumed to be a subset of " |
| 3827 | "the fast qualifiers."); |
| 3828 | |
| 3829 | bool isConst() const { return getFastTypeQuals().hasConst(); } |
| 3830 | bool isVolatile() const { return getFastTypeQuals().hasVolatile(); } |
| 3831 | bool isRestrict() const { return getFastTypeQuals().hasRestrict(); } |
| 3832 | |
| 3833 | /// Determine the type of an expression that calls a function of |
| 3834 | /// this type. |
| 3835 | QualType getCallResultType(const ASTContext &Context) const { |
| 3836 | return getReturnType().getNonLValueExprType(Context); |
| 3837 | } |
| 3838 | |
| 3839 | static StringRef getNameForCallConv(CallingConv CC); |
| 3840 | |
| 3841 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3842 | return T->getTypeClass() == FunctionNoProto || |
| 3843 | T->getTypeClass() == FunctionProto; |
| 3844 | } |
| 3845 | }; |
| 3846 | |
| 3847 | /// Represents a K&R-style 'int foo()' function, which has |
| 3848 | /// no information available about its arguments. |
| 3849 | class FunctionNoProtoType : public FunctionType, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 3850 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 3851 | |
| 3852 | FunctionNoProtoType(QualType Result, QualType Canonical, ExtInfo Info) |
| 3853 | : FunctionType(FunctionNoProto, Result, Canonical, |
| 3854 | Result->getDependence() & |
| 3855 | ~(TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation | |
| 3856 | TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack), |
| 3857 | Info) {} |
| 3858 | |
| 3859 | public: |
| 3860 | // No additional state past what FunctionType provides. |
| 3861 | |
| 3862 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 3863 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 3864 | |
| 3865 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 3866 | Profile(ID, getReturnType(), getExtInfo()); |
| 3867 | } |
| 3868 | |
| 3869 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType ResultType, |
| 3870 | ExtInfo Info) { |
| 3871 | Info.Profile(ID); |
| 3872 | ID.AddPointer(ResultType.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 3873 | } |
| 3874 | |
| 3875 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 3876 | return T->getTypeClass() == FunctionNoProto; |
| 3877 | } |
| 3878 | }; |
| 3879 | |
| 3880 | /// Represents a prototype with parameter type info, e.g. |
| 3881 | /// 'int foo(int)' or 'int foo(void)'. 'void' is represented as having no |
| 3882 | /// parameters, not as having a single void parameter. Such a type can have |
| 3883 | /// an exception specification, but this specification is not part of the |
| 3884 | /// canonical type. FunctionProtoType has several trailing objects, some of |
| 3885 | /// which optional. For more information about the trailing objects see |
| 3886 | /// the first comment inside FunctionProtoType. |
| 3887 | class FunctionProtoType final |
| 3888 | : public FunctionType, |
| 3889 | public llvm::FoldingSetNode, |
| 3890 | private llvm::TrailingObjects< |
| 3891 | FunctionProtoType, QualType, SourceLocation, |
| 3892 | FunctionType::FunctionTypeExtraBitfields, FunctionType::ExceptionType, |
| 3893 | Expr *, FunctionDecl *, FunctionType::ExtParameterInfo, Qualifiers> { |
| 3894 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 3895 | friend TrailingObjects; |
| 3896 | |
| 3897 | // FunctionProtoType is followed by several trailing objects, some of |
| 3898 | // which optional. They are in order: |
| 3899 | // |
| 3900 | // * An array of getNumParams() QualType holding the parameter types. |
| 3901 | // Always present. Note that for the vast majority of FunctionProtoType, |
| 3902 | // these will be the only trailing objects. |
| 3903 | // |
| 3904 | // * Optionally if the function is variadic, the SourceLocation of the |
| 3905 | // ellipsis. |
| 3906 | // |
| 3907 | // * Optionally if some extra data is stored in FunctionTypeExtraBitfields |
| 3908 | // (see FunctionTypeExtraBitfields and FunctionTypeBitfields): |
| 3909 | // a single FunctionTypeExtraBitfields. Present if and only if |
| 3910 | // hasExtraBitfields() is true. |
| 3911 | // |
| 3912 | // * Optionally exactly one of: |
| 3913 | // * an array of getNumExceptions() ExceptionType, |
| 3914 | // * a single Expr *, |
| 3915 | // * a pair of FunctionDecl *, |
| 3916 | // * a single FunctionDecl * |
| 3917 | // used to store information about the various types of exception |
| 3918 | // specification. See getExceptionSpecSize for the details. |
| 3919 | // |
| 3920 | // * Optionally an array of getNumParams() ExtParameterInfo holding |
| 3921 | // an ExtParameterInfo for each of the parameters. Present if and |
| 3922 | // only if hasExtParameterInfos() is true. |
| 3923 | // |
| 3924 | // * Optionally a Qualifiers object to represent extra qualifiers that can't |
| 3925 | // be represented by FunctionTypeBitfields.FastTypeQuals. Present if and only |
| 3926 | // if hasExtQualifiers() is true. |
| 3927 | // |
| 3928 | // The optional FunctionTypeExtraBitfields has to be before the data |
| 3929 | // related to the exception specification since it contains the number |
| 3930 | // of exception types. |
| 3931 | // |
| 3932 | // We put the ExtParameterInfos last. If all were equal, it would make |
| 3933 | // more sense to put these before the exception specification, because |
| 3934 | // it's much easier to skip past them compared to the elaborate switch |
| 3935 | // required to skip the exception specification. However, all is not |
| 3936 | // equal; ExtParameterInfos are used to model very uncommon features, |
| 3937 | // and it's better not to burden the more common paths. |
| 3938 | |
| 3939 | public: |
| 3940 | /// Holds information about the various types of exception specification. |
| 3941 | /// ExceptionSpecInfo is not stored as such in FunctionProtoType but is |
| 3942 | /// used to group together the various bits of information about the |
| 3943 | /// exception specification. |
| 3944 | struct ExceptionSpecInfo { |
| 3945 | /// The kind of exception specification this is. |
| 3946 | ExceptionSpecificationType Type = EST_None; |
| 3947 | |
| 3948 | /// Explicitly-specified list of exception types. |
| 3949 | ArrayRef<QualType> Exceptions; |
| 3950 | |
| 3951 | /// Noexcept expression, if this is a computed noexcept specification. |
| 3952 | Expr *NoexceptExpr = nullptr; |
| 3953 | |
| 3954 | /// The function whose exception specification this is, for |
| 3955 | /// EST_Unevaluated and EST_Uninstantiated. |
| 3956 | FunctionDecl *SourceDecl = nullptr; |
| 3957 | |
| 3958 | /// The function template whose exception specification this is instantiated |
| 3959 | /// from, for EST_Uninstantiated. |
| 3960 | FunctionDecl *SourceTemplate = nullptr; |
| 3961 | |
| 3962 | ExceptionSpecInfo() = default; |
| 3963 | |
| 3964 | ExceptionSpecInfo(ExceptionSpecificationType EST) : Type(EST) {} |
| 3965 | }; |
| 3966 | |
| 3967 | /// Extra information about a function prototype. ExtProtoInfo is not |
| 3968 | /// stored as such in FunctionProtoType but is used to group together |
| 3969 | /// the various bits of extra information about a function prototype. |
| 3970 | struct ExtProtoInfo { |
| 3971 | FunctionType::ExtInfo ExtInfo; |
| 3972 | bool Variadic : 1; |
| 3973 | bool HasTrailingReturn : 1; |
| 3974 | Qualifiers TypeQuals; |
| 3975 | RefQualifierKind RefQualifier = RQ_None; |
| 3976 | ExceptionSpecInfo ExceptionSpec; |
| 3977 | const ExtParameterInfo *ExtParameterInfos = nullptr; |
| 3978 | SourceLocation EllipsisLoc; |
| 3979 | |
| 3980 | ExtProtoInfo() : Variadic(false), HasTrailingReturn(false) {} |
| 3981 | |
| 3982 | ExtProtoInfo(CallingConv CC) |
| 3983 | : ExtInfo(CC), Variadic(false), HasTrailingReturn(false) {} |
| 3984 | |
| 3985 | ExtProtoInfo withExceptionSpec(const ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) { |
| 3986 | ExtProtoInfo Result(*this); |
| 3987 | Result.ExceptionSpec = ESI; |
| 3988 | return Result; |
| 3989 | } |
| 3990 | }; |
| 3991 | |
| 3992 | private: |
| 3993 | unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<QualType>) const { |
| 3994 | return getNumParams(); |
| 3995 | } |
| 3996 | |
| 3997 | unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<SourceLocation>) const { |
| 3998 | return isVariadic(); |
| 3999 | } |
| 4000 | |
| 4001 | unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>) const { |
| 4002 | return hasExtraBitfields(); |
| 4003 | } |
| 4004 | |
| 4005 | unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<ExceptionType>) const { |
| 4006 | return getExceptionSpecSize().NumExceptionType; |
| 4007 | } |
| 4008 | |
| 4009 | unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<Expr *>) const { |
| 4010 | return getExceptionSpecSize().NumExprPtr; |
| 4011 | } |
| 4012 | |
| 4013 | unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<FunctionDecl *>) const { |
| 4014 | return getExceptionSpecSize().NumFunctionDeclPtr; |
| 4015 | } |
| 4016 | |
| 4017 | unsigned numTrailingObjects(OverloadToken<ExtParameterInfo>) const { |
| 4018 | return hasExtParameterInfos() ? getNumParams() : 0; |
| 4019 | } |
| 4020 | |
| 4021 | /// Determine whether there are any argument types that |
| 4022 | /// contain an unexpanded parameter pack. |
| 4023 | static bool containsAnyUnexpandedParameterPack(const QualType *ArgArray, |
| 4024 | unsigned numArgs) { |
| 4025 | for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < numArgs; ++Idx) |
| 4026 | if (ArgArray[Idx]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) |
| 4027 | return true; |
| 4028 | |
| 4029 | return false; |
| 4030 | } |
| 4031 | |
| 4032 | FunctionProtoType(QualType result, ArrayRef<QualType> params, |
| 4033 | QualType canonical, const ExtProtoInfo &epi); |
| 4034 | |
| 4035 | /// This struct is returned by getExceptionSpecSize and is used to |
| 4036 | /// translate an ExceptionSpecificationType to the number and kind |
| 4037 | /// of trailing objects related to the exception specification. |
| 4038 | struct ExceptionSpecSizeHolder { |
| 4039 | unsigned NumExceptionType; |
| 4040 | unsigned NumExprPtr; |
| 4041 | unsigned NumFunctionDeclPtr; |
| 4042 | }; |
| 4043 | |
| 4044 | /// Return the number and kind of trailing objects |
| 4045 | /// related to the exception specification. |
| 4046 | static ExceptionSpecSizeHolder |
| 4047 | getExceptionSpecSize(ExceptionSpecificationType EST, unsigned NumExceptions) { |
| 4048 | switch (EST) { |
| 4049 | case EST_None: |
| 4050 | case EST_DynamicNone: |
| 4051 | case EST_MSAny: |
| 4052 | case EST_BasicNoexcept: |
| 4053 | case EST_Unparsed: |
| 4054 | case EST_NoThrow: |
| 4055 | return {0, 0, 0}; |
| 4056 | |
| 4057 | case EST_Dynamic: |
| 4058 | return {NumExceptions, 0, 0}; |
| 4059 | |
| 4060 | case EST_DependentNoexcept: |
| 4061 | case EST_NoexceptFalse: |
| 4062 | case EST_NoexceptTrue: |
| 4063 | return {0, 1, 0}; |
| 4064 | |
| 4065 | case EST_Uninstantiated: |
| 4066 | return {0, 0, 2}; |
| 4067 | |
| 4068 | case EST_Unevaluated: |
| 4069 | return {0, 0, 1}; |
| 4070 | } |
| 4071 | llvm_unreachable("bad exception specification kind")__builtin_unreachable(); |
| 4072 | } |
| 4073 | |
| 4074 | /// Return the number and kind of trailing objects |
| 4075 | /// related to the exception specification. |
| 4076 | ExceptionSpecSizeHolder getExceptionSpecSize() const { |
| 4077 | return getExceptionSpecSize(getExceptionSpecType(), getNumExceptions()); |
| 4078 | } |
| 4079 | |
| 4080 | /// Whether the trailing FunctionTypeExtraBitfields is present. |
| 4081 | static bool hasExtraBitfields(ExceptionSpecificationType EST) { |
| 4082 | // If the exception spec type is EST_Dynamic then we have > 0 exception |
| 4083 | // types and the exact number is stored in FunctionTypeExtraBitfields. |
| 4084 | return EST == EST_Dynamic; |
| 4085 | } |
| 4086 | |
| 4087 | /// Whether the trailing FunctionTypeExtraBitfields is present. |
| 4088 | bool hasExtraBitfields() const { |
| 4089 | return hasExtraBitfields(getExceptionSpecType()); |
| 4090 | } |
| 4091 | |
| 4092 | bool hasExtQualifiers() const { |
| 4093 | return FunctionTypeBits.HasExtQuals; |
| 4094 | } |
| 4095 | |
| 4096 | public: |
| 4097 | unsigned getNumParams() const { return FunctionTypeBits.NumParams; } |
| 4098 | |
| 4099 | QualType getParamType(unsigned i) const { |
| 4100 | assert(i < getNumParams() && "invalid parameter index")((void)0); |
| 4101 | return param_type_begin()[i]; |
| 4102 | } |
| 4103 | |
| 4104 | ArrayRef<QualType> getParamTypes() const { |
| 4105 | return llvm::makeArrayRef(param_type_begin(), param_type_end()); |
| 4106 | } |
| 4107 | |
| 4108 | ExtProtoInfo getExtProtoInfo() const { |
| 4109 | ExtProtoInfo EPI; |
| 4110 | EPI.ExtInfo = getExtInfo(); |
| 4111 | EPI.Variadic = isVariadic(); |
| 4112 | EPI.EllipsisLoc = getEllipsisLoc(); |
| 4113 | EPI.HasTrailingReturn = hasTrailingReturn(); |
| 4114 | EPI.ExceptionSpec = getExceptionSpecInfo(); |
| 4115 | EPI.TypeQuals = getMethodQuals(); |
| 4116 | EPI.RefQualifier = getRefQualifier(); |
| 4117 | EPI.ExtParameterInfos = getExtParameterInfosOrNull(); |
| 4118 | return EPI; |
| 4119 | } |
| 4120 | |
| 4121 | /// Get the kind of exception specification on this function. |
| 4122 | ExceptionSpecificationType getExceptionSpecType() const { |
| 4123 | return static_cast<ExceptionSpecificationType>( |
| 4124 | FunctionTypeBits.ExceptionSpecType); |
| 4125 | } |
| 4126 | |
| 4127 | /// Return whether this function has any kind of exception spec. |
| 4128 | bool hasExceptionSpec() const { return getExceptionSpecType() != EST_None; } |
| 4129 | |
| 4130 | /// Return whether this function has a dynamic (throw) exception spec. |
| 4131 | bool hasDynamicExceptionSpec() const { |
| 4132 | return isDynamicExceptionSpec(getExceptionSpecType()); |
| 4133 | } |
| 4134 | |
| 4135 | /// Return whether this function has a noexcept exception spec. |
| 4136 | bool hasNoexceptExceptionSpec() const { |
| 4137 | return isNoexceptExceptionSpec(getExceptionSpecType()); |
| 4138 | } |
| 4139 | |
| 4140 | /// Return whether this function has a dependent exception spec. |
| 4141 | bool hasDependentExceptionSpec() const; |
| 4142 | |
| 4143 | /// Return whether this function has an instantiation-dependent exception |
| 4144 | /// spec. |
| 4145 | bool hasInstantiationDependentExceptionSpec() const; |
| 4146 | |
| 4147 | /// Return all the available information about this type's exception spec. |
| 4148 | ExceptionSpecInfo getExceptionSpecInfo() const { |
| 4149 | ExceptionSpecInfo Result; |
| 4150 | Result.Type = getExceptionSpecType(); |
| 4151 | if (Result.Type == EST_Dynamic) { |
| 4152 | Result.Exceptions = exceptions(); |
| 4153 | } else if (isComputedNoexcept(Result.Type)) { |
| 4154 | Result.NoexceptExpr = getNoexceptExpr(); |
| 4155 | } else if (Result.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) { |
| 4156 | Result.SourceDecl = getExceptionSpecDecl(); |
| 4157 | Result.SourceTemplate = getExceptionSpecTemplate(); |
| 4158 | } else if (Result.Type == EST_Unevaluated) { |
| 4159 | Result.SourceDecl = getExceptionSpecDecl(); |
| 4160 | } |
| 4161 | return Result; |
| 4162 | } |
| 4163 | |
| 4164 | /// Return the number of types in the exception specification. |
| 4165 | unsigned getNumExceptions() const { |
| 4166 | return getExceptionSpecType() == EST_Dynamic |
| 4167 | ? getTrailingObjects<FunctionTypeExtraBitfields>() |
| 4168 | ->NumExceptionType |
| 4169 | : 0; |
| 4170 | } |
| 4171 | |
| 4172 | /// Return the ith exception type, where 0 <= i < getNumExceptions(). |
| 4173 | QualType getExceptionType(unsigned i) const { |
| 4174 | assert(i < getNumExceptions() && "Invalid exception number!")((void)0); |
| 4175 | return exception_begin()[i]; |
| 4176 | } |
| 4177 | |
| 4178 | /// Return the expression inside noexcept(expression), or a null pointer |
| 4179 | /// if there is none (because the exception spec is not of this form). |
| 4180 | Expr *getNoexceptExpr() const { |
| 4181 | if (!isComputedNoexcept(getExceptionSpecType())) |
| 4182 | return nullptr; |
| 4183 | return *getTrailingObjects<Expr *>(); |
| 4184 | } |
| 4185 | |
| 4186 | /// If this function type has an exception specification which hasn't |
| 4187 | /// been determined yet (either because it has not been evaluated or because |
| 4188 | /// it has not been instantiated), this is the function whose exception |
| 4189 | /// specification is represented by this type. |
| 4190 | FunctionDecl *getExceptionSpecDecl() const { |
| 4191 | if (getExceptionSpecType() != EST_Uninstantiated && |
| 4192 | getExceptionSpecType() != EST_Unevaluated) |
| 4193 | return nullptr; |
| 4194 | return getTrailingObjects<FunctionDecl *>()[0]; |
| 4195 | } |
| 4196 | |
| 4197 | /// If this function type has an uninstantiated exception |
| 4198 | /// specification, this is the function whose exception specification |
| 4199 | /// should be instantiated to find the exception specification for |
| 4200 | /// this type. |
| 4201 | FunctionDecl *getExceptionSpecTemplate() const { |
| 4202 | if (getExceptionSpecType() != EST_Uninstantiated) |
| 4203 | return nullptr; |
| 4204 | return getTrailingObjects<FunctionDecl *>()[1]; |
| 4205 | } |
| 4206 | |
| 4207 | /// Determine whether this function type has a non-throwing exception |
| 4208 | /// specification. |
| 4209 | CanThrowResult canThrow() const; |
| 4210 | |
| 4211 | /// Determine whether this function type has a non-throwing exception |
| 4212 | /// specification. If this depends on template arguments, returns |
| 4213 | /// \c ResultIfDependent. |
| 4214 | bool isNothrow(bool ResultIfDependent = false) const { |
| 4215 | return ResultIfDependent ? canThrow() != CT_Can : canThrow() == CT_Cannot; |
| 4216 | } |
| 4217 | |
| 4218 | /// Whether this function prototype is variadic. |
| 4219 | bool isVariadic() const { return FunctionTypeBits.Variadic; } |
| 4220 | |
| 4221 | SourceLocation getEllipsisLoc() const { |
| 4222 | return isVariadic() ? *getTrailingObjects<SourceLocation>() |
| 4223 | : SourceLocation(); |
| 4224 | } |
| 4225 | |
| 4226 | /// Determines whether this function prototype contains a |
| 4227 | /// parameter pack at the end. |
| 4228 | /// |
| 4229 | /// A function template whose last parameter is a parameter pack can be |
| 4230 | /// called with an arbitrary number of arguments, much like a variadic |
| 4231 | /// function. |
| 4232 | bool isTemplateVariadic() const; |
| 4233 | |
| 4234 | /// Whether this function prototype has a trailing return type. |
| 4235 | bool hasTrailingReturn() const { return FunctionTypeBits.HasTrailingReturn; } |
| 4236 | |
| 4237 | Qualifiers getMethodQuals() const { |
| 4238 | if (hasExtQualifiers()) |
| 4239 | return *getTrailingObjects<Qualifiers>(); |
| 4240 | else |
| 4241 | return getFastTypeQuals(); |
| 4242 | } |
| 4243 | |
| 4244 | /// Retrieve the ref-qualifier associated with this function type. |
| 4245 | RefQualifierKind getRefQualifier() const { |
| 4246 | return static_cast<RefQualifierKind>(FunctionTypeBits.RefQualifier); |
| 4247 | } |
| 4248 | |
| 4249 | using param_type_iterator = const QualType *; |
| 4250 | using param_type_range = llvm::iterator_range<param_type_iterator>; |
| 4251 | |
| 4252 | param_type_range param_types() const { |
| 4253 | return param_type_range(param_type_begin(), param_type_end()); |
| 4254 | } |
| 4255 | |
| 4256 | param_type_iterator param_type_begin() const { |
| 4257 | return getTrailingObjects<QualType>(); |
| 4258 | } |
| 4259 | |
| 4260 | param_type_iterator param_type_end() const { |
| 4261 | return param_type_begin() + getNumParams(); |
| 4262 | } |
| 4263 | |
| 4264 | using exception_iterator = const QualType *; |
| 4265 | |
| 4266 | ArrayRef<QualType> exceptions() const { |
| 4267 | return llvm::makeArrayRef(exception_begin(), exception_end()); |
| 4268 | } |
| 4269 | |
| 4270 | exception_iterator exception_begin() const { |
| 4271 | return reinterpret_cast<exception_iterator>( |
| 4272 | getTrailingObjects<ExceptionType>()); |
| 4273 | } |
| 4274 | |
| 4275 | exception_iterator exception_end() const { |
| 4276 | return exception_begin() + getNumExceptions(); |
| 4277 | } |
| 4278 | |
| 4279 | /// Is there any interesting extra information for any of the parameters |
| 4280 | /// of this function type? |
| 4281 | bool hasExtParameterInfos() const { |
| 4282 | return FunctionTypeBits.HasExtParameterInfos; |
| 4283 | } |
| 4284 | |
| 4285 | ArrayRef<ExtParameterInfo> getExtParameterInfos() const { |
| 4286 | assert(hasExtParameterInfos())((void)0); |
| 4287 | return ArrayRef<ExtParameterInfo>(getTrailingObjects<ExtParameterInfo>(), |
| 4288 | getNumParams()); |
| 4289 | } |
| 4290 | |
| 4291 | /// Return a pointer to the beginning of the array of extra parameter |
| 4292 | /// information, if present, or else null if none of the parameters |
| 4293 | /// carry it. This is equivalent to getExtProtoInfo().ExtParameterInfos. |
| 4294 | const ExtParameterInfo *getExtParameterInfosOrNull() const { |
| 4295 | if (!hasExtParameterInfos()) |
| 4296 | return nullptr; |
| 4297 | return getTrailingObjects<ExtParameterInfo>(); |
| 4298 | } |
| 4299 | |
| 4300 | ExtParameterInfo getExtParameterInfo(unsigned I) const { |
| 4301 | assert(I < getNumParams() && "parameter index out of range")((void)0); |
| 4302 | if (hasExtParameterInfos()) |
| 4303 | return getTrailingObjects<ExtParameterInfo>()[I]; |
| 4304 | return ExtParameterInfo(); |
| 4305 | } |
| 4306 | |
| 4307 | ParameterABI getParameterABI(unsigned I) const { |
| 4308 | assert(I < getNumParams() && "parameter index out of range")((void)0); |
| 4309 | if (hasExtParameterInfos()) |
| 4310 | return getTrailingObjects<ExtParameterInfo>()[I].getABI(); |
| 4311 | return ParameterABI::Ordinary; |
| 4312 | } |
| 4313 | |
| 4314 | bool isParamConsumed(unsigned I) const { |
| 4315 | assert(I < getNumParams() && "parameter index out of range")((void)0); |
| 4316 | if (hasExtParameterInfos()) |
| 4317 | return getTrailingObjects<ExtParameterInfo>()[I].isConsumed(); |
| 4318 | return false; |
| 4319 | } |
| 4320 | |
| 4321 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 4322 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 4323 | |
| 4324 | void printExceptionSpecification(raw_ostream &OS, |
| 4325 | const PrintingPolicy &Policy) const; |
| 4326 | |
| 4327 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 4328 | return T->getTypeClass() == FunctionProto; |
| 4329 | } |
| 4330 | |
| 4331 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Ctx); |
| 4332 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Result, |
| 4333 | param_type_iterator ArgTys, unsigned NumArgs, |
| 4334 | const ExtProtoInfo &EPI, const ASTContext &Context, |
| 4335 | bool Canonical); |
| 4336 | }; |
| 4337 | |
| 4338 | /// Represents the dependent type named by a dependently-scoped |
| 4339 | /// typename using declaration, e.g. |
| 4340 | /// using typename Base<T>::foo; |
| 4341 | /// |
| 4342 | /// Template instantiation turns these into the underlying type. |
| 4343 | class UnresolvedUsingType : public Type { |
| 4344 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 4345 | |
| 4346 | UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Decl; |
| 4347 | |
| 4348 | UnresolvedUsingType(const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *D) |
| 4349 | : Type(UnresolvedUsing, QualType(), |
| 4350 | TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation), |
| 4351 | Decl(const_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *>(D)) {} |
| 4352 | |
| 4353 | public: |
| 4354 | UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *getDecl() const { return Decl; } |
| 4355 | |
| 4356 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 4357 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 4358 | |
| 4359 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 4360 | return T->getTypeClass() == UnresolvedUsing; |
| 4361 | } |
| 4362 | |
| 4363 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 4364 | return Profile(ID, Decl); |
| 4365 | } |
| 4366 | |
| 4367 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, |
| 4368 | UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *D) { |
| 4369 | ID.AddPointer(D); |
| 4370 | } |
| 4371 | }; |
| 4372 | |
| 4373 | class TypedefType : public Type { |
| 4374 | TypedefNameDecl *Decl; |
| 4375 | |
| 4376 | private: |
| 4377 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 4378 | |
| 4379 | TypedefType(TypeClass tc, const TypedefNameDecl *D, QualType underlying, |
| 4380 | QualType can); |
| 4381 | |
| 4382 | public: |
| 4383 | TypedefNameDecl *getDecl() const { return Decl; } |
| 4384 | |
| 4385 | bool isSugared() const { return true; } |
| 4386 | QualType desugar() const; |
| 4387 | |
| 4388 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Typedef; } |
| 4389 | }; |
| 4390 | |
| 4391 | /// Sugar type that represents a type that was qualified by a qualifier written |
| 4392 | /// as a macro invocation. |
| 4393 | class MacroQualifiedType : public Type { |
| 4394 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 4395 | |
| 4396 | QualType UnderlyingTy; |
| 4397 | const IdentifierInfo *MacroII; |
| 4398 | |
| 4399 | MacroQualifiedType(QualType UnderlyingTy, QualType CanonTy, |
| 4400 | const IdentifierInfo *MacroII) |
| 4401 | : Type(MacroQualified, CanonTy, UnderlyingTy->getDependence()), |
| 4402 | UnderlyingTy(UnderlyingTy), MacroII(MacroII) { |
| 4403 | assert(isa<AttributedType>(UnderlyingTy) &&((void)0) |
| 4404 | "Expected a macro qualified type to only wrap attributed types.")((void)0); |
| 4405 | } |
| 4406 | |
| 4407 | public: |
| 4408 | const IdentifierInfo *getMacroIdentifier() const { return MacroII; } |
| 4409 | QualType getUnderlyingType() const { return UnderlyingTy; } |
| 4410 | |
| 4411 | /// Return this attributed type's modified type with no qualifiers attached to |
| 4412 | /// it. |
| 4413 | QualType getModifiedType() const; |
| 4414 | |
| 4415 | bool isSugared() const { return true; } |
| 4416 | QualType desugar() const; |
| 4417 | |
| 4418 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 4419 | return T->getTypeClass() == MacroQualified; |
| 4420 | } |
| 4421 | }; |
| 4422 | |
| 4423 | /// Represents a `typeof` (or __typeof__) expression (a GCC extension). |
| 4424 | class TypeOfExprType : public Type { |
| 4425 | Expr *TOExpr; |
| 4426 | |
| 4427 | protected: |
| 4428 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 4429 | |
| 4430 | TypeOfExprType(Expr *E, QualType can = QualType()); |
| 4431 | |
| 4432 | public: |
| 4433 | Expr *getUnderlyingExpr() const { return TOExpr; } |
| 4434 | |
| 4435 | /// Remove a single level of sugar. |
| 4436 | QualType desugar() const; |
| 4437 | |
| 4438 | /// Returns whether this type directly provides sugar. |
| 4439 | bool isSugared() const; |
| 4440 | |
| 4441 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == TypeOfExpr; } |
| 4442 | }; |
| 4443 | |
| 4444 | /// Internal representation of canonical, dependent |
| 4445 | /// `typeof(expr)` types. |
| 4446 | /// |
| 4447 | /// This class is used internally by the ASTContext to manage |
| 4448 | /// canonical, dependent types, only. Clients will only see instances |
| 4449 | /// of this class via TypeOfExprType nodes. |
| 4450 | class DependentTypeOfExprType |
| 4451 | : public TypeOfExprType, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 4452 | const ASTContext &Context; |
| 4453 | |
| 4454 | public: |
| 4455 | DependentTypeOfExprType(const ASTContext &Context, Expr *E) |
| 4456 | : TypeOfExprType(E), Context(Context) {} |
| 4457 | |
| 4458 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 4459 | Profile(ID, Context, getUnderlyingExpr()); |
| 4460 | } |
| 4461 | |
| 4462 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context, |
| 4463 | Expr *E); |
| 4464 | }; |
| 4465 | |
| 4466 | /// Represents `typeof(type)`, a GCC extension. |
| 4467 | class TypeOfType : public Type { |
| 4468 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 4469 | |
| 4470 | QualType TOType; |
| 4471 | |
| 4472 | TypeOfType(QualType T, QualType can) |
| 4473 | : Type(TypeOf, can, T->getDependence()), TOType(T) { |
| 4474 | assert(!isa<TypedefType>(can) && "Invalid canonical type")((void)0); |
| 4475 | } |
| 4476 | |
| 4477 | public: |
| 4478 | QualType getUnderlyingType() const { return TOType; } |
| 4479 | |
| 4480 | /// Remove a single level of sugar. |
| 4481 | QualType desugar() const { return getUnderlyingType(); } |
| 4482 | |
| 4483 | /// Returns whether this type directly provides sugar. |
| 4484 | bool isSugared() const { return true; } |
| 4485 | |
| 4486 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == TypeOf; } |
| 4487 | }; |
| 4488 | |
| 4489 | /// Represents the type `decltype(expr)` (C++11). |
| 4490 | class DecltypeType : public Type { |
| 4491 | Expr *E; |
| 4492 | QualType UnderlyingType; |
| 4493 | |
| 4494 | protected: |
| 4495 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 4496 | |
| 4497 | DecltypeType(Expr *E, QualType underlyingType, QualType can = QualType()); |
| 4498 | |
| 4499 | public: |
| 4500 | Expr *getUnderlyingExpr() const { return E; } |
| 4501 | QualType getUnderlyingType() const { return UnderlyingType; } |
| 4502 | |
| 4503 | /// Remove a single level of sugar. |
| 4504 | QualType desugar() const; |
| 4505 | |
| 4506 | /// Returns whether this type directly provides sugar. |
| 4507 | bool isSugared() const; |
| 4508 | |
| 4509 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Decltype; } |
| 4510 | }; |
| 4511 | |
| 4512 | /// Internal representation of canonical, dependent |
| 4513 | /// decltype(expr) types. |
| 4514 | /// |
| 4515 | /// This class is used internally by the ASTContext to manage |
| 4516 | /// canonical, dependent types, only. Clients will only see instances |
| 4517 | /// of this class via DecltypeType nodes. |
| 4518 | class DependentDecltypeType : public DecltypeType, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 4519 | const ASTContext &Context; |
| 4520 | |
| 4521 | public: |
| 4522 | DependentDecltypeType(const ASTContext &Context, Expr *E); |
| 4523 | |
| 4524 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 4525 | Profile(ID, Context, getUnderlyingExpr()); |
| 4526 | } |
| 4527 | |
| 4528 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context, |
| 4529 | Expr *E); |
| 4530 | }; |
| 4531 | |
| 4532 | /// A unary type transform, which is a type constructed from another. |
| 4533 | class UnaryTransformType : public Type { |
| 4534 | public: |
| 4535 | enum UTTKind { |
| 4536 | EnumUnderlyingType |
| 4537 | }; |
| 4538 | |
| 4539 | private: |
| 4540 | /// The untransformed type. |
| 4541 | QualType BaseType; |
| 4542 | |
| 4543 | /// The transformed type if not dependent, otherwise the same as BaseType. |
| 4544 | QualType UnderlyingType; |
| 4545 | |
| 4546 | UTTKind UKind; |
| 4547 | |
| 4548 | protected: |
| 4549 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 4550 | |
| 4551 | UnaryTransformType(QualType BaseTy, QualType UnderlyingTy, UTTKind UKind, |
| 4552 | QualType CanonicalTy); |
| 4553 | |
| 4554 | public: |
| 4555 | bool isSugared() const { return !isDependentType(); } |
| 4556 | QualType desugar() const { return UnderlyingType; } |
| 4557 | |
| 4558 | QualType getUnderlyingType() const { return UnderlyingType; } |
| 4559 | QualType getBaseType() const { return BaseType; } |
| 4560 | |
| 4561 | UTTKind getUTTKind() const { return UKind; } |
| 4562 | |
| 4563 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 4564 | return T->getTypeClass() == UnaryTransform; |
| 4565 | } |
| 4566 | }; |
| 4567 | |
| 4568 | /// Internal representation of canonical, dependent |
| 4569 | /// __underlying_type(type) types. |
| 4570 | /// |
| 4571 | /// This class is used internally by the ASTContext to manage |
| 4572 | /// canonical, dependent types, only. Clients will only see instances |
| 4573 | /// of this class via UnaryTransformType nodes. |
| 4574 | class DependentUnaryTransformType : public UnaryTransformType, |
| 4575 | public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 4576 | public: |
| 4577 | DependentUnaryTransformType(const ASTContext &C, QualType BaseType, |
| 4578 | UTTKind UKind); |
| 4579 | |
| 4580 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 4581 | Profile(ID, getBaseType(), getUTTKind()); |
| 4582 | } |
| 4583 | |
| 4584 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType BaseType, |
| 4585 | UTTKind UKind) { |
| 4586 | ID.AddPointer(BaseType.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 4587 | ID.AddInteger((unsigned)UKind); |
| 4588 | } |
| 4589 | }; |
| 4590 | |
| 4591 | class TagType : public Type { |
| 4592 | friend class ASTReader; |
| 4593 | template <class T> friend class serialization::AbstractTypeReader; |
| 4594 | |
| 4595 | /// Stores the TagDecl associated with this type. The decl may point to any |
| 4596 | /// TagDecl that declares the entity. |
| 4597 | TagDecl *decl; |
| 4598 | |
| 4599 | protected: |
| 4600 | TagType(TypeClass TC, const TagDecl *D, QualType can); |
| 4601 | |
| 4602 | public: |
| 4603 | TagDecl *getDecl() const; |
| 4604 | |
| 4605 | /// Determines whether this type is in the process of being defined. |
| 4606 | bool isBeingDefined() const; |
| 4607 | |
| 4608 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 4609 | return T->getTypeClass() == Enum || T->getTypeClass() == Record; |
| 4610 | } |
| 4611 | }; |
| 4612 | |
| 4613 | /// A helper class that allows the use of isa/cast/dyncast |
| 4614 | /// to detect TagType objects of structs/unions/classes. |
| 4615 | class RecordType : public TagType { |
| 4616 | protected: |
| 4617 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 4618 | |
| 4619 | explicit RecordType(const RecordDecl *D) |
| 4620 | : TagType(Record, reinterpret_cast<const TagDecl*>(D), QualType()) {} |
| 4621 | explicit RecordType(TypeClass TC, RecordDecl *D) |
| 4622 | : TagType(TC, reinterpret_cast<const TagDecl*>(D), QualType()) {} |
| 4623 | |
| 4624 | public: |
| 4625 | RecordDecl *getDecl() const { |
| 4626 | return reinterpret_cast<RecordDecl*>(TagType::getDecl()); |
| 4627 | } |
| 4628 | |
| 4629 | /// Recursively check all fields in the record for const-ness. If any field |
| 4630 | /// is declared const, return true. Otherwise, return false. |
| 4631 | bool hasConstFields() const; |
| 4632 | |
| 4633 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 4634 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 4635 | |
| 4636 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Record; } |
| 4637 | }; |
| 4638 | |
| 4639 | /// A helper class that allows the use of isa/cast/dyncast |
| 4640 | /// to detect TagType objects of enums. |
| 4641 | class EnumType : public TagType { |
| 4642 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 4643 | |
| 4644 | explicit EnumType(const EnumDecl *D) |
| 4645 | : TagType(Enum, reinterpret_cast<const TagDecl*>(D), QualType()) {} |
| 4646 | |
| 4647 | public: |
| 4648 | EnumDecl *getDecl() const { |
| 4649 | return reinterpret_cast<EnumDecl*>(TagType::getDecl()); |
| 4650 | } |
| 4651 | |
| 4652 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 4653 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 4654 | |
| 4655 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Enum; } |
| 4656 | }; |
| 4657 | |
| 4658 | /// An attributed type is a type to which a type attribute has been applied. |
| 4659 | /// |
| 4660 | /// The "modified type" is the fully-sugared type to which the attributed |
| 4661 | /// type was applied; generally it is not canonically equivalent to the |
| 4662 | /// attributed type. The "equivalent type" is the minimally-desugared type |
| 4663 | /// which the type is canonically equivalent to. |
| 4664 | /// |
| 4665 | /// For example, in the following attributed type: |
| 4666 | /// int32_t __attribute__((vector_size(16))) |
| 4667 | /// - the modified type is the TypedefType for int32_t |
| 4668 | /// - the equivalent type is VectorType(16, int32_t) |
| 4669 | /// - the canonical type is VectorType(16, int) |
| 4670 | class AttributedType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 4671 | public: |
| 4672 | using Kind = attr::Kind; |
| 4673 | |
| 4674 | private: |
| 4675 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 4676 | |
| 4677 | QualType ModifiedType; |
| 4678 | QualType EquivalentType; |
| 4679 | |
| 4680 | AttributedType(QualType canon, attr::Kind attrKind, QualType modified, |
| 4681 | QualType equivalent) |
| 4682 | : Type(Attributed, canon, equivalent->getDependence()), |
| 4683 | ModifiedType(modified), EquivalentType(equivalent) { |
| 4684 | AttributedTypeBits.AttrKind = attrKind; |
| 4685 | } |
| 4686 | |
| 4687 | public: |
| 4688 | Kind getAttrKind() const { |
| 4689 | return static_cast<Kind>(AttributedTypeBits.AttrKind); |
| 4690 | } |
| 4691 | |
| 4692 | QualType getModifiedType() const { return ModifiedType; } |
| 4693 | QualType getEquivalentType() const { return EquivalentType; } |
| 4694 | |
| 4695 | bool isSugared() const { return true; } |
| 4696 | QualType desugar() const { return getEquivalentType(); } |
| 4697 | |
| 4698 | /// Does this attribute behave like a type qualifier? |
| 4699 | /// |
| 4700 | /// A type qualifier adjusts a type to provide specialized rules for |
| 4701 | /// a specific object, like the standard const and volatile qualifiers. |
| 4702 | /// This includes attributes controlling things like nullability, |
| 4703 | /// address spaces, and ARC ownership. The value of the object is still |
| 4704 | /// largely described by the modified type. |
| 4705 | /// |
| 4706 | /// In contrast, many type attributes "rewrite" their modified type to |
| 4707 | /// produce a fundamentally different type, not necessarily related in any |
| 4708 | /// formalizable way to the original type. For example, calling convention |
| 4709 | /// and vector attributes are not simple type qualifiers. |
| 4710 | /// |
| 4711 | /// Type qualifiers are often, but not always, reflected in the canonical |
| 4712 | /// type. |
| 4713 | bool isQualifier() const; |
| 4714 | |
| 4715 | bool isMSTypeSpec() const; |
| 4716 | |
| 4717 | bool isCallingConv() const; |
| 4718 | |
| 4719 | llvm::Optional<NullabilityKind> getImmediateNullability() const; |
| 4720 | |
| 4721 | /// Retrieve the attribute kind corresponding to the given |
| 4722 | /// nullability kind. |
| 4723 | static Kind getNullabilityAttrKind(NullabilityKind kind) { |
| 4724 | switch (kind) { |
| 4725 | case NullabilityKind::NonNull: |
| 4726 | return attr::TypeNonNull; |
| 4727 | |
| 4728 | case NullabilityKind::Nullable: |
| 4729 | return attr::TypeNullable; |
| 4730 | |
| 4731 | case NullabilityKind::NullableResult: |
| 4732 | return attr::TypeNullableResult; |
| 4733 | |
| 4734 | case NullabilityKind::Unspecified: |
| 4735 | return attr::TypeNullUnspecified; |
| 4736 | } |
| 4737 | llvm_unreachable("Unknown nullability kind.")__builtin_unreachable(); |
| 4738 | } |
| 4739 | |
| 4740 | /// Strip off the top-level nullability annotation on the given |
| 4741 | /// type, if it's there. |
| 4742 | /// |
| 4743 | /// \param T The type to strip. If the type is exactly an |
| 4744 | /// AttributedType specifying nullability (without looking through |
| 4745 | /// type sugar), the nullability is returned and this type changed |
| 4746 | /// to the underlying modified type. |
| 4747 | /// |
| 4748 | /// \returns the top-level nullability, if present. |
| 4749 | static Optional<NullabilityKind> stripOuterNullability(QualType &T); |
| 4750 | |
| 4751 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 4752 | Profile(ID, getAttrKind(), ModifiedType, EquivalentType); |
| 4753 | } |
| 4754 | |
| 4755 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, Kind attrKind, |
| 4756 | QualType modified, QualType equivalent) { |
| 4757 | ID.AddInteger(attrKind); |
| 4758 | ID.AddPointer(modified.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 4759 | ID.AddPointer(equivalent.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 4760 | } |
| 4761 | |
| 4762 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 4763 | return T->getTypeClass() == Attributed; |
| 4764 | } |
| 4765 | }; |
| 4766 | |
| 4767 | class TemplateTypeParmType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 4768 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 4769 | |
| 4770 | // Helper data collector for canonical types. |
| 4771 | struct CanonicalTTPTInfo { |
| 4772 | unsigned Depth : 15; |
| 4773 | unsigned ParameterPack : 1; |
| 4774 | unsigned Index : 16; |
| 4775 | }; |
| 4776 | |
| 4777 | union { |
| 4778 | // Info for the canonical type. |
| 4779 | CanonicalTTPTInfo CanTTPTInfo; |
| 4780 | |
| 4781 | // Info for the non-canonical type. |
| 4782 | TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl; |
| 4783 | }; |
| 4784 | |
| 4785 | /// Build a non-canonical type. |
| 4786 | TemplateTypeParmType(TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl, QualType Canon) |
| 4787 | : Type(TemplateTypeParm, Canon, |
| 4788 | TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation | |
| 4789 | (Canon->getDependence() & TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack)), |
| 4790 | TTPDecl(TTPDecl) {} |
| 4791 | |
| 4792 | /// Build the canonical type. |
| 4793 | TemplateTypeParmType(unsigned D, unsigned I, bool PP) |
| 4794 | : Type(TemplateTypeParm, QualType(this, 0), |
| 4795 | TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation | |
| 4796 | (PP ? TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack : TypeDependence::None)) { |
| 4797 | CanTTPTInfo.Depth = D; |
| 4798 | CanTTPTInfo.Index = I; |
| 4799 | CanTTPTInfo.ParameterPack = PP; |
| 4800 | } |
| 4801 | |
| 4802 | const CanonicalTTPTInfo& getCanTTPTInfo() const { |
| 4803 | QualType Can = getCanonicalTypeInternal(); |
| 4804 | return Can->castAs<TemplateTypeParmType>()->CanTTPTInfo; |
| 4805 | } |
| 4806 | |
| 4807 | public: |
| 4808 | unsigned getDepth() const { return getCanTTPTInfo().Depth; } |
| 4809 | unsigned getIndex() const { return getCanTTPTInfo().Index; } |
| 4810 | bool isParameterPack() const { return getCanTTPTInfo().ParameterPack; } |
| 4811 | |
| 4812 | TemplateTypeParmDecl *getDecl() const { |
| 4813 | return isCanonicalUnqualified() ? nullptr : TTPDecl; |
| 4814 | } |
| 4815 | |
| 4816 | IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const; |
| 4817 | |
| 4818 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 4819 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 4820 | |
| 4821 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 4822 | Profile(ID, getDepth(), getIndex(), isParameterPack(), getDecl()); |
| 4823 | } |
| 4824 | |
| 4825 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, unsigned Depth, |
| 4826 | unsigned Index, bool ParameterPack, |
| 4827 | TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) { |
| 4828 | ID.AddInteger(Depth); |
| 4829 | ID.AddInteger(Index); |
| 4830 | ID.AddBoolean(ParameterPack); |
| 4831 | ID.AddPointer(TTPDecl); |
| 4832 | } |
| 4833 | |
| 4834 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 4835 | return T->getTypeClass() == TemplateTypeParm; |
| 4836 | } |
| 4837 | }; |
| 4838 | |
| 4839 | /// Represents the result of substituting a type for a template |
| 4840 | /// type parameter. |
| 4841 | /// |
| 4842 | /// Within an instantiated template, all template type parameters have |
| 4843 | /// been replaced with these. They are used solely to record that a |
| 4844 | /// type was originally written as a template type parameter; |
| 4845 | /// therefore they are never canonical. |
| 4846 | class SubstTemplateTypeParmType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 4847 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 4848 | |
| 4849 | // The original type parameter. |
| 4850 | const TemplateTypeParmType *Replaced; |
| 4851 | |
| 4852 | SubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Param, QualType Canon) |
| 4853 | : Type(SubstTemplateTypeParm, Canon, Canon->getDependence()), |
| 4854 | Replaced(Param) {} |
| 4855 | |
| 4856 | public: |
| 4857 | /// Gets the template parameter that was substituted for. |
| 4858 | const TemplateTypeParmType *getReplacedParameter() const { |
| 4859 | return Replaced; |
| 4860 | } |
| 4861 | |
| 4862 | /// Gets the type that was substituted for the template |
| 4863 | /// parameter. |
| 4864 | QualType getReplacementType() const { |
| 4865 | return getCanonicalTypeInternal(); |
| 4866 | } |
| 4867 | |
| 4868 | bool isSugared() const { return true; } |
| 4869 | QualType desugar() const { return getReplacementType(); } |
| 4870 | |
| 4871 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 4872 | Profile(ID, getReplacedParameter(), getReplacementType()); |
| 4873 | } |
| 4874 | |
| 4875 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, |
| 4876 | const TemplateTypeParmType *Replaced, |
| 4877 | QualType Replacement) { |
| 4878 | ID.AddPointer(Replaced); |
| 4879 | ID.AddPointer(Replacement.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 4880 | } |
| 4881 | |
| 4882 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 4883 | return T->getTypeClass() == SubstTemplateTypeParm; |
| 4884 | } |
| 4885 | }; |
| 4886 | |
| 4887 | /// Represents the result of substituting a set of types for a template |
| 4888 | /// type parameter pack. |
| 4889 | /// |
| 4890 | /// When a pack expansion in the source code contains multiple parameter packs |
| 4891 | /// and those parameter packs correspond to different levels of template |
| 4892 | /// parameter lists, this type node is used to represent a template type |
| 4893 | /// parameter pack from an outer level, which has already had its argument pack |
| 4894 | /// substituted but that still lives within a pack expansion that itself |
| 4895 | /// could not be instantiated. When actually performing a substitution into |
| 4896 | /// that pack expansion (e.g., when all template parameters have corresponding |
| 4897 | /// arguments), this type will be replaced with the \c SubstTemplateTypeParmType |
| 4898 | /// at the current pack substitution index. |
| 4899 | class SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 4900 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 4901 | |
| 4902 | /// The original type parameter. |
| 4903 | const TemplateTypeParmType *Replaced; |
| 4904 | |
| 4905 | /// A pointer to the set of template arguments that this |
| 4906 | /// parameter pack is instantiated with. |
| 4907 | const TemplateArgument *Arguments; |
| 4908 | |
| 4909 | SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Param, |
| 4910 | QualType Canon, |
| 4911 | const TemplateArgument &ArgPack); |
| 4912 | |
| 4913 | public: |
| 4914 | IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const { return Replaced->getIdentifier(); } |
| 4915 | |
| 4916 | /// Gets the template parameter that was substituted for. |
| 4917 | const TemplateTypeParmType *getReplacedParameter() const { |
| 4918 | return Replaced; |
| 4919 | } |
| 4920 | |
| 4921 | unsigned getNumArgs() const { |
| 4922 | return SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypeBits.NumArgs; |
| 4923 | } |
| 4924 | |
| 4925 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 4926 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 4927 | |
| 4928 | TemplateArgument getArgumentPack() const; |
| 4929 | |
| 4930 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID); |
| 4931 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, |
| 4932 | const TemplateTypeParmType *Replaced, |
| 4933 | const TemplateArgument &ArgPack); |
| 4934 | |
| 4935 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 4936 | return T->getTypeClass() == SubstTemplateTypeParmPack; |
| 4937 | } |
| 4938 | }; |
| 4939 | |
| 4940 | /// Common base class for placeholders for types that get replaced by |
| 4941 | /// placeholder type deduction: C++11 auto, C++14 decltype(auto), C++17 deduced |
| 4942 | /// class template types, and constrained type names. |
| 4943 | /// |
| 4944 | /// These types are usually a placeholder for a deduced type. However, before |
| 4945 | /// the initializer is attached, or (usually) if the initializer is |
| 4946 | /// type-dependent, there is no deduced type and the type is canonical. In |
| 4947 | /// the latter case, it is also a dependent type. |
| 4948 | class DeducedType : public Type { |
| 4949 | protected: |
| 4950 | DeducedType(TypeClass TC, QualType DeducedAsType, |
| 4951 | TypeDependence ExtraDependence) |
| 4952 | : Type(TC, |
| 4953 | // FIXME: Retain the sugared deduced type? |
| 4954 | DeducedAsType.isNull() ? QualType(this, 0) |
| 4955 | : DeducedAsType.getCanonicalType(), |
| 4956 | ExtraDependence | (DeducedAsType.isNull() |
| 4957 | ? TypeDependence::None |
| 4958 | : DeducedAsType->getDependence() & |
| 4959 | ~TypeDependence::VariablyModified)) {} |
| 4960 | |
| 4961 | public: |
| 4962 | bool isSugared() const { return !isCanonicalUnqualified(); } |
| 4963 | QualType desugar() const { return getCanonicalTypeInternal(); } |
| 4964 | |
| 4965 | /// Get the type deduced for this placeholder type, or null if it's |
| 4966 | /// either not been deduced or was deduced to a dependent type. |
| 4967 | QualType getDeducedType() const { |
| 4968 | return !isCanonicalUnqualified() ? getCanonicalTypeInternal() : QualType(); |
| 4969 | } |
| 4970 | bool isDeduced() const { |
| 4971 | return !isCanonicalUnqualified() || isDependentType(); |
| 4972 | } |
| 4973 | |
| 4974 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 4975 | return T->getTypeClass() == Auto || |
| 4976 | T->getTypeClass() == DeducedTemplateSpecialization; |
| 4977 | } |
| 4978 | }; |
| 4979 | |
| 4980 | /// Represents a C++11 auto or C++14 decltype(auto) type, possibly constrained |
| 4981 | /// by a type-constraint. |
| 4982 | class alignas(8) AutoType : public DeducedType, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 4983 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 4984 | |
| 4985 | ConceptDecl *TypeConstraintConcept; |
| 4986 | |
| 4987 | AutoType(QualType DeducedAsType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword, |
| 4988 | TypeDependence ExtraDependence, ConceptDecl *CD, |
| 4989 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TypeConstraintArgs); |
| 4990 | |
| 4991 | const TemplateArgument *getArgBuffer() const { |
| 4992 | return reinterpret_cast<const TemplateArgument*>(this+1); |
| 4993 | } |
| 4994 | |
| 4995 | TemplateArgument *getArgBuffer() { |
| 4996 | return reinterpret_cast<TemplateArgument*>(this+1); |
| 4997 | } |
| 4998 | |
| 4999 | public: |
| 5000 | /// Retrieve the template arguments. |
| 5001 | const TemplateArgument *getArgs() const { |
| 5002 | return getArgBuffer(); |
| 5003 | } |
| 5004 | |
| 5005 | /// Retrieve the number of template arguments. |
| 5006 | unsigned getNumArgs() const { |
| 5007 | return AutoTypeBits.NumArgs; |
| 5008 | } |
| 5009 | |
| 5010 | const TemplateArgument &getArg(unsigned Idx) const; // in TemplateBase.h |
| 5011 | |
| 5012 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> getTypeConstraintArguments() const { |
| 5013 | return {getArgs(), getNumArgs()}; |
| 5014 | } |
| 5015 | |
| 5016 | ConceptDecl *getTypeConstraintConcept() const { |
| 5017 | return TypeConstraintConcept; |
| 5018 | } |
| 5019 | |
| 5020 | bool isConstrained() const { |
| 5021 | return TypeConstraintConcept != nullptr; |
| 5022 | } |
| 5023 | |
| 5024 | bool isDecltypeAuto() const { |
| 5025 | return getKeyword() == AutoTypeKeyword::DecltypeAuto; |
| 5026 | } |
| 5027 | |
| 5028 | AutoTypeKeyword getKeyword() const { |
| 5029 | return (AutoTypeKeyword)AutoTypeBits.Keyword; |
| 5030 | } |
| 5031 | |
| 5032 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context) { |
| 5033 | Profile(ID, Context, getDeducedType(), getKeyword(), isDependentType(), |
| 5034 | getTypeConstraintConcept(), getTypeConstraintArguments()); |
| 5035 | } |
| 5036 | |
| 5037 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context, |
| 5038 | QualType Deduced, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword, |
| 5039 | bool IsDependent, ConceptDecl *CD, |
| 5040 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Arguments); |
| 5041 | |
| 5042 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 5043 | return T->getTypeClass() == Auto; |
| 5044 | } |
| 5045 | }; |
| 5046 | |
| 5047 | /// Represents a C++17 deduced template specialization type. |
| 5048 | class DeducedTemplateSpecializationType : public DeducedType, |
| 5049 | public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 5050 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 5051 | |
| 5052 | /// The name of the template whose arguments will be deduced. |
| 5053 | TemplateName Template; |
| 5054 | |
| 5055 | DeducedTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template, |
| 5056 | QualType DeducedAsType, |
| 5057 | bool IsDeducedAsDependent) |
| 5058 | : DeducedType(DeducedTemplateSpecialization, DeducedAsType, |
| 5059 | toTypeDependence(Template.getDependence()) | |
| 5060 | (IsDeducedAsDependent |
| 5061 | ? TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation |
| 5062 | : TypeDependence::None)), |
| 5063 | Template(Template) {} |
| 5064 | |
| 5065 | public: |
| 5066 | /// Retrieve the name of the template that we are deducing. |
| 5067 | TemplateName getTemplateName() const { return Template;} |
| 5068 | |
| 5069 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 5070 | Profile(ID, getTemplateName(), getDeducedType(), isDependentType()); |
| 5071 | } |
| 5072 | |
| 5073 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, TemplateName Template, |
| 5074 | QualType Deduced, bool IsDependent) { |
| 5075 | Template.Profile(ID); |
| 5076 | ID.AddPointer(Deduced.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 5077 | ID.AddBoolean(IsDependent); |
| 5078 | } |
| 5079 | |
| 5080 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 5081 | return T->getTypeClass() == DeducedTemplateSpecialization; |
| 5082 | } |
| 5083 | }; |
| 5084 | |
| 5085 | /// Represents a type template specialization; the template |
| 5086 | /// must be a class template, a type alias template, or a template |
| 5087 | /// template parameter. A template which cannot be resolved to one of |
| 5088 | /// these, e.g. because it is written with a dependent scope |
| 5089 | /// specifier, is instead represented as a |
| 5090 | /// @c DependentTemplateSpecializationType. |
| 5091 | /// |
| 5092 | /// A non-dependent template specialization type is always "sugar", |
| 5093 | /// typically for a \c RecordType. For example, a class template |
| 5094 | /// specialization type of \c vector<int> will refer to a tag type for |
| 5095 | /// the instantiation \c std::vector<int, std::allocator<int>> |
| 5096 | /// |
| 5097 | /// Template specializations are dependent if either the template or |
| 5098 | /// any of the template arguments are dependent, in which case the |
| 5099 | /// type may also be canonical. |
| 5100 | /// |
| 5101 | /// Instances of this type are allocated with a trailing array of |
| 5102 | /// TemplateArguments, followed by a QualType representing the |
| 5103 | /// non-canonical aliased type when the template is a type alias |
| 5104 | /// template. |
| 5105 | class alignas(8) TemplateSpecializationType |
| 5106 | : public Type, |
| 5107 | public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 5108 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 5109 | |
| 5110 | /// The name of the template being specialized. This is |
| 5111 | /// either a TemplateName::Template (in which case it is a |
| 5112 | /// ClassTemplateDecl*, a TemplateTemplateParmDecl*, or a |
| 5113 | /// TypeAliasTemplateDecl*), a |
| 5114 | /// TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack, or a |
| 5115 | /// TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm (in which case the |
| 5116 | /// replacement must, recursively, be one of these). |
| 5117 | TemplateName Template; |
| 5118 | |
| 5119 | TemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName T, |
| 5120 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args, |
| 5121 | QualType Canon, |
| 5122 | QualType Aliased); |
| 5123 | |
| 5124 | public: |
| 5125 | /// Determine whether any of the given template arguments are dependent. |
| 5126 | /// |
| 5127 | /// The converted arguments should be supplied when known; whether an |
| 5128 | /// argument is dependent can depend on the conversions performed on it |
| 5129 | /// (for example, a 'const int' passed as a template argument might be |
| 5130 | /// dependent if the parameter is a reference but non-dependent if the |
| 5131 | /// parameter is an int). |
| 5132 | /// |
| 5133 | /// Note that the \p Args parameter is unused: this is intentional, to remind |
| 5134 | /// the caller that they need to pass in the converted arguments, not the |
| 5135 | /// specified arguments. |
| 5136 | static bool |
| 5137 | anyDependentTemplateArguments(ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args, |
| 5138 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Converted); |
| 5139 | static bool |
| 5140 | anyDependentTemplateArguments(const TemplateArgumentListInfo &, |
| 5141 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Converted); |
| 5142 | static bool anyInstantiationDependentTemplateArguments( |
| 5143 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args); |
| 5144 | |
| 5145 | /// True if this template specialization type matches a current |
| 5146 | /// instantiation in the context in which it is found. |
| 5147 | bool isCurrentInstantiation() const { |
| 5148 | return isa<InjectedClassNameType>(getCanonicalTypeInternal()); |
| 5149 | } |
| 5150 | |
| 5151 | /// Determine if this template specialization type is for a type alias |
| 5152 | /// template that has been substituted. |
| 5153 | /// |
| 5154 | /// Nearly every template specialization type whose template is an alias |
| 5155 | /// template will be substituted. However, this is not the case when |
| 5156 | /// the specialization contains a pack expansion but the template alias |
| 5157 | /// does not have a corresponding parameter pack, e.g., |
| 5158 | /// |
| 5159 | /// \code |
| 5160 | /// template<typename T, typename U, typename V> struct S; |
| 5161 | /// template<typename T, typename U> using A = S<T, int, U>; |
| 5162 | /// template<typename... Ts> struct X { |
| 5163 | /// typedef A<Ts...> type; // not a type alias |
| 5164 | /// }; |
| 5165 | /// \endcode |
| 5166 | bool isTypeAlias() const { return TemplateSpecializationTypeBits.TypeAlias; } |
| 5167 | |
| 5168 | /// Get the aliased type, if this is a specialization of a type alias |
| 5169 | /// template. |
| 5170 | QualType getAliasedType() const { |
| 5171 | assert(isTypeAlias() && "not a type alias template specialization")((void)0); |
| 5172 | return *reinterpret_cast<const QualType*>(end()); |
| 5173 | } |
| 5174 | |
| 5175 | using iterator = const TemplateArgument *; |
| 5176 | |
| 5177 | iterator begin() const { return getArgs(); } |
| 5178 | iterator end() const; // defined inline in TemplateBase.h |
| 5179 | |
| 5180 | /// Retrieve the name of the template that we are specializing. |
| 5181 | TemplateName getTemplateName() const { return Template; } |
| 5182 | |
| 5183 | /// Retrieve the template arguments. |
| 5184 | const TemplateArgument *getArgs() const { |
| 5185 | return reinterpret_cast<const TemplateArgument *>(this + 1); |
| 5186 | } |
| 5187 | |
| 5188 | /// Retrieve the number of template arguments. |
| 5189 | unsigned getNumArgs() const { |
| 5190 | return TemplateSpecializationTypeBits.NumArgs; |
| 5191 | } |
| 5192 | |
| 5193 | /// Retrieve a specific template argument as a type. |
| 5194 | /// \pre \c isArgType(Arg) |
| 5195 | const TemplateArgument &getArg(unsigned Idx) const; // in TemplateBase.h |
| 5196 | |
| 5197 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> template_arguments() const { |
| 5198 | return {getArgs(), getNumArgs()}; |
| 5199 | } |
| 5200 | |
| 5201 | bool isSugared() const { |
| 5202 | return !isDependentType() || isCurrentInstantiation() || isTypeAlias(); |
| 5203 | } |
| 5204 | |
| 5205 | QualType desugar() const { |
| 5206 | return isTypeAlias() ? getAliasedType() : getCanonicalTypeInternal(); |
| 5207 | } |
| 5208 | |
| 5209 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Ctx) { |
| 5210 | Profile(ID, Template, template_arguments(), Ctx); |
| 5211 | if (isTypeAlias()) |
| 5212 | getAliasedType().Profile(ID); |
| 5213 | } |
| 5214 | |
| 5215 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, TemplateName T, |
| 5216 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args, |
| 5217 | const ASTContext &Context); |
| 5218 | |
| 5219 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 5220 | return T->getTypeClass() == TemplateSpecialization; |
| 5221 | } |
| 5222 | }; |
| 5223 | |
| 5224 | /// Print a template argument list, including the '<' and '>' |
| 5225 | /// enclosing the template arguments. |
| 5226 | void printTemplateArgumentList(raw_ostream &OS, |
| 5227 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args, |
| 5228 | const PrintingPolicy &Policy, |
| 5229 | const TemplateParameterList *TPL = nullptr); |
| 5230 | |
| 5231 | void printTemplateArgumentList(raw_ostream &OS, |
| 5232 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args, |
| 5233 | const PrintingPolicy &Policy, |
| 5234 | const TemplateParameterList *TPL = nullptr); |
| 5235 | |
| 5236 | void printTemplateArgumentList(raw_ostream &OS, |
| 5237 | const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args, |
| 5238 | const PrintingPolicy &Policy, |
| 5239 | const TemplateParameterList *TPL = nullptr); |
| 5240 | |
| 5241 | /// The injected class name of a C++ class template or class |
| 5242 | /// template partial specialization. Used to record that a type was |
| 5243 | /// spelled with a bare identifier rather than as a template-id; the |
| 5244 | /// equivalent for non-templated classes is just RecordType. |
| 5245 | /// |
| 5246 | /// Injected class name types are always dependent. Template |
| 5247 | /// instantiation turns these into RecordTypes. |
| 5248 | /// |
| 5249 | /// Injected class name types are always canonical. This works |
| 5250 | /// because it is impossible to compare an injected class name type |
| 5251 | /// with the corresponding non-injected template type, for the same |
| 5252 | /// reason that it is impossible to directly compare template |
| 5253 | /// parameters from different dependent contexts: injected class name |
| 5254 | /// types can only occur within the scope of a particular templated |
| 5255 | /// declaration, and within that scope every template specialization |
| 5256 | /// will canonicalize to the injected class name (when appropriate |
| 5257 | /// according to the rules of the language). |
| 5258 | class InjectedClassNameType : public Type { |
| 5259 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 5260 | friend class ASTNodeImporter; |
| 5261 | friend class ASTReader; // FIXME: ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType is not |
| 5262 | // currently suitable for AST reading, too much |
| 5263 | // interdependencies. |
| 5264 | template <class T> friend class serialization::AbstractTypeReader; |
| 5265 | |
| 5266 | CXXRecordDecl *Decl; |
| 5267 | |
| 5268 | /// The template specialization which this type represents. |
| 5269 | /// For example, in |
| 5270 | /// template <class T> class A { ... }; |
| 5271 | /// this is A<T>, whereas in |
| 5272 | /// template <class X, class Y> class A<B<X,Y> > { ... }; |
| 5273 | /// this is A<B<X,Y> >. |
| 5274 | /// |
| 5275 | /// It is always unqualified, always a template specialization type, |
| 5276 | /// and always dependent. |
| 5277 | QualType InjectedType; |
| 5278 | |
| 5279 | InjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *D, QualType TST) |
| 5280 | : Type(InjectedClassName, QualType(), |
| 5281 | TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation), |
| 5282 | Decl(D), InjectedType(TST) { |
| 5283 | assert(isa<TemplateSpecializationType>(TST))((void)0); |
| 5284 | assert(!TST.hasQualifiers())((void)0); |
| 5285 | assert(TST->isDependentType())((void)0); |
| 5286 | } |
| 5287 | |
| 5288 | public: |
| 5289 | QualType getInjectedSpecializationType() const { return InjectedType; } |
| 5290 | |
| 5291 | const TemplateSpecializationType *getInjectedTST() const { |
| 5292 | return cast<TemplateSpecializationType>(InjectedType.getTypePtr()); |
| 5293 | } |
| 5294 | |
| 5295 | TemplateName getTemplateName() const { |
| 5296 | return getInjectedTST()->getTemplateName(); |
| 5297 | } |
| 5298 | |
| 5299 | CXXRecordDecl *getDecl() const; |
| 5300 | |
| 5301 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 5302 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 5303 | |
| 5304 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 5305 | return T->getTypeClass() == InjectedClassName; |
| 5306 | } |
| 5307 | }; |
| 5308 | |
| 5309 | /// The kind of a tag type. |
| 5310 | enum TagTypeKind { |
| 5311 | /// The "struct" keyword. |
| 5312 | TTK_Struct, |
| 5313 | |
| 5314 | /// The "__interface" keyword. |
| 5315 | TTK_Interface, |
| 5316 | |
| 5317 | /// The "union" keyword. |
| 5318 | TTK_Union, |
| 5319 | |
| 5320 | /// The "class" keyword. |
| 5321 | TTK_Class, |
| 5322 | |
| 5323 | /// The "enum" keyword. |
| 5324 | TTK_Enum |
| 5325 | }; |
| 5326 | |
| 5327 | /// The elaboration keyword that precedes a qualified type name or |
| 5328 | /// introduces an elaborated-type-specifier. |
| 5329 | enum ElaboratedTypeKeyword { |
| 5330 | /// The "struct" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier. |
| 5331 | ETK_Struct, |
| 5332 | |
| 5333 | /// The "__interface" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier. |
| 5334 | ETK_Interface, |
| 5335 | |
| 5336 | /// The "union" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier. |
| 5337 | ETK_Union, |
| 5338 | |
| 5339 | /// The "class" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier. |
| 5340 | ETK_Class, |
| 5341 | |
| 5342 | /// The "enum" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier. |
| 5343 | ETK_Enum, |
| 5344 | |
| 5345 | /// The "typename" keyword precedes the qualified type name, e.g., |
| 5346 | /// \c typename T::type. |
| 5347 | ETK_Typename, |
| 5348 | |
| 5349 | /// No keyword precedes the qualified type name. |
| 5350 | ETK_None |
| 5351 | }; |
| 5352 | |
| 5353 | /// A helper class for Type nodes having an ElaboratedTypeKeyword. |
| 5354 | /// The keyword in stored in the free bits of the base class. |
| 5355 | /// Also provides a few static helpers for converting and printing |
| 5356 | /// elaborated type keyword and tag type kind enumerations. |
| 5357 | class TypeWithKeyword : public Type { |
| 5358 | protected: |
| 5359 | TypeWithKeyword(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, TypeClass tc, |
| 5360 | QualType Canonical, TypeDependence Dependence) |
| 5361 | : Type(tc, Canonical, Dependence) { |
| 5362 | TypeWithKeywordBits.Keyword = Keyword; |
| 5363 | } |
| 5364 | |
| 5365 | public: |
| 5366 | ElaboratedTypeKeyword getKeyword() const { |
| 5367 | return static_cast<ElaboratedTypeKeyword>(TypeWithKeywordBits.Keyword); |
| 5368 | } |
| 5369 | |
| 5370 | /// Converts a type specifier (DeclSpec::TST) into an elaborated type keyword. |
| 5371 | static ElaboratedTypeKeyword getKeywordForTypeSpec(unsigned TypeSpec); |
| 5372 | |
| 5373 | /// Converts a type specifier (DeclSpec::TST) into a tag type kind. |
| 5374 | /// It is an error to provide a type specifier which *isn't* a tag kind here. |
| 5375 | static TagTypeKind getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(unsigned TypeSpec); |
| 5376 | |
| 5377 | /// Converts a TagTypeKind into an elaborated type keyword. |
| 5378 | static ElaboratedTypeKeyword getKeywordForTagTypeKind(TagTypeKind Tag); |
| 5379 | |
| 5380 | /// Converts an elaborated type keyword into a TagTypeKind. |
| 5381 | /// It is an error to provide an elaborated type keyword |
| 5382 | /// which *isn't* a tag kind here. |
| 5383 | static TagTypeKind getTagTypeKindForKeyword(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword); |
| 5384 | |
| 5385 | static bool KeywordIsTagTypeKind(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword); |
| 5386 | |
| 5387 | static StringRef getKeywordName(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword); |
| 5388 | |
| 5389 | static StringRef getTagTypeKindName(TagTypeKind Kind) { |
| 5390 | return getKeywordName(getKeywordForTagTypeKind(Kind)); |
| 5391 | } |
| 5392 | |
| 5393 | class CannotCastToThisType {}; |
| 5394 | static CannotCastToThisType classof(const Type *); |
| 5395 | }; |
| 5396 | |
| 5397 | /// Represents a type that was referred to using an elaborated type |
| 5398 | /// keyword, e.g., struct S, or via a qualified name, e.g., N::M::type, |
| 5399 | /// or both. |
| 5400 | /// |
| 5401 | /// This type is used to keep track of a type name as written in the |
| 5402 | /// source code, including tag keywords and any nested-name-specifiers. |
| 5403 | /// The type itself is always "sugar", used to express what was written |
| 5404 | /// in the source code but containing no additional semantic information. |
| 5405 | class ElaboratedType final |
| 5406 | : public TypeWithKeyword, |
| 5407 | public llvm::FoldingSetNode, |
| 5408 | private llvm::TrailingObjects<ElaboratedType, TagDecl *> { |
| 5409 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 5410 | friend TrailingObjects; |
| 5411 | |
| 5412 | /// The nested name specifier containing the qualifier. |
| 5413 | NestedNameSpecifier *NNS; |
| 5414 | |
| 5415 | /// The type that this qualified name refers to. |
| 5416 | QualType NamedType; |
| 5417 | |
| 5418 | /// The (re)declaration of this tag type owned by this occurrence is stored |
| 5419 | /// as a trailing object if there is one. Use getOwnedTagDecl to obtain |
| 5420 | /// it, or obtain a null pointer if there is none. |
| 5421 | |
| 5422 | ElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, |
| 5423 | QualType NamedType, QualType CanonType, TagDecl *OwnedTagDecl) |
| 5424 | : TypeWithKeyword(Keyword, Elaborated, CanonType, |
| 5425 | // Any semantic dependence on the qualifier will have |
| 5426 | // been incorporated into NamedType. We still need to |
| 5427 | // track syntactic (instantiation / error / pack) |
| 5428 | // dependence on the qualifier. |
| 5429 | NamedType->getDependence() | |
| 5430 | (NNS ? toSyntacticDependence( |
| 5431 | toTypeDependence(NNS->getDependence())) |
| 5432 | : TypeDependence::None)), |
| 5433 | NNS(NNS), NamedType(NamedType) { |
| 5434 | ElaboratedTypeBits.HasOwnedTagDecl = false; |
| 5435 | if (OwnedTagDecl) { |
| 5436 | ElaboratedTypeBits.HasOwnedTagDecl = true; |
| 5437 | *getTrailingObjects<TagDecl *>() = OwnedTagDecl; |
| 5438 | } |
| 5439 | assert(!(Keyword == ETK_None && NNS == nullptr) &&((void)0) |
| 5440 | "ElaboratedType cannot have elaborated type keyword "((void)0) |
| 5441 | "and name qualifier both null.")((void)0); |
| 5442 | } |
| 5443 | |
| 5444 | public: |
| 5445 | /// Retrieve the qualification on this type. |
| 5446 | NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const { return NNS; } |
| 5447 | |
| 5448 | /// Retrieve the type named by the qualified-id. |
| 5449 | QualType getNamedType() const { return NamedType; } |
| 5450 | |
| 5451 | /// Remove a single level of sugar. |
| 5452 | QualType desugar() const { return getNamedType(); } |
| 5453 | |
| 5454 | /// Returns whether this type directly provides sugar. |
| 5455 | bool isSugared() const { return true; } |
| 5456 | |
| 5457 | /// Return the (re)declaration of this type owned by this occurrence of this |
| 5458 | /// type, or nullptr if there is none. |
| 5459 | TagDecl *getOwnedTagDecl() const { |
| 5460 | return ElaboratedTypeBits.HasOwnedTagDecl ? *getTrailingObjects<TagDecl *>() |
| 5461 | : nullptr; |
| 5462 | } |
| 5463 | |
| 5464 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 5465 | Profile(ID, getKeyword(), NNS, NamedType, getOwnedTagDecl()); |
| 5466 | } |
| 5467 | |
| 5468 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, |
| 5469 | NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, QualType NamedType, |
| 5470 | TagDecl *OwnedTagDecl) { |
| 5471 | ID.AddInteger(Keyword); |
| 5472 | ID.AddPointer(NNS); |
| 5473 | NamedType.Profile(ID); |
| 5474 | ID.AddPointer(OwnedTagDecl); |
| 5475 | } |
| 5476 | |
| 5477 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == Elaborated; } |
| 5478 | }; |
| 5479 | |
| 5480 | /// Represents a qualified type name for which the type name is |
| 5481 | /// dependent. |
| 5482 | /// |
| 5483 | /// DependentNameType represents a class of dependent types that involve a |
| 5484 | /// possibly dependent nested-name-specifier (e.g., "T::") followed by a |
| 5485 | /// name of a type. The DependentNameType may start with a "typename" (for a |
| 5486 | /// typename-specifier), "class", "struct", "union", or "enum" (for a |
| 5487 | /// dependent elaborated-type-specifier), or nothing (in contexts where we |
| 5488 | /// know that we must be referring to a type, e.g., in a base class specifier). |
| 5489 | /// Typically the nested-name-specifier is dependent, but in MSVC compatibility |
| 5490 | /// mode, this type is used with non-dependent names to delay name lookup until |
| 5491 | /// instantiation. |
| 5492 | class DependentNameType : public TypeWithKeyword, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 5493 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 5494 | |
| 5495 | /// The nested name specifier containing the qualifier. |
| 5496 | NestedNameSpecifier *NNS; |
| 5497 | |
| 5498 | /// The type that this typename specifier refers to. |
| 5499 | const IdentifierInfo *Name; |
| 5500 | |
| 5501 | DependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, |
| 5502 | const IdentifierInfo *Name, QualType CanonType) |
| 5503 | : TypeWithKeyword(Keyword, DependentName, CanonType, |
| 5504 | TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation | |
| 5505 | toTypeDependence(NNS->getDependence())), |
| 5506 | NNS(NNS), Name(Name) {} |
| 5507 | |
| 5508 | public: |
| 5509 | /// Retrieve the qualification on this type. |
| 5510 | NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const { return NNS; } |
| 5511 | |
| 5512 | /// Retrieve the type named by the typename specifier as an identifier. |
| 5513 | /// |
| 5514 | /// This routine will return a non-NULL identifier pointer when the |
| 5515 | /// form of the original typename was terminated by an identifier, |
| 5516 | /// e.g., "typename T::type". |
| 5517 | const IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const { |
| 5518 | return Name; |
| 5519 | } |
| 5520 | |
| 5521 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 5522 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 5523 | |
| 5524 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 5525 | Profile(ID, getKeyword(), NNS, Name); |
| 5526 | } |
| 5527 | |
| 5528 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, |
| 5529 | NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, const IdentifierInfo *Name) { |
| 5530 | ID.AddInteger(Keyword); |
| 5531 | ID.AddPointer(NNS); |
| 5532 | ID.AddPointer(Name); |
| 5533 | } |
| 5534 | |
| 5535 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 5536 | return T->getTypeClass() == DependentName; |
| 5537 | } |
| 5538 | }; |
| 5539 | |
| 5540 | /// Represents a template specialization type whose template cannot be |
| 5541 | /// resolved, e.g. |
| 5542 | /// A<T>::template B<T> |
| 5543 | class alignas(8) DependentTemplateSpecializationType |
| 5544 | : public TypeWithKeyword, |
| 5545 | public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 5546 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 5547 | |
| 5548 | /// The nested name specifier containing the qualifier. |
| 5549 | NestedNameSpecifier *NNS; |
| 5550 | |
| 5551 | /// The identifier of the template. |
| 5552 | const IdentifierInfo *Name; |
| 5553 | |
| 5554 | DependentTemplateSpecializationType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, |
| 5555 | NestedNameSpecifier *NNS, |
| 5556 | const IdentifierInfo *Name, |
| 5557 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args, |
| 5558 | QualType Canon); |
| 5559 | |
| 5560 | const TemplateArgument *getArgBuffer() const { |
| 5561 | return reinterpret_cast<const TemplateArgument*>(this+1); |
| 5562 | } |
| 5563 | |
| 5564 | TemplateArgument *getArgBuffer() { |
| 5565 | return reinterpret_cast<TemplateArgument*>(this+1); |
| 5566 | } |
| 5567 | |
| 5568 | public: |
| 5569 | NestedNameSpecifier *getQualifier() const { return NNS; } |
| 5570 | const IdentifierInfo *getIdentifier() const { return Name; } |
| 5571 | |
| 5572 | /// Retrieve the template arguments. |
| 5573 | const TemplateArgument *getArgs() const { |
| 5574 | return getArgBuffer(); |
| 5575 | } |
| 5576 | |
| 5577 | /// Retrieve the number of template arguments. |
| 5578 | unsigned getNumArgs() const { |
| 5579 | return DependentTemplateSpecializationTypeBits.NumArgs; |
| 5580 | } |
| 5581 | |
| 5582 | const TemplateArgument &getArg(unsigned Idx) const; // in TemplateBase.h |
| 5583 | |
| 5584 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> template_arguments() const { |
| 5585 | return {getArgs(), getNumArgs()}; |
| 5586 | } |
| 5587 | |
| 5588 | using iterator = const TemplateArgument *; |
| 5589 | |
| 5590 | iterator begin() const { return getArgs(); } |
| 5591 | iterator end() const; // inline in TemplateBase.h |
| 5592 | |
| 5593 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 5594 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 5595 | |
| 5596 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context) { |
| 5597 | Profile(ID, Context, getKeyword(), NNS, Name, {getArgs(), getNumArgs()}); |
| 5598 | } |
| 5599 | |
| 5600 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, |
| 5601 | const ASTContext &Context, |
| 5602 | ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, |
| 5603 | NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, |
| 5604 | const IdentifierInfo *Name, |
| 5605 | ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args); |
| 5606 | |
| 5607 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 5608 | return T->getTypeClass() == DependentTemplateSpecialization; |
| 5609 | } |
| 5610 | }; |
| 5611 | |
| 5612 | /// Represents a pack expansion of types. |
| 5613 | /// |
| 5614 | /// Pack expansions are part of C++11 variadic templates. A pack |
| 5615 | /// expansion contains a pattern, which itself contains one or more |
| 5616 | /// "unexpanded" parameter packs. When instantiated, a pack expansion |
| 5617 | /// produces a series of types, each instantiated from the pattern of |
| 5618 | /// the expansion, where the Ith instantiation of the pattern uses the |
| 5619 | /// Ith arguments bound to each of the unexpanded parameter packs. The |
| 5620 | /// pack expansion is considered to "expand" these unexpanded |
| 5621 | /// parameter packs. |
| 5622 | /// |
| 5623 | /// \code |
| 5624 | /// template<typename ...Types> struct tuple; |
| 5625 | /// |
| 5626 | /// template<typename ...Types> |
| 5627 | /// struct tuple_of_references { |
| 5628 | /// typedef tuple<Types&...> type; |
| 5629 | /// }; |
| 5630 | /// \endcode |
| 5631 | /// |
| 5632 | /// Here, the pack expansion \c Types&... is represented via a |
| 5633 | /// PackExpansionType whose pattern is Types&. |
| 5634 | class PackExpansionType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 5635 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these |
| 5636 | |
| 5637 | /// The pattern of the pack expansion. |
| 5638 | QualType Pattern; |
| 5639 | |
| 5640 | PackExpansionType(QualType Pattern, QualType Canon, |
| 5641 | Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) |
| 5642 | : Type(PackExpansion, Canon, |
| 5643 | (Pattern->getDependence() | TypeDependence::Dependent | |
| 5644 | TypeDependence::Instantiation) & |
| 5645 | ~TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack), |
| 5646 | Pattern(Pattern) { |
| 5647 | PackExpansionTypeBits.NumExpansions = |
| 5648 | NumExpansions ? *NumExpansions + 1 : 0; |
| 5649 | } |
| 5650 | |
| 5651 | public: |
| 5652 | /// Retrieve the pattern of this pack expansion, which is the |
| 5653 | /// type that will be repeatedly instantiated when instantiating the |
| 5654 | /// pack expansion itself. |
| 5655 | QualType getPattern() const { return Pattern; } |
| 5656 | |
| 5657 | /// Retrieve the number of expansions that this pack expansion will |
| 5658 | /// generate, if known. |
| 5659 | Optional<unsigned> getNumExpansions() const { |
| 5660 | if (PackExpansionTypeBits.NumExpansions) |
| 5661 | return PackExpansionTypeBits.NumExpansions - 1; |
| 5662 | return None; |
| 5663 | } |
| 5664 | |
| 5665 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 5666 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 5667 | |
| 5668 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 5669 | Profile(ID, getPattern(), getNumExpansions()); |
| 5670 | } |
| 5671 | |
| 5672 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType Pattern, |
| 5673 | Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) { |
| 5674 | ID.AddPointer(Pattern.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 5675 | ID.AddBoolean(NumExpansions.hasValue()); |
| 5676 | if (NumExpansions) |
| 5677 | ID.AddInteger(*NumExpansions); |
| 5678 | } |
| 5679 | |
| 5680 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 5681 | return T->getTypeClass() == PackExpansion; |
| 5682 | } |
| 5683 | }; |
| 5684 | |
| 5685 | /// This class wraps the list of protocol qualifiers. For types that can |
| 5686 | /// take ObjC protocol qualifers, they can subclass this class. |
| 5687 | template <class T> |
| 5688 | class ObjCProtocolQualifiers { |
| 5689 | protected: |
| 5690 | ObjCProtocolQualifiers() = default; |
| 5691 | |
| 5692 | ObjCProtocolDecl * const *getProtocolStorage() const { |
| 5693 | return const_cast<ObjCProtocolQualifiers*>(this)->getProtocolStorage(); |
| 5694 | } |
| 5695 | |
| 5696 | ObjCProtocolDecl **getProtocolStorage() { |
| 5697 | return static_cast<T*>(this)->getProtocolStorageImpl(); |
| 5698 | } |
| 5699 | |
| 5700 | void setNumProtocols(unsigned N) { |
| 5701 | static_cast<T*>(this)->setNumProtocolsImpl(N); |
| 5702 | } |
| 5703 | |
| 5704 | void initialize(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols) { |
| 5705 | setNumProtocols(protocols.size()); |
| 5706 | assert(getNumProtocols() == protocols.size() &&((void)0) |
| 5707 | "bitfield overflow in protocol count")((void)0); |
| 5708 | if (!protocols.empty()) |
| 5709 | memcpy(getProtocolStorage(), protocols.data(), |
| 5710 | protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl*)); |
| 5711 | } |
| 5712 | |
| 5713 | public: |
| 5714 | using qual_iterator = ObjCProtocolDecl * const *; |
| 5715 | using qual_range = llvm::iterator_range<qual_iterator>; |
| 5716 | |
| 5717 | qual_range quals() const { return qual_range(qual_begin(), qual_end()); } |
| 5718 | qual_iterator qual_begin() const { return getProtocolStorage(); } |
| 5719 | qual_iterator qual_end() const { return qual_begin() + getNumProtocols(); } |
| 5720 | |
| 5721 | bool qual_empty() const { return getNumProtocols() == 0; } |
| 5722 | |
| 5723 | /// Return the number of qualifying protocols in this type, or 0 if |
| 5724 | /// there are none. |
| 5725 | unsigned getNumProtocols() const { |
| 5726 | return static_cast<const T*>(this)->getNumProtocolsImpl(); |
| 5727 | } |
| 5728 | |
| 5729 | /// Fetch a protocol by index. |
| 5730 | ObjCProtocolDecl *getProtocol(unsigned I) const { |
| 5731 | assert(I < getNumProtocols() && "Out-of-range protocol access")((void)0); |
| 5732 | return qual_begin()[I]; |
| 5733 | } |
| 5734 | |
| 5735 | /// Retrieve all of the protocol qualifiers. |
| 5736 | ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> getProtocols() const { |
| 5737 | return ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(qual_begin(), getNumProtocols()); |
| 5738 | } |
| 5739 | }; |
| 5740 | |
| 5741 | /// Represents a type parameter type in Objective C. It can take |
| 5742 | /// a list of protocols. |
| 5743 | class ObjCTypeParamType : public Type, |
| 5744 | public ObjCProtocolQualifiers<ObjCTypeParamType>, |
| 5745 | public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 5746 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 5747 | friend class ObjCProtocolQualifiers<ObjCTypeParamType>; |
| 5748 | |
| 5749 | /// The number of protocols stored on this type. |
| 5750 | unsigned NumProtocols : 6; |
| 5751 | |
| 5752 | ObjCTypeParamDecl *OTPDecl; |
| 5753 | |
| 5754 | /// The protocols are stored after the ObjCTypeParamType node. In the |
| 5755 | /// canonical type, the list of protocols are sorted alphabetically |
| 5756 | /// and uniqued. |
| 5757 | ObjCProtocolDecl **getProtocolStorageImpl(); |
| 5758 | |
| 5759 | /// Return the number of qualifying protocols in this interface type, |
| 5760 | /// or 0 if there are none. |
| 5761 | unsigned getNumProtocolsImpl() const { |
| 5762 | return NumProtocols; |
| 5763 | } |
| 5764 | |
| 5765 | void setNumProtocolsImpl(unsigned N) { |
| 5766 | NumProtocols = N; |
| 5767 | } |
| 5768 | |
| 5769 | ObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *D, |
| 5770 | QualType can, |
| 5771 | ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols); |
| 5772 | |
| 5773 | public: |
| 5774 | bool isSugared() const { return true; } |
| 5775 | QualType desugar() const { return getCanonicalTypeInternal(); } |
| 5776 | |
| 5777 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 5778 | return T->getTypeClass() == ObjCTypeParam; |
| 5779 | } |
| 5780 | |
| 5781 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID); |
| 5782 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, |
| 5783 | const ObjCTypeParamDecl *OTPDecl, |
| 5784 | QualType CanonicalType, |
| 5785 | ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols); |
| 5786 | |
| 5787 | ObjCTypeParamDecl *getDecl() const { return OTPDecl; } |
| 5788 | }; |
| 5789 | |
| 5790 | /// Represents a class type in Objective C. |
| 5791 | /// |
| 5792 | /// Every Objective C type is a combination of a base type, a set of |
| 5793 | /// type arguments (optional, for parameterized classes) and a list of |
| 5794 | /// protocols. |
| 5795 | /// |
| 5796 | /// Given the following declarations: |
| 5797 | /// \code |
| 5798 | /// \@class C<T>; |
| 5799 | /// \@protocol P; |
| 5800 | /// \endcode |
| 5801 | /// |
| 5802 | /// 'C' is an ObjCInterfaceType C. It is sugar for an ObjCObjectType |
| 5803 | /// with base C and no protocols. |
| 5804 | /// |
| 5805 | /// 'C<P>' is an unspecialized ObjCObjectType with base C and protocol list [P]. |
| 5806 | /// 'C<C*>' is a specialized ObjCObjectType with type arguments 'C*' and no |
| 5807 | /// protocol list. |
| 5808 | /// 'C<C*><P>' is a specialized ObjCObjectType with base C, type arguments 'C*', |
| 5809 | /// and protocol list [P]. |
| 5810 | /// |
| 5811 | /// 'id' is a TypedefType which is sugar for an ObjCObjectPointerType whose |
| 5812 | /// pointee is an ObjCObjectType with base BuiltinType::ObjCIdType |
| 5813 | /// and no protocols. |
| 5814 | /// |
| 5815 | /// 'id<P>' is an ObjCObjectPointerType whose pointee is an ObjCObjectType |
| 5816 | /// with base BuiltinType::ObjCIdType and protocol list [P]. Eventually |
| 5817 | /// this should get its own sugar class to better represent the source. |
| 5818 | class ObjCObjectType : public Type, |
| 5819 | public ObjCProtocolQualifiers<ObjCObjectType> { |
| 5820 | friend class ObjCProtocolQualifiers<ObjCObjectType>; |
| 5821 | |
| 5822 | // ObjCObjectType.NumTypeArgs - the number of type arguments stored |
| 5823 | // after the ObjCObjectPointerType node. |
| 5824 | // ObjCObjectType.NumProtocols - the number of protocols stored |
| 5825 | // after the type arguments of ObjCObjectPointerType node. |
| 5826 | // |
| 5827 | // These protocols are those written directly on the type. If |
| 5828 | // protocol qualifiers ever become additive, the iterators will need |
| 5829 | // to get kindof complicated. |
| 5830 | // |
| 5831 | // In the canonical object type, these are sorted alphabetically |
| 5832 | // and uniqued. |
| 5833 | |
| 5834 | /// Either a BuiltinType or an InterfaceType or sugar for either. |
| 5835 | QualType BaseType; |
| 5836 | |
| 5837 | /// Cached superclass type. |
| 5838 | mutable llvm::PointerIntPair<const ObjCObjectType *, 1, bool> |
| 5839 | CachedSuperClassType; |
| 5840 | |
| 5841 | QualType *getTypeArgStorage(); |
| 5842 | const QualType *getTypeArgStorage() const { |
| 5843 | return const_cast<ObjCObjectType *>(this)->getTypeArgStorage(); |
| 5844 | } |
| 5845 | |
| 5846 | ObjCProtocolDecl **getProtocolStorageImpl(); |
| 5847 | /// Return the number of qualifying protocols in this interface type, |
| 5848 | /// or 0 if there are none. |
| 5849 | unsigned getNumProtocolsImpl() const { |
| 5850 | return ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumProtocols; |
| 5851 | } |
| 5852 | void setNumProtocolsImpl(unsigned N) { |
| 5853 | ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumProtocols = N; |
| 5854 | } |
| 5855 | |
| 5856 | protected: |
| 5857 | enum Nonce_ObjCInterface { Nonce_ObjCInterface }; |
| 5858 | |
| 5859 | ObjCObjectType(QualType Canonical, QualType Base, |
| 5860 | ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs, |
| 5861 | ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, |
| 5862 | bool isKindOf); |
| 5863 | |
| 5864 | ObjCObjectType(enum Nonce_ObjCInterface) |
| 5865 | : Type(ObjCInterface, QualType(), TypeDependence::None), |
| 5866 | BaseType(QualType(this_(), 0)) { |
| 5867 | ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumProtocols = 0; |
| 5868 | ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumTypeArgs = 0; |
| 5869 | ObjCObjectTypeBits.IsKindOf = 0; |
| 5870 | } |
| 5871 | |
| 5872 | void computeSuperClassTypeSlow() const; |
| 5873 | |
| 5874 | public: |
| 5875 | /// Gets the base type of this object type. This is always (possibly |
| 5876 | /// sugar for) one of: |
| 5877 | /// - the 'id' builtin type (as opposed to the 'id' type visible to the |
| 5878 | /// user, which is a typedef for an ObjCObjectPointerType) |
| 5879 | /// - the 'Class' builtin type (same caveat) |
| 5880 | /// - an ObjCObjectType (currently always an ObjCInterfaceType) |
| 5881 | QualType getBaseType() const { return BaseType; } |
| 5882 | |
| 5883 | bool isObjCId() const { |
| 5884 | return getBaseType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId); |
| 5885 | } |
| 5886 | |
| 5887 | bool isObjCClass() const { |
| 5888 | return getBaseType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCClass); |
| 5889 | } |
| 5890 | |
| 5891 | bool isObjCUnqualifiedId() const { return qual_empty() && isObjCId(); } |
| 5892 | bool isObjCUnqualifiedClass() const { return qual_empty() && isObjCClass(); } |
| 5893 | bool isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() const { |
| 5894 | if (!qual_empty()) return false; |
| 5895 | if (const BuiltinType *T = getBaseType()->getAs<BuiltinType>()) |
| 5896 | return T->getKind() == BuiltinType::ObjCId || |
| 5897 | T->getKind() == BuiltinType::ObjCClass; |
| 5898 | return false; |
| 5899 | } |
| 5900 | bool isObjCQualifiedId() const { return !qual_empty() && isObjCId(); } |
| 5901 | bool isObjCQualifiedClass() const { return !qual_empty() && isObjCClass(); } |
| 5902 | |
| 5903 | /// Gets the interface declaration for this object type, if the base type |
| 5904 | /// really is an interface. |
| 5905 | ObjCInterfaceDecl *getInterface() const; |
| 5906 | |
| 5907 | /// Determine whether this object type is "specialized", meaning |
| 5908 | /// that it has type arguments. |
| 5909 | bool isSpecialized() const; |
| 5910 | |
| 5911 | /// Determine whether this object type was written with type arguments. |
| 5912 | bool isSpecializedAsWritten() const { |
| 5913 | return ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumTypeArgs > 0; |
| 5914 | } |
| 5915 | |
| 5916 | /// Determine whether this object type is "unspecialized", meaning |
| 5917 | /// that it has no type arguments. |
| 5918 | bool isUnspecialized() const { return !isSpecialized(); } |
| 5919 | |
| 5920 | /// Determine whether this object type is "unspecialized" as |
| 5921 | /// written, meaning that it has no type arguments. |
| 5922 | bool isUnspecializedAsWritten() const { return !isSpecializedAsWritten(); } |
| 5923 | |
| 5924 | /// Retrieve the type arguments of this object type (semantically). |
| 5925 | ArrayRef<QualType> getTypeArgs() const; |
| 5926 | |
| 5927 | /// Retrieve the type arguments of this object type as they were |
| 5928 | /// written. |
| 5929 | ArrayRef<QualType> getTypeArgsAsWritten() const { |
| 5930 | return llvm::makeArrayRef(getTypeArgStorage(), |
| 5931 | ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumTypeArgs); |
| 5932 | } |
| 5933 | |
| 5934 | /// Whether this is a "__kindof" type as written. |
| 5935 | bool isKindOfTypeAsWritten() const { return ObjCObjectTypeBits.IsKindOf; } |
| 5936 | |
| 5937 | /// Whether this ia a "__kindof" type (semantically). |
| 5938 | bool isKindOfType() const; |
| 5939 | |
| 5940 | /// Retrieve the type of the superclass of this object type. |
| 5941 | /// |
| 5942 | /// This operation substitutes any type arguments into the |
| 5943 | /// superclass of the current class type, potentially producing a |
| 5944 | /// specialization of the superclass type. Produces a null type if |
| 5945 | /// there is no superclass. |
| 5946 | QualType getSuperClassType() const { |
| 5947 | if (!CachedSuperClassType.getInt()) |
| 5948 | computeSuperClassTypeSlow(); |
| 5949 | |
| 5950 | assert(CachedSuperClassType.getInt() && "Superclass not set?")((void)0); |
| 5951 | return QualType(CachedSuperClassType.getPointer(), 0); |
| 5952 | } |
| 5953 | |
| 5954 | /// Strip off the Objective-C "kindof" type and (with it) any |
| 5955 | /// protocol qualifiers. |
| 5956 | QualType stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(const ASTContext &ctx) const; |
| 5957 | |
| 5958 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 5959 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 5960 | |
| 5961 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 5962 | return T->getTypeClass() == ObjCObject || |
| 5963 | T->getTypeClass() == ObjCInterface; |
| 5964 | } |
| 5965 | }; |
| 5966 | |
| 5967 | /// A class providing a concrete implementation |
| 5968 | /// of ObjCObjectType, so as to not increase the footprint of |
| 5969 | /// ObjCInterfaceType. Code outside of ASTContext and the core type |
| 5970 | /// system should not reference this type. |
| 5971 | class ObjCObjectTypeImpl : public ObjCObjectType, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 5972 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 5973 | |
| 5974 | // If anyone adds fields here, ObjCObjectType::getProtocolStorage() |
| 5975 | // will need to be modified. |
| 5976 | |
| 5977 | ObjCObjectTypeImpl(QualType Canonical, QualType Base, |
| 5978 | ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs, |
| 5979 | ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, |
| 5980 | bool isKindOf) |
| 5981 | : ObjCObjectType(Canonical, Base, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf) {} |
| 5982 | |
| 5983 | public: |
| 5984 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID); |
| 5985 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, |
| 5986 | QualType Base, |
| 5987 | ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs, |
| 5988 | ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, |
| 5989 | bool isKindOf); |
| 5990 | }; |
| 5991 | |
| 5992 | inline QualType *ObjCObjectType::getTypeArgStorage() { |
| 5993 | return reinterpret_cast<QualType *>(static_cast<ObjCObjectTypeImpl*>(this)+1); |
| 5994 | } |
| 5995 | |
| 5996 | inline ObjCProtocolDecl **ObjCObjectType::getProtocolStorageImpl() { |
| 5997 | return reinterpret_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl**>( |
| 5998 | getTypeArgStorage() + ObjCObjectTypeBits.NumTypeArgs); |
| 5999 | } |
| 6000 | |
| 6001 | inline ObjCProtocolDecl **ObjCTypeParamType::getProtocolStorageImpl() { |
| 6002 | return reinterpret_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl**>( |
| 6003 | static_cast<ObjCTypeParamType*>(this)+1); |
| 6004 | } |
| 6005 | |
| 6006 | /// Interfaces are the core concept in Objective-C for object oriented design. |
| 6007 | /// They basically correspond to C++ classes. There are two kinds of interface |
| 6008 | /// types: normal interfaces like `NSString`, and qualified interfaces, which |
| 6009 | /// are qualified with a protocol list like `NSString<NSCopyable, NSAmazing>`. |
| 6010 | /// |
| 6011 | /// ObjCInterfaceType guarantees the following properties when considered |
| 6012 | /// as a subtype of its superclass, ObjCObjectType: |
| 6013 | /// - There are no protocol qualifiers. To reinforce this, code which |
| 6014 | /// tries to invoke the protocol methods via an ObjCInterfaceType will |
| 6015 | /// fail to compile. |
| 6016 | /// - It is its own base type. That is, if T is an ObjCInterfaceType*, |
| 6017 | /// T->getBaseType() == QualType(T, 0). |
| 6018 | class ObjCInterfaceType : public ObjCObjectType { |
| 6019 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 6020 | friend class ASTReader; |
| 6021 | friend class ObjCInterfaceDecl; |
| 6022 | template <class T> friend class serialization::AbstractTypeReader; |
| 6023 | |
| 6024 | mutable ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl; |
| 6025 | |
| 6026 | ObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) |
| 6027 | : ObjCObjectType(Nonce_ObjCInterface), |
| 6028 | Decl(const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl*>(D)) {} |
| 6029 | |
| 6030 | public: |
| 6031 | /// Get the declaration of this interface. |
| 6032 | ObjCInterfaceDecl *getDecl() const { return Decl; } |
| 6033 | |
| 6034 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 6035 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 6036 | |
| 6037 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 6038 | return T->getTypeClass() == ObjCInterface; |
| 6039 | } |
| 6040 | |
| 6041 | // Nonsense to "hide" certain members of ObjCObjectType within this |
| 6042 | // class. People asking for protocols on an ObjCInterfaceType are |
| 6043 | // not going to get what they want: ObjCInterfaceTypes are |
| 6044 | // guaranteed to have no protocols. |
| 6045 | enum { |
| 6046 | qual_iterator, |
| 6047 | qual_begin, |
| 6048 | qual_end, |
| 6049 | getNumProtocols, |
| 6050 | getProtocol |
| 6051 | }; |
| 6052 | }; |
| 6053 | |
| 6054 | inline ObjCInterfaceDecl *ObjCObjectType::getInterface() const { |
| 6055 | QualType baseType = getBaseType(); |
| 6056 | while (const auto *ObjT = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) { |
| 6057 | if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(ObjT)) |
| 6058 | return T->getDecl(); |
| 6059 | |
| 6060 | baseType = ObjT->getBaseType(); |
| 6061 | } |
| 6062 | |
| 6063 | return nullptr; |
| 6064 | } |
| 6065 | |
| 6066 | /// Represents a pointer to an Objective C object. |
| 6067 | /// |
| 6068 | /// These are constructed from pointer declarators when the pointee type is |
| 6069 | /// an ObjCObjectType (or sugar for one). In addition, the 'id' and 'Class' |
| 6070 | /// types are typedefs for these, and the protocol-qualified types 'id<P>' |
| 6071 | /// and 'Class<P>' are translated into these. |
| 6072 | /// |
| 6073 | /// Pointers to pointers to Objective C objects are still PointerTypes; |
| 6074 | /// only the first level of pointer gets it own type implementation. |
| 6075 | class ObjCObjectPointerType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 6076 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 6077 | |
| 6078 | QualType PointeeType; |
| 6079 | |
| 6080 | ObjCObjectPointerType(QualType Canonical, QualType Pointee) |
| 6081 | : Type(ObjCObjectPointer, Canonical, Pointee->getDependence()), |
| 6082 | PointeeType(Pointee) {} |
| 6083 | |
| 6084 | public: |
| 6085 | /// Gets the type pointed to by this ObjC pointer. |
| 6086 | /// The result will always be an ObjCObjectType or sugar thereof. |
| 6087 | QualType getPointeeType() const { return PointeeType; } |
| 6088 | |
| 6089 | /// Gets the type pointed to by this ObjC pointer. Always returns non-null. |
| 6090 | /// |
| 6091 | /// This method is equivalent to getPointeeType() except that |
| 6092 | /// it discards any typedefs (or other sugar) between this |
| 6093 | /// type and the "outermost" object type. So for: |
| 6094 | /// \code |
| 6095 | /// \@class A; \@protocol P; \@protocol Q; |
| 6096 | /// typedef A<P> AP; |
| 6097 | /// typedef A A1; |
| 6098 | /// typedef A1<P> A1P; |
| 6099 | /// typedef A1P<Q> A1PQ; |
| 6100 | /// \endcode |
| 6101 | /// For 'A*', getObjectType() will return 'A'. |
| 6102 | /// For 'A<P>*', getObjectType() will return 'A<P>'. |
| 6103 | /// For 'AP*', getObjectType() will return 'A<P>'. |
| 6104 | /// For 'A1*', getObjectType() will return 'A'. |
| 6105 | /// For 'A1<P>*', getObjectType() will return 'A1<P>'. |
| 6106 | /// For 'A1P*', getObjectType() will return 'A1<P>'. |
| 6107 | /// For 'A1PQ*', getObjectType() will return 'A1<Q>', because |
| 6108 | /// adding protocols to a protocol-qualified base discards the |
| 6109 | /// old qualifiers (for now). But if it didn't, getObjectType() |
| 6110 | /// would return 'A1P<Q>' (and we'd have to make iterating over |
| 6111 | /// qualifiers more complicated). |
| 6112 | const ObjCObjectType *getObjectType() const { |
| 6113 | return PointeeType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>(); |
| 6114 | } |
| 6115 | |
| 6116 | /// If this pointer points to an Objective C |
| 6117 | /// \@interface type, gets the type for that interface. Any protocol |
| 6118 | /// qualifiers on the interface are ignored. |
| 6119 | /// |
| 6120 | /// \return null if the base type for this pointer is 'id' or 'Class' |
| 6121 | const ObjCInterfaceType *getInterfaceType() const; |
| 6122 | |
| 6123 | /// If this pointer points to an Objective \@interface |
| 6124 | /// type, gets the declaration for that interface. |
| 6125 | /// |
| 6126 | /// \return null if the base type for this pointer is 'id' or 'Class' |
| 6127 | ObjCInterfaceDecl *getInterfaceDecl() const { |
| 6128 | return getObjectType()->getInterface(); |
| 6129 | } |
| 6130 | |
| 6131 | /// True if this is equivalent to the 'id' type, i.e. if |
| 6132 | /// its object type is the primitive 'id' type with no protocols. |
| 6133 | bool isObjCIdType() const { |
| 6134 | return getObjectType()->isObjCUnqualifiedId(); |
| 6135 | } |
| 6136 | |
| 6137 | /// True if this is equivalent to the 'Class' type, |
| 6138 | /// i.e. if its object tive is the primitive 'Class' type with no protocols. |
| 6139 | bool isObjCClassType() const { |
| 6140 | return getObjectType()->isObjCUnqualifiedClass(); |
| 6141 | } |
| 6142 | |
| 6143 | /// True if this is equivalent to the 'id' or 'Class' type, |
| 6144 | bool isObjCIdOrClassType() const { |
| 6145 | return getObjectType()->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass(); |
| 6146 | } |
| 6147 | |
| 6148 | /// True if this is equivalent to 'id<P>' for some non-empty set of |
| 6149 | /// protocols. |
| 6150 | bool isObjCQualifiedIdType() const { |
| 6151 | return getObjectType()->isObjCQualifiedId(); |
| 6152 | } |
| 6153 | |
| 6154 | /// True if this is equivalent to 'Class<P>' for some non-empty set of |
| 6155 | /// protocols. |
| 6156 | bool isObjCQualifiedClassType() const { |
| 6157 | return getObjectType()->isObjCQualifiedClass(); |
| 6158 | } |
| 6159 | |
| 6160 | /// Whether this is a "__kindof" type. |
| 6161 | bool isKindOfType() const { return getObjectType()->isKindOfType(); } |
| 6162 | |
| 6163 | /// Whether this type is specialized, meaning that it has type arguments. |
| 6164 | bool isSpecialized() const { return getObjectType()->isSpecialized(); } |
| 6165 | |
| 6166 | /// Whether this type is specialized, meaning that it has type arguments. |
| 6167 | bool isSpecializedAsWritten() const { |
| 6168 | return getObjectType()->isSpecializedAsWritten(); |
| 6169 | } |
| 6170 | |
| 6171 | /// Whether this type is unspecialized, meaning that is has no type arguments. |
| 6172 | bool isUnspecialized() const { return getObjectType()->isUnspecialized(); } |
| 6173 | |
| 6174 | /// Determine whether this object type is "unspecialized" as |
| 6175 | /// written, meaning that it has no type arguments. |
| 6176 | bool isUnspecializedAsWritten() const { return !isSpecializedAsWritten(); } |
| 6177 | |
| 6178 | /// Retrieve the type arguments for this type. |
| 6179 | ArrayRef<QualType> getTypeArgs() const { |
| 6180 | return getObjectType()->getTypeArgs(); |
| 6181 | } |
| 6182 | |
| 6183 | /// Retrieve the type arguments for this type. |
| 6184 | ArrayRef<QualType> getTypeArgsAsWritten() const { |
| 6185 | return getObjectType()->getTypeArgsAsWritten(); |
| 6186 | } |
| 6187 | |
| 6188 | /// An iterator over the qualifiers on the object type. Provided |
| 6189 | /// for convenience. This will always iterate over the full set of |
| 6190 | /// protocols on a type, not just those provided directly. |
| 6191 | using qual_iterator = ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator; |
| 6192 | using qual_range = llvm::iterator_range<qual_iterator>; |
| 6193 | |
| 6194 | qual_range quals() const { return qual_range(qual_begin(), qual_end()); } |
| 6195 | |
| 6196 | qual_iterator qual_begin() const { |
| 6197 | return getObjectType()->qual_begin(); |
| 6198 | } |
| 6199 | |
| 6200 | qual_iterator qual_end() const { |
| 6201 | return getObjectType()->qual_end(); |
| 6202 | } |
| 6203 | |
| 6204 | bool qual_empty() const { return getObjectType()->qual_empty(); } |
| 6205 | |
| 6206 | /// Return the number of qualifying protocols on the object type. |
| 6207 | unsigned getNumProtocols() const { |
| 6208 | return getObjectType()->getNumProtocols(); |
| 6209 | } |
| 6210 | |
| 6211 | /// Retrieve a qualifying protocol by index on the object type. |
| 6212 | ObjCProtocolDecl *getProtocol(unsigned I) const { |
| 6213 | return getObjectType()->getProtocol(I); |
| 6214 | } |
| 6215 | |
| 6216 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 6217 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 6218 | |
| 6219 | /// Retrieve the type of the superclass of this object pointer type. |
| 6220 | /// |
| 6221 | /// This operation substitutes any type arguments into the |
| 6222 | /// superclass of the current class type, potentially producing a |
| 6223 | /// pointer to a specialization of the superclass type. Produces a |
| 6224 | /// null type if there is no superclass. |
| 6225 | QualType getSuperClassType() const; |
| 6226 | |
| 6227 | /// Strip off the Objective-C "kindof" type and (with it) any |
| 6228 | /// protocol qualifiers. |
| 6229 | const ObjCObjectPointerType *stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals( |
| 6230 | const ASTContext &ctx) const; |
| 6231 | |
| 6232 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 6233 | Profile(ID, getPointeeType()); |
| 6234 | } |
| 6235 | |
| 6236 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType T) { |
| 6237 | ID.AddPointer(T.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 6238 | } |
| 6239 | |
| 6240 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 6241 | return T->getTypeClass() == ObjCObjectPointer; |
| 6242 | } |
| 6243 | }; |
| 6244 | |
| 6245 | class AtomicType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 6246 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 6247 | |
| 6248 | QualType ValueType; |
| 6249 | |
| 6250 | AtomicType(QualType ValTy, QualType Canonical) |
| 6251 | : Type(Atomic, Canonical, ValTy->getDependence()), ValueType(ValTy) {} |
| 6252 | |
| 6253 | public: |
| 6254 | /// Gets the type contained by this atomic type, i.e. |
| 6255 | /// the type returned by performing an atomic load of this atomic type. |
| 6256 | QualType getValueType() const { return ValueType; } |
| 6257 | |
| 6258 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 6259 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 6260 | |
| 6261 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 6262 | Profile(ID, getValueType()); |
| 6263 | } |
| 6264 | |
| 6265 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType T) { |
| 6266 | ID.AddPointer(T.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 6267 | } |
| 6268 | |
| 6269 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 6270 | return T->getTypeClass() == Atomic; |
| 6271 | } |
| 6272 | }; |
| 6273 | |
| 6274 | /// PipeType - OpenCL20. |
| 6275 | class PipeType : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 6276 | friend class ASTContext; // ASTContext creates these. |
| 6277 | |
| 6278 | QualType ElementType; |
| 6279 | bool isRead; |
| 6280 | |
| 6281 | PipeType(QualType elemType, QualType CanonicalPtr, bool isRead) |
| 6282 | : Type(Pipe, CanonicalPtr, elemType->getDependence()), |
| 6283 | ElementType(elemType), isRead(isRead) {} |
| 6284 | |
| 6285 | public: |
| 6286 | QualType getElementType() const { return ElementType; } |
| 6287 | |
| 6288 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 6289 | |
| 6290 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 6291 | |
| 6292 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 6293 | Profile(ID, getElementType(), isReadOnly()); |
| 6294 | } |
| 6295 | |
| 6296 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, QualType T, bool isRead) { |
| 6297 | ID.AddPointer(T.getAsOpaquePtr()); |
| 6298 | ID.AddBoolean(isRead); |
| 6299 | } |
| 6300 | |
| 6301 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 6302 | return T->getTypeClass() == Pipe; |
| 6303 | } |
| 6304 | |
| 6305 | bool isReadOnly() const { return isRead; } |
| 6306 | }; |
| 6307 | |
| 6308 | /// A fixed int type of a specified bitwidth. |
| 6309 | class ExtIntType final : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 6310 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 6311 | unsigned IsUnsigned : 1; |
| 6312 | unsigned NumBits : 24; |
| 6313 | |
| 6314 | protected: |
| 6315 | ExtIntType(bool isUnsigned, unsigned NumBits); |
| 6316 | |
| 6317 | public: |
| 6318 | bool isUnsigned() const { return IsUnsigned; } |
| 6319 | bool isSigned() const { return !IsUnsigned; } |
| 6320 | unsigned getNumBits() const { return NumBits; } |
| 6321 | |
| 6322 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 6323 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 6324 | |
| 6325 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 6326 | Profile(ID, isUnsigned(), getNumBits()); |
| 6327 | } |
| 6328 | |
| 6329 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, bool IsUnsigned, |
| 6330 | unsigned NumBits) { |
| 6331 | ID.AddBoolean(IsUnsigned); |
| 6332 | ID.AddInteger(NumBits); |
| 6333 | } |
| 6334 | |
| 6335 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { return T->getTypeClass() == ExtInt; } |
| 6336 | }; |
| 6337 | |
| 6338 | class DependentExtIntType final : public Type, public llvm::FoldingSetNode { |
| 6339 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 6340 | const ASTContext &Context; |
| 6341 | llvm::PointerIntPair<Expr*, 1, bool> ExprAndUnsigned; |
| 6342 | |
| 6343 | protected: |
| 6344 | DependentExtIntType(const ASTContext &Context, bool IsUnsigned, |
| 6345 | Expr *NumBits); |
| 6346 | |
| 6347 | public: |
| 6348 | bool isUnsigned() const; |
| 6349 | bool isSigned() const { return !isUnsigned(); } |
| 6350 | Expr *getNumBitsExpr() const; |
| 6351 | |
| 6352 | bool isSugared() const { return false; } |
| 6353 | QualType desugar() const { return QualType(this, 0); } |
| 6354 | |
| 6355 | void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) { |
| 6356 | Profile(ID, Context, isUnsigned(), getNumBitsExpr()); |
| 6357 | } |
| 6358 | static void Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID, const ASTContext &Context, |
| 6359 | bool IsUnsigned, Expr *NumBitsExpr); |
| 6360 | |
| 6361 | static bool classof(const Type *T) { |
| 6362 | return T->getTypeClass() == DependentExtInt; |
| 6363 | } |
| 6364 | }; |
| 6365 | |
| 6366 | /// A qualifier set is used to build a set of qualifiers. |
| 6367 | class QualifierCollector : public Qualifiers { |
| 6368 | public: |
| 6369 | QualifierCollector(Qualifiers Qs = Qualifiers()) : Qualifiers(Qs) {} |
| 6370 | |
| 6371 | /// Collect any qualifiers on the given type and return an |
| 6372 | /// unqualified type. The qualifiers are assumed to be consistent |
| 6373 | /// with those already in the type. |
| 6374 | const Type *strip(QualType type) { |
| 6375 | addFastQualifiers(type.getLocalFastQualifiers()); |
| 6376 | if (!type.hasLocalNonFastQualifiers()) |
| 6377 | return type.getTypePtrUnsafe(); |
| 6378 | |
| 6379 | const ExtQuals *extQuals = type.getExtQualsUnsafe(); |
| 6380 | addConsistentQualifiers(extQuals->getQualifiers()); |
| 6381 | return extQuals->getBaseType(); |
| 6382 | } |
| 6383 | |
| 6384 | /// Apply the collected qualifiers to the given type. |
| 6385 | QualType apply(const ASTContext &Context, QualType QT) const; |
| 6386 | |
| 6387 | /// Apply the collected qualifiers to the given type. |
| 6388 | QualType apply(const ASTContext &Context, const Type* T) const; |
| 6389 | }; |
| 6390 | |
| 6391 | /// A container of type source information. |
| 6392 | /// |
| 6393 | /// A client can read the relevant info using TypeLoc wrappers, e.g: |
| 6394 | /// @code |
| 6395 | /// TypeLoc TL = TypeSourceInfo->getTypeLoc(); |
| 6396 | /// TL.getBeginLoc().print(OS, SrcMgr); |
| 6397 | /// @endcode |
| 6398 | class alignas(8) TypeSourceInfo { |
| 6399 | // Contains a memory block after the class, used for type source information, |
| 6400 | // allocated by ASTContext. |
| 6401 | friend class ASTContext; |
| 6402 | |
| 6403 | QualType Ty; |
| 6404 | |
| 6405 | TypeSourceInfo(QualType ty) : Ty(ty) {} |
| 6406 | |
| 6407 | public: |
| 6408 | /// Return the type wrapped by this type source info. |
| 6409 | QualType getType() const { return Ty; } |
| 6410 | |
| 6411 | /// Return the TypeLoc wrapper for the type source info. |
| 6412 | TypeLoc getTypeLoc() const; // implemented in TypeLoc.h |
| 6413 | |
| 6414 | /// Override the type stored in this TypeSourceInfo. Use with caution! |
| 6415 | void overrideType(QualType T) { Ty = T; } |
| 6416 | }; |
| 6417 | |
| 6418 | // Inline function definitions. |
| 6419 | |
| 6420 | inline SplitQualType SplitQualType::getSingleStepDesugaredType() const { |
| 6421 | SplitQualType desugar = |
| 6422 | Ty->getLocallyUnqualifiedSingleStepDesugaredType().split(); |
| 6423 | desugar.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(Quals); |
| 6424 | return desugar; |
| 6425 | } |
| 6426 | |
| 6427 | inline const Type *QualType::getTypePtr() const { |
| 6428 | return getCommonPtr()->BaseType; |
| 6429 | } |
| 6430 | |
| 6431 | inline const Type *QualType::getTypePtrOrNull() const { |
| 6432 | return (isNull() ? nullptr : getCommonPtr()->BaseType); |
| 6433 | } |
| 6434 | |
| 6435 | inline SplitQualType QualType::split() const { |
| 6436 | if (!hasLocalNonFastQualifiers()) |
| 6437 | return SplitQualType(getTypePtrUnsafe(), |
| 6438 | Qualifiers::fromFastMask(getLocalFastQualifiers())); |
| 6439 | |
| 6440 | const ExtQuals *eq = getExtQualsUnsafe(); |
| 6441 | Qualifiers qs = eq->getQualifiers(); |
| 6442 | qs.addFastQualifiers(getLocalFastQualifiers()); |
| 6443 | return SplitQualType(eq->getBaseType(), qs); |
| 6444 | } |
| 6445 | |
| 6446 | inline Qualifiers QualType::getLocalQualifiers() const { |
| 6447 | Qualifiers Quals; |
| 6448 | if (hasLocalNonFastQualifiers()) |
| 6449 | Quals = getExtQualsUnsafe()->getQualifiers(); |
| 6450 | Quals.addFastQualifiers(getLocalFastQualifiers()); |
| 6451 | return Quals; |
| 6452 | } |
| 6453 | |
| 6454 | inline Qualifiers QualType::getQualifiers() const { |
| 6455 | Qualifiers quals = getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.getLocalQualifiers(); |
| 6456 | quals.addFastQualifiers(getLocalFastQualifiers()); |
| 6457 | return quals; |
| 6458 | } |
| 6459 | |
| 6460 | inline unsigned QualType::getCVRQualifiers() const { |
| 6461 | unsigned cvr = getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.getLocalCVRQualifiers(); |
| 6462 | cvr |= getLocalCVRQualifiers(); |
| 6463 | return cvr; |
| 6464 | } |
| 6465 | |
| 6466 | inline QualType QualType::getCanonicalType() const { |
| 6467 | QualType canon = getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType; |
| 6468 | return canon.withFastQualifiers(getLocalFastQualifiers()); |
| 6469 | } |
| 6470 | |
| 6471 | inline bool QualType::isCanonical() const { |
| 6472 | return getTypePtr()->isCanonicalUnqualified(); |
| 6473 | } |
| 6474 | |
| 6475 | inline bool QualType::isCanonicalAsParam() const { |
| 6476 | if (!isCanonical()) return false; |
| 6477 | if (hasLocalQualifiers()) return false; |
| 6478 | |
| 6479 | const Type *T = getTypePtr(); |
| 6480 | if (T->isVariablyModifiedType() && T->hasSizedVLAType()) |
| 6481 | return false; |
| 6482 | |
| 6483 | return !isa<FunctionType>(T) && !isa<ArrayType>(T); |
| 6484 | } |
| 6485 | |
| 6486 | inline bool QualType::isConstQualified() const { |
| 6487 | return isLocalConstQualified() || |
| 6488 | getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.isLocalConstQualified(); |
| 6489 | } |
| 6490 | |
| 6491 | inline bool QualType::isRestrictQualified() const { |
| 6492 | return isLocalRestrictQualified() || |
| 6493 | getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.isLocalRestrictQualified(); |
| 6494 | } |
| 6495 | |
| 6496 | |
| 6497 | inline bool QualType::isVolatileQualified() const { |
| 6498 | return isLocalVolatileQualified() || |
| 6499 | getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.isLocalVolatileQualified(); |
| 6500 | } |
| 6501 | |
| 6502 | inline bool QualType::hasQualifiers() const { |
| 6503 | return hasLocalQualifiers() || |
| 6504 | getCommonPtr()->CanonicalType.hasLocalQualifiers(); |
| 6505 | } |
| 6506 | |
| 6507 | inline QualType QualType::getUnqualifiedType() const { |
| 6508 | if (!getTypePtr()->getCanonicalTypeInternal().hasLocalQualifiers()) |
| 6509 | return QualType(getTypePtr(), 0); |
| 6510 | |
| 6511 | return QualType(getSplitUnqualifiedTypeImpl(*this).Ty, 0); |
| 6512 | } |
| 6513 | |
| 6514 | inline SplitQualType QualType::getSplitUnqualifiedType() const { |
| 6515 | if (!getTypePtr()->getCanonicalTypeInternal().hasLocalQualifiers()) |
| 6516 | return split(); |
| 6517 | |
| 6518 | return getSplitUnqualifiedTypeImpl(*this); |
| 6519 | } |
| 6520 | |
| 6521 | inline void QualType::removeLocalConst() { |
| 6522 | removeLocalFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Const); |
| 6523 | } |
| 6524 | |
| 6525 | inline void QualType::removeLocalRestrict() { |
| 6526 | removeLocalFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Restrict); |
| 6527 | } |
| 6528 | |
| 6529 | inline void QualType::removeLocalVolatile() { |
| 6530 | removeLocalFastQualifiers(Qualifiers::Volatile); |
| 6531 | } |
| 6532 | |
| 6533 | inline void QualType::removeLocalCVRQualifiers(unsigned Mask) { |
| 6534 | assert(!(Mask & ~Qualifiers::CVRMask) && "mask has non-CVR bits")((void)0); |
| 6535 | static_assert((int)Qualifiers::CVRMask == (int)Qualifiers::FastMask, |
| 6536 | "Fast bits differ from CVR bits!"); |
| 6537 | |
| 6538 | // Fast path: we don't need to touch the slow qualifiers. |
| 6539 | removeLocalFastQualifiers(Mask); |
| 6540 | } |
| 6541 | |
| 6542 | /// Check if this type has any address space qualifier. |
| 6543 | inline bool QualType::hasAddressSpace() const { |
| 6544 | return getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace(); |
| 6545 | } |
| 6546 | |
| 6547 | /// Return the address space of this type. |
| 6548 | inline LangAS QualType::getAddressSpace() const { |
| 6549 | return getQualifiers().getAddressSpace(); |
| 6550 | } |
| 6551 | |
| 6552 | /// Return the gc attribute of this type. |
| 6553 | inline Qualifiers::GC QualType::getObjCGCAttr() const { |
| 6554 | return getQualifiers().getObjCGCAttr(); |
| 6555 | } |
| 6556 | |
| 6557 | inline bool QualType::hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() const { |
| 6558 | if (auto *RD = getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->getAsRecordDecl()) |
| 6559 | return hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(RD); |
| 6560 | return false; |
| 6561 | } |
| 6562 | |
| 6563 | inline bool QualType::hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() const { |
| 6564 | if (auto *RD = getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->getAsRecordDecl()) |
| 6565 | return hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(RD); |
| 6566 | return false; |
| 6567 | } |
| 6568 | |
| 6569 | inline bool QualType::hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() const { |
| 6570 | if (auto *RD = getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->getAsRecordDecl()) |
| 6571 | return hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(RD); |
| 6572 | return false; |
| 6573 | } |
| 6574 | |
| 6575 | inline FunctionType::ExtInfo getFunctionExtInfo(const Type &t) { |
| 6576 | if (const auto *PT = t.getAs<PointerType>()) { |
| 6577 | if (const auto *FT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()) |
| 6578 | return FT->getExtInfo(); |
| 6579 | } else if (const auto *FT = t.getAs<FunctionType>()) |
| 6580 | return FT->getExtInfo(); |
| 6581 | |
| 6582 | return FunctionType::ExtInfo(); |
| 6583 | } |
| 6584 | |
| 6585 | inline FunctionType::ExtInfo getFunctionExtInfo(QualType t) { |
| 6586 | return getFunctionExtInfo(*t); |
| 6587 | } |
| 6588 | |
| 6589 | /// Determine whether this type is more |
| 6590 | /// qualified than the Other type. For example, "const volatile int" |
| 6591 | /// is more qualified than "const int", "volatile int", and |
| 6592 | /// "int". However, it is not more qualified than "const volatile |
| 6593 | /// int". |
| 6594 | inline bool QualType::isMoreQualifiedThan(QualType other) const { |
| 6595 | Qualifiers MyQuals = getQualifiers(); |
| 6596 | Qualifiers OtherQuals = other.getQualifiers(); |
| 6597 | return (MyQuals != OtherQuals && MyQuals.compatiblyIncludes(OtherQuals)); |
| 6598 | } |
| 6599 | |
| 6600 | /// Determine whether this type is at last |
| 6601 | /// as qualified as the Other type. For example, "const volatile |
| 6602 | /// int" is at least as qualified as "const int", "volatile int", |
| 6603 | /// "int", and "const volatile int". |
| 6604 | inline bool QualType::isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(QualType other) const { |
| 6605 | Qualifiers OtherQuals = other.getQualifiers(); |
| 6606 | |
| 6607 | // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is a void. |
| 6608 | if (getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType()) |
| 6609 | OtherQuals.removeUnaligned(); |
| 6610 | |
| 6611 | return getQualifiers().compatiblyIncludes(OtherQuals); |
| 6612 | } |
| 6613 | |
| 6614 | /// If Type is a reference type (e.g., const |
| 6615 | /// int&), returns the type that the reference refers to ("const |
| 6616 | /// int"). Otherwise, returns the type itself. This routine is used |
| 6617 | /// throughout Sema to implement C++ 5p6: |
| 6618 | /// |
| 6619 | /// If an expression initially has the type "reference to T" (8.3.2, |
| 6620 | /// 8.5.3), the type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further |
| 6621 | /// analysis, the expression designates the object or function |
| 6622 | /// denoted by the reference, and the expression is an lvalue. |
| 6623 | inline QualType QualType::getNonReferenceType() const { |
| 6624 | if (const auto *RefType = (*this)->getAs<ReferenceType>()) |
| 6625 | return RefType->getPointeeType(); |
| 6626 | else |
| 6627 | return *this; |
| 6628 | } |
| 6629 | |
| 6630 | inline bool QualType::isCForbiddenLValueType() const { |
| 6631 | return ((getTypePtr()->isVoidType() && !hasQualifiers()) || |
| 6632 | getTypePtr()->isFunctionType()); |
| 6633 | } |
| 6634 | |
| 6635 | /// Tests whether the type is categorized as a fundamental type. |
| 6636 | /// |
| 6637 | /// \returns True for types specified in C++0x [basic.fundamental]. |
| 6638 | inline bool Type::isFundamentalType() const { |
| 6639 | return isVoidType() || |
| 6640 | isNullPtrType() || |
| 6641 | // FIXME: It's really annoying that we don't have an |
| 6642 | // 'isArithmeticType()' which agrees with the standard definition. |
| 6643 | (isArithmeticType() && !isEnumeralType()); |
| 6644 | } |
| 6645 | |
| 6646 | /// Tests whether the type is categorized as a compound type. |
| 6647 | /// |
| 6648 | /// \returns True for types specified in C++0x [basic.compound]. |
| 6649 | inline bool Type::isCompoundType() const { |
| 6650 | // C++0x [basic.compound]p1: |
| 6651 | // Compound types can be constructed in the following ways: |
| 6652 | // -- arrays of objects of a given type [...]; |
| 6653 | return isArrayType() || |
| 6654 | // -- functions, which have parameters of given types [...]; |
| 6655 | isFunctionType() || |
| 6656 | // -- pointers to void or objects or functions [...]; |
| 6657 | isPointerType() || |
| 6658 | // -- references to objects or functions of a given type. [...] |
| 6659 | isReferenceType() || |
| 6660 | // -- classes containing a sequence of objects of various types, [...]; |
| 6661 | isRecordType() || |
| 6662 | // -- unions, which are classes capable of containing objects of different |
| 6663 | // types at different times; |
| 6664 | isUnionType() || |
| 6665 | // -- enumerations, which comprise a set of named constant values. [...]; |
| 6666 | isEnumeralType() || |
| 6667 | // -- pointers to non-static class members, [...]. |
| 6668 | isMemberPointerType(); |
| 6669 | } |
| 6670 | |
| 6671 | inline bool Type::isFunctionType() const { |
| 6672 | return isa<FunctionType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6673 | } |
| 6674 | |
| 6675 | inline bool Type::isPointerType() const { |
| 6676 | return isa<PointerType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6677 | } |
| 6678 | |
| 6679 | inline bool Type::isAnyPointerType() const { |
| 6680 | return isPointerType() || isObjCObjectPointerType(); |
| 6681 | } |
| 6682 | |
| 6683 | inline bool Type::isBlockPointerType() const { |
| 6684 | return isa<BlockPointerType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6685 | } |
| 6686 | |
| 6687 | inline bool Type::isReferenceType() const { |
| 6688 | return isa<ReferenceType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6689 | } |
| 6690 | |
| 6691 | inline bool Type::isLValueReferenceType() const { |
| 6692 | return isa<LValueReferenceType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6693 | } |
| 6694 | |
| 6695 | inline bool Type::isRValueReferenceType() const { |
| 6696 | return isa<RValueReferenceType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6697 | } |
| 6698 | |
| 6699 | inline bool Type::isObjectPointerType() const { |
| 6700 | // Note: an "object pointer type" is not the same thing as a pointer to an |
| 6701 | // object type; rather, it is a pointer to an object type or a pointer to cv |
| 6702 | // void. |
| 6703 | if (const auto *T = getAs<PointerType>()) |
| 6704 | return !T->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType(); |
| 6705 | else |
| 6706 | return false; |
| 6707 | } |
| 6708 | |
| 6709 | inline bool Type::isFunctionPointerType() const { |
| 6710 | if (const auto *T = getAs<PointerType>()) |
| 6711 | return T->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType(); |
| 6712 | else |
| 6713 | return false; |
| 6714 | } |
| 6715 | |
| 6716 | inline bool Type::isFunctionReferenceType() const { |
| 6717 | if (const auto *T = getAs<ReferenceType>()) |
| 6718 | return T->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType(); |
| 6719 | else |
| 6720 | return false; |
| 6721 | } |
| 6722 | |
| 6723 | inline bool Type::isMemberPointerType() const { |
| 6724 | return isa<MemberPointerType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6725 | } |
| 6726 | |
| 6727 | inline bool Type::isMemberFunctionPointerType() const { |
| 6728 | if (const auto *T = getAs<MemberPointerType>()) |
| 6729 | return T->isMemberFunctionPointer(); |
| 6730 | else |
| 6731 | return false; |
| 6732 | } |
| 6733 | |
| 6734 | inline bool Type::isMemberDataPointerType() const { |
| 6735 | if (const auto *T = getAs<MemberPointerType>()) |
| 6736 | return T->isMemberDataPointer(); |
| 6737 | else |
| 6738 | return false; |
| 6739 | } |
| 6740 | |
| 6741 | inline bool Type::isArrayType() const { |
| 6742 | return isa<ArrayType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6743 | } |
| 6744 | |
| 6745 | inline bool Type::isConstantArrayType() const { |
| 6746 | return isa<ConstantArrayType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6747 | } |
| 6748 | |
| 6749 | inline bool Type::isIncompleteArrayType() const { |
| 6750 | return isa<IncompleteArrayType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6751 | } |
| 6752 | |
| 6753 | inline bool Type::isVariableArrayType() const { |
| 6754 | return isa<VariableArrayType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6755 | } |
| 6756 | |
| 6757 | inline bool Type::isDependentSizedArrayType() const { |
| 6758 | return isa<DependentSizedArrayType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6759 | } |
| 6760 | |
| 6761 | inline bool Type::isBuiltinType() const { |
| 6762 | return isa<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6763 | } |
| 6764 | |
| 6765 | inline bool Type::isRecordType() const { |
| 6766 | return isa<RecordType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6767 | } |
| 6768 | |
| 6769 | inline bool Type::isEnumeralType() const { |
| 6770 | return isa<EnumType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6771 | } |
| 6772 | |
| 6773 | inline bool Type::isAnyComplexType() const { |
| 6774 | return isa<ComplexType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6775 | } |
| 6776 | |
| 6777 | inline bool Type::isVectorType() const { |
| 6778 | return isa<VectorType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6779 | } |
| 6780 | |
| 6781 | inline bool Type::isExtVectorType() const { |
| 6782 | return isa<ExtVectorType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6783 | } |
| 6784 | |
| 6785 | inline bool Type::isMatrixType() const { |
| 6786 | return isa<MatrixType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6787 | } |
| 6788 | |
| 6789 | inline bool Type::isConstantMatrixType() const { |
| 6790 | return isa<ConstantMatrixType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6791 | } |
| 6792 | |
| 6793 | inline bool Type::isDependentAddressSpaceType() const { |
| 6794 | return isa<DependentAddressSpaceType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6795 | } |
| 6796 | |
| 6797 | inline bool Type::isObjCObjectPointerType() const { |
| 6798 | return isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6799 | } |
| 6800 | |
| 6801 | inline bool Type::isObjCObjectType() const { |
| 6802 | return isa<ObjCObjectType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6803 | } |
| 6804 | |
| 6805 | inline bool Type::isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() const { |
| 6806 | return isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(CanonicalType) || |
| 6807 | isa<ObjCObjectType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6808 | } |
| 6809 | |
| 6810 | inline bool Type::isAtomicType() const { |
| 6811 | return isa<AtomicType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6812 | } |
| 6813 | |
| 6814 | inline bool Type::isUndeducedAutoType() const { |
| 6815 | return isa<AutoType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6816 | } |
| 6817 | |
| 6818 | inline bool Type::isObjCQualifiedIdType() const { |
| 6819 | if (const auto *OPT = getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) |
| 6820 | return OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType(); |
| 6821 | return false; |
| 6822 | } |
| 6823 | |
| 6824 | inline bool Type::isObjCQualifiedClassType() const { |
| 6825 | if (const auto *OPT = getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) |
| 6826 | return OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType(); |
| 6827 | return false; |
| 6828 | } |
| 6829 | |
| 6830 | inline bool Type::isObjCIdType() const { |
| 6831 | if (const auto *OPT = getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) |
| 6832 | return OPT->isObjCIdType(); |
| 6833 | return false; |
| 6834 | } |
| 6835 | |
| 6836 | inline bool Type::isObjCClassType() const { |
| 6837 | if (const auto *OPT = getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) |
| 6838 | return OPT->isObjCClassType(); |
| 6839 | return false; |
| 6840 | } |
| 6841 | |
| 6842 | inline bool Type::isObjCSelType() const { |
| 6843 | if (const auto *OPT = getAs<PointerType>()) |
| 6844 | return OPT->getPointeeType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCSel); |
| 6845 | return false; |
| 6846 | } |
| 6847 | |
| 6848 | inline bool Type::isObjCBuiltinType() const { |
| 6849 | return isObjCIdType() || isObjCClassType() || isObjCSelType(); |
| 6850 | } |
| 6851 | |
| 6852 | inline bool Type::isDecltypeType() const { |
| 6853 | return isa<DecltypeType>(this); |
| 6854 | } |
| 6855 | |
| 6856 | #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ |
| 6857 | inline bool Type::is##Id##Type() const { \ |
| 6858 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Id); \ |
| 6859 | } |
| 6860 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" |
| 6861 | |
| 6862 | inline bool Type::isSamplerT() const { |
| 6863 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::OCLSampler); |
| 6864 | } |
| 6865 | |
| 6866 | inline bool Type::isEventT() const { |
| 6867 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::OCLEvent); |
| 6868 | } |
| 6869 | |
| 6870 | inline bool Type::isClkEventT() const { |
| 6871 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent); |
| 6872 | } |
| 6873 | |
| 6874 | inline bool Type::isQueueT() const { |
| 6875 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::OCLQueue); |
| 6876 | } |
| 6877 | |
| 6878 | inline bool Type::isReserveIDT() const { |
| 6879 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::OCLReserveID); |
| 6880 | } |
| 6881 | |
| 6882 | inline bool Type::isImageType() const { |
| 6883 | #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) is##Id##Type() || |
| 6884 | return |
| 6885 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" |
| 6886 | false; // end boolean or operation |
| 6887 | } |
| 6888 | |
| 6889 | inline bool Type::isPipeType() const { |
| 6890 | return isa<PipeType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6891 | } |
| 6892 | |
| 6893 | inline bool Type::isExtIntType() const { |
| 6894 | return isa<ExtIntType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6895 | } |
| 6896 | |
| 6897 | #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \ |
| 6898 | inline bool Type::is##Id##Type() const { \ |
| 6899 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Id); \ |
| 6900 | } |
| 6901 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" |
| 6902 | |
| 6903 | inline bool Type::isOCLIntelSubgroupAVCType() const { |
| 6904 | #define INTEL_SUBGROUP_AVC_TYPE(ExtType, Id) \ |
| 6905 | isOCLIntelSubgroupAVC##Id##Type() || |
| 6906 | return |
| 6907 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" |
| 6908 | false; // end of boolean or operation |
| 6909 | } |
| 6910 | |
| 6911 | inline bool Type::isOCLExtOpaqueType() const { |
| 6912 | #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) is##Id##Type() || |
| 6913 | return |
| 6914 | #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" |
| 6915 | false; // end of boolean or operation |
| 6916 | } |
| 6917 | |
| 6918 | inline bool Type::isOpenCLSpecificType() const { |
| 6919 | return isSamplerT() || isEventT() || isImageType() || isClkEventT() || |
| 6920 | isQueueT() || isReserveIDT() || isPipeType() || isOCLExtOpaqueType(); |
| 6921 | } |
| 6922 | |
| 6923 | inline bool Type::isTemplateTypeParmType() const { |
| 6924 | return isa<TemplateTypeParmType>(CanonicalType); |
| 6925 | } |
| 6926 | |
| 6927 | inline bool Type::isSpecificBuiltinType(unsigned K) const { |
| 6928 | if (const BuiltinType *BT = getAs<BuiltinType>()) { |
| 6929 | return BT->getKind() == static_cast<BuiltinType::Kind>(K); |
| 6930 | } |
| 6931 | return false; |
| 6932 | } |
| 6933 | |
| 6934 | inline bool Type::isPlaceholderType() const { |
| 6935 | if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(this)) |
| 6936 | return BT->isPlaceholderType(); |
| 6937 | return false; |
| 6938 | } |
| 6939 | |
| 6940 | inline const BuiltinType *Type::getAsPlaceholderType() const { |
| 6941 | if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(this)) |
| 6942 | if (BT->isPlaceholderType()) |
| 6943 | return BT; |
| 6944 | return nullptr; |
| 6945 | } |
| 6946 | |
| 6947 | inline bool Type::isSpecificPlaceholderType(unsigned K) const { |
| 6948 | assert(BuiltinType::isPlaceholderTypeKind((BuiltinType::Kind) K))((void)0); |
| 6949 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(K); |
| 6950 | } |
| 6951 | |
| 6952 | inline bool Type::isNonOverloadPlaceholderType() const { |
| 6953 | if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(this)) |
| 6954 | return BT->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType(); |
| 6955 | return false; |
| 6956 | } |
| 6957 | |
| 6958 | inline bool Type::isVoidType() const { |
| 6959 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Void); |
| 6960 | } |
| 6961 | |
| 6962 | inline bool Type::isHalfType() const { |
| 6963 | // FIXME: Should we allow complex __fp16? Probably not. |
| 6964 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Half); |
| 6965 | } |
| 6966 | |
| 6967 | inline bool Type::isFloat16Type() const { |
| 6968 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float16); |
| 6969 | } |
| 6970 | |
| 6971 | inline bool Type::isBFloat16Type() const { |
| 6972 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BFloat16); |
| 6973 | } |
| 6974 | |
| 6975 | inline bool Type::isFloat128Type() const { |
| 6976 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float128); |
| 6977 | } |
| 6978 | |
| 6979 | inline bool Type::isNullPtrType() const { |
| 6980 | return isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::NullPtr); |
| 6981 | } |
| 6982 | |
| 6983 | bool IsEnumDeclComplete(EnumDecl *); |
| 6984 | bool IsEnumDeclScoped(EnumDecl *); |
| 6985 | |
| 6986 | inline bool Type::isIntegerType() const { |
| 6987 | if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType)) |
| 6988 | return BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::Bool && |
| 6989 | BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::Int128; |
| 6990 | if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(CanonicalType)) { |
| 6991 | // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types. |
| 6992 | // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types. |
| 6993 | return IsEnumDeclComplete(ET->getDecl()) && |
| 6994 | !IsEnumDeclScoped(ET->getDecl()); |
| 6995 | } |
| 6996 | return isExtIntType(); |
| 6997 | } |
| 6998 | |
| 6999 | inline bool Type::isFixedPointType() const { |
| 7000 | if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType)) { |
| 7001 | return BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::ShortAccum && |
| 7002 | BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::SatULongFract; |
| 7003 | } |
| 7004 | return false; |
| 7005 | } |
| 7006 | |
| 7007 | inline bool Type::isFixedPointOrIntegerType() const { |
| 7008 | return isFixedPointType() || isIntegerType(); |
| 7009 | } |
| 7010 | |
| 7011 | inline bool Type::isSaturatedFixedPointType() const { |
| 7012 | if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType)) { |
| 7013 | return BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::SatShortAccum && |
| 7014 | BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::SatULongFract; |
| 7015 | } |
| 7016 | return false; |
| 7017 | } |
| 7018 | |
| 7019 | inline bool Type::isUnsaturatedFixedPointType() const { |
| 7020 | return isFixedPointType() && !isSaturatedFixedPointType(); |
| 7021 | } |
| 7022 | |
| 7023 | inline bool Type::isSignedFixedPointType() const { |
| 7024 | if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType)) { |
| 7025 | return ((BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::ShortAccum && |
| 7026 | BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::LongAccum) || |
| 7027 | (BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::ShortFract && |
| 7028 | BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::LongFract) || |
| 7029 | (BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::SatShortAccum && |
| 7030 | BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::SatLongAccum) || |
| 7031 | (BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::SatShortFract && |
| 7032 | BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::SatLongFract)); |
| 7033 | } |
| 7034 | return false; |
| 7035 | } |
| 7036 | |
| 7037 | inline bool Type::isUnsignedFixedPointType() const { |
| 7038 | return isFixedPointType() && !isSignedFixedPointType(); |
| 7039 | } |
| 7040 | |
| 7041 | inline bool Type::isScalarType() const { |
| 7042 | if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType)) |
| 7043 | return BT->getKind() > BuiltinType::Void && |
| 7044 | BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::NullPtr; |
| 7045 | if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(CanonicalType)) |
| 7046 | // Enums are scalar types, but only if they are defined. Incomplete enums |
| 7047 | // are not treated as scalar types. |
| 7048 | return IsEnumDeclComplete(ET->getDecl()); |
| 7049 | return isa<PointerType>(CanonicalType) || |
| 7050 | isa<BlockPointerType>(CanonicalType) || |
| 7051 | isa<MemberPointerType>(CanonicalType) || |
| 7052 | isa<ComplexType>(CanonicalType) || |
| 7053 | isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CanonicalType) || |
| 7054 | isExtIntType(); |
| 7055 | } |
| 7056 | |
| 7057 | inline bool Type::isIntegralOrEnumerationType() const { |
| 7058 | if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType)) |
| 7059 | return BT->getKind() >= BuiltinType::Bool && |
| 7060 | BT->getKind() <= BuiltinType::Int128; |
| 7061 | |
| 7062 | // Check for a complete enum type; incomplete enum types are not properly an |
| 7063 | // enumeration type in the sense required here. |
| 7064 | if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(CanonicalType)) |
| 7065 | return IsEnumDeclComplete(ET->getDecl()); |
| 7066 | |
| 7067 | return isExtIntType(); |
| 7068 | } |
| 7069 | |
| 7070 | inline bool Type::isBooleanType() const { |
| 7071 | if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CanonicalType)) |
| 7072 | return BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Bool; |
| 7073 | return false; |
| 7074 | } |
| 7075 | |
| 7076 | inline bool Type::isUndeducedType() const { |
| 7077 | auto *DT = getContainedDeducedType(); |
| 7078 | return DT && !DT->isDeduced(); |
| 7079 | } |
| 7080 | |
| 7081 | /// Determines whether this is a type for which one can define |
| 7082 | /// an overloaded operator. |
| 7083 | inline bool Type::isOverloadableType() const { |
| 7084 | return isDependentType() || isRecordType() || isEnumeralType(); |
| 7085 | } |
| 7086 | |
| 7087 | /// Determines whether this type is written as a typedef-name. |
| 7088 | inline bool Type::isTypedefNameType() const { |
| 7089 | if (getAs<TypedefType>()) |
| 7090 | return true; |
| 7091 | if (auto *TST = getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) |
| 7092 | return TST->isTypeAlias(); |
| 7093 | return false; |
| 7094 | } |
| 7095 | |
| 7096 | /// Determines whether this type can decay to a pointer type. |
| 7097 | inline bool Type::canDecayToPointerType() const { |
| 7098 | return isFunctionType() || isArrayType(); |
| 7099 | } |
| 7100 | |
| 7101 | inline bool Type::hasPointerRepresentation() const { |
| 7102 | return (isPointerType() || isReferenceType() || isBlockPointerType() || |
| 7103 | isObjCObjectPointerType() || isNullPtrType()); |
| 7104 | } |
| 7105 | |
| 7106 | inline bool Type::hasObjCPointerRepresentation() const { |
| 7107 | return isObjCObjectPointerType(); |
| 7108 | } |
| 7109 | |
| 7110 | inline const Type *Type::getBaseElementTypeUnsafe() const { |
| 7111 | const Type *type = this; |
| 7112 | while (const ArrayType *arrayType = type->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()) |
| 7113 | type = arrayType->getElementType().getTypePtr(); |
| 7114 | return type; |
| 7115 | } |
| 7116 | |
| 7117 | inline const Type *Type::getPointeeOrArrayElementType() const { |
| 7118 | const Type *type = this; |
| 7119 | if (type->isAnyPointerType()) |
| 7120 | return type->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(); |
| 7121 | else if (type->isArrayType()) |
| 7122 | return type->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); |
| 7123 | return type; |
| 7124 | } |
| 7125 | /// Insertion operator for partial diagnostics. This allows sending adress |
| 7126 | /// spaces into a diagnostic with <<. |
| 7127 | inline const StreamingDiagnostic &operator<<(const StreamingDiagnostic &PD, |
| 7128 | LangAS AS) { |
| 7129 | PD.AddTaggedVal(static_cast<std::underlying_type_t<LangAS>>(AS), |
| 7130 | DiagnosticsEngine::ArgumentKind::ak_addrspace); |
| 7131 | return PD; |
| 7132 | } |
| 7133 | |
| 7134 | /// Insertion operator for partial diagnostics. This allows sending Qualifiers |
| 7135 | /// into a diagnostic with <<. |
| 7136 | inline const StreamingDiagnostic &operator<<(const StreamingDiagnostic &PD, |
| 7137 | Qualifiers Q) { |
| 7138 | PD.AddTaggedVal(Q.getAsOpaqueValue(), |
| 7139 | DiagnosticsEngine::ArgumentKind::ak_qual); |
| 7140 | return PD; |
| 7141 | } |
| 7142 | |
| 7143 | /// Insertion operator for partial diagnostics. This allows sending QualType's |
| 7144 | /// into a diagnostic with <<. |
| 7145 | inline const StreamingDiagnostic &operator<<(const StreamingDiagnostic &PD, |
| 7146 | QualType T) { |
| 7147 | PD.AddTaggedVal(reinterpret_cast<intptr_t>(T.getAsOpaquePtr()), |
| 7148 | DiagnosticsEngine::ak_qualtype); |
| 7149 | return PD; |
| 7150 | } |
| 7151 | |
| 7152 | // Helper class template that is used by Type::getAs to ensure that one does |
| 7153 | // not try to look through a qualified type to get to an array type. |
| 7154 | template <typename T> |
| 7155 | using TypeIsArrayType = |
| 7156 | std::integral_constant<bool, std::is_same<T, ArrayType>::value || |
| 7157 | std::is_base_of<ArrayType, T>::value>; |
| 7158 | |
| 7159 | // Member-template getAs<specific type>'. |
| 7160 | template <typename T> const T *Type::getAs() const { |
| 7161 | static_assert(!TypeIsArrayType<T>::value, |
| 7162 | "ArrayType cannot be used with getAs!"); |
| 7163 | |
| 7164 | // If this is directly a T type, return it. |
| 7165 | if (const auto *Ty = dyn_cast<T>(this)) |
| 7166 | return Ty; |
| 7167 | |
| 7168 | // If the canonical form of this type isn't the right kind, reject it. |
| 7169 | if (!isa<T>(CanonicalType)) |
| 7170 | return nullptr; |
| 7171 | |
| 7172 | // If this is a typedef for the type, strip the typedef off without |
| 7173 | // losing all typedef information. |
| 7174 | return cast<T>(getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()); |
| 7175 | } |
| 7176 | |
| 7177 | template <typename T> const T *Type::getAsAdjusted() const { |
| 7178 | static_assert(!TypeIsArrayType<T>::value, "ArrayType cannot be used with getAsAdjusted!"); |
| 7179 | |
| 7180 | // If this is directly a T type, return it. |
| 7181 | if (const auto *Ty = dyn_cast<T>(this)) |
| 7182 | return Ty; |
| 7183 | |
| 7184 | // If the canonical form of this type isn't the right kind, reject it. |
| 7185 | if (!isa<T>(CanonicalType)) |
| 7186 | return nullptr; |
| 7187 | |
| 7188 | // Strip off type adjustments that do not modify the underlying nature of the |
| 7189 | // type. |
| 7190 | const Type *Ty = this; |
| 7191 | while (Ty) { |
| 7192 | if (const auto *A = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Ty)) |
| 7193 | Ty = A->getModifiedType().getTypePtr(); |
| 7194 | else if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<ElaboratedType>(Ty)) |
| 7195 | Ty = E->desugar().getTypePtr(); |
| 7196 | else if (const auto *P = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) |
| 7197 | Ty = P->desugar().getTypePtr(); |
| 7198 | else if (const auto *A = dyn_cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)) |
| 7199 | Ty = A->desugar().getTypePtr(); |
| 7200 | else if (const auto *M = dyn_cast<MacroQualifiedType>(Ty)) |
| 7201 | Ty = M->desugar().getTypePtr(); |
| 7202 | else |
| 7203 | break; |
| 7204 | } |
| 7205 | |
| 7206 | // Just because the canonical type is correct does not mean we can use cast<>, |
| 7207 | // since we may not have stripped off all the sugar down to the base type. |
| 7208 | return dyn_cast<T>(Ty); |
| 7209 | } |
| 7210 | |
| 7211 | inline const ArrayType *Type::getAsArrayTypeUnsafe() const { |
| 7212 | // If this is directly an array type, return it. |
| 7213 | if (const auto *arr = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(this)) |
| 7214 | return arr; |
| 7215 | |
| 7216 | // If the canonical form of this type isn't the right kind, reject it. |
| 7217 | if (!isa<ArrayType>(CanonicalType)) |
| 7218 | return nullptr; |
| 7219 | |
| 7220 | // If this is a typedef for the type, strip the typedef off without |
| 7221 | // losing all typedef information. |
| 7222 | return cast<ArrayType>(getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()); |
| 7223 | } |
| 7224 | |
| 7225 | template <typename T> const T *Type::castAs() const { |
| 7226 | static_assert(!TypeIsArrayType<T>::value, |
| 7227 | "ArrayType cannot be used with castAs!"); |
| 7228 | |
| 7229 | if (const auto *ty = dyn_cast<T>(this)) return ty; |
| 7230 | assert(isa<T>(CanonicalType))((void)0); |
| 7231 | return cast<T>(getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()); |
| 7232 | } |
| 7233 | |
| 7234 | inline const ArrayType *Type::castAsArrayTypeUnsafe() const { |
| 7235 | assert(isa<ArrayType>(CanonicalType))((void)0); |
| 7236 | if (const auto *arr = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(this)) return arr; |
| 7237 | return cast<ArrayType>(getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()); |
| 7238 | } |
| 7239 | |
| 7240 | DecayedType::DecayedType(QualType OriginalType, QualType DecayedPtr, |
| 7241 | QualType CanonicalPtr) |
| 7242 | : AdjustedType(Decayed, OriginalType, DecayedPtr, CanonicalPtr) { |
| 7243 | #ifndef NDEBUG1 |
| 7244 | QualType Adjusted = getAdjustedType(); |
| 7245 | (void)AttributedType::stripOuterNullability(Adjusted); |
| 7246 | assert(isa<PointerType>(Adjusted))((void)0); |
| 7247 | #endif |
| 7248 | } |
| 7249 | |
| 7250 | QualType DecayedType::getPointeeType() const { |
| 7251 | QualType Decayed = getDecayedType(); |
| 7252 | (void)AttributedType::stripOuterNullability(Decayed); |
| 7253 | return cast<PointerType>(Decayed)->getPointeeType(); |
| 7254 | } |
| 7255 | |
| 7256 | // Get the decimal string representation of a fixed point type, represented |
| 7257 | // as a scaled integer. |
| 7258 | // TODO: At some point, we should change the arguments to instead just accept an |
| 7259 | // APFixedPoint instead of APSInt and scale. |
| 7260 | void FixedPointValueToString(SmallVectorImpl<char> &Str, llvm::APSInt Val, |
| 7261 | unsigned Scale); |
| 7262 | |
| 7263 | } // namespace clang |
| 7264 | |
| 7265 | #endif // LLVM_CLANG_AST_TYPE_H |
| 1 | //===- llvm/ADT/PointerUnion.h - Discriminated Union of 2 Ptrs --*- C++ -*-===// |
| 2 | // |
| 3 | // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. |
| 4 | // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. |
| 5 | // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception |
| 6 | // |
| 7 | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// |
| 8 | // |
| 9 | // This file defines the PointerUnion class, which is a discriminated union of |
| 10 | // pointer types. |
| 11 | // |
| 12 | //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// |
| 13 | |
| 14 | #ifndef LLVM_ADT_POINTERUNION_H |
| 15 | #define LLVM_ADT_POINTERUNION_H |
| 16 | |
| 17 | #include "llvm/ADT/DenseMapInfo.h" |
| 18 | #include "llvm/ADT/PointerIntPair.h" |
| 19 | #include "llvm/Support/PointerLikeTypeTraits.h" |
| 20 | #include <cassert> |
| 21 | #include <cstddef> |
| 22 | #include <cstdint> |
| 23 | |
| 24 | namespace llvm { |
| 25 | |
| 26 | template <typename T> struct PointerUnionTypeSelectorReturn { |
| 27 | using Return = T; |
| 28 | }; |
| 29 | |
| 30 | /// Get a type based on whether two types are the same or not. |
| 31 | /// |
| 32 | /// For: |
| 33 | /// |
| 34 | /// \code |
| 35 | /// using Ret = typename PointerUnionTypeSelector<T1, T2, EQ, NE>::Return; |
| 36 | /// \endcode |
| 37 | /// |
| 38 | /// Ret will be EQ type if T1 is same as T2 or NE type otherwise. |
| 39 | template <typename T1, typename T2, typename RET_EQ, typename RET_NE> |
| 40 | struct PointerUnionTypeSelector { |
| 41 | using Return = typename PointerUnionTypeSelectorReturn<RET_NE>::Return; |
| 42 | }; |
| 43 | |
| 44 | template <typename T, typename RET_EQ, typename RET_NE> |
| 45 | struct PointerUnionTypeSelector<T, T, RET_EQ, RET_NE> { |
| 46 | using Return = typename PointerUnionTypeSelectorReturn<RET_EQ>::Return; |
| 47 | }; |
| 48 | |
| 49 | template <typename T1, typename T2, typename RET_EQ, typename RET_NE> |
| 50 | struct PointerUnionTypeSelectorReturn< |
| 51 | PointerUnionTypeSelector<T1, T2, RET_EQ, RET_NE>> { |
| 52 | using Return = |
| 53 | typename PointerUnionTypeSelector<T1, T2, RET_EQ, RET_NE>::Return; |
| 54 | }; |
| 55 | |
| 56 | namespace pointer_union_detail { |
| 57 | /// Determine the number of bits required to store integers with values < n. |
| 58 | /// This is ceil(log2(n)). |
| 59 | constexpr int bitsRequired(unsigned n) { |
| 60 | return n > 1 ? 1 + bitsRequired((n + 1) / 2) : 0; |
| 61 | } |
| 62 | |
| 63 | template <typename... Ts> constexpr int lowBitsAvailable() { |
| 64 | return std::min<int>({PointerLikeTypeTraits<Ts>::NumLowBitsAvailable...}); |
| 65 | } |
| 66 | |
| 67 | /// Find the index of a type in a list of types. TypeIndex<T, Us...>::Index |
| 68 | /// is the index of T in Us, or sizeof...(Us) if T does not appear in the |
| 69 | /// list. |
| 70 | template <typename T, typename ...Us> struct TypeIndex; |
| 71 | template <typename T, typename ...Us> struct TypeIndex<T, T, Us...> { |
| 72 | static constexpr int Index = 0; |
| 73 | }; |
| 74 | template <typename T, typename U, typename... Us> |
| 75 | struct TypeIndex<T, U, Us...> { |
| 76 | static constexpr int Index = 1 + TypeIndex<T, Us...>::Index; |
| 77 | }; |
| 78 | template <typename T> struct TypeIndex<T> { |
| 79 | static constexpr int Index = 0; |
| 80 | }; |
| 81 | |
| 82 | /// Find the first type in a list of types. |
| 83 | template <typename T, typename...> struct GetFirstType { |
| 84 | using type = T; |
| 85 | }; |
| 86 | |
| 87 | /// Provide PointerLikeTypeTraits for void* that is used by PointerUnion |
| 88 | /// for the template arguments. |
| 89 | template <typename ...PTs> class PointerUnionUIntTraits { |
| 90 | public: |
| 91 | static inline void *getAsVoidPointer(void *P) { return P; } |
| 92 | static inline void *getFromVoidPointer(void *P) { return P; } |
| 93 | static constexpr int NumLowBitsAvailable = lowBitsAvailable<PTs...>(); |
| 94 | }; |
| 95 | |
| 96 | template <typename Derived, typename ValTy, int I, typename ...Types> |
| 97 | class PointerUnionMembers; |
| 98 | |
| 99 | template <typename Derived, typename ValTy, int I> |
| 100 | class PointerUnionMembers<Derived, ValTy, I> { |
| 101 | protected: |
| 102 | ValTy Val; |
| 103 | PointerUnionMembers() = default; |
| 104 | PointerUnionMembers(ValTy Val) : Val(Val) {} |
| 105 | |
| 106 | friend struct PointerLikeTypeTraits<Derived>; |
| 107 | }; |
| 108 | |
| 109 | template <typename Derived, typename ValTy, int I, typename Type, |
| 110 | typename ...Types> |
| 111 | class PointerUnionMembers<Derived, ValTy, I, Type, Types...> |
| 112 | : public PointerUnionMembers<Derived, ValTy, I + 1, Types...> { |
| 113 | using Base = PointerUnionMembers<Derived, ValTy, I + 1, Types...>; |
| 114 | public: |
| 115 | using Base::Base; |
| 116 | PointerUnionMembers() = default; |
| 117 | PointerUnionMembers(Type V) |
| 118 | : Base(ValTy(const_cast<void *>( |
| 119 | PointerLikeTypeTraits<Type>::getAsVoidPointer(V)), |
| 120 | I)) {} |
| 121 | |
| 122 | using Base::operator=; |
| 123 | Derived &operator=(Type V) { |
| 124 | this->Val = ValTy( |
| 125 | const_cast<void *>(PointerLikeTypeTraits<Type>::getAsVoidPointer(V)), |
| 126 | I); |
| 127 | return static_cast<Derived &>(*this); |
| 128 | }; |
| 129 | }; |
| 130 | } |
| 131 | |
| 132 | /// A discriminated union of two or more pointer types, with the discriminator |
| 133 | /// in the low bit of the pointer. |
| 134 | /// |
| 135 | /// This implementation is extremely efficient in space due to leveraging the |
| 136 | /// low bits of the pointer, while exposing a natural and type-safe API. |
| 137 | /// |
| 138 | /// Common use patterns would be something like this: |
| 139 | /// PointerUnion<int*, float*> P; |
| 140 | /// P = (int*)0; |
| 141 | /// printf("%d %d", P.is<int*>(), P.is<float*>()); // prints "1 0" |
| 142 | /// X = P.get<int*>(); // ok. |
| 143 | /// Y = P.get<float*>(); // runtime assertion failure. |
| 144 | /// Z = P.get<double*>(); // compile time failure. |
| 145 | /// P = (float*)0; |
| 146 | /// Y = P.get<float*>(); // ok. |
| 147 | /// X = P.get<int*>(); // runtime assertion failure. |
| 148 | template <typename... PTs> |
| 149 | class PointerUnion |
| 150 | : public pointer_union_detail::PointerUnionMembers< |
| 151 | PointerUnion<PTs...>, |
| 152 | PointerIntPair< |
| 153 | void *, pointer_union_detail::bitsRequired(sizeof...(PTs)), int, |
| 154 | pointer_union_detail::PointerUnionUIntTraits<PTs...>>, |
| 155 | 0, PTs...> { |
| 156 | // The first type is special because we want to directly cast a pointer to a |
| 157 | // default-initialized union to a pointer to the first type. But we don't |
| 158 | // want PointerUnion to be a 'template <typename First, typename ...Rest>' |
| 159 | // because it's much more convenient to have a name for the whole pack. So |
| 160 | // split off the first type here. |
| 161 | using First = typename pointer_union_detail::GetFirstType<PTs...>::type; |
| 162 | using Base = typename PointerUnion::PointerUnionMembers; |
| 163 | |
| 164 | public: |
| 165 | PointerUnion() = default; |
| 166 | |
| 167 | PointerUnion(std::nullptr_t) : PointerUnion() {} |
| 168 | using Base::Base; |
| 169 | |
| 170 | /// Test if the pointer held in the union is null, regardless of |
| 171 | /// which type it is. |
| 172 | bool isNull() const { return !this->Val.getPointer(); } |
| 173 | |
| 174 | explicit operator bool() const { return !isNull(); } |
| 175 | |
| 176 | /// Test if the Union currently holds the type matching T. |
| 177 | template <typename T> bool is() const { |
| 178 | constexpr int Index = pointer_union_detail::TypeIndex<T, PTs...>::Index; |
| 179 | static_assert(Index < sizeof...(PTs), |
| 180 | "PointerUnion::is<T> given type not in the union"); |
| 181 | return this->Val.getInt() == Index; |
| 182 | } |
| 183 | |
| 184 | /// Returns the value of the specified pointer type. |
| 185 | /// |
| 186 | /// If the specified pointer type is incorrect, assert. |
| 187 | template <typename T> T get() const { |
| 188 | assert(is<T>() && "Invalid accessor called")((void)0); |
| 189 | return PointerLikeTypeTraits<T>::getFromVoidPointer(this->Val.getPointer()); |
| 190 | } |
| 191 | |
| 192 | /// Returns the current pointer if it is of the specified pointer type, |
| 193 | /// otherwise returns null. |
| 194 | template <typename T> T dyn_cast() const { |
| 195 | if (is<T>()) |
| 196 | return get<T>(); |
| 197 | return T(); |
| 198 | } |
| 199 | |
| 200 | /// If the union is set to the first pointer type get an address pointing to |
| 201 | /// it. |
| 202 | First const *getAddrOfPtr1() const { |
| 203 | return const_cast<PointerUnion *>(this)->getAddrOfPtr1(); |
| 204 | } |
| 205 | |
| 206 | /// If the union is set to the first pointer type get an address pointing to |
| 207 | /// it. |
| 208 | First *getAddrOfPtr1() { |
| 209 | assert(is<First>() && "Val is not the first pointer")((void)0); |
| 210 | assert(((void)0) |
| 211 | PointerLikeTypeTraits<First>::getAsVoidPointer(get<First>()) ==((void)0) |
| 212 | this->Val.getPointer() &&((void)0) |
| 213 | "Can't get the address because PointerLikeTypeTraits changes the ptr")((void)0); |
| 214 | return const_cast<First *>( |
| 215 | reinterpret_cast<const First *>(this->Val.getAddrOfPointer())); |
| 216 | } |
| 217 | |
| 218 | /// Assignment from nullptr which just clears the union. |
| 219 | const PointerUnion &operator=(std::nullptr_t) { |
| 220 | this->Val.initWithPointer(nullptr); |
| 221 | return *this; |
| 222 | } |
| 223 | |
| 224 | /// Assignment from elements of the union. |
| 225 | using Base::operator=; |
| 226 | |
| 227 | void *getOpaqueValue() const { return this->Val.getOpaqueValue(); } |
| 228 | static inline PointerUnion getFromOpaqueValue(void *VP) { |
| 229 | PointerUnion V; |
| 230 | V.Val = decltype(V.Val)::getFromOpaqueValue(VP); |
| 231 | return V; |
| 232 | } |
| 233 | }; |
| 234 | |
| 235 | template <typename ...PTs> |
| 236 | bool operator==(PointerUnion<PTs...> lhs, PointerUnion<PTs...> rhs) { |
| 237 | return lhs.getOpaqueValue() == rhs.getOpaqueValue(); |
| 238 | } |
| 239 | |
| 240 | template <typename ...PTs> |
| 241 | bool operator!=(PointerUnion<PTs...> lhs, PointerUnion<PTs...> rhs) { |
| 242 | return lhs.getOpaqueValue() != rhs.getOpaqueValue(); |
| 243 | } |
| 244 | |
| 245 | template <typename ...PTs> |
| 246 | bool operator<(PointerUnion<PTs...> lhs, PointerUnion<PTs...> rhs) { |
| 247 | return lhs.getOpaqueValue() < rhs.getOpaqueValue(); |
| 248 | } |
| 249 | |
| 250 | // Teach SmallPtrSet that PointerUnion is "basically a pointer", that has |
| 251 | // # low bits available = min(PT1bits,PT2bits)-1. |
| 252 | template <typename ...PTs> |
| 253 | struct PointerLikeTypeTraits<PointerUnion<PTs...>> { |
| 254 | static inline void *getAsVoidPointer(const PointerUnion<PTs...> &P) { |
| 255 | return P.getOpaqueValue(); |
| 256 | } |
| 257 | |
| 258 | static inline PointerUnion<PTs...> getFromVoidPointer(void *P) { |
| 259 | return PointerUnion<PTs...>::getFromOpaqueValue(P); |
| 260 | } |
| 261 | |
| 262 | // The number of bits available are the min of the pointer types minus the |
| 263 | // bits needed for the discriminator. |
| 264 | static constexpr int NumLowBitsAvailable = PointerLikeTypeTraits<decltype( |
| 265 | PointerUnion<PTs...>::Val)>::NumLowBitsAvailable; |
| 266 | }; |
| 267 | |
| 268 | // Teach DenseMap how to use PointerUnions as keys. |
| 269 | template <typename ...PTs> struct DenseMapInfo<PointerUnion<PTs...>> { |
| 270 | using Union = PointerUnion<PTs...>; |
| 271 | using FirstInfo = |
| 272 | DenseMapInfo<typename pointer_union_detail::GetFirstType<PTs...>::type>; |
| 273 | |
| 274 | static inline Union getEmptyKey() { return Union(FirstInfo::getEmptyKey()); } |
| 275 | |
| 276 | static inline Union getTombstoneKey() { |
| 277 | return Union(FirstInfo::getTombstoneKey()); |
| 278 | } |
| 279 | |
| 280 | static unsigned getHashValue(const Union &UnionVal) { |
| 281 | intptr_t key = (intptr_t)UnionVal.getOpaqueValue(); |
| 282 | return DenseMapInfo<intptr_t>::getHashValue(key); |
| 283 | } |
| 284 | |
| 285 | static bool isEqual(const Union &LHS, const Union &RHS) { |
| 286 | return LHS == RHS; |
| 287 | } |
| 288 | }; |
| 289 | |
| 290 | } // end namespace llvm |
| 291 | |
| 292 | #endif // LLVM_ADT_POINTERUNION_H |